summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/62855-0.txt9266
-rw-r--r--old/62855-0.zipbin171179 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/62855-h.zipbin344497 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/62855-h/62855-h.htm9858
-rw-r--r--old/62855-h/images/cover.jpgbin125469 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/62855-h/images/p2.jpgbin4346 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/62855-h/images/spine.jpgbin34572 -> 0 bytes
10 files changed, 17 insertions, 19124 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8fb44b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #62855 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/62855)
diff --git a/old/62855-0.txt b/old/62855-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 7e9502c..0000000
--- a/old/62855-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,9266 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of Treasury of American Indian Tales, by
-Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: Treasury of American Indian Tales
-
-Author: Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-Release Date: August 5, 2020 [EBook #62855]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURY OF AMERICAN INDIAN TALES ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Stephen Hutcheson and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- TREASURY
- OF
- AMERICAN INDIAN TALES
-
-
- BY THEODORE WHITSON RESSLER
-
- [Illustration: {Logo}]
-
- BONANZA BOOKS · NEW YORK
-
- _517110660_
-
-_Copyright © MCMLVII by National Board of Young Men’s Christian
-Association. Library of Congress Catalog Number: 57-5046. All rights
-reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or utilized in any form
-or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying,
-recording, or by any information storage and retrieval system, without
-permission in writing from the publisher. Inquiries should be addressed
-to: BONANZA BOOKS, a division of Crown Publishers, Inc., 419 Park Avenue
-South, New York, New York 10016._
-
- _This edition is published by BONANZA BOOKS,
- a division of Crown Publishers, Inc.
- by arrangement with The Association Press.
- a b c d e f g h
- Manufactured in the United States of America._
-
-
-To William Frederick, My Son
-
- I dedicate this book to you, my son. The ways of the Indian were good.
- Honesty and truth were sacred to them; courage, a part of their lives,
- as much as eating and sleeping. May this book prove to bring you many
- joyful hours of reading, for constantly were you with me during its
- writing, not only in person but in spirit.
-
-
-
-
- THE 44 STORIES FROM 27 TRIBES
-
-
- _Introduction_ ix
- 1. ADVENTURE
- _Little Rabbit Discovers a Secret of Strength_, Pueblo 3
- _Atagahi—The Secret Lake_, Cherokee 10
- _Quarter Moon and Little Elk_, Iroquois 13
- _A Kitten Brings a Boy His Feather_, Nez Percé 20
- _Little Thunder Finds a Friend_, Wyandot 23
- _How Not to Catch a Fish_, Bella Coola 29
- _Little Fire Cloud’s Dream_, Delaware 33
- _The Cry of the Horned Owl_, Cayuga 38
- _The Dream That Led to Victory_, Apache 42
- 2. HUNTING AND FISHING
- _Grey Calf Learns to Hunt Buffalo_, Crow 53
- _Little Fox and the Golden Eagle_, Apache 60
- _How Long Moose Became a Brave_, Powhatan 65
- _How a Fishing Trip Taught Loyalty to a Boy_, Iroquois 71
- _Little Bear’s First Hunt_, Apache 79
- _Crying Eagle Sees a Great Battle_, Iroquois 84
- _Spotted Tail and the Ghost Wolf_, Mohawk 89
- 3. CUSTOMS
- _The Tribes Gather_, Cree 99
- _Singing Eagle’s First Clothes_, Huron 105
- _The New Tepee_, Blackfoot 108
- _Little Dove Learns to Weave_, Winnebago 112
- _Red Cloud’s Dream_, Algonquin 117
- _Broken Tooth and the War Bonnet_, Apache 127
- _Grey Squirrel Hears His Name_, Oneida 129
- 4. HEROISM
- _Little Fawn and the Wolves_, Choctaw 139
- _The Island_, Iroquois 144
- _A New Bow for Tani_, Cherokee 149
- _Singing Waters and the Medicine Well_, Teton-Dakota 153
- _The War That Should Not Have Happened_, Comanche 160
- _Little Horse and the Painted Arrow_, Delaware 174
- _Falling Water Earns a Feather_, Dakota-Sioux 192
- _The Race with Death_, Apache 197
- _The Storm_, Algonquin 210
- 5. CHARACTER
- _Sleeping Bear Makes a Mistake_, Montagnais 217
- _The Lesson of the Elm Tree_, Cherokee 220
- _The Race_, Oneida 225
- _Little Thunderbird Tells the Truth_, Blackfoot 241
- _The Prize No One Could See_, Kickapoo 247
- _The Mysterious Pony Raiders_, Blackfoot 253
- _The Canoe Race_, Ottawa 263
- _Standing Fawn Makes a Doll_, Shawnee 269
- _Black Cloud Remembers_, Seneca 274
- _The Miracle of the Pine Grove_, Iroquois 281
- _Crooked Arrow Finds a Friend_, Shawnee 286
- _The Boy and the Warrior Chief_, Seneca 300
-
-
-
-
- INTRODUCTION
-
-
-This is a collection of American Indian tales for pre-teen boys and
-girls, a fact that does not obviate the possibility of their interest to
-parents and youth leaders, as well. All have been tested by the
-author-compiler with youngsters in many settings—in homes, in church,
-Scout and Y groups, by the campfire, in meeting rooms, and even in
-buses.
-
-Those stories which the author has created are based upon Indian lore
-and customs. Many of the traditional stories were related to him by his
-Indian friends, descendants of the braves who first recounted them many
-generations ago. Both the original and the traditional tales are set
-down within the general context of Indian history, but without any
-pretense that the events actually took place.
-
-Authenticity, however, in the life, customs, and moral standards of the
-Indians has been striven for in each story. Throughout, an attempt has
-been made to impart, without “preaching” at youngsters, three major
-ethical values common to all American Indians—courage, honesty in
-dealing with others, and truthfulness in speech.
-
-The tales are of varying length, but all are short to conform with the
-interest span of average pre-teeners—and, hopefully, to leave them eager
-for the next story session.
-
-It will be noted that both Indian boys and girls play leading roles. The
-author has found that the appeal of each story has been equal for both
-sexes irrespective of whether it has a young hero or heroine.
-
-Parents and youth leaders will observe, too, that stress is placed in
-several stories upon the close father-son and mother-daughter
-relationship—completely true in Indian culture, and as much coveted in
-the formative pre-teen years of our own children today.
-
-Whether read to children, or adapted and retold to them, or read by
-children themselves, it is hoped that these stories will be cherished as
-much by them as by the hundreds of boys and girls who helped,
-unwittingly, to select them for this book.
-
- Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-
-
-
- 1. ADVENTURE
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE RABBIT DISCOVERS A SECRET OF STRENGTH
-
-
-Little Rabbit was a young Pueblo brave who lived a very happy and
-carefree life. There was nothing very special about Little Rabbit unless
-you were to say that his spirits were never dampened by a sad turn of
-events. When something went wrong and people were unhappy, Little Rabbit
-usually found his way to their side, and would offer words of
-encouragement.
-
-The village in which Little Rabbit was born was like all the Pueblo
-adobe villages of centuries before him. Little Rabbit had to climb a
-ladder in order to enter his home, because all ground floor rooms had
-only a roof entrance. By pulling up the ladder at night, families made
-their homes hard to enter.
-
-Little Rabbit had once watched several families make an adobe building,
-several levels high. The walls were made of a mixture of yellowish clay
-and sand, called adobe; the roofs were made of a heavy layer of the same
-adobe laid over a strong frame of log beams, crisscrossed with poles,
-willow branches, sticks, grass, and desert brush. The Spaniards had
-taught the Pueblos how to mold the adobe into bricks. Small holes were
-made for windows and doorways. Each family had one large room, and the
-ground floor room (without windows or a doorway) was used by all the
-families for storage, initiation of the boys into secret societies, and
-for religious ceremonies.
-
-Because each floor was set back the depth of the room below, each level
-had a porch which was used by the Pueblo women for making corn bread,
-pottery, and baskets, and by the men to weave rugs and blankets. When
-religious ceremonies, dances, and games were taking place, these porches
-gave the whole family the best possible point from which to watch.
-
-Such was the village in which Little Rabbit had grown to the age of
-twelve, a strong and tall young brave.
-
-One day he had just finished playing some running games with his friends
-and was returning to his home when one of his friends called to him,
-“Come, Little Rabbit, we are going to walk the ledges.”
-
-Now walking the ledges was a very difficult game and, most of the time,
-was forbidden by the parents. But occasionally some of the more daring
-young braves, willing to chance their necks, would organize a game of
-ledge walking. The idea was something like “Follow the Leader,” but far
-more dangerous. The boys would walk right on the edge of the roofs—along
-the first floor and, if successful and daring enough, along the second,
-and then along the third floor roof. As the boys went higher, fewer and
-fewer would take part; a fall from any one of the roofs would be bad,
-but a fall from the second or third could cause great injury or even
-death.
-
-Now Little Rabbit was not a coward, but he hesitated to play the game
-because his father had told him that he was not to go without his
-father’s permission, and Little Rabbit knew that this was one game his
-father would not permit him to play. So with sadness in his heart he
-shouted back to the other boys that he had work to do, and continued on
-his way home.
-
-Several days passed, and each day a few of the older boys would gather
-to walk ledges, and each day they would ask Little Rabbit to take part,
-and each day Little Rabbit would say no. Finally it got to be too much
-for even Little Rabbit. The next time he was asked he answered yes, and
-soon was playing the very dangerous game.
-
-The boys had all completed the first ledge of the round floor and were
-starting for the second. Just as Little Rabbit reached the second ledge,
-a voice called out, “Little Rabbit, my son, what are you doing?”
-
-The rest of the braves scattered, but the surprise at hearing his
-father’s angry voice near by frightened Little Rabbit for a moment, and
-he lost his balance. He tried to straighten up, but went tumbling down
-the side of the dwelling. He managed to break his fall by grasping at
-the ladder but was not able to hold on. When he landed, his leg was
-doubled under him and a sharp pain shot through his body, and then he
-fainted.
-
-When Little Rabbit awoke, he found he was stretched on his own bed, and
-his father and mother were standing over him.
-
-“I am sorry, my son,” his father said softly. “I did not mean to startle
-you so. But I was afraid for you, and the fear in my heart gave
-harshness and anger to my voice. If I had waited until you were safely
-over the edge and then called to you, this terrible thing might not have
-happened.”
-
-“Do not blame yourself,” said Little Rabbit. “It is I who made the
-mistake. I disobeyed my father. I am truly sorry for that. If I had not
-been doing something wrong, I would not have been startled when you
-called. It was a foolish thing for me to do. I let the other boys tease
-me into playing. It would have been braver for me to tell them no. Truly
-I am ashamed, my father.”
-
-“You must rest, my son. Your leg has been badly injured. When you have
-rested we shall talk of this.” With that, Little Rabbit’s father left
-the house to continue his work.
-
-For many days Little Rabbit lay in pain from his hurt leg; but more than
-his leg, his heart and mind were hurt from the unhappiness he had
-brought to his father by disobeying. He tried to talk with his mother
-about how he felt but all his mother would say was, “Do not worry so,
-Little Rabbit. Your father has forgiven you.”
-
-But this was not what concerned Little Rabbit. His father now had to
-carry on the work of farming the corn and brans and cotton all alone for
-the family. This made Little Rabbit feel very unhappy. He wanted to do
-his share of the work, and he liked to see crops grow.
-
-His leg began to heal, and soon Little Rabbit was able to hobble around
-with the aid of a stout staff. He began to help around the house as much
-as he could. Before long, he was able to limp out to the garden after
-his father and work a little there, too.
-
-Many moons passed and his leg healed and became strong. But it was
-twisted so that when Little Rabbit walked or ran he would limp rather
-badly. The other young braves felt sorry for Little Rabbit. Even though
-he could move about rather easily with his twisted leg, he really could
-not keep up with the other young braves in the many games they played.
-Soon he found that he was not being asked so often to play the really
-exciting games.
-
-One day as Little Rabbit was seated in front of his home, his father was
-returning from the garden. As he came to where Little Rabbit was seated,
-he stopped and spoke gently.
-
-“Why do you sit here so sad and forlorn, my son? Always you have been
-gay and happy, but lately you have become quiet and sad. Tell your
-father what it is that troubles you.”
-
-And so Little Rabbit explained that because he could not keep up with
-them in the games of speed and skill, the other boys no longer invited
-him to play.
-
-“My son, if you are going to sit here and let your life pass you by
-because your leg will not obey every command it is given, you will soon
-become very unhappy and bitter. You will be of no use to anyone, even
-yourself. You must turn your thoughts to other things. If you cannot run
-fast, you must practice. If you cannot jump, you must practice.”
-
-“I have tried, my father, but it seems to do no good. My leg is strong,
-but the way it is twisted causes me to limp. If I try to run my leg
-bends under me. I have tried day after day but it is of no use.”
-
-“You cannot sit here and think of the world as a sad, unhappy place.
-Such thoughts will make your leg feel even more twisted than it really
-is. You must be thankful for your opportunity to raise yourself to be
-more than just an ordinary Indian brave. You have a battle inside
-yourself now that calls for great courage and wisdom. How you will
-overcome it I do not know, but you must try, my son.”
-
-That night Little Rabbit could not go to sleep because he was thinking
-about what his father had said. Maybe he had not been working hard
-enough to make his leg do what he commanded. Tomorrow he would try
-harder.
-
-And so every day Little Rabbit practiced very hard. For many hours each
-week, he would exercise his leg. Finally one day he awoke feeling strong
-and fit. After breakfast he went forth from his home to find his friends
-for a game. When he located them, they were beginning a foot race which
-would take them around the village. Without waiting to be asked, Little
-Rabbit trotted into line just as the race started. The other boys were
-off to a big lead, but that didn’t worry Little Rabbit. He remembered
-what his father had said and, with each running step, he repeated the
-words, “I must try.”
-
-The race was going strong. Soon, to his own surprise, Little Rabbit
-began to pass the other boys one after another. What he had lost in
-ability, he made up in stamina—the strength to go on and on. His many
-days of practice were now proving valuable. As the other boys began to
-tire and drop back, Little Rabbit passed the leading young brave. Then
-he began to widen the gap between himself and the next runner until
-nearly one hundred paces separated him from the second place runner when
-he crossed the finish line.
-
-When all the runners had come panting to the finish line, they gathered
-around Little Rabbit, slapping his shoulders and congratulating him upon
-his victory. Finally, one of the young braves asked, “How did you manage
-to stay so fresh to the very end?”
-
-“Well, you see,” said Little Rabbit quietly, “when I fell from the ledge
-that day and broke my leg, I was sure that I was being punished for
-disobeying my father’s wishes. After my leg healed and I began to play
-again, I found that I could not keep up with you in your games. Once
-again I thought that I was still being punished. But my father told me I
-must try harder. This brought me courage. Once again I began practicing
-every day to learn to run and jump even though my leg was twisted. I do
-not have the skill that I used to have, but I now have endurance which
-may stand me in very good stead later on as it has here today.”
-
-
-
-
- ATAGAHI—THE SECRET LAKE
-
-
-Somewhere in the high ridges of the Great Smokies there was believed to
-be a lake called Atagahi, the Secret Lake. Few people had heard of it,
-and this is a story of a young Cherokee brave and his sister who enjoyed
-the secret of this beautiful lake nestled in the Great Smokies.
-
-Utani placed his bright, shiny, new knife on the ground next to his new
-moccasins and admired the gleaming of the blade in the sun. He was a
-young Cherokee brave, rather tall for his age but very powerfully built
-and with sharp penetrating black eyes. He was too busy admiring the
-glint of the metal in the sun to notice the approach of Netani, his
-sister, until the shadow of her body crossed the knife blade and shut
-off the sun.
-
-“Get out of the way of the sun,” cried Utani. “You are blocking the rays
-from shining on my knife.” Netani made no effort to move and so Utani
-repeated his request.
-
-Netani could not understand Utani’s demand that she move, but he was her
-big brother and so she must obey. As she stepped aside she inquired of
-Utani why he watched so intently the blade of his knife in the sun.
-
-Utani, of course, now being a man, did not want to give a childish
-answer such as, “I am watching the blade shine in the sun.” So he
-quickly gave another answer: “I am receiving a message from the sun.”
-
-“What sort of message?” asked Netani.
-
-“Oh, the sun is telling me where Atagahi is and maybe if I study the
-blade long enough the sun will tell me just where to find it.”
-
-This, Utani thought, would satisfy his little sister. But her curiosity
-was too great, and she asked that Utani take her to the secret lake,
-Atagahi.
-
-Now, Utani realized he had gone a little too far in his bragging; but
-being very stubborn, he refused to tell his sister that he really could
-not find the secret lake by looking at the knife blade in the sun. Utani
-made up his mind that he would have to find the secret lake, Atagahi. He
-rose and placed his knife carefully in his belt and, taking his sister’s
-hand, started toward the ridges of the Great Smokies. For two hours,
-Utani and Netani climbed higher and higher into the mountains; but as
-the day wore on, Utani began to feel a bit frightened, for they were a
-long way from home and had come upon nothing that looked like a lake.
-Finally Netani stopped a few feet behind Utani and called out.
-
-“Let us rest here for a while, big brother. I am getting tired. Besides
-it is late and I am hungry. Let us go back to the village and look
-tomorrow.”
-
-Of course, Utani secretly thought that was a wonderful idea, for he was
-tired and hungry too. He agreed to follow his little sister’s idea.
-
-As he grasped his sister’s hand to start home, his foot kicked a small
-stone which rolled off the side of the trail and down a small embankment
-of earth and landed at the bottom with a splash. Utani and Netani looked
-at each other with great surprise and then carefully stepped to the edge
-of the path. Utani pushed aside the branches that grew along the side of
-the trail, and they both peered down into the waters of a beautiful blue
-green lake nestled among the trees and rocks that hid it from human eyes
-along the trail. They had found it! They had found Atagahi! It was fast
-growing dark, so the two children decided to return to their village and
-come back the following day to the secret lake. When they returned to
-their village the older braves wanted to know where they had been.
-Netani said, “We looked at Utani’s knife blade in the sun, and the sun
-told us where to find Atagahi.”
-
-The older Cherokee braves all laughed and laughed very loudly. But
-Netani and Utani did not laugh, for they knew where Atagahi was and they
-could go there any time they pleased. They never told anyone their
-secret, but every once in a while if you looked very carefully up the
-trail into the mountains, you might see two Indian children kicking
-stones off the side of the trail.
-
-
-
-
- QUARTER MOON AND LITTLE ELK
-
-
-“Quarter Moon! Where are you, Quarter Moon?”
-
-Little Elk was shouting for his friend as he trotted through the quiet
-Iroquois village.
-
-It was July, and many of the older braves had gone off to fish and hunt.
-There were few left in the village except the women, the old men, and
-the children. Little Elk was now twelve and he was feeling like a big
-warrior more and more each day.
-
-Finally just as Little Elk was about to give up, he heard his friend
-answering him from behind his father’s wigwam. “Why do you call so
-loudly, Little Elk?”
-
-“Because my mother said that I could go fishing this day and I would
-like you, my friend, to go with me. I have a great deal of good fishing
-equipment, and there is still one canoe left at the shore of the great
-lake. Can you come with me?”
-
-Quarter Moon thought for a moment, especially of the work he was
-supposed to do that day. Finally he said, “Wait, I will go and ask my
-mother.”
-
-With that he disappeared into the wigwam and in a moment was out again,
-smiling.
-
-“My mother says that I may go, but that I must be back when the sun has
-climbed to the highest point in the sky. For any day now, my father is
-expected back and I have not completed the chores he gave me to do when
-he left.”
-
-“Come then,” said Little Elk. “We must hurry.”
-
-The two boys ran to the lake shore and, after placing their fishing
-equipment in the canoe, they stepped in and pushed away from the shore.
-
-“We will paddle along the shore,” said Little Elk.
-
-The Indians of the Northeast made fishing tackle from young basswood
-saplings and made their hooks from bone. With these they were able to
-catch the mighty muskellunge of the northern waters and supplemented
-their fresh meat diet with lake fish.
-
-The boys paddled for quite some time before they dropped their lines
-into the water. They had picked a good spot because in a matter of
-minutes they had several fish in the floor of the canoe. Suddenly,
-Little Elk noticed that the canoe had been drifting and he spoke to his
-friend about it.
-
-“We should start for home, Little Elk,” Quarter Moon said. “The sun is
-climbing high in the heavens. We have many fine fish, and our mothers
-will be proud.”
-
-As they picked up their paddles once again, Little Elk looked around to
-make sure that they were headed in the right direction. They had been so
-busy with their fishing that they had drifted far from where they had
-started. Little Elk wasn’t quite sure which direction they should take
-to go homeward, for the two boys had never been off by themselves
-fishing and for a moment he was confused. Then, looking at the sun, he
-decided that they had turned completely around and would have to turn
-their canoe once again to be headed in the right direction. And after he
-told Quarter Moon, the two boys turned the canoe around and began to
-paddle in the direction they were sure was right.
-
-They paddled past several islands and toward the main shore, when
-Quarter Moon cried out, “Little Elk, our canoe has sprung a leak.”
-
-Little Elk looked down at his moccasins. The water was beginning to rise
-in the canoe. Then Little Elk knew why this old canoe had been left at
-the shore of the lake. The bottom was not considered safe. So the canoe
-had been left to be repaired and used later on.
-
-“Quarter Moon, we are not too far from the shore. Paddle harder and we
-will be able to reach the shore before the canoe fills so full that we
-cannot move it.”
-
-So the boys paddled with all their strength and soon felt the bow of the
-canoe scrape against the sandy bottom of the lake shore. Jumping out,
-the two boys pulled the leaking canoe ashore and up onto the brush.
-Looking around, the boys realized that they were in unfamiliar
-territory. Neither boy had ever been this far along the shore, but now,
-by looking out upon the lake, they guessed that they were some distance
-north of their village.
-
-“Well,” said Little Elk, “at least we are not lost, for by following the
-shore south, we will come to our village. Come, Quarter Moon! We will
-put our fish upon some green sticks and take them with us.”
-
-The boys took their knives and cut out two young branches from nearby
-trees; by running the branch through the gills of the fish and out
-through the mouth, they were able to carry them comfortably. The boys
-then started to follow the shore for home. By this time the sun was
-beginning to lower in the sky, and the boys knew that it was getting
-quite late. So they hurried along the shore carrying their prize catch
-of muskellunge.
-
-When they had gone less than halfway to the village, Quarter Moon
-suddenly called out to his faster companion.
-
-“Wait, Little Elk, do not run so fast. I cannot keep up with you. I must
-rest.”
-
-The two boys seated themselves on the side of the lake to catch their
-breath. It was then that they suddenly heard a noise. Turning around,
-Little Elk saw several feathers through the trees. He was about to call
-out when a warrior came into his sight and he realized that these were
-not Iroquois, but a roving band of Abnakes. Quickly he threw himself to
-the ground and pushed Quarter Moon down beside him. Quarter Moon almost
-cried out because he was so startled, but Little Elk motioned him to be
-still. He pointed into the woods and Quarter Moon could see why Little
-Elk had motioned him to be quiet. Then Little Elk counted the Abnakes
-who were moving quietly along the trail in single file, headed in the
-direction of his village. There were fourteen of them, all tall, strong,
-young warriors, each carrying a stout bow and a quiver of arrows.
-
-When the band had passed, Little Elk turned to Quarter Moon and
-whispered:
-
-“We must hurry. They are headed in the direction of our village and with
-our warriors all gone, there are none but the old men, women, and
-children. We must warn the village.”
-
-They jumped up and began to run as fast as they could along the shore
-toward their village, forgetting all about their fish and fishing gear,
-in their haste to get to their village and warn their people.
-
-Soon they saw smoke from campfires only a few hundred paces ahead. Even
-though both boys felt as if their hearts would burst, they forced
-themselves to continue running until the wigwams of the village were in
-sight. The boys slowed to a trot, and entered the village all out of
-breath. They ran straight to the wigwam of Quarter Moon’s uncle and
-tried, between gasps for breath, to tell him what they had seen. Finally
-Quarter Moon’s uncle raised his hand. “Wait! Wait! My boy, get your
-breath and then tell me what has brought you to my wigwam breathing so
-heavily and looking like a frightened deer.”
-
-The boys took several deep breaths and then Little Elk told his story to
-the old man.
-
-“But we are not at war with the Abnakes and surely we have nothing they
-would want in our village. But if this is an attack, we must warn the
-others. Go through the village and tell all the others to gather at the
-medicine lodge. There are some of us left who can handle weapons. Rather
-than give our few supplies or our women to an attacking band of Abnakes,
-we will gather every able-bodied man and woman and fight if we have to.”
-
-Word was sent out through the village, and soon everyone gathered at the
-medicine lodge. Quarter Moon was ready to repeat to all what he had told
-the old brave when Little Elk looked through the fringe in the trees and
-spotted some warriors approaching. He was about to shout a warning when
-he saw his father in the lead of the party. Little Elk ran to his
-father, shouting that the Abnakes were near by. And then he saw,
-standing next to his father, a very tall and handsome Abnake. For some
-reason, Little Elk felt that this was no ordinary warrior. Then his
-father spoke.
-
-“Wait, Little Elk, my son. What is this you say about our village being
-invaded?”
-
-Little Elk was embarrassed and looked down at the ground. “My father,
-when Quarter Moon and I were returning from our fishing trip, we saw
-some Abnakes through the trees. They carried many bows and quivers of
-arrows, and they were moving swiftly and quietly toward our village.
-Quarter Moon and I ran as fast as we could to warn the village.”
-
-“You did well, my son. But come, I want you to welcome a friend of mine.
-This is Chief Big Running Fox of the Abnakes. With him are fourteen of
-his finest hunters. Our hunting party searched far and wide for game but
-with little success. After many days of searching, we were ready to
-start for home, sad and empty handed, when we were met by Chief Big
-Running Fox. After explaining to him our presence in Abnake lands, we
-were invited to their village, where we received food and shelter for
-the night. The next morning Chief Big Running Fox explained that the bad
-weather this past spring had driven the game north. The Abnakes had
-plenty, but knew that their neighbors to the south would not have much
-game. So Chief Big Running Fox let us hunt on the Abnake grounds to get
-plenty of meat for our tribe. In return we have invited them here for a
-feast to thank them for this great kindness.”
-
-“I am sorry, great chief, that I thought you were going to attack our
-village,” said Little Elk, feeling very much ashamed.
-
-Chief Big Running Fox placed his hands upon the boy’s shoulders. “Do not
-feel ashamed. It could have been an unfriendly visit and you were right
-to warn your people of strangers near your home. Your father can be
-proud to have you for a son, and we are glad to have you as a friend.”
-
-The hunting party of Iroquois and Abnakes moved into the village side by
-side. That night, instead of war dances, there were happy dances
-celebrating their good hunting and finding a new friend. Right in the
-center of all the excitement sat Little Elk and Quarter Moon, the heroes
-of the day.
-
-
-
-
- A KITTEN BRINGS A BOY HIS FEATHER
-
-
-Between the swift running Snake River and the rumbling Grande Ronde in
-the beautiful Valley of Winding Waters, there lived a band of Indians
-called the Wallows, a branch of the Nez Percé tribe.
-
-Little White Wolf was one of the young boys who was trying to earn his
-first feathers which would show that he had become a full-fledged brave.
-Often he would wander from the camp into the forests that covered the
-slopes of the valley. There he would try to think of things he could do
-to get his feather—an act of bravery or great hunting skill. Two summers
-had passed since he first tried to win his feather. His little friends,
-Swift Owl and Gray Frog, had earned their feathers and now strutted
-proudly through the village to call attention to their feathers. They
-both took special care to spend most of their time playing near Little
-White Wolf, no doubt to make him jealous of their awards.
-
-One day, when Little White Wolf was watching his mother mold a small
-bowl from clay, he caught sight of his father, Big White Wolf, striding
-into the village with a large brown animal slung over his shoulders.
-Little White Wolf knew that his father had made a kill. The boy raced
-forward excitedly to greet his father. As his father came nearer, the
-boy saw the large claws of a mountain lion. He was thrilled and proud
-and asked impatiently for his father to tell him the story of the kill.
-But his father only shook his head and put his hand on Little White
-Wolf’s shoulder to quiet him.
-
-“My son,” he told him, “you will have to wait until the big fire tonight
-when I tell the tale for all to hear.”
-
-That night as the braves gathered around the evening fire, Little White
-Wolf settled as close as he could to the spot where his father would
-stand to tell his tale of adventure. After the other braves had told
-their stories, Little White Wolf’s father walked with long, firm steps
-to the center of the circle and began to speak. While Little White Wolf
-listened, he thought that his father looked unusually strong and tall.
-
-Big White Wolf told how he had been tracking a deer in a small glen at
-the southern end of the valley when he heard a snarl. Turning quickly,
-he saw a large female puma poised to spring at him from a tree. Just as
-the cat leaped, Big White Wolf shot his arrow. The cat fell dead at his
-feet. He could not explain why the big cat had been roused unless he had
-been close to a lair of kittens which this mother cat had been guarding.
-
-Little White Wolf leaned forward listening intently. Suddenly a thought
-flashed through his mind. He could not sleep soundly that night because
-he kept thinking of his secret plan. As dawn broke, Little White Wolf
-arose silently and gathered his bow and arrow and a small pouch of food.
-Then he started off for the southern end of the valley. He came soon to
-the place where his father had killed the big cat. The boy began to
-search every nook and cranny for the little kittens that must be here.
-He felt sure his father had been right in guessing why the cat had
-sprung at him.
-
-Finally, after many hours of searching, Little White Wolf was about to
-give up when he heard a faint cry coming from his right. He moved behind
-a small tree and parted the branches to see what had made the sound.
-Just a few paces away in the hollow of a rock lay a small ball of brown
-fur. Now Little White Wolf must carry out his plan to bring the puma
-kitten back to camp alive. He moved slowly and quietly so that he would
-not frighten the kitten. The little puma was looking away from Little
-White Wolf.
-
-When the boy was only two paces away, the kitten heard him. The animal
-jumped up quickly and started to run. But the Indian was too fast. He
-leaped and caught the kitten by the scruff of the neck. Then he lifted
-the little puma gently and began to scratch its head and pet it. In a
-few moments, the animal was curled up in Little White Wolf’s arms,
-leaning contentedly against the boy’s chest. The boy started back to
-camp with his prize.
-
-No one had known why he had left or where he had gone, so Little White
-Wolf was greeted excitedly by the other boys as he marched into the
-camp. Even Swift Owl and Gray Frog praised him for having rescued the
-little puma and for having braved a possible attack from some grown
-puma.
-
-That night Little White Wolf told his story. With great dignity, the
-Chief awarded the boy his feather. He was a very proud young brave. Now
-he could strut with Gray Frog and Swift Owl throughout the camp.
-
-Little White Wolf never realized how thankful his father was that his
-son had returned safely. Big White Wolf knew that the father cat might
-have returned while the boy was taking the kitten. If that had happened,
-there might have been no feather award council fire that night.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE THUNDER FINDS A FRIEND
-
-
-Little Thunder was always the first one awake in his woodland Wyandot
-village, running about doing many chores before his parents were even
-awake. He would build up the breakfast fire and make sure there was
-enough wood to keep it going during the day. He would take the water
-bags to the cool spring and refill them with fresh water for that day
-and do many other little chores.
-
-Finally when the rest of the village began to stir, Little Thunder would
-rush about gathering up his many small treasures and lay them all out in
-front of him on the ground to choose the ones he would carry with him
-that day. He had pieces of flint, a deer’s horn, colored stones from the
-brooks, birch bark on which he had burned pictures, and many other
-things important to an Indian boy. Then his mother would call him in to
-eat. When breakfast was over, his father and mother would explain the
-family’s plans for the day. Then each would set about doing his share of
-the work.
-
-One morning just before Little Thunder’s father was to go off on a hunt
-with the other warriors of the village, he called Little Thunder to him.
-
-“You must take care of your mother while I am away,” Big Thunder told
-the boy. “You must be the man of the house now. You must protect your
-mother and your home and see that all of the work is done.” He smiled
-and pressed his son’s shoulders. “You will soon be a man and then we can
-go on the big hunt together. But you are man enough now to watch over
-your mother while I am away.”
-
-Little Thunder felt very proud of the way his father had spoken to him.
-When all was in readiness and the hunters had left the village, Little
-Thunder turned to his mother and stood very straight as he looked at
-her.
-
-“Do not be afraid, for I will watch over you, mother,” he promised. “To
-show that I can get all the food we need, I will go into the woods and
-bring us a fine fat rabbit for supper.”
-
-Now Little Thunder had a good hunting bow which his grandfather had made
-for him many moons ago. It was of stout hickory and had an even curve to
-it when the sinew string was pulled tight. Little Thunder had worked
-carefully to make straight, strong arrow shafts. He had chosen the best
-willow shoots from which be peeled the bark. Then he seasoned and
-straightened them over the fire, and rubbed them smooth with sandstone.
-His arrowpoints were made of flint which he had chipped with a piece of
-deer’s antler after much practice under the eyes of his father. These
-were his best arrows and he was saving them for the time he would go
-with his father on the hunt.
-
-Little Thunder laid these big-game arrows aside and picked up the set he
-had made for use now as a young Indian boy. They had bone points which
-he had ground sharp and bound into the split end of the shaft with wet
-sinew that tightened as it dried. On the other end he had glued and tied
-carefully trimmed goose and turkey feathers to help the arrow fly
-straight to its mark. He selected several arrows and tested his bow.
-Little Thunder knew he would find plenty of game because the Indians
-never killed without needing the food or skin of an animal. Having
-finished all preparations for the hunt, he said good-bye to his mother
-and started off to find the fat juicy rabbit he had promised her.
-
-Little Thunder trotted along the forest trails at a fast jog, looking in
-all directions for signs of game. He moved softly on his toes and the
-balls of his feet, as his father had taught him, so that he would not
-frighten the creatures of the forest.
-
-Soon he came out of the forest into a large clearing that he believed
-would yield the game he was after. He had walked watchfully only a short
-while when, not seven paces from him, he saw a rather large clump of
-tall grass move. He dropped to the ground, pressed his body flat against
-the earth and waited. The grass did not move again. He tested the slight
-breeze by wetting a finger in his mouth and holding his finger in the
-air. The side of his finger away from him felt cool and he knew that the
-breeze was blowing toward him. Whatever was in the grass ahead of him
-would not be able to catch his scent. He crept forward softly. When he
-was about three paces from the clump of grass, he stood up with bow and
-arrow ready to shoot.
-
-But before he let the arrow fly, he stopped short. There, nestled in the
-grass, was a young fawn which appeared to have been born only a short
-while ago. The fawn, frightened by Little Thunder, lay perfectly still,
-his coat blending in almost perfectly with the grasses and shrubs around
-him.
-
-Little Thunder put the arrow back in his quiver. He moved toward the
-animal slowly. The fawn struggled to his spindly little legs and wobbled
-slightly. Then his legs gave way and he fell to the ground. Little
-Thunder could not help laughing at the awkward little animal. This
-scared the fawn even more and he rose to his feet again and tried to run
-but again tumbled to the ground. Little Thunder ran forward to where the
-fawn lay, fearful that the fawn might have hurt himself. When he reached
-the side of the fawn he knelt down and placed his hands along the soft
-silky neck. The fawn trembled but he made no attempt to move. Gently,
-Little Thunder stroked his neck and head and back and soon the little
-fawn quieted down. It was not too long before a rough little tongue
-reached up and swiped at Little Thunder’s face. Little Thunder laughed
-again and the fawn trembled. Speaking softly, Little Thunder told the
-fawn that everything was all right and that no one would harm him.
-
-Little Thunder realized that the mother deer must not be too far off,
-because only rarely would a mother deer leave her young—and then only to
-get a drink of water or find a new place to hide her fawn. Little
-Thunder rose from the ground and decided to look around for the fawn’s
-mother. Walking to the opposite edge of the clearing, he looked down
-through the forest and saw a lake. Winding his way through the trees and
-brush, he was soon standing upon the shore of the lake. There he found
-fresh tracks of a full-grown deer. Then he saw some blood on the shore
-near more deer tracks, but he could find no further trace of the deer.
-Then he spotted the prints of a pair of moccasins. He realized that a
-warrior from a neighboring tribe in search of food had probably come
-upon the doe while she was drinking, shot her, and carried her away. He
-knew his guess was right when he saw a deer’s stubby tail tied to the
-branch of a low-hanging tree—a sign always left by an Indian near the
-place where he had killed an animal for food or clothing.
-
-Little Thunder ran back quickly to the little fawn, still nestled in the
-tall grass. Even though he trembled as Little Thunder came near, he soon
-became calm as the young Indian petted him gently.
-
-“Your mother has been killed, little one,” Little Thunder murmured to
-the fawn. “That leaves you with no one to look out for you. Do not
-worry. I, Little Thunder, will be your friend. But first we must get you
-to a safer place, for there are many animals that would make life
-dangerous for you here in the open.”
-
-Little Thunder lifted the young fawn in his arms and carried him into
-the woods where he found a small thicket. Hiding the fawn in the
-thicket, he returned to the lake and brought some water to the fawn.
-Then picking up his bow and arrows, he trotted swiftly toward home to
-tell his mother of his adventure. On the way, a plump rabbit ran across
-his path. Little Thunder’s shot was easy and accurate. So he brought his
-mother the big rabbit he had promised—and a big but true story, too.
-
-For many days after that, Little Thunder went back with food to his
-newly found friend. The young fawn soon became strong and was able to
-frisk about. Soon Little Thunder and the fawn were playing games
-together in the clearing. He even taught the fawn to come when he
-whistled.
-
-At last, his father returned from the long hunting trip and Little
-Thunder told him all about his adventure with the young fawn.
-
-“This I will have to see for myself,” Big Thunder told the boy.
-“Tomorrow we shall go together to the thicket in the forest.”
-
-So the next morning Little Thunder took his father to the forest, but
-when they reached the thicket, it was empty. Big Thunder smiled at his
-son as if to say that the boy had dreamed the whole adventure.
-
-“He is probably out frisking in the clearing,” Little Thunder said
-hastily, “or he’s down at the lake having a drink. He will be back soon.
-Come, father, we will sit over here and wait.”
-
-Though they waited patiently long into the afternoon, the deer did not
-return. For several days after that, Little Thunder came back to the
-forest and clearing and lake, but there was no sign of his animal
-friend. Little Thunder lost all hope of finding the fawn and soon forgot
-all about him, until one day about twelve moons later.
-
-Little Thunder had gone hunting that day and found himself on the trail
-of a young buck. He followed the buck all morning and just as he was
-about to give up the trail and return home, he saw the clearing where he
-had found the fawn. Approaching quietly he looked out across the
-clearing. At first he could see nothing. Then as he gazed along the side
-of the clearing near the forest, his eyes stopped at the small thicket.
-Something moved. Could it be the fawn, he wondered hopefully.
-
-Slowly he stood up and moved toward the thicket. Then something stirred
-again. A beautiful young buck stood up in the thicket. The buck turned
-to run. Little Thunder whistled and called out softly. The buck stopped,
-turned and looked at the boy. Then, without fear, the buck ran forward
-to where Little Thunder stood with his hand outstretched. The animal’s
-tongue licked the Indian’s hand, and Little Thunder reached up and
-scratched the young buck’s head. The boy knew that his friend had come
-back at last. He would have much to talk about to the buck—and even more
-to tell his father.
-
-
-
-
- HOW NOT TO CATCH A FISH
-
-
-The Bella Coola were a tribe that lived along the Northwest coast. Like
-most of the Indians in this part of the land, they were fishermen and
-woodcarvers. Some of the most beautiful carvings in the world have come
-from these tribes. Their chief source of food was fish. Each year at the
-time the salmon were running, the Indians would go out to the great
-rivers with spears and fish nets to make large catches. Each salmon was
-then split and dried and stored.
-
-As soon as the Bella Coola boys were old and strong enough, they were
-taken out to the rivers and taught how to throw the fish spear with its
-long line attached. They were also taught the use of the large fish
-nets. Both the spear and the net were hard to handle and sometimes
-dangerous.
-
-One day Little Twig (who had that name because of his size and the
-thinness of his body when he was born) begged his father to take him on
-the salmon hunt. All the men of the tribe were getting ready to head for
-the river steps where the salmon would be leaping. But Little Twig’s
-father stooped beside his son and spoke slowly to him.
-
-“My son, I would like to take you along, but this is man’s work and you
-are still a young boy with much to learn. Stay here in the village and
-play with the other children. Your day of hunting and spearing the great
-salmon will come before you know it. But this time the answer must be
-No.”
-
-Little Twig watched his father leave the village. When all the other
-fishermen had left, Little Twig went in search of his friend, Running
-Turtle. He found him carving a new handle for his knife.
-
-“Running Turtle, let us go and watch our fathers fish for the great
-salmon,” he said. “We can go far above them on the river and watch from
-the ledge. We will stay only for a short while and will be back in the
-village before we are missed. I have never seen them fish for the great
-salmon because my father says that it is too dangerous for Indian boys.
-Will you go?”
-
-“My father will not let me go to fish with the men of the village
-either. But he never said that I could not watch the men as they fish.
-Come, Little Twig, let us hurry. The men are probably already there.”
-
-The two boys set out swiftly after the fishing party. Soon they could
-hear the river roaring just ahead of them. They stopped at the trees
-that grew close to the river shore. Peering through the branches, they
-could see the men of the tribe spread out on both sides of the river,
-some with nets and some with spears. At the feet of each fisherman were
-large baskets into which he threw the fish he caught.
-
-The boys worked their way around and above the fishermen until they were
-about three hundred paces upstream from the fishermen. Edging close to
-the side of the river near the top of the waterfalls, the boys crept out
-on a sloping ledge of rock that was only an arm’s length from the
-rushing water. They were so close that the spray wet their faces as they
-gazed downstream at the fishermen.
-
-Soon Little Twig became so excited by what he was watching that he stood
-up and began to pretend that he was fishing for salmon, too. But he was
-not used to the slippery rocks as the men were, and he suddenly found
-that he was losing his balance. He called to Running Turtle to help him,
-but before Running Turtle could grab him Little Twig was tumbling into
-the rushing river. His body was caught in the great swirling waters that
-swept him downstream. He choked as his eyes and nose and ears filled
-with water. Just as he began to think he would die, he felt his body
-being lifted from the water, and heard a voice shouting.
-
-“Look at this fine fish that I have caught,” someone yelled, laughing.
-
-Then Little Twig realized that one of the fishermen had reached out with
-his net and snatched him from the river. Little Twig sputtered and
-coughed and rubbed his eyes as strong hands set him on his feet. There
-he was, in the middle of a circle of grinning warriors from the village.
-He began rubbing all the sore spots where river rocks had struck his
-body. Suddenly he recognized his father’s face. Instead of wearing the
-stern look which Little Twig had expected, his father was smiling.
-
-“Were you so eager to take a swim that you dove into the river?” he
-asked the boy. “Or did you hope to catch brother salmon with your bare
-hands?”
-
-“I disobeyed you, my father, and I am truly sorry. I was a foolish young
-boy to come to the river when you told me to stay at home. Now I know
-why I have not been brought on the fishing trips. This is truly a job
-for men.”
-
-Little Twig looked toward the ground. His father reached down and lifted
-the lad into the air.
-
-“Yes, my son, this is a job for men. Someday soon you will join us in
-hunting the swift salmon with spear and net. But for now, be happy to
-remain in the village with your friends. You were lucky that my brother
-had his net where he did, or we might have missed you and your body
-would have been carried away. Come, we will go back to the village to
-tell your mother of your swim this fine day.”
-
-Then he laughed again. Little Twig laughed this time, too, and all the
-braves joined in the laughter. No one would speak harshly to him about
-his foolish act even though it had brought him near death. Indians
-believed that angry words make people sick. So Indian parents, like
-Little Twig’s father, always tried to speak happily.
-
-Just then Running Turtle came out of hiding, and he started to laugh
-with the others.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE FIRE CLOUD’S DREAM
-
-
-The Delawares were a peaceful tribe, hunting and fishing in their rich
-valley and not bothering their neighbors, for they had plenty and needed
-little more than they were able to obtain themselves with their strong
-bows and sharp arrows and their well-kept fishing gear.
-
-It was late spring, and one day as Little Fire Cloud romped and played
-in the village his father called to him.
-
-“Come, Little Fire Cloud, it is time we built a new canoe. Shortly we
-shall be needing a new canoe and if we do not start work now it will not
-be ready when the time comes to leave camp.”
-
-So father and son started out to gather the materials to make a fine new
-canoe.
-
-The Indians of the forest and lakes depended a great deal upon the canoe
-and were wise enough to construct them of material that was easy to
-obtain. Light cedar made the ribs and the planking of the canoe, and
-over this the Indians stretched a tight cover of birch bark. Then they
-took spruce roots and split them and these they used to sew the seams of
-the canoe together. They then would calk the spaces with a tarlike
-substance which was made from pine pitch and soot. When finished the
-product was firm and sturdy, but above all if the canoe should become
-injured in any way, the materials were always handy in the forest with
-which to make repairs.
-
-Finally Little Fire Cloud and his father had gathered all the necessary
-equipment together and the work on the canoe was started. Father and son
-worked very hard at the job, and a few days later the canoe was
-completed. As the two finished their work they stood back to admire the
-job and Little Fire Cloud said,
-
-“Is it not beautiful, father? It is the most beautiful canoe I have ever
-seen either in our own village or any of our neighbors.”
-
-“Yes, Little Fire Cloud, it really is a beautiful canoe and one which we
-can be proud of.”
-
-For the rest of that day that remained, Little Fire Cloud could talk of
-nothing else but the beautiful canoe that he helped his father to build.
-Finally supper was over, and it was time to retire.
-
-That night as Little Fire Cloud fell asleep his head was all full of
-visions of canoes and rapids and great lakes and rivers. Soon the
-confusion of many things became one thing, and Little Fire Cloud found
-himself standing on the shore of a great lake. He did not know how he
-got there or what lake it was, but the water was a beautiful blue green
-and it was calm and smooth. It was daytime and, as Little Fire Cloud
-looked upon the lake, in the distance he saw a canoe coming toward him.
-In the bow of the canoe stood a great warrior, his arms folded across
-his chest and his eyes looking right at Little Fire Cloud.
-
-In the stern of the canoe, a young warrior softly paddled the canoe
-forward toward the shore, directly to where Little Fire Cloud was
-standing. As the canoe drew closer, Little Fire Cloud saw that it was
-made of shimmering silver birch bark and it looked so clean and new.
-
-As the bow scraped the shore, the warrior stepped from the canoe and
-walked to where Little Fire Cloud was standing.
-
-“Come, Little Fire Cloud, step into the canoe, and we shall take a short
-trip.”
-
-“I do not know if I should,” said Little Fire Cloud overcome by the
-great warrior who stood before him. “My father might wonder where I had
-gone.”
-
-“Do not worry about your father for you will be gone only a short while
-and we shall return you to this point on the shore. I have something I
-want to show you.”
-
-So Little Fire Cloud feeling a warmth toward this great warrior stepped
-in and seated himself in the middle of the canoe. Then the great warrior
-stepped in and pushed away from shore. The warrior in the stern turned
-the canoe toward the middle of the lake and began to paddle steadily,
-his blade cutting the water neatly and hardly making a ripple.
-
-The canoe glided softly and smoothly across the water. Up ahead a mist
-had settled upon the water, and soon the canoe had entered this mist and
-was gliding softly through the water with nothing on any side but the
-cloudy white mist. All that Little Fire Cloud could see was water right
-next to the canoe.
-
-Little Fire Cloud called to the warrior.
-
-“Where are you taking me, O great warrior of the lake?”
-
-“You shall see, little brave,” said the great warrior without turning in
-the canoe.
-
-Soon the mist lifted, and there surrounding the canoe was a beautiful
-pool of water with many streams running off in different directions.
-
-The Indian who was paddling guided the canoe into one of these streams,
-and as the canoe moved forward the warrior pointed toward the shore.
-There along the shore, Little Fire Cloud could see many beaver working
-diligently at gathering material for their homes. As the canoe continued
-along the stream, Little Fire Cloud saw many beautiful flowers and
-plants, and occasionally a deer could be seen drinking at the water’s
-edge. Little Fire Cloud was quick to notice that the animals seemed to
-pay no attention to the canoe when it sailed past where they stood
-except to lift their heads and look at this craft as it moved smoothly
-along the stream under the expert hands of the brave in the stern.
-
-Little Fire Cloud noticed that there were no weapons in the canoe.
-
-Soon they had reached a fork in the stream, and again the canoe was
-guided into one of the openings and the trip continued. Many more wild
-flowers and animals were observed by Little Fire Cloud until suddenly
-they were in the mist once again and all the beauty was behind them as
-they moved swiftly through the mist.
-
-When they broke from the cloud, Little Fire Cloud could see the shore of
-the lake once again and he realized that they must have traveled in a
-circle. Soon the canoe scraped the shore and the warrior stepped out and
-assisted Little Fire Cloud. When the boy was safely ashore the warrior
-said, “Did you enjoy your trip?”
-
-“Oh, yes,” answered Little Fire Cloud. “Everything was so beautiful.
-Thank you very much for the nice ride and for showing me all the
-beautiful things of nature.”
-
-“Yes, Little Fire Cloud, there are many many beautiful things in nature
-that can be seen if one travels quietly and peacefully in a good canoe.
-Nature is our friend and, if we remember this, many pleasant hours will
-be spent seeing nature. Do not do anything to spoil this picture which
-will remain with you always. If you never raise your bow to kill unless
-you have need for food or clothing game will always be plentiful. But if
-you wasted this beauty which is given to the Indian you yourself and
-your people would soon die from hunger and cold. To kill for the sake of
-killing is cruel and wasteful. Now I must say good-bye, for I have many
-miles to travel. Good-bye, Little Fire Cloud, and remember your trip
-into the misty lake.”
-
-With that the warrior stepped into the canoe, and soon the canoe turned
-and disappeared into the distance.
-
-Suddenly Little Fire Cloud felt a hand upon his shoulder and someone was
-shaking him.
-
-“My son, my son, wake up, you have been dreaming.”
-
-When Little Fire Cloud opened his eyes he was lying on his bed, and his
-father was standing over him.
-
-“Oh, father, I had the most beautiful dream. A great warrior came and
-took me for a ride in a beautiful canoe and showed me the wonders of
-nature in all their splendor.”
-
-And Little Fire Cloud went on to tell his dream in all the beautiful
-detail that he could remember. His father was a good father and so he
-listened patiently to his son; and when Little Fire Cloud had finished
-telling about the dream, his father said, “Yes, my son, it was a
-beautiful dream, and in the dream you learned a great lesson concerning
-the creatures of the wild which I hope you will always remember.”
-
-
-
-
- THE CRY OF THE HORNED OWL
-
-
-Little Beaver was full of excitement, for soon the winter would be over
-and he and his friend Jumping Rabbit would once again be able to take
-their little canoe and go to the lake and streams to catch the fine fish
-that waited in the early spring for the bait to be cast.
-
-The Cayuga village had weathered the winter well, and now the first
-signs of spring were beginning to show. With the bursting forth of the
-spring flowers and the green shoots of plants and grass and the green
-leaves the Cayuga village seemed to come alive.
-
-One of the first tasks was the uncovering of the canoes. (When winter
-approached, the canoes were all hauled far above the lake water’s edge
-and covered completely with mounds of sand. This kept them from drying
-out and cracking during the cold winter.) Finally all the canoes had
-been uncovered, and the Indians took to the lakes and the streams again,
-fishing and hunting to replenish the food supply that had been used
-during the winter.
-
-One morning Little Beaver searched for his friend Jumping Rabbit for a
-long time and when he could not find him, he decided to go off by
-himself. Walking to the edge of the lake he found that his father had
-uncovered his canoe for him.
-
-Stepping into the canoe he paddled across the lake to the mouth of a
-stream which was new to him. This stream led to the Lake of the Rushes
-where the girls and women gathered the rushes each spring to make new
-mats for the platforms of the wigwam. Here he had not been before.
-
-As Little Beaver paddled he saw many signs of spring, but he was
-searching for big game. He wanted to be the first young boy to bring a
-deer back to the village.
-
-Soon he beached his canoe on the side of the Rush Lake and moved inland
-searching for signs of the deer. Suddenly he came upon the tracks of
-what seemed to be a fine big buck. Following carefully along the track
-of the deer he noticed that the deer was moving slowly. Then suddenly
-the spaces between the tracks became bigger and he knew that the deer
-had begun to move faster.
-
-Suddenly the noises of the woods ceased and it was very quiet. Up ahead
-a shadow flitted across the trail. Little Beaver dropped upon his belly
-and then he heard it—the cry of the great horned owl. But still he knew
-that the owl would not cry at this time of day and from a short distance
-off the trail he heard an answering cry.
-
-Through the fading light among the trees up ahead, he saw a small group
-of warriors gather. One of these warriors placed his hand alongside his
-mouth, and the cry of the horned owl once again was heard and from
-another direction an answer.
-
-Then Little Beaver knew that these were unfriendly Indians from the
-north and they had invaded the land of the Cayugas. They could be here
-for one reason only, to raid his village.
-
-“I must return at once to the village and warn my people of this
-danger.”
-
-Little Beaver turned and retreated down the path to where he had left
-his canoe. Pushing it out into the lake he immediately began paddling as
-fast as his arms could go for the mouth of the stream that would lead
-into the next lake and to the shore of his village. He reached the mouth
-of the stream just as the dark storm clouds started to gather over the
-lake.
-
-And then it was raining and raining hard. This would slow up the
-attackers, but it would not stop them and Little Beaver had to get to
-his village quickly to warn his people of the danger. He dipped his
-paddle deep into the waters of the lake and the canoe moved forward. But
-now the wind was getting stronger and his arms began to ache from the
-effort. He paddled harder and harder but soon his arms became weak and
-he was still a great distance from the shore. Besides the danger of the
-storm it was fast approaching nightfall, and ahead Little Beaver could
-see the friendly fires of his village being lit one at a time.
-
-These would act as beacons of direction for the enemy.
-
-He chanced a glance behind and then he heard it again. The cry of the
-horned owl. The cry was coming from almost directly behind and in the
-dusk he could see the canoes of the enemy slipping from the stream into
-the lake.
-
-The storm passed and the waters became calm, and now Little Beaver’s job
-was easier, but so was that of the enemy. He paddled with all his might
-though he felt his arms would fall off.
-
-Finally he reached the shore and he leaped out onto the sand. Without
-waiting to pull his canoe ashore he rushed for the village. He turned to
-glance at the lake once more and he could see the canoes of the enemy
-drawing along the shore, closer to the village with each stroke.
-
-He rushed to his father and quickly told him what he had seen. His
-father dashed from the wigwam and glanced toward the lake. Just then
-they both heard it once again. The cry of the great horned owl. His
-father stopped and listened and then placing his own hand to the side of
-his mouth he answered the whistle. Then he turned to his son.
-
-“It is all right my son. These are friends come to join in a great
-celebration. It is your uncle and his people from the north. Be not
-afraid, for they are friends.”
-
-Little Beaver looked at his father. He smiled and taking his father’s
-hand they walked toward the lakeside. Stepping from the canoes were a
-number of Cayuga warriors and they came with many bundles.
-
-The two groups greeted each other and then the leader of the visitors
-came forward.
-
-“Your father has explained that you thought we were unfriendly Indians
-come to call. I, for one, am glad that you are not a grown warrior right
-now, for your arrow shaft might have found its place in my heart in the
-forest. We had hoped to surprise your people with our visit but when we
-saw your canoe glide away from the Lake of the Rushes we knew we had
-been seen. And so, my little brave, let me congratulate you on a fine
-job of paddling. You came across the lake in a storm without slowing
-your stroke. I have told my brother that if we had been the enemy you
-would have reached the village far ahead of us and we would now be
-walking the trail of the happy hunting ground.”
-
-That night Little Beaver slept very soundly. He had a great adventure on
-his first trip to the Lake of the Rushes and it would be a long time to
-come before he would go alone again.
-
-
-
-
- THE DREAM THAT LED TO VICTORY
-
-
-Singing Fire, the young Apache brave, rode swiftly through the hills
-toward the village of his people. He had been hunting and now was
-returning to his tepee to join his family in a hearty evening meal. His
-hunger made him urge his pony to an even faster pace. Soon he could see
-the smoke of the fires in the village. It was only a few moments later
-that Singing Fire brought his pony to a quick stop on the very edge of
-the village. To ride his horse through the village this evening would
-have been unkind. The summer had been very dry, and his pony’s hoofs
-would have raised much dust that would settle in the cooking pots.
-
-Walking through the village, the young brave waved and called to his
-friends. He laughed when they joked with him about his empty hands. He
-had been unable to find any game that he felt was worth bringing to the
-village. Soon he reached his father’s tepee and was welcomed warmly by
-the family.
-
-When supper was finished, Singing Fire went to talk with his friend,
-Many Painted Ponies. The two braves had always been together since they
-were very young and just learning to walk. Now whenever they had time,
-they would sit and talk about their future together as great leaders of
-the Apache tribe. He found his friend working at making new arrow tips.
-
-“Hello, my good friend, Many Painted Ponies, and how are you this fine
-evening?”
-
-“My stomach is full and my heart is happy, Singing Fire. Could a brave
-ask much more of life? I have been very fortunate in having such a fine
-father and mother who have made my life such a pleasure. As I saw you
-ride in from the hunt, I noticed you carried no game. Was there no game
-where you rode? Usually you do not return empty-handed.”
-
-“Today was bad for the hunt. The largest game knew that I was hunting
-and ran for cover, and I was not as quick as they to find the hiding
-places.”
-
-The two young men laughed and then spent some time talking until
-darkness came. Each young man went back to his tepee for a well-earned
-sleep.
-
-The next day there was great excitement in the village. As young Singing
-Fire stepped from his tepee, he saw that people were gathering in the
-center of the village to hear a tall Apache warrior who was talking
-loudly and rapidly to the chief of the village. As Singing Fire drew
-near, he was able to catch some of the words spoken by the warrior.
-
-“It is true, my Chief, the Comanches have been seen in our land. If we
-are not careful they will raid our pony herds and make off with many of
-our best mounts. I have seen them to the east, and they skulk like the
-lowly wolf in the night.”
-
-The great chief listened quietly until the young warrior had finished.
-Then he motioned to the older men of the tribe to gather in his tepee.
-When they were all inside, Singing Fire, Many Painted Ponies, and the
-other young braves stood outside waiting impatiently for what the elders
-of the tribe would decide. They could hear the young brave who had first
-reported to the chief repeating his story for those who had come late.
-He said that while trailing some ponies that had strayed from the herd
-he had come upon the coals of a recent fire. Because the marks in the
-sand were not Apache, he had followed the tracks made when the group
-broke camp. Traveling at a rapid pace, he soon had come upon the band of
-Comanches in a small gully. After watching them for a short while, the
-brave had mounted his pony and ridden as fast as he could to the village
-to tell the chief of this threat to their property and peace, within
-such a short distance of their camp.
-
-Finally the Chief came out from his tepee and spoke to the young
-warriors.
-
-“The Comanches have entered our hunting grounds. Not only have they
-broken the law, but they dare to ride within a short distance of our
-camp. We will gather a war party and go in search of these thieves of
-the night. We will give them a sound lesson by whipping those wild dogs
-so badly that they will return to their own land with their tails
-between their legs—if there are any left to return when we have met them
-upon the field of battle.”
-
-With low shouts of agreement, everyone ran to prepare for the warpath.
-
-Singing Fire and Many Painted Ponies returned to check their weapons and
-when preparations were completed returned to where the chief sat astride
-a great white horse. When everyone had assembled, the party left camp in
-search of the invading Comanches. For several days the party searched
-but no sign was found other than the old fire, that anyone had been in
-the vicinity. At last the chief turned to his men and said, “They have
-seen our strength and afraid have returned to their own land. They
-respect the might and fighting ability of the Apaches. Come, we will
-return to our village.”
-
-The party started for home, but as Singing Fire and Many Painted Ponies
-rode along, Singing Fire was quiet.
-
-“What is it, my friend, Singing Fire? You are so quiet.”
-
-“I was just thinking, my friend, that the Comanches are not known as
-cowards; they surely would not turn from a fight. I do not believe they
-have left our land.”
-
-“But, Singing Fire, for three days we have searched the land and no sign
-do we see of the Comanches. Certainly the earth did not open and swallow
-them up.”
-
-“That is just the point, my friend. What has happened to the party? The
-brave reported seeing them and took us to where they had their fire. The
-tracks led away but suddenly stopped, and we have seen nothing to
-indicate that they returned to their own lands across the great river. I
-just am not satisfied that they have left.”
-
-Nothing more was said for the remainder of the trip back to the village,
-and that evening after supper, Singing Fire went to sleep thinking about
-the hunt for the Comanches.
-
-As he slept, he dreamed there were Comanche warriors mounted upon fast
-horses and they all seemed to be riding toward a solid wall. Singing
-Fire suddenly awoke recalling seeing that wall before.
-
-About a day’s ride from their village was a small valley which they
-called the valley of the snake because it twisted and turned between the
-mountains. As the thundering riders neared the wall, it seemed to open
-up and they had disappeared within. Then the walls closed again and
-there was silence. Singing Fire leaped from his bed and rushed to his
-father’s side.
-
-“My father, I must speak to our chief. It is of great importance that I
-see him now.”
-
-“But it is late, my son, and certainly what you have to say can wait
-until tomorrow.”
-
-“No, father, I must speak to him now.” With that, Singing Fire left his
-tepee and soon was standing before the tepee of the Great Chief. He made
-his presence known and was invited into the tepee.
-
-The chief invited him to sit and then asked, “What brings you to my
-tepee so late, young Singing Fire?”
-
-“Tonight, O Great Chief, in a dream I was drawn to the painted hill
-which stands guard over our village. Here I stood troubled in heart and
-mind because of what has been reported to our tribe.” Then Singing Fire
-proceeded to tell in complete detail of the dream he had had. When he
-finished, he waited for the chief to speak.
-
-“What importance do you attach to this dream you have had, young Singing
-Fire?”
-
-“I do not know, Great Chief, but I would like your permission to take
-Many Painted Ponies and ride to this place I have seen in the dream. I
-would like to see what can be found there and then I will return to my
-village.”
-
-The Indians placed a great deal of faith in dreams, and so the chief
-gave his permission and early the next morning, Many Painted Ponies and
-Singing Fire set out for the valley that Singing Fire had seen not only
-in his dream, but many times on his hunting trips.
-
-They traveled all day, and when the sun was setting in the west, they
-found themselves but a short distance from the entrance to the valley.
-They camped for the night, not lighting a fire, in case there should be
-any unfriendly Indians in the vicinity.
-
-As dawn drew near, the two young men crawled to the mountainous heights
-overlooking the twisting valley. There they lay and watched the valley
-below. For almost an hour they sat until finally about noontime a small
-band of warriors could be seen riding into the valley. They rode
-straight up the middle of the valley twisting and turning as the valley
-turned but finally about midway up the valley they swung sharply to the
-left and seemed to disappear into the very walls surrounding the valley.
-
-“Come,” said Singing Fire, “we must investigate this strange
-occurrence.”
-
-It took them most of the afternoon to reach a vantage point overlooking
-where the warriors had disappeared. Crawling carefully to the very edge,
-the two young braves looked carefully over the edge. Below them lay a
-fantastic sight. A tremendous Comanche encampment was being formed in a
-small box canyon. The entrance to the box canyon was a mere crack in the
-wall which was just about wide enough for one horse and rider to enter
-at one time. Now Singing Fire could see why a rider going through the
-valley would not see the opening for it was actually hidden from view by
-a turn in the trail. If one were not looking for it, one would not find
-it except by accident.
-
-“This is why we have not seen the Comanches except for that one small
-party. Under cover of night or early dawn they have been entering our
-land in small parties, gathering here until their force is large enough
-to make war upon our people.”
-
-Singing Fire tapped his friend upon the shoulder, motioning him away
-from the edge.
-
-“Many Painted Ponies, one of us must ride for all he is worth to reach
-our village and tell of this plan to our people. You must tell the chief
-to gather the Apaches together and we can trap the scheming Comanches in
-their own camp.”
-
-Many Painted Ponies rose to leave. “Be careful, my friend, for if they
-should suspect that you are here your scalp will soon hang from their
-medicine lodge and they will break from their camp fearing the trap we
-will set for them. Now I will ride for our village and may your prayers
-go with me.” With that, Many Painted Ponies left and mounting his pony
-he rode off toward home.
-
-Singing Fire kept careful watch for the next day and night and when dawn
-approached he saw the dust of many horses approaching. Riding forth to
-meet his people, a plan formed in his mind. In council with the chiefs a
-short time later the plan was outlined. The best marksmen of the Apaches
-were placed around the box canyon on the walls overlooking the
-unsuspecting camp of the Comanches. Other warriors would ride into the
-valley to stand guard at the only entrance or exit to the canyon to make
-sure none escaped.
-
-Soon all was in readiness. The signal was given. Like an attacking horde
-of eagles, the Apaches began firing down upon the Comanche encampment.
-The battle was long and bloody. In confusion the Comanches mounted their
-ponies and headed for the exit. Here they were met with a hail of arrows
-which drove them back into the canyon.
-
-When the Comanche forces were thoroughly disorganized, the chief
-signaled the Apaches to charge through the entrance and soon the two
-tribes were locked in hand to hand combat. The victory was complete and
-soon the last of the Comanches had fallen before the knives and war
-clubs of the attacking Apaches.
-
-In triumph the tribe returned to the village where great celebrations
-marked the next few days and nights. The hero of the affair was praised
-before the council, and Singing Fire was honored for his part in the
-great victory.
-
-
-
-
- 2. HUNTING AND FISHING
-
-
-
-
- GREY CALF LEARNS TO HUNT BUFFALO
-
-
-Grey Calf opened his eyes to greet the warmth of the early spring day.
-There was a great deal of excitement in his Crow village as he rolled
-out from under his buffalo robe. At just that moment, his father entered
-the tepee.
-
-“Come, my son,” he said. “We must dress and eat right away. The village
-is broken down, for we are going to move again. Your mother is waiting
-to take down our tepee. Come, you must prepare to help load the
-travois.”
-
-Grey Calf learned as a very young Crow that whenever his tribe had to
-move to follow the buffalo herds, the whole village was packed and
-loaded upon travois drawn by the horse or horses of each family.
-Everything the family owned was made to be carried easily in rawhide
-containers that could be folded and put away when the family had settled
-in a new place. Furniture was made so that it could be folded, too.
-
-Many times, Grey Calf had watched his mother make the travois. She would
-take two of the tepee poles and fasten them together with a rawhide
-thong, just a short way from one end. Then she would pull the poles
-apart at the opposite end and set them, at the point where they were
-crossed and tied, upon the shoulders of their horse. The longer ends of
-the crossed poles would stretch outward and rest on the ground behind
-their horse on each side. Then she would run a long strip of rawhide
-through the knot that joined the poles over the horse’s shoulders, and
-tie it around the horse’s chest like a light harness. Finally, she would
-stretch and tie strips of rawhide across the poles behind the horse, to
-make a frame on which their family goods were loaded.
-
-Grey Calf’s father had told him once that many years ago, before the
-white man had brought horses to the Indians’ land, the travois had been
-fastened to their strong dogs. But the dogs were not so strong as
-horses, so the loads had to be much smaller and lighter. Even their
-tepees were smaller in those days because larger ones would have weighed
-too much for any one dog to pull on the travois.
-
-These thoughts passed rapidly through Grey Calf’s mind as he listened to
-his father. Then he yawned and asked, “Must we move so soon again,
-father? It seems such a short while ago that our tribe set up its
-village here.”
-
-“My son, the buffalo are on the move,” his father answered patiently.
-“You know that we would not have our tepees, our best food and clothing,
-and little of anything else without the great buffalo. When they decide
-to move, we must move with them. The scouts who have been watching the
-herd tell us that it has started to leave for new feeding grounds.”
-
-Without another word, Grey Calf got up quickly and began helping his
-mother gather their belongings. He helped her take down the tepee. Then
-she built the travois rapidly, and he helped her pack and load their
-belongings onto it.
-
-Soon, where once a proud village had stood, hardly anything was left
-standing. The men set out ahead on their horses, followed by the women
-and children on horses, the smaller children sometimes riding on the
-travois, their mothers and the older children riding astride the horses’
-backs. Grey Calf, like many other of the older boys, was riding his own
-pony near his mother.
-
-The scouts were far ahead of them, keeping close touch with the
-wandering buffalo herd, and signaling the tribe to tell the braves which
-way to lead their families. The scouts were also watching carefully for
-roving bands of the Crows’ enemies, for they were near Cheyenne
-territory, but they saw none.
-
-Just as Grey Calf was ready to ask his mother if the buffalo herd would
-never stop roaming, a scout raced his horse back to tell the braves that
-the herd was circling around, ready to settle down near fresh water and
-food. The Chief gave the signal, and all the families went to work
-busily setting up their tepees. Before too long, smoke was rising lazily
-from the fires which circled their new village. The trek had taken most
-of the day, and the women were beginning to cook the evening meal.
-
-The braves were watering their thirsty horses, and then would put them
-out to graze. Grey Calf did all he could to help his mother get their
-meal ready quickly because he was very hungry. When all the small chores
-had been completed, the families gathered at their tepees, to eat the
-food that smelled so good to all the children.
-
-It wasn’t long after Grey Calf had eaten that he began to feel drowsy.
-Saying goodnight to his father and mother, he went into the tepee,
-rolled himself in his warm buffalo robe (because the prairie night would
-be cool), and was soon sound asleep.
-
-The next day dawned as one of great excitement, for word came to the
-tepee of Grey Calf that today One Horn, the great buffalo hunter, was
-going to take the young braves on their first buffalo hunt.
-
-Like other Crow boys, Grey Calf had spent many days preparing patiently
-for this great event. His father had taught him how to ride his pony and
-to shoot the bow and arrow. He had learned how to ride into a herd and
-to shoot from beneath his pony’s neck. And now that great day was here.
-One Horn, the greatest of buffalo hunters in the tribe, would give the
-young braves their last lesson before taking them out onto the prairie
-for the actual hunt.
-
-When the young braves had gathered, One Horn stepped to the center of
-the circle and gave his final instructions, warning them not to be too
-eager but to take their time and make sure of their shot. And above all,
-he warned them, as soon as they had made their shot they must swerve
-away from the herd. In this way they would be out of danger if the herd
-should spread out to avoid trampling its fallen members.
-
-When One Horn finished, he asked if there were any questions. The young
-braves had none. So One Horn told them that the time of the hunt would
-be midafternoon. The boys were told to return to their tepees and get
-everything ready.
-
-Grey Calf sped back to his tepee to tell his family breathlessly all
-that had happened. For the rest of the morning he worked carefully over
-each of his arrows and his strong bow. In fact, he was so busy that his
-mother had to call him three times before he came to lunch.
-
-The sun seemed to move very slowly for all the Crow boys. But soon a
-young brave on a frisky pony rode swiftly through the village to tell
-them to gather for the hunt.
-
-Grey Calf leaped upon his pony’s back and sped to the edge of the
-village where the other young braves were gathering. When all had
-gathered and were seated on the ground, One Horn spoke.
-
-“A small group of buffalo has wandered away from the main herd,” he
-said. “It is from this small group that we shall choose our targets. I
-will inspect each young brave’s weapons in turn. When all are
-satisfactory, we shall move out in the direction of the small herd. Do
-not ride hard but move your pony slowly. Buffalo will not go far in this
-heat. We shall have plenty of time to come near them, take our positions
-quietly, and then attack together without warning.”
-
-When One Horn had finished examining each young brave’s weapons, the
-small band moved out in single file. Soon they sighted the buffalo. One
-Horn gave hand signals to the young braves to spread out and take their
-positions silently, but above all to wait for the signal from One Horn
-to attack.
-
-As slowly and quietly as possible, each young brave moved into position.
-All eyes were on One Horn, and suddenly he gave the signal. The air was
-torn apart as wild yelps leaped from the throats of the eager young
-hunters. The buffalo were startled and began running about wildly. The
-boys dug their heels into their ponies’ sides and headed into the group
-of buffalo. Soon the dust clouds were so heavy that one could not tell
-the hunters from the hunted, but the young braves rode swiftly, each
-hunter picking out his buffalo carefully and with an eye to size. This
-was to be the first of many buffalo kills, and each young brave hoped
-that his would be the largest of the beasts brought down.
-
-Buffalo after buffalo began to stumble and fall before the accurate
-shooting of the young hunters. The ponies were magnificent in their
-performance, for each had been carefully trained for this day.
-
-As quickly as the hunt had started it was over. One by one the young
-braves returned to One Horn who had seen their great success. Soon they
-were once again at their starting point. They knew that the remaining
-buffalo would tire and, knowing they were no longer being chased, would
-begin to mill and settle down once again.
-
-One Horn gazed proudly upon the field of battle. Twelve plump shaggy
-beasts lay dead upon the prairie. Every brave had made his kill. There
-would be much rejoicing in the village that evening. One Horn told the
-young braves how to prepare their kills for the return to the village,
-and they went to work immediately. Their adventure this afternoon would
-mean much food for the tribe and new clothing for the coming winter and
-horns and tails to decorate their costumes and tepees.
-
-As One Horn rode from dead buffalo to dead buffalo, watching the young
-braves at work, he was quick to praise each lad for his part in the hunt
-that day. Soon all had completed their tasks and a triumphant band
-returned to the village.
-
-That evening each young brave in turn told how he had made his kill and
-there was a great deal of celebrating. The honor of the biggest kill
-went to Grey Calf. As the last of the families were going into their
-tepees for the evening, Grey Calf’s father came to sit by his side.
-
-“My son, your father is proud. Not only has my son killed his first
-buffalo but it was by far the largest of the beasts killed today. Today
-you had success and triumph, but life will not always be that simple.
-The trail ahead is hard. There will be many difficult times, but if you
-learn your lessons well you shall one day be a great and respected
-warrior of the tribe.”
-
-When Grey Calf’s father had finished speaking, he looked down upon his
-son and smiled. The tired young brave had fallen asleep.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE FOX AND THE GOLDEN EAGLE
-
-
-Little Fox, a member of the Apache Tribe, was a shy Indian lad who was
-rather small. When he was born he was a very tiny baby and his face was
-thin and pointed like that of a fox. For this reason he was given the
-name of Little Fox.
-
-As Little Fox grew older, he dreamed of the day he would be able to wear
-the feathers of the Great Golden Eagle, the most respected bird of the
-American Indian. It was believed that there was great power in the
-thirteen tail feathers and in the pinion feathers on the wings of the
-Great Golden Eagle.
-
-One day Little Fox was seated in his mother’s wickiup, when his father
-entered. Without a word Little Fox’s father went to a case made of
-deerskin and carefully removed the cover. Then with great care he
-removed from the case a most beautiful feather bonnet, at which Little
-Fox gazed with great longing. His father, Swift Deer, was an honored
-brave in the tribe and had become privileged to wear the bonnet of eagle
-feathers for his many brave deeds and the telling of these deeds before
-the Council of Chiefs. Swift Deer had been granted the right to place
-additional eagle feathers in his headdress. Suddenly, Swift Deer turned
-to Little Fox, and said, “Why do you look so sad, my son?”
-
-Little Fox turned slowly to his father and said, “It is because I,
-Little Fox, have not been able to do anything that the Council would
-recognize as a deed worthy of the wearing of the feathers of the Great
-Golden Eagle.”
-
-“Little Fox,” said his father, “you seek too hard for a deed to compete
-for this honor. Tell me, do you have any eagle feathers that you could
-wear, in case you should do a deed which would be considered worthy?”
-
-“No, my father,” said Little Fox, “but by the rising of the next new
-moon, I shall have many eagle feathers, for tomorrow I start in search
-of the Great Golden Eagle. It has been told by Great Moose that beyond
-the three hills many Golden Eagles have been seen.”
-
-Swift Deer was proud. He knew that though his son was small he had in
-his breast a brave heart, for to go in search of the Great Golden Eagle
-took a great deal of courage. Once again Swift Deer took his son aside
-and told him the many dangers of eagle hunting, but praised him for his
-bravery in going to get the tail feathers of the Great Golden Eagle.
-
-The following morning, Little Fox took some food. Then taking a long
-strong thong of deerskin, he looped it several times around his waist
-and tied the food pouch to it. Strapping a knife also to the thong, he
-started for the place where the Great Golden Eagles had been seen.
-
-On the way he stopped just long enough to snare a plump young rabbit
-which he would use for bait. When he reached the place where the eagles
-were to be found, he started digging a deep hole, large enough for him
-to stand in. Then he placed branches over the hole to hide it, with a
-small space for him to reach through and grasp the tail feathers of the
-eagle. To the top of this cover he tied the plump young rabbit with a
-piece of thong. After all was in readiness, Little Fox lifted the edge
-of his cover and slid into the hole, resting his foot on a thick root
-which stuck out of the earth into the hole. Placing his back against the
-side of the hole, he waited patiently for the Golden Eagle.
-
-An hour passed and then two and three, and Little Fox began to feel his
-muscles tighten up and his body start to grow stiff. He began to feel
-impatient. Suddenly, he heard the rabbit begin to move about uneasily,
-then tug in panic against the thong that held him. Surely the Golden
-Eagle must be close by. Little Fox felt relaxed; the stiffness in his
-body was gone. Now excitement rushed into his body as he waited for the
-Golden Eagle to come to rest on the top of his hiding place.
-
-All at once, Little Fox felt the ground tremble and he heard what
-sounded like the low rumble of a waterfall. Then he knew that what he
-had heard was the low growl of a bear. He peered through a crack in the
-cover over the hole and saw the bear’s towering form. Fear gripped the
-heart of Little Fox. Many were the stories he had heard of Indians who
-had lost their lives while hunting for the prized feathers of the Golden
-Eagle.
-
-The bear, with the swiftness of a fleeting arrow, made one sweep with
-his huge paw and the rabbit went sprawling. The bear paused as though he
-were thinking about the problem before him. Here was one of his enemies
-trapped beneath his feet. How would he reach his enemy? With an angry
-growl he ripped at the boughs which covered the hiding place of Little
-Fox until he had uncovered the top of the hole.
-
-Holding his breath and his heart beating wildly, Little Fox crouched far
-down in the hole and waited for the final moment when he, instead of the
-Golden Eagle, would fall victim in his own trap. The bear lunged but
-missed his mark. Little Fox suddenly realized that the top of the hole
-was too small for the bear to get his paw and his head in at the same
-time. Again and again the bear lunged, but without success. The more he
-lunged and failed, the angrier he became. He thrust first his paw and
-then his head into the hole; but Little Fox, by pressing down against
-the bottom of the hole, was able to keep just out of reach of the
-flailing paws and gnashing teeth. All of a sudden, the bear pulled back
-away from the hole as if to consider his next move. In this instant,
-Little Fox thought of a way that might save his life. He quickly untied
-the long leather thong around his waist, made a loop of it, and as
-slowly and quietly as possible placed the loop just below the opening,
-holding it in place all around by pressing the thong into the earth.
-Little Fox tied the other end to the root on which he had been standing.
-
-Now the bear was returning. Little Fox waited, holding tight to the
-leather thong. As the bear placed his head in the hole and so into the
-loop, Little Fox pulled hard on the thong, which immediately came loose
-from the earth and tightened around the throat of the bear.
-
-In angry surprise, the bear pulled back from the hole only to be stopped
-short as the thong drew tight. Then he began a series of noises which
-Little Fox remembered for many moons. The bear’s growls gradually grew
-to roars, and then turned to cries of pain. The harder the bear pulled,
-the tighter the thong gripped his throat, until the cries became coughs
-and gasps. Then all was quiet. The bear’s thrashing around had ceased,
-but still Little Fox waited.
-
-Little Fox slowly raised himself until he could see just over the edge.
-There, not two feet from the hole, lay a huge bear, quite still and
-dead. Little Fox quickly pulled himself from the hole and started at a
-run for the village.
-
-He reached the village and, not stopping to answer any questions, ran
-straight to his father’s wickiup. He began telling his story, still
-panting and talking so fast that his father made him stop to get his
-breath and then speak slowly. When Little Fox had finished, Swift Deer
-gathered some of the other warriors and went to the place where this
-adventure had taken place. With great pride, Swift Deer helped to skin
-the bear and bring it back to the village. Not long after, Little Fox
-stood in the Council meeting before the elders of the tribe and
-recounted his tale of courage. And when all his words had been heard,
-the Council voted that Little Fox should wear in his headband not one,
-but two of the most treasured tail feathers of the Great Golden Eagle.
-
-
-
-
- HOW LONG MOOSE BECAME A BRAVE
-
-
-The Powhatan Indians were a great tribe whose hard work each year was
-rewarded with large supplies of food and clothing.
-
-Long Moose was growing up among his people happily, doing his share of
-the tribe’s work. He had become very tall and awkward. He had great
-strength, too, which he hadn’t learned yet to use well. During games and
-contests, Long Moose often forgot how strong he was and, not meaning to,
-would hurt his friends, sometimes rather badly.
-
-Long Moose was still trying over and over to learn how to make hunting
-tools when winter came. It was a bitter, cold, northern winter. Both his
-mother and father became very sick and died after only a few days,
-leaving his younger sister and himself alone without near relatives to
-help them.
-
-Because Long Moose was not a skillful young brave, his sister had little
-respect for him. He spent many days thinking sadly about his parents,
-but doing nothing to get food and keep their shelter tight against the
-wind and snow. Soon their small supply of food and fuel was nearly gone,
-and Long Moose had brought no hides for making clothes or repairing
-their home. He had also failed to give his share of food and hides for
-all the tribe, as every warrior was expected to do. Not only his sister
-but all the tribe began to feel that Little Moose was not a good
-Powhatan.
-
-His sister’s harsh looks at him and his own growing hunger and cold made
-Long Moose think about how and why he was not a good brother or a good
-brave. He had to admit to himself that there was only one real reason
-besides his poor hunting tools and bad marksmanship: he did not want to
-hunt or make good hunting tools because he did not want to kill any
-animals.
-
-He thought about how often he had gone out to hunt and even when,
-without looking for them, he had run across deer near by, he would still
-come back without having shot a single arrow. Long Moose knew that he
-loved all wild animals as much as he had loved his parents, and loved
-his sister and his friends now.
-
-Driven by his hunger, the cold, his shame, and his real love for his
-sister, Long Moose set out several times to hunt. Each time he made a
-kill, but he was nearly as sad when he had done so as he had been when
-his parents died. To add to his sorrow, his sister would scold him for
-his poor skill, and taunt him by saying that he would never grow to be a
-real brave.
-
-All the tribe could see that Long Moose and his sister were hungry most
-of the time. Their clothes were shabby and their home now was beyond
-repair.
-
-One day in early spring, Long Moose went down to the edge of the lake to
-be away from the unkind glances of his sister and his friends—and to
-think. As he sat on a cold rock, staring out at the ice on the lake, an
-old man of the tribe came up and stood quietly beside him, waiting for
-Long Moose to speak.
-
-“Nantesi, my friend,” Long Moose said, wondering if he still were his
-friend, “what brings you here to me?”
-
-“My friend, Long Moose, for nearly two moons now there has been hunger
-in your home. Your clothes are worn out, and your sister is afraid to
-leave your home, because she is ashamed of her clothes. She has told
-some of the women that you are afraid to hunt the wild game because of
-the bear that lurks in the woods. Some of the other families have given
-her food and skins from time to time. But they can give her no more. The
-next winter may be hard again and each family will need every bit of its
-food and skins. You must not fear the bear. Your arms are strong, your
-legs are swift, and surely you have the strength of three men. You
-should be able to bring back more than is needed in your own home. Will
-you continue to lose the respect of your tribe, or will you become a man
-and take your place with the other braves of the tribe?”
-
-Long Moose thought carefully about each word the old brave had spoken.
-
-“Nantesi,” he said after a long silence, “let them think what they will.
-I do not fear the wagging tongues of my neighbors, and I do not fear the
-great bear of the forest. There is a good reason why I do not bring more
-home for my sister and myself with some left over for the tribe. Never
-have I feared the creatures of the forest. Instead, I have loved them
-much as I love my own people. That is why, when on the hunt, my arrows
-do not bring death. I cannot shoot these creatures who live so happily
-among the trees and streams. Is it wrong to love these creatures so
-much? Nantesi, do you not know the feeling I have when a deer licks my
-hand, or a rabbit plays at my feet while I rest in the shade of a great
-oak tree? These things have happened to me. The wild creatures trust me
-and come right to my hand. I cannot bring death upon those who trust
-me.”
-
-Nantesi said nothing. He understood now the feelings within this strange
-young man. He rose to leave.
-
-“Wait, Nantesi, my friend. My heart is heavy. What can I do? I know that
-what I believe is wrong in the eyes of many, for ours is a tribe of
-great hunters. What am I do? I must live among my people, but I cannot
-be happy unless I live my life the way I honestly believe I should.”
-
-“Long Moose, I am an old man. Some of our tribe think I am wise. But
-this time they might not believe that what I say is wise. Go into the
-hills with your troubled thoughts. Think calmly in the quiet woods, far
-away from us. Only in this way can your heart give you the true answer
-that all of nature has been given to man that he may give food and
-shelter to those he loves and to himself.” Then Nantesi left as quickly
-as he had come.
-
-The following morning, many in the tribe watched the lonely figure of
-Long Moose leaving the village, as he headed toward the distant hills.
-At last, after three weeks had passed, all eyes were turned toward the
-far end of the village. Entering the camp, a fine buck upon his
-shoulders, was Long Moose standing taller than ever before. His clothes
-were tattered and torn, but there was a proud smile on his face.
-
-Going straight to his sister’s house, Long Moose set the fat buck at his
-sister’s feet without a word. Smiling, he put one hand on her shoulder
-as she stared at him in surprise. Many of the villagers crowded around
-asking questions, but Long Moose said nothing and looked over their
-heads for Nantesi. Then he saw the old man sitting contentedly before
-his home, looking kindly in his direction. Walking over to where the old
-brave sat, Long Moose asked if he could talk with him. Nantesi rose
-slowly, and greeting Long Moose warmly, invited the young man into his
-home. When both were seated, Nantesi, as before, waited for Long Moose
-to speak.
-
-“Nantesi, my friend, for a long time I have been away from my tribe. As
-you said would happen, my mind is no longer troubled. Up in the hills I
-made a campsite for myself. I lived on nuts and berries and plants and
-the cool water of the mountain streams. Each night I wrapped myself in
-my blanket and slept a troubled sleep.
-
-“But three nights ago, when I had finished my evening prayer, I rolled
-myself in my blanket and rested my head upon a soft bed of pine needles.
-Sleep came suddenly, and for the first time in three weeks I slept
-peacefully until the moon had risen high in the sky. I awoke with a
-start knowing I had the answer that you had said I would find in the
-forest.
-
-“Suddenly, I knew that I had watched the very creatures that I love
-struggle with each other for life here in the forests and in the fields
-and the streams. I had never thought that this was wrong. Right at this
-very moment, the struggle for life is going on in many parts of the
-forest. Before the sun brings the dawn of a new day, many of our forest
-creatures will have died because others must live. The strongest or the
-wisest live. Now I knew what I had hidden from myself that if some wild
-creatures did not die to provide food for others, many of the same
-animals that I love so much would die. I knew that I should not kill
-just for the sake of killing. The animals themselves kill only when they
-are hungry or their lives are in danger. I, too, could follow their
-example and be a good brave.
-
-“The truth had come to me from life itself. I sat up and gazed into the
-fire trying to decide whether I had been dreaming. Suddenly my heart was
-happy once again. I went back to sleep and in the morning started my
-trip back to the village. Halfway here I came upon a buck. My aim was
-good. I have brought fresh meat for my sister to cook and store away,
-and a hide for her to make into a new dress. I shall go out again
-tomorrow and bring back my share for the tribe.
-
-“I have found the answer I had been searching for. Now I can return to
-my tribe with pride. That is my story, Nantesi, and I wanted to tell you
-first about it. It is good to be back. It is good to be a Powhatan.”
-
-Nantesi smiled across at his young friend. “It is good to have you back.
-Welcome, brave!”
-
-
-
-
- HOW A FISHING TRIP TAUGHT LOYALTY TO A BOY
-
-
-It was a bright morning in the village of the Iroquois. Maseca, the
-little Indian brave, awoke to the sound of the birds of the woodland.
-Today Maseca and Chincho were going fishing and that was always a great
-adventure, for they never knew exactly what would happen as they strode
-through the forest or out along the wild streams.
-
-Maseca gathered up his fishing gear and he carefully went over it all to
-see that it was in good shape. Then he sat down to eat some food his
-mother had prepared for him. But he was impatient to get under way. So
-he arose and, stuffing some dry deer meat into his pouch, started off in
-search of Chincho.
-
-Because Chincho was a little older than the other children with whom he
-and Maseca played, he would sometimes be the bully in the group. But
-only on rare occasions did he bully Maseca. Such an occasion occurred
-when he boasted to everyone that he could beat Maseca in a foot race.
-Maseca had accepted the challenge and had beaten the older boy quite
-badly. Since then, even though Chincho and Maseca had been close
-friends, Chincho would let jealousy get the best of him and thought of
-ways to teach Maseca a lesson for having beaten him in a foot race.
-
-Sometimes Chincho even found himself wishing that Maseca would break his
-leg or suffer some other injury which would make him a cripple. But
-whenever these thoughts entered his mind, Chincho would drive them out,
-and dream about the many wonderful times he and Maseca had had together,
-wandering through the forests and fishing in the streams.
-
-On this bright morning Chincho bolted the last of his breakfast as he
-heard the hurrying footsteps of Maseca approaching his father’s wigwam.
-Placing his deer meat in a leather pouch which his mother had made for
-him and gathering up his fishing gear, Chincho quickly left the wigwam
-to join Maseca and together they swiftly trotted off through the forest.
-They wanted to be the first ones to the stream and get the best spots
-for fishing. They did not speak as they trotted, for they knew that that
-would only shorten their wind and their speed, and that the other boys
-of the village might get there before them. Finally, they reached the
-stream and settled down to catch the lazy fish that swam unaware of the
-presence of the two boys.
-
-Early in the afternoon, having caught several good-sized fish, they
-decided to hang their catch in a tree and do a little exploring
-upstream. So they started out in a direction they had never gone before,
-remembering the warnings of the elders to walk softly and not too far
-from familiar ground, because one could get lost very easily in the
-green forest. This was especially true in the summer when the leaves
-often hid landmarks that would be easy to remember.
-
-As they traveled farther and farther upstream, gazing at all the
-beauties of nature around them, Chincho suddenly stopped and threw
-himself flat on the ground behind a big birch tree. Maseca, not knowing
-the reason, but realizing that Chincho was not playing a game, did the
-same thing. Maseca started to speak but Chincho motioned for him to
-remain silent. Then Chincho pointed up ahead. About a hundred paces
-ahead standing in a little clearing taking a drink from the stream was a
-tremendous buck deer. Maseca had never seen so large a deer and he could
-not help gasping in surprise. Chincho turned and frowned at him and
-Maseca quickly stifled all other exclamations. Then Chincho crawled
-close to Maseca.
-
-“Maseca,” he whispered, “do you think we could get near enough to that
-deer to kill him? Wouldn’t it be wonderful to bring that buck back to
-the village?”
-
-Maseca nodded that he thought it a wonderful idea and they agreed
-quickly that they would try to take the big deer as a prize. After
-making sure that the wind was blowing toward them, carrying their scent
-away from the deer, they began to move quietly and slowly on their
-stomachs toward the unsuspecting deer. Chincho rose to his knees and,
-fitting a new arrow to his bow, stopped some thirty paces short of the
-deer, drew back on the bowstring, and let the arrow fly. The boys heard
-the arrow whistle as it flew and the thud as it struck its target. But
-Chincho’s aim had not been accurate. The deer bounded away, the arrow
-sticking in his side but not in a vital place.
-
-Chincho knew that he must obey the law of his tribe regarding any animal
-a brave has wounded. He must track the wounded deer until he either came
-upon him dead or could get close enough to make the kill. Long ago the
-tribe had ruled wisely that it was cruel to let a wounded animal wander
-the forest in pain, possibly suffering so much that it would injure
-other animals, and possibly dying from loss of blood or from a sickness
-from the wound. Chincho was tempted not to follow the deer into the
-unknown woods, when he felt Maseca’s gaze upon him.
-
-“Chincho, you do not plan to leave without finding the wounded deer. It
-is the law of our tribe.”
-
-Chincho looked guilty and said, “It is not a bad wound. The arrow barely
-scratched him. He will be all right. Come, let us return to the village
-before it is dark.”
-
-“No,” Maseca insisted, “we must follow the deer until we bring him down.
-You must not leave a wounded animal to suffer. It is the law.”
-
-Chincho knew that Maseca was right, and yet in his heart he was afraid.
-So he tried to excuse his cowardice by saying, “But it is also the law
-of our tribe that we shall not wander too far from the familiar parts of
-our land. We could become lost here in the green forest. We should turn
-back.” As he started to turn, Chincho saw a challenging look in Maseca’s
-eyes and he waited as Maseca spoke.
-
-“You may return to the village claiming that the law says one should not
-wander too far, but I will follow the deer and make sure of his death. I
-will mark my trail plainly so that by night or by day I can follow it
-back to my starting place. Go, Chincho. Return to your father’s home and
-see if you can sleep peacefully when you think of the deer you have
-wounded.”
-
-Even while he was speaking, Maseca realized that his friend’s fear was
-very great, and that it would be a mistake to force Chincho to follow
-the buck. Maseca would have to worry as much about calming Chincho’s
-fear as he would have to worry about finding the way back for both of
-them.
-
-Chincho thought that Maseca would laugh at him and insisted now on going
-with Maseca to trail the deer. So they started to follow the drops of
-blood they found on the plants as they went through the forest. Maseca
-broke branches and cut slices of bark from the sides of trees to mark
-the path they were taking.
-
-For awhile the big buck had run straight ahead as fast as he could in
-spite of the wound. Then the crushed grass showed where he had lain down
-to rest for a moment. But the grass was rising up straight again, which
-told the boys that the deer had not rested long, sensing the danger
-close by. Soon they saw fewer blood spots, and they knew that the blood
-was starting to clot. Now, Maseca knew the deer could live for some time
-yet.
-
-“It grows late,” he warned Chincho. “We must hurry if we are to catch up
-with the deer and claim our kill. We have only a short while left before
-the sun will sink.”
-
-Just at that moment Chincho saw something off to the side of the trail,
-lying half-hidden in the brush. It was brown. As Chincho looked more
-closely, he saw it moving rhythmically as an animal does in breathing.
-He touched Maseca lightly on the shoulder and pointed toward the brush.
-They both realized that this must be the wounded buck. Just as they were
-trying to decide what to do, the deer made up their minds for them. With
-a bellow, he leaped from his hiding place and headed straight for
-Chincho. Chincho stood rooted to the spot with fright. His eyes bulged
-as he saw the huge beast, his antlers held low in attack, bearing down
-upon him. Maseca raised his bow, and with all the courage and calmness
-he could muster, drew back and let go the string. As his arrow whished
-straight toward the onrushing buck, Maseca knew that his aim had been
-straight. As the arrow struck, the deer leaped into the air toward
-Chincho. The buck’s action was so quick that Chincho failed to move in
-time. As it fell, one of its antlers cut deeply into Chincho’s leg. The
-boy gasped in pain and slumped to the ground, next to the dead buck.
-
-Maseca ran quickly to his side and held his head in his arms. Then he
-looked down at the nasty wound in Chincho’s leg and saw the blood
-pouring out. Hurriedly, he gathered some large leaves, wet them in a
-nearby stream, and placed them against the wound. Then he pulled a
-leather thong from his leggings and used it to bind the leaves in place.
-When he saw that the wound had nearly stopped bleeding, he spoke quietly
-to Chincho.
-
-“I must go for help, Chincho. You must lie still and quiet until I
-return.” With that Maseca pulled up all the strength that was left in
-his tired body and started running at top speed along the trail he had
-marked.
-
-As the sun sank behind the hills of the quiet valley, Chincho prayed
-that Maseca would hurry. The pain was getting worse and, though the
-blood had stopped flowing from the wound, Chincho was beginning to lose
-strength. Suddenly, from down the trail, the boy heard the voices of
-many braves. Then he heard his father shouting his name.
-
-“Over here! Over here!” Chincho called weakly. His father ran to him and
-knelt at his son’s side. Soon Chincho was surrounded by many of the
-older braves who looked first at him and then at the dead buck. He
-searched among the faces for that of his friend.
-
-“Where is Maseca?” he asked his father.
-
-“Back in the village resting, my son,” his father said softly. “You see,
-Maseca ran so fast through the forest to seek help for you that he
-caught his foot in a root and twisted his leg badly. He wouldn’t stop
-even though he was barely able to hobble into camp. He had just enough
-strength left to tell us where you were before he fainted.”
-
-Chincho began to feel very guilty about the many times he had hoped that
-Maseca would be injured some day just because Maseca had beaten him in
-the foot race.
-
-“He will be well again soon, won’t he, father? He will be able to run as
-fast as before?” His father smiled down at Chincho.
-
-“Is that what you want, my son?” he asked.
-
-“Oh, yes, father. He must be well again. Because he won the foot race
-fairly, I have often wished that he would be hurt. Now that it has
-really happened, I am sorry. I will never wish harm for any friend
-again. Only then will I be a true son to my father and a true Iroquois
-brave.”
-
-While Chincho and his father were talking, the other braves cut two
-saplings and tied branches across them to make a stretcher to carry the
-boy. Chincho’s father held his son’s hand as the other braves lifted the
-boy onto the stretcher.
-
-“You have spoken wisely, my son. Do not worry. Maseca will soon be well
-enough to race and hunt and fish again with you.”
-
-Chincho smiled up at his father and turned his head to look proudly at
-the large buck that two braves were carrying, hung by its feet from a
-sapling stretched across their shoulders.
-
-The next night there was a special council fire. Two young braves were
-lying on stretchers, side by side, at the place of honor. At their
-sides, stood their fathers. Then the Chief told the tribe about the
-bravery and hunting skill and strength of these two boys. “They will be
-great braves, worthy of the Iroquois nation,” he said solemnly.
-
-Chincho’s and Maseca’s fathers glanced proudly down at their sons.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE BEAR’S FIRST HUNT
-
-
-Little Bear opened his eyes and looked around his wickiup home. As the
-sleep left his eyes, he noticed that his father’s bed was empty and that
-he was alone. Quickly he threw off his buffalo robe and ran to the door
-of the wickiup. Pushing aside the deerskin he looked out into the small
-Apache camp.
-
-There was quite a bit of activity. Everyone was hurrying about. Although
-it was still very early, the cooking fires were burning brightly, and
-the women of the tribe were busy preparing a hot meal. Then he
-remembered that today was the day of the big hunt.
-
-Little Bear ran quickly through the village searching for his father,
-Swift Eagle. Finally after asking several of his friends, he was told
-that his father could probably be found at the corral. Soon he saw his
-father looking over the horses. Swift Eagle was telling young braves
-which horses to select for his use on the hunt.
-
-“Father,” called Little Bear, “why did you not waken me when the dawn
-came? There has been much excitement since the sun first broke through
-the night, but you did not wake me.”
-
-“My son, I wanted you to rest, for today is the day of the big hunt.
-Soon the warriors will be gathering and we will be ready to leave for
-the feeding grounds of the great buffalo. Now I must check the horses,
-for we must take only the young and the strong. This will be a long and
-hard Journey.”
-
-Little Bear suddenly realized that this was to be a real test for him.
-When a young Apache is considered a young brave, he is taken on his
-first big buffalo hunt along with the older warriors of the tribe. He
-must prove himself worthy of being called a hunter. Little Bear had
-waited a long time for this great day. He felt his heart beating a
-little faster than usual and he was filled with excitement and a little
-fear. Little Bear’s fear left when his father placed his hand upon his
-son’s shoulder and said, “Be not afraid, my son, for you were born an
-Apache and Apaches fear nothing. You will make a great hunter, and a
-true Apache.”
-
-Together they walked back to their wickiup where Little Bear’s mother
-had prepared a fine breakfast. When they had all eaten, they heard that
-the hunting party was beginning to form. Soon all was in readiness, and
-the great hunting party rode out from the village. The scouts had
-reported that a rather large herd of buffalo had stopped to graze only
-half a day’s ride from their camp. So it was for this herd that the
-hunting party had made its plans.
-
-As they rode along, Little Bear began to think of how he would make his
-first kill of buffalo, the largest of the wild game hunted by the
-Apaches. Little Bear had hunted before but only for rabbits and other
-small game. This was to be his day of triumph, and he was excited. Soon
-the caravan of hunters halted to rest and replenish their water supply
-from a spring near by. The scouts were sent ahead once again to see if
-the herd had shifted position.
-
-As Swift Eagle and his son sat by the cool spring, Little Bear stared
-toward the horizon hoping to be the first of the party to see the
-returning scouts. His father had been watching him with a kindly eye,
-and said, “Do not be too eager, my son. When excitement grows within the
-body, the hand becomes unsteady. You must control our body and your
-mind, or you will find that your aim will not be true. Your arrow,
-instead of striking its mark, will do nothing but chew up the dust of
-the prairie.”
-
-Little Bear listened quietly to his father; as so many times before, he
-realized the wisdom in his father’s words.
-
-There was little conversation for a while, until the scouts returned to
-report that the herd had not moved and that a short ride would bring the
-party to within striking distance. The hunting party moved on until the
-signal was passed that the herd was just over the next rise.
-Instructions were given and the party quickly spread out into an
-attacking formation, each brave hoping to have the best spot to ride
-down the buffalo herd. As soon as everyone was in position, they waited
-for the next signal of the leader.
-
-Little Bear could feel the excitement mounting in his body and,
-remembering the words of his father, fought off the tenseness that was
-filling his arms and legs. The rise in front of him, which separated the
-hunting party from the herd, seemed to be very far away. Just as Little
-Bear felt he could not control his pony or himself any longer, the
-signal was given. The braves, with shouts rising from their throats,
-raced over the rise. Soon there was a mixture of running, frightened
-buffalo, and riding, yelling warrior hunters, and clouds of dust that
-rose from the hundreds of hoofs churning the prairie.
-
-Little Bear drew an arrow from his quiver. Following the patient
-teaching of his father, he calmly placed the arrow to the bow string.
-Leaning forward on the neck of his pony, holding tight with his knees
-pressed against his pony’s sides, he peered into the dust and quickly
-spotted his quarry. A large bull buffalo was lumbering along a little
-wide of the herd. Carefully taking aim, Little Bear let go his arrow.
-The last thing he saw before the dust welled up again to block his sight
-was his arrow protruding from the side of a stumbling buffalo.
-
-Little Bear swerved his pony rapidly away from the herd. When the pony
-was able to check his forward speed, pony and rider withdrew to the side
-of the battleground to watch the rest of the hunt in safety. As the herd
-disappeared across the prairie, the members of the hunting party turned
-their horses and began the ride back to where the herd had been grazing.
-When the dust had cleared, Little Bear saw scattered across the prairie
-the bodies of many buffalo which had fallen before the accurate shooting
-of the hunters. Each brave would be able to tell his kill, for each
-arrow bore the mark of its owner.
-
-Little Bear galloped toward the spot where he thought his buffalo had
-fallen. While he rode, his heart beat very fast. He tried to show little
-excitement as he drew near to a group of hunters who stood looking down
-at an object upon the ground. As Little Bear drew close, he slowed his
-pony. His father turned and smiled. Dismounting, Little Bear walked to
-his father’s side. Lying on the ground at the feet of the older braves
-was a bull buffalo of tremendous size. And there was the arrow of Little
-Bear exactly where the arrow of a good hunter should be. He had hit the
-buffalo in a vital spot.
-
-Swift Eagle placed his arm across the shoulders of his son. Amid the
-many grunts and exclamations of approval coming from the warrior
-hunters, Little Bear heard the deep calm, proud voice of his father.
-
-“You have done well, my son. This is a fine buffalo, one which we are
-sure will prove to be the largest one killed this day. The many hours
-spent in teaching you were not wasted. This you have proven today. You
-will return to our village a hero and tell of your exploits at the
-council tonight. No longer will you have to stay behind when the hunters
-go in search of food. Today you have become a hunter and earned the
-right to ride with the hunting party. Your father is proud.”
-
-And so the procession, after attending the buffalo and stripping the
-hides and packing the fresh meat for the return trek, headed for home.
-At the front of the party rode Swift Eagle and Little Bear, a proud
-father and an even prouder son. Today the young brave had succeeded in
-his first hunt.
-
-
-
-
- CRYING EAGLE SEES A GREAT BATTLE
-
-
-It was a dark winter evening in the small Iroquois village. The cries of
-the wolf echoed in the forest as Great Eagle, war leader of the
-Iroquois, was preparing for bed. He stopped to take a last look for the
-night at his young son, Crying Eagle, and smiled at his boy who slept so
-peacefully. As he pulled the warm robe up around his son’s neck to keep
-the cold from seeping in and disturbing his sleep, he thought to
-himself,
-
-“How lucky I am to have been blessed with such a son. Truly, he will be
-a leader among his people. Not because he is the son of Great Eagle, war
-chief of the Iroquois, but because he will be tall and strong and brave
-and will learn well the ways of the tribe. Soon he will be ready to be a
-leader and when that day comes, I will be proud to stand forth and say,
-‘This is my son.’”
-
-Great Eagle slept warm and soundly that night and arose with the dawn of
-the next day. Today his son was to go on a trek with him to learn the
-ways of the wild game in winter time.
-
-Great Eagle moved to his son’s bed and called softly to him, “Come, my
-son, for we have a long way to travel and much to do today.”
-
-Crying Eagle got up quickly, put on his warm winter clothes, and sat
-with his father at breakfast. As soon as breakfast was over, they
-gathered their weapons and left the protection of the Iroquois village
-and headed toward the forest. As they walked along the trail, Great
-Eagle pointed out different signs. Here the snow had been scraped by a
-deer nosing for anything green under the snow. There was a squirrel nest
-bulging with its store of winter food. And everywhere there were the
-tracks of many wolves. This had been a hard winter, and the hungry
-wolves were moving in packs to seek out easy prey. Many animals would
-not find enough food to keep them at full strength. Unless one were very
-careful, escape from an attack by these forest marauders would be
-impossible.
-
-Crying Eagle began to get tired and his father motioned toward a small
-glen in the forest off to the side of the trail. There were some fallen
-logs upon which they could sit and have their lunch of jerked venison
-and water. As they sat eating slowly, Great Eagle watched the forest
-around them for any signs of game. But all was quiet except for the
-singing of the few winter birds that lived there, even in the coldest
-weather. Suddenly, they heard the crackling of some dry timber in the
-distance and Great Eagle raised his head.
-
-“A buck leaping through the brush,” he said.
-
-“How can you tell, father?”
-
-“Listen, my son! You will discover that there is a moment of silence
-between each crackling of brush. That tells you that whatever makes the
-noise is leaping, and the heavy crashing of brush tells you that the
-animal is large. Because it leaps, you know it is not a bear. So we can
-be almost sure that it is a buck.”
-
-Just as Great Eagle stopped speaking, they saw a large buck moving in
-long leaps among the brush and small trees. Suddenly, he stopped and
-sniffed the air. Great Eagle and his son stood perfectly still. The buck
-looked directly toward them. The breeze was blowing toward the buck and
-he had caught their scent. Crying Eagle raised his bow but felt his
-father’s hand upon his shoulder.
-
-“No, my son. The buck is truly beautiful. But our wigwam is full of
-venison, and we have enough fine clothes to last for a long time. We do
-not kill the forest animals unless we really need to. Truly, I know how
-much you want to make a kill and tell your friends of the fine buck your
-steady hand brought down, but that must wait for another day. We are
-here to learn the way animals live during the winter, so that when you
-must hunt for your family, you will find it easy.”
-
-The buck seemed to wait for Great Eagle to speak with his son. Then he
-leaped away through the forest. Great Eagle and his son spent the rest
-of the afternoon studying other signs of wild life. As the sun began to
-sink low in the west, Great Eagle turned and started on the trail for
-home. After they had gone a ways, Great Eagle halted and motioned for
-his son to be still. Together the two Indians crouched low and Great
-Eagle pointed through the trees. There, only three hundred paces away in
-a clearing, stood a large buck. Off to the right of the buck stood a
-beautiful brown doe and further on through the trees was another buck,
-moving slowly forward through the trees.
-
-“Why do we stop, father?” asked Crying Eagle, still crouching low in the
-snow.
-
-“Because, son, I believe that we are about to see something very rarely
-seen by humans. The buck in the clearing is standing guard over his
-bride, the doe on our right. The buck coming through the trees is young
-and wants the doe, too. So he is challenging the old buck to a duel. The
-winner will get the doe. In a moment they will face each other in the
-clearing. They will meet head on and the battle will be on. The buck
-that gives up first and turns from the battle will be the loser, and the
-other will claim his bride.”
-
-Soon, as Great Eagle had said, the younger buck entered the clearing.
-The two faced each other, the younger pawing at the ground while the
-older stood surveying this young challenger of his right to the doe, who
-lay watching them calmly from the brush to the side of the clearing.
-Then the two bucks began to circle. They stopped and almost at once the
-young one charged. The older buck met the attack head on and there was a
-loud crash as their antlers met and locked. They pushed and pulled and
-wrenched until suddenly their antlers were free. They were almost
-equally matched, for even though the younger buck seemed faster, the
-older was a veteran of many such battles and knew more tricks in
-fighting.
-
-Again they locked horns but unlocked quickly this time. Then the older
-buck’s antlers slashed into the side of the young buck. Back and forth
-the battle waged and then, as suddenly as it had started, it was over.
-The young buck had had enough. He tossed his head into the air and
-leaped off into the forest, to lick his wounds and wait for another doe.
-The old buck walked with what looked like pride to his doe. She rose to
-her feet and, side by side, they began pushing their noses into the snow
-to smell out food.
-
-“Come,” said Great Eagle, “let us leave them in peace. You have seen one
-of the great events in the life of wild animals. Remember it well for
-you may be called upon to defend the persons and things you love, even
-when you think the enemy is stronger. Remember how strength alone is not
-enough. You must know how to fight well in order to win.”
-
-Crying Eagle was thinking about each word his father had spoken as they
-headed home. They moved rapidly because they wanted to reach the village
-before dark. Soon through the trees they could see the flickering of
-many campfires. In a few moments they were in the camp and at home. A
-hot meal of stew was waiting for them, and father and son ate heartily.
-When they had finished, Crying Eagle spoke to his father.
-
-“My father, you opened my eyes today to many new things. I hope that I
-have learned my lesson well and will always obey your teaching.”
-
-Crying Eagle kept his promise well. Some years later there was trouble
-between his village and the neighboring tribes. While the young bucks
-shouted for blood and the scalps of their neighbors, Crying Eagle called
-for peace and talk. Like his father in battle, he was a brave warrior,
-but where talk around the council fire could save lives, Crying Eagle
-was a great leader and peacemaker.
-
-Crying Eagle lived to a very old age, but he never forgot that walk
-through the winter forest with his father Chief Great Eagle, war chief
-of the mighty Iroquois.
-
-
- Based on a story told to the author by John Fitch, Vermont farmer,
- 1937.
-
-
-
-
- SPOTTED TAIL AND THE GHOST WOLF
-
-
-The Mohawk village of bark houses nestled along the river, and all was
-peace and contentment in the village. Spotted Tail and his family lived
-in peace and contentment in the village, for they were a happy people.
-The hunting and fishing were good and there was little sickness among
-the people of his tribe and all was made so that the people would be
-happy.
-
-When young Spotted Tail had reached his fifteenth summer, something
-happened to his tribe. Suddenly the game of the forest became scarce.
-The deer began to disappear and even the smallest of game was becoming
-hard to find. This concerned the council, for never before had this
-happened to their hunting grounds. And then one day while the warriors
-were busy preparing to go out on the hunt, a young Mohawk warrior
-staggered into the camp. Blood dripped from his body and as he reached
-the center of the village he collapsed.
-
-Eager hands lifted him and carried him to his house and when his wounds
-had been bathed the great chief of the Mohawks came to talk with him.
-
-“What has happened to you, my brother? Surely this is the work of some
-great savage beast that you have encountered in the green forest.”
-
-“O Great Chief, my companion and I had been following the tracks of a
-deer and feeling we were quite lucky to have come upon such a find.
-Suddenly as we trotted along the trail following the deer there was a
-horrible snarling from off to the side of the trail. We stopped and
-looked toward the side of the trail, and there before our very eyes was
-a pack of ferocious-looking wolves. Before we could even draw our
-bowstrings they were upon us. My companion and I fought them, but soon
-they had dragged my companion to the ground. They began to fight among
-themselves over one of their wounded comrades, and it was then that I
-crawled off into the brush and when I saw my chance I ran as fast as I
-could toward our village. I could hear the snarls of the pack behind me
-but I ran as fast as my legs could carry me and soon I heard them no
-more. But one thing I will always remember is the leader of the pack, a
-white wolf of tremendous size. He had a beautiful white coat and was
-much larger than the rest of the pack. I am tired, I must rest now.”
-
-And with that the warrior closed his eyes and slept.
-
-The chief immediately called a council of his warriors and among them
-was Spotted Tail’s father. Now the reason for the lack of game was
-known. The winter further north had been very severe and so the wolf
-pack had come further south seeking food. But now that they had been
-roaming so free for so long they decided to stay.
-
-The chief rose before the council and said:
-
-“We must set out on the hunt immediately, but we must hunt this pack of
-wolves and destroy them before they cause all the deer to disappear. If
-we fail, our smoke racks will become empty and our people will starve.”
-
-So party after party of warriors were sent out in search of the wolf
-pack, but they always returned disappointed; for they had often come
-upon the pack but never had been able to get close enough to do any real
-damage.
-
-Finally Sleeping Water, one of the young warriors, Suggested that
-instead of going in large parties they ought to go out in pairs or three
-at a time and when sighting the pack send word to a larger hunting party
-and they in turn could surround and destroy the pack.
-
-The council approved of this method and so the warriors began to go out
-in pairs. It was now that Spotted Tail began his adventure which was to
-be spoken of in the lodges for many moons to come.
-
-Spotted Tail was chosen by Sleeping Water to go as his companion, and
-the two braves started on the hunt. They ranged far and wide and finally
-picked up the trail of the pack. Sleeping Water knelt by the tracks of
-the wolves and could tell that they were fairly fresh tracks.
-
-Quickly the two braves trotted along the trail in pursuit of the pack
-and soon through the trees ahead Sleeping Water spotted the pack moving
-stealthily through the trees as if stalking an animal. Turning to
-Spotted Tail he said, “Spotted Tail, you will keep the pack in sight and
-follow them as they move, marking your trail. I will return and fetch a
-large hunting party and we shall destroy this pack of wolves. You are
-not afraid to keep watch?”
-
-Spotted Tail felt it a great honor to be asked to do such an important
-job and he told Sleeping Water that he would keep close watch on the
-pack and if he moved he would mark his trail well.
-
-When Sleeping Water departed, Spotted Tail kept close watch on the pack
-as it milled around. Evidently the hunt they were on was ended, for many
-of the wolves were circling in the snow and finding resting places.
-
-It was fast growing dark and Spotted Tail hoped that they would not
-decide to move in the dark or he would surely lose them before the dawn.
-Then he saw him—the giant white leader of the pack—standing off to one
-side of the pack as if on guard. He was truly a majestic animal, fully
-half a foot taller at the shoulder than the other wolves and his coat
-was a shimmering white as pure as the snow.
-
-As night settled, a bright moon came out and the night was shattered by
-the baying of the wolves at the moon.
-
-On a rock pinnacle overlooking the wolves’ bedding ground, the great
-white leader stood guard, his eyes never still, moving from side to side
-as he watched for any approaching danger. Spotted Tail remained awake as
-long as he could, but soon his eyes felt very tired. He was about to
-drop off to sleep when he noticed the pack stirring. He gazed out into
-the shadows of the night and the leader seemed to be staring right
-through the brush and trees into Spotted Tail’s hiding place.
-
-Then Spotted Tail saw the reason for the movement: a deer had wandered
-to within a short distance of the wolves, and now the pack was preparing
-to kill this unsuspecting victim.
-
-The leader seemed to bark instructions and suddenly the pack was up and
-circling the deer. There was a mad rush and suddenly the excitement was
-over, the booty was shared, and the pack settled down once again.
-
-Spotted Tail breathed a sigh of relief, for the pack in chasing the deer
-had come too close for comfort to his hiding place in the thick brush.
-Dawn was fast approaching, and now the pack was on the move once again.
-Spotted Tail followed as close as he dared, making sure that he kept
-downwind from these lean hungry wolves that had caused death and
-starvation to come to his People. Then he got an idea.
-
-If he could get a good shot in and wound or even kill the leader, it
-might have the same effect as if a chief died, the pack would be without
-a leader and might be so disorganized that the hunters from his tribe,
-who he was sure were fast approaching, would be able to make easy work
-of the rest of the pack.
-
-Then the opportunity came his way. There standing off to the side of the
-pack was the large white leader. Spotted Tail settled himself upon one
-knee in the snow and drawing careful aim with his bow, he let fly. The
-arrow seemed to go right through the great beast and he leaped high in
-the air. Spotted Tail was about to shout of his great shot to the
-heavens when he saw that the wolf had come to rest on all fours and was
-turned now in his direction, his teeth bared and a terrible snarl coming
-from deep within his throat.
-
-Gathered behind the great white wolf like an army, was the rest of the
-pack, snarling and waiting for the orders from their leader, but the
-leader seemed to warn them away—this was his kill—and slowly began
-moving toward Spotted Tail.
-
-Spotted Tail stood firm and placed another arrow to his bowstring. He
-fired again, and the arrow again seemed to go straight to its mark but
-still the beast kept moving forward. Now the wolf began to run in a
-steady loping trot toward the Indian and suddenly he was leaping.
-
-Spotted Tail drew his knife, but in mid-air the wolf seemed to stop and
-try to turn and return from whence he had come, and then the body was
-crashing to the ground, an arrow quivering in his side. Then there were
-howls and yells and cries from many points of the forest and arrows came
-flying into the wolf pack. Beast after beast fell under the onslaught of
-deadly shafts being fired by revenge-seeking Mohawk warriors until
-suddenly the whole pack lay dead in the quiet of the winter forest.
-
-It all happened so quickly that before Spotted Tail realized what had
-happened, Sleeping Water was lifting him from the snow smiling.
-
-“You have done well, my young brother, you have been brave this day. You
-left very clear signs for our party to follow and because of that we
-were able to wipe out this pack of beasts which have killed so much
-game.”
-
-“But the leader of the pack—I fired an arrow into him and it went right
-through him. Twice I saw this happen. He must have been a ghost and yet
-I saw his body hit the ground with the arrows of my brothers. How do you
-explain this, Sleeping Water?”
-
-“Come, Spotted Tail, I will show you.” Together they walked to where the
-great beast lay.
-
-“You see, his coat was such a pure white that it blended with the snow
-and when you fired it seemed as though you hit him but actually you
-missed. It is no shame, for it was a long and a difficult shot and when
-you fired a second time as he was moving toward you, the sun on the snow
-caused reflection to make you misjudge your shot.
-
-“We observed all this from our hiding places, for we came upon you just
-as you were preparing to make your first shot. But, please, Spotted
-Tail, do not take a chance like that again. It is very foolish to try
-something so dangerous when you are alone and especially when you knew
-that help was on the way. But this adventure has ended well, and you
-will have much to tell in the medicine lodge tonight, of the great ghost
-wolf that hunted these lands.”
-
-And so the pack was destroyed and soon the game returned once again to
-the hunting ground of the Mohawk and once again all was peaceful and
-happy along the Osage River.
-
-
- This story was told to the author by Jim Nutley of the Canadian Forest
- Ranger Service.
-
-
-
-
- 3. CUSTOMS
-
-
-
-
- THE TRIBES GATHER
-
-
-The Cree were plains Indians. Today their village was full of activity.
-A hunting party had just returned after a very successful hunt. The
-braves were already around the great council fire, telling of their
-exploits. Among these warriors was Slow Tongue, whose bravery and
-courage among the Cree was never questioned.
-
-When all the celebrating was over, Slow Tongue returned to his tepee and
-his family. His young son, Swift Hawk, had waited up for him and, with
-pride in his eyes, he looked up into his father’s face and said, “I am
-very proud to have you for my father.”
-
-“My young son, it is long past your bedtime and you should have closed
-your ears to the night noises of the prairie many hours ago. But I must
-also say that I am proud to have you as a son and tomorrow we shall talk
-and I shall tell you all about the hunt.” Slow Tongue turned to leave
-his son’s side when he heard a noise at the entrance of his tepee.
-
-“Slow Tongue,” a voice called quietly, “it is I, Seeing Bear. Come, I
-must speak with you.”
-
-Slow Tongue left the tepee. “Why do you call me from my tepee so late in
-the night, Sleeping Bear,” he asked. “I am tired and my buffalo robe
-beckons to me to come and wrap myself in its warm folds, for my body
-aches.”
-
-“Look, Slow Tongue! Look to the north! At first I thought the heat of
-the day had made me see things that do not exist. But now I am sure it
-has not. Look and tell me what you see.”
-
-Slow Tongue turned his head to the north and gazed out into the darkness
-of the night. Far in the distance he saw a red glow which disappeared,
-appeared again, and disappeared many times.
-
-“What can it mean, Slow Tongue?”
-
-“It is a message, Seeing Bear. The fire signal tells that the tribes of
-the plains are gathering for the Sun Dance. Truly this is great news.
-Tomorrow we must break camp and leave for the northern meadow of the
-Blue Star, for it is there that the great celebrations will be held. You
-go to the southern part of the village and I will go to the northern
-part, and we will spread the word. It is late and many are asleep, but
-surely this is news for which they will be glad to be awakened.”
-
-The next morning there was great excitement in the Cree village. The
-gathering for the Sun Dance not only meant gathering to celebrate the
-greatest religious ceremony of the plains Indians, but it also meant
-that it would be a time for great feasts, mock battles, ceremonial
-hunts, and the recounting of the past year’s experience with many old
-friends. And, of course, the men looked forward to smoking the
-ceremonial pipes which was also a part of this great occasion.
-
-The tribe had soon broken down its village and packed and the great
-procession headed north toward the meadow of the Blue Star.
-
-For two days and two nights the Cree village moved northward. Their
-progress was slow but steady, and there was much gaiety. There was much
-to look forward to, and many of the younger braves could hardly be kept
-from rushing on ahead of the tribe.
-
-Soon other tribes began to join the Cree in their trek north. In all
-directions smoke signals could be seen, sent up by eager messengers
-reporting the movements of the tribes as they converged on the sacred
-grounds.
-
-It was very clear to Swift Hawk now that friend and enemy were walking
-side by side. This was one time during the year when the burning desire
-to strike out at your enemy was replaced by a stronger desire to do
-worship together in the hope of a good year to come.
-
-Soon the meadow of the Blue Star was reached, and the tribe of Swift
-Hawk chose a place to set its village in the great circle with the
-tribe’s sacred tepee as its center. Campfires began to burn merrily, and
-the smell of cooking food filled the air. Old and young warriors walked
-about to renew old acquaintances and talk about what had happened during
-the past year. Dancers could be seen here and there practicing seriously
-for the time of the great ceremony.
-
-Soon word spread through the encampment that there were to be riding
-contests at the far west side of the meadow on the following day. These
-contests would be open to young braves who had made their first buffalo
-kill during the last year. This made Swift Hawk leap and shout for joy.
-Just last month he had brought down his first buffalo. This meant he
-could enter the riding contest. For many years now Swift Hawk had
-watched the contests from afar. Each year he promised himself that next
-year he would enter and win. Each year his father told him to be patient
-and that his time would come.
-
-It was a very difficult contest to test the skills of the young
-warriors. Each boy was to start his ride from the top of a hill that
-sloped sharply down into the meadow. At every one-hundred-yard point
-along a twisting path down the steep slope, for a distance of five
-hundred yards, were four sets of poles, two poles to each set. Each set
-was driven in the ground a buffalo’s length apart until they stood
-between four and five feet above ground. Between these two poles a
-buffalo hide was stretched to look like a buffalo running directly
-toward the sloping path, his flank toward the young warriors as they
-rode down.
-
-Each young brave was allowed a bow of his choice, four arrows, and a
-quiver. The brave, when given the signal to go, would race down the
-slope at full speed. Drawing an arrow from the quiver and bending his
-body down under the neck of his pony and holding on with his feet, he
-would aim his arrow under the neck of the pony and shoot the arrow into
-the buffalo hide. He would do this with each of the four arrows.
-
-Such a contest would surely test the strength and courage of any young
-brave. But young Indians were brought up to fear little and to welcome a
-test like this. For this reason it was no surprise to the great
-chieftains when a rather large group of young braves gathered at the
-starting point the next morning. Each boy sat astride a fine looking
-pony, usually the gift of his father or some other leading member of the
-tribe. Each boy had his bow, his quiver, and four very special arrows
-which had been worked over and cared for like a pet or one of the
-family.
-
-Final instructions were given to the young braves, and the riding
-contest was on! There was a great cheer from all who were watching as
-each rider left the starting point. This was a friendly match among boys
-from many tribes that often fought each other the rest of the year. Down
-the steep slope a lone warrior could be seen stationed at each buffalo
-hide. Here he could not only retrieve arrows but help to judge the young
-braves as they rode by and fired at the target.
-
-Soon it was Swift Hawk’s turn. Remembering all that his father had
-taught him, he dug his heels into his pony’s sides and started his fast
-and dangerous ride. Carefully he drew an arrow from the quiver; then
-bending under the pony’s neck, he placed the arrow to the bow, and as
-the target came into view, Swift Hawk let his arrow fly! He heard the
-plunk as the arrow struck the hide. With his head still under the pony’s
-neck and riding so hard, he could hardly have seen where it had landed.
-But a loud cheer told him that he had made a good shot. Down the steep,
-winding course, Swift Hawk swiftly shot his arrows at the three other
-targets, and went back toward the starting point.
-
-As he reached the hilltop he heard a great shout go up. Looking down the
-course he saw a young Crow brave just turning his pony to return to the
-starting point. The loud cheer meant that he had ridden well and made
-many good hits.
-
-One by one each of the other young braves made his attempt but none
-could equal the riding and skill of the young Crow Indian. And so it was
-when the last contestant had made his ride and fired no better than the
-rest that the Crow brave was announced as the winner. Swift Hawk was one
-of the first to reach his side and congratulate him on his victory. Deep
-in his heart, Swift Hawk was sad. But he was also very happy for this
-young brave. Surely the young man had deserved to win; and, above all,
-Swift Hawk realized how happy the young brave and his family must be
-that he had won.
-
-The contest over, Swift Hawk returned to his home and his father,
-disappointed but not unhappy now. There would be other contests, and
-this was a time of celebration and joy. His father found him sitting
-beside a tree stump.
-
-“You did very well, my son,” Slow Tongue said, placing his hands upon
-Swift Hawk’s shoulders. “The Crow boy who won did just a little bit
-better, but all the Cree are proud of you. There will be other contests
-and many games. Soon your turn will come. But even if it should not,
-remember what I have told you. As long as you play fair with your fellow
-braves and obey the rules, there is nothing to be ashamed of when you
-lose to someone who plays fair and has great skill.”
-
-“Thank you, father, I shall always remember that.”
-
-Games and new contests were beginning. Just as Swift Hawk’s father had
-told him, his time would come and sooner than he expected. In the foot
-race he ran much faster than any of his fellow braves, winning easily.
-Swift Hawk was as good a winner as he had been a good loser, boasting to
-no one about his victory.
-
-
-
-
- SINGING EAGLE’S FIRST CLOTHES
-
-
-The Huron tribe were a rather typical tribe of the Eastern woodlands.
-They were a hunting and fishing tribe, and when their villages were
-built they were built to last for a long time.
-
-In this particular village of the Hurons, there lived a young boy by the
-name of Singing Eagle. Now as was the custom among most of the tribes of
-that area, a young Indian child did not own any clothes at all until he
-reached the age of ten.
-
-This particular day was to be a great one for Singing Eagle, but when he
-woke that late summer morning, it was just another day for him.
-
-After eating his breakfast, he dashed away to play with the other
-children. Meanwhile back at the wigwam, Singing Eagle’s mother, Early
-Dawn, was very busy indeed. For many days and nights she had been
-working quite hard making Singing Eagle his first real set of clothing.
-
-Singing Eagle’s father had hunted the big brown buck early last spring
-and his long chase had finally been rewarded, when he was able to shoot
-and kill a very fine large buck. Carefully skinning the buck, he had
-returned both the skin and the meat to his wigwam, where his wife
-immediately set to work tanning the skin in preparation for making it
-into a winter outfit for young Singing Eagle.
-
-When the skin had been carefully tanned, Singing Eagle’s mother had
-fashioned from it a pair of leggings. The leggings of the woodland
-Indian were made in matched pairs. They covered the whole leg and fitted
-rather snugly and were held up with a thong fastened to the waistbelt.
-The buckskin was sewn together with threads of sinew.
-
-The shirt, which Singing Eagle’s mother was so proud of, had long
-sleeves and would reach to Singing Eagle’s knees, but above all the
-shirt was beautifully decorated with painted pictures. When Singing
-Eagle grew up, the paintings would be upon his future shirts and
-beadwork would also be added. The shirt was of buckskin.
-
-Finally Singing Eagle’s mother proudly held up, for her husband to see,
-the beautiful moccasins. The moccasins of the woodland Indian were
-fashioned from one piece of skin and were soft-soled and often these too
-were decorated with beadwork. Here Singing Eagle’s mother had decided
-not to wait until her son grew any more, but had put a beautiful beaded
-design on the toe of each moccasin. This was to be a truly wonderful
-day.
-
-After lunch, Singing Eagle lay down to rest, for he had been playing
-very hard that morning with the other children. When he awoke, he looked
-around and his eyes fairly jumped from his head. There at the foot of
-his bed was his first suit of clothing. Quickly he grasped them to him
-and hugged them, feeling how soft and pliable they were, following the
-many days of work.
-
-Quickly he slipped into the clothes and when he was completely dressed,
-ran from the wigwam to find his father and show him his beautiful
-clothes. Soon he found his father at the edge of the village talking
-with two other braves of the tribe. All excited, he pulled at his
-father’s sleeve until his father turned and noticing the clothes,
-quickly changed his expression from anger to one of surprise.
-
-“How handsome you look, my son. Your mother has done a fine job on your
-clothes. I wish that my shirts were as beautiful as the one you now wear
-upon your back. You look very much like a man now, my son.”
-
-Singing Eagle was very proud that his father had noticed his clothes and
-given him such fine compliments. But time was wasting. As was customary
-when a young Indian boy received his first full set of clothing to wear,
-the rest of the day was spent in showing off his new clothes to his many
-friends. And so that day, in a matter of a couple of hours, the whole
-Huron village knew that Singing Eagle had his first real Indian suit,
-made from a fine buck that his father had shot just for him.
-
-
-
-
- THE NEW TEPEE
-
-
-The Blackfoot village was all astir to greet the new day. It was late in
-the springtime, and the great hunters of the tribe had been off to hunt
-the buffalo. Word had just reached the village that the hunt was over
-and the hunting party was on the way home.
-
-This made Little Bird very happy, for she knew that her husband, Big Red
-Bear, would be returning to the tepee and that there would be much
-celebrating in the tribe. Everything must be made ready to greet the
-hunters.
-
-The women of the village began dashing around preparing for the arrival
-of the hunting party. There was much to be done and much work lay ahead,
-now that the buffalo had been killed. The meat must be stored and some
-of it smoked, and the hides must be turned into new tepee covers and
-robes. All this would take place after the celebration, but still the
-women of the tribe knew they had a long job ahead.
-
-The news was good. The hunt had been successful, and many buffalo had
-fallen before the weapons of the hunters. The buffalo had a good winter
-and were not thin or ragged. The grass had been full-grown and rich.
-Enough rain had fallen to provide the food and water necessary to make
-the buffalo fat and a good target for expert bowmen.
-
-Soon all was in readiness and everyone waited impatiently for the first
-signs of the returning hunters. And then the signal came! A young brave
-on a shaggy brown pony came dashing through the village, announcing the
-arrival of the hunters.
-
-Everyone was out to greet them and shout thanks and praise. Husbands and
-wives, fathers and children greeted each other warmly. The tribe was
-filled with joy.
-
-Night came swiftly. Before long the beating drums told the people that
-the dancing and feasting was to begin. This celebration often lasted all
-night and sometimes into the next day; then as dancers tired, they would
-wander off to their tepees for the first really peaceful sleep since the
-hunting party had left the village.
-
-Little Bird and her husband enjoyed the great feast and celebration. The
-next day Little Bird set to work on the buffalo skins for her family
-tepee. It had been a hard winter and the weather had damaged many
-Blackfoot homes. There were more than enough skins brought back by the
-hunters, so that those tepee coverings that had become worn and tattered
-could be replaced. So Little Bird set to work with the women of the
-tribe who were busy preparing and sewing together the buffalo hides to
-make new covers for the tepees.
-
-One day Little Bird learned that a new tepee was to be built in the
-village. The old tepee of the chief had been damaged so badly by the
-winter snow and ice, and the poles had become so rotted, that the tribe
-agreed to build him a new tepee. The building of a new tepee was
-important because everybody in the tribe helped to make it. All the
-friends and neighbors would be invited to attend a great feast and when
-the feast was over, the women would begin sewing the skins together.
-
-Little Bird and her husband went to the feast. When it was over, Little
-Bird sat down with the rest of the women and, taking up her bone needle,
-began to sew two buffalo hides together. The cutting of the skins had
-been entrusted to Slow Water, the wife of Black Fox, the tribe’s best
-hunter, since she had great skill in judging the number of skins needed
-by their size and shape. They used no patterns, so only a woman with
-this kind of skill was asked to do the cutting.
-
-As the sewing continued and the tepee walls began to take shape, even
-more whispering went on around Little Bird. When Little Bird asked one
-of her friends what it was all about, her friend would only say, “Be
-patient, Little Bird, for soon we shall all know what they have been
-whispering about.”
-
-The next day the women who had been working on the skins came to the
-tepee of Little Bird. Because her husband was away, Little Bird invited
-the women to sit and talk. There was a great deal of laughter as the
-women sat down. Slow Water, the skillful cutter, had been chosen to
-speak to Little Bird for all of them.
-
-“Little Bird,” she began, “we are here to ask you to do something for
-our tribe. You always have a smile for everyone wherever you go in the
-village. As you know, we must choose someone who is always cheerful to
-work on the smoke flaps for the new tepee. We are here to ask you,
-Little Bird, to work on the smoke flaps of the new tepee, so that your
-happy spirit will be woven into the flap and the smoke will depart from
-the tepee evenly and smoothly.”
-
-Little Bird smiled. Her heart was happy. This was truly a great honor.
-Now she understood why all the whispering had been going on the last
-couple of days.
-
-“I will be happy to help sew the smoke flaps of the new tepee. It is a
-great honor for which I thank you from the bottom of my heart.”
-
-And some say that as long as that tepee stood, the chief never had to
-worry about the smoke rising out of the tepee easily, even on stormy,
-windy nights. The Indians believed that the happy spirit of Little Bird
-really lived in that flap.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE DOVE LEARNS TO WEAVE
-
-
-When Little Dove, a Winnebago baby girl, was born she had everything a
-new-born baby could ask for. First of all, her father was chief of the
-Winnebagos, and her mother was considered one of the most beautiful
-women in the tribe.
-
-There were many relatives who came to view the new child and left many
-precious gifts for her.
-
-When she was born, Little Dove was strapped to a cradle board and
-carried by her mother in this fashion. Each day her mother would unwrap
-her and clean her body all over and massage her little limbs. Then she
-was wrapped once again on the board, and life continued this way until
-the baby was able to walk.
-
-She was always fed when she was hungry and was never but a few feet from
-her mother’s side. But soon Little Dove began to walk and so she left
-the cradle board and began to run and play with the other children in
-the out of doors.
-
-Everyone was affectionate and indulgent toward the girl as Indians
-always were toward their children. Soon, however, they realized that
-Little Dove was beginning to grow up. Little Dove was already ten
-summers old, when her mother called her to the side of their home to
-talk with her.
-
-“Little Dove,” she commenced, “you must start to prepare for your life
-later on as a wife and a mother. If you are to be a good wife, you must
-learn the work that all Indian women must do.”
-
-Most Indian girls welcomed this advice from their mothers, but Little
-Dove was different. Because she was the chief’s daughter some people had
-given her the idea that she would be waited upon for the rest of her
-life—if not by her mother or other women of the tribe, then eventually
-by her husband. When she told this to her mother, her mother tried to
-explain, but Little Dove did not want to listen and simply walked away.
-
-Soft Feather, her mother, was very much concerned and went to talk to
-her husband. But just as many fathers do even today, the chief said,
-
-“Be patient, she is young and she will learn.”
-
-Soft Feather was quite disturbed and each day she would ask Little Dove
-to come and begin to learn, but each day Little Dove would run off to
-play with the younger children while the older children were busy
-learning the work that goes with adult life.
-
-One day young Little Dove noticed an Indian boy that she had seen
-several times sitting by himself shaping a bow.
-
-“What are you doing?” she asked.
-
-“I am shaping a bow so that when I marry I will have a fine weapon with
-which to bring down the running deer.”
-
-For a long while Little Dove sat with the young boy, and nothing more
-was said. Finally the young brave rose and, bidding good-bye to Little
-Dove, started for his home.
-
-Little Dove was now twelve and each day she would see the young boy at
-work or play. Finally she went to her mother.
-
-“Mother, the young boy who has the pretty belt and bone-handled knife,
-who is he?”
-
-“That, my daughter, is your father’s best friend’s son, Straight Arrow.
-Why, do you like him especially?”
-
-“I like him a lot.”
-
-Several weeks passed, and one day as Little Dove was idling her time
-away dangling her feet in a stream, young Straight Arrow came to the
-water’s edge to wash some dirt from his arms and legs. He had been
-working in the garden with his father and now was going to clean up.
-Little Dove looked directly at him and said,
-
-“Are you planning on taking a wife very soon, Straight Arrow?”
-
-“I suppose so, Little Dove, for I am almost sixteen and my father said
-that I should be married now.”
-
-“I too am planning to be married soon,” said Little Dove.
-
-“Can you cook, or sew, or weave baskets?”
-
-“No, I cannot do those things. Will I have to?”
-
-“Well, I do not know about you but any girl that I marry must be able to
-do that and lots more. Well, I must be going now. It is time for lunch
-and I am very hungry and my sister is a very good cook.”
-
-With that, Straight Arrow left the side of the stream and he left behind
-a very angry Little Dove.
-
-Little Dove rushed home and told her mother what had happened. When she
-had finished blurting out her story, her mother said,
-
-“And now what do you want me to do about it, my Little Dove?”
-
-“Mother, will you teach me to weave baskets and sew and cook?”
-
-So the lessons began that very afternoon. The cooking was easy but when
-it came to the weaving, that was a little more difficult and it was a
-long time before Little Dove could weave a basket that looked like a
-basket.
-
-First, she and her mother would gather some thin ash and linden trees.
-These had to be straight and free of knots. They they would strip them
-of the bark. These they pounded until they came apart in long splints.
-Then these were dyed and woven into baskets. Also Little Dove learned
-how to make shredded basswood fibers. These were made almost the same
-way except that they were made into a strong thread by twisting them and
-rolling them against the thigh of one’s leg. These threads were used to
-weave belts and tump lines and square bags.
-
-Soon Little Dove had become quite expert at cooking and sewing and
-weaving, and once again she looked for Straight Arrow. She found him one
-day seated by a small stream that ran near the village. She sat down and
-began throwing pebbles into the stream.
-
-“I have learned to cook and to weave and to sew, Straight Arrow,” she
-said rather quickly.
-
-“That is good,” he answered, “for now you will make someone a good
-wife.” With that he rose and walked slowly back to the village. Little
-Dove sat and cried. When she could cry no longer she sat and looked into
-the water until it was dark, and then she returned to the village. Her
-mother was waiting for her.
-
-“Your father wishes to speak with you, Little Dove.”
-
-“Yes, my father, you sent for me?”
-
-“Little Dove, today a young brave came to see me. He wants you for his
-wife and he has offered me many fine horses. I think he will make you a
-good husband, so in four moons’ time you will be married, my daughter.”
-
-Little Dove felt her heart sink.
-
-“Who is it that has asked to marry me, father?”
-
-“Straight Arrow, son of Big Bow, my daughter, for today you told him you
-could weave.”
-
-Father and daughter smiled at each other, and then Little Dove left to
-talk with her mother and tell her how wrong a foolish young Indian girl
-could be.
-
-
-
-
- RED CLOUD’S DREAM
-
-
-Red Cloud was a young Algonquin lad who played and romped in his village
-along with the other young Indian braves and girls. He was a tall Indian
-for his age and quite good looking.
-
-As was the custom among the Algonquins, however, no child, boy or girl,
-would be considered mature until he or she had a dream in which the
-powers of nature promised success and courage in his or her adult life.
-
-Red Cloud entered adolescence and he knew that the time was fast
-approaching when he would be required to spend many lonely nights in the
-forest, fasting and waiting, until the Thunderbird, the Sun, or other
-powers of nature had spoken to him.
-
-Each day Red Cloud would awake and expect his father to call him to
-inform him that today was the day. But many days passed, and still Great
-Cloud did not call for his son. Soon with the excitement of the games
-and the learning of lessons from his father concerning the use of
-weapons and tracking, the problem of coming into maturity left the mind
-of Red Cloud and going off alone into the forest was the farthest thing
-from his mind.
-
-Each day in the beginning as he had padded along the trail with his
-father he had expected to be told of the ordeal he must go through, but
-as each day passed and nothing was said, Red Cloud began to look forward
-to his lessons and to forget even the possibility of anything else on
-these daily walks.
-
-Several months passed, and Red Cloud became quite a good hunter and
-tracker and his ability with the bow was unchallenged. His father was
-very proud of him and each day as they returned along the trail, Great
-Cloud walked with his arm lovingly across the shoulders of his son.
-
-One afternoon when they had returned from tracking a deer, Great Cloud
-summoned Red Cloud to his wigwam. Red Cloud thought that he might have
-done something on the hunt which displeased his father, but he entered
-the wigwam walking straight and proud as his father had taught him.
-Great Cloud motioned for his son to be seated and when he had done so,
-Great Cloud began to speak.
-
-“My son, in your dreams have any of the powers of nature appeared to you
-promising success and courage in your adult life? Now think hard, for
-this is very important.”
-
-Then and only then did Red Cloud realize that the time had come for him
-to be put to the test. Now he realized that his father was asking him
-whether he was a mature Indian brave or whether he was still a child.
-
-“No, father, I have had no dream in which the powers of nature
-appeared.”
-
-“Then you know, my son, what you have to do,” answered Great Cloud.
-“These many weeks you have probably wondered why I have not called you
-to me before. It was because I felt that you were not ready to bear the
-ordeal of spending many lonely nights in the forest alone. When one
-retires to the deep green of the forest to await the voice of the
-Thunderbird or the Sun or other powers of nature, one must go alone with
-just his weapons. Your education has been such that you would not have
-been able to survive in the forest very long before now, and that is why
-I have so carefully trained you in the many ways of nature and the
-forest these past few weeks. As you know, before you may be considered a
-mature Indian in the Algonquin tribe you must first hear the voice of
-one of the powers of nature promising you courage and success in your
-adult life. Are you now prepared to go into the great forest and endure
-this ordeal?”
-
-Red Cloud hesitated, for he knew that his answer must be a
-straightforward one and honest, for truth was a sacred thing to the
-Indians.
-
-“O my father, I must be truthful, for so you have taught me in my
-younger days. I have listened and watched patiently each day as I
-trotted at your heels along the trail and I have locked away in my heart
-and in my mind all the careful little bits of information you have given
-to me which would make me a boy worthy to be called the son of Great
-Cloud. The forest has been a friendly place to me, for I have spent many
-happy hours there with you. Now I am faced with a decision which I must
-make here and now, and all I can say to you, father, is that I, Red
-Cloud, your son, am ready to go into the great forest to await the word
-from the powers of nature.”
-
-Great Cloud placed his hands upon the shoulders of his son and smiling
-at him said, “You have spoken well, my son. Tomorrow you shall leave for
-the forest and look for a place where you will not be disturbed. Take
-with you your weapons and your blanket, but no other goods such as food,
-for you must fast while you await the dream.”
-
-With that Red Cloud departed from the wigwam to prepare for his journey
-the following morning.
-
-There was no sleep for the young Red Cloud that evening, as he thought
-of his coming trip into the big forest. Finally the early light of dawn
-peeked through the door of the wigwam and before most of the village was
-even astir, Red Cloud was up from his bed and had gathered his precious
-weapons and his blanket for the trip.
-
-He bade good-bye to his mother, Morning Star, and his father, Great
-Cloud, and started for the forest.
-
-It was a beautiful morning. The bright sun shone down through the leaves
-of the great green trees of the forest and the spring flowers were all
-in gay bloom, dressed in their finest colors of reds, blues, yellows,
-purples, and oranges. As he trotted along the trail Red Cloud could hear
-overhead the many different calls and songs of the forest birds.
-Occasionally there was a rustle along the side of the trail or a rabbit
-would scamper across the path of Red Cloud.
-
-Once through the branch of a low-hanging birch tree, Red Cloud saw the
-magnificent body of a full-grown buck with six points. Oh, how he
-regretted that he was not upon a hunting trip, for wouldn’t that buck
-have made a beautiful trophy to bring back to the village?
-
-The buck, too, seemed to be aware of the reason for Red Cloud’s journey,
-for though the boy moved carefully he did stir the leaves as he walked
-and though the buck turned his majestic head he did not move from his
-spot in the glen of the forest.
-
-Red Cloud smiled to himself, recalling words of his father, “Sometimes
-the wild animals seem to sense the reason for your journey and fear not
-the approach of a warrior who is not on a hunt.” At the time Red Cloud
-had not thought much about the statement but here beside the trail it
-had been proved to him by the actions of the majestic buck.
-
-Soon Red Cloud felt that he had journeyed deep enough into the forest
-along the well-known trails, so he turned from the path to go into the
-forest where no trail was known to him. It was not easy going, for he
-had to cut small brush from his path. Occasionally he would take a small
-piece of bark from the side of a tree to mark the direction he had taken
-in order to find his way back to the main trail.
-
-Soon he came to a stream and stooped to drink of the cool refreshing
-water. As he stood up once again he gazed up through the opening in the
-trees and noticed that evening was fast approaching and soon it would be
-dark. So he moved on more rapidly and he noticed that his direction was
-taking him up the side of a small ridge. Finally, tired and realizing
-that darkness would soon be upon him, Red Cloud decided to stop and make
-his camp. He found that where he had chosen to stop, there was a small
-formation of rocks which provided a natural shelter from the cool
-evening breezes.
-
-Within the shelter of these rocks he built himself a small fire and
-then, wrapping his blanket around him, settled down to sleep through the
-comforting night, hoping as all boys do that the dream would come to him
-on this, his first night and that he could return to the warmth and
-shelter of his friendly wigwam and his family on the following day. But
-also Red Cloud was prepared to spend many days, if the need arose and
-many nights, for he had been taught endurance by his father.
-
-The night passed quickly, and suddenly Red Cloud opened his eyes to the
-rays of the sun and a new day. Climbing from under the folds of his
-blanket he realized that he was quite thirsty and hungry. Water he could
-seek and drink, but he realized that until he had the dream he was to
-partake of no food regardless of how long he must wait. Unless, of
-course, he desired to return to the village and report that the spirits
-had not spoken to him in a dream and then as was the custom of his tribe
-he would be considered a poor unfortunate person with little hope of
-success in life. So Red Cloud put the thoughts of food from his mind and
-started in search of water.
-
-In the great forest one did not have to look too far for water because
-all through the great forest there ran many streams of clear cool water.
-So it was not long before Red Cloud found such a stream and, after
-splashing the icy cold water in his face to chase the sleep from his
-eyes, he drank deeply until his thirst was satisfied. Then turning from
-the stream he started back toward his camp.
-
-When he arrived back at his blanket, he spread it on the ground and then
-lay down to gaze up into the sky through the openings in the trees. He
-passed an hour or more making wonderful pictures in his mind from the
-formation of clouds that floated overhead across the heavens. Billowy
-white puffs of smoke they seemed to be, and Red Cloud marveled at how
-soft and pure they looked. But soon his restless heart made him rise
-from the blanket and he decided to explore. He started for the top of
-the ridge many miles away and when he had reached there he knelt,
-turning his head toward the heavens and raising his arms. And so as if
-reaching for the sun he made his prayers to the great Wakanda.
-
-When he had knelt in this position for an hour or more he rose to start
-down the ridge toward his campsite again, planning to go in another
-direction from the campsite and eventually explore the whole surrounding
-area. It was then that he noticed a slight stirring in the brush.
-Quickly Red Cloud dropped behind a shelter of rock and watched the spot
-in the brush. He did not know what to expect, for this part of the
-forest was strange to him and he did not know what might be hidden in
-the brush. Then as he watched the brush he realized that the slight
-breeze that was blowing would be carrying his scent right toward
-whatever was concealed in the patch of brush.
-
-Then he saw it was a tremendous brown bear which was six feet tall on
-its hind feet. Evidently the bear had been eating blueberries from the
-bushes which covered the side of the ridge and had suddenly become aware
-of the presence of someone or something which was foreign to him. The
-bear was now raised up on his hind paws in order to look over the tops
-of the bushes and see if he could discover this thing which had invaded
-his feeding grounds.
-
-Red Cloud crouched even lower behind the rock, for he knew that a brown
-bear could be very mean, especially when he was hungry. Then Red Cloud
-thought of his weapons. In seeking water he had left his weapons at the
-campsite and had nothing with him but his hunting knife, which he felt
-would do him little good against a mad full-grown brown bear. So the
-best thing he could do was to attempt to circle the bear and get
-downwind from him so that the bear could no longer smell him. But he
-must do it by keeping out of sight.
-
-Slowly Red Cloud edged himself out from behind the rock, keeping his
-body pressed close to the ground. Before he started to move he noticed
-that the bear had settled down to feeding once again. The breeze had
-died down but there was always the danger of a quick gust again and Red
-Cloud realized he was still in a dangerous position. He hugged the
-ground as hard as he could and continued to squirm away from and around
-this dangerous bear.
-
-Then Red Cloud was aware of another danger. Having gone without food for
-almost two whole days, he was not the strong lad that he would have been
-when eating two hearty meals a day. He wondered, if the bear did see
-him, whether he would be able to run fast enough to get away from the
-bear. But getting downwind was the most important thing at this time, so
-Red Cloud continued to crawl and the rough stones on the forest floor
-cut through his shirt and into his skin, scraping it raw; but the more
-it hurt the harder Red Cloud pressed his body against the friendly
-earth.
-
-He slowly raised his head and realized that he was now almost completely
-downwind from the bear and that the big fellow had gone back to munching
-the berries. For what seemed like hours, Red Cloud lay quietly in hiding
-behind a great oak tree, not daring to look out for fear the bear would
-be looking around just at the time he peeked out from behind the tree.
-
-And then it happened. Red Cloud had been lying so still, afraid to move,
-that suddenly he felt his leg go numb and he realized that his leg had
-gone to sleep. He moved it slightly to bring circulation and life back
-into it and in so doing he dislodged a fairly large stone which began
-its noisy fall down the side of the ridge and as it rolled it would
-click against other stones and they too would join the miniature
-landslide. Red Cloud huddled behind the tree and then he heard a low
-growl. He decided he had better take a chance and glance from behind the
-tree, and as he did his heart leapt, for the bear was looking almost
-right at him. The bear let out another terrible growl, and then from
-above where Red Cloud lay in hiding, the young brave heard another
-growl.
-
-Slowly turning his head so that he could look up the ridge, he saw the
-reason for the bear’s sudden anger. His berry patch had been invaded by
-another large brown bear who was now growling out a challenge. If either
-bear had spotted Red Cloud, he was forgotten now, for they had eyes only
-for each other and possession of the berry patch was the prize which
-they both sought.
-
-With mighty growls they dropped to all fours and charged at each other.
-Red Cloud, at first fascinated by this battle between two creatures of
-the forest, stood rooted to his hiding place, but then thought more
-wisely of it and taking the chance offered him by the two bears being
-involved in a battle to the death, ran as swiftly as he could down the
-ridge and away from the danger that threatened his very life.
-
-He did not stop running until he had reached his campsite miles away and
-then, throwing himself flat on the ground, thanked the great Wakanda for
-sparing him from this danger which had threatened and for bringing him
-safely to his campsite.
-
-Once again he offered his prayers to the powers of nature and then,
-wrapping himself in his blanket and building up the fire, he settled
-down for the night.
-
-It was during the warm sleep of that evening brought on by the fatigue
-of his day’s adventure that Red Cloud had his dream. In his dream the
-great Thunderbird appeared to him telling him that he would have much
-courage added to the courage already in his heart and that as an adult
-in the tribe he would have a great deal of success in all he attempted.
-Upon awakening at the first rays of the dawn, Red Cloud felt suddenly
-refreshed. He had been visited in his dreams and now could return to the
-village.
-
-Gathering his weapons he put out the embers of the fire he had made and
-scattered the dead ashes. Then with a light heart and a quick step he
-started back upon the path he had blazed until he reached the main
-trail. There he quickened his step and just as dusk was beginning to
-fall, entered the village, being welcomed warmly by his many friends.
-His father and several of the lesser chiefs were at the door of his
-father’s wigwam and that evening a council was held at the central
-lodge.
-
-There Red Cloud rose before the male members of his tribe and recounted
-his adventures in the great forest, closing by repeating his dream. As
-he finished there were many grunts of approval and words of praise.
-
-But Great Cloud said nothing, and Red Cloud wondered about this until he
-looked into the eyes of his great father; and there he saw the fire of
-pride burning brightly and in his heart he was very happy. Together
-father and son left the central lodge that evening, and true to the
-dream, Red Cloud grew in the tribe to become one of its greatest
-warriors.
-
-
- This story is based upon an incident in the life of Red Cloud, an
- Algonquin warrior, as told to the author by John Fitch, a farmer from
- Vermont.
-
-
-
-
- BROKEN TOOTH AND THE WAR BONNET
-
-
-The Apache warriors had been waiting a long time for this revenge upon
-the maurauding Kiowas and now the time had come. The leader of the
-Apache band raised his hand and the attack was on. The Apache war party
-swept down the hillside into the midst of the Kiowa camp. The camp had
-been caught off guard and the raiding Apaches were making short work of
-the few Kiowa braves who would stand and fight.
-
-Broken Tooth, one of the most honored warriors of the Apache tribe, rode
-down to a Kiowa brave and touched him with his coup stick. Then he rode
-on a short ways, turned abruptly and sent an arrow into the Kiowa’s
-chest.
-
-The battle was short and furious. The Apache raiders withdrew from the
-village and slowly returned home to count their coup and to sing of
-their victory at the great council. As they rode, Broken Tooth was
-thinking ahead to the great council that night. After this raid today a
-great event would take place in his tepee on the morrow.
-
-The party entered the camp and there was much rejoicing. Finally, the
-evening meal was eaten and the word was sent out that the council would
-meet to hear the deeds of the day.
-
-When all the men of the tribe had gathered in the council lodge, they
-rose one by one to recount their deeds of the day. Finally, Broken Tooth
-rose and told of his riding down upon the Kiowa warrior and touching him
-with his coup stick. He then related his other exploits of the day. The
-great chief rose from his place and then he spoke, “Broken Tooth, you
-have been a brave warrior and you have earned many honors. Today you
-have added even more honors for your brave deeds.”
-
-The council then broke up, but the following day word was passed that
-Broken Tooth was on that day going to make a new headdress. As was the
-custom, the men of the tribe gathered that afternoon in the tepee of
-Broken Tooth and all his feathers were spread upon the ground. They were
-then sorted according to size, and the making of the headdress began. As
-each feather was being prepared for the headdress, Broken Tooth
-recounted for the men the story of the deed that had won him that
-feather. The men would listen and smoke and grunt approval after each
-story. Finally, the bonnet was finished and there was no more beautiful
-piece of handiwork in the whole village.
-
-The following day there were reports from the scouts that the Arapaho
-were banding together and would be attacking in force. The Apaches
-gathered their warriors and rode forth to meet the enemy. A large plain
-between the two villages was picked as the place of battle and the
-tribes met in both hand-to-hand and long-range battle. It was a
-hard-fought battle and soon both tribes withdrew, bearing their dead and
-wounded.
-
-Among the dead was Broken Tooth. As his body was borne back to the
-Apache village many praised the beauty of the war bonnet which had been
-worn so proudly by its owner for a single day.
-
-
-
-
- GREY SQUIRREL HEARS HIS NAME
-
-
-The Oneidas were a tribe of the Iroquois Nation which had swept north to
-invade the lands of the Algonquins, spreading death and destruction.
-After having beaten all the surrounding Algonquin tribes badly, the
-Iroquois tribes fell to fighting among themselves—the Onondagas,
-Mohawks, Cayugas, and Senecas, as well as the Oneidas. This constant
-bloodshed in the Mohawk valley in time weakened the tribes so that they
-were always in danger of attack from the revenge-seeking Algonquins.
-
-It was during this unhappy time that a young brave, Grey Squirrel, lived
-among the Oneida people. He was not an unusual Indian. He was of average
-build with average good looks and average abilities. He took part in
-only the things the average young man in his tribe enjoyed—hunting,
-fishing, trapping, and doing all the things they did. However, there was
-one difference that set Grey Squirrel aside from his brothers of the
-tribe: Grey Squirrel had never heard his name spoken by the chiefs of
-the tribe. All the other braves of his age had either heard the chiefs
-call their names while on the hunt, at a tribal ceremony, or while
-walking in the woods or swimming in the stream.
-
-So Grey Squirrel began to wonder whether he had ever done anything
-which, in the eyes of the chiefs, made him unworthy. He had fought in
-great battles, but he had never been cowardly. So cowardice could not be
-the reason. He had never failed to hunt well, to keep his wigwam warm
-and sturdy, and to see that there was enough food for all the family. He
-could see no way in which he had been unworthy of the chiefs’ notice.
-Often Grey Squirrel would walk by the quiet stream and ponder the reason
-for his being a brave forgotten by the chiefs.
-
-As Grey Squirrel’s heart grew troubled, he sought the wise advice of his
-father, Grey Owl. One evening, he approached his father’s wigwam and
-asked if he might speak with him about something which tormented his
-mind. Grey Owl invited him into his home and they both sat cross-legged
-around the small fire in the center of the wigwam. There was a long
-period of silence and then Grey Owl spoke.
-
-“What is it that troubles you so deeply, my son? I have often watched
-you wander from the village to the near-by stream and sit and ponder. I
-have watched you return with a downcast look from the hunt or battle
-when you should have been joyful that your bow had proven straight and
-true in whatever task you set for it.” His father paused. “Speak, my
-son, unburden your heart to your father who has loved you and guided you
-from babyhood to fine young manhood.”
-
-Grey Squirrel looked long at his father and as he watched his father’s
-eyes, his face softened and he said, “O wise and kind father, many years
-I walked the forest trails at your heels carefully watching every move,
-imitating all that you taught me to the best of my ability. Many, many
-hours we spent together beneath the sheltering branches of the towering
-oak trees, listening with our ears to the voices of the forest. You
-taught me how to listen and what to listen for, so that my ears have
-grown very keen. Today the deer may not tread the forest floor that I do
-not hear, nor the rabbit scurry for cover that I cannot uncover the
-entrance to his home, nor the bluebird set his wings for flight that I
-cannot immediately see his starting place. And yet, dear father, there
-is one sound I have listened for and have not heard.”
-
-Grey Owl had been listening calmly to all that his young son had to say.
-Surprise crossed his face with his son’s last words, and then a gentle
-smile came upon his lips. “Tell me, Grey Squirrel, what is this sound
-you listen so hard for but cannot hear?”
-
-“O father,” Grey Squirrel said, “I have listened for the voices of our
-great chiefs calling my name, but to this day I have not heard them. Am
-I not in favor with those who watch over our tribe and guide our feet
-along the safe paths? Tell me, father, why do I not hear my name spoken
-by them? I have listened along the forest trails or in the din of
-battle. I have lain awake in the quiet of my wigwam listening for just a
-whisper. All the other braves of our village are proud that they have
-heard their names repeated by the chiefs. I alone have not. What is
-wrong, father? I have come to you to seek your wise answer.”
-
-Grey Owl lowered his eyes to the ground as he searched his thoughts for
-the right reply. Then he lifted his head slowly and studied his son’s
-face. He began to speak slowly and kindly. “My son, you have made one
-very great mistake. Without having meant to do so, you have done the one
-thing which could have prevented you from hearing the chiefs call your
-name.”
-
-“Tell me, father,” Grey Squirrel said impatiently, “tell me what it is!”
-
-Grey Owl rose and walked behind his son. Placing his hands upon the
-young man’s shoulders, he said, “Because you have walked in search of
-their praise you have spent many hours expecting to hear them praise
-you. Do not listen so hard, my son. Live your life the best you know
-how. One day you shall be rewarded by hearing the voices of the chiefs
-who watch over our tribe. Do not be troubled any longer. Return to your
-wigwam and your family and continue to be a good husband and father. If
-you allow it to worry you greatly, it will soon hurt your whole life.
-You are young, my son. You have not been forgotten.”
-
-Grey Squirrel rose then, and faced his father. “Father,” he said, “your
-words are of little comfort. But I will follow your advice, for it has
-been wise and good through the years of my youth.” With that, Grey
-Squirrel turned and left his father’s wigwam.
-
-He returned to his own home and was greeted warmly by his good wife,
-Morning Star, who had prepared a fine meal for him. All through his
-dinner, Grey Squirrel thought carefully about his father’s words. But
-when he went to bed that evening, he decided that he should drive these
-troubled thoughts from his mind. The weeks that followed were very
-pleasant for Grey Squirrel. The hunting and fishing were good.
-Everything was going well. The people of the village saw the sudden
-change in Grey Squirrel and the fact that he no longer appeared worried.
-Grey Squirrel felt better, greeting each new day happily.
-
-One day Grey Squirrel shouldered his bow and chose his best arrows.
-Bidding his family good-bye, he started toward the forest to hunt for
-fresh meat for his family. He trotted easily along the forest trail,
-stopping now and then to study the ground and look for signs of moving
-game.
-
-He had been on the trail for a while when he came to a narrow stream.
-Stooping to drink of the fresh, cool water, he stopped with his hand
-halfway to his mouth. He blinked his eyes and looked again into the
-stream, not moving a muscle. There, in a quiet pool next to his
-reflection was that of the head and antlers of a beautiful deer. Slowly
-the brave lifted his head until he was looking straight into the eyes of
-a magnificent buck standing directly across the stream, almost within
-reach. As Grey Squirrel straightened up slowly, the buck shied a little
-and backed off. Many thoughts passed through Grey Squirrel’s head, but
-the one which puzzled him most was why the buck shied only a little and
-then stood and watched him without any sign of fear after that.
-
-Grey Squirrel lowered a hand slowly to reach for his bow which he had
-placed upon the ground as he was kneeling to drink. Grasping the bow
-firmly, he fitted an arrow onto the bow string and took careful aim. The
-great buck’s eyes stayed his hand from releasing the arrow and made him
-lower the bow. His mind told Grey Squirrel that this buck would provide
-good food, but his heart told him to stop. Then he noticed that the deer
-was favoring his right hoof and realized that the buck had an injury.
-The leg just above the hoof was swollen to almost twice its normal size.
-Grey Squirrel dropped his bow and arrow to the ground, and with careful
-and even steps, waded across the stream toward the buck.
-
-The animal suddenly turned as if to spring into the forest, but his leg
-collapsed under him and he fell to the ground. Grey Squirrel guessed
-that the deer must have already used up his strength in escaping from
-whatever had caused the injury, had come to the stream to bathe the
-injured leg, and could go no further. Now the buck was struggling to
-rise and Grey Squirrel jumped quickly to his side. Firmly but gently,
-the Indian placed one knee against the buck’s side, one hand on the
-animal’s chest, the other on the buck’s neck to hold him steady. The
-animal was frightened and trembled. Grey Squirrel spoke softly to the
-buck and began to stroke its side, each time managing to bring his hand
-a little closer to the injured hoof. Finally the buck seemed to sigh and
-relaxed as though he understood that this man wanted to help him.
-
-Grey Squirrel leaned over to look at the injured leg more closely. The
-buck apparently had run into some heavy brambles and a large thorn had
-lodged in the soft part of the leg just above the hoof, which had become
-infected and had begun to fester. Grey Squirrel took his knife from his
-belt and pressed the point of the blade into the flesh beside the thorn.
-The buck’s leg quivered slightly. Then the thorn and a misty fluid
-spurted from the wound. Grey Squirrel took wet leaves and mud from the
-bed of the stream and laid them over the wound. All through this
-operation the buck lay still, allowing Grey Squirrel to do as he
-pleased. The animal continued to lie there quietly as though waiting for
-any more help the Indian might gave him.
-
-Grey Squirrel went back to the stream and, cupping his hands, brought
-some cool water for the animal. The buck drank it eagerly. A long time
-passed while Grey Squirrel kept vigil over the resting buck.
-Occasionally as he moved to another position, the buck would follow him
-with his eyes; when Grey Squirrel settled down again, the buck would put
-his head back on the earth and he too would rest again. Finally, dusk
-drew near and it began to darken in the forest. As if by signal, the
-buck arose, tested his injured leg, glanced at Grey Squirrel, and
-started for the protection of the dense trees. Grey Squirrel called and
-the buck stopped at the edge of the woods and turned to look back. He
-cocked his head to one side as if to say “thank you,” and then moved
-into the thick woods and out of sight.
-
-Grey Squirrel suddenly became angry with himself and shouted aloud,
-“What a fool you are, Grey Squirrel! There, before you, was food for
-your family for a whole week. But you let the buck make you feel sorry
-for him. You cared for his injury, and now he has left you empty-handed
-after a whole day of hunting, with only the story of a deer who let you
-pet him—as if anyone would believe you! You are a fool, Grey Squirrel!”
-
-Then there was a loud rustling near by. All of a sudden, Grey Squirrel
-heard a voice, calling his name.
-
-“Grey Squirrel!” the voice boomed, echoing in the forest. “Don’t be
-angry with yourself. I witnessed what you did today. Your tribe will
-honor you. It takes courage to travel in the forests alone in search of
-food. But it takes greater courage to forget to be a hunter when his
-prey is so easy a target because of an injury. You sacrificed time and
-food for your family’s table to help the injured buck. If you had killed
-the animal, you would have felt cowardly. Return to our village, hold
-your head high, and tell of your deed today. Do not worry if they do not
-believe you at first. Your heart is happy for your kindness. Go, Grey
-Squirrel, it grows late. I will ask the chiefs to hear your story at the
-council fire tonight.”
-
-In quiet wonder, Grey Squirrel stood gazing at Strong Heart, the great
-war chief of the Oneidas, who stepped out of the woods only a few paces
-from the spot where the buck had stopped briefly to gaze back at him.
-Lifting his bow from the ground, Grey Squirrel started back to his
-family and his wigwam. In his heart were a warmth and peace that he had
-never felt before.
-
-
-
-
- 4. HEROISM
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE FAWN AND THE WOLVES
-
-
-It had been a very poor hunting year for the Choctaw Tribe. Little Fawn,
-daughter of Wolf’s Tooth, sat in her wigwam, thinking about her hunger.
-Not just Little Fawn, but everyone in the village was beginning to feel
-the pangs of hunger. One month still remained before the ice would thaw
-in the lakes, and the fish would begin to swim again, and the young
-green sprouts of grass would burst through the earth and draw the game
-back to the hunting ground. A grave decision had to be made. When the
-Council had gathered, Wolf’s Tooth rose up and spoke.
-
-“We need food. If we are not to starve, we must organize a strong
-hunting party, and travel south to seek out the animals that have
-wandered from our hunting grounds.”
-
-There were many grunts of approval. The decision was made that a great
-hunting party would leave the following day for the south. There was
-much dancing and preparation for the hunt. Tough hickory bows were
-tested again and again for weak spots. Sinew cords that were old or
-might have weak spots were cast aside, and new ones strung on the
-hickory bows. Knives and tomahawks were made ready. The tension mounted
-until dawn when the hunting party started from the village toward the
-south.
-
-Little Fawn gazed slowly around the encampment and immediately noticed
-that all the strong young braves were gone. All that remained were the
-old men, the sick, the women and children. This bothered Little Fawn,
-until she thought to herself, “What could happen? Nothing. We will be
-safe as long as we stay in our village.”
-
-Before the men left on the trip, they had been so confident they would
-bring back home an ample supply of meat that they gave their families
-extra rations of meat and greens which they had been guarding well. Some
-of the families were careful and, though given plenty, still used the
-extra food sparingly; but many of the families could not resist the
-temptation to feast, and built up fires to cook the extra meat and
-greens. It was just this mistake that nearly cost many of the remaining
-Choctaw people their lives.
-
-Just as the families were sitting down to eat, a howl echoed from out of
-the forest and then another and another from different directions. The
-women became frightened and some of the children began to cry. Some of
-the men began to cry too, because they realized that they were old and
-sick and could give little help to the women and children against the
-danger that was now just outside their village.
-
-How well they knew the sounds which came from the forests on the edge of
-the camp! The wolves were hungry, for their hunting season had been a
-poor one too. These lean and starving savage beasts had been drawn to
-the outskirts of the village by the smell of the large quantities of
-meat cooking in the many vessels throughout the village. The howling
-continued, and it grew louder as many more voices joined the circle of
-wolves slowly closing in on the village.
-
-Food and hunger were forgotten by the older squaws as they hurried to
-carry their children to the comparative safety of the wigwam. Suddenly,
-all were stricken with panic except Little Fawn. Though her little heart
-pounded in her breast, Little Fawn searched her mind for a solution to
-this threat of death to her people. She ran quickly to her home and
-there found her younger brother, Flying Squirrel, crouched in the corner
-of the wigwam, shaking with fear. Slowly she explained to him that he
-must stop shaking and listen carefully. Though only a young boy, she
-told him, he must now become a man. He must leave immediately upon the
-trail of the hunting party to bring help to the village while she,
-Little Fawn, stayed behind to do whatever she could to help her people.
-
-Flying Squirrel knew the job he must do. So he immediately set out upon
-the trail of the hunting party, helped by the bright moon and driven on
-by thoughts of his brave young sister who was staying behind to face
-this howling menace of a pack of wolves. Both fear and courage lent
-wings to his feet as he sped through the circle of wolves and down the
-trail in pursuit of the hunting party.
-
-Meanwhile, Little Fawn called two other young Indian girls to her and
-explained that the only reason the wolves were staying as far from the
-village was their fear of the many fires which still burned brightly in
-the village.
-
-“So,” Little Fawn said, “it is our job to keep those fires burning all
-night, and to make torches and light them on the edge of the village to
-keep the wolves away.” Reluctantly the girls agreed, and fires were
-built up. The three girls made torches of pine knots and placed them in
-a wide circle at the edge of the village.
-
-All night they kept the fires burning, and all night the howling of the
-wolves kept up. With the coming of dawn, however, the wolves scurried
-back into the forest. Only then did the girls who had helped Little Fawn
-decide to take a much needed rest. But Little Fawn could not rest
-because she was so worried about her little brother, Flying Squirrel. At
-just about this time, he reached the hunting party and, after explaining
-what had happened, collapsed in the arms of his father.
-
-Wolf’s Tooth chose a half dozen warriors and immediately started home
-for the village which was almost a full day’s journey away.
-
-Back at the village, Little Fawn was busy gathering wood for the fires
-that coming evening. Soon many willing hands were helping in this task.
-As the day wore on, Little Fawn anxiously watched the south trail for
-signs of the returning warriors. As the sun began to set, Little Fawn
-began to wonder if Flying Squirrel had been able to reach Wolf’s Tooth
-and his band. Little Fawn knew that the wolves would be back after the
-sun set.
-
-It grew dark fast. Little Fawn went to look at the many torches around
-the village, lighting any that had gone out and preparing once again for
-the long wait. As she reached to set another torch ablaze, she heard a
-low, threatening growl almost beside her. Turning slowly around, Little
-Fawn found she was gazing into the sharp eyes of a hungry wolf who must
-have followed her right to this spot. Little Fawn drew back in fear
-until her back pressed against a hickory tree as the wolf crouched to
-spring. There was no escape and Little Fawn faced the wolf trembling.
-The wolf leaped. There was the sudden twang of a bowstring. A howl of
-agony came from the throat of the wolf as the arrow struck home. The
-rescue party had arrived just in time. Wolf’s Tooth’s arrow had found
-its mark. The rescue party killed most of the wolves and drove off the
-rest of the pack. All the next day Little Fawn and her brother, Flying
-Squirrel, were thanked and praised by her tribe.
-
-Wolf Tooth told them: “I am very proud of my children. My son moves even
-more swiftly than a flying squirrel. My daughter may be as gentle as a
-little fawn, but she is braver than a pack of wolves.”
-
-
-
-
- THE ISLAND
-
-
-White Eagle was a young Iroquois boy. His favorite friend was Shining
-Star, a young Indian girl from his tribe. The small village in which
-they lived stood on the shore of a large and beautiful lake that could
-become very dangerous in a sudden storm.
-
-Scattered in the lake were many small islands. When parents were sure
-that their children could handle the tribe’s canoes safely in the lake,
-they allowed them to explore these islands. A favorite sport of White
-Eagle and Shining Star was to paddle to one of these islands to search
-for berries and other wild fruit.
-
-One sunny summer day, White Eagle and Shining Star decided to take a
-canoe trip to one of the islands farthest from their village. As far as
-White Eagle knew, the island they planned to visit was at the other end
-of the long lake. Excitedly, the two children went down to the shore and
-set out on their adventure across the calm, blue lake. They enjoyed
-paddling in the sun because its beams seemed to warm them to their
-hearts.
-
-They had been paddling gaily and laughing a great deal for some time
-when Shining Star suddenly turned to White Eagle with an unhappy look on
-her pretty face.
-
-“White Eagle,” she said sadly, “I am getting tired. I think we should
-visit one of the islands nearer home. I don’t think I can help you
-paddle all the way across this great lake and back again.”
-
-“Very well,” said White Eagle kindly, “there is an island over there
-that we have never visited before. We will go ashore there and hunt for
-berries.”
-
-Without saying any more, the children turned their canoe and headed for
-the island about one hundred paces away. Soon their canoe was scraping
-bottom on a sand bar that seemed to lead from the island into the water.
-Stepping from the canoe, White Eagle steadied it while Shining Star
-stepped ashore. Finally, he pulled the canoe up onto the shore so that
-it would not be carried away from the island into the lake and leave
-them stranded. Then, hand in hand, the children began to explore.
-
-Now these islands were not small and, if one were not careful, he could
-really get lost for a little while. So the children were careful to mark
-their trail with broken branches as they went. In their eagerness to
-explore this island they forgot what they had actually come for.
-
-“We have never been on this island before,” said White Eagle. “At least,
-I don’t remember having been on it before now.”
-
-“No,” answered Shining Star. “We have never been here before.”
-
-“Well, the only thing to do is look around.” Maybe White Eagle was
-thinking of himself as an Indian warrior when he added, “Let’s see if we
-can find any enemies.”
-
-“Oh, don’t be silly, White Eagle! We won’t find any enemies on this
-island,” Shining Star said, laughing and forgetting how tired she had
-been.
-
-“Don’t fool yourself, Shining Star. My father tells me that sometimes
-the enemy will set up camp on an island near a village to keep watch on
-the tribe. Then when they feel that the village is off guard, they
-attack.”
-
-White Eagle said this with such a serious face that Shining Star became
-frightened. “Let’s go home, White Eagle, I’m afraid.”
-
-“Don’t be silly, little one, I was only fooling.” (Now he played the
-part of a warrior again.) “There is probably no living thing upon this
-island but ourselves. Come on! We’re wasting time. Let’s start
-exploring.”
-
-The two children continued to investigate the island, always making sure
-that they were leaving a plain trail so that they could return to their
-canoe in safety. After several hours, they decided that there were no
-berries on this island so they might as well return home. They turned
-around and started back for the shore, trying to follow their trail
-carefully.
-
-Sooner than he had expected, White Eagle could see the lake waters, but
-when they reached the shore he realized that this was not where they had
-landed. And there was no canoe. Looking out across the water, White
-Eagle knew that they were on another side of the island. Perhaps they
-had followed a fresh trail someone else had left.
-
-Shining Star seated herself on a log about ten paces from the shore to
-rest and wait for White Eagle to make a decision.
-
-“Come, Shining Star,” he said confidently, “we will walk along the shore
-until we reach our canoe.”
-
-So taking hands once again, the children started along the shore of the
-island. Suddenly, the sky became black, a strong wind came up, and dark
-storm clouds started moving in over the lake.
-
-“Hurry, Shining Star!” he said with just a touch of fear in his voice.
-“A storm is coming over the lake. We must hurry if we are to reach home
-before the waves get so high that we can’t paddle our canoe.”
-
-Shining Star started to run, but stumbled and fell, twisting her ankle.
-She cried out in pain and White Eagle knelt by her side.
-
-“Oh, I’ve hurt my ankle,” Shining Star told him, holding back her tears.
-
-White Eagle lifted the young girl in his arms and started carrying her.
-Soon they reached the place where the canoe was beached. Placing her
-gently into the canoe, White Eagle shoved the canoe into the water and
-climbed inside.
-
-The sky had become very dark. They could hear thunder and see flashes of
-lightning across the lake. Rain was beginning to fall fast. Now even
-White Eagle was afraid, but he tried his best to hide his fear from
-Shining Star. Using all the strength he could muster, he paddled
-furiously toward home, but the winds now were pounding the light canoe
-and seemed to drive him further and further from their village. Shining
-Star lay quietly in the bow of the canoe. She was too brave an Indian
-girl to cry but her eyes, peering through the driving rain toward White
-Eagle’s face, pleaded with him to get them safely home.
-
-And then, without warning, a great gust of wind caught the bow of the
-canoe and swung it hard. White Eagle leaned in the opposite direction to
-balance the canoe. Suddenly, the wind shifted. Before White Eagle had a
-chance to turn the bow into the wind, it caught the canoe again and,
-with a loud swish, turned it over into the lake.
-
-Amidst his surprise and confusion White Eagle’s first thought was for
-Shining Star. He heard the girl sputtering and coughing. He looked to
-see her head just appearing above the water beside the canoe. Reaching
-his hand out, he grasped her arm and pulled her to him. Then grasping
-the underside of the overturned canoe, he pulled Shining Star so that
-her arms rested on the canoe and she was able to grasp the keel.
-
-Thus the two children hung on for what seemed like hours but actually
-was only a few minutes. The water was cold. White Eagle began to shiver,
-not so much because the water was cold, but because the rain was colder
-and the biting wind made it even worse.
-
-And then as quickly as the storm had come, it was gone. White Eagle
-tried, but did not have the strength to hold on to Shining Star and turn
-the canoe. Just when he was giving up any chance of getting to shore,
-strong hands gripped his arms. It was then that White Eagle realized
-that he was losing consciousness. Everything went black.
-
-When he finally woke, he found that he was in his bed in his own wigwam.
-His mother was kneeling by him with a cup of hot broth. Slowly he
-sipped. And then he could hold back no longer.
-
-“My mother, what of Shining Star?”
-
-“She is all right, my son. You have done well this day. It was feared
-that you children would be caught in the storm, so your father and
-Shining Star’s father set forth in their canoes and reached you both
-just as you were slipping from the canoe. You are a brave lad, White
-Eagle, and your father is proud as is the father of Shining Star. You
-saved her life and she was brave, as you were.”
-
-
-
-
- A NEW BOW FOR TANI
-
-
-Tani was a small Cherokee lad who lived during the great Hundred Years’
-War between the Northern and Southern tribes. When he was twelve years
-old, Tani’s only wish was to own a bow like his father’s—a strong
-hickory bow with a stout hide thong and a quiver of straight strong
-arrows.
-
-Each time he would approach his father about owning such a bow, his
-father would laugh, and placing his hand on his son’s head, tell him in
-a kindly voice that he was still a little too young to handle a
-man-sized hickory bow. This always made Tani feel a little sad because,
-being a boy of twelve, he thought he was man enough to own one.
-
-One day Tani’s father called Tani to him and told him they would be
-going on a hunting trip and asked if he would like to go along. Tani was
-overjoyed and all he could think about for the next three days was the
-forthcoming trip with his father. When the time finally arrived, Tani
-prepared for the trip just as his father did and noticed his father
-place war paint on his face and chest and arms. Tani said good-bye to
-all, and when he said good-bye to his mother he noticed she was crying.
-He did not understand, for his father had not told him that the hunting
-trip they were going on was to seek out Talitanigska, one of the great
-Cherokee Chieftains, and report to him the movements of a large band of
-Seneca Indians. This was a very dangerous journey, for the Seneca
-Indians were deadly enemies of the Cherokee Tribe.
-
-As Tani and his father traveled swiftly along the back paths of the vast
-forests toward the encampment of Talitanigska, one thought kept rushing
-through the little brave’s mind: What great adventure was his father
-leading him into? Tani soon learned the answer to this question. That
-evening, as Tani and his father were seated at a small guarded fire off
-to the side of the trail, Tani’s father told him the nature of their
-task.
-
-The little brave’s heart pounded as he learned the reason for their
-journey. That night as they rolled in their blankets and slept, Tani
-dreamed of many Seneca Indians attacking his father and himself and of
-his standing back to back with his father, beating off the attackers.
-
-When the dawn broke, Tani and his father were on their way. They were
-careful to avoid any soft earth that might leave signs for roving
-Senecas to find and follow.
-
-About midafternoon Tani’s father turned into a shallow stream and
-started north against the current. Suddenly, his father slipped and fell
-heavily head first into the stream. Tani reached his father’s side and
-found his father could not stand. He helped him ashore and seated him
-against the trunk of a tree on the bank. A gash was red with blood
-across the forehead of Tani’s father. Tani saw that his father’s ankle
-was badly twisted. Not a word was spoken, but Tani built a small fire
-and made his father as comfortable as possible.
-
-For several hours as the sun slowly sank behind the hills, Tani’s father
-worried about the situation he and his son were in. He was tired and he
-must have dozed, for he woke with a start as he felt his bow being
-lifted from his fingers. He watched in silence as Tani fitted an arrow
-to the bow, pulled back the string and let fly. The arrow buried itself
-in a near-by bush. There was a thud, followed by a terrifying scream. A
-Seneca sprang up and fell dead across the path. Tani rushed forward and,
-having made sure their enemy was dead, returned to his father’s side.
-Without a word he continued his sleepless watch.
-
-The night passed without incident but as dawn approached, Tani heard a
-rustle in the near-by bush. He raised his bow ready to fire, but
-recognized the head feathers of his Cherokee brothers and let the bow
-drop to the ground. He leaped forward with a happy cry. The two braves
-were from Talitanigska’s camp. They quickly made a sling hammock to
-carry Tani’s father and soon the four of them set forth for the great
-Chieftain’s camp.
-
-Once safely within the camp, Tani’s father was well cared for and soon
-was able to stand once again on his injured foot. Two weeks after their
-arrival at Talitanigska’s camp a great council fire was held to
-celebrate the victory of the Cherokees over their enemies, the Senecas.
-As the festivities came to a close, Talitanigska stepped to the center
-of the ring and asked that Tani step forward. Then, in front of the
-great Cherokee Chieftains, Talitanigska took his stout hickory bow from
-his shoulder and placed it in Tani’s hands.
-
-“This is for you, Tani,” he said, “for you are a great brave and now a
-man among men. You stood full of courage in the face of great danger.
-Because of your quick thinking, you saved your father’s life and made it
-possible for your father to bring me the valuable information. This
-information helped our fellow tribesmen to meet and defeat the Senecas,
-our enemies.”
-
-Tani did not know what to say; but the following morning, as he and his
-father prepared to leave, he stepped in front of Chief Talitanigska and
-thanked him for the gift. He said he would always cherish the great
-hickory bow and remember the great kindness shown him by one of the
-great Chiefs of the Cherokee nation. Tani had his bow, just like his
-father’s. There was no happier brave alive as he tramped closely behind
-his father on the path home.
-
-
-
-
- SINGING WATERS AND THE MEDICINE WELL
-
-
-Singing Waters’ work as an Indian maiden in the Teton-Dakota tribe was
-typical of the work of Indian maidens across the continent. Each year
-she would make new clothing for her family and each day of the year she
-would cook and do the many little things that were the duty of a good
-Indian squaw. The work was hard but Singing Waters did not mind, for she
-loved her husband and her children and was very happy and proud to be
-able to help them.
-
-When she found that she had some free time, Singing Waters would join
-the other women of the tribe to boast about her husband’s great deeds on
-the hunt and in battle. This was a favorite pastime of all the squaws.
-They would spend many hours throughout the years to talk, over and over
-again about the adventures of their braves. Each time they would repeat
-the stories with even more enthusiasm.
-
-One day, all the tribe’s braves had left to hunt down a great buffalo
-herd for food and clothing for the tribe. Singing Waters was seated in
-front of her tepee, teaching her two daughters how to cook, when the
-morning sky grew suddenly very black. A great quiet fell upon the
-village. Even the dogs that seemed to spend their day barking for no
-good reason were silent. Singing Waters heard only the wind as it
-whispered through the village.
-
-Then from the distance, there came a rumble that seemed to come slowly
-nearer and nearer to the village. Singing Waters realized quickly that a
-dust storm was heading for her village. The other squaws had heard it,
-too, and were rushing to gather their children into their tepees and
-bind the skins across the entrances as tightly as they could. The dogs
-whimpered and scattered for whatever shelter they could find. The
-village did not have to wait long, for the winds were soon lashing
-against the tepees, straining their fastenings, and the dust was
-whipping through the village like a flood tide rushing over the rocks on
-the seashore.
-
-The dust reached into every opening in Singing Waters’ tepee. It wasn’t
-long before a fine coating of it covered everything and everyone inside.
-Her two daughters huddled close to her, crying slightly because of their
-fear of the storm. But soon the wind blew out of the village, and the
-last dust clouds settled to the ground. One by one the flaps of the
-tepees swung back. Mothers, children and old men began to come out. They
-found that many things, left outside in the haste of escaping from the
-storm, were covered with coats of light brown dust. Everyone began
-cleaning up the village and sweeping away the dust which had piled up
-against the sides of the tepees.
-
-While this was happening a young boy, named Fat Buffalo because he was
-short and very fat, came running through the village, crying that his
-mother was lost. Singing Waters halted him and shook him a little to
-make him stop his screaming. When he had quieted, she was able to learn
-that Brown Fawn, the boy’s mother, had left the tepee early that morning
-to seek fresh water. She had been gone only a little while when the
-storm struck. Now she was not back in the tepee and Fat Buffalo was
-frightened.
-
-Singing Waters was worried, but did not tell Fat Buffalo. She knew that
-an Indian woman out in such a storm might easily fall under the stinging
-pelting of the sand, only to be smothered by it. She might never be
-found unless, years later, new storms should blow away the dust and
-reveal the dry bones of a skeleton and a few bits of her clothing.
-Though Singing Waters felt panic in her heart, she quieted herself and
-spoke calmly to Fat Buffalo.
-
-“Go back to your tepee, Fat Buffalo, and wait. Your mother probably
-found shelter from the storm. Now that it has stopped she will be home
-soon. If it will make you feel better, I will go and look for her.
-Return now to your tepee. I wouldn’t be surprised if your mother were
-there already.”
-
-How Singing Waters hoped that Brown Fawn was back in the village by now!
-It would be almost an impossible task to find her here on the plains if
-she were dead or even hurt. First, Singing Waters would not know in
-which direction to start. The water hole that she and most of the tribe
-used was to the south, but there were many water holes in many
-directions from the village. Singing Waters decided that she should go
-to Brown Fawn’s tepee and find out if anyone else in the family knew in
-which direction she had gone.
-
-After warning her two daughters to stay close to home, saying that she
-would be back shortly, Singing Waters ran swiftly through the village.
-Reaching Brown Fawn’s tepee, she opened the tent flap and stepped
-inside. As her eyes grew used to the darkness, she saw Fat Buffalo
-kneeling in the far corner of the tepee, crying. Approaching slowly,
-Singing Waters saw that there was someone else in the tepee and that Fat
-Buffalo was kneeling next to that person. As she drew near, her heart
-was happy, for she thought that Brown Fawn had returned and was
-comforting Fat Buffalo. She was about to turn and leave when she
-suddenly realized that this woman was not Brown Fawn, but Fat Buffalo’s
-grandmother, Little Otter, who held the boy’s head on her lap.
-
-Singing Waters approached quietly and spoke softly to Little Otter. “Has
-Brown Fawn returned yet with the water?” she asked with slight hope in
-her voice.
-
-“No,” said Little Otter, “and it was because of me that she went in
-search of water. We have some water here in the tepee. But I have not
-been feeling well, and Brown Fawn thought that herbs brewed in fresh
-spring water from the rocks on the near-by hills might make a tea which
-would help my sickness to leave.”
-
-“But,” said Singing Waters, “the hills where the streams flow are many
-miles from here. If Brown Fawn left when the sun rose, then she might
-just have reached the spring when the storm came. She is probably on her
-way back to the village right now.”
-
-The sad news about Brown Fawn soon reached everyone in the village. Many
-anxious eyes watched the trail that led from the hills. Each person
-hoped to be first to catch sight of Brown Fawn and bring happiness to
-Little Otter and Fat Buffalo.
-
-Later that afternoon, Singing Waters came once again to Brown Fawn’s
-tepee. She talked quietly with Little Otter and then hurried back to her
-tepee and placed a warm buffalo jacket across her shoulders. Then taking
-her two little daughters, she went to her sister’s tepee and asked if
-she might leave the children there for supper while she went in search
-of Brown Fawn. Her sister looked at her and asked, “Why do you not wait
-until the warriors return? They should be coming any time now, and they
-could go in search of Brown Fawn! You have two little children to think
-about.”
-
-“Yes,” said Singing Waters, “I have two little children to think about,
-but we do not know when the warriors will be back. If the hunting is
-good they may not return for another week. Brown Fawn may not be too far
-from the village.” Nothing Singing Waters’ sister could say to her would
-change her mind. So she set out from the village toward the mountain
-spring known to the members of her tribe as the medicine well. It was
-getting late in the day, and Singing Waters knew that she must hurry if
-she were to reach the medicine well before sunset. She knew the trail
-well. As a girl she had followed it many times, for there always seemed
-to be some sickness in her village.
-
-Singing Waters finally came in sight of the ridge beyond which lay the
-medicine well, still having found no trace of Brown Fawn. Tirelessly,
-she trotted on until she had climbed the ridge and had worked her way to
-the place from which the water flowed into the medicine well. As Singing
-Waters approached the medicine well, she called Brown Fawn’s name
-softly, but heard no answer. Then she began to call more loudly.
-Suddenly, from far ahead she heard a voice answer. Now Singing Waters
-began to run, for she feared that Brown Fawn was in serious trouble. She
-ran until she reached the side of the medicine well, but still did not
-see Brown Fawn. Then she called again and the voice answered. “Help me,
-I am over here.”
-
-The voice was coming from beyond the medicine well. Singing Waters ran
-on further; then she stopped and called again. The voice replied again,
-and Singing Waters knew that she was closer. Brown Fawn’s voice seemed
-to be coming from just behind a rise ahead of her. She ran swiftly to
-the top of the rise, and there she found a water bag. As she looked down
-the side of the rise through the gathering gloom she could make out
-Brown Fawn’s figure down the side of the hill. She sat leaning against a
-boulder, and she called out to Singing Waters to help her. Singing
-Waters slipped and slid in her haste down the side of the hill until she
-was at the side of Brown Fawn. Brown Fawn was so glad to see her that
-she cried, great tears rolling down her now pale cheeks.
-
-Singing Waters could see that Brown Fawn had twisted her ankle. As she
-began to lift the injured woman, Singing Waters asked her how she had
-hurt herself and how she had escaped the storm. Brown Fawn told how she
-had reached the medicine well just as the dust storm had broken. After
-filling her water bag, she had turned quickly to go and had fallen,
-twisting her ankle. When she was once again able to rise, putting her
-weight on her other ankle, she found that she had lost all sense of
-direction and had started hobbling in the wrong direction.
-
-“Why didn’t you lie down among the rocks until the storm passed?”
-Singing Waters asked.
-
-“I wanted to rest,” Brown Fawn replied, “but then I would think of my
-mother and son and I felt I must return to her and Fat Buffalo
-immediately with the medicine water.”
-
-“But,” said Singing Waters, “you are safe now. Now we must return to the
-village while there is still a little light or we may become lost out
-here on the prairie far away from the warmth of our tepees. Come, Brown
-Fawn, lean upon me and I will help you to walk.”
-
-So Brown Fawn placed her arm across Singing Waters’ shoulders. Together
-they slowly started back to the village. It was dark by the time they
-had reached the fringe of the village, but bright fires had been lighted
-to show them the way home. There was much rejoicing as Singing Waters
-entered the village half carrying Brown Fawn. Gentle hands grasped Brown
-Fawn and placed her gently upon the buffalo robe in her tepee. Soon her
-eyelids flickered and she opened them wide, looking around for a face
-which meant much to her. But Singing Waters had returned to her own home
-and her children and was recounting for them the adventure she had just
-had. They smiled, knowing that their mother was a woman of great
-courage. They were very proud.
-
-
-
-
- THE WAR THAT SHOULD NOT HAVE HAPPENED
-
-
-Little Turtle was a young Comanche who lived happily with his mother,
-father, and two older brothers on the great prairies. His father was
-well respected by the tribe, above all for having three sons who would
-grow to manhood and bring honor to the Comanche name.
-
-Each day was a new adventure for Little Turtle and he welcomed each dawn
-with great excitement. He never knew just what was planned for him or
-what the other children of the village would decide to do, but he was
-always ready to take part in whatever would happen.
-
-For some time now, Little Turtle, who had just turned ten, had been in
-the complete charge of his father. On certain days his father would take
-him far from the village to hunt and learn how to stalk wild game and
-find their signs. He learned his lessons well. At night in the tepee, he
-would sit next to his father because he was the youngest, and he would
-listen carefully while his father explained many things a young brave
-must know to become a strong and great Comanche warrior.
-
-Because the Comanche village had been at peace for the last three years,
-Little Turtle had only love in his heart for everyone he knew or met.
-Sometimes his brothers and his father would speak to him of the hated
-Apache and Kiowa and the many reasons the Comanches had for hating them.
-But this meant very little to the lad. He never let such thoughts of war
-spoil his fun.
-
-One evening after the three boys were asleep, Little Turtle’s father
-spoke with his mother.
-
-“Blue Star,” he said, “for many days now I have talked to our youngest
-son of the Apaches and the Kiowas, but he does not seem to understand. I
-have told him of their many cruel ways and about our warriors who have
-fallen under the arrow and the tomahawk of the Apaches and the Kiowas.
-Still he refuses to speak harshly of such neighbors. Maybe Little Turtle
-is right. Maybe I am wrong in hating these neighbors to the north. You
-are wise, Blue Star. Your advice is often sought. Tell me now what I
-should teach our son. Shall I teach him to hate the horse stealers from
-the north? Or shall I not speak even their names in our daily talks?”
-
-Blue Star thought for a moment and then said, “My husband and great
-warrior of the Comanches, hatred is a word which Little Turtle will
-learn soon enough. Now he is young and innocent. He enjoys the coming of
-each new day for the adventures that it will bring in his world of
-dreams. He is a happy child and to us a very wonderful boy. Do we want
-to change this wonderful boy to a grown warrior filled with hate? He
-knows nothing but love. Possibly peace will be a long time upon our
-village. We, his parents, would not want to spoil that happy world in
-which he lives.”
-
-Great Hawk thought long about his wife’s words. Then he left the tepee
-to walk alone and solve this problem which lay so heavily upon his
-heart. Since his early days, Great Hawk had been taught to hate the
-Apaches and the Kiowas. His own father had lost his life in a battle
-with the Apaches. His brother’s hair now hung from the tepee of Grey
-Wolf, the Kiowa chieftain who sat at the head of the council lodge. And
-Grey Wolf was a cruel leader of a tribe that always looked for enemies
-to kill.
-
-Great Hawk knew that he had strong personal reasons for hating the
-tribes to the north. But was it right for him to think of punishing his
-son for not hating them, too, in the way he did? Until he had talked
-with Blue Star, he had planned to question his son tomorrow about the
-Apaches and Kiowas, and if his son did not show a growing hatred toward
-them, then he would punish him. But now he was not sure. No, he would
-wait and be patient. After all, as Blue Star had said, there had been
-peace for three years now. Thoughts of war were kept alive only by the
-young bucks of the tribe who were eager for battle and glory. War was
-far from the minds of the older and wiser men of the tribe. They knew
-that peace had brought them prosperity and happiness, but war made them
-poor and brought them hunger and pain and the death of friends.
-
-Great Hawk began thinking about Crooked Leg, one of the chieftains. He
-was the only member of the council of Comanche chieftains who was not
-happy that war had not come again.
-
-Early in his youth Crooked Leg had fallen into the hands of the Kiowas
-and had been tortured badly. When his body was found being dragged by a
-Kiowa pony that had been turned loose, he had been beaten and twisted so
-badly that he lay close to death for many months. He had lived, but his
-leg had never healed straight. He always rose in pain and could never
-run again. Crooked Leg had stayed behind in the village during all later
-battles. His hate for the Kiowa had grown until he now thought about it
-all the time. At council meetings, he would always argue that the
-Comanches should once again take to the warpath against the Apaches and
-Kiowas. Each time he spoke, only a few council members would agree with
-him. So Crooked Leg was asked to be quiet while the council talked about
-tribal business. But the young bucks who thirsted for the taste of
-battle would carry his words through the village after each council
-meeting. For many days, the village would talk for war and against war.
-Soon the wise council members would win out, the bucks would quiet down,
-and Crooked Leg would be left to grumble in his tepee alone and
-forgotten for awhile.
-
-Crooked Leg’s life had a lesson for Great Hawk. As he was returning to
-his tepee, he promised himself that he would not speak of hatred again
-to his son. He must not allow hatred to run his life as it had run
-Crooked Leg’s. If he did, even his friends might forget him and he would
-be of little use to anyone.
-
-The following day promised little peace. Dawn brought a roaring storm
-that smashed at the Comanche village. The pounding rain had soon churned
-the ground into deep mud. Families remained indoors and fathers sat
-around their fires teaching sons how to make stout bows and straight
-arrows, knives, tomahawks, and other handmade tools a young brave needs
-to survive. Great Hawk used the time to talk to Little Turtle of the
-great powers of nature and peace and the Comanche people.
-
-“As you grow,” he told Little Turtle, “remember to stay straight and
-true and do all things that are right, and you shall live a rich and
-happy life in our tribe. The Comanches have been favored greatly. We
-have lived in peace for the past three years and though it has been very
-dry, we have never been without water. Now the sky has opened and
-allowed the rains to fall so that we have water for our families and our
-horses. We have not suffered from great thirst since the great drought
-visited our land when we were last at war. After two years the supply of
-water was so small that our people were dying more from the great thirst
-than from the arrows of the enemy. Before long our chiefs sat down in
-council with our enemies to smoke the peace pipe. Now peace reigns over
-our people and they have plenty of food and water.”
-
-Little Turtle had listened carefully while his father was speaking, then
-turned to his mother and said, “Mother, I am a very lucky boy to be a
-Comanche and to have such a wonderful family. I have a strong, wise, and
-kind father. You have cared for me as a baby and given me good food so
-that my bones would grow strong and straight. And I have two brothers of
-whom I am very proud.”
-
-Blue Star smiled happily and began to make lunch. While the family was
-eating, the rain stopped. Soon the sun broke through the dark clouds and
-began to dry the earth. In the middle of the afternoon, Great Hawk rose
-and touched his son upon the shoulder.
-
-“Come, Little Turtle,” he said. “It is time you learned to ride a horse.
-We will go to my string of ponies and pick one that you may ride and
-call your own. If you are to go on the hunt and take part in the many
-other riding events in the village, you must learn to ride well.”
-
-Little Turtle’s heart leaped excitedly. He had been looking forward to
-the day his father would teach him to ride. Slowly Great Hawk and his
-son walked to where the tribe’s ponies were kept tied. Great Hawk began
-to look amongst the herd for a special pinto pony he had planned to give
-Little Turtle. It was small but strong and could run for a long time
-without getting winded. Great Hawk saw quickly that something was wrong.
-He began counting and discovered that three of his string, including the
-pinto, were gone. At first he thought that the storm had frightened them
-and they had broken loose from the main line which held the whole
-string. But as he reached the main line where the three ponies should
-have been tied, he saw the dangling ends of ropes that had been cut by a
-knife.
-
-The pony guard must have left the herd to seek shelter during the storm.
-So it was easy for someone to steal his three ponies. Without thinking
-of Little Turtle, Great Hawk knelt in the mud to look closely at the
-clear tracks that the thieves had left. He rose to his feet quickly.
-
-“The Apaches have stolen my ponies!” he cried out defiantly. “I shall
-ride after them and bring the ponies back even if blood must be shed!”
-
-Then he remembered Little Turtle. “Go, Little Turtle,” he ordered.
-“Return to the tepee and explain to your mother what I must do. The
-Apaches have stolen three of my best ponies. I must ride fast to catch
-up with them before they get too far into the hills. I shall not rest
-until the ponies are back in our village or the scalps of the Apache
-thieves hang in our tepee.”
-
-Then Great Hawk jumped onto a pony and sped off toward the hills.
-
-Little Turtle ran home and told his mother and brothers what had
-happened.
-
-Little Turtle’s brothers had been two of the young bucks who had agreed
-with Crooked Leg’s war talk. So they rushed out of the tepee, happy for
-this chance to fight. They stopped outside their tepee just long enough
-to pick up their weapons and shout the news to other young bucks of the
-tribe. Many of the young braves rallied quickly, grabbed their weapons,
-and dashed toward their ponies. This was just what Great Hawk had wanted
-to prevent. He thought that if he could overtake the thieves he would be
-able to bring them back as prisoners. Then the council of chieftains
-would decide how their stealing should be punished.
-
-Only three Indians—not a large Apache band—were fleeing with the ponies.
-Great Hawk saw this clearly from the tracks he was following. He thought
-it might be three young Apache bucks who wanted to start trouble and had
-turned to stealing horses as a way of making the Comanches angry enough
-to fight. He must hurry, for if he did not reach the thieves before they
-got to the safety of the hills, he would have to report their escape to
-the council. Even the older Comanche chieftains probably would decide
-that war was the only answer.
-
-When he reached the base of the hills, Great Hawk lost the trail of the
-thieves in the rocks. Slowly, he turned his mount and started for the
-village. This would now mean war. Great Hawk turned back toward the
-hills. Shaking his fist at the Apaches’ stronghold, he swore vengeance
-upon them. As he headed for home again, he met the war party of young
-Comanche bucks, led by his two sons.
-
-“Wait!” he said, raising his hand. “Why do you ride so hard?”
-
-“We ride to avenge the theft of your horses,” Great Hawk’s oldest son
-replied. “We will catch the Apache party and soak the foothills with
-their blood. No matter how many they are, we shall defeat them!”
-
-“Wait!” Great Hawk pleaded. “There were only three men. They are already
-in the hills. We will lose many men if we try to attack them here. We do
-not know this ground, but the Apaches know it well. We must take this
-problem to our council.”
-
-Just as Great Hawk spoke of the council, Crooked Leg rode out from
-amidst the young warriors. Great Hawk had not seen the old warrior who
-rode up close to Great Hawk.
-
-“Out of the way, old and weak one,” Crooked Leg screamed. “You are
-afraid of these thieving vultures who steal from us under cover of a
-great storm. We are not afraid and we will go on until we find them. We
-have sat back too long getting fat and lazy on the buffalo meat. We have
-closed our eyes to the Apaches’ great war plans against our village!”
-
-There were many shouts of approval from the young bucks, who were
-starting to move about impatiently.
-
-“Wait!” shouted Great Hawk above the yelling of the young Comanche
-braves. “This long-planned war plan against our village was carried out
-by just three braves, as the trail will show you. They did not attack.
-They killed no one. They only stole three horses. This was no attack by
-the Apache tribe. It was probably the work of three young bucks, like
-many of you here, who could not be held back. They went off on their own
-to try to stir up trouble between our two tribes. They baited the trap
-and you are riding right into it. What has happened here must be settled
-by our council. Do not let Crooked Leg drive you into something you will
-regret the rest of your lives—if you live to regret it!”
-
-The young men grew quiet as Great Hawk was speaking.
-
-“And now I speak directly to my two sons,” he continued. “I, your
-father, order you to return with me to our tepee.”
-
-But the fire that Crooked Leg had been building for so long burst into
-flame again as he urged the young bucks to go on. They surged forward
-toward the hills. Great Hawk was forced to rein his pony aside to avoid
-being run into. He knew that if Crooked Leg succeeded in clashing with
-the Apaches, he, Great Hawk, would lose importance in the tribe. But if
-Crooked Leg were defeated at the hands of the Apaches, the council would
-deliver fair judgment and punishment.
-
-The young Comanche men had never fought before and might be defeated
-easily. So for the sake of his sons, Great Hawk turned his pony and fell
-in with the young bucks. When they saw that he had joined them, they
-urged their ponies ahead at a faster pace.
-
-Soon they were deep in the hills of the Apaches. The party halted, and
-Great Hawk moved to the front. Grasping the bridle on Crooked Leg’s pony
-he swung the animal around sharply.
-
-“You will ride no farther,” he told the old warrior. “I command you to
-go back to our village now. We have no idea where the horse thieves are.
-You are willing to gamble the lives of these brave young Comanches to
-satisfy a hate that burns deeply in your heart and mind.”
-
-While Crooked Leg watched him angrily, Great Hawk spoke to the young
-men.
-
-“Your wish to see justice done is good,” he began. “But the Apache has
-great strength, even greater here in his own home. We are few and most
-of us have never fought. If we fight here, our scalps will hang in the
-tepee of the Apaches before nightfall. Do not follow Crooked Leg any
-longer. What he suggests can bring only death to yourselves and much
-sadness to your families. We must return to the council and seek the
-wise advice of our chieftains.”
-
-Great Hawk could see that his words were beginning to have an effect. He
-continued talking to the young bucks until their ranks began to break as
-a few turned their mounts toward home. Others followed, and Crooked Leg
-started screaming at them to come back and follow him to glory in the
-defeat of the Apaches. Then, just as the last few braves were heading
-back down the trail, the hills suddenly bristled with Apache warriors,
-each aiming an arrow at a young Comanche brave. As Great Hawk looked
-slowly around, he saw that there were twenty times more Apache than
-Comanche warriors.
-
-The Comanche party was stunned. No one moved. Then one brave made a grab
-for his tomahawk. Great Hawk slapped his arm, saying, “Do not be a fool.
-You would be dead before your hand touched the tomahawk handle. Right
-now at least a dozen arrows are aimed at your body. Your tepee will be
-unhappy tonight if you are so foolish.”
-
-Then Great Hawk rode out a little apart from the rest of the band.
-Raising his empty hands, he called to the Apaches.
-
-“Who among you is the leader, for it is with him that I wish to talk?”
-
-A tall, strong brave stepped from behind a boulder and made his way to
-the circle of warriors.
-
-“I, Maskan, am leader here,” he said. “Why do you ride into our lands in
-such haste and with such anger on your faces?”
-
-Then Great Hawk explained the events that had led up to this moment.
-When he finished, the Apache leader signaled, and three young Kiowa
-bucks were dragged from behind the boulders into plain sight of the
-Comanche party.
-
-“These,” said Maskan, “are the three who stole your horses and ours.
-Their blood has run hot with the desire for adventure. So all alone,
-they set out last evening to invade your land and ours to steal horses.
-We have waited for them here among the rocks. We have watched you from
-the time they were taken by our warriors. You who seem to lead here have
-spoken wisely. The Kiowas will be punished as all Kiowa are in the
-Apache nation. We have your horses. They will be yours again. We ask you
-to go in peace from these hills. You have come in anger. Now you can
-leave in friendship. The older men of your tribe and ours know the
-trouble we are having with our young braves who want the glory of
-battle. One day war will come when the chieftains who want it are strong
-enough to convince the council. That day is not far away. But now return
-in peace to your village.”
-
-Maskan turned and started for the boulder before Great Hawk could thank
-him. Maskan told his braves to bring out the stolen horses. At that
-moment Crooked Leg slipped his tomahawk from his belt and sent it
-sailing toward the Apache leader. It landed with a thud in the middle of
-Maskan’s back. Maskan cried out and fell to the ground, rolling in the
-dust. Immediately, Crooked Leg’s body was filled with arrows as shaft
-after shaft whined through the air. War whoops split the air as the
-Comanches rose to attack the Apaches who dodged behind the rocks that
-had sheltered them before.
-
-Great Hawk realized that it would be useless to attempt any talk of
-peace now. With a sinking feeling in his heart he, too, joined the
-battle, struggling to reach his two sons. The great numbers of Apaches,
-well protected by large boulders, made the victory easy for them. The
-young Comanches fell under the hail of Apache arrows, and their war
-cries became screams of pain.
-
-Then Great Hawk yelled to the warriors to retreat. The riddled band
-rushed toward their village. Sixteen young Comanche braves lay dead on
-the ground and seven strong Indian ponies were dead or dying. It was a
-ragged, tired, and bloody war party that entered the Comanche village
-that night. Badly beaten, their spirit defeated, they understood now
-that war was not as glorious as they had thought. As Great Hawk entered
-his tepee alone, Blue Star greeted him warmly but with fright in her
-eyes.
-
-“Where are our two sons, Great Hawk?” she asked. Great Hawk looked at
-his wife and then at Little Turtle.
-
-“Little Turtle, you have never learned to hate and you know nothing of
-war. Now both hatred and war must shatter your world of dreams. Your two
-brothers lie out there in the foothills, killed by sharp, well-aimed
-Apache arrows. They and fourteen others will no longer walk this earth
-with us. Among them lies Crooked Leg, who is to blame for these deaths
-today. Many Apaches and Comanches will yet die in a battle that never
-should have begun.”
-
-From that day forward, Little Turtle left his dream world and walked in
-the real world of warring tribes, learning to hate his tribe’s enemies,
-to fight and revenge the death of his brothers.
-
-The war continued for some time. Many Apache and Comanche braves were
-killed and injured. The council of Comanche chieftains met to discuss
-better ways of fighting the Apaches. Great Hawk, who had led so many
-attacks against the Apaches, stood in the council to speak. As he spoke,
-Little Turtle listened from just outside the lodge where he lay hidden.
-
-“I, Great Hawk, have fought many battles with the Apaches. I am tired
-but I will fight as long as we must. Before this war started, I had
-great hate in my heart for the Apaches and Kiowas, as many of you know.
-I tried to teach this to my son. I know now how wrong I was. My son
-could not bring himself to hate someone or something he had not seen and
-who had done him no harm. On that unhappy day which could have ended
-peacefully, Crooked Leg sent a tomahawk into the back of Maskan, a brave
-and fair-minded warrior who tried to keep the peace. Then the war
-started. Two of my sons fell dead at my side, but still I fought on.
-When we who were left managed to escape with our lives and return to our
-village, I had to break the sad news to my family. Yet from that moment
-I held no hate for the Apaches.
-
-“My oldest boys had gone from our village to follow Crooked Leg, a man
-whose whole life has been one of hate. They died because of that hate,
-though they died bravely, fighting as Comanches should. But now my
-youngest son has learned to hate as his brothers did and I am worried
-deeply. War comes with hate and is worse than disease or drought. The
-Comanches have always fought honorably, but Crooked Leg’s act will
-always dishonor our tribe. We cannot seek peace until we have cleansed
-our hearts of hate. We must do this for the happiness and well-being of
-our children and their children.”
-
-The council was silent for several moments after Great Hawk had spoken.
-Then one of the head chiefs rose slowly and looked directly at Great
-Hawk. “You have spoken wisely, Great Hawk,” he began. “We must think
-this over carefully. If we want peace, it must be genuine and honorable.
-Let us go back to our tepees. Let us call the council to meet in two
-suns and make our decision then.”
-
-When Great Hawk returned to his tepee, his son was waiting for him,
-having run ahead.
-
-“Do not be troubled, father,” Little Turtle said, “for I have driven the
-hate from my heart. I hope this war will end soon and that there will be
-no room in anyone’s heart for hate. For hate eats men’s hearts and makes
-them like Crooked Leg, unhappy and selfish and cruel, bringing death and
-sorrow to those around them. These things are not for the Comanches.”
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE HORSE AND THE PAINTED ARROW
-
-
-Little Horse was a member of the proud and courageous Delaware tribe. He
-grew up in his tribe among a people who were peaceful. They hunted and
-fished and sang and danced and celebrated much as most tribes did in the
-very early days, but there was to come a time when all was not peace and
-contentment.
-
-Little Horse had been well trained by his father, Running Bear, and he
-had taken his lessons as a young boy very seriously. Though he had
-practiced very hard, he had never become very good with the bow and
-arrow or the tomahawk. But he had become very good at using and throwing
-the traditional hunting knife which was his proudest possession.
-
-It was spring in the valley of the Delawares and day followed day with
-the peaceful and warm sun shining down upon the village in which Little
-Horse lived. Occasionally the soft rains would descend on the forest and
-hillside making everything wet and a rich green color. All was happiness
-in the village until that fateful day when Little Horse decided to take
-his long trip.
-
-Shouldering his stout bow and a quiver of arrows he started out along
-the forest trail. He desired to go to the upper end of the valley and
-search out some wild turkey which he had heard many of the returning
-hunters speak about. The fact that the place where these turkeys lived
-was almost a day’s journey from his village did not seem to bother him,
-for he had placed in his food pouch enough dried venison and he would
-have berries and nuts along the way.
-
-As he walked along, he looked from side to side watching for signs of
-wild game, not wanting to kill any so close to home but wanting to test
-his senses of hearing and sight which had been trained by his father so
-patiently.
-
-Once in a while, Little Horse would stop in his journey to partake of
-some fresh water or just to rest on a moss patch under some large tree
-and think about the wonders of nature and the wonderful peace in his
-tribe.
-
-Then he would rise and continue his journey which took him further and
-further from home with each step. And not realizing it, he had soon
-crossed into the land of the Iroquois, for his particular tribe had
-their village close to the line which separated the lands of the
-Delawares from the hunting grounds of the Iroquois.
-
-This talk of tribal lands and borders did not mean much to Little Horse,
-although he had heard his father speak quite often of the Iroquois; and
-though he had been told never to wander too far from the village, he
-felt he was grown up enough by this time to take care of himself. One
-other thing which meant very little to Little Horse was the fact that in
-this period, neighboring tribes were often at war with each other, for
-war between tribes was rather common among the American Indians.
-Stealing and quarreling among individuals and trespassing upon hunting
-grounds were but a few reasons for this constant state of war and
-feuding. But to a young lad like Little Horse, who was so wrapped up in
-his desire to hunt the elusive turkey, war and fighting were the
-furthest things from his mind.
-
-Meanwhile Running Bear, back at the village, was asking about for his
-son, for today he was to have taken him fishing in the great lake. No
-one seemed to know where the boy was until Running Bear asked a group of
-children playing on the edge of the village, and one of them replied
-that he had seen Little Horse with his food pouch at his belt and his
-bow over his shoulder trotting up the trail that led to the north and
-into the land of the Iroquois.
-
-Fear gripped Running Bear’s heart. Just that morning one of the hunters
-had returned from the forest to tell of having found three Iroquois
-painted arrows stuck in the ground in a row, which was a sign of open
-warfare and he had the three arrows gripped in his hand which had been
-found close by to the village. This could mean but one thing. For some
-reason the Iroquois had been aroused, and now no Delaware would be safe
-alone any great distance from the home encampment. As long as this open
-warfare lasted, now they would have to travel in groups.
-
-Running Bear feared for his son. So Running Bear gathered a few of his
-friends, and in a group they started up the trail toward the land of the
-Iroquois, hoping that Little Horse had not gone too far after all.
-
-But they were to be sadly disappointed, for Little Horse at this moment
-was deep in Iroquois territory on the trail of wild turkey.
-
-As Little Horse walked silently along the forest trails, he suddenly
-realized that it had become very quiet. He stopped to listen for the
-song of the birds but he heard none. He even found it so quiet that the
-breeze sounded like a windstorm. Someone or something else was near by,
-for only for that reason would all the forest creatures grow silent.
-
-Then he heard the call of one solitary bird ahead and off to the left.
-And then behind him to the right he heard a similar call and then Little
-Horse knew.
-
-It came upon him suddenly like a thundering in his ears. He realized
-that he was no longer in Delaware country, for this was the call of the
-Iroquois which his father had taught to him. But what had he to fear?
-The Delawares and the Iroquois were not at war, and so he boldly
-shouldered his bow and turned to start for home down the trail. But
-before he had taken two steps there was a loud whooping from many
-directions and before Little Horse could do anything, he was surrounded
-and his arms pinned by four husky Iroquois braves. One of them
-brandishing a shining knife was about to take the boy’s life when
-another brave stepped from the brush and spoke, “Put down your knife.
-This Delaware is tall, but he is only a boy.”
-
-“But he is still a Delaware,” cried the brave, holding the knife close
-to the heart of Little Horse.
-
-“No matter, he is young and strong. We will take him back to the village
-with us. We have not had much sport these days of late. This young one
-will make a fair game for us. We will have him run the gauntlet to see
-whether he will be permitted to live. I, Crooked Hand, have spoken.”
-
-Little Horse then realized that Crooked Hand must be some sort of leader
-in the tribe, for there was no more argument. The arms of Little Horse
-were then tightly bound behind him and he was roughly shoved along the
-trail toward the village from whence these warriors had come. His
-weapons had been gathered, and one of the braves carried these as the
-party trotted easily along the trail, pressing Little Horse before them.
-
-It was not too long after this that Running Bear and his rescue party
-arrived at the place where the struggle had taken place. It was soon
-evident to all the braves in the party that Little Horse had been taken
-prisoner, for once past the marks of the struggle, it was easy to pick
-out the markings of his moccasins in the soft earth of the trail and
-Little Horse had made sure to come down heavily on his feet in order to
-leave a trail plain enough for any who might follow to see.
-
-Running Bear and his party pressed forward, going more stealthily now,
-for they were deep in the territory of the Iroquois and from all signs
-quite close to the village. Suddenly Running Bear stopped and signaled
-the party to flatten themselves upon the ground. Through the trees he
-had seen the feather of an Iroquois and, hardly daring to breathe, they
-waited. Detection now would mean almost certain death, for they were
-tired from their long race through the forest and the Iroquois, being
-close to home and fresh, would have made easy victims of the Delawares.
-
-The lone Iroquois brave had stopped and looked around and then
-satisfying himself that nothing out of the ordinary was around had
-continued along the trail in pursuit of the rest of his party which had
-Little Horse captive.
-
-Running Bear, when he felt it was safe, gathered his friends about him
-and then spoke in a whisper.
-
-“We will wait until it is dark and then I will approach the village and
-see if it would be possible for us to rescue Little Horse and return to
-our village. It is very late and surely he will not be in danger
-tonight, for the thieving Iroquois will go into council to decide what
-to do with him. He is definitely a prisoner and most likely since he is
-young and strong but yet a boy they will make him run the gauntlet
-tomorrow as a test as to whether he will be permitted to live or must
-die.”
-
-When darkness fell, Running Bear slipped through the forest to the edge
-of the Iroquois village and there, hidden in the brush, he was able to
-view the happenings in the village. He noticed one particular wigwam
-being well guarded and this he presumed was where Little Horse was being
-held prisoner. Then as his eyes wandered about the village he noticed a
-number of older men entering the large council lodge.
-
-This was a fairly large village of the Iroquois, and Running Bear felt
-that it would be useless for his small band to attempt a rescue of
-Little Horse.
-
-Suddenly he heard a slight rustling to the side of the trail and peering
-into the darkness he saw the figure of a brave approaching the trail. He
-waited and when the brave was almost upon him he reached out and
-throwing his arms around the throat of the Iroquois he drove his knife
-into the brave’s heart.
-
-Without a sound the Iroquois slipped to the ground. Running Bear turned
-and fled back through the forest. They must leave the land quickly, for
-as soon as the dead brave was discovered a large party would be sent to
-look for the killers. So as soon as Running Bear had returned to his
-friends they made a hasty retreat from the vicinity of the village and,
-running at a steady pace, returned to their village to report the
-findings. Running Bear planned to gather a large force and the following
-evening they would attack the Iroquois village and seek to rescue Little
-Horse.
-
-Meanwhile Little Horse sat in the wigwam of the Iroquois village
-awaiting the decision of the council and it was not long in coming. Soon
-a rather tall Iroquois brave entered and standing in the doorway he
-informed Little Horse that the council had agreed to spare his life if
-tomorrow he could prove himself worthy of the gift of life by running
-the gauntlet.
-
-When the sun was directly overhead he would be placed at the head of two
-rows of Iroquois and at a given signal would run the gauntlet of war
-clubs prepared for him.
-
-It would be ridiculous to say that Little Horse was not frightened, for
-at this particular time Little Horse was a very scared little brave. He
-had known nothing but comfort and warmth and friendliness since the day
-he was born, and the loving care and kindness of his family and friends
-had been his only contact with Indian life. Here in the village of a
-tribe which he had not thought to be hostile, he suddenly found himself
-a prisoner and about to be forced to run the gauntlet of war clubs.
-
-He had heard a great deal about the gauntlet from his father who had
-witnessed the gauntlet and had told of his experience as one of the line
-of braves making up the gauntlet when they dealt with some of their
-prisoners.
-
-Little Horse was afraid, and his fear kept him from resting his body for
-the coming ordeal. Then in the midst of this fear which gripped his
-heart, Little Horse remembered the words of his father.
-
-“My son,” Running Bear had said to him one day, “if ever you should find
-yourself in trouble or in danger, remember that you are a Delaware and
-the Delawares are a strong and proud people. Rest as much as you can,
-force your body to relax so that you may be prepared for whatever ordeal
-you must face. You have been taught every skill possible except the
-skill of courage. This you must have in your heart and if courage abides
-in your heart as the beaver in the stream, then fear can be overcome and
-one can consider himself prepared for any hardship which may lie ahead.”
-
-Remembering those words was great comfort to Little Horse and again and
-again he kept repeating them to himself. Soon the chill that seemed to
-be in his body left him and the cold fear that gripped his heart
-released its hold and he was calm once again. When his body relaxed and
-his mind was at ease, Little Horse slept.
-
-No sense to worry over what tomorrow will bring, but remember the words
-of Running Bear. Twice more he repeated the words of his father to
-himself and with that he was asleep.
-
-He had not been asleep long when the door of the wigwam was darkened by
-two of the braves who had aided in his capture that afternoon. As they
-viewed the boy asleep on the floor, the taller of the two spoke.
-
-“He sleeps. Look how calm his face is. Notice the slight smile upon his
-lips. This is the sign of a growing warrior. Courage burns deep in his
-heart. For even now, knowing that tomorrow he may have to die, he sleeps
-the peaceful sleep of a baby. This lad can be no more than fifteen and
-yet he is tall and strong and he had a good face. For many moons we have
-been at peace with our brothers the Delawares and now war and
-bloodshed.” The other brave shook his head and, looking at the lad, he
-spoke.
-
-“If you had not been present when he was captured, his hair would now be
-hanging from the wigwam of the vicious one. He has the blood of several
-Delawares upon his hands now and one more would only have added to his
-greatness even if it were only the scalp of a boy.
-
-“Masi is a ruthless brave. Ever since he was beaten in battle by the
-brave Delaware, Running Bear, he has carried hatred in his heart for the
-Delawares. Their having sent hunting parties into the land of the
-Iroquois and taken game from our hunting grounds was all the excuse that
-was needed. And so our tribes are at war, and it will not cease until
-many are dead and there is much sadness in the wigwams of both tribes.”
-With these words, the warriors withdrew from the door.
-
-Little Horse had heard all and pondered the words of the Iroquois. He
-had not known that any of their tribe had invaded the hunting grounds of
-the Iroquois unless it had been himself. This troubled him, but he
-pushed the thoughts from his mind and slept once again. Because of his
-training he slept soundly and as dawn broke through the greyness he
-awoke feeling quite hungry and thirsty.
-
-The guards at his door looked in, and soon food and drink were brought
-to him. He ate hungrily and drank long of the cool water and when he had
-finished, his guards stepped forward and once again bound his wrists.
-However, they took him outside the wigwam and allowed him to walk up and
-down for a short while to give his muscles exercise. The morning passed
-quickly and soon it was time.
-
-Little Horse felt the old fear once again returning to his breast and
-now there was nothing he could do to force it back. As the guards
-approached they noticed Little Horse looking upward as if to speak with
-someone and it was true, for Little Horse was calling upon the powers of
-nature to give him strength at this hour of trial.
-
-His guards approached him and, grasping his arms, dragged him from the
-wigwam, for now fear had gripped the heart of Little Horse and he fought
-the hands of the Iroquois which held his arms in firm grip and he fought
-the tough thongs which bound his wrists. But twist and turn as he would,
-it did no good and soon he was standing before the elders of the tribe.
-
-Across the center of the village he saw the gauntlet of tall powerful
-braves begin to form and his legs trembled slightly. The elders talked
-among themselves, and then one old man stepped forward and spoke to
-Little Horse.
-
-“Your tribe has invaded the lands of the Iroquois in seeking wild game
-and in doing so they have broken the law of the tribes. If they had
-stayed on their own ground there would have been no need for war. But
-for the Iroquois to do nothing when their neighbor invades the sacred
-hunting ground would be as if we shouted through the forest that we were
-weak and afraid of the Delawares. You have been captured on our land and
-as an example to all Delawares you will be made to run the gauntlet. If
-you do so successfully your life will be spared, but if not the war
-clubs my braves now hold shall beat your body till it blends with the
-dirt of the forest floor and you are no more. Are you ready for the
-ordeal?”
-
-Little Horse held his head high and looking straight into the eyes of
-the elder warrior, he said, “I know not of any of our braves that
-invaded your hunting grounds unless it was myself. In pursuit of the
-wild turkey, I ran quickly along the trail and was in the land of the
-Iroquois before I realized. I did not think that the great Iroquois
-would miss one little wild turkey.”
-
-The old warrior looked stern and then he said, “It is not you but other
-braves of your tribe who have entered our grounds, but you and I are not
-here to argue, for I will not even discuss it, the law has been broken
-and war has been declared. Already the blood of one of our warriors had
-been spilled on the very edge of our camp.”
-
-With this statement the heart of Little Horse beat just a little faster,
-for if one of the Iroquois had died close to the village then the
-Delawares must have followed and there was still hope that he would be
-rescued.
-
-“I am ready for the gauntlet,” Little Horse said.
-
-With that he was dragged to the head of the two lines. He looked down
-the two long rows of warriors standing like statues with war clubs
-raised, each one hoping that his blow would be the one that would deal
-death to this Delaware. Then the signal was given, and Little Horse took
-a deep breath and started running with top speed. As he ran he ducked
-from side to side and hesitated, forcing one blow to come down too soon
-or miss entirely. Halfway down the line he had not fared too badly, but
-as he came to the second half he was thrown a little off stride and
-could not duck so many of the blows. Several landed rather solidly upon
-his back and shoulders and arms and he began to feel weak, but with a
-last spurt of speed he reached the end of the line just as the club of
-Masi glanced off the side of his head. Instead of slumping to the ground
-between the two rows, Little Horse fell forward clear of the line and as
-Masi raised his club to strike again the elder stepped forward and
-raising his arms he said,
-
-“Cease, Masi, for the boy is clear of the gauntlet. He has received
-quite a beating, but breath still stirs in his body. He is a brave lad
-and has earned the right to live.”
-
-Little Horse was then carried to a wigwam where his bruises were cared
-for. Food and water were brought and he was made comfortable. The tall
-warrior that had prevented his death upon the trail entered the wigwam
-and spoke with Little Horse.
-
-“O my brave young man, you have proved to be quite courageous this day,
-and the Iroquois admire the courage of even their enemies. You will rest
-now and when you are well we will talk.”
-
-With that he left the wigwam, and sudden darkness came once again to
-Little Horse as he fell unconscious.
-
-Meanwhile Running Bear had gathered quite a force of Delawares and was
-approaching the village from the south. Advance scouts who had been near
-the village of the Iroquois throughout the day reported the gauntlet and
-the exact location where they had placed the boy.
-
-Running Bear swiftly gave his orders and the band advanced at a quicker
-pace, spreading out so that by the late afternoon a strong semicircle of
-Delaware braves surrounded the Iroquois stronghold.
-
-At a given signal from Running Bear, the attack was on. The attack was
-such that the Iroquois were caught completely by surprise. Though the
-band of attacking Delawares was much smaller than the number of Iroquois
-in the village, they swooped into the village to surprise the guards
-surrounding the wigwam of Little Horse.
-
-They rushed in and gathering the body of the still unconscious boy they
-rushed out again and into the forest, and were away before the Iroquois
-had gathered themselves together. By the time the Iroquois were ready to
-do battle, the Delawares had left, leaving the bodies of four Iroquois
-and two of their own attacking party dead upon the ground surrounding
-the wigwam where Little Horse had been held captive.
-
-Once the rescue had been accomplished the attacking Delawares did not
-wait to join in battle with the now furious Iroquois but sped swiftly
-toward the south and the safety and security of their own village. They
-traveled at a very fast pace and though it was growing dark it was not
-long before they had placed many miles between themselves and the
-village of the Iroquois.
-
-Onward through the night and into the next day they pressed until soon
-they could see the smoke of the Delaware village. They arrived in the
-middle of the village among the welcoming shouts of their friends and
-families who had awaited their return with growing anxiety.
-
-Without a moment’s hesitation, Little Horse was placed in the warmth and
-seclusion of his father’s wigwam and when his hurts had been attended
-to, his father knelt by his side to add what comfort he could, and to
-add his praise to the courage of the boy. He promised that he, Running
-Bear, would not rest until he had paid back the Iroquois for the
-injuries they had inflicted upon his son.
-
-“Now rest, my son,” Running Bear said, “and when you have rested and
-eaten we shall talk some more.” Running Bear turned to leave but Little
-Horse placed his hand upon his arm and bade him stay.
-
-“Wait, my father, for there is something I must tell you. While at the
-village of our neighbors the Iroquois I learned why it was that they had
-declared war upon the Delawares. It was reported to them that the
-Delawares had invaded their hunting ground and made off with many kills.
-This being a breach of the peace between the tribes, they had no choice
-but to declare that war existed between their own tribe and that of the
-Delawares.”
-
-“This is a serious matter, my son,” said Running Bear, “for we have had
-plenty of food on our own land and I see no reason for any of our braves
-going into the land of the Iroquois to hunt. But this matter is of grave
-importance and we must hold a council immediately, for the Iroquois are
-probably at this very moment preparing a great dance, since tomorrow
-they will no doubt move to attack our village.”
-
-With that, Running Bear left his wigwam and calling the elder braves
-together, they immediately went into council. After telling the council
-all that his son had reported to him, Running Bear asked that the tribe
-be assembled and told of the situation that existed. The council agreed
-and very shortly the whole tribe was gathered in the center of the ring
-and one of the elders rose to speak.
-
-“The Iroquois have declared war, and Little Horse tells us that the
-reason for this is that some of our braves have invaded their hunting
-grounds to kill the swift deer. If this is true we have done the
-Iroquois a grave injustice. The forest and fields of our land have
-yielded us much food this past year and I see no reason for having left
-our lands to hunt elsewhere. Who among you has caused the wrath of the
-Iroquois to be brought down upon our heads?”
-
-One at a time the leaders of the families stepped forward to deny that
-they had left the sacred hunting grounds of the Delawares until all had
-spoken. When no one had accepted the guilt, Running Bear rose and spoke.
-
-“If no one of our village has violated the sacred lands of the Iroquois,
-we have committed no crime. Of this I must speak further. For at this
-moment the Iroquois are probably on their way to our village to seek
-revenge for our attack last night. I will take with me two warriors and
-without weapons we shall go to speak of peace with our neighbors, the
-Iroquois.
-
-“Already seven brave young men are dead, and my own son lies hurt and
-bleeding in my wigwam. In order to prevent the shed of further blood, I
-must go to meet the oncoming Iroquois with only talk of peace.
-Somewhere, somehow, an injustice has been done, and we must right this
-wrong before peace can once more prevail over our land.”
-
-With that, Running Bear selected two stout warriors and leaving their
-weapons behind they proceeded at a steady pace back up the path toward
-the Iroquois country. They traveled swiftly and many hours later Running
-Bear suggested they stop and rest.
-
-As the three warriors rested at the side of the trail, they were
-suddenly surrounded by many Iroquois braves. Their arms were tightly
-bound and menacing motions with tomahawk and knife were made. But the
-same warrior that had prevented the death of Little Horse stepped
-forward and, raising his arm for silence, he spoke to Running Bear.
-
-“You appear to be the leader of this small party and I ask you why you
-come to the land of the Iroquois without arms when open war exists?”
-
-Running Bear spoke loud and clear for the whole Iroquois war party to
-hear. “I, Running Bear, with my two fellow warriors come in peace to
-speak with the council of the great Iroquois. As you can see, we carry
-no arms and we rested in the open along the trail, hoping that we would
-find our Iroquois neighbors before they and the Delawares shed each
-other’s blood once again.”
-
-The Iroquois brave said nothing, but having the wrists of the three
-Delawares bound they were herded along the trail back to the camp of the
-Iroquois.
-
-As the party entered the camp they could hear much moaning and crying
-from the families of the Iroquois that had been slain and also they
-observed the menacing looks as the people of the village crowded around
-the party, pressing ever closer hoping for a reason to swing a club or a
-tomahawk or drive a knife deep into the head or hearts of these
-Delawares who so boldly approached the village without arms.
-
-But the tall leader of the war party guided them safely to a wigwam
-where they were placed under heavy guard until the council lodge had
-been prepared for the great council.
-
-When the elders and wise men of the tribe had gathered, the prisoners
-were led before them. Running Bear spoke briefly of their mission and
-then in a loud clear voice he said,
-
-“The Delawares have sworn to their chiefs that none among our village
-have invaded the hunting grounds of the Iroquois and therefore there is
-no need for war between us.”
-
-There was some hushed conversation and then one of the elders spoke to a
-guard at the door. “Summon the warrior known as Masi.” Masi was brought
-to the council and the elder who had summoned him spoke.
-
-“Masi, it was you who reported to the council of the thievery of the
-Delaware and it was you who brought to our council the entrails of a
-deer to prove before the council your story of having seen the hunting
-party of Delawares invade our lands and kill much wild game. Now tell
-these warriors who come to us from the Delawares that you have seen this
-with your own eyes.”
-
-Masi spoke and told of having seen a hunting party of some fifteen
-braves of the Delawares stalk, kill, and strip the carcasses of several
-deer and take several wild turkey and other wild game. When he had
-finished, the council looked first at Masi and then at Running Bear. The
-elder was about to speak once more when the tall warrior who had saved
-the life of Little Horse stepped forward and spoke to the council.
-
-“I do not know why,” he said, “but my heart tells me the Delaware speaks
-truth. For many weeks now Masi has brooded over the death of his sister,
-and his mind has not been quite right since she died of the great
-sickness. We know that Masi has been a great warrior, but ask him once
-again to repeat what he saw. For when he first told his story the
-hunting party of Delawares were six in number. Suddenly they have
-increased to number fifteen.”
-
-“Yes, yes,” cried Masi, “and there have been many, many more since that
-day. If we are not careful they will be in our village in one more sun
-and we shall all be murdered in our sleep.”
-
-With that, Masi began to scream and he threw himself upon the ground,
-tearing at the ground and bemoaning the death of his young sister whom
-he had loved dearly. He was truly a grief-stricken brave gone mad.
-
-The elder who seemed to be a leader in the council stepped forward then
-and placing his hands upon the shoulders of Running Bear, he said,
-“There has been a great wrong done here, and we must sit and smoke the
-peacepipe together. We ask forgiveness, for we have wronged each other
-greatly. Once again peace shall exist between the Iroquois and the
-Delawares and let us not allow anything to break that peace. Brothers we
-have been in the past, and brothers we will be again. Come sit with us
-and we shall smoke the pipe.”
-
-With that, the peacepipe was passed from hand to hand and when all had
-smoked, food and drink were brought. Then there was much rejoicing as
-the village was told of the results of the council meeting. Loaded down
-with gifts, Running Bear and his two warriors returned to their village
-with the word of peace.
-
-After telling of the good news, Running Bear went to his wigwam where he
-found Little Horse now able to sit up and partake of solid food. He
-seated himself next to his son and once again praised him for the
-courage he had showed and explained to him how important the information
-he had brought had been—how he, Running Bear, was able through talk with
-the council of Iroquois to bring about peace between the Delawares and
-the Iroquois.
-
-
-
-
- FALLING WATER EARNS A FEATHER
-
-
-Falling Water came galloping into the Dakota-Sioux camp on his brand-new
-pony. The pony had been a present from his uncle, Walking Bear, one of
-the leaders of the tribe. Proudly Falling Water rode it up and down
-through the camp so all the other young braves could see what a
-beautiful pony he had. When he felt that everyone had seen the pony he
-rode swiftly back to the tepee of his father and dismounting ran to show
-his father the fine gift.
-
-One Horn, so named because he had lost an ear in a battle with a band of
-Shoshone braves a few years ago, stepped from the tepee and admired this
-fine gift.
-
-“It is a strong pony and a young one, my son. Treat it well, for a horse
-can be your best friend.”
-
-“Yes, father, I will take good care of the pony and I will ride him on
-the hunt. I am now a man and with my own weapons and my own horse, I can
-now go on the hunt.”
-
-“Yes, my son. In fact tomorrow your uncle is leading a hunting party in
-search of the buffalo, for it is almost time for the big buffalo hunt.
-So see to your weapons and be sure you are ready for the great hunt.”
-
-Falling Water rushed into the tepee and the rest of the day he spent
-working on his weapons in preparation for the hunt. He was sixteen now
-and considered a man but until now he had not been on any of the big
-hunts, for he had been sick the season of the hunt last year and now he
-was well and strong and prepared to ride with the best of them.
-
-The following morning, Walking Bear gathered the warriors about him and
-made sure that all were prepared for the trip ahead.
-
-“We will divide into three groups and go in different directions. When
-the sun has crossed the great sky twice we will meet where the
-Whispering River flows. There we will compare what each group has found,
-and the largest herd shall become our target. Let me warn you each and
-every one that though we are hunting buffalo, we must be ever aware that
-our enemies the Shoshones are all about us and we must be on guard that
-these jackals do not add our scalps to their belts. Calling Hawk, you
-will lead one party, Speaks Like Thunder, you will lead the second
-party, and I will lead the third. Good hunting, and may we all meet with
-our hair still upon our heads, come the end of the second day.”
-
-So it was that Falling Water, in Calling Hawk’s party, was off on an
-adventure that was to earn him his first feathers for bravery.
-
-Calling Hawk led his party to the west, for scouts had reported a fine
-herd of buffalo moving in that direction. The party moved steadily along
-keeping their eyes alert for signs of dust clouds that would signify a
-moving herd or horsemen. One or two braves were sent ahead to sweep wide
-of the main party to see what they could possibly find. From time to
-time these scouts would ride back to the main party and two more would
-take their place.
-
-The first day ended with no sight of buffalo or of marauding Shoshones,
-and the group made camp in a small clump of trees.
-
-The following morning after a breakfast of pemmican they were on their
-way once again.
-
-It was late in the morning when a scout riding hard brought his pony to
-a halt in front of Calling Hawk. He reported that he had spotted a herd
-of buffalo about a quarter of a mile ahead of the group. And so the
-party quickened its pace and soon came to the top of a rise. There below
-it on the prairie was a fine large herd of buffalo. They were not moving
-and therefore no dust cloud had been seen.
-
-Calling Hawk asked two of the braves to remain and keep watch on the
-herd while the others continued to the Whispering River which was but a
-short distance ahead, there to join with Walking Bear and make their
-report.
-
-Unknown to Calling Hawk and his party, the herd had also been seen by a
-hunting party of Shoshones, slightly larger than the Dakota-Sioux party,
-and also at the same time they had seen the party of Calling Hawk. As
-the Sioux moved toward the river, the Shoshones moved parallel awaiting
-the best place to attack.
-
-And now it was Falling Water’s turn to ride scout and he moved out from
-the party. He rode hard to get a long lead on the party and then began
-to move steadily to the side of the group and ever toward the river.
-Soon he felt it was time to return to the group.
-
-It was getting late in the afternoon, and as he turned to return he saw
-to the north a small cloud of dust. Urging his horse to the top of a
-near-by rise he slid from his back and, crawling to the very edge,
-peered over into the valley below. There he saw a sight which made his
-blood run hot.
-
-A band of perhaps twenty Shoshones were riding hard toward the
-unsuspecting Sioux party which was about twelve in number. Quickly
-mounting his horse, Falling Water rode like the wind back toward his
-brothers. Finally coming over a slight hill he saw the party moving
-slowly forward. Then he began to shout his warning of Shoshones and
-Calling Hawk called his party to a halt.
-
-Falling Water galloped up and reported what he had seen. Quickly the
-Sioux formed a line and drawing their weapons they moved forward to meet
-the Shoshones.
-
-Soon the Sioux saw the oncoming enemy and urged their horses to even
-greater speed.
-
-The two groups clashed, and there was a mixture of rearing horses and
-screaming men. Knives flashed and arrows swished through the air, some
-flying harmlessly or some thudding into flesh.
-
-Falling Water, right in the middle, rode toward a large Shoshone buck.
-As he did, a knife thrust slashed his arm and he dropped his weapons,
-but now he was too close to the Shoshone to stop the forward move of his
-horse. Ducking under the slashing knife of the Shoshone warrior, he
-placed his hand upon the brave’s shoulder and pushed. The brave was
-thrown off balance and almost lost his seat and, while he was trying to
-regain his seat, Falling Water dashed to the outer circle.
-
-Soon the fight was over and twelve Shoshones and three Sioux lay dead
-upon the ground while a badly beaten group of Shoshones beat a hasty
-retreat into the distance. The felled warriors were placed across their
-horses’ backs, and the group continued to their meeting place.
-
-When Calling Hawk reported to Walking Bear their fight with the
-Shoshone, Walking Bear ordered a return to the village.
-
-When the party entered the village the people were immediately aware of
-what had happened because of the bodies and the Shoshone scalps hanging
-from the belts of several warriors.
-
-That evening a council was held, and Falling Water rose to report to the
-council of his great deed of courage. He had rushed in and touched an
-enemy while still alive. When he had finished, Walking Bear said,
-
-“Are there any here that were witnesses to this event?”
-
-Calling Hawk stepped forward and in very descriptive words retold the
-event. The others told their stories of bravery and then Falling Water
-was called before the chief, his uncle.
-
-“I am very proud of you, my brother’s son. You have proven yourself a
-great warrior this day and for that you shall be privileged to wear two
-eagle feathers.”
-
-There were many shouts of praise and approval, and Falling Water felt a
-warm glow as his father placed his hands across his shoulders and said,
-“I am proud of you, my son.”
-
-Today Falling Water had earned his first feathers.
-
-
-
-
- THE RACE WITH DEATH
-
-
-In the high range of mountains lived the great and powerful Apaches. For
-many, many years the war between the Long Knives and the Apaches had
-been waging back and forth.
-
-The Long Knives, as the white men’s cavalry were known in those days,
-had at last worked out a treaty with the Apaches and all was peaceful
-for the time being. With the coming of peace to the Apaches, the return
-of normal family life was slowly but surely noticed by the younger of
-the warriors.
-
-There was more time now to teach the young braves their lessons, and the
-women were happier than they had been. For the past few years all the
-talk had been of war and killing, but now conversation turned to other
-topics. Of course there were a few young bucks who still chanted for
-war, but the wiser chiefs desired to stay at peace for as long as was
-possible.
-
-One evening some of the older chiefs were seated around the fire smoking
-and talking to pass the evening hours away when their attention was
-called to Chief Running Dog, one of the older chiefs of the tribe, who
-had been sitting quietly in the circle not saying much but gazing off
-into the night as if he were looking for something.
-
-Twisted Wolf spoke. “What do you look for, friend Running Dog? Do you
-see something in the distance with those old eyes that the rest of us
-should be looking for?”
-
-“No, Twisted Wolf, I do not look for anything in the present, but rather
-I am looking far into the past, to a time when I was just a small boy
-and there had been peace and happiness in our tribe for many years.”
-
-“Why should you think about the past now, old one? Is there something
-particular that you are trying to recall?”
-
-Running Dog laughed, “Oh, I do not have to think too hard to recall what
-I want to think about. Something happened when I was a young boy that I
-shall long remember. Some of you should remember this one adventure too,
-for some of you were just about my age at the time.”
-
-“Tell us,” they cried, “tell us what adventure you recall as a boy.”
-
-“Well,” said Chief Running Dog, “the story I remember is one which my
-father liked to call the Race of Death. But I do not want to bore you
-with tales of my childhood. They are only memories of an old man who
-lives in a world of dreams.”
-
-“Now, Running Dog, do you want us to coax you? I have never known you to
-need prompting to tell a story. Why do you need coaxing at this time?”
-
-“Well, it is not a funny story and to me at the time it was not a very
-nice experience to go through. Just recalling it brings back some of the
-fears which filled my heart at the time. But, if it is your desire, then
-I shall tell you the story. Fill your pipes and settle back, because it
-is quite a long story and we will be here at the fire for some time
-until I have finished. But remember that I warned you. If you get bored,
-it is your own fault, for you have asked for this story.”
-
-“Do not ramble, Running Dog. Get on with the story.”
-
-So it was that Running Dog, old Apache warrior, told his story that
-evening on the plateau of Apache country around a blazing council fire
-with his friends there to relive the experience of his childhood once
-again.
-
-“It was many years ago,” Running Dog began. “The Apache village in which
-I lived had a very long and difficult time of sickness. Many of our
-number had died of the great coughing sickness which the Long Knives
-call pneumonia, but it seemed that at last the sickness was leaving us
-and our people were returning to a time of good health and prosperity.
-There was much mourning for loved ones, but our family had been very
-lucky. My father and mother had both survived the epidemic and I, their
-only son, had been well all through the siege of sickness.
-
-“The sick continued to get well and little by little the tribe returned
-to its normal activity. Once again the contests and games took place and
-there was much joy at the ceremonial dances and feasts.
-
-“It was just after one of these feasts that my friend White Cloud and I
-decided to take a hunting trip into the far hills. We sought the
-permission of our fathers, and packing some food and blankets we placed
-these upon a pack horse and started off for the distant high mountains.
-
-“What exactly we were going to hunt we did not know, but we were so
-excited about the prospect of living by ourselves for a few days that
-the problem of what to hunt did not seem to bother us too much at the
-time.
-
-“One thing my father had cautioned me about. ‘My son, Running Dog,’ he
-said, ‘on your trip be aware of any strangers. Not too far to the north
-is the land of the Kiowas and they have been seen recently in this area.
-Just a few scattered here and there, but you and your friend White Cloud
-are riding two very fine ponies; and the Kiowas, I am sure, would like
-nothing better than to return to their village in the possession of
-three more very fine Apache horses, for their very life is one of horse
-stealing. The pack horse you take is just as strong and fast as the
-other two, so be careful and do not get careless on your trip. You are
-old enough now to realize the dangers an Apache faces in this country.
-
-“‘Besides the wandering Kiowas you had best be alert to the cats that
-roam the rock ledges. Keep your bow and arrow handy and make sure your
-hand is steady, for you will get but one chance to stop the wild leap of
-a mountain lion if he chooses to spring. Now I must bid you good-bye. I
-have asked the gods to protect you and your friend White Cloud. May they
-guide you safely to a successful hunt and a safe return to your homes
-and your families. I will ride part way and see you on your way. Come, I
-will get my horse.’”
-
-So the two boys, along with Running Dog’s father, rode to the edge of
-the camp and a little way farther on, where Running Dog’s father bade
-them a fond good-bye once again and turned to return to the village.
-
-The two boys waved until they were out of sight and then concentrated on
-the long trip they felt they must make before they would enter good
-hunting territory. As they rode they kept careful watch along the trail
-for signs of anyone having recently been there.
-
-Occasionally they saw signs where Indian ponies had been but these were
-all many days old. They found evidence too of wild game, but at no time
-did they catch sight of anything more than a rabbit or two.
-
-After traveling most of the day and stopping only for lunch the two boys
-decided to halt and make camp for the night. They found a beautiful spot
-near a water hole and after staking their horses out they unrolled their
-blankets and prepared the evening meal. In the darkness they could hear
-the coyote baying at the moon and Running Dog remarked how sad and
-plaintive was the call of the coyote. White Cloud agreed, “Yes, Running
-Dog, it is quite a sad sound, but after all the coyote is a very lonely
-animal. You too would not feel much like laughing if you had to spend
-all of your life alone without friends.”
-
-The two boys laughed and then wrapping themselves in their blankets were
-soon fast asleep.
-
-The following morning the boys rose and after eating breakfast, packed
-their equipment once again and were soon on the trail, traveling ever
-northward. Soon they had entered land that was not at all familiar to
-them, but they began to notice plentiful signs of game and so they kept
-eagerly onward.
-
-“Look,” cried Running Dog, “pony tracks, and they are fresh. Not too
-long ago Indian ponies passed this way. In fact I would say they are not
-more than a day old. See, it has been damp here and the impression of
-the ponies’ hoofs has not had time to harden through. I wonder though,
-White Cloud, why our brothers would be this far north?”
-
-White Cloud thought for a moment and then he said, “But, Running Dog,
-you do not think that we are the only ones off on a hunting party. These
-are probably the tracks of some of our men who are also seeking game and
-have come this far north in search of it.”
-
-“That may be true, White Cloud; on the other hand, these may be the hoof
-prints of Kiowa ponies and if so then we are much further north than I
-figured and are now in Kiowa territory. That is not a healthy place to
-be.”
-
-“What should we do, Running Dog?”
-
-“I do not know. For if we are in the land of the Kiowas we should turn
-and return to our own land; but if we are not and these are the tracks
-of friendly Apaches we would be silly to turn back, for only now have
-the signs of game become plentiful. The problem is whether we should
-stay and take our chances or return empty-handed with our tails between
-our legs.”
-
-“You are older, Running Dog, you make the decision.”
-
-“All right then, we shall stay and take our chances. I have seen many
-signs of deer and we shall find ourselves a large buck to kill before we
-return to our village. But come, it is getting late. Let us find a good
-place to camp.”
-
-The two young braves traveled a little farther on, and then when they
-both agreed that an ideal place was not to be located, they settled for
-a small clump of trees nestled in a gully. There was water not too far
-distant, and about two hundred yards from where they camped, there was a
-large mass of rock ledges that rose up from the ground, eventually
-growing into a cliff. In among these boulders and rock ledges they were
-able to find a source of water, and so they decided to make this their
-base of operations.
-
-To the west of where they camped they had seen a small woodland and
-swamp area which they figured would make a good hunting place for wild
-game. The boys went about setting up their camping ground and when they
-had completed the task at hand they settled down to going over their
-hunting equipment.
-
-The two boys having checked their bows and arrows went off to attempt to
-find some fresh meat for supper. White Cloud headed for the woodlands to
-the west and Running Dog started for the rock formation to the north.
-After about two hours of hunting and searching, Running Dog returned to
-the campsite empty-handed, but soon he saw his friend White Cloud riding
-like the wind toward the camp.
-
-Slung over his horse’s neck was an object that flopped loosely back and
-forth as he rose. Soon he was in the camp and swinging down from his
-pony’s back he placed a plump young rabbit on the ground in front of
-Running Dog and smiled, saying, “Here, little friend, is our dinner for
-tonight.”
-
-Soon the fire was blazing, and the two boys settled down to a delicious
-meal of roast rabbit. When they had finished their dinner they rolled up
-in their blankets and were soon asleep. Tomorrow was going to be a long
-day, for they were determined to track down some large game and make
-their kill, for their supplies were running low and they must start the
-return trip to the village the following afternoon.
-
-The night passed without incident and when the dawn broke it was raining
-slightly. The two boys looked at the heavens frowning, but in about a
-half hour the sky had cleared and the sun shone through again.
-
-The boys started off for the woodland and their big game hunt. They had
-not gone very far when Running Dog glanced up toward the high rock
-formations. He did not know what caused him to look in that direction,
-but suddenly he stopped and called to White Cloud who had been riding a
-little ahead, anxious to reach the woods.
-
-“Wait, White Cloud. Look, look to the north, beyond that formation of
-rocks.”
-
-White Cloud turned and gazed in the direction Running Dog pointed. There
-rising above the rock formation were puffs of smoke. “Maybe it is the
-campfire of another hunting party, Running Dog?”
-
-“No,” said Running Dog, “that is not campfire, those are Kiowa smoke
-signals. I will try to make them out.”
-
-“Are you sure they are Kiowa smoke signals, Running Do?”
-
-“Oh yes, White Cloud, many moons ago my father taught me of the Kiowa
-smoke signals. Though all tribes use this method the Kiowas have a
-definite series of signals before their message. Look, White Cloud. See
-that series of short puffs of smoke? That is peculiar only to the
-Kiowas. Let me see if I can make out what they are sending.”
-
-The two boys sat astride their ponies watching the signals of smoke rise
-in the distance. Running Dog studied the signals as diligently as he
-could and seeking back into his memory for everything his father had
-taught him about smoke signals.
-
-Then he turned to White Cloud, “Come, my friend, we must hurry. Those
-signals are to a band of Kiowas to the south that we are here in their
-hunting grounds and therefore have broken the law of the Kiowa and must
-die. They are calling to this band to bring our scalps on their war
-lances triumphantly to the village. We must hurry, White Cloud. There is
-no telling how long that message has been playing in the sky. We did not
-notice it until now but that does not mean that it has not been sent
-before just now. We must ride to camp and take our other horse and start
-for home.”
-
-The two boys wheeled their ponies about and sped back for the camp. They
-entered the camp and quickly gathering their possessions together they
-put them aboard the pack horse and climbing upon their own ponies they
-started swiftly southward. They rode steadily for about an hour, and
-then Running Dog pulled up his pony.
-
-“Wait, White Cloud, we are doing just what they wish us to do. We are
-running and we have a long hard trip to make. Besides, that signal was
-evidently for a band to the south of our camp. If we are not careful we
-shall find that we have ridden right into a trap. Let us plan our trip
-more carefully. First we must stay away from the main trails. We must
-take to the foothills and work our way south that way. It will take us
-longer, but there will be less chance of being ambushed, I believe, if
-we stay away from the well-used main trails. The Kiowas are a very
-tricky people and we would be in a trap before we knew it. They will be
-sure to be covering the water holes for they know we must have water. As
-far as I know there are but three between here and our village. How much
-water do you have in your pouch?”
-
-“My pouch is about empty, Running Dog, but surely we will find water
-elsewhere than at the three water holes.”
-
-“There is a good chance that we will, but I do not want to count on it.
-After all, our hunters are the ones that are familiar with this land. We
-are strangers here and not acquainted with the good and bad points.
-Come, our horses have rested. We will leave the main trail now and
-continue cross country. It is going to be a hard journey, White Cloud,
-but we are racing death.”
-
-With that the two boys steered their ponies from the main trail and
-began to travel in a southeasterly direction. Here there was no clear
-trail, and they had only the uncanny sense of a homing pigeon to guide
-them. They pushed their ponies easily for the first couple of hours, but
-finally the steady pace began to tell and they had to come to a stop.
-
-They had entered a green valley and as they rode they noticed an
-abundance of game. “Too bad that we are in a race,” remarked White
-Cloud, “for here is a paradise of game.” Running Dog said nothing, and
-the two boys brought their ponies to a stop. They stepped from their
-ponies and rested, allowing the horses to crop grass.
-
-As they lay there, White Cloud glanced back in the direction from which
-they had come. Again he could see the ominous puffs of smoke rising from
-behind the small hills that separated them from the main band of Kiowas.
-
-After resting a short while and allowing their ponies to blow, they
-mounted again and continued their gallop toward their village and
-security. Night was approaching now and the boys were glad for they knew
-that they could travel much more swiftly at night because it would be
-cooler. Besides, they knew that the Kiowas would not attack unless they
-were sure they could kill both the boys.
-
-They rode more swiftly now, and suddenly Running Dog’s pony whinnied
-aloud and swerved to one side. Running Dog tried to pull him back but
-the pony galloped off in a slightly different direction from the one in
-which they had been traveling. Then Running Dog understood why, for
-suddenly he heard the hoofs of his horse splashing. The horse had found
-water. What a break! The boys threw themselves from their horses and lay
-flat in the water. Suddenly Running Dog lifted himself from the water
-and grasping White Cloud’s arm he said:
-
-“We are foolish. Suppose they are watching this water hole. We sit here
-like two fat frogs waiting for the hook. Come quickly, we must leave
-this place.” The two boys mounted once again and rode on. Suddenly the
-pack horse stumbled and fell. The boys stopped their ponies and returned
-to the side of the pack horse. “He will be all right,” said White Cloud,
-“he is just winded.”
-
-“We must leave him,” said Running Dog. “We cannot wait for him to regain
-his breath and his strength. We must ride.”
-
-Now the two boys could travel a little faster without the pack horse to
-slow them down, although they hated the thought of leaving a pony for
-the blood-thirsty Kiowas. Finally they brought their ponies to a halt
-and dismounted.
-
-“We must rest several hours or our ponies will die underneath us. Try to
-sleep, White Cloud. I will stand guard. I will wake you in a short time
-and then I will sleep. Do not worry, I am tired, but my eyes and ears
-are sharp.”
-
-White Cloud was exhausted and in a matter of seconds he was asleep.
-Running Dog kept careful watch and a short time later he wakened White
-Cloud. Then Running Dog slept and shortly just as dawn was breaking
-White Cloud shook his friend and the two thrust some dried venison into
-their mouths to chew and each one taking a long drink of water they
-mounted and were soon on their way once again.
-
-They had been riding for about an hour when Running Dog glanced back in
-the direction they had just come and there on a hillside a few miles
-back he saw a small band of Kiowas. They were evidently looking for
-something or someone.
-
-It was not a puzzle to Running Dog long, for he saw the band of Kiowas
-break from the hillside in their direction. “They have seen us, White
-Cloud! Ride as you have never ridden before. We are near to our land,
-but it is still a hard ride and the worst is yet to come. I cannot be
-sure if that is a band that is pursuing us or whether it is the band
-from the south. In any case, we must keep going. Ride, White Cloud, ride
-for your life.”
-
-The two ponies thundered on. Soon they had entered a series of hills.
-The second day was fast drawing to a close. Then it happened.
-
-White Cloud’s pony caught his foot in a gopher hole, and down went pony
-and rider.
-
-Running Dog pulled his pony to a halt and rode back to where his friend
-had fallen. Both boy and pony were down. The pony had evidently a broken
-leg and White Cloud had hit his head upon a stone and was unconscious.
-Running Dog took his knife and put the horse out of his misery and then
-he dragged his friend to the shelter of a rock and poured some water on
-his face. Soon White Cloud shook his head.
-
-“What happened?”
-
-“Your horse stumbled. I have had to use my knife on him, his leg was
-broken. But how do you feel?”
-
-“Oh, I am a little dizzy and very tired. But go, Running Dog, you must
-ride to the village for help.”
-
-“Yes, White Cloud, I must do that, but I am lost. I do not know where we
-are and the sky is black tonight. We must stay here until dawn. My pony
-is all done in anyway. He would not get very far tonight. We will rest.
-I will stand guard first.”
-
-With that, Running Dog moved off to a small crevice of rock and settled
-down to keep watch. But the grind had been too much even for him, and
-before too long his head hung low upon his chest and both boys slept.
-
-Suddenly Running Dog woke with a start, hands of steel were holding his
-arms and legs, pinning him where he sat. He struggled and then he heard
-a familiar voice, “Why do you struggle so hard, my son?”
-
-“Father, it is you. Oh father, I am so glad to see you. But tell me, how
-did you find us?”
-
-“Well,” said Running Dog’s father, “we too have eyes and saw the Kiowa
-signals while off gathering some horses that had strayed. We rode to
-meet the invader, for we knew that they would have come far into Apache
-territory to catch those that they pursued. So we rode to attack the
-band. We were able to defeat them and send them running for their homes,
-but before that we were able to learn from one of their dying braves
-that you, their quarry, had ridden in this direction.
-
-“I am sorry we were holding you when you awoke but you are mighty fast
-with the knife and I did not want to take the chance of being killed by
-my own son.”
-
-They laughed and then the party returned without further incident to the
-safety of their village.
-
- * * * * * * * *
-
-“Here my story ends,” said Running Dog, “but I shall long remember the
-events of that Race with Death.”
-
-
-
-
- THE STORM
-
-
-In the Algonquin tribe, Masequah had grown to manhood through the many
-winters and summers that his tribe lived in peace. He was a very tall,
-strong and good-looking Indian brave. He was bravest of all in battle, a
-good hunter, and a good husband to his wife, Senan, and their son, Pyan.
-Masequah was very proud of his son. As the baby grew, his mother no
-longer had to carry him upon her back. Soon Masequah was able to walk
-hand in hand with Pyan through the forest.
-
-As his son grew older, Masequah began to train him for manhood. One day
-Masequah and Pyan stepped into a canoe and paddled across the wide lake
-to look for berries and nuts. Pyan was now seven years of age, and his
-training had begun in earnest. While they were on the other shore, a
-great storm arose, and the wind brought huge angry waves to the lake.
-Masequah feared that their light canoe would be broken by the waves. He
-told Pyan that it would be much safer to stay where they were until
-morning.
-
-They found a small cove that would give them some shelter. Then they
-started hunting for food, while the rain beat down on them. Pyan spotted
-two rabbits, and his father shot both of them. Then they went back to
-the cove, found dry wood, and built a fire to cook the rabbits. Masequah
-and Pyan settled themselves as comfortably as they could for the long
-night.
-
-The winds began to blow even harder and the rain began to fall more
-heavily. Pyan snuggled closer to his father’s side to keep warm. As the
-warrior looked at his son, he saw fear in his son’s eyes. Masequah had
-taught his son that Indians were never afraid, but suddenly he realized
-that lessons were not enough. Even an Indian needed to understand the
-thing he feared in order to drive fear away.
-
-“Don’t be afraid, Pyan,” he said kindly. “The rain that falls around us
-brings strength to food we have planted and to the trees in the forest.
-At the worst, it can only wet us. We are too wise to battle the wind on
-the lake. The bright bolts of lightning could not strike us here easily
-in this cove, and the thunder is only a loud noise like a war drum.
-There is nothing to fear.”
-
-As Masequah watched his son’s face in the flickering light of the fire,
-he knew that his words had been of little comfort. “I want to go home,”
-said Pyan, “I want my mother and the warmth of my bed. I am afraid.”
-
-“Don’t be afraid, Pyan,” Masequah said, “your father is with you.”
-
-“Can you stop the lightning?” asked Pyan. “Can you stop the rain? That
-will stop my fear. The wind that is blowing so strong frightens me.”
-
-Masequah picked up his son and carried him to the shelter of a cave and
-after placing his son in the cave he said, “Wait, I shall return. I must
-get an answer to your questions.” Masequah walked to the edge of the
-lake and, facing straight into the wind, shouted, “O great storm, tell
-me what answers I should give my son! He is afraid and I have told him
-not to be afraid. The wind, the lightning, and the rain frighten him and
-he wants to return to his home. To try to paddle our light canoe across
-the rough waters of the lake could mean death for my son and me. I am
-not afraid to die, but my son is young and his whole life lies before
-him. Tell me what I can do to stop his fear. He has asked me to stop the
-rain and the wind. This I cannot do, but you, great storm, hear a
-father’s plea and blow away from our land!”
-
-Masequah shivered, for the storm seemed to be getting worse. He turned
-from the lake and walked back to the cave. Taking his son’s hand, he
-said, “Pyan, come, follow your father. We are going home.”
-
-“But, father,” said Pyan, “the winds and the rain and the lightning have
-not stopped. The water is rough and our canoe is light. We will be
-drowned.”
-
-Pyan held back as his father took his hand. His father spoke kindly and
-firmly: “Come, Pyan, do not be afraid. Your father will protect you.”
-
-As they reached the shore Pyan began to tremble and felt heartsick
-because he was cowardly while his father was so brave. Pyan stepped into
-the canoe and his father followed. Masequah pointed to the sky.
-
-“Look, Pyan, the sky is beginning to brighten. Now the storm will halt
-long enough for us to reach the safety of our village.”
-
-There was a blinding flash of lightning and a loud clap of thunder. The
-rain stopped suddenly, the winds died down, and the waves on the lake
-became calm. Masequah pushed the canoe from the shore and paddled
-swiftly across the lake.
-
-When they reached home, Pyan told his mother excitedly how the storm had
-stopped when his father ordered it to halt. Pyan’s mother turned slowly
-to Masequah.
-
-“My husband,” she said with wonder in her voice, “until just now as you
-and Pyan arrived, the storm hasn’t paused once tonight.”
-
-For many years until Masequah’s death, the members of his tribe looked
-upon Masequah as a brave gifted with mysterious powers. They would tell
-of a hunting party that had reached the lake at the same time that
-Masequah and Pyan had started for home; the hunters had been whipped by
-the raging storm while they stood on a hill top overlooking the lake;
-suddenly they had seen the storm stop and the lake below them grow calm;
-and then they had watched a small canoe, with a man and a boy in it,
-glide swiftly across the peaceful waters. To them it was a miracle, but
-Masequah knew better.
-
-Masequah would always deny that he had any mysterious powers. Over and
-over again, he would remind his friends that no storm covers all the
-earth, and that every storm has its edges just as the lake does, or like
-the shadow of a fleecy cloud on a sunny day.
-
-No matter how often he told them that the edge of the storm had moved
-away from the lake, most of his friends still insisted that it was a
-miracle. Even Pyan, who believed that his father was wise and truthful,
-sometimes wondered.
-
-
- This story was told to the author by Barney Mason, a Canadian Scout,
- who had learned it from living descendants of the Algonquin Tribe.
-
-
-
-
- 5. CHARACTER
-
-
-
-
- SLEEPING BEAR MAKES A MISTAKE
-
-
-The Montagnais village of the great Northern forest was large with many
-fine wigwams. The village had been built in a meadow near a great lake,
-and the smell of woodfires was always in the air, as the smoke curled
-skyward from each wigwam. It was a busy time of year for the Montagnais
-because winter would soon be upon them. Families were repairing their
-homes and making new clothing for the winter months.
-
-It was on one of these busy days that Bald Eagle informed his family
-that he believed they should build a new wigwam. So the work was
-organized. First Bald Eagle selected a good place to build it. Then he
-scratched lines on the ground to show where the frame would be set.
-Having cut saplings and put them in place, bending the ends to make
-arches for the roof, he bound them together with withes made from a
-peeled basswood sapling about three fingers thick that bent very easily.
-The making of these withes had fallen to Sleeping Bear, Bald Eagle’s
-son. It is about this job that our story is concerned.
-
-When Sleeping Bear was asked to make the withes, he was proud. This was
-the first time his father had ever asked him to do such an important
-job. Dashing off into the forest, he came upon a young basswood sapling
-about three fingers thick. Taking his knife from its beaded sheath, he
-proceeded to cut the sapling. The flint blade of his knife did a very
-neat job and he soon had the young sapling down and trimmed.
-
-Then Sleeping Bear set to work to strip the bark from the sapling. When
-he had all the bark peeled away, he dashed home to show his father what
-good work he had done.
-
-Bald Eagle smiled. “That is fine, my son, but now we must have the
-withes to tie the ends of the frame together.”
-
-Sleeping Bear squatted upon the ground and began to cut thin strips from
-the basswood. He worked very carefully until he had cut a very, very
-thin strip from the sapling. Then he cut another and another, until he
-had a good supply. Picking them all up, he walked to where his father
-was working and proudly he said:
-
-“Here, father, are the strips you can use for withes.”
-
-Without looking up, Bald Eagle said, “That is fine, my son. How many
-have you cut for me?”
-
-“I have cut about thirty,” said Sleeping Bear.
-
-Bald Eagle looked up. Reaching toward his son’s outstretched hands, he
-grasped the basswood strips.
-
-“These will make very fine fishing lines, my son, but they are much too
-thin for withes. You must make them thicker, so that they will hold the
-frame in the position we want.” Handing the strips back to Sleeping
-Bear, Bald Eagle smiled and continued to work upon the frame of the
-wigwam.
-
-Sadly, Sleeping Bear turned and headed back into the forest to find more
-basswood saplings. As he walked along, he was not thinking about the
-basswood, but about how foolish he had felt when his father told him
-that the strips he had cut were too thin. He kicked at the pebbles and
-was very angry with himself. He did not realize that he had walked quite
-a distance from the village, until suddenly it got very dark.
-
-Looking up, Sleeping Bear realized that he was close to the swamp area
-and that he must have come quite a distance. Slowly, he turned and
-started back along the trail looking to either side for basswood
-saplings. Finally, he saw two or three set back in the forest a short
-way. Leaving the trail, he reached the saplings and started to cut them
-down and trim them. He had out two when there was a low growl behind
-him. Turning, he saw a bear standing on his hind feet and testing the
-air for scent with his snout.
-
-Sleeping Bear was suddenly very frightened. Crouching low to the ground,
-he began to edge his way toward the path again. Soon he reached the
-path. Then he began to run until he was safe in the camp once again.
-Dashing up to his father he stood a minute catching his breath, and then
-he blurted out the story of the bear.
-
-Bald Eagle put his arm around his son’s shoulders and said:
-
-“You see how much trouble can be brought on by one foolish mistake? If
-you had watched your father carefully, you would have known how to make
-a withe the right thickness. Because you were angry, you did not look
-for basswood saplings close to home, but wandered deep into the forest
-and almost became the dinner of brother bear. Rushing to escape the
-bear, you left your basswood saplings behind. So the task of making
-withes begins all over again. Be careful, my son, that when you do
-something, you do it right, or if you make a mistake, you do not waste
-time brooding over it. Better to accept it and go forth to do the job
-better.”
-
-And so Sleeping Bear learned a great lesson that day.
-
-
-
-
- THE LESSON OF THE ELM TREE
-
-
-A small Cherokee lad by the name of White Eagle lived with his father
-and mother on the shores of a large lake in the Appalachian Mountains.
-He was a lad of about eleven years. His father, Great Eagle, was known
-in the tribe as one of the bravest of warriors. In this Cherokee tribe
-there was much talk of war with other tribes, and the tribe’s highest
-honors and respect always went to the bravest and most daring warrior.
-
-Not many suns away lived another woodlands tribe, the Eries. This story
-concerns a young captive from this Erie tribe and White Eagle, the
-Cherokee boy.
-
-Very rarely did any tribe go so far afield in its hunting, but this one
-winter food was very scarce for the Cherokees and they traveled quite a
-distance north in search of additional game. They moved into the hunting
-grounds of the Iroquois, quickly made their kills, and started for home.
-On their way, they came upon an Erie boy whom Great Eagle decided to
-bring home to his tepee as a brother to his son.
-
-The Cherokee tribe lived in a sentry-patrolled, fortified village. When
-Little Frog, as the Erie lad was called, first saw the village, he was
-frightened. He realized that he was near the entire tribe of fearful
-Cherokees whose wars his father had often recounted to him. Great Eagle
-sensed the boy’s fear and laid his hand gently on his shoulder. Great
-Eagle took him to his home and introduced him to White Eagle. White
-Eagle was pleased to have a boy of his own age to play with in his own
-wigwam. That night there was much dancing and merry-making to celebrate
-the successful hunting raid into the Iroquois lands.
-
-The following morning Great Eagle roused the boys to tell them that
-today they would go in search of small game to improve their shooting
-ability. Each boy was given a small amount of food, and they started off
-for the forest with Great Eagle. Little Frog began to look upon Great
-Eagle as his father and felt happy. His own father had been killed in an
-early tribal raid.
-
-As they padded through the forest, they could hear the cry of wild birds
-and every now and then the snapping of a twig. Great Eagle signaled with
-his hand for the two youngsters to wait. Then he moved off to the side
-to investigate the noise; but once again he returned to the trail,
-indicating that the game they were after was not to be seen.
-
-When the sun had risen high in the heavens, Great Eagle decided they
-would sit and rest and eat some food. As they were eating, Little Frog
-asked White Eagle, “Do you often travel with your father?” White Eagle
-replied, “Right now I am being trained by my father to become a great
-warrior.”
-
-The Erie boy was very much impressed with this and thought of himself
-how wonderful it would be if he had a father. White Eagle then asked
-Little Frog, “Do you miss your village and your people?” “No,” Little
-Frog replied, “because in my village I was not wanted by anyone. My
-father had been killed in battle. My mother died of a great sickness and
-I was cast out of my father’s wigwam by a new brave. I was made to work
-for myself to get food and to live as best I could.” White Eagle
-realized then how lucky he was to have such a fine warrior father as
-Great Eagle.
-
-After drinking some water to wash down the dried deer meat, Great Eagle
-arose and the boys stood up quickly, and they started forward. The brave
-signaled the boys to follow him more softly now. Little Eagle noticed
-that they were approaching a stream where beaver had built their dams
-and homes. As they approached the stream, Great Eagle pointed to the
-brush where the boys should wait while he looked about for the beaver.
-Not having seen any, Great Eagle returned to where the boys were hidden
-and told them they would start back to the village and search for wild
-turkeys and rabbits. White Eagle felt a slight disappointment at not
-having been able to try out his new arrows on the beaver, but he trusted
-the wisdom of his father. So he and Little Frog returned along the trail
-with Great Eagle.
-
-When they had almost reached the edge of the forest, Great Eagle stopped
-and pointed into the brush at the side of the trail. There, crouching in
-hiding, was a small cotton-tail rabbit. Quickly, White Eagle raised his
-bow and let fly an arrow. The rabbit took one leap and fell dead. White
-Eagle was so excited that he danced up and down, shouting at the top of
-his lungs that he had made his kill. Great Eagle quieted his son and
-then looked slowly in Little Frog’s direction. Approaching the rabbit,
-Great Eagle noticed that two arrows had struck it. He knew that Little
-Frog must have shot his arrow at the same time as White Eagle. White
-Eagle and Little Frog began to argue about whose arrow had really killed
-the rabbit. Naturally, each claimed that his arrow had made the kill.
-
-Great Eagle was at a loss as to just what to do. He was always fair in
-his decisions and did not want to favor one boy over the other,
-especially because it involved his son. So Great Eagle said, “Let us
-agree; say that each of your arrows shared in killing the rabbit, for I
-can see that you are both like stubborn elm trees—and you are both
-better with your bows than I had thought.”
-
-With that, Great Eagle picked up the rabbit and put it in his pouch and
-the three of them started for home. Both boys seemed quite happy now
-that Great Eagle had made the decision. However, that night Little Frog
-leaned over in his bed and tapped White Eagle’s shoulder. “White Eagle,”
-he said, “what does your father mean when he says we are like the
-stubborn elm?” “Tomorrow morning,” said White Eagle, “I will show you
-what my father meant.” With that the boys went to sleep.
-
-The following morning when they arose, Little Frog was impatient to
-learn why Great Eagle had called them stubborn like the elm, and he
-quickly reminded White Eagle of his promise of the night before. Hand in
-hand, they started for the great forest. As they went along, White Eagle
-kept breaking branches of the different trees along the way. Little Frog
-was imitating White Eagle as they walked until they came upon a small
-young elm tree. White Eagle did his best to break the elm tree, but all
-it did was bend. Then Little Frog tried to help him break the tree; but
-despite their weight and strength, it still only bent.
-
-Just then they heard a voice behind them and Great Eagle stepped up and
-placed his hands on the shoulders of both boys.
-
-“Now,” he said, “you have found the reason why I called you stubborn as
-the elm. Many, many of the trees of the forest can be broken and forced
-to the earth. But the elm tree will bend and not break unless the
-strength of several braves is put upon it. So it is with two proud young
-Indian boys who both believe they are right, putting their equal
-strength against each other in an argument. Neither gives way, just as
-the elm will not give away. If I attempted to add my strength on either
-side of the argument, the other might have bent to the earth like the
-elm if we all put our weight upon it. So remember this tree. As long as
-you believe honestly that you are right, you can be strong and straight
-like the elm tree; but once you leave the path of truth and wisdom you
-become weak and brittle, and your enemy can bow you to the ground in
-shame and defeat.”
-
-
- This story was told to the author by James Ariga, a boy of part
- Cherokee blood, at the Ten Mile River Scout Reservation in the year
- 1947.
-
-
-
-
- THE RACE
-
-
-Winter had come to the many Indian villages in the northeastern
-woodlands, and with it, the snow, the wind, and the cold. The winter was
-so severe that even the strongest braves hesitated to wander far from
-their villages, knowing that death could overtake an adventurous brave
-if a sudden blizzard should catch him far from familiar ground.
-
-This story is about two such adventurous young Oneida Indians that
-winter. Naltan and Ceysoda were outstanding young boys of their tribe.
-Time and time again before winter set in, they had taken part in the
-games and contests of the tribe, and one or the other had won each time.
-This had continued until the other young boys in the village decided
-that Naltan and Ceysoda were just too good for them, and that something
-must be done to prevent their running away with all the prizes.
-
-So one fall day, when they were sure that Ceysoda and Naltan were not
-around, all the youngsters gathered to discuss a plan. On the following
-day, there were to be foot races in the village. The group plotted that
-at the start of the foot race, two of the faster young braves would trip
-Naltan and Ceysoda so that they would fall and thus be put out of the
-race. The boys who had tripped them would be scored out of the race,
-too, but at least they would have the satisfaction of knowing that
-someone besides Naltan and Ceysoda would win the foot race for a change.
-
-Just at that moment they saw Naltan coming around one of the wigwams,
-and they all started walking away in different directions. Naltan walked
-up to one of the leaders of the group and asked:
-
-“What have I missed, friend Beartooth? Ceysoda and I have been busy
-repairing and sharpening our hunting weapons. We did not know that there
-was to be a meeting of all the boys of the village.”
-
-Beartooth was quick to recover from his surprise and then in a very calm
-voice said:
-
-“Oh, Naltan, that was no meeting of all the boys. It was merely a few of
-us talking about the foot races tomorrow and the weather. It has been
-very cold, and soon winter will be here with her snow and winds and
-bitter cold. Tomorrow we are going to have the foot races. So we were
-talking about who we thought would be victorious.”
-
-“Do you think there are any among you who can defeat Ceysoda and me in
-the foot race, Beartooth? If you do, you had better forget about it,”
-Naltan boasted. “Ceysoda and I will win the race tomorrow, as we always
-do.”
-
-“We shall see,” said Beartooth with a note of warning in his voice. “We
-shall see.” Then he turned and walked away from Naltan toward his
-father’s wigwam.
-
-Naltan shrugged his shoulders and, thinking no more about it, dashed off
-to find Ceysoda. He looked all around the camp and finally found him
-practicing with his bow and arrow a short distance from the village.
-Naltan told him what Beartooth had said. Ceysoda was silent for a few
-moments, thinking.
-
-“Naltan, my friend,” he said, “I have a strange feeling that our
-brothers plot against us. I have no good reason for feeling this way,
-but I can’t help it. For some reason our friends have planned a way to
-make us lose the race. What it is and how I know I cannot tell you, but
-the feeling is upon me.”
-
-“You are foolish, Ceysoda. The fact that we have won many contests and
-games from our friends surely wouldn’t give them a reason to plot any
-harm.”
-
-“I do not say that they want to harm us; but in some way they will try
-to make sure we do not win the foot races tomorrow. Wait and see,
-Naltan.”
-
-The two boys spoke no further and soon it was time to return to their
-wigwams for the evening meal. When Naltan and his father had finished
-eating, Naltan told his father that he would like to get his advice. So
-father and son sat down by the blazing coals of the fire in the middle
-of their wigwam.
-
-“Father,” Naltan began, “today Ceysoda told me that our friends were
-planning some trick to make us lose in the foot race tomorrow. He also
-said that he did not know why he had this feeling, but he did have it.
-Surely, father, our friends would not try to harm us?”
-
-“No, my son, I do not believe that your friends would want to harm you,
-but is there any reason that you would have to believe that what your
-friend Ceysoda tells you might be true?”
-
-“No, father, there isn’t anything—yes, wait a minute! There might be.
-Late this afternoon when Ceysoda and I had finished working on our bows,
-I went down to Beartooth’s wigwam to borrow some thongs for my
-moccasins. Just as I reached the small clearing near Beartooth’s home, I
-saw almost all of our friends gathered together talking; but when they
-saw me they scattered, each one heading for his own home. When I
-questioned Beartooth about it, he said that they had been talking about
-the coming winter and the foot races tomorrow, and had just finished
-when I arrived.”
-
-“Well, do not worry about it, my son. Whoever is strongest and fastest
-will win tomorrow. It will soon be time for bed. Go out and play for a
-little while, but when your mother calls, come to bed, for you will need
-your rest for the foot races.” With that Naltan’s father rose to leave.
-
-“You know, father, my thoughts became so confused when I saw the crowd
-of boys that I forgot to ask Beartooth for the thongs. I will go down
-now before he goes to sleep so that I may work a little more on my bow
-tonight before I go to sleep.”
-
-Naltan left his home and walked quickly to Beartooth’s home. As he
-neared Beartooth’s wigwam he heard voices. Beartooth was talking to one
-of the other young braves. “Yes, that’s right,” he was saying, “make
-sure that you are next to Naltan at the start of the race tomorrow. When
-the signal is given, pretend to trip so that you will fall against
-Naltan and tumble him to the ground. I will do the same to Ceysoda. Then
-we can be sure that someone else will win the race.”
-
-Naltan decided that he did not need the extra thong that night, but
-hurried to see his friend, Ceysoda. Reaching the wigwam where he lived,
-he called until Ceysoda came to the entrance.
-
-“What do you want, Naltan? It is late and I am tired. I was just about
-to go to bed.”
-
-“Ceysoda, I have discovered what our friends plan for us tomorrow.”
-Naltan repeated what he had heard at Beartooth’s wigwam. When he had
-finished, he waited to see how Ceysoda would take the news. He did not
-have to wait long, for suddenly Ceysoda’s face took on an angry look.
-“Those crawling mud worms,” he cried. “Have they become so jealous
-because they cannot win at the games and contests that they have to use
-trickery against us? I knew that the feeling I had was a true one. Now
-we know exactly what they are going to do. But how can we prevent this
-from happening tomorrow, Naltan?”
-
-“I have a plan,” said Naltan. “Tomorrow when we line up for the race we
-will ask that the others be given a slight lead over us because we have
-won so many races. We should be able to tell by what they say to that
-whether or not they would still try to carry out such a plan.”
-
-“That is a very good idea, Naltan,” said Ceysoda, yawning. “Now I must
-say goodnight, for I am tired, and we have some hard running ahead of us
-tomorrow.”
-
-The boys said goodnight. Ceysoda turned back into his wigwam and Naltan
-started to go home to his own bed. On the way, he wondered whether he
-should tell his father what had happened. He decided to handle this in
-his own way, without the help of any adults.
-
-The following day was very crisp and cool. Off to the northwest clouds
-warned that a snowstorm might be building up. But everyone was too
-excited to take much notice of anything besides the preparations going
-on all around for the big foot race. Fathers and sons together made the
-final inspection of the boys’ clothing for the big race. The boys’
-moccasins especially were looked over carefully for any weak spots where
-the leather might break. A torn moccasin could mean lost time and a lost
-race.
-
-At last, the call went up through the village for all who were entering
-the race to gather at the starting line just outside the village on the
-border of a great meadow. The young boys gathered, joined by their proud
-fathers, each of whom hoped that his son would cross the finish line
-first and win the beautiful bone-handled hunting knife which the tribe’s
-medicine man had offered as the first prize.
-
-When all the contestants had gathered at the starting line, the warrior
-in charge of the race began to give instructions. He called for the
-attention of all the runners. At that moment, Ceysoda and Naltan stepped
-forward and asked that they be allowed to start ten paces behind the
-others so that this could be a more even race. There were many shouts
-from the other boys that Ceysoda and Naltan were only boasting. They
-said that they wanted the two boys to start with them. If Ceysoda and
-Naltan won the race, all well and good! But if they had to start back
-and lost the race then someone would always complain that it was not an
-even race. The warrior in charge then made his decision.
-
-“I believe,” he said, “that Naltan and Ceysoda are being very fair. So
-far they have won all foot races by a great margin. Now they offer to
-start late in order to give every one of you a better chance to win. I
-have no doubt that many of you have been practicing hard for this event,
-but these two have been practicing just as hard. So it would be a very
-unfair race unless I did give them a handicap to even up the chances for
-you all.”
-
-Beartooth knew that if they argued against this ruling, suspicion might
-be aroused. So he bade his friends be quiet and line up again for the
-race.
-
-The course for the race this year had been chosen very carefully. The
-boys were to run across the meadow and into the woods up the game trail
-until they reached the blaze marked on a fallen birch. Then they were to
-turn off the trail and head east until they came to the singing rock.
-That, Naltan knew, was the rock from which water trickled during and
-after a heavy rain, and made an unusual, almost tinkling sound. At the
-rock the boys would turn south, break from the forest, cross the meadow,
-and head for home. The first one to cross the finish line would be
-declared the winner and receive the coveted hunting knife.
-
-The instructions were clear. The boys waited eagerly. When the warrior
-had made sure that all were lined up correctly, he gave them the
-starting signal. Instead of leaping forward, the racers began to mill
-around. Then several boys broke from the group and started to run along
-the course. Five young Indian braves, including Beartooth, Naltan, and
-Ceysoda, could be seen lying on the ground. Naltan and Ceysoda leaped
-quickly to their feet and began running. They had already lost a great
-deal of valuable ground, but the desire to win this race now burned
-especially bright in their hearts. They ran swiftly across the meadow in
-pursuit of the fast-disappearing figures of the leading braves, while
-others trailed behind them.
-
-As they reached the woods, they began to overtake the other boys one at
-a time, because the running became harder as they got deeper into the
-woods. There were rocks and branches to hinder their way, and the
-footing was often unsure. As the two boys reached the blazed birch tree
-they turned eastward and continued swiftly on their way. They soon
-passed more of the young braves. As they reached the singing rock and
-turned for home only two boys were still between them and the finish
-line. When they broke into the open and reached the meadow, the gap
-between the boys narrowed rapidly, and they were greeted by cheers. It
-was clear to all that Naltan and Ceysoda would overtake the two leaders.
-The cheering grew louder when, with a sudden burst of speed, Naltan and
-Ceysoda passed them and sped across the finish line at exactly the same
-moment. They were declared winners in a tied race, and each was given a
-beautiful knife.
-
-After the award was made, Naltan looked around for Beartooth, but could
-not find him. On the way home, Naltan asked his father if he had seen
-Beartooth.
-
-“Why, my son,” his father said, “he was standing close to me as you and
-Ceysoda broke from the woods into the meadow on the last part of the
-race. Then he disappeared. Why are you so concerned. When you had picked
-yourself up from the ground and started after the other boys, the
-warrior in charge of the race spoke to Beartooth. Beartooth confessed
-his plan which, it seems, did not work out successfully. He will be
-punished for his plot. There is no need for you to be worried.”
-
-“But I am worried, father, for there is no need to punish Beartooth.
-What he did was wrong, but I am sure he is sorry. And after all, no harm
-was done. I will go to him and speak with him and show him that I am not
-angry. Then I will talk to the warrior who started the race?”
-
-Naltan left his father and went to Beartooth’s house. He called to his
-friend but there was no answer. When he called again, Beartooth’s mother
-came out of the wigwam and told him that her son had not returned from
-the foot race.
-
-“But all the contestants have finished in the race and are home by now.
-Where could Beartooth have gone? I will look for him.”
-
-Naltan left to find Ceysoda, who was showing his beautiful knife proudly
-to his many friends.
-
-“Ceysoda,” Naltan called as he drew near. “Come, I must talk with you.”
-When he finished telling Ceysoda about Beartooth’s not returning home,
-the two boys went in search of him. They looked all through the village
-but could not find him anywhere. They asked all the children but they
-had not seen him. Finally, they found the boy to whom Beartooth had
-spoken about the plot and who was to have helped him. At first the boy
-denied knowing anything about where Beartooth might be; but finally
-after continued questioning from Naltan, the boy told them.
-
-“Beartooth was afraid when the warrior at the racing field told him that
-he would have to be punished. So while everyone was milling around and
-shouting at the end of the race, he stole off and ran into the wood. He
-feared not only the punishment of the warrior and council, but also the
-punishment that you and Ceysoda would bring down upon him for playing
-such a trick.”
-
-While they were talking, a few snowflakes began to fall.
-
-“Come,” said Naltan, “we must go after him quickly. From the looks of
-the sky and this snow, there will be a heavy storm. Beartooth has had
-little experience with snow. His days alone in the forest have been few.
-If we do not go after him, he may be lost in the storm and threatened by
-the wild animals of the forest.”
-
-“I cannot go,” the boy answered. “My father would not allow it. Besides,
-how would we know where to look?”
-
-The boys stepped back and stared at the boy. “You are a coward,” Naltan
-said angrily. “I cannot waste time arguing with you. Come, Ceysoda, we
-must leave immediately.”
-
-Without further words, the two friends turned and started for the
-forest. The snow was beginning to fall faster and thicker now. As they
-reached the forest, they stopped to choose the most likely trail that
-Beartooth would follow. The race had tired Ceysoda, and he was breathing
-heavily now.
-
-“Wait, Naltan,” he pleaded. “The boy was right. How would we know which
-direction Beartooth would take? Besides, at the rate this snow is
-falling any trace of him would be covered. Is it wise to go on?”
-
-“Wise or not, Ceysoda, we must go on. Beartooth must be found. Not
-knowing the forest too well, he would probably travel the main trail
-toward the north. We will go in that direction. If we hurry, we may be
-able to pick up a sign of his route before the snow has a chance to
-cover it completely, and reach him before he goes too far.”
-
-The boys spoke no further but hurried up the trail to the north, keeping
-their eyes toward the ground to look for signs of the boy’s having
-passed that way. Soon Naltan stopped and pointed to a place in the trail
-where the snow had been disturbed.
-
-“He must have fallen here. See the way the snow has been pushed aside.
-Come, quickly, Ceysoda, he cannot be too far ahead.” The two boys
-continued swiftly on the trail. Soon they were able to make out signs of
-fresh moccasin prints in the snow. But just when they felt they were
-getting close, the wind began to blow harder, sweeping along the trail
-and covering any tracks or other signs that they might have found. The
-boys had been traveling at a fast pace for some time, when Ceysoda
-stopped suddenly.
-
-“Wait, Naltan, I must rest,” he said. “I am tired. I cannot go on
-without rest. Just for a moment let me catch my breath. Surely Beartooth
-will not continue without rest, too, and we will lose no ground by
-stopping for a short while.”
-
-“All right,” said Naltan, “but just for a moment. The day is growing
-late.” The two boys squatted down by the side of the trail and breathed
-deeply to get their wind back again. Suddenly, Nathan gazed up through
-the trees and then, stretching his hands out in front of him, he said,
-“Ceysoda, my friend, look! It has stopped snowing. We are in luck. But
-we must hurry even so, because the storm will no longer slow Beartooth’s
-pace.”
-
-The two boys rose and sped on up the trail. Truly they were in luck, for
-soon they came upon a place in the snow where someone had stopped to
-rest at the side of the trail. The prints of small moccasins were plain
-in the snow and led straight up the trail. Now the boys increased their
-efforts, for they knew they must be close. Suddenly, the tracks stopped
-and turned off the trail into the thick woods. This puzzled Naltan, but
-he turned to follow them. The two boys began finding the going a little
-rougher. Suddenly, they found that they not only were following moccasin
-tracks, but another set of tracks now appeared not far behind the boy’s.
-These were the tracks of a bear!
-
-The bear, Naltan thought, must have been late in going into hibernation
-for the winter because he had not found enough food. Now a delicious
-morsel of warm-blooded food was on the trail ahead of him. Now Naltan
-understood why Beartooth had left the trail; he must have seen the bear
-ahead on the trail and turned off to escape him. But the hear was not
-going to be avoided so easily. Naltan suddenly stopped and turned to
-Ceysoda.
-
-“What shall we do if we do come upon the bear and Beartooth?” he asked.
-“We are not armed with our bows and arrows. We could hardly defend
-ourselves against such a worthy opponent as a bear. Two young Indians
-such as we, no matter how brave, would be easy prey for a large bear.
-Yet we must go on and see if there is any help we can give. To turn back
-now would certainly mark us as cowards.”
-
-Ceysoda did not like the idea of fighting a full-grown bear; yet he
-liked less the thought of turning his back on danger and returning to
-the village to meet his friends’ ridicule and his father’s anger for
-having been so cowardly. They would have trouble enough as it was, for
-having left the village without letting their parents or friends know
-where they had gone. Naltan’s voice swung his thoughts back to his
-present plight.
-
-“I have an idea, Ceysoda. Between us we have two knives. Let us cut a
-couple of stout saplings to use as spears if we should need them. At
-least we will have some chance, even if it is not a very good one,
-against the bear.”
-
-So the two boys immediately began cutting stout saplings to hack into
-crude spears—poor weapons against an angry bear, but the best the boys
-could think of at the moment. When they sharpened the points on their
-spears, they continued following the very clear trail in the snow. They
-did not travel as fast now because they sensed a danger lurking ahead of
-them. They did not know just how far ahead the bear was, whether he was
-still following Beartooth, or whether he had discovered them. In fact,
-at this very moment, he might be awaiting them, hidden among the rocks
-up ahead, which they could plainly see now as they watched the forest in
-front of them cautiously while following the tracks carefully in the
-snow.
-
-They were continuing their anxious march in silence when they were
-startled by a sound that echoed through the forest, a sound all too
-familiar to them—the growl of an angry bear. It had come from in front
-and to the right of them. So the boys went on with even more caution.
-Suddenly, Naltan signaled to Ceysoda and the two boys crouched low to
-the ground. Ahead of them, about a hundred paces, the natural trail they
-had been following came to an end in a boxlike formation of rocks. The
-rocks reached almost straight up to the height of an elm tree. On top of
-this enclosure stood the bear and about ten feet below him on a ledge
-sticking out from the rocks was Beartooth. Behind the bear the boys
-noticed that the rocks continued to rise and they figured that they had
-come upon almost a dead end. Beartooth, Naltan figured, had reached the
-dead end and panic-stricken because of the bear, had either fallen or
-jumped to the ledge. For the moment he was safe, for the bear did not
-want to chance jumping to the ledge and there was no way that he could
-climb down. Suddenly he turned to the side and calmly walked around and
-down beside the wall until he was once again on the forest floor. He
-trotted to a spot directly beneath where the boy lay and studied the
-situation, trying to figure a way to get at this thing that had invaded
-the privacy of his forest at a time when he had been almost mad with
-hunger.
-
-The wind was blowing into the faces of the boys so they knew for the
-time being they were safe because the bear could not smell them, but if
-the wind should shift they would then be in trouble, for the bear would
-turn his attention to them. This also gave them time to think and work
-out a plan. Suddenly Ceysoda touched Naltan’s shoulder.
-
-“My brother,” he said, “he moved. Beartooth moved; he is alive. We must
-do something.” “Yes,” said Naltan, “for in his present situation he
-might fall from the ledge and then it would be all over. If we can
-somehow drive the bear off, we could then rescue Beartooth and return to
-the village.”
-
-“That is a good idea, Naltan, but tell me, friend, how do we get
-Beartooth off the ledge once we have chased the bear away, if we can
-chase him away?”
-
-This was a serious problem, for the boys had nothing they could use as a
-rope and, besides, Naltan could for the moment think of no way to get
-rid of the bear.
-
-Just then the boys noticed Beartooth moving again, but this time he
-rolled even closer to the ledge. Without thinking, Ceysoda stood
-straight up and shouted at Beartooth. “Look out, Beartooth, you are
-right at the edge of the ledge. Look out, you will fall.”
-
-Then Ceysoda realized what he had done, and he stood frozen as the bear
-turned and raising himself on his hind legs, emitting a terrible growl,
-started for the boys. Ceysoda’s shouts had roused Beartooth and he
-worked his way back from the edge of the ledge close to the wall and
-safety. Meanwhile the bear was increasing his speed toward the two boys.
-The boys stood almost frozen with fear, but suddenly they were able to
-shake off the paralysis that had gripped them, and both boys drew their
-rustic spears in front of them to await the charge of the bear who was
-coming ever closer.
-
-Naltan stepped slightly in front of Ceysoda in order to take the brunt
-of the attack, but Ceysoda would have none of it and edged up right next
-to Naltan. By this time the bear was almost upon them and with a
-terrifying snarl came rushing the last few yards.
-
-Naltan and Ceysoda, with the ends of the spears jammed into the ground
-held fast as the bear rushed right into the sharp points. The bear
-stopped in his tracks as if suddenly he had forgotten something and then
-with an agonizing snarl fell over dead, the two spears protruding from
-his body. Immediately Naltan and Ceysoda ran forward to the base of the
-ledge. Climbing to the top above Beartooth, the boys cut a long stout
-staff and lowered the end to Beartooth who grasped it and was pulled to
-safety. Then swiftly the three boys started for the village. On the way,
-each in turn told their story.
-
-First Beartooth told of how he had run away and how he had been chased
-to the top of the rock formation by the bear and, in trying to avoid
-him, had fallen. The two boys told how they had followed Beartooth to
-bring him back and of their coming upon the bear and their narrow
-escape.
-
-When they reached the warmth and security of their village again, Naltan
-and Ceysoda went with Beartooth to his wigwam and there assured him that
-they had no desire to punish him in any way for his trickery of that
-morning. “What you did was wrong, but what has happened to you today we
-firmly believe is punishment enough. Let us forget the incidents of this
-day. We are still friends and friends we must remain, for only through
-unity and friendship will we grow into strong good Oneida warriors.”
-
-Beartooth smiled and thanked his two friends, and he continued to smile
-as Naltan and Ceysoda walked off arm in arm toward their homes and large
-suppers that awaited the returning heroes.
-
-
-
-
- LITTLE THUNDERBIRD TELLS THE TRUTH
-
-
-The Blackfoot tribe was on the move. The buffalo had begun to search for
-new pasture. So the tribe had packed all its tepees on the travois and
-were moving to follow the herd. Their lives depended upon these prairie
-beasts, and they did not dare to be too far from them. For two days the
-herd moved until it found enough grass and water, and then it milled
-around and started to graze. How long or how short a time they would
-stay in this new place, no one knew; but here the tribe must make its
-camp until the buffalo forced them to move again.
-
-As soon as his family’s tepee was set up, Little Thunderbird wandered
-off in search of some excitement. He was a Blackfoot lad who seemed to
-be able to get into trouble no matter where he was—like the day he cut
-the string on his father’s bow, or the day he burned a hole in his
-mother’s new dress. These are only samples of the kinds of mischief
-Thunderbird got himself into. So today he planned to stay far from his
-home until mealtime and in that way keep out of trouble.
-
-Skipping through the village, he saw some of his friends throwing stones
-to see who could throw the farthest, and he ran up to them to ask if he
-could play. His friends told him to get in line and wait his turn. Soon
-he was throwing stones along with the other children. After they had
-played this game for a while, the children decided to play Follow the
-Leader. There was a great deal of talk about who would be leader for the
-game. Finally, one of the older boys was chosen, and he led off by
-dodging through a rack of drying buffalo meat.
-
-After everyone had run through the rack, the leader headed for the
-strings of ponies which were picketed out on the edge of the village.
-Here he ducked under the lines of many ponies that reared and whinnied
-from fright as the shouting youths leaped past them one after another.
-This kept on until one of the braves who was guarding the ponies chased
-the boys back into the village. The leader ran over boulders, danced
-between tepees, and did many other stunts which each boy repeated until
-finally the leader sat down, tired out. All the other boys admitted they
-were tired, too, and the group sat around talking about their fathers’
-great deeds.
-
-Soon it was Little Thunderbird’s turn and he stood and walked to the
-center of the circle, the way the big braves did in council. Then he
-raised his hands for silence from the group.
-
-“My father is the greatest of Blackfoot warriors,” Thunderbird began.
-“One day, while he was out on a hunt with some other braves of the
-tribe, he spotted a mountain lion. They were high in the hills and they
-had been looking for some ponies that had strayed from the herd. When my
-father saw the mountain lion, he spoke with the other braves and they
-decided to kill the beast. As you know, the mountain lion preys upon our
-pony herds. By killing this one, that would be one less lion to worry
-about. My father looked around the circle of braves and asked who would
-go with him to kill the lion. The braves talked a great deal and at last
-two of them stepped forward and said that they would go.
-
-“Slowly the three men began the climb into the hills. The lion had seen
-them coming and headed for higher ground. But finally he came to a solid
-wall and could climb no farther. My father stepped forward and drew his
-bow and shot an arrow toward the lion. He missed and the lion started
-toward him, snarling. The other braves turned and ran for their lives.
-There was no time to shoot another arrow, so my father drew his knife
-and waited for the lion’s charge.
-
-“The beast leaped, and my father caught the lion on his knife. Again and
-again, he plunged the knife into the lion. The fight ended quickly. The
-lion lay dead at my father’s feet. My father had not even been
-scratched. Dancing around his victim, my father cut the lion’s tail off
-and placed it in his pouch. Then he caught up with the other braves
-farther down the trail, and they continued on the hunt for the ponies.
-
-“After they found the ponies and brought them back to the village, my
-father told the council of his brave fight and held the tail of the lion
-on high for all to see. For his courage, he was allowed to wear another
-feather in his headdress. Now he is really a brave worthy of honor from
-all. But the two who deserted him were cowards and do not deserve to be
-members of our tribe.”
-
-When Little Thunderbird had finished, he seated himself in the circle
-once again. He was proud of the way the other boys listened to his story
-and the way they talked of his father as a great brave. Little
-Thunderbird enjoyed the attention he was getting, but in his heart he
-was troubled. He had made up the whole story. There was no truth at all
-in it. Then the test came.
-
-“Take us to see the lion’s tail, Little Thunderbird,” one of the boys
-said. “We want to see the lion’s tail.” And the rest of the boys took up
-the cry.
-
-Now what was Little Thunderbird to do? But he decided to bluff it out
-anyway. He led the boys to his father’s tepee. When they got there, he
-searched hurriedly for something that looked like a lion’s tail. But he
-could not find anything. The boys began to get angry.
-
-“You lied to us, Little Thunderbird,” one of them said. “Your father
-never killed a lion, and he is not the greatest brave in the tribe!”
-
-The other boys agreed. They ran out, leaving Little Thunderbird standing
-at the entrance to his father’s tepee. Suddenly, Little Thunderbird felt
-very much alone. In the next few days, he began to feel even more lonely
-because the other boys would not play with him or speak to him. This
-went on, until one day Little Thunderbird refused to leave the tepee.
-His mother asked him if he felt sick, and he told her he was “just a
-little tired.” But Little Thunderbird’s mother knew that something must
-be wrong and so she talked with her husband about it.
-
-“I know what is wrong, my dear wife. My friends have told me of Little
-Thunderbird’s tale to the other boys one day about the brave deed of his
-father, the greatest warrior the Blackfoot have ever known. When they
-asked Little Thunderbird to prove the story, he could not. He had lied
-to his friends and his conscience is punishing him.”
-
-“But can’t you help him?” the boy’s mother pleaded.
-
-“There is nothing I can do. Many moons ago I taught my son the strength
-of truth. He does not have to lie now. If he is not proud of his father,
-let him say so. I am not ashamed that I have not done something great
-and have not done something very brave. I have done no more and no less
-than most of the braves of the tribe. Surely I am not the greatest
-warrior in the tribe, and I have never given Little Thunderbird any
-reason to say that I am. The boys will not make fun of him if he tells
-the truth. They know that their fathers are like me. The boys will
-probably praise him if he admits that he lied.”
-
-Little Thunderbird lay just inside the tepee and had heard his father
-speaking with his mother. Rising from his bed, he ran out of the tepee
-and headed through the village to find his friends. His parents
-understood and did not try to call him back. Finally, he found them,
-once again seated in a council circle like the men of the tribe. When
-they saw him coming, the tallest arose from his place and stopped Little
-Thunderbird before he could reach the circle.
-
-“What is it you want here, teller of lies?” he asked angrily. “We do not
-want you for a friend. Go from this place. There is none here that you
-could call a friend.”
-
-“Wait, let me speak,” Little Thunderbird begged. “I have something
-important to say and I want to be heard.”
-
-“All right, speak,” the tall lad said, “but be brief—and none of your
-lies!”
-
-Little Thunderbird stepped to the center of the circle. He was about to
-raise his arms for silence as he had done before, but he thought better
-of it and waited until the boys were quiet once again.
-
-“The last time I stood before you I told you of my father’s brave deed
-in fighting a mountain lion.” The boys began to laugh, but Little
-Thunderbird went on. “I lied to you. My father is a brave man but he has
-never had to fight a mountain lion. My father taught me to tell the
-truth when I was very young. He trusted that I would, and I have broken
-that trust. But I have learned my lesson. Lies can bring nothing but
-hurt to the liar and to all who trust him. If we speak with a straight
-tongue, our friends will believe in us and trust us. I ask you now to
-trust me. I will never lie again. Your friendship means too much to me.”
-
-The tall boy rose from the circle. The other boys watched him closely to
-see what he would do. Everyone was very quiet.
-
-“Here truly is a brave Blackfoot,” the tall boy said. “It took real
-courage for Little Thunderbird to come before this council and admit he
-was wrong.” He paused and looked at Little Thunderbird. “I offer you my
-hand in friendship once again. Come, take your place in the council.”
-
-Little Thunderbird smiled and took his place. A short distance from the
-circle, a tall brave smiled, too. Little Thunderbird’s father had been
-sure to speak loudly so that his voice would be heard by the young boy
-inside the tepee.
-
-
- Based on an idea from a story told to the author by Mr. Walter
- Elliott.
-
-
-
-
- THE PRIZE NO ONE COULD SEE
-
-
-The dawn came slowly as the sun tried to fight its way through the mist
-that hung in the valleys. The spring had been cool, and for nearly a
-moon rain had been drenching the ground. By midmorning, the sun had
-burned away the haze, and its rays beat down upon the little Kickapoo
-village, warming and drying everything that had been wet and cold for so
-long.
-
-When Little Snapping Turtle walked from his father’s wigwam and saw the
-bright sun and the blue skies, he called to his father who was still
-inside.
-
-“Father, father, come here! See, the sun has won. The storm clouds have
-run from the battle with the sun. Once again we have light and warmth.
-Is this not a good reason for a celebration?”
-
-“Yes, my son, it is reason enough for you and your friends to celebrate.
-But we should be glad for the rain we have had because it makes the
-forest green and gives the streams new strength and makes the lakes rise
-so that all the animals may drink. Of course, it has also kept the young
-braves in their houses, so now that the sun is out again we should have
-a celebration.”
-
-“What shall we do, father? Can we go on a hunt or a fishing trip? Can
-we, father?”
-
-“No, my son, there is not time for that yet. Now that the sun is with us
-again, there is much gardening to do right here in the village. But late
-this afternoon we shall have a race to see who has lost the most speed
-during this lazy vacation. Go to the other young braves in the tribe and
-tell them that I, Big Snapping Turtle, Medicine Man of the Kickapoo
-tribe, will give a fine belt and knife as a prize to the young brave who
-wins the race this afternoon.”
-
-“What kind of a race will it be, father?”
-
-“Oh, it would not be fair to tell you, my young son, for then you would
-have an advantage over the other young braves. Just spread the news and
-this afternoon we will gather in the meadow for the race.”
-
-Eagerly Little Snapping Turtle ran to tell all the young boys to gather
-in the meadow north of the village late in the afternoon for a race. He
-also told them about the prize that any young brave would want. Most of
-the boys he talked to were working hard in the gardens to make up for
-time lost during the rain. But they stopped long enough to listen
-excitedly to the news Little Snapping Turtle brought. All of them said
-they would be there, and then went back to work. The rain had been good
-for the seed, but it had also been good for the weeds. When Little
-Snapping Turtle got back home, he went to work cheerfully with his
-father in their garden to clear out the weeds.
-
-Finally the time neared for the big contest, and the young boys began to
-gather in the meadow. Soon every boy in the village was present, and Big
-Snapping Turtle stepped to the front to explain the rules.
-
-He first gave each boy a small container made of birch bark. After this
-had been done, Big Snapping Turtle signaled for all to be quiet.
-
-“A quarter of a mile from here there are several small lakes,” he said.
-“In one of those lakes, as you know, there are some very small fish.
-Each of you has a container. At the signal you will run to that lake and
-trap a small fish. Making sure to keep the fish in the container, you
-will run back to the meadow. The first boy to return with a fish still
-alive in the container will win the race. Then after the prize has been
-awarded, we will put all the fish you caught into the stream that runs
-through our village so that they can swim to the great lake to the
-south.”
-
-The boys waited impatiently for the signal. When it was given, they
-shouted and laughed as they raced toward the lake that held the small
-fish. Little Snapping Turtle soon was far ahead of the other young boys.
-When he reached the lake shore, he waded knee deep into the lake and
-placed his container halfway under and then stood perfectly still,
-waiting for the curious little fish to swim into the trap.
-
-As he stood there quietly, peering at the sandy bottom, several of the
-others arrived and began to follow his lead. Soon there were fifteen or
-twenty of them spread out near the shore standing motionless waiting for
-the fish. Now and then a boy would shout that he had made a catch only
-to find that the fish had escaped.
-
-Finally patience rewarded Little Snapping Turtle. With a flick of his
-wrist, Little Snapping Turtle scooped his container into the water. When
-he looked into it, he discovered that he had trapped two fish instead of
-one. Quickly he waded toward shore and he saw that two boys had also
-trapped their fish and were on the way back to the meadow. He stopped
-only a moment to tear a large leaf from a plant that grew along the lake
-shore. Then he wrapped it tightly over the mouth of the container and
-started running again.
-
-The two boys were running swiftly ahead of him along the trail, each
-with a container in his hand. Suddenly, one of the boys slipped and fell
-and his container and fish went flying off into the brush. Now only one
-boy, Crying Hawk, stood between Little Snapping Turtle and victory.
-Using all the strength he had, he began to catch up with the young boy
-ahead of him.
-
-As he began to pass Crying Hawk, he noticed that the boy was limping.
-Looking at the boy’s feet, he saw that Crying Hawk’s moccasins were
-loose, and he guessed that a pebble must have fallen into one of them.
-The boy stopped to take the pebble out. As he did, Little Snapping
-Turtle sped by him. Turning to look at Crying Hawk, Little Snapping
-Turtle found that the boy had just sat down and was crying. He stopped
-and went back to him.
-
-“What is the trouble, Crying Hawk?” Little Snapping Turtle asked kindly.
-
-“I thought that for once I could win a game and own a new knife and
-belt. But a pebble has cut my foot, and I cannot hope to win now. I was
-lucky enough to catch my fish first and I thought that I had a good head
-start. But as it always has happened, an accident will make me lose the
-race. I will never be a winner. Don’t wait for me, Little Snapping
-Turtle. If you stay with me any longer, the other boys will catch up
-with you.”
-
-Then Little Snapping Turtle remembered that Crying Hawk had never won
-any contest. He was a little slower than the other boys, and not so
-skilled as many of them. He, Little Snapping Turtle, had won many
-contests and many prizes. Quickly he took off his own new doeskin
-moccasins and slipped them onto Crying Hawk’s feet.
-
-“These will protect your feet,” he told Crying Hawk. “Run quickly now,
-for you still have a chance. Take my container, too. I have sealed a
-leaf tightly over the top and little water will spill. Today you will
-win the race.”
-
-Crying Hawk started to complain, but Little Snapping Turtle silenced
-him. He pulled the other boy to his feet and, shoving the container into
-his hand, sent him on his way. With the new moccasins, the boy ran more
-easily and soon was out of sight. Little Snapping Turtle picked up
-Crying Hawk’s container and put his feet into the ill-fitting moccasins.
-He trotted slowly after Crying Hawk, keeping just far enough behind to
-make sure the boy would win.
-
-He heard several pairs of feet moving swiftly along the trail just in
-back of him. From here to the meadow, the trail narrowed and only one
-boy could use it at one time. So Little Snapping Turtle kept his slow
-pace and kept the others from passing Crying Hawk. Little Snapping
-Turtle could see the clearing now and he sped toward the meadow. There
-he saw Crying Hawk standing proudly next to Little Snapping Turtle’s
-father. He ran up to Crying Hawk.
-
-“Say nothing of what happened on the trail,” he whispered. “You have run
-a good race, Crying Hawk.”
-
-Soon all the boys were back and the inspection of the containers began.
-When Big Snapping Turtle had seen all of them, he stepped to the front
-and declared Crying Hawk the winner. Everyone cheered as the boy
-received the knife and belt from the smiling Medicine Man. Then they all
-started back toward the village to place the fish in the stream and then
-go home.
-
-As Little Snapping Turtle and his father walked along the trail, the
-Medicine Man asked, “Where did you get that container, my son?”
-
-Little Snapping Turtle blushed as he looked up at his father, but his
-father smiled. “It is well, my son. I knew each container that I had
-given out and at the end of the race you did not have the one you had
-started with. I also noticed the beautiful moccasins that Crying Hawk
-was wearing. I discovered, too, how big my son’s heart really is. Today
-you lost a race, but the happiness you won is the best possible prize.”
-
-
-
-
- THE MYSTERIOUS PONY RAIDERS
-
-
-Among the American Indians truth was respected as most sacred. Parents
-took great pains to teach their children that above all else, a good
-Indian was one who had honor and spoke nothing but the truth, or, as the
-Indians would say, spoke with a straight tongue. It is about the power
-of truth that this story is told.
-
-The Blackfoot Indians were a wandering tribe of the Western plains.
-Their very lives depended upon the great buffalo herds. From the buffalo
-meat and hides, the Blackfeet were able to get their food, skins for
-clothing, and their tepees; and from the head, horns, and tail,
-decorations for costume and headdress.
-
-Blackfoot villages were always moving, since they were set up near the
-grazing herds of buffalo. When the herd moved, the whole tribe would tie
-its belongings onto travois drawn by horses, and move with the buffalo
-until the animals stopped once again to graze where there was more
-prairie grass.
-
-Young Deerfoot, the son of a great warrior of the Blackfeet, Sleeping
-Bear, prided himself on being one of the strongest of the tribe’s young
-braves. While growing into young manhood, he had won many honors in his
-tribe as a warrior and a great hunter. Blind Dog was another young brave
-about Deerfoot’s age. The son of Black Dog, he also had become quite
-famous among the Blackfeet for his honors in war and hunting.
-
-Both young braves were guarding the tribe’s horses, one very warm summer
-evening as the chiefs of the Blackfeet were gathered in the center of
-the village around the blazing campfires. The chiefs had met to talk of
-tribal problems and to plan ahead for fall and winter. At this time,
-life had been unusually peaceful on the plains. There had been some
-horse stealing and a few occasional skirmishes among small parties of
-raiders from different tribes. Outside of that, there had not been much
-excitement.
-
-As the chiefs sat around the fire, Blind Dog and Deerfoot were taking
-their job of standing guard over the horses very seriously. The quiet
-was broken by a noise off to one side of the herd of horses. Deerfoot
-signaled silently to Blind Dog to draw near so that they might speak.
-When Blind Dog had reached Deerfoot’s side the two crouched low behind
-the horses, and Deerfoot whispered that he had heard a noise slightly to
-the west of the herd.
-
-The two braves crept forward on their hands and knees, keeping the
-horses between themselves and whatever had made the noise. The horses
-began moving uneasily as the two young braves drew closer to the spot
-from which the noise had come.
-
-Deerfoot stopped abruptly. He slapped Blind Dog’s shoulder and began to
-laugh. Not two paces from them was a small mongrel dog which had
-wandered down among the horses seeking a cool place in which to lie and
-rest for a while. When Blind Dog saw what had amused Deerfoot so much,
-he laughed too, because they had been so alarmed by a dog.
-
-“If it were not so quiet tonight,” Deerfoot remarked, “we would not have
-been so worried by anything so unimportant as a puppy.”
-
-“Yes,” Blind Dog agreed, “it has been much too quiet. We have not had
-much excitement. Things have been far too peaceful.”
-
-“Do you wish to have a war on your hands, Blind Dog?” Deerfoot asked
-with a smile.
-
-“Well, it would be a very welcome change from horse herd duty at night,
-and repairing bridles and broken weapons in the daytime.”
-
-“You are getting restless, my friend.” Deerfoot spoke soberly now. “That
-is not good. When one gets restless, one becomes careless. That can be
-dangerous.”
-
-At first, Blind Dog refused to be serious. “Oh, do not worry, Deerfoot.
-I may have become restless, but I will never become careless.” Then he
-added gravely, “To become careless even for a moment might mean death to
-a warrior like myself. There is many a brave in other tribes who would
-love to see my scalp hanging from his tepee pole. But I like the feel of
-my scalp right where it is. Anyway, nothing—not even a puppy—will ever
-catch me off guard.”
-
-“Do not be so sure of yourself, Blind Dog. Being so sure can make any
-brave careless. You must always be alert. It may seem too peaceful to us
-here now, but even the quiet shadows of this very night could conceal
-our enemies. As we sit here talking noisily about not being careless,
-they could be stealing some of our best horses. Let us go back to our
-guard posts so that we can watch the herd as we should.”
-
-Deerfoot and Blind Dog mounted their horses and had started to circle
-the herd to see that nothing had disturbed the horses. When they had
-finished checking and had dismounted, Blind Dog complained that he felt
-ill.
-
-“Since we have just checked the herd and everything is all right,”
-Deerfoot said, “why don’t you return to the village, Blind Dog, and go
-to your tepee? It is almost time for the other guards to take our
-places. I can stand guard alone for that short time.”
-
-Blind Dog said that he should not leave his friend, but with Deerfoot’s
-urging, he finally agreed and walked slowly back toward the village.
-Arriving at his tepee, he found that his father must still be at the
-council meeting. The night air had become chilly and he wrapped himself
-in a warm buffalo robe and curled up in the corner of the tepee. Blind
-Dog was just about to fall off to sleep when he heard men shouting
-excitedly and horses snorting and pounding their hoofs. He struggled out
-of the robe and stepped outside of the tepee in time to see several
-chieftains break from the council ring and head toward the horses.
-
-As they reached the edge of the herd, they called out for the guard but
-there was no response. They called again and again, but their only
-answer was the stomping of horses and the frightened neighing of ponies.
-It was very dark and it was some time before the chieftains discovered
-that about six of their finest animals were missing. Where were the
-guards, they wondered, and how had the horses gotten loose? Then someone
-noticed Blind Dog and called to him.
-
-“Blind Dog, were you not on watch with Deerfoot? What did you see? What
-happened? Who raided our herd?”
-
-Blind Dog looked at Great Owl and his father, Black Dog, who stood
-waiting for his answer. Just then they heard the clopping of a single
-pony’s hoofs. Peering into the darkness, they could make out the figure
-of a lone horseman riding wildly toward the standing group. As the rider
-came nearer, Blind Dog saw that it was his friend. Deerfoot jumped from
-his pony and stood, breathless and bleeding, before the chieftains,
-waiting for silence so that he could report what had happened. When
-everyone was quiet, Deerfoot began his story. For the moment, Blind Dog
-was forgotten.
-
-“Blind Dog and I were on guard here at the horse herd,” Deerfoot said,
-“when we heard a strange noise. We found that it was only a stray dog
-that had wandered down here to the horse herd. We went back to our guard
-posts and settled down again, keeping careful watch.
-
-“After some time had passed, I heard another noise much like the dog had
-made so I did not pay any attention. Suddenly, the horses became uneasy.
-When I went to see what the trouble was, I was struck a blow on the side
-of my head. It was not too hard a blow and only made me a little dizzy.
-As I shook off the shadows from my brain, I spotted a small group of
-warriors who were cutting some of our best ponies loose from the herd.
-Then I called for Blind Dog and started after the raiders. By the time I
-had reached the place the raiders had been, they were already heading
-back into the night, driving several of our ponies before them. I
-quickly mounted a pony and started to chase the thieves, but I lost them
-in the darkness. Perhaps I was closer to them than I realized because
-they let some of the stolen ponies go. I have been able to round up some
-of the ponies, but I believe there are still a few missing. I will mount
-up again and start after them immediately.”
-
-But Chief Great Owl stopped Deerfoot with a wave of his hand and said,
-“No, Deerfoot, let some of the other braves round them up. You are hurt
-and need rest. But first we must speak with Blind Dog. Who has seen
-Blind Dog?”
-
-Without any hesitation, Blind Dog stepped from the circle of braves and
-stood next to Deerfoot.
-
-“You summoned me, Chief Great Owl?” he asked politely.
-
-“Blind Dog, were you on herd guard duty tonight with Deerfoot?”
-
-“Yes, Great Chief, I was.”
-
-“When Deerfoot called you to assist him, why did you not answer?”
-
-“Because I was not where I could hear Deerfoot.”
-
-“Where were you then?”
-
-“When Deerfoot called for help, I was in my tepee just about to go off
-to sleep.”
-
-Great Owl glared at Blind Dog. “Do you mean that you had left your guard
-post to sleep in your tepee, leaving Deerfoot here alone to watch the
-herd?”
-
-Black Dog waited for his son to answer. “Speak, my son,” he pleaded.
-“Tell Great Owl that you did not desert your friend and leave him alone
-on duty.”
-
-“I am sorry, father, but what he says is true. I was not at my guard
-post when the raiders came in the night. I did neglect my duty and for
-that I shall take proper punishment.”
-
-“My son,” Black Dog said with great sorrow in his voice, “do you know
-what you are saying? You are admitting that you have shirked your duty.
-Is guarding the herd not important to the whole tribe?”
-
-“Yes, father, it is very important. I am ashamed of what I have done.”
-
-Great Owl ordered Blind Dog to be held under guard until the council
-should decide his punishment.
-
-Quietly, Blind Dog went with the guards. He glanced back toward
-Deerfoot, but Deerfoot would not meet his gaze. Dropping his head upon
-his chest, Blind Dog was troubled that Deerfoot had avoided looking at
-him. He was worried, too, about why Deerfoot had not told the rest of
-the story—how Deerfoot had insisted that he go to his tepee when he had
-felt ill. Then he guessed that Deerfoot must have had a good reason, so
-Blind Dog would not change his friend’s story unless he really had to.
-He vowed, however, that he would try to speak with Deerfoot and discover
-for himself just why Deerfoot had not told them the whole story.
-
-The tepee in which Blind Dog was held under guard was close to the
-center of the village where the council had met. Suddenly, he heard many
-voices talking excitedly and realized that the council had gathered
-again. What had been a calm council before had now become an angry group
-of men seeking revenge upon the horse stealers. He heard Deerfoot
-repeating his story and the chieftains questioning him closely. Above
-all they wanted to know of what tribe the raiders were members. Then he
-could hear Deerfoot reply vaguely, “It was dark and I was still confused
-from the blow upon my head. I would not want to accuse any tribe unless
-I were sure. But who could be this close to us?”
-
-Many of the chiefs shook their heads in doubt, but Sleeping Bear rose to
-plead for war, repeating by his own son’s account of the stealing of
-fine horses by a neighboring tribe.
-
-Crouched in the tepee, Blind Dog realized now why Deerfoot had not told
-the complete story. Rushing to the entrance of the tepee, he begged the
-guards to take him before Chief Great Owl and the council. One of the
-guards ran to the council and reported the prisoner’s mysterious
-request. Chief Great Owl said that Blind Dog should be permitted to
-enter the council ring and speak to the council.
-
-With head held high, Blind Dog stepped to the center of the ring and
-gazed around at the unfriendly eyes which peered at him from faces of
-stone. Finally Blind Dog spoke.
-
-“Since I was but a tiny boy holding tightly to my father’s hand so that
-I would not stumble, I have been taught to respect the property of
-others. I have been taught to honor my parents and the elders of our
-tribe. I have been taught to learn well the many things a good brave
-should learn. Above all, I have learned the power of truth.
-
-“My father has told me many times that I would never gain by telling a
-lie. I have seen the truth of this often. Now, more strongly than ever,
-I see the power that truth can have. I wondered a while ago why Deerfoot
-had not told the whole story, but now I know.
-
-“Yes, we were on guard duty together, as he told you, and we did hear a
-noise after that of the dog. We circled the herd to see that all was
-well. Upon returning to our starting place, I told Deerfoot that I was
-not feeling well. I had suddenly become chilled and sick to my stomach.
-Deerfoot reminded me that it was almost time for us to be relieved, but
-that I should go immediately to my tepee to rest. He said that he would
-be glad to stand guard alone. I realized that what I did then was wrong,
-but I felt so sick that I followed Deerfoot’s suggestion and went to my
-father’s tepee. There I rolled myself in a buffalo blanket and lay in
-pain for some time until I, too, heard Deerfoot’s shouts and the
-hoofbeats of the horses running away from our camp.
-
-“I, too, rushed to the herd and reached there a short time before most
-of you. I looked around quickly for signs that would show how many
-raiders there had been. But oh, Great Chieftain, there were no tracks of
-any ponies other than our own.
-
-“Deerfoot has used this story to try to arouse our tribe to a war. He
-thirsts for the excitement that fighting would bring him. Now I am sure
-that Deerfoot ran those ponies off himself in order to cause a war
-between our tribe and our nearest neighbors. If I am lying now, punish
-me doubly; but if I am right, let the punishment fall where it belongs,
-even upon my friend.”
-
-Great Owl rose and called upon Deerfoot to defend himself. All eyes were
-turned in his direction as Deerfoot rose to face Blind Dog.
-
-“Oh, Great Chief,” said Deerfoot, “all that Blind Dog has told you is
-true. I sent him from the herd and I ran the ponies off into the night.
-I made the wound that you see on my head. We had no raiders in our camp
-tonight. Blind Dog has just taught me the true meaning of loyalty to my
-tribe.
-
-“The fact that he was placed under guard and was to be punished made
-little difference to him. But when he discovered that my plan was to
-hurt more than him and me, he spoke out for what he believed was the
-truth. Yes, I had hoped to force our tribe into war. I hoped that I
-might be honored for bravery in war, even though I would sacrifice the
-honor and friendship of my boyhood companion, Blind Dog, and many of our
-braves might be killed in useless fighting. To make myself once again a
-man in Blind Dog’s sight, let me repeat his words. ‘I am ashamed of what
-I have done.’ Let the council punish me so that I will not forget again
-the sacredness of truth and friendship and loyalty to my tribe.”
-
-
- The incident around which this story is woven was told to the author
- by Sam Carpin, trapper, hunter, and former member of the Butte,
- Montana, Police Force.
-
-
-
-
- THE CANOE RACE
-
-
-Long Bow for many moons had been the champion of the canoe racers in the
-Ottawa village and had accepted every challenge that had ever come his
-way.
-
-From the time he was a young boy he had spent many hours upon the waters
-of the great lake practicing his canoeing until he felt there wasn’t
-another boy in the tribe that could come at all close to beating him in
-a fair race.
-
-Soon the great hunt was upon them, and the warriors gathered their
-weapons and headed north to hunt the elusive deer. Whenever they went
-off on these hunts Black Rock, a short husky young warrior, always could
-be seen as the constant companion of Long Bow.
-
-As the hunting party trotted along the woodland trail getting farther
-and farther from the village, Black Rock and Long Bow would hold
-conversation in sentences with very few words.
-
-“I think we will have a good hunt, Long Bow.”
-
-“Yes, Black Rock, for the signs of deer in this area are many.”
-
-“We have had a good year, and if the gods bless us we will have another
-good year.”
-
-“Soon the winter will be upon us and we must wait a long time for the
-spring.”
-
-“Long Bow, you speak of the winter when here it is just late spring.”
-
-“It will be a long summer for me.”
-
-“Why so, friend Long Bow?”
-
-“It used to be that during the summer when we held our games and
-contests there would be excitement and thrills.”
-
-“Are there still not excitement and thrills for you?”
-
-“Black Rock, my friend, I have become so skilled that there are none
-left in our tribe who give me any competition.”
-
-“That is not a wise way to talk, Long Bow. One must never set himself
-above all others; that can be said only by the council.”
-
-As they continued along the trail, Black Rock said no more to his
-friend, and Long Bow did not seem concerned that his friend offered no
-more conversation.
-
-Soon they both forgot about the talk, for the hunting party had begun to
-split up in search of the game. For the next few hours the party made
-many fine shots and then it was time to return to the village.
-
-Each of the two braves had a fine buck strung upon a pole between them
-as they walked easily along the trail homeward. Once again Black Rock
-and Long Bow were a team.
-
-Now the excitement of the hunt was over and the catch was good, and all
-the braves were feeling very good about their success. And so as a
-result there was much talk and laughing and joking about the misses and
-successful shots. Long Bow noticed that Black Rock was especially quiet
-as they walked along the trail.
-
-“Black Rock, my friend, what makes your tongue so still? You have made a
-fine kill this day and there will be much fresh meat for the village,
-yet you walk with a heavy step and your voice is still.”
-
-“I am silent for a good reason, Long Bow my friend, for I fear that if I
-speak my heart will speak rather than my lips.”
-
-Long Bow said nothing for a long while, trying to figure out what Black
-Rock meant by such a statement. Finally the leader of the hunt called a
-halt and the warriors placed their heavy burdens upon the ground and
-seated themselves under the shade trees to rest and drink of the water
-pouches before the journey homeward.
-
-As Black Rock and Long Bow sat beneath a tree, Long Bow chanced a
-question of his friend.
-
-“What did you mean, friend Black Rock, that your heart would speak
-rather than your lips?”
-
-“As we approached the hunting grounds, my friend, you said that your
-summer would not be enjoyable because there was no competition for you.
-Would the fact that you are among your people not give you joy enough?
-Must there always be competition or contests to make your blood run
-fast?”
-
-“Black Rock, you are one who can be contented with every-day living in
-our village. I cannot, and the yearly games and contests I have always
-looked forward to with great anticipation; but for the past three years
-there has been no competition among the braves, especially in the king
-of contests, the canoe race. Eagerly the young braves have met me on the
-lake, but I am so skilled that no one has been able to come even close
-to winning in the canoe race.”
-
-“This is not a good way to feel, friend Long Bow, so I guess it is time
-that someone told you so. I, Black Rock, will challenge you upon the
-lake and then we shall see if there is no competition left in the
-village.”
-
-Now Long Bow had never raced against his friend Black Rock, for Black
-Rock had never entered the canoe race, leaving the glory to his friend
-Long Bow. He also knew that Black Rock was considered a good man in a
-canoe but not good enough to defeat the great Long Bow.
-
-“Then this is a challenge, friend Black Rock?”
-
-“Yes, Long Bow, when the moon is full, on the following dawn we shall
-man our canoes on the great blue water. We shall race and see who best
-handles the canoe.”
-
-Long Bow laughed. “Oh, Black Rock, are you serious? Do you really think
-that you can beat your friend Long Bow in a canoe race?”
-
-“I do not know, Long Bow, but someone has to try.”
-
-The leader called, and the men picked up their burdens and continued on
-their way home.
-
-In the days that followed, whenever Long Bow had no work to do he could
-be found out on the lake paddling up and down the shore line practicing
-hard for the coming event. Black Rock on the other hand very rarely
-would be seen in a canoe unless he were fishing or trapping.
-
-Word had spread swiftly through the village about the canoe race, and
-the excitement was growing as each night the moon appeared more full.
-Finally the moon was full and that night there was a great celebration
-in the camp in preparation for the big event.
-
-Many of the braves were making wagers as to who would win, and there
-even were some hot words; but the men realized that this was to be a
-friendly challenge. Suddenly one of the braves realized that Black Rock
-was nowhere to be seen. This was unheard of the night before a great
-contest and they looked high and low but could find no trace of him.
-Finally one of the men thought to ask his wife who had been sitting
-quietly off to one side.
-
-“He has taken a walk before retiring. He said that he wished to be alone
-this night.”
-
-Black Rock was alone. He had walked to a small glen a short way from the
-camp, and there if one had come he would have seen a young warrior
-kneeling talking to someone although no other person could be seen.
-
-“O, Great Manitou, who guides the lives of all red men, give me strength
-tomorrow to wield a strong and sure paddle. Carry my canoe swiftly
-across the waters and on to victory. Not for the glory that it will
-bring me but to wipe from the heart of my friend Long Bow his feeling
-that he is above the other men of the tribe. If he can be made to see
-right again, as a good Ottawa brave should, this is all that I ask.”
-
-When he had finished Black Rock rose and returned to his home. The
-celebrating was still going on, but quietly Black Rock said good-night
-to his wife and wrapped himself in his blanket and was soon asleep. He
-had been troubled, but his walk and his prayer had eased his mind, for
-now he knew that it rested with the great spirits.
-
-The following day dawned bright and clear, and before the sun had risen
-very far in the heavens the lake shore was crowded with eager spectators
-waiting for the start of the race.
-
-The rules were outlined to the two warriors and then each took his
-position along the shore, standing in their respective canoes. About a
-mile down the shore of the lake a warrior stood with a gayly colored
-coup stick. This was the point which would indicate the finish line. The
-signal was given, and the two men bent to the task.
-
-The crowd cheered as the two canoes sped down the shore line, neither
-one getting far ahead before the other would pull alongside. As they
-neared the finish line, the watchers on the shore could see the muscles
-of the two men striving in their backs and shoulders.
-
-Finally the finish line was just a few yards away, and with a mighty
-surge, Black Rock drove his canoe across the finish line first.
-
-There was a mixed chorus of groans and cheers as the men returned to the
-starting point and beached their canoes. The crowd milled around Black
-Rock as he stepped ashore, but he raised his arms for silence.
-
-“Long Bow has lost the race this day, but let no man say that he is not
-a good man with the canoe; for there are none among us who to this day
-have been able to defeat him. I shake the hand of my brother Long Bow
-and to him I say, it was a great race and I have won, but it was a close
-race and if we raced again I might not be so lucky.”
-
-“No, Black Rock, it was not luck this day that won the race, but rather
-a strong back being helped by a true loyal heart. I know now why you
-challenged me and I could not have won if you had tied one hand behind
-your back. I have been selfish and ungrateful for the many friends and
-good things that have been showered upon me. I have lost this battle of
-the canoes, but it has helped me win a battle with myself. I thank you,
-Black Rock, for bringing a straying warrior once again into the camp of
-good Ottawas.”
-
-
-
-
- STANDING FAWN MAKES A DOLL
-
-
-When the excitement was over in Flying Arrow’s wigwam and all the
-Shawnee had returned to their own homes to sit and talk of the birth of
-a new son to Flying Arrow, Standing Fawn, daughter to Flying Arrow,
-wandered off from the wickiup to think about this thing that had
-happened.
-
-Until this day, little Standing Fawn had been the center of attention in
-the home of her mother and father and also when they went to visit
-friends; but now a new baby boy had been born, and everyone was very
-excited. When Standing Fawn had come running to tell her mother how she
-had helped her grandmother to dry rabbit skins and to make furry ropes
-for blankets her mother had said how nice that was, but went right back
-to taking care of the little boy Indian that now held the place of honor
-in the home of Flying Arrow.
-
-This Standing Fawn could not understand, but for the time being she did
-not think about it any more but went to join the other girls that were
-gathering nuts. The girls had to hurry so that they gathered enough nuts
-for the tribal families before the squirrels got them all.
-
-The walnut and butternut hulls were used for dyeing quills and so many,
-many nuts had to be gathered that soon the baskets were bulging with
-these and beechnuts, hazelnuts, and hickory nuts. When the task was over
-Standing Fawn returned home to her father and mother and her little
-brother.
-
-As she entered the wickiup she could hear her mother singing softly to
-the new baby. There against the wall was the carrying case for the baby
-which Standing Fawn had helped her mother to make. That was fun working
-with her mother, but now mother was busy with the new baby and so
-Standing Fawn felt that she was no longer loved.
-
-After supper, she crawled into her warm blankets and was soon asleep,
-but she awakened a short time later as the new baby cried for food. The
-crying continued until he was fed and then Standing Fawn was asleep once
-again.
-
-For many weeks there was a great deal of work to be done with the new
-baby in the house, and Standing Fawn found that more and more she was
-asked to carry on the duties that her mother had done before this time.
-
-When friends came to visit, they still had a smile and warm pat on the
-head for Standing Fawn, but most of the attention was given to her
-little brother, or so it seemed to Standing Fawn.
-
-One night the little baby was very restless and did a lot of crying.
-Standing Fawn did not sleep well that night and in the morning when she
-rose to stir the coals for the morning fire and prepare to cook the
-breakfast she was feeling very cross. Her mother called to her from the
-wickiup.
-
-“Standing Fawn, will you go to the stream and fetch some fresh water and
-heat it for me, please?”
-
-“Yes, mother, I will go, but I am so tired,” Standing Fawn heard herself
-answer. “Today I would like to go to grandmother’s to help her with the
-quills if I may.”
-
-“But, Standing Fawn, I need your help here today.”
-
-“I want to go to grandmother’s today.”
-
-“All right, Standing Fawn, you may go to grandmother’s today. I will
-manage alone.”
-
-So after Standing Fawn had fetched the water she skipped merrily on her
-way to join her grandmother who was busy this winter in making fancy
-quill work upon moccasins and leggings, knife sheaths, and anything else
-that needed bright decoration.
-
-“Welcome, Standing Fawn, you have not been to see your grandmother for a
-long time. I was beginning to think that you had forgotten old Granny.”
-
-“No, grandmother, it is just that with the new baby I have been kept so
-busy that I have not been able to leave home for very long at all. I
-wish the new boy had never come to our home.” With that Standing Fawn
-kicked her foot at some soft rabbit hides that lay on the floor of the
-wickiup, more angry at herself than anything else.
-
-“Now, now,” said her grandmother. “That is no way to feel, especially
-about a little boy who was not able to choose whether he would come to
-the house of your father or not. He is very small and he does not
-understand if you are angry with him, but he does understand love and
-attention.”
-
-“Yes, grandmother, and he is getting plenty of that from everyone who
-comes to our house. Since he has come I have been very unhappy, and I
-shouldn’t be unhappy, should I, grandmother?”
-
-“No, Standing Fawn, that is not the right feeling to have in your heart.
-Let me explain something to you as best I can.
-
-“When you were born your father was disappointed, for you were a girl
-and he had hoped so for a warrior son, but he loved you as much as if
-you were a boy; for, as your mother said to him, your daughter will bear
-many sons. Your parents loved you and cherished you and did everything
-they could to make your life a happy and pleasant one. When your mother
-was heavy with child you were a great help to her around the wickiup.
-When your brother was born, there was much excitement in the village,
-for it was a boy and now your father had a warrior son and a beautiful
-daughter.
-
-“For this he was very thankful and went to the hills to thank the great
-spirit for blessing his home so. When he returned there was great
-rejoicing once again just as there was when you were born, but then the
-work started just as when you were born, and your mother had no one to
-help her when you were a very small baby, but now she had you and she
-depends a great deal upon you to help her with your little brother. Soon
-he will be big and strong and you will be very proud to be called his
-sister. But now he is small and needs your love and attention.”
-
-“I understand, grandmother, and I have been a very foolish girl. I will
-try to make up to my brother for this feeling I have had in my heart
-that is bad.”
-
-“I am glad, granddaughter, to hear you say that. Now you had best run
-along, for your mother will be needing help this day.”
-
-“Yes, my grandmother, but first I have something I must do.” So Standing
-Fawn strolled off to a corner of her grandmother’s wickiup and there she
-gathered some items into her lap and began working busily at something.
-Soon it was finished and she rose and saying good-bye to her
-grandmother, walked back to her own wickiup. Her mother was busy
-preparing supper, for the project Standing Fawn worked on had taken most
-of the day.
-
-“Well, my daughter, did you have a nice day with your grandmother?”
-
-“Oh yes, mother, a very nice day.” Standing Fawn was sure to keep her
-hands behind her back so that her mother could not see what she held.
-
-Finally she excused herself and ran into the wickiup. There where he
-usually hung was her baby brother in his cradleboard, warm and sleeping.
-To the large cradle loop above his head, Standing Fawn hung a dainty
-little doll, all dressed in buckskin, that she had been so busy making
-that day. Next to the doll she placed a very small bow and arrows and
-tiny moccasins. Just at that moment her father entered the wickiup.
-
-“See, father, what I have made for my little brother, who will one day
-be a great warrior. When he sees this doll it will make him want to run
-fast and shoot straight and carry himself as a warrior should.”
-
-As Standing Fawn talked her mother had entered and was standing next to
-her father.
-
-Flying Arrow motioned for his daughter to come to him and then kneeling
-on the ground and placing his hands upon his daughter’s shoulders he
-said:
-
-“Surely, my daughter, if he were not destined to be a great warrior he
-would not be blessed with such a fine and beautiful sister. I am a very
-proud man to have such a wonderful family.”
-
-Standing Fawn looked at her mother, and her mother was smiling. And
-inside, Standing Fawn felt all warm and good.
-
-
-
-
- BLACK CLOUD REMEMBERS
-
-
-It had been many weeks since the Seneca hunting party had seen the
-friendly smoke of their own village and as they lay among the pines,
-resting now, they were thinking of how it would be in their village when
-they returned the following day to speak of their success on the hunt.
-Their catch was large and there would be much dancing and celebration
-when they did return.
-
-Black Cloud, leader of the hunting party, lay stretched out beneath the
-boughs of a large pine and gazed up through the branches at the clear
-sky lighted this evening by a bright full moon. The heavens were filled
-with stars, and this would mean a good clear day for travel when dawn
-finally broke upon the forest.
-
-The party had traveled far in search of food but their labors were not
-in vain for they were returning loaded down with good fresh meat for
-their tribe.
-
-The trip had been an exciting one from the standpoint of the hunt, but
-now the excitement was over and the warriors were tired. A half day’s
-journey lay between them and their homes, and they were eager to start
-the next morning.
-
-The canoes had been pulled up the side of the lake and rigged for
-shelter in case of rain but all the party were sleeping in the open. As
-Black Cloud lay gazing at the stars he remembered back to his days as a
-boy when he had made his first hunting trip with his father.
-
-“Come, father, hurry, we must get started!” Little Black Cloud had
-called as he waited at the beach for his father to join him. His father
-finally arrived and, approving of the canoe which his son had chosen, he
-turned it upright and pushed it into the lake. They loaded their packs
-and hunting weapons and soon Black Cloud was seated in the middle of the
-canoe as his father pushed from shore.
-
-“Where are we going to hunt, father?” asked Little Black Cloud.
-
-“Well, my son, I thought that we would try Bear Lake; for many of our
-warriors have reported fine deer around Bear Lake, and you saw the two
-beauties that were brought to the camp last week.”
-
-“Yes, father, they were beautiful bucks, and I hope we are as
-fortunate.”
-
-“We have a hard long journey ahead, my son, and so pull hard upon the
-paddle; for we must reach the upper end of the lake before nightfall.
-There we will make camp and tomorrow we shall carry our canoe to the
-upper lake known as Bear Lake. It is quite a distance and though it may
-seem close it will take us some time to reach our destination.”
-
-Father and son pulled upon the paddles, and soon the canoe was moving
-steadily forward toward the upper end of the lake. As the craft skimmed
-through the water, Little Black Cloud’s father pointed out the many
-signs of wild game that could be seen along the shore.
-
-Here was evidence of where brother beaver had been at work cutting logs
-or here was a grey muddy hole near the lake’s edge to which the forest
-animals came to drink. Always the canoe was kept near the shoreline, for
-this made the trip more interesting since there was much to see.
-
-As noon approached, Little Black Cloud’s father directed the canoe in to
-the shore and beached it in a small cove. Father and son stepped ashore
-and pulled the canoe up after them. Near by there were some fine berry
-bushes and, walking inland a short way, they came upon a clear swift
-flowing stream. They picked some berries and, seating themselves near
-the stream, they made a meal of some fried venison they had brought with
-them, berries, and water. After eating they relaxed for a few moments
-and then the two walked back to the lake edge and climbing aboard their
-canoe once again were soon continuing their journey up the lake shore.
-
-It was near dark when they reached the top of the lake. Little Black
-Cloud’s father guided the canoe into a small stream leading from the
-lake and, calling to his son to stop paddling, he guided the canoe
-softly against the shore of the stream. The two Indians stepped from
-their canoe and then, lifting the canoe from the water, set it upon the
-shore.
-
-“We shall make camp here for the night, my son. You will gather some
-wood and I will see if I can catch us some fish for our supper. I shall
-not be gone long and there will still be plenty of daylight.” Saying
-this, Little Black Cloud’s father took up his fishing line and bone hook
-and a bright spinner and started back through the woods for the lake
-shore.
-
-Little Black Cloud meanwhile started busily preparing camp and gathering
-wood for a fire. In an hour his father was back carrying a fine fish and
-soon they were having fresh fish steaks broiled on green sticks. These
-they flavored with some sugar, which they always carried, and washed it
-down with fresh water.
-
-“And now, my son, we must sleep, for in the morning we have a long walk
-ahead to reach the Bear Lake.”
-
-Father and son rolled into their blankets and the night noises around
-them provided a lullaby.
-
-When dawn broke, Little Black Cloud found that his father had been up
-for some time and that breakfast was ready and waiting.
-
-Following a hearty breakfast, Little Black Cloud picked up his pack. His
-father strapped his own pack upon his back and, balancing the light
-birch bark canoe upon his head, led the way through the forest toward
-the lake. The woodland Indians often had to make portages like this in
-order to reach their final destination.
-
-After traveling for some time in this manner, Little Black Cloud noticed
-a clear space among the trees ahead. His father seemed to sense what he
-was thinking, for he called to his son, “That is Bear Lake just ahead.
-It was given that name many moons ago by our people, for it used to be
-the home of many bears who lived and thrived here, but when our people
-discovered that many fine fish lived in these waters they had to drive
-the bears off in order to make the fishing grounds safe for our people.
-
-“Since the disappearance of the bears the deer have flocked to the
-shores of this fine lake, and now whenever fresh meat is needed a small
-party of us come to the lake and in a short time we have enough meat for
-the needs of our people.”
-
-Soon the two had reached the shores of Bear Lake and, looking out upon
-the calm waters, Little Black Cloud said, “My, how peaceful the waters
-look, father. It seems as though nothing or no one had ever visited
-these shores before.”
-
-Then a short distance down the shore there was a rustling in the brush
-and a splash, and soon the head of a doe would be seen bending to drink,
-and then another and another; and then the eight-pointed head of a buck
-could be seen a short distance beyond the does.
-
-“Look, father, look. How many deer are there?” Little Black Cloud was
-very excited, for never before had he seen such a large number of deer
-in one place at the same time.
-
-“Come, my son, we must leave our gear here and go in pursuit of the fine
-deer. They abide all along these shores and back away from the lakes in
-the shaded glens and the open meadows. It may not be as easy to catch
-them as it is to see them.”
-
-Once again the canoe was placed in the water, and father and son set off
-to hunt the deer. They moved quietly down the shore, but no sooner had
-they reached a spot near enough to fire an arrow when the deer would
-turn and disappear into the woodlands. For several hours they paddled
-the shore but try as they might to approach the deer quietly the animals
-would turn as if warned and, with a flick of their tails, were deep in
-the woods by the time the canoe was within striking distance.
-
-Soon dusk was drawing nigh, and the two turned their canoe to return to
-where they had left their gear.
-
-“Come,” said Little Black Cloud’s father, “we will have some supper and
-when it is dark we shall hunt again.”
-
-“But, father, how can you hunt when it is dark? You cannot see the
-deer.”
-
-“I will show you, my son. First we must gather some pine knots.”
-
-And so the supper was prepared and two very hungry Indians feasted and
-then sat back to allow the food to settle. Finally the father rose and
-taking his boy by the hand they wandered into the woods to gather pine
-knots. Finally they had gathered about ten pine knots and these they
-placed in the bottom of the canoe.
-
-Then Little Black Cloud’s father made an attachment on the front of the
-canoe which would hold a burning pine knot. It was getting dark faster
-now, and so the two Indians loaded their weapons into the canoe and then
-strapping a piece of birch bark to the bow of the canoe to act as a
-reflector they pushed away from shore after lighting a pine knot and
-placing it in the holder which contained sand so the fire would not burn
-the canoe. It was then that Little Black Cloud was able to see why his
-father wanted the pine knots.
-
-As they skimmed along the shore, the deer would see the light and be
-attracted by it to the shore. This would then make them easy targets,
-for their bodies would then be outlined on the shore.
-
-Slowly the canoe moved along the shore until Little Black Cloud’s father
-motioned for him to stop paddling. Placing his paddle in the bottom of
-the canoe, Little Black Cloud took his bow and arrow and stood waiting.
-Soon the flash of a pair of eyes was seen and then Little Black Cloud
-fired.
-
-There was a splash and all was still. They steered the canoe toward the
-place they had seen the deer and there lay a small buck. This was placed
-in the canoe and they moved on.
-
-Little Black Cloud shot another deer that night, and then father and son
-returned to camp to skin and dress the two deer.
-
-The following day they returned to the lake where they had started and
-were soon paddling down the lake shore for home. Little Black Cloud’s
-father decided not to stop that evening and so continued paddling
-swiftly until the friendly fires of the village were in sight. He
-beached the canoe, and a proud father and a very tired young Indian boy
-entered the village that night with two fine specimens of deer.
-
-Black Cloud sighed as he lay under the pine. Yes, these were fond
-memories he had of the days when he was a youth.
-
-But soon he would be doing the same thing his father had done twelve
-summers ago for when he returned to the village the next day, he did not
-know that his wife would be waiting for him with a new-born baby son, a
-boy who would some day paddle swiftly along the lake shore with his
-father.
-
-
-
-
- THE MIRACLE OF THE PINE GROVE
-
-
-The drums beat slowly. A cloud of sadness hung over the Iroquois
-village. People moved slowly about their tasks. Even the pets of the
-village seemed to have lost their playfulness. The little children were
-playing quietly at sitting games, rather than the usual noisy running
-games that they liked so well.
-
-As Little Rock, a young Iroquois warrior, rode into the village with a
-dead buck slung across his pony, he became suddenly aware of the great
-feeling of sadness that was upon his village. Instead of hearing the
-usual gay greetings from the people of the tribe, Little Rock noticed
-that when he looked at them they would shake their heads and turn slowly
-away. Little Rock feared that great trouble had come and wanted to know
-what it was. So he dug his heels into his pony’s sides and sped toward
-his father’s wigwam. As he drew near, he saw a number of people gathered
-close to the entrance. The drums boomed slowly and sadly. As Little Rock
-came nearer his friend, Little Red Cloud, stopped him.
-
-“Wait, Little Rock!” his friend warned gently. “Do not go to your father
-now. The Medicine Man is with him.”
-
-“What is the trouble with my father?”
-
-“Do not worry, Little Rock. Great Rock is a great and strong Chief. He
-will be all right.”
-
-“As my friend, Little Red Cloud, I ask you once again. What is the
-matter with my father? It cannot be so simple, when half the tribe
-gathers outside the entrance to my father’s wigwam. They usually come to
-talk or seek advice, but now they are silent and their faces are sad.
-Tell me, Little Red Cloud, what is wrong?”
-
-Little Rock could not wait for an answer. He jumped from his pony and
-ran swiftly toward his father’s wigwam. He was met at the entrance by
-his mother.
-
-“Wait, Little Rock! Do not come in yet. Tall Spear is making medicine
-for your father. He is very ill.”
-
-“I must go to him. He may need me.”
-
-Just then the Medicine Man joined Little Rock’s mother.
-
-“Your father is asking for you, Little Rock,” the old man said. “You can
-see him now.”
-
-Little Rock stepped inside the wigwam and found his father lying on the
-great buffalo robe, his head propped up. Great Rock’s face looked drawn
-and tired and he breathed with great difficulty. As Little Rock knelt
-beside his father, the sick man’s eyes opened wide.
-
-“My son, you have returned.” Great Rock spoke slowly as though each word
-pained him greatly. “Did you have a good hunt?”
-
-“Yes, my father. There was much game and I was able to bring a really
-fine buck back to our village. He will give us much fine meat, and his
-skin will make you a fine shirt.”
-
-Great Rock closed his eyes for a few moments while Little Rock, his
-mother, and the Medicine Man waited anxiously in silence. Then Great
-Rock opened his eyes, wet his lips, and started speaking with great
-effort again.
-
-“That is good, my son. You have learned the ways of the forest well.
-This was your first trip alone into the great forest, yet you have
-tracked down a fine buck.” The old chief seemed more tired than before.
-
-Little Rock reached for a bowl of soup near by and spooned some of this
-to his father’s lips. The old man started to sip the soup slowly. Then
-he raised his hand weakly.
-
-“My son, your father is old. Last night this sickness came upon me. I
-feel that the time is growing near when I shall journey to the Happy
-Hunting Grounds. I have raised you to be a warrior in our tribe. I have
-taught you the way of the bear and the way of the fox. You will have to
-be the man of the family now and provide for your mother.”
-
-“But, my father,” said Little Rock, “you must not leave us now. Our
-tribe and all the Iroquois need you now more than ever before. There is
-trouble among the tribes. Soon the Great Council will meet. If your seat
-at the Council is taken by one who is not so wise, the trouble among our
-tribes will continue and become greater. You must get well, father, for
-much depends upon you.”
-
-“There are others as wise, my son. My voice is but a small breeze in a
-big windstorm. The men who lead our tribes are wise in the ways of
-peace. They will make good decisions. Of that I am certain. But now
-leave me, my son, for I wish to be alone. I am tired and I must rest for
-the final journey.”
-
-“Yes, my father, I will go now, but it is not to pine and weep, as the
-others do. I know you will get well. Tall Spear will make strong
-medicine. I have no fear.”
-
-Little Rock left the wigwam and, without saying a word to anyone, he
-mounted his pony and rode swiftly from the village. For many hours he
-rode until it was nearly dark. Then he stopped his pony in a pine grove.
-Leaving the pony to graze, he walked deep into the grove until he came
-to a place where an opening in the trees allowed the last rays of light
-to stream in.
-
-Under the spreading branches of a great pine tree, Little Rock knelt and
-started digging with his knife to root up some plants. When he had
-gathered a handful of roots, he arose. He walked toward a stream and
-near it he picked some berries from a bush. He dropped the roots and
-berries into a small leather pouch and rode back to the village. He
-thrust the pouch into his mother’s hand and asked her to brew the roots
-quickly in some fresh water.
-
-When the broth had been bubbling for a short time, Little Rock grasped
-the gourd from the fire and carried it toward the wigwam where his
-father lay ill with fever. As he approached the wigwam, Tall Spear
-stopped him.
-
-“Little Rock, what is it you carry in the gourd?” the Medicine Man
-asked.
-
-“Many moons ago, my father and I traveled deep into the forest. Finally
-we came to a large pine grove. Deep within the pine grove, my father
-pointed out certain roots and berries that grew there and nowhere else
-near our village. He told me that those berries and roots would make
-strong medicine for anyone sick with hotness of the skin. When I spoke
-with my father, I remembered those roots and berries. I thought that a
-broth made from them might save his life. So I have brought them to his
-wigwam.”
-
-The Medicine Man grasped the gourd and was about to turn away when
-Little Rock seized his arm.
-
-“Make him drink, Tall Spear. Tell him this is broth made from the plants
-in the pine grove. He will understand and he will drink.”
-
-“I will give him the medicine and I will tell him. You have done well,
-Little Rock. Your respect for your father’s wisdom is very great.”
-
-With that the Medicine Man disappeared inside the wigwam, and Little
-Rock sat upon the ground to wait. Soon Tall Spear came out again.
-
-“Your father has sipped the broth. He told me to clasp your hand as he
-would in thanks for bringing the roots. He is resting now. All we can do
-is wait.”
-
-As time went by, Little Rock became drowsy and soon could keep his eyes
-open no longer. As he fell asleep, the old Medicine Man took his blanket
-and wrapped it around the young brave’s shoulders.
-
-A new day was dawning as Little Rock awoke. He looked quickly toward the
-entrance of the wigwam. Suddenly Tall Spear appeared, his face looking
-cheerful.
-
-“Your father is asking for you. He is weak but he will not die. He will
-sit at the Council soon to decide for peace. Go to him and go with your
-head held high, for you have much to be proud of this day.”
-
-Little Rock entered the wigwam and hurried to his father’s side. At that
-moment his father reached out his hand and Little Rock bent down to take
-it. The eyes of father and son met in silence. No words were needed to
-tell how much more closely their lives were tied together.
-
-Tall Spear stepped quickly outside. It seemed only a moment to the men
-inside the wigwam when they heard the voices of their Oneida brothers
-speaking loudly and happily again.
-
-
-
-
- CROOKED ARROW FINDS A FRIEND
-
-
-Black Hawk was a young Shawnee brave who lived in the earliest days of
-the American Indian. Black Hawk had been raised in his village by his
-father, Tall Hawk, who was very proud of him.
-
-Tall Hawk had very carefully taught Black Hawk all there was to know
-about hunting, fishing, stalking, and all the other necessary ways of
-forest and stream.
-
-Each year, Tall Hawk would look at his son growing and exclaim to his
-wife, Soft Bird, “See how tall and strong he grows. Surely he is the
-most handsome brave in our village. Not only is he handsome but brave
-and strong as well; he will bring much honor and glory to his father.”
-At this Soft Bird nodded, for she knew how much Tall Hawk thought of his
-son.
-
-It was late spring, and the Shawnee were preparing to take the trail of
-the wild fish and game. It was time they began thinking of new skins for
-clothing and housing and food for their families. Each father who had a
-son, carefully trained his son for just this day.
-
-Finally all was in readiness and the great hunting party, after bidding
-good-bye to their friends and loved ones, took the trail to the north
-where scouts had earlier reported seeing herd of deer. Perhaps this
-would be easier than they had thought, but as they traveled onward, Tall
-Hawk began to realize that they were quite a long way from the village.
-
-He signaled for the party to stop and called two of the leader warriors
-to him. “We have traveled far from our village. Do you think it wise
-that we go on? Surely along the way we have seen many single deer, but
-nowhere have we seen signs of a herd or a large number. This territory
-which we now enter is the home and hunting grounds of the Conestogas. We
-must leave here, for we are on land that does not belong to us.”
-
-Tall Hawk was turning to speak to the others of the party when one of
-the warriors interrupted him. “Yes, this is Conestoga country, but we
-are to stop now because of a few woodland weasels that call this their
-land?”
-
-“But it is their land and we shall do just that, turn around and go
-back. Such foolishness this day could bring the angry Conestogas down on
-our heads in a very short space of time and we would be badly
-outnumbered. Our party is not too strong, and any attack upon us here in
-unfamiliar territory would mean that many lives would be lost.”
-
-“Are you afraid, Tall Hawk? Does your stomach swim and your heart
-flutter like a bird? Surely the Conestogas do not concern you?”
-
-“One Conestoga against one Shawnee, or even two Conestogas against one
-Shawnee, and I would not in the least be afraid, for the gods know that
-one good Shawnee brave could hold his own against any two Conestogas.
-But we are on their home grounds. Any attack by a large force of
-Conestogas and any one of us would be lucky to live. No, foolish one, we
-shall turn and go back in the direction we came. We shall search
-elsewhere for the elusive deer.”
-
-With that, Tall Hawk turned to the hunting party and repeated what had
-gone on between himself and the other two braves. There were some grunts
-from braves who disagreed with Tall Hawk, but for the most part they
-were willing to return.
-
-As the party turned to go back down the trail, one of the scouts who had
-been sent ahead came running into the circle to report that a large band
-of Conestogas were heading for just that place and they would be better
-off to start immediately for the home village. Tall Hawk gave the
-signal, and the hunting party turned quickly and trotted south toward
-the village.
-
-It was fully a day’s journey and they had no rest. The long grind began
-to tell upon their numbers. When they would falter and were about to
-collapse, Tall Hawk could be heard to shout, “Keep running, fools! Do
-you wish your hair to grace the home of one of our Conestoga neighbors?”
-
-This threat served its purpose, and the braves who were tiring suddenly
-found fresh strength and would continue the grueling run.
-
-Soon they reached their own hunting grounds and were safe on the other
-side when the Conestogas broke from the cover of the forest and into the
-meadow which separated the hunting grounds of the two tribes.
-
-Suddenly the leader of the Conestogas raised his hand, and the band of
-braves with him stopped running and listened. The chief explained that
-they had reached the border and could go no further. And so the score
-was equal. Black Hawk was proud of his father, for once again he had
-proved to his fellow braves that he was a wise man.
-
-The hunting party slowed down a bit now and, after traveling about two
-miles, they camped for the night. They were tired and after a hasty
-supper they fell off to sleep one by one until all but the guards were
-sound asleep. Black Hawk was soon sound asleep as well, but Tall Hawk
-lay awake thinking.
-
-Why did they not sight the deer before they reached the land of the
-Conestogas? Surely the scouts that had reported the deer herd to the
-village had not imagined seeing so many deer, or had they? And why had
-the chase taken them into Conestoga land? Over and over he asked himself
-these questions until he could not stay awake any longer and finally he
-was asleep with the rest of the party.
-
-The next morning after breakfast the party continued on its trek, this
-time turning westward. Soon they came to a large lake and Tall Hawk
-divided the party, requesting some of them to remain here and fish and
-the others to continue on around the lake in search of game. Black Hawk
-was among those chosen to stay and fish and he was very happy about it.
-He saw that he was the only young brave allowed to stay with the fishing
-party and he felt it was because he was such a good fisherman.
-
-When the hunting party had finally gone out of sight, Red Hand, the
-second in command, gathered the group and explained to them their
-mission. This lake should have plenty of fish, and so they would spend
-the next day and night here fishing and in the morning of the second day
-return to their village, as they hoped, with a successful catch of fish
-from the beautiful lake.
-
-Red Hand led the way down the shore of the lake to where the last
-fishing party had hidden the canoes. Then, asking the party to team up
-in pairs, he slipped a pouch from his shoulder and gave out fishing
-equipment to each brave. When each one had received his equipment, Red
-Hand said, “We shall fish the lake for one day and we shall rest on
-shore for one night. On the dawn of the second day the hunting party
-will return and we shall all leave for our homes together. Let us pray
-that the gods will smile favorably upon us this day and that our catch
-will be a large one. Good luck to all of you, and may your lines be
-heavy with fish when you return.”
-
-With these words ringing in their ears the Indians rushed to the canoes
-and pushed off into the quiet blue waters of this great lake. Black Hawk
-had chosen as his partner an older brave of the tribe by the name of
-Crooked Arrow. Perhaps it seemed strange that Black Hawk should choose
-his partner because he was so young, but Crooked Arrow very rarely spoke
-and many of the Indians of the tribe did not like him. Why they did not
-like him, Black Hawk did not know. He did know that Crooked Arrow was
-not very good-looking and that he was a little fatter than most of the
-other men of the tribe. But, aside from that, Black Hawk could see no
-reason for not liking him and so had asked him if he would be Black
-Hawk’s partner in the fishing trip.
-
-Crooked Arrow had shaken his head and without saying a word had followed
-Black Hawk to the canoes and helped him lift one into the lake. The
-other braves had laughed at Black Hawk when they saw him choose Crooked
-Arrow as his partner, but Red Hand had motioned them to be quiet and
-stop making fun of the boy.
-
-When the instructions had been given out and the equipment distributed
-among the braves, Black Hawk and Crooked Arrow stepped into their canoe
-and pushed away from the shore. They dipped their paddles softly into
-the lake and the canoe glided quietly across the waters.
-
-Soon they had pulled away from the other canoe and Crooked Arrow who had
-taken the stern of the canoe, was steering the canoe for a point of land
-about a half a mile down the lake shore. Black Hawk turned to him and
-asked, “Why do you steer for that part of the lake, Crooked Arrow? I
-should think that that section of lake over to the eastward would be
-better.”
-
-“Crooked Arrow knows where the fish are, little Black Hawk.”
-
-He said nothing more but pulled strongly with his paddle and the canoe
-fairly skimmed across the water. Black Hawk thought to himself that they
-would probably have gone even faster if he, Black Hawk, had removed his
-paddle from the water, for he could not keep up with Crooked Arrow’s
-stroke and was causing a backwash with his paddle by dragging it through
-the water.
-
-Finally Crooked Arrow said, “My little friend, dip your paddle deep and
-pull strongly back toward the stern of the canoe. When you have
-completed the stroke, draw your paddle completely from the water and
-reach it forward high in the air before placing it in the water again.”
-
-Black Hawk followed his instructions, and soon he found that the
-paddling was a lot easier by using that technique than the way he had
-been trying to paddle. He had been concentrating so hard on his paddling
-that he did not realize that they were soon to the place where Crooked
-Arrow said that they would be sure to catch some fish.
-
-Crooked Arrow motioned for Black Hawk to throw his line overboard, which
-he did, and with that Crooked Arrow slowed down the canoe to an even,
-smooth pace which would take them just past the small jutting of land.
-
-Black Hawk could see his own lure shining in the water. As the lure came
-parallel with the jutting land there was a great swirl of water, and the
-fight was on.
-
-A very large fish had grasped the lure in his mouth and it was now a
-fight between the boy and the fish. It was a huge bass that was
-threshing around in the water and soon it was obvious that Black Hawk
-would be the victor. With some swift overhand strokes he had pulled the
-fish up to the side of the canoe. Then with a thrust of his arm, Crooked
-Arrow speared the fish with his fish spear and brought him safely
-aboard. He was a beautiful big bass and Black Hawk was so proud he
-nearly tipped over the canoe in his excitement to see the fish.
-
-“Be not so excited, my young friend. It is a nice-sized fish, but the
-day is young and we must catch many, many more.” Black Hawk cast his
-lure in again, and soon the episode was repeated. Back and forth Crooked
-Arrow paddled near the jutting land and fish after fish fell victim to
-the line of Black Hawk and the spear of Crooked Arrow.
-
-Soon shadows began to gather and Crooked Arrow turned the bow of the
-canoe toward the place they had started from. Black Hawk paddled even
-harder now going home, for he was very proud. There in the bottom of the
-canoe, all nicely strung on an improvised leather loop, were twelve
-plump large fish.
-
-When they reached the shore, Black Hawk with his fish in hand dashed
-ashore to report his success to Red Hand. Red Hand looked with pride
-upon the catch Black Hawk held up to show him and then he said, “My, but
-that is a fine catch of fish. Did you catch them all by yourself?”
-
-“Oh no,” said Black Hawk, “Crooked Arrow and I both caught them. They
-would strike at my line and when I pulled them to the side of the boat,
-Crooked Arrow would spear them and bring them on board. Oh, what an
-exciting trip we have had. How did the others make out, or are we the
-first to return?”
-
-“Yes, you are the first to return, but remember you were not too far
-from the landing place. The others will be here shortly. Sit down and we
-will smoke and rest while we wait for the others.”
-
-They sat down and waited. Soon the other canoes, one by one, would slip
-up to the shore, and the braves would leap out and triumphantly tell Red
-Hand of their catch. Soon the last of the canoes had been beached and
-the last of the fish carefully packed away for the journey home the
-following morning.
-
-The braves had a supper of delicious fresh lake bass and after they had
-sat around the fire telling of their adventures on the lake they all
-turned in for the night. Soon the fire had burned to just ashes and all
-the braves slept peacefully in the quiet of the night.
-
-It had been a long day on the lake in the sun, and now the quiet spring
-breezes through the trees overhead sang a soft lullaby along the lake
-shore. When it had been quiet for a long time, Black Hawk sat up and
-noticed that Crooked Arrow was gone from where he lay down to sleep.
-
-Black Hawk looked around and then suddenly he glanced toward the lake.
-There he saw Crooked Arrow standing quiet. Black Hawk rose and quietly
-slipped down toward the lake and to where Crooked Arrow was standing.
-Approaching the lakeside, Black Hawk respected the brave, Crooked Arrow,
-and when he had reached a point about five yards from the brave he
-stopped. He could barely hear Crooked Arrow and then he knew that
-Crooked Arrow was thanking someone.
-
-“Finally, O Great Spirit, I, Crooked Arrow, humbly thank you for sending
-to me a friend, this boy, Black Hawk, who asked me to go with him on the
-fishing trip. For this I am thankful and also I am thankful that you
-sent the fish of the lake to his hook so that his catch was a large one.
-You have been very kind to Crooked Arrow this day and I will not forget.
-I have never known my family, but from this day forth I shall look upon
-Black Hawk as if he were my son. I know he has a father, a good and
-wonderful man, but I am sure he will not mind if I remain close to him,
-for his kindness to me this day has brought great joy to my heart. Thank
-you once again, O Great Spirit.”
-
-Crooked Arrow turned and walked slowly back to where he had been
-sleeping and lay down once again. Either he did not look or did not
-particularly notice that Black Hawk was missing from his place upon the
-ground.
-
-For a long time Black Hawk sat by the side of the lake thinking about
-what Crooked Arrow had been saying. Suddenly he realized what had
-happened here. He had made a friend, a very close friend, and it made
-his heart warm. Slowly he too returned to where he had slept and, lying
-down once again, was soon fast asleep.
-
-Dawn broke bright and warm upon the lake and soon all the Indians were
-astir.
-
-They all ate a hearty breakfast and as they were packing the remainder
-of the equipment and safely storing the canoes away once again, the
-first of the hunting party arrived.
-
-They too had a very successful hunt, and Black Hawk counted five very
-plump bucks being carried by the hunting party.
-
-Some of the braves were quick to point out to him that the largest buck
-had been brought down with an arrow from the bow of Tall Hawk and this
-made Black Hawk very proud of his father. The party started on the
-return trip to the village and it was a happy group which entered the
-circle of homes to be greeted warmly by friends and family who viewed
-the fine food supply with a great deal of laughter and joy. The party
-soon dispersed, each one returning to his own home.
-
-When Black Hawk and his father returned to their home there was a fine
-meal awaiting them; and the rest of the family, his mother and two
-sisters, greeted the two hunters with praise for their success which had
-preceded them to their home by the little braves’ spreading the word
-through the village of the success of the hunters, especially Tall Hawk
-and his son Black Hawk, the great fisherman.
-
-After supper, Black Hawk stepped out of his home and wandered through
-the village greeting his many friends and talking with them of the
-adventures he had just been through.
-
-Finally Black Hawk had been to almost all his friends when he noticed
-one rather shabby wigwam set off from the rest on the far side of the
-village. Slowly puzzling a little bit about this, he wandered toward the
-wigwam. He saw one of his playmates, Walking Bird, and he stopped to ask
-who lived in the wigwam in the distance.
-
-“Oh,” said Walking Bird, “that is the home of Crooked Arrow. He lives
-off by himself like that, for he seems to enjoy being by himself. He is
-a strange sort of man and he very rarely comes out of his wigwam to
-participate in the activities of the tribe, except when there is a
-hunting or a fishing party or a tribal celebration. Was not he on the
-same trip with you?”
-
-“Yes, he was, and I think I shall pay him a visit.”
-
-Quickly Black Hawk approached the wigwam of Crooked Arrow and when he
-had reached the flap that served as a door he called out and asked if he
-might enter.
-
-“Come in, come in, my friend, Black Hawk,” called Crooked Arrow.
-
-The boy entered and Crooked Arrow rose to greet him.
-
-“It is very kind of you to come and see me.”
-
-“Is it not the thing to do for friends to visit one another?” asked
-Black Hawk. “Why do you live here by yourself? Have you no family?”
-
-“No, Black Hawk, Crooked Arrow has no family, and I have liked living
-here on the edge of the village. It is quiet and I get much time to work
-on my tools for fishing and hunting. I like it here.”
-
-Black Hawk stayed until it was quite late and he noticed that Crooked
-Arrow talked on and on about many, many things. Finally it was getting
-very late and Black Hawk rose to leave.
-
-“Come again, little Black Hawk. My wigwam is always open to my good
-friend. The next time you come we will have another fine talk.”
-
-“Thank you, friend Crooked Arrow. I shall return often for you have been
-a good friend.”
-
-With that, Black Hawk turned and walked to his own wigwam. As he
-approached his home he noticed his father just leaving. When Tall Hawk
-saw his son, he stopped and called to him. “Black Hawk, my son, where
-have you been? It is quite late and your mother was getting quite
-concerned.”
-
-“I was visiting with a friend, my father, a very good friend.” It was
-then that Black Hawk spoke with his father about the events on the
-fishing trip and about how Crooked Arrow had knelt at the lakeside and
-thanked the Great Spirit for his friend, Black Hawk.
-
-His father listened attentively and then when Black Hawk had finished he
-said, “My son, I am very proud of you. You have done a great and
-generous thing. Crooked Arrow has been a lonely person. You have brought
-much joy to his life. To have a friend is a wonderful thing.”
-
-“But, my father, if this is such a wonderful thing, why has no one
-befriended him before? Why does he still live alone on the edge of the
-tribe? Why is he alone on the hunt though he is with many braves?”
-
-“He is not an easy person to talk to, my son. You, a boy, have spoken to
-him as an equal; this has meant much to him. The rest of us should be
-ashamed. We have been so busy that we have not taken time out to look at
-what is around us. It has taken a young Indian boy to bring to our
-attention this lack of concern for a fellow member of the tribe. If he
-had been a worthless brave who had sought pity and help from others, the
-treatment he had been given would have been what he deserved.”
-
-But in thinking back, Tall Hawk realized that Crooked Arrow had always
-carried his share of the responsibility in the tribe.
-
-When a hunting party was forming, he always volunteered; when a battle
-was in progress, Crooked Arrow was always found to be in the middle.
-When there was distasteful jobs to be done around the village or a new
-lodge to be built or some repairs needed or someone to stand night
-watch, Crooked Arrow would always be among the first to volunteer.
-
-Yes, thought Tall Hawk, here is a man who has been treated with scorn
-who should have been treated with honor by his fellow braves.
-
-The following day after giving much thought to the question, Tall Hawk
-went to consult with the leaders of the village.
-
-After many hours, a delegation was formed and they proceeded to the
-wigwam of Crooked Arrow. The fat ugly warrior stepped from his wigwam
-and suddenly his eyes grew a little wild until he saw in the delegation
-Black Hawk, his friend.
-
-“Why have you come to the humble wigwam of Crooked Arrow?” he asked of
-the leaders. “What have I done to cause you to come? If I have done
-wrong tell me and I shall do all in my power to make it right.”
-
-“No,” said Tall Hawk, “It is we who have done wrong. We come to invite
-you to rebuild your wigwam within the village circle. There is a fine
-place right next to mine, and I would consider it an honor if you would
-build there and become my neighbor. My son has told me quite a bit about
-you and I can see now where we have been very unfair in the way we have
-neglected making you a part of our tribe. Come, become a part of our
-family. Share our fires and our food and we shall talk together of the
-great hunts. This we ask you to do as a sign that you will forgive us
-for this wrong which has existed so long.”
-
-“Yes, I will come, but listen. You have done me no wrong. I have been
-happy living here on the edge of the village, watching the children play
-and taking part in the hunt. I have had a good life. I have never known
-what real friendship was from the time I was a little boy going from one
-to the other begging for food to keep me going. But Black Hawk has
-brought the meaning of friendship to my heart, and for that reason I
-have desired these last few days to live closer to my people. Yes, I
-will come. With gladness in my heart, I will come.”
-
-The group turned and started for the center of the village to proclaim
-what had just happened; and, as they walked, a small boy, Black Hawk,
-and a not so ugly, fat, young man could be seen walking hand in hand—a
-certain lightness in their step that had not been there before.
-
-
-
-
- THE BOY AND THE WARRIOR CHIEF
-
-
-Flying Owl was a very happy little Seneca brave. He had all he could
-wish for. His father was a very brave and honored member of the tribe.
-His mother was kind and made the best-tasting dishes of food for him
-when he was hungry. His sister and he would quarrel now and then, but
-most of the time they played and lived together very happily.
-
-Their home was strong and warm in the winter and cool in the summer.
-There were always many nice clothes to wear and plenty to eat. Flying
-Owl was learning from his father every day about the ways of the forest
-and the stream. When anyone watched Flying Owl at play, he would think,
-“Now there is a lucky and happy little boy. I wonder if he knows how
-fortunate he is.” But Flying Owl was a rare little Indian brave, for he
-did realize how lucky he was. When he was still young, Flying Owl gladly
-shared his toys and other things with his friends. For this reason he
-was very much liked by both the braves and women and by the other boys
-and girls of the tribe.
-
-One bright summer day, Flying Owl rose early from his bed and looked out
-at the bright warm sun shining down on the green forest and the
-blue-green lake at the edge of their village. He thought to himself,
-“What a wonderful day this is to go fishing. Only a short way from our
-home is the beautiful little hidden lake which my father has shown me.
-Surely there must be big fish in that lake. If I could catch some of
-them all by myself, my father would be proud of me and we would have a
-delicious supper this evening.”
-
-So without any delay, Flying Owl gathered together his fishing tackle
-which he and his father had made with such care during the cold winter
-nights. Flying Owl was often allowed to go off by himself on short trips
-like this, so long as he did not go too far or stay away from his home
-after dark. He packed his fishing gear and some food and started out,
-waving good-bye to his mother and sister who stood at the entrance to
-their wigwam. His mother called to remind him to be back in time for
-supper. Flying Owl shouted that he not only would be back before supper
-but would bring their supper home with him. Then his mother and sister
-watched him trotting from the village until he was out of sight.
-
-Flying Owl ran gaily along the forest paths, thinking that the many wild
-creatures had been awake since dawn. Now they were scurrying through the
-brush and the tree tops, enjoying the warm sunshine and cool breezes
-which blew gently through the forest. Flying Owl’s heart felt very
-happy. It was good to be alive, discovering new wonders of nature here
-in the forest instead of playing in the village that he knew too well.
-And he thought, “Perhaps some great adventure is waiting for me here in
-the green forest!”
-
-He hurried on, impatient to reach the secret lake and catch the many
-large fish that he was sure were there. At the pace he was keeping, it
-was not long before he saw, through an opening in the trees, the
-blue-green, shimmering waters of the lake. Running faster, he reached
-the lake shore quickly and stopped a moment to look out across the
-waters and wonder where he would find the best place to fish.
-
-He saw a tree that had fallen out into the lake, and decided to stand on
-the end of the log in the lake. He cast his line into the water and
-settled down to await the first nibble. He did not have to wait long.
-There was a sharp tug upon his line and he felt the line go taut in his
-hands. In fact, it had come so suddenly that Flying Owl was almost
-thrown off balance. Bracing the heels of his moccasins against the curve
-of the log, he started pulling at the line and brought in a fine fat
-fish. The catch now lay on the bank next to him and he was ready to cast
-again. In only a few moments, he felt another sharp tug and soon had
-landed another plump fish. “This is really fun!” Flying Owl said aloud.
-
-Just then he heard a movement behind him. Turning quickly, he saw a tall
-handsome Indian brave dressed in the costume of the Woodland Indians,
-wearing the headdress of a chieftain. Flying Owl was startled, but the
-tall brave reached out his hand in friendship.
-
-“Do not be afraid, Flying Owl,” he said. “I will not hurt you.”
-
-“Who are you?” Flying Owl asked as he looked up at the brave. “I do not
-recognize you as a member of our tribe. How do you know my name?”
-
-The brave smiled, stepped closer, and said, “Oh, I know your name
-because I _am_ of your tribe. I remember you as a baby who looked so
-much like his father whom I knew well.”
-
-“But I do not ever remember seeing you and I thought I knew everyone. If
-you are one of our tribe, I should know you, and above all because you
-are wearing the headdress of our Chief. Surely all, even the children,
-know our great Chieftains.”
-
-The brave drew closer until he was no more than a pace from Flying Owl.
-Then he took a small deerskin jacket from his shoulders, laid it on the
-ground, and sat cross-legged upon it, facing the boy. “My name is Bear
-Claw and I am truly your Chief. If you do not believe me, you may ask
-any question you wish about our tribe, and I will give you the answer.”
-
-Flying Owl accepted the challenge and began to question the tall brave
-carefully until he was sure that the man was telling the truth. Still he
-had never seen or heard of him.
-
-“Surely,” the chieftain said, “you must know now that I am one of your
-tribe. But let me ask you a few questions. You have been asking me many,
-and now it is my turn.” He waited with a laughing sparkle in his eyes
-while Flying Owl watched his face closely. “What reason would you have
-for questioning me, Bear Claw?” Flying Owl asked.
-
-“I would merely like to ask why you came to the still lake on such a
-beautiful summer day,” replied the brave, not taking his eyes from the
-boy for one moment.
-
-“Well,” said Flying Owl, “I thought it would be fun if I came here today
-and caught enough fish for my mother to cook for our supper.”
-
-“Oh,” said Bear Claw smiling, “that is a very good reason. Please do not
-let me stop your fishing.” Then Bear Claw stretched out on the bank of
-the lake and lay gazing up through the trees at the bright blue sky.
-
-Flying Owl hesitated, thinking about this strong brave’s strange
-behavior. Then he remembered the fish he must catch and how he must
-return home before dark. So he cast his line into the water again and
-almost immediately caught another large fish. This he placed with the
-other two and went on fishing until he soon had a good catch. Seeing the
-sun sinking lower in the afternoon sky, he knew that he must hurry to
-reach the village in time for his mother to cook the fish for supper.
-
-Taking a stout birch branch, he ran one end of the branch through the
-gills of the fish to carry his catch over his shoulder. As he turned to
-say good-bye to the brave who had kept him company at the lakeside, he
-was surprised to find him gone. Beneath the tree, he saw only the
-flattened fir needles where the brave had lain watching him. He looked
-all around and could find no further trace of him. Flying Owl moved even
-faster toward home, because now he certainly had a great deal to tell
-his friends. He reached home in plenty of time before supper and handed
-the fish to his mother, telling her that, like his father, he had
-brought their meal for the evening. His mother was very proud and told
-him so. Then she asked, “Did you have any strange and wonderful
-adventures today, my little Flying Owl?”
-
-The boy was just about to blurt out that he had, when he decided that he
-should wait to tell his father first about everything that had happened.
-So all he said was, “We will talk later, mother. I have much to tell
-you.”
-
-Impatient now to break the news to his father, he went outside to look
-for him. Flying Owl found him talking with another brave and waited
-respectfully until his father had finished and was starting home.
-Planting himself in front of his father, Flying Owl began to tell his
-story, but he was speaking so fast that his father could hardly
-understand him.
-
-“Wait, my son! You must speak more slowly. I want to hear about
-everything that happened to you today, but your words tumble out so
-swiftly that my brain can’t make any sense of them. Now start from the
-beginning again.”
-
-Flying Owl took a deep breath and began slowly this time to tell his
-father all about his adventure at the great still lake in the deep
-forest. As he talked, his father’s face looked more and more puzzled.
-When Flying Owl had finished, his father put one hand on his son’s
-shoulder, and they started for the wigwam. Nothing more was said about
-the adventure until they reached home. While Flying Owl was washing, his
-father turned to his mother and asked her what she thought of their
-son’s story.
-
-“He has not told me about it yet. He wanted to wait until he found you
-and tell you first.”
-
-When the family had begun eating the supper of fish Flying Owl had
-caught, the young brave told his story once again for his mother’s
-benefit. When he had ended it, his parents looked at each other and
-smiled and said no more about it.
-
-When the children had gone to bed, Flying Owl’s mother said to her
-husband, “Surely you do not believe this story that Flying Owl has told
-us. It must be something he imagined. He probably had a dull day and
-believed that he had to think up some adventure to tell his father.”
-
-“No,” said her husband, “that is not the reason, for the catching of
-many sweet fish would be enough of a story. There is something more
-behind this and I must find out what it is. How would he know Bear
-Claw’s name? He was only a baby when the great chief vanished. Tomorrow
-I will go with the boy and see for myself this place where he says he
-met Bear Claw.”
-
-The next morning, Flying Owl’s father remarked to his son that it was
-such a nice day that they ought to go fishing once again at the still
-lake. Surely if there were more fish like those they had eaten the night
-before, they should try to make another large catch and share them with
-other families in the village. Flying Owl was thrilled with the thought
-of going fishing with his father and gathered his gear together quickly.
-Father and son started off together into the forest, traveling at a
-slower pace than Flying Owl had gone the day before. It was almost
-mid-day when they reached the side of the lake. Flying Owl’s father
-suggested that they eat lunch before they began fishing. When they were
-through eating, Flying Owl’s father looked at the boy curiously.
-
-“My son, show me where you saw this Seneca Chief yesterday.”
-
-“Certainly, father,” Flying Owl said confidently.
-
-He took his father’s hand and walked back to the fir tree under which
-the warrior had rested. They both looked carefully at the ground.
-
-“I see no signs of where a person lay under this tree, my son,” Flying
-Owl’s father finally said. “Are you sure that you saw a Seneca Chief
-when you were here yesterday?”
-
-“Oh yes, father, I know I did. We can’t find any trace of the spot he
-lay on because the fir needles have risen again like the grass on which
-a deer has lain. Surely you don’t believe that I would lie to you,
-father?”
-
-“No, my son. I do not believe you would, but I know of no one by the
-name of Bear Claw who lives in our village. Perhaps one of our
-unfriendly neighbors was playing a trick on you, or maybe your
-imagination wanted a little adventure of its own.”
-
-Flying Owl paused for a moment, thinking seriously.
-
-“No, father, you have taught me to be truthful at all times, and to tell
-you exactly what I have seen and heard. I did see a tall Seneca standing
-right there, wearing a Chief’s headdress that was one of the most
-beautiful I have ever seen. It was not something in my imagination, and
-it was not one of our neighbors, for he wore no mask and no paint to
-hide behind. His costume was Seneca, and when I questioned him about our
-village, he knew every answer.”
-
-“All right, my son, we will speak no more about it. But come, we must
-cast our lines. It is growing late and we must hurry if we are to bring
-home another meal this evening.”
-
-So they started to fish and waited a long time without getting even a
-nibble. They changed their bait and moved to a new position farther
-along the lake shore, but nothing did any good. When the sun had sunk
-very low, Flying Owl’s father announced that it was time to start for
-home. As they trotted back through the forest, neither spoke to the
-other, because both were thinking busily about Flying Owl’s story, his
-good catch of yesterday, and their poor luck today.
-
-When Flying Owl’s mother saw them returning empty-handed, she said
-nothing of the fact that there were no fish. When the children had
-finished their supper and gone to bed, their parents spoke of the boy’s
-adventure. Now they were more puzzled than ever. Just at that moment
-there was a loud muttering of voices, followed by such shouting and
-laughter and cheers as had not been heard in the village for many moons.
-Flying Owl’s father dashed from his home, grasping his bow as he went.
-Certainly something wonderful must be happening. As he reached the
-center of the village, the first thing he saw was a tall Seneca
-Chieftain standing amidst many warriors who were shouting and dancing.
-It was Bear Claw, a Seneca Chief who had disappeared after a great
-battle. His people had returned to their village defeated and heartsick,
-believing him dead, and there had been much sadness. It had happened so
-many moons ago that Chief Bear Claw had almost been forgotten. Now he
-had appeared in the village as if from nowhere. Finally Bear Claw raised
-his arms in the air, asking for silence.
-
-“Your Chief has returned. I have much to tell you, but I must wait
-because I am tired and need rest. Tomorrow we shall have feasting and
-dancing and a Great Council. Then I will speak.”
-
-The great warrior turned and walked to his wigwam where his wife and
-young son, who had been leading the tribe, waited for him. Flying Owl’s
-father walked slowly back to his home where the boy lay sleeping,
-unaware of the great event that had been taking place.
-
-The next day the sun rose and covered the small village with a warm
-glow, as though greeting Bear Claw’s return. Flying Owl walked out into
-the sunshine and found everyone preparing for a great celebration. He
-ran to ask his father about the reason for all the excitement.
-
-“My son, sit beside your father who doubted you. Today a miracle has
-come to pass, and together we will hear how that miracle happened.”
-
-Although he was bubbling over with curiosity to learn what had happened,
-Flying Owl sat patiently and silently beside his father. Soon it was
-time for the special meeting. The whole village began to gather in front
-of the home of the great Chief who had returned to his people. Flying
-Owl and his father joined the others and sat watching the entrance of
-the wigwam. Soon a great warrior with a magnificent headdress stepped
-out. Flying Owl grasped his father’s arm and whispered, “That’s the
-Seneca Chief I told you about, father!”
-
-“Yes, my son. That is Bear Claw, warrior Chief of our tribe, who has
-returned to us after we had believed him dead.”
-
-Bear Claw signaled for silence. Then he began speaking with great
-dignity.
-
-“Many moons ago, when we were at war with our enemies to the north, I
-fell, wounded by an enemy arrow. Before I could escape, the enemy fell
-upon me and took me prisoner. I was taken to their village where I was
-kept under close guard. They did not kill me but made me a slave—a far
-greater punishment for any Seneca. For many moons I worked in the enemy
-camp, often being whipped and beaten and spit upon by their warriors and
-their squaws, and even their children. Two moons ago I escaped and began
-my long trek homeward. But I moved slowly because the path was long and
-I was weary. They sent a war party after me to bring me back. So for
-many suns I hid in the deep forest. I led their war party in a chase,
-first toward our village, and then away from it. I did not want to come
-too close to our homes until I was sure they had lost my trail. I knew
-they would not dare to attack our village because they were a small
-band, but still big enough to take prisoner any of our people who might
-have wandered too far away.
-
-“Yesterday I arrived at the secret lake with the only things that I had
-been able to find and bring with me from the enemy camp—my knife, my
-bow, and my headdress which they had taken from me when they captured
-me. Suddenly I saw a Seneca boy fishing. I approached and spoke with
-him. Last night I slept in the forest until it was late and dark enough
-to enter our village. The rest of the story you know. But first, before
-the celebration, I would like to see that young lad I spoke to at the
-lakeside, the young brave who is called Flying Owl.”
-
-Flying Owl rose and stepped forward to face the Chief.
-
-“You were the first of my people to see me, young brave, and it was the
-sight of you, fishing in the lake, which first made me feel that I was
-really home. You are a good fisherman and a bright lad, and I am sure
-you will become a great warrior. Because you were the first and because
-you appeared so brave in the face of what might have been great danger,
-I wish to reward you. Here is the bow which I carried all through my
-homeward trip. Keep it and remember the Seneca Chief you spoke to the
-day the fish were biting so well and the sun was warm—the day that
-happiness once again filled that Chief’s heart.”
-
-“Thank you, Bear Claw,” the boy replied proudly. “May I hope that some
-day my father and I may go fishing with you at the secret lake?”
-
-Everyone laughed and, most of all, Bear Claw. There was joy in the
-village for their leader had returned, and a boy had made him welcome.
-
-
-
-
- Transcriber’s Notes
-
-
---Copyright notice provided as in the original—this e-text is public
- domain in the country of publication.
-
---Silently corrected palpable typos; left non-standard (or amusing)
- spellings and dialect unchanged.
-
---In the text versions, delimited italics text in _underscores_ (the
- HTML version reproduces the font form of the printed book.)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Treasury of American Indian Tales, by
-Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURY OF AMERICAN INDIAN TALES ***
-
-***** This file should be named 62855-0.txt or 62855-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/6/2/8/5/62855/
-
-Produced by Stephen Hutcheson and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/62855-0.zip b/old/62855-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index c7c45a7..0000000
--- a/old/62855-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/62855-h.zip b/old/62855-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index dc9620f..0000000
--- a/old/62855-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/62855-h/62855-h.htm b/old/62855-h/62855-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index 63ca345..0000000
--- a/old/62855-h/62855-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,9858 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
-<head>
-<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
-<meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
-<meta name="viewport" content="width=device-width, initial-scale=1.0" />
-<title>Treasury of American Indian Tales, by Theodore Whitson Ressler&mdash;a Project Gutenberg eBook</title>
-<meta name="author" content="Theodore Whitson Ressler" />
-<meta name="pss.pubdate" content="1957" />
-<link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
-<link rel="spine" href="images/spine.jpg" />
-<link rel="schema.DC" href="http://dublincore.org/documents/1998/09/dces/" />
-<meta name="DC.Title" content="Treasury of American Indian Tales" />
-<meta name="DC.Language" content="en" />
-<meta name="DC.Format" content="text/html" />
-<meta name="DC.Created" content="1957" />
-<meta name="DC.Creator" content="Theodore Whitson Ressler" />
-<style type="text/css">
-table.twocol tr td { margin-left:2em; margin-right:2em; } /* BODY */
-
-h1, h2, h3, h5, h6, .titlepg p { text-align:center; clear:right; text-indent:0; } /* HEADINGS */
-h1 { margin-top:3em; margin-left:auto;margin-right:auto; max-width:15em; }
-.box h1, .box h2 { margin-top:.5em; margin-left:.5em; margin-right:.5em; }
-h2, h3 { margin-top:3em; margin-bottom:2em; margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; max-width: 17em; }
-h2 { max-width: 20em; font-size:120%; }
-h2 .h2line1 { }
-h2 .h2line2 { }
-h3 { font-size:110%; max-width: 22em; }
-.box h3 { margin-top:1em; }
-h6 { font-size:100%; font-style:italic; }
-h6.var { font-size:80%; font-style:normal; }
-.titlepg { margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; border-style:double; clear:both; }
-pre { font-family:serif; }
-
-/* == BOXES == */
-.dbox { border-style:double; }
-div.box, .dbox { margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; max-width:25em;}
-.nbox { margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; max-width:18em;}
-div.box, div.subbox, div.nbox { border-style:solid; border-width:1px; margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:2em; }
-div.subbox { margin:.2em; }
-div.box dl dd, div.subbox dl dd, div.nbox dl dd {margin-left:2em; font-size:90%; }
-div.box dl dt, div.subbox dl dt, div.nbox dl dt {margin-left:1em; }
-div.box p {margin-left:1em; margin-right:1em; max-width:70em; }
-h4 { font-size:80%; text-align:center; clear:right; }
-span.chaptertitle { font-style:normal; display:block; text-align:center; font-size:150%; text-indent:0; }
-
-p, blockquote, li { text-align:justify; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; } /* PARAGRAPHS */
-pre { max-width:21em; }
-p.bq, blockquote { margin-left:2em; margin-right:2em; margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:2em; }
-blockquote p.bq { margin-left:1em; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em;}
-div.verse { font-size:100%; }
-p.indent {text-indent:2em; text-align:left; }
-p.tb, p.tbcenter { margin-top:2em; }
-
-span.pb, div.pb, dt.pb, p.pb /* PAGE BREAKS */
-{ text-align:right; float:right; margin-right:0em; clear:right; }
-div.pb { display:inline; }
-.pb, dt.pb, dl.toc dt.pb, dl.tocl dt.pb, .index dt.pb, dl.undent dt.pb { text-align:right; float:right; margin-left: 1.5em;
- margin-top:.5em; margin-bottom:.5em; display:inline; text-indent:0;
- font-size:80%; font-style:normal; font-weight:bold;
- color:gray; border:1px solid gray;padding:1px 3px; }
-div.index .pb { display:block; }
-.bq div.pb, .bq span.pb { font-size:90%; margin-right:2em; }
-
- /* IMAGES */
-div.img, body a img, .imgcenter {text-align:center; margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:0em; clear:both; }
-.caption {margin-top:0em; font-weight:bold; font-size:90%; }
-img { max-width:100%; height:auto; }
-
-sup, a.fn { font-size:75%; vertical-align:100%; line-height:50%; font-weight:normal; }
-.center, .tbcenter, .csmallest, .csmaller, .caption { text-align:center; clear:both; text-indent:0; } /* TEXTUAL MARKUP */
-table.center { clear:both; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
-.small { font-size:80%; }
-.smaller, .csmaller { font-size:66%; }
-.smallest, .csmallest { font-size:50%; }
-.larger, .xlarge { font-size:150%; }
-.large { font-size:125%; }
-.largest, .xxlarge { font-size:200%; }
-.gs { letter-spacing:1em; }
-.gs3 { letter-spacing:1.5em; }
-.gslarge { letter-spacing:.3em; font-size:110%; }
-.sc { font-variant:small-caps; font-style:normal; }
-.sc i { font-variant:normal; }
-.ss { font-family:sans-serif; }
-.rubric { color:red; font-weight:bold; }
-hr { width:40%; margin-left:30%; clear:right; }
-hr.dwide { width:80%; margin-left:10%; }
-.shorthr { width:20%; }
-.jl { text-align:left; }
-span.jl { float:left; }
-.jr, .jr1 { text-align:right; }
-span.jr, span.jr1, span.center, span.jl { display:block; }
-.jr1 { margin-right:2em; }
-.ind1 { text-align:left; margin-left:2em; }
-.u { text-decoration:underline; }
-.i { font-style:italic; }
-.b { font-weight:bold; }
-span.ou { text-decoration:overline underline; font-size:90%; font-family:sans-serif; font-weight:bold; font-variant:small-caps; }
-
-table.center { border-style: groove; }
-table.center, table.hymntab { clear:both; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
-
-dd.t { text-align:left; margin-left: 5.5em; }
-
-span.date, span.author { text-align:right; font-variant:small-caps; display:block; margin-right:1em; }
-span.center { text-align:center; display:block; text-indent:0; }
-span.hst { margin-left:1.5em; }
-.biblio dt { margin-top:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em; }
-.biblio dd { font-size:90%; }
-
-/* FOOTNOTE BLOCKS */
-div.notes p { margin-left:1em; text-indent:-1em; text-align:justify; max-width:25em; }
-.fnblock { margin-top:2em; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; max-width:25em; }
-.fndef { text-align:justify; margin-top:1.5em; margin-left:1.5em; text-indent:-1.5em; }
-.fndef p.fncont, .fndef dl { margin-left:0em; text-indent:0em; }
-.fndef p.fnbq, .fndef dl { margin-left:1em; text-indent:0em; }
-
-.lnum { text-align:right; float:right; margin-left:.5em; /* POETRY LINE NUMBER */
-display:inline; }
-
-.hymn { text-align:left; } /* HYMN AND VERSE: HTML */
-.verse { text-align:left; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:0em; }
-p.t0, p.l, .t0, .l, div.l, l { margin-left:4em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.tw, div.tw, .tw { margin-left:1em; text-indent:-1em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t, div.t, .t { margin-left:5em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t2, div.t2, .t2 { margin-left:6em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t3, div.t3, .t3 { margin-left:7em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t4, div.t4, .t4 { margin-left:8em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t5, div.t5, .t5 { margin-left:9em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t6, div.t6, .t6 { margin-left:10em; text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t7, div.t7, .t7 { margin-left:11em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t8, div.t8, .t8 { margin-left:12em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t9, div.t9, .t9 { margin-left:13em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t10,div.t10,.t10 { margin-left:14em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t11,div.t11,.t11 { margin-left:15em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t12,div.t12,.t12 { margin-left:16em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t13,div.t13,.t13 { margin-left:17em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t14,div.t14,.t14 { margin-left:18em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.t15,div.t15,.t15 { margin-left:19em;text-indent:-3em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:left; }
-p.lc { margin-left:2em; text-indent:0; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:center; }
-
- /* CONTENTS (.TOC) */
- dl.toc { margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; max-width:27em; }
- .toc dt.center { text-align:center; clear:both; margin-top:3em; margin-bottom:1em; text-indent:0; }
- .toc dt { margin-left:0; text-indent:0; margin-right:0; }
- .toc dt .cn { font-style:normal; }
- .toc dt.jr { text-align:left; }
- .toc dd { text-align:right; clear:both; margin-left:2em; ; }
- .toc dd.t { text-align:right; clear:both; margin-left:4em; text-indent:0em; }
- .toc dt a, .toc dd a { text-align:left; clear:right; float:left; }
- .toc dt.sc { text-align:right; clear:both; font-variant:small-caps; }
- .toc dt.scl { text-align:left; clear:both; font-variant:small-caps; }
- .toc dt.sct { text-align:left; clear:both; }
- .toc dt.jl { text-align:left; clear:both; font-variant:normal; }
- .toc dt.scc { text-align:center; clear:both; font-variant:small-caps; text-indent:0; }
- .toc dt span.lj { text-align:left; display:block; float:left; }
- .toc dt.jr { font-style:normal; }
- .toc dt a span.cn, .toc dt span.cn, dt span.cn { width:3.5em; text-align:right; margin-right:.7em; float:left; }
- dt .large {font-weight:bold; }
-
-.clear { clear:both; }
-.htab { margin-left:8em; }
- /* MAXWIDTH FOR JUVENILE BOOKS */
- p, blockquote, li, dd, dt, div.bcat, pre { text-align:justify; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
- p, li, div.bcat { max-width:25em; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
-
- p.smaller { max-width:40em; }
- p.csmallest { max-width:40em; }
- p.small { max-width:31.25em; }
- blockquote { max-width:23em; }
- div.verse { max-width:25em; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
- div.bq { margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; max-width:23em; }
-
- /* book advertisements */
- div.bcat dl dd { margin-left:4em; max-width:21em; }
- div.bcat dl dt { text-indent:-2em; margin-left:2em; }
- p.bkad {font-size:125%; font-weight:bold; margin-top:2em; max-width:20em; margin-right:auto; margin-left:auto; }
- p.bkpr {font-size:90%; }
- p.bkrv { }
- dl.blist dt { margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em; }
- dl.blist, dl.biblio { margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; max-width:25em; }
-
- dl.int { margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto; max-width:25em; }
- dl.int dt {margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em; }
- dl.int dd {margin-left:2em; }
-</style>
-</head>
-<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of Treasury of American Indian Tales, by
-Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: Treasury of American Indian Tales
-
-Author: Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-Release Date: August 5, 2020 [EBook #62855]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURY OF AMERICAN INDIAN TALES ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Stephen Hutcheson and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-<div class="img">
-<img class="cover" id="coverpage" src="images/cover.jpg" alt="Treasury of American Indian Tales" width="500" height="754" />
-</div>
-<div class="box">
-<h1>TREASURY
-<br /><span class="smallest">OF</span>
-<br />AMERICAN INDIAN TALES</h1>
-<p class="center">BY THEODORE WHITSON RESSLER</p>
-<div class="img">
-<img src="images/p2.jpg" alt="{Logo}" width="178" height="89" />
-</div>
-<p class="center"><span class="large">BONANZA BOOKS &middot; NEW YORK</span></p>
-</div>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_iv">iv</div>
-<p class="center"><span class="ss"><i>517110660</i></span></p>
-<p><span class="ss"><i>Copyright &copy; MCMLVII by National Board of Young Men&rsquo;s Christian
-Association. Library of Congress Catalog Number: 57-5046.
-All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or
-utilized in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical,
-including photocopying, recording, or by any information storage
-and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher.
-Inquiries should be addressed to: BONANZA BOOKS, a
-division of Crown Publishers, Inc., 419 Park Avenue South, New
-York, New York 10016.</i></span></p>
-<p class="center"><span class="ss"><i>This edition is published by BONANZA BOOKS,
-<br />a division of Crown Publishers, Inc.
-<br />by arrangement with The Association Press.
-<br />a b c d e f g h
-<br />Manufactured in the United States of America.</i></span></p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_v">v</div>
-<p class="tb"><span class="sc">To William Frederick, My Son</span></p>
-<blockquote>
-<p>I dedicate this book to you, my
-son. The ways of the Indian were
-good. Honesty and truth were sacred
-to them; courage, a part of
-their lives, as much as eating and
-sleeping. May this book prove to
-bring you many joyful hours of
-reading, for constantly were you
-with me during its writing, not
-only in person but in spirit.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_vii">vii</div>
-<h2>THE 44 STORIES FROM 27 TRIBES</h2>
-<dl class="toc">
-<dd><a href="#c1"><i>Introduction</i></a> ix</dd>
-<dt>1. ADVENTURE</dt>
-<dd><a href="#c2"><i>Little Rabbit Discovers a Secret of Strength</i>, <span class="sc">Pueblo</span></a> 3</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c3"><i>Atagahi&mdash;The Secret Lake</i>, <span class="sc">Cherokee</span></a> 10</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c4"><i>Quarter Moon and Little Elk</i>, <span class="sc">Iroquois</span></a> 13</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c5"><i>A Kitten Brings a Boy His Feather</i>, <span class="sc">Nez Perc&eacute;</span></a> 20</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c6"><i>Little Thunder Finds a Friend</i>, <span class="sc">Wyandot</span></a> 23</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c7"><i>How Not to Catch a Fish</i>, <span class="sc">Bella Coola</span></a> 29</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c8"><i>Little Fire Cloud&rsquo;s Dream</i>, <span class="sc">Delaware</span></a> 33</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c9"><i>The Cry of the Horned Owl</i>, <span class="sc">Cayuga</span></a> 38</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c10"><i>The Dream That Led to Victory</i>, <span class="sc">Apache</span></a> 42</dd>
-<dt>2. HUNTING AND FISHING</dt>
-<dd><a href="#c11"><i>Grey Calf Learns to Hunt Buffalo</i>, <span class="sc">Crow</span></a> 53</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c12"><i>Little Fox and the Golden Eagle</i>, <span class="sc">Apache</span></a> 60</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c13"><i>How Long Moose Became a Brave</i>, <span class="sc">Powhatan</span></a> 65</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c14"><i>How a Fishing Trip Taught Loyalty to a Boy</i>, <span class="sc">Iroquois</span></a> 71</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c15"><i>Little Bear&rsquo;s First Hunt</i>, <span class="sc">Apache</span></a> 79</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c16"><i>Crying Eagle Sees a Great Battle</i>, <span class="sc">Iroquois</span></a> 84</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c17"><i>Spotted Tail and the Ghost Wolf</i>, <span class="sc">Mohawk</span></a> 89</dd>
-<dt>3. CUSTOMS</dt>
-<dd><a href="#c18"><i>The Tribes Gather</i>, <span class="sc">Cree</span></a> 99</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c19"><i>Singing Eagle&rsquo;s First Clothes</i>, <span class="sc">Huron</span></a> 105</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c20"><i>The New Tepee</i>, <span class="sc">Blackfoot</span></a> 108</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c21"><i>Little Dove Learns to Weave</i>, <span class="sc">Winnebago</span></a> 112</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c22"><i>Red Cloud&rsquo;s Dream</i>, <span class="sc">Algonquin</span></a> 117</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c23"><i>Broken Tooth and the War Bonnet</i>, <span class="sc">Apache</span></a> 127</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c24"><i>Grey Squirrel Hears His Name</i>, <span class="sc">Oneida</span></a> 129</dd>
-<dt>4. HEROISM</dt>
-<dd><a href="#c25"><i>Little Fawn and the Wolves</i>, <span class="sc">Choctaw</span></a> 139</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c26"><i>The Island</i>, <span class="sc">Iroquois</span></a> 144</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c27"><i>A New Bow for Tani</i>, <span class="sc">Cherokee</span></a> 149</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c28"><i>Singing Waters and the Medicine Well</i>, <span class="sc">Teton-Dakota</span></a> 153</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c29"><i>The War That Should Not Have Happened</i>, <span class="sc">Comanche</span></a> 160</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c30"><i>Little Horse and the Painted Arrow</i>, <span class="sc">Delaware</span></a> 174</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c31"><i>Falling Water Earns a Feather</i>, <span class="sc">Dakota-Sioux</span></a> 192</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c32"><i>The Race with Death</i>, <span class="sc">Apache</span></a> 197</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c33"><i>The Storm</i>, <span class="sc">Algonquin</span></a> 210</dd>
-<dt>5. CHARACTER</dt>
-<dd><a href="#c34"><i>Sleeping Bear Makes a Mistake</i>, <span class="sc">Montagnais</span></a> 217</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c35"><i>The Lesson of the Elm Tree</i>, <span class="sc">Cherokee</span></a> 220</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c36"><i>The Race</i>, <span class="sc">Oneida</span></a> 225</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c37"><i>Little Thunderbird Tells the Truth</i>, <span class="sc">Blackfoot</span></a> 241</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c38"><i>The Prize No One Could See</i>, <span class="sc">Kickapoo</span></a> 247</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c39"><i>The Mysterious Pony Raiders</i>, <span class="sc">Blackfoot</span></a> 253</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c40"><i>The Canoe Race</i>, <span class="sc">Ottawa</span></a> 263</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c41"><i>Standing Fawn Makes a Doll</i>, <span class="sc">Shawnee</span></a> 269</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c42"><i>Black Cloud Remembers</i>, <span class="sc">Seneca</span></a> 274</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c43"><i>The Miracle of the Pine Grove</i>, <span class="sc">Iroquois</span></a> 281</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c44"><i>Crooked Arrow Finds a Friend</i>, <span class="sc">Shawnee</span></a> 286</dd>
-<dd><a href="#c45"><i>The Boy and the Warrior Chief</i>, <span class="sc">Seneca</span></a> 300</dd>
-</dl>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_ix">ix</div>
-<h2 id="c1"><span class="h2line1">INTRODUCTION</span></h2>
-<p>This is a collection of American Indian tales for pre-teen
-boys and girls, a fact that does not obviate the
-possibility of their interest to parents and youth leaders,
-as well. All have been tested by the author-compiler with
-youngsters in many settings&mdash;in homes, in church, Scout
-and Y groups, by the campfire, in meeting rooms, and
-even in buses.</p>
-<p>Those stories which the author has created are based
-upon Indian lore and customs. Many of the traditional
-stories were related to him by his Indian friends, descendants
-of the braves who first recounted them many generations
-ago. Both the original and the traditional tales are
-set down within the general context of Indian history, but
-without any pretense that the events actually took place.</p>
-<p>Authenticity, however, in the life, customs, and moral
-standards of the Indians has been striven for in each
-story. Throughout, an attempt has been made to impart,
-without &ldquo;preaching&rdquo; at youngsters, three major ethical
-values common to all American Indians&mdash;courage, honesty
-in dealing with others, and truthfulness in speech.</p>
-<p>The tales are of varying length, but all are short to
-conform with the interest span of average pre-teeners&mdash;and,
-hopefully, to leave them eager for the next story
-session.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_x">x</div>
-<p>It will be noted that both Indian boys and girls play
-leading roles. The author has found that the appeal of
-each story has been equal for both sexes irrespective of
-whether it has a young hero or heroine.</p>
-<p>Parents and youth leaders will observe, too, that stress
-is placed in several stories upon the close father-son and
-mother-daughter relationship&mdash;completely true in Indian
-culture, and as much coveted in the formative pre-teen
-years of our own children today.</p>
-<p>Whether read to children, or adapted and retold to
-them, or read by children themselves, it is hoped that
-these stories will be cherished as much by them as by the
-hundreds of boys and girls who helped, unwittingly, to
-select them for this book.</p>
-<p><span class="jr"><span class="sc">Theodore Whitson Ressler</span></span></p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_1">1</div>
-<h2><span class="h2line1">1. ADVENTURE</span></h2>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_3">3</div>
-<h2 id="c2"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE RABBIT DISCOVERS A SECRET OF STRENGTH</span></h2>
-<p>Little Rabbit was a young Pueblo brave who lived a
-very happy and carefree life. There was nothing very
-special about Little Rabbit unless you were to say that his
-spirits were never dampened by a sad turn of events.
-When something went wrong and people were unhappy,
-Little Rabbit usually found his way to their side, and
-would offer words of encouragement.</p>
-<p>The village in which Little Rabbit was born was like
-all the Pueblo adobe villages of centuries before him.
-Little Rabbit had to climb a ladder in order to enter his
-home, because all ground floor rooms had only a roof
-entrance. By pulling up the ladder at night, families made
-their homes hard to enter.</p>
-<p>Little Rabbit had once watched several families make
-an adobe building, several levels high. The walls were
-made of a mixture of yellowish clay and sand, called
-adobe; the roofs were made of a heavy layer of the same
-adobe laid over a strong frame of log beams, crisscrossed
-with poles, willow branches, sticks, grass, and desert
-brush. The Spaniards had taught the Pueblos how to
-mold the adobe into bricks. Small holes were made for
-windows and doorways. Each family had one large room,
-and the ground floor room (without windows or a doorway)
-was used by all the families for storage, initiation
-of the boys into secret societies, and for religious ceremonies.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_4">4</div>
-<p>Because each floor was set back the depth of the
-room below, each level had a porch which was used by
-the Pueblo women for making corn bread, pottery, and
-baskets, and by the men to weave rugs and blankets.
-When religious ceremonies, dances, and games were
-taking place, these porches gave the whole family the
-best possible point from which to watch.</p>
-<p>Such was the village in which Little Rabbit had grown
-to the age of twelve, a strong and tall young brave.</p>
-<p>One day he had just finished playing some running
-games with his friends and was returning to his home
-when one of his friends called to him, &ldquo;Come, Little
-Rabbit, we are going to walk the ledges.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Now walking the ledges was a very difficult game and,
-most of the time, was forbidden by the parents. But occasionally
-some of the more daring young braves, willing
-to chance their necks, would organize a game of ledge
-walking. The idea was something like &ldquo;Follow the
-Leader,&rdquo; but far more dangerous. The boys would walk
-right on the edge of the roofs&mdash;along the first floor and,
-if successful and daring enough, along the second, and
-then along the third floor roof. As the boys went higher,
-fewer and fewer would take part; a fall from any one of
-the roofs would be bad, but a fall from the second or
-third could cause great injury or even death.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_5">5</div>
-<p>Now Little Rabbit was not a coward, but he hesitated
-to play the game because his father had told him that he
-was not to go without his father&rsquo;s permission, and Little
-Rabbit knew that this was one game his father would
-not permit him to play. So with sadness in his heart he
-shouted back to the other boys that he had work to do,
-and continued on his way home.</p>
-<p>Several days passed, and each day a few of the older
-boys would gather to walk ledges, and each day they
-would ask Little Rabbit to take part, and each day Little
-Rabbit would say no. Finally it got to be too much for
-even Little Rabbit. The next time he was asked he answered
-yes, and soon was playing the very dangerous
-game.</p>
-<p>The boys had all completed the first ledge of the
-round floor and were starting for the second. Just as
-Little Rabbit reached the second ledge, a voice called out,
-&ldquo;Little Rabbit, my son, what are you doing?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The rest of the braves scattered, but the surprise at
-hearing his father&rsquo;s angry voice near by frightened Little
-Rabbit for a moment, and he lost his balance. He tried
-to straighten up, but went tumbling down the side of the
-dwelling. He managed to break his fall by grasping at
-the ladder but was not able to hold on. When he landed,
-his leg was doubled under him and a sharp pain shot
-through his body, and then he fainted.</p>
-<p>When Little Rabbit awoke, he found he was stretched
-on his own bed, and his father and mother were standing
-over him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am sorry, my son,&rdquo; his father said softly. &ldquo;I did not
-mean to startle you so. But I was afraid for you, and the
-fear in my heart gave harshness and anger to my voice.
-If I had waited until you were safely over the edge and
-then called to you, this terrible thing might not have
-happened.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_6">6</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not blame yourself,&rdquo; said Little Rabbit. &ldquo;It is I
-who made the mistake. I disobeyed my father. I am truly
-sorry for that. If I had not been doing something wrong,
-I would not have been startled when you called. It was
-a foolish thing for me to do. I let the other boys tease
-me into playing. It would have been braver for me to
-tell them no. Truly I am ashamed, my father.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You must rest, my son. Your leg has been badly
-injured. When you have rested we shall talk of this.&rdquo;
-With that, Little Rabbit&rsquo;s father left the house to continue
-his work.</p>
-<p>For many days Little Rabbit lay in pain from his hurt
-leg; but more than his leg, his heart and mind were hurt
-from the unhappiness he had brought to his father by
-disobeying. He tried to talk with his mother about how
-he felt but all his mother would say was, &ldquo;Do not worry
-so, Little Rabbit. Your father has forgiven you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>But this was not what concerned Little Rabbit. His
-father now had to carry on the work of farming the corn
-and brans and cotton all alone for the family. This made
-Little Rabbit feel very unhappy. He wanted to do his
-share of the work, and he liked to see crops grow.</p>
-<p>His leg began to heal, and soon Little Rabbit was able
-to hobble around with the aid of a stout staff. He began
-to help around the house as much as he could. Before
-long, he was able to limp out to the garden after his father
-and work a little there, too.</p>
-<p>Many moons passed and his leg healed and became
-strong. But it was twisted so that when Little Rabbit
-walked or ran he would limp rather badly. The other
-young braves felt sorry for Little Rabbit. Even though
-he could move about rather easily with his twisted leg,
-he really could not keep up with the other young braves
-in the many games they played. Soon he found that he
-was not being asked so often to play the really exciting
-games.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_7">7</div>
-<p>One day as Little Rabbit was seated in front of his
-home, his father was returning from the garden. As he
-came to where Little Rabbit was seated, he stopped and
-spoke gently.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why do you sit here so sad and forlorn, my son?
-Always you have been gay and happy, but lately you have
-become quiet and sad. Tell your father what it is that
-troubles you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And so Little Rabbit explained that because he could
-not keep up with them in the games of speed and skill,
-the other boys no longer invited him to play.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, if you are going to sit here and let your life
-pass you by because your leg will not obey every command
-it is given, you will soon become very unhappy
-and bitter. You will be of no use to anyone, even yourself.
-You must turn your thoughts to other things. If you
-cannot run fast, you must practice. If you cannot jump,
-you must practice.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have tried, my father, but it seems to do no good.
-My leg is strong, but the way it is twisted causes me to
-limp. If I try to run my leg bends under me. I have tried
-day after day but it is of no use.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You cannot sit here and think of the world as a sad,
-unhappy place. Such thoughts will make your leg feel
-even more twisted than it really is. You must be thankful
-for your opportunity to raise yourself to be more than
-just an ordinary Indian brave. You have a battle inside
-yourself now that calls for great courage and wisdom.
-How you will overcome it I do not know, but you must
-try, my son.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>That night Little Rabbit could not go to sleep because
-he was thinking about what his father had said. Maybe
-he had not been working hard enough to make his leg
-do what he commanded. Tomorrow he would try harder.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_8">8</div>
-<p>And so every day Little Rabbit practiced very hard.
-For many hours each week, he would exercise his leg.
-Finally one day he awoke feeling strong and fit. After
-breakfast he went forth from his home to find his friends
-for a game. When he located them, they were beginning
-a foot race which would take them around the village.
-Without waiting to be asked, Little Rabbit trotted into
-line just as the race started. The other boys were off to
-a big lead, but that didn&rsquo;t worry Little Rabbit. He remembered
-what his father had said and, with each running
-step, he repeated the words, &ldquo;I must try.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The race was going strong. Soon, to his own surprise,
-Little Rabbit began to pass the other boys one after
-another. What he had lost in ability, he made up in
-stamina&mdash;the strength to go on and on. His many days
-of practice were now proving valuable. As the other boys
-began to tire and drop back, Little Rabbit passed the
-leading young brave. Then he began to widen the gap
-between himself and the next runner until nearly one
-hundred paces separated him from the second place
-runner when he crossed the finish line.</p>
-<p>When all the runners had come panting to the finish
-line, they gathered around Little Rabbit, slapping his
-shoulders and congratulating him upon his victory.
-Finally, one of the young braves asked, &ldquo;How did you
-manage to stay so fresh to the very end?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_9">9</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, you see,&rdquo; said Little Rabbit quietly, &ldquo;when I
-fell from the ledge that day and broke my leg, I was
-sure that I was being punished for disobeying my father&rsquo;s
-wishes. After my leg healed and I began to play again,
-I found that I could not keep up with you in your games.
-Once again I thought that I was still being punished.
-But my father told me I must try harder. This brought
-me courage. Once again I began practicing every day to
-learn to run and jump even though my leg was twisted.
-I do not have the skill that I used to have, but I now have
-endurance which may stand me in very good stead later
-on as it has here today.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_10">10</div>
-<h2 id="c3"><span class="h2line1">ATAGAHI&mdash;THE SECRET LAKE</span></h2>
-<p>Somewhere in the high ridges of the Great Smokies
-there was believed to be a lake called Atagahi, the Secret
-Lake. Few people had heard of it, and this is a story of
-a young Cherokee brave and his sister who enjoyed the
-secret of this beautiful lake nestled in the Great Smokies.</p>
-<p>Utani placed his bright, shiny, new knife on the ground
-next to his new moccasins and admired the gleaming of
-the blade in the sun. He was a young Cherokee brave,
-rather tall for his age but very powerfully built and with
-sharp penetrating black eyes. He was too busy admiring
-the glint of the metal in the sun to notice the approach
-of Netani, his sister, until the shadow of her body crossed
-the knife blade and shut off the sun.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Get out of the way of the sun,&rdquo; cried Utani. &ldquo;You are
-blocking the rays from shining on my knife.&rdquo; Netani
-made no effort to move and so Utani repeated his request.</p>
-<p>Netani could not understand Utani&rsquo;s demand that she
-move, but he was her big brother and so she must obey.
-As she stepped aside she inquired of Utani why he
-watched so intently the blade of his knife in the sun.</p>
-<p>Utani, of course, now being a man, did not want to
-give a childish answer such as, &ldquo;I am watching the blade
-shine in the sun.&rdquo; So he quickly gave another answer:
-&ldquo;I am receiving a message from the sun.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What sort of message?&rdquo; asked Netani.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_11">11</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, the sun is telling me where Atagahi is and maybe
-if I study the blade long enough the sun will tell me just
-where to find it.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>This, Utani thought, would satisfy his little sister. But
-her curiosity was too great, and she asked that Utani take
-her to the secret lake, Atagahi.</p>
-<p>Now, Utani realized he had gone a little too far in his
-bragging; but being very stubborn, he refused to tell his
-sister that he really could not find the secret lake by
-looking at the knife blade in the sun. Utani made up his
-mind that he would have to find the secret lake, Atagahi.
-He rose and placed his knife carefully in his belt and,
-taking his sister&rsquo;s hand, started toward the ridges of the
-Great Smokies. For two hours, Utani and Netani climbed
-higher and higher into the mountains; but as the day wore
-on, Utani began to feel a bit frightened, for they were a
-long way from home and had come upon nothing that
-looked like a lake. Finally Netani stopped a few feet
-behind Utani and called out.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Let us rest here for a while, big brother. I am getting
-tired. Besides it is late and I am hungry. Let us go back
-to the village and look tomorrow.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Of course, Utani secretly thought that was a wonderful
-idea, for he was tired and hungry too. He agreed to
-follow his little sister&rsquo;s idea.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_12">12</div>
-<p>As he grasped his sister&rsquo;s hand to start home, his foot
-kicked a small stone which rolled off the side of the trail
-and down a small embankment of earth and landed at
-the bottom with a splash. Utani and Netani looked at
-each other with great surprise and then carefully stepped
-to the edge of the path. Utani pushed aside the branches
-that grew along the side of the trail, and they both peered
-down into the waters of a beautiful blue green lake
-nestled among the trees and rocks that hid it from human
-eyes along the trail. They had found it! They had found
-Atagahi! It was fast growing dark, so the two children
-decided to return to their village and come back the
-following day to the secret lake. When they returned to
-their village the older braves wanted to know where they
-had been. Netani said, &ldquo;We looked at Utani&rsquo;s knife blade
-in the sun, and the sun told us where to find Atagahi.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The older Cherokee braves all laughed and laughed
-very loudly. But Netani and Utani did not laugh, for they
-knew where Atagahi was and they could go there any
-time they pleased. They never told anyone their secret,
-but every once in a while if you looked very carefully up
-the trail into the mountains, you might see two Indian
-children kicking stones off the side of the trail.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_13">13</div>
-<h2 id="c4"><span class="h2line1">QUARTER MOON AND LITTLE ELK</span></h2>
-<p>&ldquo;Quarter Moon! Where are you, Quarter Moon?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Elk was shouting for his friend as he trotted
-through the quiet Iroquois village.</p>
-<p>It was July, and many of the older braves had gone
-off to fish and hunt. There were few left in the village
-except the women, the old men, and the children. Little
-Elk was now twelve and he was feeling like a big warrior
-more and more each day.</p>
-<p>Finally just as Little Elk was about to give up, he
-heard his friend answering him from behind his father&rsquo;s
-wigwam. &ldquo;Why do you call so loudly, Little Elk?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Because my mother said that I could go fishing this
-day and I would like you, my friend, to go with me. I
-have a great deal of good fishing equipment, and there
-is still one canoe left at the shore of the great lake. Can
-you come with me?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Quarter Moon thought for a moment, especially of the
-work he was supposed to do that day. Finally he said,
-&ldquo;Wait, I will go and ask my mother.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that he disappeared into the wigwam and in a
-moment was out again, smiling.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My mother says that I may go, but that I must be
-back when the sun has climbed to the highest point in
-the sky. For any day now, my father is expected back and
-I have not completed the chores he gave me to do when
-he left.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_14">14</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Come then,&rdquo; said Little Elk. &ldquo;We must hurry.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys ran to the lake shore and, after placing
-their fishing equipment in the canoe, they stepped in and
-pushed away from the shore.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We will paddle along the shore,&rdquo; said Little Elk.</p>
-<p>The Indians of the Northeast made fishing tackle from
-young basswood saplings and made their hooks from
-bone. With these they were able to catch the mighty muskellunge
-of the northern waters and supplemented their
-fresh meat diet with lake fish.</p>
-<p>The boys paddled for quite some time before they
-dropped their lines into the water. They had picked a good
-spot because in a matter of minutes they had several fish
-in the floor of the canoe. Suddenly, Little Elk noticed
-that the canoe had been drifting and he spoke to his
-friend about it.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We should start for home, Little Elk,&rdquo; Quarter Moon
-said. &ldquo;The sun is climbing high in the heavens. We have
-many fine fish, and our mothers will be proud.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As they picked up their paddles once again, Little
-Elk looked around to make sure that they were headed
-in the right direction. They had been so busy with their
-fishing that they had drifted far from where they had
-started. Little Elk wasn&rsquo;t quite sure which direction they
-should take to go homeward, for the two boys had never
-been off by themselves fishing and for a moment he was
-confused. Then, looking at the sun, he decided that they
-had turned completely around and would have to turn
-their canoe once again to be headed in the right direction.
-And after he told Quarter Moon, the two boys turned
-the canoe around and began to paddle in the direction
-they were sure was right.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_15">15</div>
-<p>They paddled past several islands and toward the
-main shore, when Quarter Moon cried out, &ldquo;Little Elk,
-our canoe has sprung a leak.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Elk looked down at his moccasins. The water
-was beginning to rise in the canoe. Then Little Elk knew
-why this old canoe had been left at the shore of the lake.
-The bottom was not considered safe. So the canoe had
-been left to be repaired and used later on.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Quarter Moon, we are not too far from the shore.
-Paddle harder and we will be able to reach the shore
-before the canoe fills so full that we cannot move it.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So the boys paddled with all their strength and soon
-felt the bow of the canoe scrape against the sandy bottom
-of the lake shore. Jumping out, the two boys pulled the
-leaking canoe ashore and up onto the brush. Looking
-around, the boys realized that they were in unfamiliar
-territory. Neither boy had ever been this far along the
-shore, but now, by looking out upon the lake, they
-guessed that they were some distance north of their
-village.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said Little Elk, &ldquo;at least we are not lost, for
-by following the shore south, we will come to our village.
-Come, Quarter Moon! We will put our fish upon some
-green sticks and take them with us.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boys took their knives and cut out two young
-branches from nearby trees; by running the branch
-through the gills of the fish and out through the mouth,
-they were able to carry them comfortably. The boys
-then started to follow the shore for home. By this time
-the sun was beginning to lower in the sky, and the boys
-knew that it was getting quite late. So they hurried along
-the shore carrying their prize catch of muskellunge.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_16">16</div>
-<p>When they had gone less than halfway to the village,
-Quarter Moon suddenly called out to his faster companion.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Little Elk, do not run so fast. I cannot keep up
-with you. I must rest.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys seated themselves on the side of the lake
-to catch their breath. It was then that they suddenly
-heard a noise. Turning around, Little Elk saw several
-feathers through the trees. He was about to call out when
-a warrior came into his sight and he realized that these
-were not Iroquois, but a roving band of Abnakes. Quickly
-he threw himself to the ground and pushed Quarter
-Moon down beside him. Quarter Moon almost cried out
-because he was so startled, but Little Elk motioned him
-to be still. He pointed into the woods and Quarter Moon
-could see why Little Elk had motioned him to be quiet.
-Then Little Elk counted the Abnakes who were moving
-quietly along the trail in single file, headed in the direction
-of his village. There were fourteen of them, all tall,
-strong, young warriors, each carrying a stout bow and a
-quiver of arrows.</p>
-<p>When the band had passed, Little Elk turned to Quarter
-Moon and whispered:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We must hurry. They are headed in the direction of
-our village and with our warriors all gone, there are none
-but the old men, women, and children. We must warn
-the village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>They jumped up and began to run as fast as they
-could along the shore toward their village, forgetting all
-about their fish and fishing gear, in their haste to get to
-their village and warn their people.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_17">17</div>
-<p>Soon they saw smoke from campfires only a few hundred
-paces ahead. Even though both boys felt as if their
-hearts would burst, they forced themselves to continue
-running until the wigwams of the village were in sight.
-The boys slowed to a trot, and entered the village all out
-of breath. They ran straight to the wigwam of Quarter
-Moon&rsquo;s uncle and tried, between gasps for breath, to tell
-him what they had seen. Finally Quarter Moon&rsquo;s uncle
-raised his hand. &ldquo;Wait! Wait! My boy, get your breath
-and then tell me what has brought you to my wigwam
-breathing so heavily and looking like a frightened deer.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boys took several deep breaths and then Little Elk
-told his story to the old man.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But we are not at war with the Abnakes and surely
-we have nothing they would want in our village. But if
-this is an attack, we must warn the others. Go through
-the village and tell all the others to gather at the medicine
-lodge. There are some of us left who can handle weapons.
-Rather than give our few supplies or our women to an
-attacking band of Abnakes, we will gather every able-bodied
-man and woman and fight if we have to.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Word was sent out through the village, and soon everyone
-gathered at the medicine lodge. Quarter Moon was
-ready to repeat to all what he had told the old brave
-when Little Elk looked through the fringe in the trees
-and spotted some warriors approaching. He was about to
-shout a warning when he saw his father in the lead of the
-party. Little Elk ran to his father, shouting that the
-Abnakes were near by. And then he saw, standing next
-to his father, a very tall and handsome Abnake. For
-some reason, Little Elk felt that this was no ordinary
-warrior. Then his father spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Little Elk, my son. What is this you say about
-our village being invaded?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_18">18</div>
-<p>Little Elk was embarrassed and looked down at the
-ground. &ldquo;My father, when Quarter Moon and I were
-returning from our fishing trip, we saw some Abnakes
-through the trees. They carried many bows and quivers
-of arrows, and they were moving swiftly and quietly
-toward our village. Quarter Moon and I ran as fast as we
-could to warn the village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You did well, my son. But come, I want you to
-welcome a friend of mine. This is Chief Big Running Fox
-of the Abnakes. With him are fourteen of his finest
-hunters. Our hunting party searched far and wide for
-game but with little success. After many days of searching,
-we were ready to start for home, sad and empty
-handed, when we were met by Chief Big Running Fox.
-After explaining to him our presence in Abnake lands,
-we were invited to their village, where we received food
-and shelter for the night. The next morning Chief Big
-Running Fox explained that the bad weather this past
-spring had driven the game north. The Abnakes had
-plenty, but knew that their neighbors to the south would
-not have much game. So Chief Big Running Fox let us
-hunt on the Abnake grounds to get plenty of meat for
-our tribe. In return we have invited them here for a feast
-to thank them for this great kindness.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am sorry, great chief, that I thought you were going
-to attack our village,&rdquo; said Little Elk, feeling very much
-ashamed.</p>
-<p>Chief Big Running Fox placed his hands upon the
-boy&rsquo;s shoulders. &ldquo;Do not feel ashamed. It could have
-been an unfriendly visit and you were right to warn your
-people of strangers near your home. Your father can be
-proud to have you for a son, and we are glad to have you
-as a friend.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_19">19</div>
-<p>The hunting party of Iroquois and Abnakes moved
-into the village side by side. That night, instead of war
-dances, there were happy dances celebrating their good
-hunting and finding a new friend. Right in the center of
-all the excitement sat Little Elk and Quarter Moon, the
-heroes of the day.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_20">20</div>
-<h2 id="c5"><span class="h2line1">A KITTEN BRINGS A BOY HIS FEATHER</span></h2>
-<p>Between the swift running Snake River and the rumbling
-Grande Ronde in the beautiful Valley of Winding
-Waters, there lived a band of Indians called the Wallows,
-a branch of the Nez Perc&eacute; tribe.</p>
-<p>Little White Wolf was one of the young boys who was
-trying to earn his first feathers which would show that
-he had become a full-fledged brave. Often he would wander
-from the camp into the forests that covered the slopes
-of the valley. There he would try to think of things he
-could do to get his feather&mdash;an act of bravery or great
-hunting skill. Two summers had passed since he first
-tried to win his feather. His little friends, Swift Owl and
-Gray Frog, had earned their feathers and now strutted
-proudly through the village to call attention to their
-feathers. They both took special care to spend most of
-their time playing near Little White Wolf, no doubt to
-make him jealous of their awards.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_21">21</div>
-<p>One day, when Little White Wolf was watching his
-mother mold a small bowl from clay, he caught sight of
-his father, Big White Wolf, striding into the village with
-a large brown animal slung over his shoulders. Little
-White Wolf knew that his father had made a kill. The
-boy raced forward excitedly to greet his father. As his
-father came nearer, the boy saw the large claws of a
-mountain lion. He was thrilled and proud and asked
-impatiently for his father to tell him the story of the kill.
-But his father only shook his head and put his hand on
-Little White Wolf&rsquo;s shoulder to quiet him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son,&rdquo; he told him, &ldquo;you will have to wait until
-the big fire tonight when I tell the tale for all to hear.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>That night as the braves gathered around the evening
-fire, Little White Wolf settled as close as he could to
-the spot where his father would stand to tell his tale of
-adventure. After the other braves had told their stories,
-Little White Wolf&rsquo;s father walked with long, firm steps
-to the center of the circle and began to speak. While
-Little White Wolf listened, he thought that his father
-looked unusually strong and tall.</p>
-<p>Big White Wolf told how he had been tracking a deer
-in a small glen at the southern end of the valley when he
-heard a snarl. Turning quickly, he saw a large female
-puma poised to spring at him from a tree. Just as the
-cat leaped, Big White Wolf shot his arrow. The cat fell
-dead at his feet. He could not explain why the big cat
-had been roused unless he had been close to a lair of
-kittens which this mother cat had been guarding.</p>
-<p>Little White Wolf leaned forward listening intently.
-Suddenly a thought flashed through his mind. He could
-not sleep soundly that night because he kept thinking of
-his secret plan. As dawn broke, Little White Wolf arose
-silently and gathered his bow and arrow and a small
-pouch of food. Then he started off for the southern end
-of the valley. He came soon to the place where his father
-had killed the big cat. The boy began to search every
-nook and cranny for the little kittens that must be here.
-He felt sure his father had been right in guessing why the
-cat had sprung at him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_22">22</div>
-<p>Finally, after many hours of searching, Little White
-Wolf was about to give up when he heard a faint cry
-coming from his right. He moved behind a small tree and
-parted the branches to see what had made the sound.
-Just a few paces away in the hollow of a rock lay a small
-ball of brown fur. Now Little White Wolf must carry out
-his plan to bring the puma kitten back to camp alive. He
-moved slowly and quietly so that he would not frighten
-the kitten. The little puma was looking away from Little
-White Wolf.</p>
-<p>When the boy was only two paces away, the kitten
-heard him. The animal jumped up quickly and started to
-run. But the Indian was too fast. He leaped and caught
-the kitten by the scruff of the neck. Then he lifted the
-little puma gently and began to scratch its head and pet
-it. In a few moments, the animal was curled up in Little
-White Wolf&rsquo;s arms, leaning contentedly against the boy&rsquo;s
-chest. The boy started back to camp with his prize.</p>
-<p>No one had known why he had left or where he had
-gone, so Little White Wolf was greeted excitedly by the
-other boys as he marched into the camp. Even Swift Owl
-and Gray Frog praised him for having rescued the little
-puma and for having braved a possible attack from some
-grown puma.</p>
-<p>That night Little White Wolf told his story. With great
-dignity, the Chief awarded the boy his feather. He was a
-very proud young brave. Now he could strut with Gray
-Frog and Swift Owl throughout the camp.</p>
-<p>Little White Wolf never realized how thankful his
-father was that his son had returned safely. Big White
-Wolf knew that the father cat might have returned while
-the boy was taking the kitten. If that had happened, there
-might have been no feather award council fire that night.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_23">23</div>
-<h2 id="c6"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE THUNDER FINDS A FRIEND</span></h2>
-<p>Little Thunder was always the first one awake in his
-woodland Wyandot village, running about doing many
-chores before his parents were even awake. He would
-build up the breakfast fire and make sure there was
-enough wood to keep it going during the day. He would
-take the water bags to the cool spring and refill them with
-fresh water for that day and do many other little chores.</p>
-<p>Finally when the rest of the village began to stir,
-Little Thunder would rush about gathering up his many
-small treasures and lay them all out in front of him on
-the ground to choose the ones he would carry with him
-that day. He had pieces of flint, a deer&rsquo;s horn, colored
-stones from the brooks, birch bark on which he had
-burned pictures, and many other things important to an
-Indian boy. Then his mother would call him in to eat.
-When breakfast was over, his father and mother would
-explain the family&rsquo;s plans for the day. Then each would
-set about doing his share of the work.</p>
-<p>One morning just before Little Thunder&rsquo;s father was
-to go off on a hunt with the other warriors of the village,
-he called Little Thunder to him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_24">24</div>
-<p>&ldquo;You must take care of your mother while I am away,&rdquo;
-Big Thunder told the boy. &ldquo;You must be the man of the
-house now. You must protect your mother and your
-home and see that all of the work is done.&rdquo; He smiled
-and pressed his son&rsquo;s shoulders. &ldquo;You will soon be a man
-and then we can go on the big hunt together. But you are
-man enough now to watch over your mother while I am
-away.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Thunder felt very proud of the way his father
-had spoken to him. When all was in readiness and the
-hunters had left the village, Little Thunder turned to his
-mother and stood very straight as he looked at her.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not be afraid, for I will watch over you, mother,&rdquo;
-he promised. &ldquo;To show that I can get all the food we
-need, I will go into the woods and bring us a fine fat
-rabbit for supper.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Now Little Thunder had a good hunting bow which
-his grandfather had made for him many moons ago. It
-was of stout hickory and had an even curve to it when
-the sinew string was pulled tight. Little Thunder had
-worked carefully to make straight, strong arrow shafts.
-He had chosen the best willow shoots from which be
-peeled the bark. Then he seasoned and straightened them
-over the fire, and rubbed them smooth with sandstone.
-His arrowpoints were made of flint which he had chipped
-with a piece of deer&rsquo;s antler after much practice under the
-eyes of his father. These were his best arrows and he was
-saving them for the time he would go with his father on
-the hunt.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_25">25</div>
-<p>Little Thunder laid these big-game arrows aside and
-picked up the set he had made for use now as a young
-Indian boy. They had bone points which he had ground
-sharp and bound into the split end of the shaft with wet
-sinew that tightened as it dried. On the other end he had
-glued and tied carefully trimmed goose and turkey
-feathers to help the arrow fly straight to its mark. He
-selected several arrows and tested his bow. Little Thunder
-knew he would find plenty of game because the
-Indians never killed without needing the food or skin of
-an animal. Having finished all preparations for the hunt,
-he said good-bye to his mother and started off to find the
-fat juicy rabbit he had promised her.</p>
-<p>Little Thunder trotted along the forest trails at a fast
-jog, looking in all directions for signs of game. He
-moved softly on his toes and the balls of his feet, as his
-father had taught him, so that he would not frighten the
-creatures of the forest.</p>
-<p>Soon he came out of the forest into a large clearing
-that he believed would yield the game he was after. He
-had walked watchfully only a short while when, not
-seven paces from him, he saw a rather large clump of
-tall grass move. He dropped to the ground, pressed his
-body flat against the earth and waited. The grass did not
-move again. He tested the slight breeze by wetting a
-finger in his mouth and holding his finger in the air. The
-side of his finger away from him felt cool and he knew
-that the breeze was blowing toward him. Whatever was
-in the grass ahead of him would not be able to catch his
-scent. He crept forward softly. When he was about three
-paces from the clump of grass, he stood up with bow and
-arrow ready to shoot.</p>
-<p>But before he let the arrow fly, he stopped short.
-There, nestled in the grass, was a young fawn which
-appeared to have been born only a short while ago. The
-fawn, frightened by Little Thunder, lay perfectly still, his
-coat blending in almost perfectly with the grasses and
-shrubs around him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_26">26</div>
-<p>Little Thunder put the arrow back in his quiver. He
-moved toward the animal slowly. The fawn struggled to
-his spindly little legs and wobbled slightly. Then his legs
-gave way and he fell to the ground. Little Thunder could
-not help laughing at the awkward little animal. This
-scared the fawn even more and he rose to his feet again
-and tried to run but again tumbled to the ground. Little
-Thunder ran forward to where the fawn lay, fearful that
-the fawn might have hurt himself. When he reached the
-side of the fawn he knelt down and placed his hands
-along the soft silky neck. The fawn trembled but he
-made no attempt to move. Gently, Little Thunder stroked
-his neck and head and back and soon the little fawn
-quieted down. It was not too long before a rough little
-tongue reached up and swiped at Little Thunder&rsquo;s face.
-Little Thunder laughed again and the fawn trembled.
-Speaking softly, Little Thunder told the fawn that everything
-was all right and that no one would harm him.</p>
-<p>Little Thunder realized that the mother deer must not
-be too far off, because only rarely would a mother deer
-leave her young&mdash;and then only to get a drink of water
-or find a new place to hide her fawn. Little Thunder rose
-from the ground and decided to look around for the
-fawn&rsquo;s mother. Walking to the opposite edge of the
-clearing, he looked down through the forest and saw a
-lake. Winding his way through the trees and brush, he
-was soon standing upon the shore of the lake. There he
-found fresh tracks of a full-grown deer. Then he saw
-some blood on the shore near more deer tracks, but he
-could find no further trace of the deer. Then he spotted
-the prints of a pair of moccasins. He realized that a
-warrior from a neighboring tribe in search of food had
-probably come upon the doe while she was drinking,
-shot her, and carried her away. He knew his guess was
-right when he saw a deer&rsquo;s stubby tail tied to the branch
-of a low-hanging tree&mdash;a sign always left by an Indian
-near the place where he had killed an animal for food or
-clothing.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_27">27</div>
-<p>Little Thunder ran back quickly to the little fawn,
-still nestled in the tall grass. Even though he trembled
-as Little Thunder came near, he soon became calm as
-the young Indian petted him gently.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your mother has been killed, little one,&rdquo; Little Thunder
-murmured to the fawn. &ldquo;That leaves you with no
-one to look out for you. Do not worry. I, Little Thunder,
-will be your friend. But first we must get you to a safer
-place, for there are many animals that would make life
-dangerous for you here in the open.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Thunder lifted the young fawn in his arms and
-carried him into the woods where he found a small
-thicket. Hiding the fawn in the thicket, he returned to
-the lake and brought some water to the fawn. Then
-picking up his bow and arrows, he trotted swiftly toward
-home to tell his mother of his adventure. On the way, a
-plump rabbit ran across his path. Little Thunder&rsquo;s shot
-was easy and accurate. So he brought his mother the big
-rabbit he had promised&mdash;and a big but true story, too.</p>
-<p>For many days after that, Little Thunder went back
-with food to his newly found friend. The young fawn
-soon became strong and was able to frisk about. Soon
-Little Thunder and the fawn were playing games together
-in the clearing. He even taught the fawn to come
-when he whistled.</p>
-<p>At last, his father returned from the long hunting trip
-and Little Thunder told him all about his adventure with
-the young fawn.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;This I will have to see for myself,&rdquo; Big Thunder told
-the boy. &ldquo;Tomorrow we shall go together to the thicket
-in the forest.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_28">28</div>
-<p>So the next morning Little Thunder took his father to
-the forest, but when they reached the thicket, it was
-empty. Big Thunder smiled at his son as if to say that the
-boy had dreamed the whole adventure.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He is probably out frisking in the clearing,&rdquo; Little
-Thunder said hastily, &ldquo;or he&rsquo;s down at the lake having a
-drink. He will be back soon. Come, father, we will sit
-over here and wait.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Though they waited patiently long into the afternoon,
-the deer did not return. For several days after that, Little
-Thunder came back to the forest and clearing and lake,
-but there was no sign of his animal friend. Little Thunder
-lost all hope of finding the fawn and soon forgot all about
-him, until one day about twelve moons later.</p>
-<p>Little Thunder had gone hunting that day and found
-himself on the trail of a young buck. He followed the
-buck all morning and just as he was about to give up
-the trail and return home, he saw the clearing where he
-had found the fawn. Approaching quietly he looked out
-across the clearing. At first he could see nothing. Then
-as he gazed along the side of the clearing near the forest,
-his eyes stopped at the small thicket. Something moved.
-Could it be the fawn, he wondered hopefully.</p>
-<p>Slowly he stood up and moved toward the thicket.
-Then something stirred again. A beautiful young buck
-stood up in the thicket. The buck turned to run. Little
-Thunder whistled and called out softly. The buck
-stopped, turned and looked at the boy. Then, without
-fear, the buck ran forward to where Little Thunder stood
-with his hand outstretched. The animal&rsquo;s tongue licked
-the Indian&rsquo;s hand, and Little Thunder reached up and
-scratched the young buck&rsquo;s head. The boy knew that his
-friend had come back at last. He would have much to
-talk about to the buck&mdash;and even more to tell his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_29">29</div>
-<h2 id="c7"><span class="h2line1">HOW NOT TO CATCH A FISH</span></h2>
-<p>The Bella Coola were a tribe that lived along the
-Northwest coast. Like most of the Indians in this part of
-the land, they were fishermen and woodcarvers. Some of
-the most beautiful carvings in the world have come from
-these tribes. Their chief source of food was fish. Each
-year at the time the salmon were running, the Indians
-would go out to the great rivers with spears and fish nets
-to make large catches. Each salmon was then split and
-dried and stored.</p>
-<p>As soon as the Bella Coola boys were old and strong
-enough, they were taken out to the rivers and taught how
-to throw the fish spear with its long line attached. They
-were also taught the use of the large fish nets. Both the
-spear and the net were hard to handle and sometimes
-dangerous.</p>
-<p>One day Little Twig (who had that name because of
-his size and the thinness of his body when he was born)
-begged his father to take him on the salmon hunt. All the
-men of the tribe were getting ready to head for the river
-steps where the salmon would be leaping. But Little
-Twig&rsquo;s father stooped beside his son and spoke slowly to
-him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, I would like to take you along, but this is
-man&rsquo;s work and you are still a young boy with much to
-learn. Stay here in the village and play with the other
-children. Your day of hunting and spearing the great
-salmon will come before you know it. But this time the
-answer must be No.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_30">30</div>
-<p>Little Twig watched his father leave the village. When
-all the other fishermen had left, Little Twig went in
-search of his friend, Running Turtle. He found him
-carving a new handle for his knife.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Running Turtle, let us go and watch our fathers fish
-for the great salmon,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;We can go far above
-them on the river and watch from the ledge. We will stay
-only for a short while and will be back in the village
-before we are missed. I have never seen them fish for
-the great salmon because my father says that it is too
-dangerous for Indian boys. Will you go?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My father will not let me go to fish with the men of
-the village either. But he never said that I could not
-watch the men as they fish. Come, Little Twig, let us
-hurry. The men are probably already there.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys set out swiftly after the fishing party.
-Soon they could hear the river roaring just ahead of
-them. They stopped at the trees that grew close to the
-river shore. Peering through the branches, they could see
-the men of the tribe spread out on both sides of the river,
-some with nets and some with spears. At the feet of each
-fisherman were large baskets into which he threw the
-fish he caught.</p>
-<p>The boys worked their way around and above the
-fishermen until they were about three hundred paces
-upstream from the fishermen. Edging close to the side
-of the river near the top of the waterfalls, the boys crept
-out on a sloping ledge of rock that was only an arm&rsquo;s
-length from the rushing water. They were so close that
-the spray wet their faces as they gazed downstream at
-the fishermen.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_31">31</div>
-<p>Soon Little Twig became so excited by what he was
-watching that he stood up and began to pretend that
-he was fishing for salmon, too. But he was not used to
-the slippery rocks as the men were, and he suddenly
-found that he was losing his balance. He called to Running
-Turtle to help him, but before Running Turtle
-could grab him Little Twig was tumbling into the rushing
-river. His body was caught in the great swirling
-waters that swept him downstream. He choked as his eyes
-and nose and ears filled with water. Just as he began to
-think he would die, he felt his body being lifted from the
-water, and heard a voice shouting.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Look at this fine fish that I have caught,&rdquo; someone
-yelled, laughing.</p>
-<p>Then Little Twig realized that one of the fishermen
-had reached out with his net and snatched him from the
-river. Little Twig sputtered and coughed and rubbed his
-eyes as strong hands set him on his feet. There he was,
-in the middle of a circle of grinning warriors from the
-village. He began rubbing all the sore spots where river
-rocks had struck his body. Suddenly he recognized his
-father&rsquo;s face. Instead of wearing the stern look which
-Little Twig had expected, his father was smiling.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Were you so eager to take a swim that you dove into
-the river?&rdquo; he asked the boy. &ldquo;Or did you hope to catch
-brother salmon with your bare hands?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I disobeyed you, my father, and I am truly sorry. I
-was a foolish young boy to come to the river when you
-told me to stay at home. Now I know why I have not
-been brought on the fishing trips. This is truly a job for
-men.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Twig looked toward the ground. His father
-reached down and lifted the lad into the air.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_32">32</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my son, this is a job for men. Someday soon
-you will join us in hunting the swift salmon with spear
-and net. But for now, be happy to remain in the village
-with your friends. You were lucky that my brother had
-his net where he did, or we might have missed you and
-your body would have been carried away. Come, we will
-go back to the village to tell your mother of your swim
-this fine day.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then he laughed again. Little Twig laughed this time,
-too, and all the braves joined in the laughter. No one
-would speak harshly to him about his foolish act even
-though it had brought him near death. Indians believed
-that angry words make people sick. So Indian parents,
-like Little Twig&rsquo;s father, always tried to speak happily.</p>
-<p>Just then Running Turtle came out of hiding, and he
-started to laugh with the others.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_33">33</div>
-<h2 id="c8"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE FIRE CLOUD&rsquo;S DREAM</span></h2>
-<p>The Delawares were a peaceful tribe, hunting and
-fishing in their rich valley and not bothering their neighbors,
-for they had plenty and needed little more than
-they were able to obtain themselves with their strong
-bows and sharp arrows and their well-kept fishing gear.</p>
-<p>It was late spring, and one day as Little Fire Cloud
-romped and played in the village his father called to him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, Little Fire Cloud, it is time we built a new
-canoe. Shortly we shall be needing a new canoe and if
-we do not start work now it will not be ready when the
-time comes to leave camp.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So father and son started out to gather the materials to
-make a fine new canoe.</p>
-<p>The Indians of the forest and lakes depended a great
-deal upon the canoe and were wise enough to construct
-them of material that was easy to obtain. Light cedar
-made the ribs and the planking of the canoe, and over
-this the Indians stretched a tight cover of birch bark.
-Then they took spruce roots and split them and these they
-used to sew the seams of the canoe together. They then
-would calk the spaces with a tarlike substance which
-was made from pine pitch and soot. When finished the
-product was firm and sturdy, but above all if the canoe
-should become injured in any way, the materials were
-always handy in the forest with which to make repairs.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_34">34</div>
-<p>Finally Little Fire Cloud and his father had gathered
-all the necessary equipment together and the work on the
-canoe was started. Father and son worked very hard at
-the job, and a few days later the canoe was completed.
-As the two finished their work they stood back to admire
-the job and Little Fire Cloud said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Is it not beautiful, father? It is the most beautiful
-canoe I have ever seen either in our own village or any
-of our neighbors.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, Little Fire Cloud, it really is a beautiful canoe
-and one which we can be proud of.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>For the rest of that day that remained, Little Fire
-Cloud could talk of nothing else but the beautiful canoe
-that he helped his father to build. Finally supper was
-over, and it was time to retire.</p>
-<p>That night as Little Fire Cloud fell asleep his head
-was all full of visions of canoes and rapids and great
-lakes and rivers. Soon the confusion of many things
-became one thing, and Little Fire Cloud found himself
-standing on the shore of a great lake. He did not know
-how he got there or what lake it was, but the water was
-a beautiful blue green and it was calm and smooth. It
-was daytime and, as Little Fire Cloud looked upon the
-lake, in the distance he saw a canoe coming toward him.
-In the bow of the canoe stood a great warrior, his arms
-folded across his chest and his eyes looking right at
-Little Fire Cloud.</p>
-<p>In the stern of the canoe, a young warrior softly paddled
-the canoe forward toward the shore, directly to
-where Little Fire Cloud was standing. As the canoe drew
-closer, Little Fire Cloud saw that it was made of shimmering
-silver birch bark and it looked so clean and new.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_35">35</div>
-<p>As the bow scraped the shore, the warrior stepped
-from the canoe and walked to where Little Fire Cloud
-was standing.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, Little Fire Cloud, step into the canoe, and we
-shall take a short trip.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not know if I should,&rdquo; said Little Fire Cloud
-overcome by the great warrior who stood before him.
-&ldquo;My father might wonder where I had gone.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not worry about your father for you will be gone
-only a short while and we shall return you to this point
-on the shore. I have something I want to show you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So Little Fire Cloud feeling a warmth toward this great
-warrior stepped in and seated himself in the middle of the
-canoe. Then the great warrior stepped in and pushed
-away from shore. The warrior in the stern turned the
-canoe toward the middle of the lake and began to paddle
-steadily, his blade cutting the water neatly and hardly
-making a ripple.</p>
-<p>The canoe glided softly and smoothly across the water.
-Up ahead a mist had settled upon the water, and soon
-the canoe had entered this mist and was gliding softly
-through the water with nothing on any side but the
-cloudy white mist. All that Little Fire Cloud could see
-was water right next to the canoe.</p>
-<p>Little Fire Cloud called to the warrior.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Where are you taking me, O great warrior of the
-lake?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You shall see, little brave,&rdquo; said the great warrior
-without turning in the canoe.</p>
-<p>Soon the mist lifted, and there surrounding the canoe
-was a beautiful pool of water with many streams running
-off in different directions.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_36">36</div>
-<p>The Indian who was paddling guided the canoe into
-one of these streams, and as the canoe moved forward
-the warrior pointed toward the shore. There along the
-shore, Little Fire Cloud could see many beaver working
-diligently at gathering material for their homes. As the
-canoe continued along the stream, Little Fire Cloud saw
-many beautiful flowers and plants, and occasionally a
-deer could be seen drinking at the water&rsquo;s edge. Little
-Fire Cloud was quick to notice that the animals seemed
-to pay no attention to the canoe when it sailed past
-where they stood except to lift their heads and look at this
-craft as it moved smoothly along the stream under the
-expert hands of the brave in the stern.</p>
-<p>Little Fire Cloud noticed that there were no weapons
-in the canoe.</p>
-<p>Soon they had reached a fork in the stream, and again
-the canoe was guided into one of the openings and the
-trip continued. Many more wild flowers and animals were
-observed by Little Fire Cloud until suddenly they were
-in the mist once again and all the beauty was behind
-them as they moved swiftly through the mist.</p>
-<p>When they broke from the cloud, Little Fire Cloud
-could see the shore of the lake once again and he realized
-that they must have traveled in a circle. Soon the canoe
-scraped the shore and the warrior stepped out and assisted
-Little Fire Cloud. When the boy was safely ashore
-the warrior said, &ldquo;Did you enjoy your trip?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, yes,&rdquo; answered Little Fire Cloud. &ldquo;Everything
-was so beautiful. Thank you very much for the nice
-ride and for showing me all the beautiful things of
-nature.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_37">37</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, Little Fire Cloud, there are many many beautiful
-things in nature that can be seen if one travels quietly
-and peacefully in a good canoe. Nature is our friend and,
-if we remember this, many pleasant hours will be spent
-seeing nature. Do not do anything to spoil this picture
-which will remain with you always. If you never raise
-your bow to kill unless you have need for food or clothing
-game will always be plentiful. But if you wasted this
-beauty which is given to the Indian you yourself and
-your people would soon die from hunger and cold. To
-kill for the sake of killing is cruel and wasteful. Now I
-must say good-bye, for I have many miles to travel.
-Good-bye, Little Fire Cloud, and remember your trip
-into the misty lake.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that the warrior stepped into the canoe, and soon
-the canoe turned and disappeared into the distance.</p>
-<p>Suddenly Little Fire Cloud felt a hand upon his shoulder
-and someone was shaking him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, my son, wake up, you have been dreaming.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When Little Fire Cloud opened his eyes he was lying
-on his bed, and his father was standing over him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, father, I had the most beautiful dream. A great
-warrior came and took me for a ride in a beautiful canoe
-and showed me the wonders of nature in all their splendor.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And Little Fire Cloud went on to tell his dream in all
-the beautiful detail that he could remember. His father
-was a good father and so he listened patiently to his son;
-and when Little Fire Cloud had finished telling about the
-dream, his father said, &ldquo;Yes, my son, it was a beautiful
-dream, and in the dream you learned a great lesson concerning
-the creatures of the wild which I hope you will
-always remember.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_38">38</div>
-<h2 id="c9"><span class="h2line1">THE CRY OF THE HORNED OWL</span></h2>
-<p>Little Beaver was full of excitement, for soon the winter
-would be over and he and his friend Jumping Rabbit
-would once again be able to take their little canoe and go
-to the lake and streams to catch the fine fish that waited
-in the early spring for the bait to be cast.</p>
-<p>The Cayuga village had weathered the winter well, and
-now the first signs of spring were beginning to show.
-With the bursting forth of the spring flowers and the
-green shoots of plants and grass and the green leaves the
-Cayuga village seemed to come alive.</p>
-<p>One of the first tasks was the uncovering of the canoes.
-(When winter approached, the canoes were all hauled
-far above the lake water&rsquo;s edge and covered completely
-with mounds of sand. This kept them from drying out
-and cracking during the cold winter.) Finally all the
-canoes had been uncovered, and the Indians took to the
-lakes and the streams again, fishing and hunting to replenish
-the food supply that had been used during the
-winter.</p>
-<p>One morning Little Beaver searched for his friend
-Jumping Rabbit for a long time and when he could not
-find him, he decided to go off by himself. Walking to the
-edge of the lake he found that his father had uncovered
-his canoe for him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_39">39</div>
-<p>Stepping into the canoe he paddled across the lake to
-the mouth of a stream which was new to him. This
-stream led to the Lake of the Rushes where the girls and
-women gathered the rushes each spring to make new
-mats for the platforms of the wigwam. Here he had not
-been before.</p>
-<p>As Little Beaver paddled he saw many signs of spring,
-but he was searching for big game. He wanted to be the
-first young boy to bring a deer back to the village.</p>
-<p>Soon he beached his canoe on the side of the Rush
-Lake and moved inland searching for signs of the deer.
-Suddenly he came upon the tracks of what seemed to be
-a fine big buck. Following carefully along the track of
-the deer he noticed that the deer was moving slowly.
-Then suddenly the spaces between the tracks became
-bigger and he knew that the deer had begun to move
-faster.</p>
-<p>Suddenly the noises of the woods ceased and it was
-very quiet. Up ahead a shadow flitted across the trail.
-Little Beaver dropped upon his belly and then he heard
-it&mdash;the cry of the great horned owl. But still he knew
-that the owl would not cry at this time of day and from a
-short distance off the trail he heard an answering cry.</p>
-<p>Through the fading light among the trees up ahead,
-he saw a small group of warriors gather. One of these
-warriors placed his hand alongside his mouth, and the
-cry of the horned owl once again was heard and from
-another direction an answer.</p>
-<p>Then Little Beaver knew that these were unfriendly
-Indians from the north and they had invaded the land of
-the Cayugas. They could be here for one reason only, to
-raid his village.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I must return at once to the village and warn my
-people of this danger.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_40">40</div>
-<p>Little Beaver turned and retreated down the path to
-where he had left his canoe. Pushing it out into the lake
-he immediately began paddling as fast as his arms could
-go for the mouth of the stream that would lead into the
-next lake and to the shore of his village. He reached the
-mouth of the stream just as the dark storm clouds started
-to gather over the lake.</p>
-<p>And then it was raining and raining hard. This would
-slow up the attackers, but it would not stop them and
-Little Beaver had to get to his village quickly to warn his
-people of the danger. He dipped his paddle deep into the
-waters of the lake and the canoe moved forward. But
-now the wind was getting stronger and his arms began to
-ache from the effort. He paddled harder and harder but
-soon his arms became weak and he was still a great distance
-from the shore. Besides the danger of the storm it
-was fast approaching nightfall, and ahead Little Beaver
-could see the friendly fires of his village being lit one at a
-time.</p>
-<p>These would act as beacons of direction for the enemy.</p>
-<p>He chanced a glance behind and then he heard it
-again. The cry of the horned owl. The cry was coming
-from almost directly behind and in the dusk he could see
-the canoes of the enemy slipping from the stream into
-the lake.</p>
-<p>The storm passed and the waters became calm, and
-now Little Beaver&rsquo;s job was easier, but so was that of
-the enemy. He paddled with all his might though he felt
-his arms would fall off.</p>
-<p>Finally he reached the shore and he leaped out onto
-the sand. Without waiting to pull his canoe ashore he
-rushed for the village. He turned to glance at the lake
-once more and he could see the canoes of the enemy
-drawing along the shore, closer to the village with each
-stroke.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_41">41</div>
-<p>He rushed to his father and quickly told him what he
-had seen. His father dashed from the wigwam and
-glanced toward the lake. Just then they both heard it
-once again. The cry of the great horned owl. His father
-stopped and listened and then placing his own hand to
-the side of his mouth he answered the whistle. Then he
-turned to his son.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It is all right my son. These are friends come to join
-in a great celebration. It is your uncle and his people
-from the north. Be not afraid, for they are friends.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Beaver looked at his father. He smiled and taking
-his father&rsquo;s hand they walked toward the lakeside.
-Stepping from the canoes were a number of Cayuga warriors
-and they came with many bundles.</p>
-<p>The two groups greeted each other and then the leader
-of the visitors came forward.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your father has explained that you thought we were
-unfriendly Indians come to call. I, for one, am glad that
-you are not a grown warrior right now, for your arrow
-shaft might have found its place in my heart in the forest.
-We had hoped to surprise your people with our visit but
-when we saw your canoe glide away from the Lake of the
-Rushes we knew we had been seen. And so, my little
-brave, let me congratulate you on a fine job of paddling.
-You came across the lake in a storm without slowing your
-stroke. I have told my brother that if we had been the
-enemy you would have reached the village far ahead of
-us and we would now be walking the trail of the happy
-hunting ground.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>That night Little Beaver slept very soundly. He had a
-great adventure on his first trip to the Lake of the Rushes
-and it would be a long time to come before he would go
-alone again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_42">42</div>
-<h2 id="c10"><span class="h2line1">THE DREAM THAT LED TO VICTORY</span></h2>
-<p>Singing Fire, the young Apache brave, rode swiftly
-through the hills toward the village of his people. He had
-been hunting and now was returning to his tepee to join
-his family in a hearty evening meal. His hunger made him
-urge his pony to an even faster pace. Soon he could see
-the smoke of the fires in the village. It was only a few
-moments later that Singing Fire brought his pony to a
-quick stop on the very edge of the village. To ride his
-horse through the village this evening would have been
-unkind. The summer had been very dry, and his pony&rsquo;s
-hoofs would have raised much dust that would settle in
-the cooking pots.</p>
-<p>Walking through the village, the young brave waved
-and called to his friends. He laughed when they joked
-with him about his empty hands. He had been unable to
-find any game that he felt was worth bringing to the
-village. Soon he reached his father&rsquo;s tepee and was welcomed
-warmly by the family.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_43">43</div>
-<p>When supper was finished, Singing Fire went to talk
-with his friend, Many Painted Ponies. The two braves had
-always been together since they were very young and just
-learning to walk. Now whenever they had time, they
-would sit and talk about their future together as great
-leaders of the Apache tribe. He found his friend working
-at making new arrow tips.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Hello, my good friend, Many Painted Ponies, and
-how are you this fine evening?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My stomach is full and my heart is happy, Singing
-Fire. Could a brave ask much more of life? I have been
-very fortunate in having such a fine father and mother
-who have made my life such a pleasure. As I saw you
-ride in from the hunt, I noticed you carried no game.
-Was there no game where you rode? Usually you do not
-return empty-handed.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Today was bad for the hunt. The largest game knew
-that I was hunting and ran for cover, and I was not as
-quick as they to find the hiding places.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two young men laughed and then spent some time
-talking until darkness came. Each young man went back
-to his tepee for a well-earned sleep.</p>
-<p>The next day there was great excitement in the village.
-As young Singing Fire stepped from his tepee, he saw that
-people were gathering in the center of the village to hear
-a tall Apache warrior who was talking loudly and rapidly
-to the chief of the village. As Singing Fire drew near, he
-was able to catch some of the words spoken by the
-warrior.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It is true, my Chief, the Comanches have been seen in
-our land. If we are not careful they will raid our pony
-herds and make off with many of our best mounts. I have
-seen them to the east, and they skulk like the lowly wolf
-in the night.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_44">44</div>
-<p>The great chief listened quietly until the young warrior
-had finished. Then he motioned to the older men of the
-tribe to gather in his tepee. When they were all inside,
-Singing Fire, Many Painted Ponies, and the other young
-braves stood outside waiting impatiently for what the
-elders of the tribe would decide. They could hear the
-young brave who had first reported to the chief repeating
-his story for those who had come late. He said that while
-trailing some ponies that had strayed from the herd he
-had come upon the coals of a recent fire. Because the
-marks in the sand were not Apache, he had followed the
-tracks made when the group broke camp. Traveling at a
-rapid pace, he soon had come upon the band of Comanches
-in a small gully. After watching them for a
-short while, the brave had mounted his pony and ridden
-as fast as he could to the village to tell the chief of this
-threat to their property and peace, within such a short
-distance of their camp.</p>
-<p>Finally the Chief came out from his tepee and spoke to
-the young warriors.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The Comanches have entered our hunting grounds.
-Not only have they broken the law, but they dare to ride
-within a short distance of our camp. We will gather a war
-party and go in search of these thieves of the night. We
-will give them a sound lesson by whipping those wild
-dogs so badly that they will return to their own land
-with their tails between their legs&mdash;if there are any left to
-return when we have met them upon the field of battle.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With low shouts of agreement, everyone ran to prepare
-for the warpath.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_45">45</div>
-<p>Singing Fire and Many Painted Ponies returned to
-check their weapons and when preparations were completed
-returned to where the chief sat astride a great
-white horse. When everyone had assembled, the party left
-camp in search of the invading Comanches. For several
-days the party searched but no sign was found other than
-the old fire, that anyone had been in the vicinity. At last
-the chief turned to his men and said, &ldquo;They have seen our
-strength and afraid have returned to their own land. They
-respect the might and fighting ability of the Apaches.
-Come, we will return to our village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The party started for home, but as Singing Fire and
-Many Painted Ponies rode along, Singing Fire was quiet.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What is it, my friend, Singing Fire? You are so
-quiet.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I was just thinking, my friend, that the Comanches are
-not known as cowards; they surely would not turn from a
-fight. I do not believe they have left our land.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But, Singing Fire, for three days we have searched the
-land and no sign do we see of the Comanches. Certainly
-the earth did not open and swallow them up.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That is just the point, my friend. What has happened
-to the party? The brave reported seeing them and took us
-to where they had their fire. The tracks led away but
-suddenly stopped, and we have seen nothing to indicate
-that they returned to their own lands across the great
-river. I just am not satisfied that they have left.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Nothing more was said for the remainder of the trip
-back to the village, and that evening after supper, Singing
-Fire went to sleep thinking about the hunt for the
-Comanches.</p>
-<p>As he slept, he dreamed there were Comanche warriors
-mounted upon fast horses and they all seemed to be
-riding toward a solid wall. Singing Fire suddenly awoke
-recalling seeing that wall before.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_46">46</div>
-<p>About a day&rsquo;s ride from their village was a small valley
-which they called the valley of the snake because it
-twisted and turned between the mountains. As the thundering
-riders neared the wall, it seemed to open up and
-they had disappeared within. Then the walls closed again
-and there was silence. Singing Fire leaped from his bed
-and rushed to his father&rsquo;s side.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My father, I must speak to our chief. It is of great
-importance that I see him now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But it is late, my son, and certainly what you have to
-say can wait until tomorrow.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, father, I must speak to him now.&rdquo; With that,
-Singing Fire left his tepee and soon was standing before
-the tepee of the Great Chief. He made his presence known
-and was invited into the tepee.</p>
-<p>The chief invited him to sit and then asked, &ldquo;What
-brings you to my tepee so late, young Singing Fire?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Tonight, O Great Chief, in a dream I was drawn to
-the painted hill which stands guard over our village. Here
-I stood troubled in heart and mind because of what has
-been reported to our tribe.&rdquo; Then Singing Fire proceeded
-to tell in complete detail of the dream he had had. When
-he finished, he waited for the chief to speak.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What importance do you attach to this dream you
-have had, young Singing Fire?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not know, Great Chief, but I would like your
-permission to take Many Painted Ponies and ride to this
-place I have seen in the dream. I would like to see what
-can be found there and then I will return to my village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The Indians placed a great deal of faith in dreams, and
-so the chief gave his permission and early the next morning,
-Many Painted Ponies and Singing Fire set out for the
-valley that Singing Fire had seen not only in his dream,
-but many times on his hunting trips.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_47">47</div>
-<p>They traveled all day, and when the sun was setting in
-the west, they found themselves but a short distance from
-the entrance to the valley. They camped for the night,
-not lighting a fire, in case there should be any unfriendly
-Indians in the vicinity.</p>
-<p>As dawn drew near, the two young men crawled to
-the mountainous heights overlooking the twisting valley.
-There they lay and watched the valley below. For almost
-an hour they sat until finally about noontime a small
-band of warriors could be seen riding into the valley.
-They rode straight up the middle of the valley twisting
-and turning as the valley turned but finally about midway
-up the valley they swung sharply to the left and seemed
-to disappear into the very walls surrounding the valley.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come,&rdquo; said Singing Fire, &ldquo;we must investigate this
-strange occurrence.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>It took them most of the afternoon to reach a vantage
-point overlooking where the warriors had disappeared.
-Crawling carefully to the very edge, the two young
-braves looked carefully over the edge. Below them lay a
-fantastic sight. A tremendous Comanche encampment
-was being formed in a small box canyon. The entrance
-to the box canyon was a mere crack in the wall which was
-just about wide enough for one horse and rider to enter at
-one time. Now Singing Fire could see why a rider going
-through the valley would not see the opening for it was
-actually hidden from view by a turn in the trail. If one
-were not looking for it, one would not find it except by
-accident.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;This is why we have not seen the Comanches except
-for that one small party. Under cover of night or early
-dawn they have been entering our land in small parties,
-gathering here until their force is large enough to make
-war upon our people.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Singing Fire tapped his friend upon the shoulder, motioning
-him away from the edge.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_48">48</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Many Painted Ponies, one of us must ride for all he is
-worth to reach our village and tell of this plan to our
-people. You must tell the chief to gather the Apaches
-together and we can trap the scheming Comanches in
-their own camp.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Many Painted Ponies rose to leave. &ldquo;Be careful, my
-friend, for if they should suspect that you are here your
-scalp will soon hang from their medicine lodge and they
-will break from their camp fearing the trap we will set
-for them. Now I will ride for our village and may your
-prayers go with me.&rdquo; With that, Many Painted Ponies left
-and mounting his pony he rode off toward home.</p>
-<p>Singing Fire kept careful watch for the next day and
-night and when dawn approached he saw the dust of
-many horses approaching. Riding forth to meet his people,
-a plan formed in his mind. In council with the chiefs
-a short time later the plan was outlined. The best marksmen
-of the Apaches were placed around the box canyon
-on the walls overlooking the unsuspecting camp of the
-Comanches. Other warriors would ride into the valley to
-stand guard at the only entrance or exit to the canyon to
-make sure none escaped.</p>
-<p>Soon all was in readiness. The signal was given. Like
-an attacking horde of eagles, the Apaches began firing
-down upon the Comanche encampment. The battle was
-long and bloody. In confusion the Comanches mounted
-their ponies and headed for the exit. Here they were met
-with a hail of arrows which drove them back into the
-canyon.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_49">49</div>
-<p>When the Comanche forces were thoroughly disorganized,
-the chief signaled the Apaches to charge
-through the entrance and soon the two tribes were
-locked in hand to hand combat. The victory was complete
-and soon the last of the Comanches had fallen before
-the knives and war clubs of the attacking Apaches.</p>
-<p>In triumph the tribe returned to the village where
-great celebrations marked the next few days and nights.
-The hero of the affair was praised before the council, and
-Singing Fire was honored for his part in the great victory.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_51">51</div>
-<h2><span class="h2line1">2. HUNTING AND FISHING</span></h2>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_53">53</div>
-<h2 id="c11"><span class="h2line1">GREY CALF LEARNS TO HUNT BUFFALO</span></h2>
-<p>Grey Calf opened his eyes to greet the warmth of the
-early spring day. There was a great deal of excitement
-in his Crow village as he rolled out from under his buffalo
-robe. At just that moment, his father entered the
-tepee.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, my son,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;We must dress and eat right
-away. The village is broken down, for we are going to
-move again. Your mother is waiting to take down our
-tepee. Come, you must prepare to help load the travois.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Grey Calf learned as a very young Crow that whenever
-his tribe had to move to follow the buffalo herds, the
-whole village was packed and loaded upon travois drawn
-by the horse or horses of each family. Everything the
-family owned was made to be carried easily in rawhide
-containers that could be folded and put away when the
-family had settled in a new place. Furniture was made
-so that it could be folded, too.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_54">54</div>
-<p>Many times, Grey Calf had watched his mother make
-the travois. She would take two of the tepee poles and
-fasten them together with a rawhide thong, just a short
-way from one end. Then she would pull the poles apart
-at the opposite end and set them, at the point where
-they were crossed and tied, upon the shoulders of their
-horse. The longer ends of the crossed poles would stretch
-outward and rest on the ground behind their horse on
-each side. Then she would run a long strip of rawhide
-through the knot that joined the poles over the horse&rsquo;s
-shoulders, and tie it around the horse&rsquo;s chest like a light
-harness. Finally, she would stretch and tie strips of rawhide
-across the poles behind the horse, to make a frame
-on which their family goods were loaded.</p>
-<p>Grey Calf&rsquo;s father had told him once that many years
-ago, before the white man had brought horses to the Indians&rsquo;
-land, the travois had been fastened to their strong
-dogs. But the dogs were not so strong as horses, so the
-loads had to be much smaller and lighter. Even their
-tepees were smaller in those days because larger ones
-would have weighed too much for any one dog to pull
-on the travois.</p>
-<p>These thoughts passed rapidly through Grey Calf&rsquo;s
-mind as he listened to his father. Then he yawned and
-asked, &ldquo;Must we move so soon again, father? It seems
-such a short while ago that our tribe set up its village
-here.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, the buffalo are on the move,&rdquo; his father
-answered patiently. &ldquo;You know that we would not have
-our tepees, our best food and clothing, and little of
-anything else without the great buffalo. When they
-decide to move, we must move with them. The scouts
-who have been watching the herd tell us that it has
-started to leave for new feeding grounds.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Without another word, Grey Calf got up quickly and
-began helping his mother gather their belongings. He
-helped her take down the tepee. Then she built the
-travois rapidly, and he helped her pack and load their
-belongings onto it.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_55">55</div>
-<p>Soon, where once a proud village had stood, hardly
-anything was left standing. The men set out ahead on
-their horses, followed by the women and children on
-horses, the smaller children sometimes riding on the
-travois, their mothers and the older children riding astride
-the horses&rsquo; backs. Grey Calf, like many other of the
-older boys, was riding his own pony near his mother.</p>
-<p>The scouts were far ahead of them, keeping close
-touch with the wandering buffalo herd, and signaling the
-tribe to tell the braves which way to lead their families.
-The scouts were also watching carefully for roving bands
-of the Crows&rsquo; enemies, for they were near Cheyenne
-territory, but they saw none.</p>
-<p>Just as Grey Calf was ready to ask his mother if the
-buffalo herd would never stop roaming, a scout raced
-his horse back to tell the braves that the herd was
-circling around, ready to settle down near fresh water
-and food. The Chief gave the signal, and all the families
-went to work busily setting up their tepees. Before too
-long, smoke was rising lazily from the fires which circled
-their new village. The trek had taken most of the day, and
-the women were beginning to cook the evening meal.</p>
-<p>The braves were watering their thirsty horses, and then
-would put them out to graze. Grey Calf did all he could
-to help his mother get their meal ready quickly because
-he was very hungry. When all the small chores had been
-completed, the families gathered at their tepees, to eat
-the food that smelled so good to all the children.</p>
-<p>It wasn&rsquo;t long after Grey Calf had eaten that he began
-to feel drowsy. Saying goodnight to his father and mother,
-he went into the tepee, rolled himself in his warm buffalo
-robe (because the prairie night would be cool), and was
-soon sound asleep.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_56">56</div>
-<p>The next day dawned as one of great excitement, for
-word came to the tepee of Grey Calf that today One
-Horn, the great buffalo hunter, was going to take the
-young braves on their first buffalo hunt.</p>
-<p>Like other Crow boys, Grey Calf had spent many
-days preparing patiently for this great event. His father
-had taught him how to ride his pony and to shoot the
-bow and arrow. He had learned how to ride into a herd
-and to shoot from beneath his pony&rsquo;s neck. And now
-that great day was here. One Horn, the greatest of
-buffalo hunters in the tribe, would give the young braves
-their last lesson before taking them out onto the prairie
-for the actual hunt.</p>
-<p>When the young braves had gathered, One Horn
-stepped to the center of the circle and gave his final
-instructions, warning them not to be too eager but to
-take their time and make sure of their shot. And above
-all, he warned them, as soon as they had made their shot
-they must swerve away from the herd. In this way they
-would be out of danger if the herd should spread out to
-avoid trampling its fallen members.</p>
-<p>When One Horn finished, he asked if there were any
-questions. The young braves had none. So One Horn told
-them that the time of the hunt would be midafternoon.
-The boys were told to return to their tepees and get
-everything ready.</p>
-<p>Grey Calf sped back to his tepee to tell his family
-breathlessly all that had happened. For the rest of the
-morning he worked carefully over each of his arrows and
-his strong bow. In fact, he was so busy that his mother
-had to call him three times before he came to lunch.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_57">57</div>
-<p>The sun seemed to move very slowly for all the Crow
-boys. But soon a young brave on a frisky pony rode
-swiftly through the village to tell them to gather for the
-hunt.</p>
-<p>Grey Calf leaped upon his pony&rsquo;s back and sped to
-the edge of the village where the other young braves
-were gathering. When all had gathered and were seated
-on the ground, One Horn spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;A small group of buffalo has wandered away from
-the main herd,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It is from this small group that
-we shall choose our targets. I will inspect each young
-brave&rsquo;s weapons in turn. When all are satisfactory, we
-shall move out in the direction of the small herd. Do
-not ride hard but move your pony slowly. Buffalo will
-not go far in this heat. We shall have plenty of time to
-come near them, take our positions quietly, and then
-attack together without warning.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When One Horn had finished examining each young
-brave&rsquo;s weapons, the small band moved out in single file.
-Soon they sighted the buffalo. One Horn gave hand
-signals to the young braves to spread out and take their
-positions silently, but above all to wait for the signal from
-One Horn to attack.</p>
-<p>As slowly and quietly as possible, each young brave
-moved into position. All eyes were on One Horn, and
-suddenly he gave the signal. The air was torn apart as
-wild yelps leaped from the throats of the eager young
-hunters. The buffalo were startled and began running
-about wildly. The boys dug their heels into their ponies&rsquo;
-sides and headed into the group of buffalo. Soon the
-dust clouds were so heavy that one could not tell the
-hunters from the hunted, but the young braves rode
-swiftly, each hunter picking out his buffalo carefully and
-with an eye to size. This was to be the first of many
-buffalo kills, and each young brave hoped that his would
-be the largest of the beasts brought down.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_58">58</div>
-<p>Buffalo after buffalo began to stumble and fall before
-the accurate shooting of the young hunters. The ponies
-were magnificent in their performance, for each had been
-carefully trained for this day.</p>
-<p>As quickly as the hunt had started it was over. One
-by one the young braves returned to One Horn who had
-seen their great success. Soon they were once again at
-their starting point. They knew that the remaining buffalo
-would tire and, knowing they were no longer being
-chased, would begin to mill and settle down once again.</p>
-<p>One Horn gazed proudly upon the field of battle.
-Twelve plump shaggy beasts lay dead upon the prairie.
-Every brave had made his kill. There would be much
-rejoicing in the village that evening. One Horn told the
-young braves how to prepare their kills for the return to
-the village, and they went to work immediately. Their
-adventure this afternoon would mean much food for the
-tribe and new clothing for the coming winter and horns
-and tails to decorate their costumes and tepees.</p>
-<p>As One Horn rode from dead buffalo to dead buffalo,
-watching the young braves at work, he was quick to
-praise each lad for his part in the hunt that day. Soon
-all had completed their tasks and a triumphant band
-returned to the village.</p>
-<p>That evening each young brave in turn told how he
-had made his kill and there was a great deal of celebrating.
-The honor of the biggest kill went to Grey Calf. As
-the last of the families were going into their tepees for
-the evening, Grey Calf&rsquo;s father came to sit by his side.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_59">59</div>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, your father is proud. Not only has my son
-killed his first buffalo but it was by far the largest of the
-beasts killed today. Today you had success and triumph,
-but life will not always be that simple. The trail ahead
-is hard. There will be many difficult times, but if you
-learn your lessons well you shall one day be a great and
-respected warrior of the tribe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When Grey Calf&rsquo;s father had finished speaking, he
-looked down upon his son and smiled. The tired young
-brave had fallen asleep.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_60">60</div>
-<h2 id="c12"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE FOX AND THE GOLDEN EAGLE</span></h2>
-<p>Little Fox, a member of the Apache Tribe, was a shy
-Indian lad who was rather small. When he was born he
-was a very tiny baby and his face was thin and pointed
-like that of a fox. For this reason he was given the name
-of Little Fox.</p>
-<p>As Little Fox grew older, he dreamed of the day he
-would be able to wear the feathers of the Great Golden
-Eagle, the most respected bird of the American Indian.
-It was believed that there was great power in the thirteen
-tail feathers and in the pinion feathers on the wings of
-the Great Golden Eagle.</p>
-<p>One day Little Fox was seated in his mother&rsquo;s wickiup,
-when his father entered. Without a word Little Fox&rsquo;s
-father went to a case made of deerskin and carefully
-removed the cover. Then with great care he removed
-from the case a most beautiful feather bonnet, at which
-Little Fox gazed with great longing. His father, Swift
-Deer, was an honored brave in the tribe and had become
-privileged to wear the bonnet of eagle feathers for his
-many brave deeds and the telling of these deeds before
-the Council of Chiefs. Swift Deer had been granted the
-right to place additional eagle feathers in his headdress.
-Suddenly, Swift Deer turned to Little Fox, and said,
-&ldquo;Why do you look so sad, my son?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_61">61</div>
-<p>Little Fox turned slowly to his father and said, &ldquo;It is
-because I, Little Fox, have not been able to do anything
-that the Council would recognize as a deed worthy of
-the wearing of the feathers of the Great Golden Eagle.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Fox,&rdquo; said his father, &ldquo;you seek too hard for
-a deed to compete for this honor. Tell me, do you have
-any eagle feathers that you could wear, in case you
-should do a deed which would be considered worthy?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, my father,&rdquo; said Little Fox, &ldquo;but by the rising
-of the next new moon, I shall have many eagle feathers,
-for tomorrow I start in search of the Great Golden
-Eagle. It has been told by Great Moose that beyond the
-three hills many Golden Eagles have been seen.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Swift Deer was proud. He knew that though his son
-was small he had in his breast a brave heart, for to go
-in search of the Great Golden Eagle took a great deal
-of courage. Once again Swift Deer took his son aside
-and told him the many dangers of eagle hunting, but
-praised him for his bravery in going to get the tail
-feathers of the Great Golden Eagle.</p>
-<p>The following morning, Little Fox took some food.
-Then taking a long strong thong of deerskin, he looped
-it several times around his waist and tied the food pouch
-to it. Strapping a knife also to the thong, he started for
-the place where the Great Golden Eagles had been seen.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_62">62</div>
-<p>On the way he stopped just long enough to snare a
-plump young rabbit which he would use for bait. When
-he reached the place where the eagles were to be found,
-he started digging a deep hole, large enough for him to
-stand in. Then he placed branches over the hole to hide
-it, with a small space for him to reach through and grasp
-the tail feathers of the eagle. To the top of this cover he
-tied the plump young rabbit with a piece of thong. After
-all was in readiness, Little Fox lifted the edge of his cover
-and slid into the hole, resting his foot on a thick root
-which stuck out of the earth into the hole. Placing his
-back against the side of the hole, he waited patiently for
-the Golden Eagle.</p>
-<p>An hour passed and then two and three, and Little
-Fox began to feel his muscles tighten up and his body
-start to grow stiff. He began to feel impatient. Suddenly,
-he heard the rabbit begin to move about uneasily, then
-tug in panic against the thong that held him. Surely the
-Golden Eagle must be close by. Little Fox felt relaxed;
-the stiffness in his body was gone. Now excitement rushed
-into his body as he waited for the Golden Eagle to come
-to rest on the top of his hiding place.</p>
-<p>All at once, Little Fox felt the ground tremble and
-he heard what sounded like the low rumble of a waterfall.
-Then he knew that what he had heard was the low
-growl of a bear. He peered through a crack in the cover
-over the hole and saw the bear&rsquo;s towering form. Fear
-gripped the heart of Little Fox. Many were the stories
-he had heard of Indians who had lost their lives while
-hunting for the prized feathers of the Golden Eagle.</p>
-<p>The bear, with the swiftness of a fleeting arrow, made
-one sweep with his huge paw and the rabbit went sprawling.
-The bear paused as though he were thinking about
-the problem before him. Here was one of his enemies
-trapped beneath his feet. How would he reach his enemy?
-With an angry growl he ripped at the boughs which
-covered the hiding place of Little Fox until he had
-uncovered the top of the hole.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_63">63</div>
-<p>Holding his breath and his heart beating wildly, Little
-Fox crouched far down in the hole and waited for the
-final moment when he, instead of the Golden Eagle,
-would fall victim in his own trap. The bear lunged but
-missed his mark. Little Fox suddenly realized that the
-top of the hole was too small for the bear to get his paw
-and his head in at the same time. Again and again the
-bear lunged, but without success. The more he lunged
-and failed, the angrier he became. He thrust first his
-paw and then his head into the hole; but Little Fox,
-by pressing down against the bottom of the hole, was able
-to keep just out of reach of the flailing paws and gnashing
-teeth. All of a sudden, the bear pulled back away from
-the hole as if to consider his next move. In this instant,
-Little Fox thought of a way that might save his life.
-He quickly untied the long leather thong around his
-waist, made a loop of it, and as slowly and quietly as
-possible placed the loop just below the opening, holding
-it in place all around by pressing the thong into the
-earth. Little Fox tied the other end to the root on which
-he had been standing.</p>
-<p>Now the bear was returning. Little Fox waited, holding
-tight to the leather thong. As the bear placed his head
-in the hole and so into the loop, Little Fox pulled hard
-on the thong, which immediately came loose from the
-earth and tightened around the throat of the bear.</p>
-<p>In angry surprise, the bear pulled back from the hole
-only to be stopped short as the thong drew tight. Then
-he began a series of noises which Little Fox remembered
-for many moons. The bear&rsquo;s growls gradually grew to
-roars, and then turned to cries of pain. The harder the
-bear pulled, the tighter the thong gripped his throat, until
-the cries became coughs and gasps. Then all was quiet.
-The bear&rsquo;s thrashing around had ceased, but still Little
-Fox waited.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_64">64</div>
-<p>Little Fox slowly raised himself until he could see just
-over the edge. There, not two feet from the hole, lay a
-huge bear, quite still and dead. Little Fox quickly pulled
-himself from the hole and started at a run for the village.</p>
-<p>He reached the village and, not stopping to answer any
-questions, ran straight to his father&rsquo;s wickiup. He began
-telling his story, still panting and talking so fast that his
-father made him stop to get his breath and then speak
-slowly. When Little Fox had finished, Swift Deer gathered
-some of the other warriors and went to the place
-where this adventure had taken place. With great pride,
-Swift Deer helped to skin the bear and bring it back to
-the village. Not long after, Little Fox stood in the Council
-meeting before the elders of the tribe and recounted
-his tale of courage. And when all his words had been
-heard, the Council voted that Little Fox should wear in
-his headband not one, but two of the most treasured tail
-feathers of the Great Golden Eagle.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_65">65</div>
-<h2 id="c13"><span class="h2line1">HOW LONG MOOSE BECAME A BRAVE</span></h2>
-<p>The Powhatan Indians were a great tribe whose hard
-work each year was rewarded with large supplies of food
-and clothing.</p>
-<p>Long Moose was growing up among his people happily,
-doing his share of the tribe&rsquo;s work. He had become
-very tall and awkward. He had great strength, too, which
-he hadn&rsquo;t learned yet to use well. During games and
-contests, Long Moose often forgot how strong he was
-and, not meaning to, would hurt his friends, sometimes
-rather badly.</p>
-<p>Long Moose was still trying over and over to learn
-how to make hunting tools when winter came. It was a
-bitter, cold, northern winter. Both his mother and father
-became very sick and died after only a few days, leaving
-his younger sister and himself alone without near relatives
-to help them.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_66">66</div>
-<p>Because Long Moose was not a skillful young brave,
-his sister had little respect for him. He spent many days
-thinking sadly about his parents, but doing nothing to
-get food and keep their shelter tight against the wind and
-snow. Soon their small supply of food and fuel was nearly
-gone, and Long Moose had brought no hides for making
-clothes or repairing their home. He had also failed to
-give his share of food and hides for all the tribe, as every
-warrior was expected to do. Not only his sister but all the
-tribe began to feel that Little Moose was not a good
-Powhatan.</p>
-<p>His sister&rsquo;s harsh looks at him and his own growing
-hunger and cold made Long Moose think about how
-and why he was not a good brother or a good brave. He
-had to admit to himself that there was only one real
-reason besides his poor hunting tools and bad marksmanship:
-he did not want to hunt or make good hunting
-tools because he did not want to kill any animals.</p>
-<p>He thought about how often he had gone out to hunt
-and even when, without looking for them, he had run
-across deer near by, he would still come back without
-having shot a single arrow. Long Moose knew that he
-loved all wild animals as much as he had loved his
-parents, and loved his sister and his friends now.</p>
-<p>Driven by his hunger, the cold, his shame, and his real
-love for his sister, Long Moose set out several times to
-hunt. Each time he made a kill, but he was nearly as sad
-when he had done so as he had been when his parents
-died. To add to his sorrow, his sister would scold him
-for his poor skill, and taunt him by saying that he would
-never grow to be a real brave.</p>
-<p>All the tribe could see that Long Moose and his sister
-were hungry most of the time. Their clothes were shabby
-and their home now was beyond repair.</p>
-<p>One day in early spring, Long Moose went down to
-the edge of the lake to be away from the unkind glances
-of his sister and his friends&mdash;and to think. As he sat on
-a cold rock, staring out at the ice on the lake, an old
-man of the tribe came up and stood quietly beside him,
-waiting for Long Moose to speak.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_67">67</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Nantesi, my friend,&rdquo; Long Moose said, wondering if
-he still were his friend, &ldquo;what brings you here to me?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My friend, Long Moose, for nearly two moons now
-there has been hunger in your home. Your clothes are
-worn out, and your sister is afraid to leave your home,
-because she is ashamed of her clothes. She has told some
-of the women that you are afraid to hunt the wild game
-because of the bear that lurks in the woods. Some of the
-other families have given her food and skins from time
-to time. But they can give her no more. The next winter
-may be hard again and each family will need every bit of
-its food and skins. You must not fear the bear. Your arms
-are strong, your legs are swift, and surely you have the
-strength of three men. You should be able to bring back
-more than is needed in your own home. Will you continue
-to lose the respect of your tribe, or will you become a
-man and take your place with the other braves of the
-tribe?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Long Moose thought carefully about each word the
-old brave had spoken.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Nantesi,&rdquo; he said after a long silence, &ldquo;let them think
-what they will. I do not fear the wagging tongues of my
-neighbors, and I do not fear the great bear of the forest.
-There is a good reason why I do not bring more home
-for my sister and myself with some left over for the tribe.
-Never have I feared the creatures of the forest. Instead,
-I have loved them much as I love my own people. That
-is why, when on the hunt, my arrows do not bring death.
-I cannot shoot these creatures who live so happily
-among the trees and streams. Is it wrong to love these
-creatures so much? Nantesi, do you not know the feeling
-I have when a deer licks my hand, or a rabbit plays at
-my feet while I rest in the shade of a great oak tree?
-These things have happened to me. The wild creatures
-trust me and come right to my hand. I cannot bring
-death upon those who trust me.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_68">68</div>
-<p>Nantesi said nothing. He understood now the feelings
-within this strange young man. He rose to leave.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Nantesi, my friend. My heart is heavy. What
-can I do? I know that what I believe is wrong in the
-eyes of many, for ours is a tribe of great hunters. What
-am I do? I must live among my people, but I cannot be
-happy unless I live my life the way I honestly believe I
-should.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Long Moose, I am an old man. Some of our tribe
-think I am wise. But this time they might not believe that
-what I say is wise. Go into the hills with your troubled
-thoughts. Think calmly in the quiet woods, far away from
-us. Only in this way can your heart give you the true
-answer that all of nature has been given to man that he
-may give food and shelter to those he loves and to himself.&rdquo;
-Then Nantesi left as quickly as he had come.</p>
-<p>The following morning, many in the tribe watched the
-lonely figure of Long Moose leaving the village, as he
-headed toward the distant hills. At last, after three weeks
-had passed, all eyes were turned toward the far end of
-the village. Entering the camp, a fine buck upon his
-shoulders, was Long Moose standing taller than ever
-before. His clothes were tattered and torn, but there was a
-proud smile on his face.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_69">69</div>
-<p>Going straight to his sister&rsquo;s house, Long Moose set
-the fat buck at his sister&rsquo;s feet without a word. Smiling,
-he put one hand on her shoulder as she stared at him in
-surprise. Many of the villagers crowded around asking
-questions, but Long Moose said nothing and looked
-over their heads for Nantesi. Then he saw the old man
-sitting contentedly before his home, looking kindly in his
-direction. Walking over to where the old brave sat, Long
-Moose asked if he could talk with him. Nantesi rose
-slowly, and greeting Long Moose warmly, invited the
-young man into his home. When both were seated, Nantesi,
-as before, waited for Long Moose to speak.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Nantesi, my friend, for a long time I have been away
-from my tribe. As you said would happen, my mind is no
-longer troubled. Up in the hills I made a campsite for
-myself. I lived on nuts and berries and plants and the cool
-water of the mountain streams. Each night I wrapped
-myself in my blanket and slept a troubled sleep.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But three nights ago, when I had finished my evening
-prayer, I rolled myself in my blanket and rested my
-head upon a soft bed of pine needles. Sleep came suddenly,
-and for the first time in three weeks I slept peacefully
-until the moon had risen high in the sky. I awoke
-with a start knowing I had the answer that you had said
-I would find in the forest.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Suddenly, I knew that I had watched the very creatures
-that I love struggle with each other for life here
-in the forests and in the fields and the streams. I had
-never thought that this was wrong. Right at this very
-moment, the struggle for life is going on in many parts
-of the forest. Before the sun brings the dawn of a new
-day, many of our forest creatures will have died because
-others must live. The strongest or the wisest live. Now I
-knew what I had hidden from myself that if some wild
-creatures did not die to provide food for others, many of
-the same animals that I love so much would die. I knew
-that I should not kill just for the sake of killing. The
-animals themselves kill only when they are hungry or
-their lives are in danger. I, too, could follow their example
-and be a good brave.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_70">70</div>
-<p>&ldquo;The truth had come to me from life itself. I sat up
-and gazed into the fire trying to decide whether I had
-been dreaming. Suddenly my heart was happy once
-again. I went back to sleep and in the morning started
-my trip back to the village. Halfway here I came upon a
-buck. My aim was good. I have brought fresh meat for
-my sister to cook and store away, and a hide for her to
-make into a new dress. I shall go out again tomorrow
-and bring back my share for the tribe.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have found the answer I had been searching for.
-Now I can return to my tribe with pride. That is my
-story, Nantesi, and I wanted to tell you first about it. It
-is good to be back. It is good to be a Powhatan.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Nantesi smiled across at his young friend. &ldquo;It is good
-to have you back. Welcome, brave!&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_71">71</div>
-<h2 id="c14"><span class="h2line1">HOW A FISHING TRIP TAUGHT LOYALTY TO A BOY</span></h2>
-<p>It was a bright morning in the village of the Iroquois.
-Maseca, the little Indian brave, awoke to the sound of
-the birds of the woodland. Today Maseca and Chincho
-were going fishing and that was always a great adventure,
-for they never knew exactly what would happen as
-they strode through the forest or out along the wild
-streams.</p>
-<p>Maseca gathered up his fishing gear and he carefully
-went over it all to see that it was in good shape. Then
-he sat down to eat some food his mother had prepared
-for him. But he was impatient to get under way. So
-he arose and, stuffing some dry deer meat into his pouch,
-started off in search of Chincho.</p>
-<p>Because Chincho was a little older than the other
-children with whom he and Maseca played, he would
-sometimes be the bully in the group. But only on rare
-occasions did he bully Maseca. Such an occasion occurred
-when he boasted to everyone that he could beat
-Maseca in a foot race. Maseca had accepted the challenge
-and had beaten the older boy quite badly. Since
-then, even though Chincho and Maseca had been close
-friends, Chincho would let jealousy get the best of him
-and thought of ways to teach Maseca a lesson for having
-beaten him in a foot race.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_72">72</div>
-<p>Sometimes Chincho even found himself wishing that
-Maseca would break his leg or suffer some other injury
-which would make him a cripple. But whenever these
-thoughts entered his mind, Chincho would drive them
-out, and dream about the many wonderful times he and
-Maseca had had together, wandering through the forests
-and fishing in the streams.</p>
-<p>On this bright morning Chincho bolted the last of his
-breakfast as he heard the hurrying footsteps of Maseca
-approaching his father&rsquo;s wigwam. Placing his deer meat
-in a leather pouch which his mother had made for him
-and gathering up his fishing gear, Chincho quickly left
-the wigwam to join Maseca and together they swiftly
-trotted off through the forest. They wanted to be the
-first ones to the stream and get the best spots for fishing.
-They did not speak as they trotted, for they knew that
-that would only shorten their wind and their speed, and
-that the other boys of the village might get there before
-them. Finally, they reached the stream and settled down
-to catch the lazy fish that swam unaware of the presence
-of the two boys.</p>
-<p>Early in the afternoon, having caught several good-sized
-fish, they decided to hang their catch in a tree and
-do a little exploring upstream. So they started out in a
-direction they had never gone before, remembering the
-warnings of the elders to walk softly and not too far
-from familiar ground, because one could get lost very
-easily in the green forest. This was especially true in the
-summer when the leaves often hid landmarks that would
-be easy to remember.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_73">73</div>
-<p>As they traveled farther and farther upstream, gazing
-at all the beauties of nature around them, Chincho
-suddenly stopped and threw himself flat on the ground
-behind a big birch tree. Maseca, not knowing the reason,
-but realizing that Chincho was not playing a game, did
-the same thing. Maseca started to speak but Chincho
-motioned for him to remain silent. Then Chincho pointed
-up ahead. About a hundred paces ahead standing in a
-little clearing taking a drink from the stream was a
-tremendous buck deer. Maseca had never seen so large
-a deer and he could not help gasping in surprise. Chincho
-turned and frowned at him and Maseca quickly stifled
-all other exclamations. Then Chincho crawled close to
-Maseca.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Maseca,&rdquo; he whispered, &ldquo;do you think we could get
-near enough to that deer to kill him? Wouldn&rsquo;t it be
-wonderful to bring that buck back to the village?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Maseca nodded that he thought it a wonderful idea
-and they agreed quickly that they would try to take the
-big deer as a prize. After making sure that the wind was
-blowing toward them, carrying their scent away from the
-deer, they began to move quietly and slowly on their
-stomachs toward the unsuspecting deer. Chincho rose to
-his knees and, fitting a new arrow to his bow, stopped
-some thirty paces short of the deer, drew back on the
-bowstring, and let the arrow fly. The boys heard the
-arrow whistle as it flew and the thud as it struck its
-target. But Chincho&rsquo;s aim had not been accurate. The
-deer bounded away, the arrow sticking in his side but not
-in a vital place.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_74">74</div>
-<p>Chincho knew that he must obey the law of his tribe
-regarding any animal a brave has wounded. He must
-track the wounded deer until he either came upon him
-dead or could get close enough to make the kill. Long
-ago the tribe had ruled wisely that it was cruel to let a
-wounded animal wander the forest in pain, possibly
-suffering so much that it would injure other animals, and
-possibly dying from loss of blood or from a sickness from
-the wound. Chincho was tempted not to follow the deer
-into the unknown woods, when he felt Maseca&rsquo;s gaze
-upon him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Chincho, you do not plan to leave without finding the
-wounded deer. It is the law of our tribe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Chincho looked guilty and said, &ldquo;It is not a bad
-wound. The arrow barely scratched him. He will be all
-right. Come, let us return to the village before it is dark.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; Maseca insisted, &ldquo;we must follow the deer until
-we bring him down. You must not leave a wounded
-animal to suffer. It is the law.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Chincho knew that Maseca was right, and yet in his
-heart he was afraid. So he tried to excuse his cowardice
-by saying, &ldquo;But it is also the law of our tribe that we
-shall not wander too far from the familiar parts of our
-land. We could become lost here in the green forest.
-We should turn back.&rdquo; As he started to turn, Chincho
-saw a challenging look in Maseca&rsquo;s eyes and he waited as
-Maseca spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You may return to the village claiming that the law
-says one should not wander too far, but I will follow the
-deer and make sure of his death. I will mark my trail
-plainly so that by night or by day I can follow it back
-to my starting place. Go, Chincho. Return to your
-father&rsquo;s home and see if you can sleep peacefully when
-you think of the deer you have wounded.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_75">75</div>
-<p>Even while he was speaking, Maseca realized that his
-friend&rsquo;s fear was very great, and that it would be a
-mistake to force Chincho to follow the buck. Maseca
-would have to worry as much about calming Chincho&rsquo;s
-fear as he would have to worry about finding the way
-back for both of them.</p>
-<p>Chincho thought that Maseca would laugh at him and
-insisted now on going with Maseca to trail the deer. So
-they started to follow the drops of blood they found on
-the plants as they went through the forest. Maseca broke
-branches and cut slices of bark from the sides of trees
-to mark the path they were taking.</p>
-<p>For awhile the big buck had run straight ahead as
-fast as he could in spite of the wound. Then the crushed
-grass showed where he had lain down to rest for a
-moment. But the grass was rising up straight again,
-which told the boys that the deer had not rested long,
-sensing the danger close by. Soon they saw fewer blood
-spots, and they knew that the blood was starting to clot.
-Now, Maseca knew the deer could live for some time yet.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It grows late,&rdquo; he warned Chincho. &ldquo;We must hurry
-if we are to catch up with the deer and claim our kill.
-We have only a short while left before the sun will sink.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Just at that moment Chincho saw something off to the
-side of the trail, lying half-hidden in the brush. It was
-brown. As Chincho looked more closely, he saw it
-moving rhythmically as an animal does in breathing.
-He touched Maseca lightly on the shoulder and pointed
-toward the brush. They both realized that this must be
-the wounded buck. Just as they were trying to decide
-what to do, the deer made up their minds for them. With
-a bellow, he leaped from his hiding place and headed
-straight for Chincho. Chincho stood rooted to the spot
-with fright. His eyes bulged as he saw the huge beast,
-his antlers held low in attack, bearing down upon him.
-Maseca raised his bow, and with all the courage and
-calmness he could muster, drew back and let go the
-string. As his arrow whished straight toward the onrushing
-buck, Maseca knew that his aim had been straight.
-As the arrow struck, the deer leaped into the air toward
-Chincho. The buck&rsquo;s action was so quick that Chincho
-failed to move in time. As it fell, one of its antlers cut
-deeply into Chincho&rsquo;s leg. The boy gasped in pain and
-slumped to the ground, next to the dead buck.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_76">76</div>
-<p>Maseca ran quickly to his side and held his head in his
-arms. Then he looked down at the nasty wound in
-Chincho&rsquo;s leg and saw the blood pouring out. Hurriedly,
-he gathered some large leaves, wet them in a nearby
-stream, and placed them against the wound. Then he
-pulled a leather thong from his leggings and used it to
-bind the leaves in place. When he saw that the wound
-had nearly stopped bleeding, he spoke quietly to Chincho.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I must go for help, Chincho. You must lie still and
-quiet until I return.&rdquo; With that Maseca pulled up all the
-strength that was left in his tired body and started running
-at top speed along the trail he had marked.</p>
-<p>As the sun sank behind the hills of the quiet valley,
-Chincho prayed that Maseca would hurry. The pain was
-getting worse and, though the blood had stopped flowing
-from the wound, Chincho was beginning to lose strength.
-Suddenly, from down the trail, the boy heard the voices
-of many braves. Then he heard his father shouting his
-name.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Over here! Over here!&rdquo; Chincho called weakly. His
-father ran to him and knelt at his son&rsquo;s side. Soon
-Chincho was surrounded by many of the older braves
-who looked first at him and then at the dead buck. He
-searched among the faces for that of his friend.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Where is Maseca?&rdquo; he asked his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_77">77</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Back in the village resting, my son,&rdquo; his father said
-softly. &ldquo;You see, Maseca ran so fast through the forest
-to seek help for you that he caught his foot in a root and
-twisted his leg badly. He wouldn&rsquo;t stop even though he
-was barely able to hobble into camp. He had just enough
-strength left to tell us where you were before he fainted.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Chincho began to feel very guilty about the many
-times he had hoped that Maseca would be injured some
-day just because Maseca had beaten him in the foot race.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He will be well again soon, won&rsquo;t he, father? He will
-be able to run as fast as before?&rdquo; His father smiled down
-at Chincho.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Is that what you want, my son?&rdquo; he asked.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, yes, father. He must be well again. Because he
-won the foot race fairly, I have often wished that he
-would be hurt. Now that it has really happened, I am
-sorry. I will never wish harm for any friend again. Only
-then will I be a true son to my father and a true Iroquois
-brave.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>While Chincho and his father were talking, the other
-braves cut two saplings and tied branches across them to
-make a stretcher to carry the boy. Chincho&rsquo;s father held
-his son&rsquo;s hand as the other braves lifted the boy onto the
-stretcher.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You have spoken wisely, my son. Do not worry.
-Maseca will soon be well enough to race and hunt and
-fish again with you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Chincho smiled up at his father and turned his head
-to look proudly at the large buck that two braves were
-carrying, hung by its feet from a sapling stretched across
-their shoulders.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_78">78</div>
-<p>The next night there was a special council fire. Two
-young braves were lying on stretchers, side by side, at
-the place of honor. At their sides, stood their fathers.
-Then the Chief told the tribe about the bravery and
-hunting skill and strength of these two boys. &ldquo;They will
-be great braves, worthy of the Iroquois nation,&rdquo; he said
-solemnly.</p>
-<p>Chincho&rsquo;s and Maseca&rsquo;s fathers glanced proudly down
-at their sons.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_79">79</div>
-<h2 id="c15"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE BEAR&rsquo;S FIRST HUNT</span></h2>
-<p>Little Bear opened his eyes and looked around his
-wickiup home. As the sleep left his eyes, he noticed that
-his father&rsquo;s bed was empty and that he was alone. Quickly
-he threw off his buffalo robe and ran to the door of the
-wickiup. Pushing aside the deerskin he looked out into
-the small Apache camp.</p>
-<p>There was quite a bit of activity. Everyone was hurrying
-about. Although it was still very early, the cooking
-fires were burning brightly, and the women of the tribe
-were busy preparing a hot meal. Then he remembered
-that today was the day of the big hunt.</p>
-<p>Little Bear ran quickly through the village searching
-for his father, Swift Eagle. Finally after asking several of
-his friends, he was told that his father could probably be
-found at the corral. Soon he saw his father looking over
-the horses. Swift Eagle was telling young braves which
-horses to select for his use on the hunt.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Father,&rdquo; called Little Bear, &ldquo;why did you not waken
-me when the dawn came? There has been much excitement
-since the sun first broke through the night, but you
-did not wake me.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_80">80</div>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, I wanted you to rest, for today is the day of
-the big hunt. Soon the warriors will be gathering and
-we will be ready to leave for the feeding grounds of the
-great buffalo. Now I must check the horses, for we must
-take only the young and the strong. This will be a long
-and hard Journey.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Bear suddenly realized that this was to be a real
-test for him. When a young Apache is considered a
-young brave, he is taken on his first big buffalo hunt
-along with the older warriors of the tribe. He must prove
-himself worthy of being called a hunter. Little Bear had
-waited a long time for this great day. He felt his heart
-beating a little faster than usual and he was filled with
-excitement and a little fear. Little Bear&rsquo;s fear left when
-his father placed his hand upon his son&rsquo;s shoulder and
-said, &ldquo;Be not afraid, my son, for you were born an
-Apache and Apaches fear nothing. You will make a great
-hunter, and a true Apache.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Together they walked back to their wickiup where
-Little Bear&rsquo;s mother had prepared a fine breakfast. When
-they had all eaten, they heard that the hunting party
-was beginning to form. Soon all was in readiness, and
-the great hunting party rode out from the village. The
-scouts had reported that a rather large herd of buffalo
-had stopped to graze only half a day&rsquo;s ride from their
-camp. So it was for this herd that the hunting party had
-made its plans.</p>
-<p>As they rode along, Little Bear began to think of how
-he would make his first kill of buffalo, the largest of the
-wild game hunted by the Apaches. Little Bear had
-hunted before but only for rabbits and other small game.
-This was to be his day of triumph, and he was excited.
-Soon the caravan of hunters halted to rest and replenish
-their water supply from a spring near by. The scouts were
-sent ahead once again to see if the herd had shifted
-position.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_81">81</div>
-<p>As Swift Eagle and his son sat by the cool spring,
-Little Bear stared toward the horizon hoping to be the
-first of the party to see the returning scouts. His father
-had been watching him with a kindly eye, and said, &ldquo;Do
-not be too eager, my son. When excitement grows within
-the body, the hand becomes unsteady. You must control
-our body and your mind, or you will find that your aim
-will not be true. Your arrow, instead of striking its mark,
-will do nothing but chew up the dust of the prairie.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Bear listened quietly to his father; as so many
-times before, he realized the wisdom in his father&rsquo;s words.</p>
-<p>There was little conversation for a while, until the
-scouts returned to report that the herd had not moved
-and that a short ride would bring the party to within
-striking distance. The hunting party moved on until the
-signal was passed that the herd was just over the next
-rise. Instructions were given and the party quickly spread
-out into an attacking formation, each brave hoping to
-have the best spot to ride down the buffalo herd. As
-soon as everyone was in position, they waited for the next
-signal of the leader.</p>
-<p>Little Bear could feel the excitement mounting in his
-body and, remembering the words of his father, fought
-off the tenseness that was filling his arms and legs. The
-rise in front of him, which separated the hunting party
-from the herd, seemed to be very far away. Just as Little
-Bear felt he could not control his pony or himself any
-longer, the signal was given. The braves, with shouts
-rising from their throats, raced over the rise. Soon there
-was a mixture of running, frightened buffalo, and riding,
-yelling warrior hunters, and clouds of dust that rose from
-the hundreds of hoofs churning the prairie.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_82">82</div>
-<p>Little Bear drew an arrow from his quiver. Following
-the patient teaching of his father, he calmly placed the
-arrow to the bow string. Leaning forward on the neck of
-his pony, holding tight with his knees pressed against his
-pony&rsquo;s sides, he peered into the dust and quickly spotted
-his quarry. A large bull buffalo was lumbering along a
-little wide of the herd. Carefully taking aim, Little Bear
-let go his arrow. The last thing he saw before the dust
-welled up again to block his sight was his arrow protruding
-from the side of a stumbling buffalo.</p>
-<p>Little Bear swerved his pony rapidly away from the
-herd. When the pony was able to check his forward
-speed, pony and rider withdrew to the side of the battleground
-to watch the rest of the hunt in safety. As the
-herd disappeared across the prairie, the members of the
-hunting party turned their horses and began the ride back
-to where the herd had been grazing. When the dust had
-cleared, Little Bear saw scattered across the prairie the
-bodies of many buffalo which had fallen before the
-accurate shooting of the hunters. Each brave would be
-able to tell his kill, for each arrow bore the mark of its
-owner.</p>
-<p>Little Bear galloped toward the spot where he thought
-his buffalo had fallen. While he rode, his heart beat very
-fast. He tried to show little excitement as he drew near
-to a group of hunters who stood looking down at an
-object upon the ground. As Little Bear drew close, he
-slowed his pony. His father turned and smiled. Dismounting,
-Little Bear walked to his father&rsquo;s side. Lying on the
-ground at the feet of the older braves was a bull buffalo
-of tremendous size. And there was the arrow of Little
-Bear exactly where the arrow of a good hunter should be.
-He had hit the buffalo in a vital spot.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_83">83</div>
-<p>Swift Eagle placed his arm across the shoulders of his
-son. Amid the many grunts and exclamations of approval
-coming from the warrior hunters, Little Bear heard the
-deep calm, proud voice of his father.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You have done well, my son. This is a fine buffalo,
-one which we are sure will prove to be the largest one
-killed this day. The many hours spent in teaching you
-were not wasted. This you have proven today. You will
-return to our village a hero and tell of your exploits at
-the council tonight. No longer will you have to stay
-behind when the hunters go in search of food. Today
-you have become a hunter and earned the right to ride
-with the hunting party. Your father is proud.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And so the procession, after attending the buffalo and
-stripping the hides and packing the fresh meat for the
-return trek, headed for home. At the front of the party
-rode Swift Eagle and Little Bear, a proud father and an
-even prouder son. Today the young brave had succeeded
-in his first hunt.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_84">84</div>
-<h2 id="c16"><span class="h2line1">CRYING EAGLE SEES A GREAT BATTLE</span></h2>
-<p>It was a dark winter evening in the small Iroquois
-village. The cries of the wolf echoed in the forest as
-Great Eagle, war leader of the Iroquois, was preparing
-for bed. He stopped to take a last look for the night at
-his young son, Crying Eagle, and smiled at his boy who
-slept so peacefully. As he pulled the warm robe up
-around his son&rsquo;s neck to keep the cold from seeping in
-and disturbing his sleep, he thought to himself,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;How lucky I am to have been blessed with such a
-son. Truly, he will be a leader among his people. Not
-because he is the son of Great Eagle, war chief of the
-Iroquois, but because he will be tall and strong and brave
-and will learn well the ways of the tribe. Soon he will be
-ready to be a leader and when that day comes, I will
-be proud to stand forth and say, &lsquo;This is my son.&rsquo;&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Great Eagle slept warm and soundly that night and
-arose with the dawn of the next day. Today his son was
-to go on a trek with him to learn the ways of the wild
-game in winter time.</p>
-<p>Great Eagle moved to his son&rsquo;s bed and called softly
-to him, &ldquo;Come, my son, for we have a long way to travel
-and much to do today.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_85">85</div>
-<p>Crying Eagle got up quickly, put on his warm winter
-clothes, and sat with his father at breakfast. As soon as
-breakfast was over, they gathered their weapons and left
-the protection of the Iroquois village and headed toward
-the forest. As they walked along the trail, Great Eagle
-pointed out different signs. Here the snow had been
-scraped by a deer nosing for anything green under the
-snow. There was a squirrel nest bulging with its store of
-winter food. And everywhere there were the tracks of
-many wolves. This had been a hard winter, and the
-hungry wolves were moving in packs to seek out easy
-prey. Many animals would not find enough food to keep
-them at full strength. Unless one were very careful,
-escape from an attack by these forest marauders would
-be impossible.</p>
-<p>Crying Eagle began to get tired and his father motioned
-toward a small glen in the forest off to the side
-of the trail. There were some fallen logs upon which
-they could sit and have their lunch of jerked venison and
-water. As they sat eating slowly, Great Eagle watched
-the forest around them for any signs of game. But all was
-quiet except for the singing of the few winter birds that
-lived there, even in the coldest weather. Suddenly, they
-heard the crackling of some dry timber in the distance
-and Great Eagle raised his head.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;A buck leaping through the brush,&rdquo; he said.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;How can you tell, father?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Listen, my son! You will discover that there is a
-moment of silence between each crackling of brush. That
-tells you that whatever makes the noise is leaping, and
-the heavy crashing of brush tells you that the animal is
-large. Because it leaps, you know it is not a bear. So we
-can be almost sure that it is a buck.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_86">86</div>
-<p>Just as Great Eagle stopped speaking, they saw a large
-buck moving in long leaps among the brush and small
-trees. Suddenly, he stopped and sniffed the air. Great
-Eagle and his son stood perfectly still. The buck looked
-directly toward them. The breeze was blowing toward
-the buck and he had caught their scent. Crying Eagle
-raised his bow but felt his father&rsquo;s hand upon his shoulder.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, my son. The buck is truly beautiful. But our
-wigwam is full of venison, and we have enough fine
-clothes to last for a long time. We do not kill the forest
-animals unless we really need to. Truly, I know how
-much you want to make a kill and tell your friends of
-the fine buck your steady hand brought down, but that
-must wait for another day. We are here to learn the way
-animals live during the winter, so that when you must
-hunt for your family, you will find it easy.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The buck seemed to wait for Great Eagle to speak
-with his son. Then he leaped away through the forest.
-Great Eagle and his son spent the rest of the afternoon
-studying other signs of wild life. As the sun began to
-sink low in the west, Great Eagle turned and started on
-the trail for home. After they had gone a ways, Great
-Eagle halted and motioned for his son to be still. Together
-the two Indians crouched low and Great Eagle
-pointed through the trees. There, only three hundred
-paces away in a clearing, stood a large buck. Off to the
-right of the buck stood a beautiful brown doe and further
-on through the trees was another buck, moving slowly
-forward through the trees.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why do we stop, father?&rdquo; asked Crying Eagle, still
-crouching low in the snow.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_87">87</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Because, son, I believe that we are about to see
-something very rarely seen by humans. The buck in the
-clearing is standing guard over his bride, the doe on our
-right. The buck coming through the trees is young and
-wants the doe, too. So he is challenging the old buck to
-a duel. The winner will get the doe. In a moment they
-will face each other in the clearing. They will meet head
-on and the battle will be on. The buck that gives up first
-and turns from the battle will be the loser, and the other
-will claim his bride.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Soon, as Great Eagle had said, the younger buck
-entered the clearing. The two faced each other, the
-younger pawing at the ground while the older stood
-surveying this young challenger of his right to the doe,
-who lay watching them calmly from the brush to the side
-of the clearing. Then the two bucks began to circle. They
-stopped and almost at once the young one charged. The
-older buck met the attack head on and there was a loud
-crash as their antlers met and locked. They pushed and
-pulled and wrenched until suddenly their antlers were
-free. They were almost equally matched, for even though
-the younger buck seemed faster, the older was a veteran
-of many such battles and knew more tricks in fighting.</p>
-<p>Again they locked horns but unlocked quickly this
-time. Then the older buck&rsquo;s antlers slashed into the side
-of the young buck. Back and forth the battle waged and
-then, as suddenly as it had started, it was over. The young
-buck had had enough. He tossed his head into the air
-and leaped off into the forest, to lick his wounds and wait
-for another doe. The old buck walked with what looked
-like pride to his doe. She rose to her feet and, side by
-side, they began pushing their noses into the snow to
-smell out food.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_88">88</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Come,&rdquo; said Great Eagle, &ldquo;let us leave them in peace.
-You have seen one of the great events in the life of wild
-animals. Remember it well for you may be called upon
-to defend the persons and things you love, even when
-you think the enemy is stronger. Remember how strength
-alone is not enough. You must know how to fight well
-in order to win.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Crying Eagle was thinking about each word his father
-had spoken as they headed home. They moved rapidly
-because they wanted to reach the village before dark.
-Soon through the trees they could see the flickering of
-many campfires. In a few moments they were in the camp
-and at home. A hot meal of stew was waiting for them,
-and father and son ate heartily. When they had finished,
-Crying Eagle spoke to his father.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My father, you opened my eyes today to many new
-things. I hope that I have learned my lesson well and will
-always obey your teaching.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Crying Eagle kept his promise well. Some years later
-there was trouble between his village and the neighboring
-tribes. While the young bucks shouted for blood and the
-scalps of their neighbors, Crying Eagle called for peace
-and talk. Like his father in battle, he was a brave warrior,
-but where talk around the council fire could save lives,
-Crying Eagle was a great leader and peacemaker.</p>
-<p>Crying Eagle lived to a very old age, but he never
-forgot that walk through the winter forest with his father
-Chief Great Eagle, war chief of the mighty Iroquois.</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>Based on a story told to the author by John Fitch, Vermont
-farmer, 1937.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_89">89</div>
-<h2 id="c17"><span class="h2line1">SPOTTED TAIL AND THE GHOST WOLF</span></h2>
-<p>The Mohawk village of bark houses nestled along the
-river, and all was peace and contentment in the village.
-Spotted Tail and his family lived in peace and contentment
-in the village, for they were a happy people. The
-hunting and fishing were good and there was little sickness
-among the people of his tribe and all was made so
-that the people would be happy.</p>
-<p>When young Spotted Tail had reached his fifteenth
-summer, something happened to his tribe. Suddenly the
-game of the forest became scarce. The deer began to
-disappear and even the smallest of game was becoming
-hard to find. This concerned the council, for never before
-had this happened to their hunting grounds. And then
-one day while the warriors were busy preparing to go out
-on the hunt, a young Mohawk warrior staggered into the
-camp. Blood dripped from his body and as he reached
-the center of the village he collapsed.</p>
-<p>Eager hands lifted him and carried him to his house
-and when his wounds had been bathed the great chief of
-the Mohawks came to talk with him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What has happened to you, my brother? Surely this
-is the work of some great savage beast that you have
-encountered in the green forest.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_90">90</div>
-<p>&ldquo;O Great Chief, my companion and I had been following
-the tracks of a deer and feeling we were quite lucky
-to have come upon such a find. Suddenly as we trotted
-along the trail following the deer there was a horrible
-snarling from off to the side of the trail. We stopped and
-looked toward the side of the trail, and there before our
-very eyes was a pack of ferocious-looking wolves. Before
-we could even draw our bowstrings they were upon us.
-My companion and I fought them, but soon they had
-dragged my companion to the ground. They began to
-fight among themselves over one of their wounded comrades,
-and it was then that I crawled off into the brush
-and when I saw my chance I ran as fast as I could
-toward our village. I could hear the snarls of the pack
-behind me but I ran as fast as my legs could carry me
-and soon I heard them no more. But one thing I will
-always remember is the leader of the pack, a white wolf
-of tremendous size. He had a beautiful white coat and
-was much larger than the rest of the pack. I am tired, I
-must rest now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And with that the warrior closed his eyes and slept.</p>
-<p>The chief immediately called a council of his warriors
-and among them was Spotted Tail&rsquo;s father. Now the
-reason for the lack of game was known. The winter
-further north had been very severe and so the wolf pack
-had come further south seeking food. But now that they
-had been roaming so free for so long they decided to stay.</p>
-<p>The chief rose before the council and said:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We must set out on the hunt immediately, but we
-must hunt this pack of wolves and destroy them before
-they cause all the deer to disappear. If we fail, our smoke
-racks will become empty and our people will starve.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_91">91</div>
-<p>So party after party of warriors were sent out in
-search of the wolf pack, but they always returned disappointed;
-for they had often come upon the pack but never
-had been able to get close enough to do any real damage.</p>
-<p>Finally Sleeping Water, one of the young warriors,
-Suggested that instead of going in large parties they ought
-to go out in pairs or three at a time and when sighting
-the pack send word to a larger hunting party and they
-in turn could surround and destroy the pack.</p>
-<p>The council approved of this method and so the
-warriors began to go out in pairs. It was now that Spotted
-Tail began his adventure which was to be spoken of in the
-lodges for many moons to come.</p>
-<p>Spotted Tail was chosen by Sleeping Water to go as
-his companion, and the two braves started on the hunt.
-They ranged far and wide and finally picked up the trail
-of the pack. Sleeping Water knelt by the tracks of the
-wolves and could tell that they were fairly fresh tracks.</p>
-<p>Quickly the two braves trotted along the trail in
-pursuit of the pack and soon through the trees ahead
-Sleeping Water spotted the pack moving stealthily
-through the trees as if stalking an animal. Turning to
-Spotted Tail he said, &ldquo;Spotted Tail, you will keep the
-pack in sight and follow them as they move, marking
-your trail. I will return and fetch a large hunting party
-and we shall destroy this pack of wolves. You are not
-afraid to keep watch?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Spotted Tail felt it a great honor to be asked to do
-such an important job and he told Sleeping Water that
-he would keep close watch on the pack and if he moved
-he would mark his trail well.</p>
-<p>When Sleeping Water departed, Spotted Tail kept close
-watch on the pack as it milled around. Evidently the
-hunt they were on was ended, for many of the wolves
-were circling in the snow and finding resting places.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_92">92</div>
-<p>It was fast growing dark and Spotted Tail hoped that
-they would not decide to move in the dark or he would
-surely lose them before the dawn. Then he saw him&mdash;the
-giant white leader of the pack&mdash;standing off to one
-side of the pack as if on guard. He was truly a majestic
-animal, fully half a foot taller at the shoulder than the
-other wolves and his coat was a shimmering white as
-pure as the snow.</p>
-<p>As night settled, a bright moon came out and the
-night was shattered by the baying of the wolves at the
-moon.</p>
-<p>On a rock pinnacle overlooking the wolves&rsquo; bedding
-ground, the great white leader stood guard, his eyes never
-still, moving from side to side as he watched for any
-approaching danger. Spotted Tail remained awake as
-long as he could, but soon his eyes felt very tired. He was
-about to drop off to sleep when he noticed the pack
-stirring. He gazed out into the shadows of the night and
-the leader seemed to be staring right through the brush
-and trees into Spotted Tail&rsquo;s hiding place.</p>
-<p>Then Spotted Tail saw the reason for the movement:
-a deer had wandered to within a short distance of the
-wolves, and now the pack was preparing to kill this
-unsuspecting victim.</p>
-<p>The leader seemed to bark instructions and suddenly
-the pack was up and circling the deer. There was a mad
-rush and suddenly the excitement was over, the booty
-was shared, and the pack settled down once again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_93">93</div>
-<p>Spotted Tail breathed a sigh of relief, for the pack in
-chasing the deer had come too close for comfort to his
-hiding place in the thick brush. Dawn was fast approaching,
-and now the pack was on the move once again.
-Spotted Tail followed as close as he dared, making sure
-that he kept downwind from these lean hungry wolves
-that had caused death and starvation to come to his
-People. Then he got an idea.</p>
-<p>If he could get a good shot in and wound or even
-kill the leader, it might have the same effect as if a chief
-died, the pack would be without a leader and might be
-so disorganized that the hunters from his tribe, who he
-was sure were fast approaching, would be able to make
-easy work of the rest of the pack.</p>
-<p>Then the opportunity came his way. There standing
-off to the side of the pack was the large white leader.
-Spotted Tail settled himself upon one knee in the snow
-and drawing careful aim with his bow, he let fly. The
-arrow seemed to go right through the great beast and he
-leaped high in the air. Spotted Tail was about to shout
-of his great shot to the heavens when he saw that the
-wolf had come to rest on all fours and was turned now
-in his direction, his teeth bared and a terrible snarl coming
-from deep within his throat.</p>
-<p>Gathered behind the great white wolf like an army,
-was the rest of the pack, snarling and waiting for the
-orders from their leader, but the leader seemed to warn
-them away&mdash;this was his kill&mdash;and slowly began moving
-toward Spotted Tail.</p>
-<p>Spotted Tail stood firm and placed another arrow to
-his bowstring. He fired again, and the arrow again
-seemed to go straight to its mark but still the beast kept
-moving forward. Now the wolf began to run in a steady
-loping trot toward the Indian and suddenly he was
-leaping.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_94">94</div>
-<p>Spotted Tail drew his knife, but in mid-air the wolf
-seemed to stop and try to turn and return from whence
-he had come, and then the body was crashing to the
-ground, an arrow quivering in his side. Then there were
-howls and yells and cries from many points of the forest
-and arrows came flying into the wolf pack. Beast after
-beast fell under the onslaught of deadly shafts being fired
-by revenge-seeking Mohawk warriors until suddenly the
-whole pack lay dead in the quiet of the winter forest.</p>
-<p>It all happened so quickly that before Spotted Tail
-realized what had happened, Sleeping Water was lifting
-him from the snow smiling.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You have done well, my young brother, you have
-been brave this day. You left very clear signs for our
-party to follow and because of that we were able to wipe
-out this pack of beasts which have killed so much game.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But the leader of the pack&mdash;I fired an arrow into him
-and it went right through him. Twice I saw this happen.
-He must have been a ghost and yet I saw his body hit
-the ground with the arrows of my brothers. How do you
-explain this, Sleeping Water?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, Spotted Tail, I will show you.&rdquo; Together they
-walked to where the great beast lay.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You see, his coat was such a pure white that it
-blended with the snow and when you fired it seemed as
-though you hit him but actually you missed. It is no
-shame, for it was a long and a difficult shot and when you
-fired a second time as he was moving toward you, the sun
-on the snow caused reflection to make you misjudge your
-shot.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_95">95</div>
-<p>&ldquo;We observed all this from our hiding places, for we
-came upon you just as you were preparing to make your
-first shot. But, please, Spotted Tail, do not take a chance
-like that again. It is very foolish to try something so
-dangerous when you are alone and especially when you
-knew that help was on the way. But this adventure has
-ended well, and you will have much to tell in the medicine
-lodge tonight, of the great ghost wolf that hunted these
-lands.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And so the pack was destroyed and soon the game
-returned once again to the hunting ground of the Mohawk
-and once again all was peaceful and happy along
-the Osage River.</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>This story was told to the author by Jim Nutley of the Canadian
-Forest Ranger Service.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_97">97</div>
-<h2><span class="h2line1">3. CUSTOMS</span></h2>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_99">99</div>
-<h2 id="c18"><span class="h2line1">THE TRIBES GATHER</span></h2>
-<p>The Cree were plains Indians. Today their village was
-full of activity. A hunting party had just returned after
-a very successful hunt. The braves were already around
-the great council fire, telling of their exploits. Among
-these warriors was Slow Tongue, whose bravery and
-courage among the Cree was never questioned.</p>
-<p>When all the celebrating was over, Slow Tongue returned
-to his tepee and his family. His young son, Swift
-Hawk, had waited up for him and, with pride in his eyes,
-he looked up into his father&rsquo;s face and said, &ldquo;I am very
-proud to have you for my father.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My young son, it is long past your bedtime and you
-should have closed your ears to the night noises of the
-prairie many hours ago. But I must also say that I am
-proud to have you as a son and tomorrow we shall talk
-and I shall tell you all about the hunt.&rdquo; Slow Tongue
-turned to leave his son&rsquo;s side when he heard a noise at
-the entrance of his tepee.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Slow Tongue,&rdquo; a voice called quietly, &ldquo;it is I, Seeing
-Bear. Come, I must speak with you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Slow Tongue left the tepee. &ldquo;Why do you call me from
-my tepee so late in the night, Sleeping Bear,&rdquo; he asked.
-&ldquo;I am tired and my buffalo robe beckons to me to come
-and wrap myself in its warm folds, for my body aches.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_100">100</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Look, Slow Tongue! Look to the north! At first I
-thought the heat of the day had made me see things that
-do not exist. But now I am sure it has not. Look and tell
-me what you see.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Slow Tongue turned his head to the north and gazed
-out into the darkness of the night. Far in the distance he
-saw a red glow which disappeared, appeared again, and
-disappeared many times.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What can it mean, Slow Tongue?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It is a message, Seeing Bear. The fire signal tells that
-the tribes of the plains are gathering for the Sun Dance.
-Truly this is great news. Tomorrow we must break camp
-and leave for the northern meadow of the Blue Star, for
-it is there that the great celebrations will be held. You go
-to the southern part of the village and I will go to the
-northern part, and we will spread the word. It is late and
-many are asleep, but surely this is news for which they
-will be glad to be awakened.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The next morning there was great excitement in the
-Cree village. The gathering for the Sun Dance not only
-meant gathering to celebrate the greatest religious ceremony
-of the plains Indians, but it also meant that it
-would be a time for great feasts, mock battles, ceremonial
-hunts, and the recounting of the past year&rsquo;s experience
-with many old friends. And, of course, the men looked
-forward to smoking the ceremonial pipes which was also
-a part of this great occasion.</p>
-<p>The tribe had soon broken down its village and packed
-and the great procession headed north toward the
-meadow of the Blue Star.</p>
-<p>For two days and two nights the Cree village moved
-northward. Their progress was slow but steady, and there
-was much gaiety. There was much to look forward to,
-and many of the younger braves could hardly be kept
-from rushing on ahead of the tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_101">101</div>
-<p>Soon other tribes began to join the Cree in their trek
-north. In all directions smoke signals could be seen, sent
-up by eager messengers reporting the movements of the
-tribes as they converged on the sacred grounds.</p>
-<p>It was very clear to Swift Hawk now that friend and
-enemy were walking side by side. This was one time
-during the year when the burning desire to strike out at
-your enemy was replaced by a stronger desire to do worship
-together in the hope of a good year to come.</p>
-<p>Soon the meadow of the Blue Star was reached, and
-the tribe of Swift Hawk chose a place to set its village in
-the great circle with the tribe&rsquo;s sacred tepee as its center.
-Campfires began to burn merrily, and the smell of cooking
-food filled the air. Old and young warriors walked
-about to renew old acquaintances and talk about what
-had happened during the past year. Dancers could be
-seen here and there practicing seriously for the time of the
-great ceremony.</p>
-<p>Soon word spread through the encampment that there
-were to be riding contests at the far west side of the
-meadow on the following day. These contests would be
-open to young braves who had made their first buffalo
-kill during the last year. This made Swift Hawk leap and
-shout for joy. Just last month he had brought down his
-first buffalo. This meant he could enter the riding contest.
-For many years now Swift Hawk had watched the contests
-from afar. Each year he promised himself that next
-year he would enter and win. Each year his father told
-him to be patient and that his time would come.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_102">102</div>
-<p>It was a very difficult contest to test the skills of the
-young warriors. Each boy was to start his ride from the
-top of a hill that sloped sharply down into the meadow.
-At every one-hundred-yard point along a twisting path
-down the steep slope, for a distance of five hundred yards,
-were four sets of poles, two poles to each set. Each set
-was driven in the ground a buffalo&rsquo;s length apart until
-they stood between four and five feet above ground. Between
-these two poles a buffalo hide was stretched to look
-like a buffalo running directly toward the sloping path,
-his flank toward the young warriors as they rode down.</p>
-<p>Each young brave was allowed a bow of his choice,
-four arrows, and a quiver. The brave, when given the
-signal to go, would race down the slope at full speed.
-Drawing an arrow from the quiver and bending his body
-down under the neck of his pony and holding on with
-his feet, he would aim his arrow under the neck of the
-pony and shoot the arrow into the buffalo hide. He would
-do this with each of the four arrows.</p>
-<p>Such a contest would surely test the strength and
-courage of any young brave. But young Indians were
-brought up to fear little and to welcome a test like this.
-For this reason it was no surprise to the great chieftains
-when a rather large group of young braves gathered at the
-starting point the next morning. Each boy sat astride a
-fine looking pony, usually the gift of his father or some
-other leading member of the tribe. Each boy had his bow,
-his quiver, and four very special arrows which had been
-worked over and cared for like a pet or one of the family.</p>
-<p>Final instructions were given to the young braves, and
-the riding contest was on! There was a great cheer from
-all who were watching as each rider left the starting point.
-This was a friendly match among boys from many tribes
-that often fought each other the rest of the year. Down
-the steep slope a lone warrior could be seen stationed at
-each buffalo hide. Here he could not only retrieve arrows
-but help to judge the young braves as they rode by and
-fired at the target.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_103">103</div>
-<p>Soon it was Swift Hawk&rsquo;s turn. Remembering all that
-his father had taught him, he dug his heels into his pony&rsquo;s
-sides and started his fast and dangerous ride. Carefully he
-drew an arrow from the quiver; then bending under the
-pony&rsquo;s neck, he placed the arrow to the bow, and as the
-target came into view, Swift Hawk let his arrow fly! He
-heard the plunk as the arrow struck the hide. With his
-head still under the pony&rsquo;s neck and riding so hard, he
-could hardly have seen where it had landed. But a loud
-cheer told him that he had made a good shot. Down the
-steep, winding course, Swift Hawk swiftly shot his arrows
-at the three other targets, and went back toward the
-starting point.</p>
-<p>As he reached the hilltop he heard a great shout go up.
-Looking down the course he saw a young Crow brave
-just turning his pony to return to the starting point. The
-loud cheer meant that he had ridden well and made many
-good hits.</p>
-<p>One by one each of the other young braves made his
-attempt but none could equal the riding and skill of the
-young Crow Indian. And so it was when the last contestant
-had made his ride and fired no better than the
-rest that the Crow brave was announced as the winner.
-Swift Hawk was one of the first to reach his side and congratulate
-him on his victory. Deep in his heart, Swift
-Hawk was sad. But he was also very happy for this young
-brave. Surely the young man had deserved to win; and,
-above all, Swift Hawk realized how happy the young
-brave and his family must be that he had won.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_104">104</div>
-<p>The contest over, Swift Hawk returned to his home
-and his father, disappointed but not unhappy now. There
-would be other contests, and this was a time of celebration
-and joy. His father found him sitting beside a tree
-stump.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You did very well, my son,&rdquo; Slow Tongue said,
-placing his hands upon Swift Hawk&rsquo;s shoulders. &ldquo;The
-Crow boy who won did just a little bit better, but all the
-Cree are proud of you. There will be other contests and
-many games. Soon your turn will come. But even if it
-should not, remember what I have told you. As long as
-you play fair with your fellow braves and obey the rules,
-there is nothing to be ashamed of when you lose to someone
-who plays fair and has great skill.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Thank you, father, I shall always remember that.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Games and new contests were beginning. Just as Swift
-Hawk&rsquo;s father had told him, his time would come and
-sooner than he expected. In the foot race he ran much
-faster than any of his fellow braves, winning easily.
-Swift Hawk was as good a winner as he had been a good
-loser, boasting to no one about his victory.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_105">105</div>
-<h2 id="c19"><span class="h2line1">SINGING EAGLE&rsquo;S FIRST CLOTHES</span></h2>
-<p>The Huron tribe were a rather typical tribe of the
-Eastern woodlands. They were a hunting and fishing
-tribe, and when their villages were built they were built
-to last for a long time.</p>
-<p>In this particular village of the Hurons, there lived a
-young boy by the name of Singing Eagle. Now as was
-the custom among most of the tribes of that area, a young
-Indian child did not own any clothes at all until he
-reached the age of ten.</p>
-<p>This particular day was to be a great one for Singing
-Eagle, but when he woke that late summer morning, it
-was just another day for him.</p>
-<p>After eating his breakfast, he dashed away to play with
-the other children. Meanwhile back at the wigwam, Singing
-Eagle&rsquo;s mother, Early Dawn, was very busy indeed.
-For many days and nights she had been working quite
-hard making Singing Eagle his first real set of clothing.</p>
-<p>Singing Eagle&rsquo;s father had hunted the big brown buck
-early last spring and his long chase had finally been rewarded,
-when he was able to shoot and kill a very fine
-large buck. Carefully skinning the buck, he had returned
-both the skin and the meat to his wigwam, where his wife
-immediately set to work tanning the skin in preparation
-for making it into a winter outfit for young Singing
-Eagle.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_106">106</div>
-<p>When the skin had been carefully tanned, Singing
-Eagle&rsquo;s mother had fashioned from it a pair of leggings.
-The leggings of the woodland Indian were made in
-matched pairs. They covered the whole leg and fitted
-rather snugly and were held up with a thong fastened to
-the waistbelt. The buckskin was sewn together with
-threads of sinew.</p>
-<p>The shirt, which Singing Eagle&rsquo;s mother was so proud
-of, had long sleeves and would reach to Singing Eagle&rsquo;s
-knees, but above all the shirt was beautifully decorated
-with painted pictures. When Singing Eagle grew up, the
-paintings would be upon his future shirts and beadwork
-would also be added. The shirt was of buckskin.</p>
-<p>Finally Singing Eagle&rsquo;s mother proudly held up, for her
-husband to see, the beautiful moccasins. The moccasins
-of the woodland Indian were fashioned from one piece of
-skin and were soft-soled and often these too were decorated
-with beadwork. Here Singing Eagle&rsquo;s mother had
-decided not to wait until her son grew any more, but had
-put a beautiful beaded design on the toe of each moccasin.
-This was to be a truly wonderful day.</p>
-<p>After lunch, Singing Eagle lay down to rest, for he
-had been playing very hard that morning with the other
-children. When he awoke, he looked around and his eyes
-fairly jumped from his head. There at the foot of his bed
-was his first suit of clothing. Quickly he grasped them to
-him and hugged them, feeling how soft and pliable they
-were, following the many days of work.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_107">107</div>
-<p>Quickly he slipped into the clothes and when he was
-completely dressed, ran from the wigwam to find his
-father and show him his beautiful clothes. Soon he found
-his father at the edge of the village talking with two other
-braves of the tribe. All excited, he pulled at his father&rsquo;s
-sleeve until his father turned and noticing the clothes,
-quickly changed his expression from anger to one of
-surprise.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;How handsome you look, my son. Your mother has
-done a fine job on your clothes. I wish that my shirts
-were as beautiful as the one you now wear upon your
-back. You look very much like a man now, my son.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Singing Eagle was very proud that his father had noticed
-his clothes and given him such fine compliments.
-But time was wasting. As was customary when a young
-Indian boy received his first full set of clothing to wear,
-the rest of the day was spent in showing off his new
-clothes to his many friends. And so that day, in a matter
-of a couple of hours, the whole Huron village knew that
-Singing Eagle had his first real Indian suit, made from a
-fine buck that his father had shot just for him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_108">108</div>
-<h2 id="c20"><span class="h2line1">THE NEW TEPEE</span></h2>
-<p>The Blackfoot village was all astir to greet the new
-day. It was late in the springtime, and the great hunters
-of the tribe had been off to hunt the buffalo. Word had
-just reached the village that the hunt was over and the
-hunting party was on the way home.</p>
-<p>This made Little Bird very happy, for she knew that
-her husband, Big Red Bear, would be returning to the
-tepee and that there would be much celebrating in the
-tribe. Everything must be made ready to greet the hunters.</p>
-<p>The women of the village began dashing around preparing
-for the arrival of the hunting party. There was
-much to be done and much work lay ahead, now that the
-buffalo had been killed. The meat must be stored and
-some of it smoked, and the hides must be turned into new
-tepee covers and robes. All this would take place after
-the celebration, but still the women of the tribe knew
-they had a long job ahead.</p>
-<p>The news was good. The hunt had been successful, and
-many buffalo had fallen before the weapons of the hunters.
-The buffalo had a good winter and were not thin or
-ragged. The grass had been full-grown and rich. Enough
-rain had fallen to provide the food and water necessary to
-make the buffalo fat and a good target for expert bowmen.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_109">109</div>
-<p>Soon all was in readiness and everyone waited impatiently
-for the first signs of the returning hunters. And
-then the signal came! A young brave on a shaggy brown
-pony came dashing through the village, announcing the
-arrival of the hunters.</p>
-<p>Everyone was out to greet them and shout thanks and
-praise. Husbands and wives, fathers and children greeted
-each other warmly. The tribe was filled with joy.</p>
-<p>Night came swiftly. Before long the beating drums told
-the people that the dancing and feasting was to begin.
-This celebration often lasted all night and sometimes into
-the next day; then as dancers tired, they would wander off
-to their tepees for the first really peaceful sleep since the
-hunting party had left the village.</p>
-<p>Little Bird and her husband enjoyed the great feast and
-celebration. The next day Little Bird set to work on the
-buffalo skins for her family tepee. It had been a hard
-winter and the weather had damaged many Blackfoot
-homes. There were more than enough skins brought back
-by the hunters, so that those tepee coverings that had
-become worn and tattered could be replaced. So Little
-Bird set to work with the women of the tribe who were
-busy preparing and sewing together the buffalo hides to
-make new covers for the tepees.</p>
-<p>One day Little Bird learned that a new tepee was to be
-built in the village. The old tepee of the chief had been
-damaged so badly by the winter snow and ice, and the
-poles had become so rotted, that the tribe agreed to build
-him a new tepee. The building of a new tepee was important
-because everybody in the tribe helped to make it.
-All the friends and neighbors would be invited to attend
-a great feast and when the feast was over, the women
-would begin sewing the skins together.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_110">110</div>
-<p>Little Bird and her husband went to the feast. When
-it was over, Little Bird sat down with the rest of the
-women and, taking up her bone needle, began to sew two
-buffalo hides together. The cutting of the skins had been
-entrusted to Slow Water, the wife of Black Fox, the tribe&rsquo;s
-best hunter, since she had great skill in judging the number
-of skins needed by their size and shape. They used no
-patterns, so only a woman with this kind of skill was
-asked to do the cutting.</p>
-<p>As the sewing continued and the tepee walls began to
-take shape, even more whispering went on around Little
-Bird. When Little Bird asked one of her friends what it
-was all about, her friend would only say, &ldquo;Be patient,
-Little Bird, for soon we shall all know what they have
-been whispering about.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The next day the women who had been working on
-the skins came to the tepee of Little Bird. Because her
-husband was away, Little Bird invited the women to sit
-and talk. There was a great deal of laughter as the women
-sat down. Slow Water, the skillful cutter, had been chosen
-to speak to Little Bird for all of them.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Bird,&rdquo; she began, &ldquo;we are here to ask you to
-do something for our tribe. You always have a smile for
-everyone wherever you go in the village. As you know,
-we must choose someone who is always cheerful to work
-on the smoke flaps for the new tepee. We are here to ask
-you, Little Bird, to work on the smoke flaps of the new
-tepee, so that your happy spirit will be woven into the
-flap and the smoke will depart from the tepee evenly and
-smoothly.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Bird smiled. Her heart was happy. This was truly
-a great honor. Now she understood why all the whispering
-had been going on the last couple of days.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_111">111</div>
-<p>&ldquo;I will be happy to help sew the smoke flaps of the
-new tepee. It is a great honor for which I thank you from
-the bottom of my heart.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And some say that as long as that tepee stood, the chief
-never had to worry about the smoke rising out of the tepee
-easily, even on stormy, windy nights. The Indians believed
-that the happy spirit of Little Bird really lived in
-that flap.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_112">112</div>
-<h2 id="c21"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE DOVE LEARNS TO WEAVE</span></h2>
-<p>When Little Dove, a Winnebago baby girl, was born
-she had everything a new-born baby could ask for. First
-of all, her father was chief of the Winnebagos, and her
-mother was considered one of the most beautiful women
-in the tribe.</p>
-<p>There were many relatives who came to view the new
-child and left many precious gifts for her.</p>
-<p>When she was born, Little Dove was strapped to a
-cradle board and carried by her mother in this fashion.
-Each day her mother would unwrap her and clean her
-body all over and massage her little limbs. Then she was
-wrapped once again on the board, and life continued this
-way until the baby was able to walk.</p>
-<p>She was always fed when she was hungry and was
-never but a few feet from her mother&rsquo;s side. But soon
-Little Dove began to walk and so she left the cradle board
-and began to run and play with the other children in the
-out of doors.</p>
-<p>Everyone was affectionate and indulgent toward the
-girl as Indians always were toward their children. Soon,
-however, they realized that Little Dove was beginning to
-grow up. Little Dove was already ten summers old, when
-her mother called her to the side of their home to talk
-with her.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_113">113</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Dove,&rdquo; she commenced, &ldquo;you must start to
-prepare for your life later on as a wife and a mother.
-If you are to be a good wife, you must learn the work that
-all Indian women must do.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Most Indian girls welcomed this advice from their
-mothers, but Little Dove was different. Because she was
-the chief&rsquo;s daughter some people had given her the idea
-that she would be waited upon for the rest of her life&mdash;if
-not by her mother or other women of the tribe, then
-eventually by her husband. When she told this to her
-mother, her mother tried to explain, but Little Dove did
-not want to listen and simply walked away.</p>
-<p>Soft Feather, her mother, was very much concerned
-and went to talk to her husband. But just as many fathers
-do even today, the chief said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Be patient, she is young and she will learn.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Soft Feather was quite disturbed and each day she
-would ask Little Dove to come and begin to learn, but
-each day Little Dove would run off to play with the
-younger children while the older children were busy learning
-the work that goes with adult life.</p>
-<p>One day young Little Dove noticed an Indian boy that
-she had seen several times sitting by himself shaping a
-bow.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What are you doing?&rdquo; she asked.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am shaping a bow so that when I marry I will have
-a fine weapon with which to bring down the running
-deer.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>For a long while Little Dove sat with the young boy,
-and nothing more was said. Finally the young brave rose
-and, bidding good-bye to Little Dove, started for his
-home.</p>
-<p>Little Dove was now twelve and each day she would
-see the young boy at work or play. Finally she went to
-her mother.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_114">114</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Mother, the young boy who has the pretty belt and
-bone-handled knife, who is he?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That, my daughter, is your father&rsquo;s best friend&rsquo;s son,
-Straight Arrow. Why, do you like him especially?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I like him a lot.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Several weeks passed, and one day as Little Dove was
-idling her time away dangling her feet in a stream, young
-Straight Arrow came to the water&rsquo;s edge to wash some
-dirt from his arms and legs. He had been working in the
-garden with his father and now was going to clean up.
-Little Dove looked directly at him and said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Are you planning on taking a wife very soon, Straight
-Arrow?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I suppose so, Little Dove, for I am almost sixteen
-and my father said that I should be married now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I too am planning to be married soon,&rdquo; said Little
-Dove.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Can you cook, or sew, or weave baskets?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, I cannot do those things. Will I have to?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, I do not know about you but any girl that I
-marry must be able to do that and lots more. Well, I
-must be going now. It is time for lunch and I am very
-hungry and my sister is a very good cook.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that, Straight Arrow left the side of the stream
-and he left behind a very angry Little Dove.</p>
-<p>Little Dove rushed home and told her mother what
-had happened. When she had finished blurting out her
-story, her mother said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;And now what do you want me to do about it, my
-Little Dove?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Mother, will you teach me to weave baskets and sew
-and cook?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_115">115</div>
-<p>So the lessons began that very afternoon. The cooking
-was easy but when it came to the weaving, that was a
-little more difficult and it was a long time before Little
-Dove could weave a basket that looked like a basket.</p>
-<p>First, she and her mother would gather some thin ash
-and linden trees. These had to be straight and free of
-knots. They they would strip them of the bark. These
-they pounded until they came apart in long splints. Then
-these were dyed and woven into baskets. Also Little Dove
-learned how to make shredded basswood fibers. These
-were made almost the same way except that they were
-made into a strong thread by twisting them and rolling
-them against the thigh of one&rsquo;s leg. These threads were
-used to weave belts and tump lines and square bags.</p>
-<p>Soon Little Dove had become quite expert at cooking
-and sewing and weaving, and once again she looked for
-Straight Arrow. She found him one day seated by a small
-stream that ran near the village. She sat down and began
-throwing pebbles into the stream.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have learned to cook and to weave and to sew,
-Straight Arrow,&rdquo; she said rather quickly.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That is good,&rdquo; he answered, &ldquo;for now you will make
-someone a good wife.&rdquo; With that he rose and walked
-slowly back to the village. Little Dove sat and cried.
-When she could cry no longer she sat and looked into the
-water until it was dark, and then she returned to the
-village. Her mother was waiting for her.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your father wishes to speak with you, Little Dove.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my father, you sent for me?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Dove, today a young brave came to see me.
-He wants you for his wife and he has offered me many
-fine horses. I think he will make you a good husband, so
-in four moons&rsquo; time you will be married, my daughter.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Dove felt her heart sink.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_116">116</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Who is it that has asked to marry me, father?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Straight Arrow, son of Big Bow, my daughter, for
-today you told him you could weave.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Father and daughter smiled at each other, and then
-Little Dove left to talk with her mother and tell her how
-wrong a foolish young Indian girl could be.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_117">117</div>
-<h2 id="c22"><span class="h2line1">RED CLOUD&rsquo;S DREAM</span></h2>
-<p>Red Cloud was a young Algonquin lad who played and
-romped in his village along with the other young Indian
-braves and girls. He was a tall Indian for his age and
-quite good looking.</p>
-<p>As was the custom among the Algonquins, however,
-no child, boy or girl, would be considered mature until
-he or she had a dream in which the powers of nature
-promised success and courage in his or her adult life.</p>
-<p>Red Cloud entered adolescence and he knew that the
-time was fast approaching when he would be required to
-spend many lonely nights in the forest, fasting and waiting,
-until the Thunderbird, the Sun, or other powers of
-nature had spoken to him.</p>
-<p>Each day Red Cloud would awake and expect his
-father to call him to inform him that today was the day.
-But many days passed, and still Great Cloud did not call
-for his son. Soon with the excitement of the games and
-the learning of lessons from his father concerning the use
-of weapons and tracking, the problem of coming into
-maturity left the mind of Red Cloud and going off alone
-into the forest was the farthest thing from his mind.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_118">118</div>
-<p>Each day in the beginning as he had padded along the
-trail with his father he had expected to be told of the
-ordeal he must go through, but as each day passed and
-nothing was said, Red Cloud began to look forward to
-his lessons and to forget even the possibility of anything
-else on these daily walks.</p>
-<p>Several months passed, and Red Cloud became quite
-a good hunter and tracker and his ability with the bow
-was unchallenged. His father was very proud of him and
-each day as they returned along the trail, Great Cloud
-walked with his arm lovingly across the shoulders of his
-son.</p>
-<p>One afternoon when they had returned from tracking
-a deer, Great Cloud summoned Red Cloud to his wigwam.
-Red Cloud thought that he might have done something
-on the hunt which displeased his father, but he
-entered the wigwam walking straight and proud as his
-father had taught him. Great Cloud motioned for his son
-to be seated and when he had done so, Great Cloud began
-to speak.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, in your dreams have any of the powers of
-nature appeared to you promising success and courage in
-your adult life? Now think hard, for this is very important.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then and only then did Red Cloud realize that the time
-had come for him to be put to the test. Now he realized
-that his father was asking him whether he was a mature
-Indian brave or whether he was still a child.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, father, I have had no dream in which the powers
-of nature appeared.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_119">119</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Then you know, my son, what you have to do,&rdquo;
-answered Great Cloud. &ldquo;These many weeks you have
-probably wondered why I have not called you to me
-before. It was because I felt that you were not ready to
-bear the ordeal of spending many lonely nights in the
-forest alone. When one retires to the deep green of the
-forest to await the voice of the Thunderbird or the Sun
-or other powers of nature, one must go alone with just
-his weapons. Your education has been such that you
-would not have been able to survive in the forest very
-long before now, and that is why I have so carefully
-trained you in the many ways of nature and the forest
-these past few weeks. As you know, before you may be
-considered a mature Indian in the Algonquin tribe you
-must first hear the voice of one of the powers of nature
-promising you courage and success in your adult life.
-Are you now prepared to go into the great forest and
-endure this ordeal?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Red Cloud hesitated, for he knew that his answer
-must be a straightforward one and honest, for truth was
-a sacred thing to the Indians.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;O my father, I must be truthful, for so you have
-taught me in my younger days. I have listened and
-watched patiently each day as I trotted at your heels
-along the trail and I have locked away in my heart and
-in my mind all the careful little bits of information you
-have given to me which would make me a boy worthy
-to be called the son of Great Cloud. The forest has been
-a friendly place to me, for I have spent many happy
-hours there with you. Now I am faced with a decision
-which I must make here and now, and all I can say to
-you, father, is that I, Red Cloud, your son, am ready
-to go into the great forest to await the word from the
-powers of nature.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_120">120</div>
-<p>Great Cloud placed his hands upon the shoulders of
-his son and smiling at him said, &ldquo;You have spoken well,
-my son. Tomorrow you shall leave for the forest and
-look for a place where you will not be disturbed. Take
-with you your weapons and your blanket, but no other
-goods such as food, for you must fast while you await
-the dream.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that Red Cloud departed from the wigwam to
-prepare for his journey the following morning.</p>
-<p>There was no sleep for the young Red Cloud that
-evening, as he thought of his coming trip into the big
-forest. Finally the early light of dawn peeked through the
-door of the wigwam and before most of the village was
-even astir, Red Cloud was up from his bed and had gathered
-his precious weapons and his blanket for the trip.</p>
-<p>He bade good-bye to his mother, Morning Star, and
-his father, Great Cloud, and started for the forest.</p>
-<p>It was a beautiful morning. The bright sun shone down
-through the leaves of the great green trees of the forest
-and the spring flowers were all in gay bloom, dressed in
-their finest colors of reds, blues, yellows, purples, and
-oranges. As he trotted along the trail Red Cloud could
-hear overhead the many different calls and songs of the
-forest birds. Occasionally there was a rustle along the
-side of the trail or a rabbit would scamper across the
-path of Red Cloud.</p>
-<p>Once through the branch of a low-hanging birch tree,
-Red Cloud saw the magnificent body of a full-grown
-buck with six points. Oh, how he regretted that he was
-not upon a hunting trip, for wouldn&rsquo;t that buck have made
-a beautiful trophy to bring back to the village?</p>
-<p>The buck, too, seemed to be aware of the reason for
-Red Cloud&rsquo;s journey, for though the boy moved carefully
-he did stir the leaves as he walked and though the buck
-turned his majestic head he did not move from his spot
-in the glen of the forest.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_121">121</div>
-<p>Red Cloud smiled to himself, recalling words of his
-father, &ldquo;Sometimes the wild animals seem to sense the
-reason for your journey and fear not the approach of a
-warrior who is not on a hunt.&rdquo; At the time Red Cloud
-had not thought much about the statement but here
-beside the trail it had been proved to him by the actions
-of the majestic buck.</p>
-<p>Soon Red Cloud felt that he had journeyed deep
-enough into the forest along the well-known trails, so he
-turned from the path to go into the forest where no trail
-was known to him. It was not easy going, for he had to
-cut small brush from his path. Occasionally he would
-take a small piece of bark from the side of a tree to
-mark the direction he had taken in order to find his way
-back to the main trail.</p>
-<p>Soon he came to a stream and stooped to drink of the
-cool refreshing water. As he stood up once again he gazed
-up through the opening in the trees and noticed that
-evening was fast approaching and soon it would be dark.
-So he moved on more rapidly and he noticed that his
-direction was taking him up the side of a small ridge.
-Finally, tired and realizing that darkness would soon be
-upon him, Red Cloud decided to stop and make his
-camp. He found that where he had chosen to stop, there
-was a small formation of rocks which provided a natural
-shelter from the cool evening breezes.</p>
-<p>Within the shelter of these rocks he built himself a
-small fire and then, wrapping his blanket around him,
-settled down to sleep through the comforting night, hoping
-as all boys do that the dream would come to him on
-this, his first night and that he could return to the warmth
-and shelter of his friendly wigwam and his family on the
-following day. But also Red Cloud was prepared to spend
-many days, if the need arose and many nights, for he had
-been taught endurance by his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_122">122</div>
-<p>The night passed quickly, and suddenly Red Cloud
-opened his eyes to the rays of the sun and a new day.
-Climbing from under the folds of his blanket he realized
-that he was quite thirsty and hungry. Water he could
-seek and drink, but he realized that until he had the
-dream he was to partake of no food regardless of how
-long he must wait. Unless, of course, he desired to return
-to the village and report that the spirits had not spoken
-to him in a dream and then as was the custom of his
-tribe he would be considered a poor unfortunate person
-with little hope of success in life. So Red Cloud put the
-thoughts of food from his mind and started in search of
-water.</p>
-<p>In the great forest one did not have to look too far for
-water because all through the great forest there ran many
-streams of clear cool water. So it was not long before
-Red Cloud found such a stream and, after splashing the
-icy cold water in his face to chase the sleep from his eyes,
-he drank deeply until his thirst was satisfied. Then turning
-from the stream he started back toward his camp.</p>
-<p>When he arrived back at his blanket, he spread it on
-the ground and then lay down to gaze up into the sky
-through the openings in the trees. He passed an hour or
-more making wonderful pictures in his mind from the
-formation of clouds that floated overhead across the
-heavens. Billowy white puffs of smoke they seemed to be,
-and Red Cloud marveled at how soft and pure they
-looked. But soon his restless heart made him rise from
-the blanket and he decided to explore. He started for the
-top of the ridge many miles away and when he had
-reached there he knelt, turning his head toward the
-heavens and raising his arms. And so as if reaching for
-the sun he made his prayers to the great Wakanda.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_123">123</div>
-<p>When he had knelt in this position for an hour or
-more he rose to start down the ridge toward his campsite
-again, planning to go in another direction from the campsite
-and eventually explore the whole surrounding area.
-It was then that he noticed a slight stirring in the brush.
-Quickly Red Cloud dropped behind a shelter of rock and
-watched the spot in the brush. He did not know what to
-expect, for this part of the forest was strange to him and
-he did not know what might be hidden in the brush.
-Then as he watched the brush he realized that the slight
-breeze that was blowing would be carrying his scent right
-toward whatever was concealed in the patch of brush.</p>
-<p>Then he saw it was a tremendous brown bear which
-was six feet tall on its hind feet. Evidently the bear had
-been eating blueberries from the bushes which covered
-the side of the ridge and had suddenly become aware of
-the presence of someone or something which was foreign
-to him. The bear was now raised up on his hind paws in
-order to look over the tops of the bushes and see if he
-could discover this thing which had invaded his feeding
-grounds.</p>
-<p>Red Cloud crouched even lower behind the rock, for
-he knew that a brown bear could be very mean, especially
-when he was hungry. Then Red Cloud thought of his
-weapons. In seeking water he had left his weapons at
-the campsite and had nothing with him but his hunting
-knife, which he felt would do him little good against a
-mad full-grown brown bear. So the best thing he could
-do was to attempt to circle the bear and get downwind
-from him so that the bear could no longer smell him. But
-he must do it by keeping out of sight.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_124">124</div>
-<p>Slowly Red Cloud edged himself out from behind the
-rock, keeping his body pressed close to the ground.
-Before he started to move he noticed that the bear had
-settled down to feeding once again. The breeze had died
-down but there was always the danger of a quick gust
-again and Red Cloud realized he was still in a dangerous
-position. He hugged the ground as hard as he could and
-continued to squirm away from and around this dangerous
-bear.</p>
-<p>Then Red Cloud was aware of another danger. Having
-gone without food for almost two whole days, he was not
-the strong lad that he would have been when eating two
-hearty meals a day. He wondered, if the bear did see him,
-whether he would be able to run fast enough to get away
-from the bear. But getting downwind was the most important
-thing at this time, so Red Cloud continued to crawl
-and the rough stones on the forest floor cut through his
-shirt and into his skin, scraping it raw; but the more it
-hurt the harder Red Cloud pressed his body against the
-friendly earth.</p>
-<p>He slowly raised his head and realized that he was now
-almost completely downwind from the bear and that the
-big fellow had gone back to munching the berries. For
-what seemed like hours, Red Cloud lay quietly in hiding
-behind a great oak tree, not daring to look out for fear
-the bear would be looking around just at the time he
-peeked out from behind the tree.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_125">125</div>
-<p>And then it happened. Red Cloud had been lying so
-still, afraid to move, that suddenly he felt his leg go numb
-and he realized that his leg had gone to sleep. He moved
-it slightly to bring circulation and life back into it and in
-so doing he dislodged a fairly large stone which began its
-noisy fall down the side of the ridge and as it rolled it
-would click against other stones and they too would join
-the miniature landslide. Red Cloud huddled behind the
-tree and then he heard a low growl. He decided he had
-better take a chance and glance from behind the tree, and
-as he did his heart leapt, for the bear was looking almost
-right at him. The bear let out another terrible growl, and
-then from above where Red Cloud lay in hiding, the
-young brave heard another growl.</p>
-<p>Slowly turning his head so that he could look up the
-ridge, he saw the reason for the bear&rsquo;s sudden anger. His
-berry patch had been invaded by another large brown
-bear who was now growling out a challenge. If either
-bear had spotted Red Cloud, he was forgotten now, for
-they had eyes only for each other and possession of the
-berry patch was the prize which they both sought.</p>
-<p>With mighty growls they dropped to all fours and
-charged at each other. Red Cloud, at first fascinated by
-this battle between two creatures of the forest, stood
-rooted to his hiding place, but then thought more wisely
-of it and taking the chance offered him by the two bears
-being involved in a battle to the death, ran as swiftly as
-he could down the ridge and away from the danger that
-threatened his very life.</p>
-<p>He did not stop running until he had reached his campsite
-miles away and then, throwing himself flat on the
-ground, thanked the great Wakanda for sparing him from
-this danger which had threatened and for bringing him
-safely to his campsite.</p>
-<p>Once again he offered his prayers to the powers of
-nature and then, wrapping himself in his blanket and
-building up the fire, he settled down for the night.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_126">126</div>
-<p>It was during the warm sleep of that evening brought
-on by the fatigue of his day&rsquo;s adventure that Red Cloud
-had his dream. In his dream the great Thunderbird
-appeared to him telling him that he would have much
-courage added to the courage already in his heart and
-that as an adult in the tribe he would have a great deal of
-success in all he attempted. Upon awakening at the first
-rays of the dawn, Red Cloud felt suddenly refreshed. He
-had been visited in his dreams and now could return to
-the village.</p>
-<p>Gathering his weapons he put out the embers of the
-fire he had made and scattered the dead ashes. Then with
-a light heart and a quick step he started back upon the
-path he had blazed until he reached the main trail. There
-he quickened his step and just as dusk was beginning to
-fall, entered the village, being welcomed warmly by his
-many friends. His father and several of the lesser chiefs
-were at the door of his father&rsquo;s wigwam and that evening
-a council was held at the central lodge.</p>
-<p>There Red Cloud rose before the male members of his
-tribe and recounted his adventures in the great forest,
-closing by repeating his dream. As he finished there were
-many grunts of approval and words of praise.</p>
-<p>But Great Cloud said nothing, and Red Cloud wondered
-about this until he looked into the eyes of his great
-father; and there he saw the fire of pride burning brightly
-and in his heart he was very happy. Together father and
-son left the central lodge that evening, and true to the
-dream, Red Cloud grew in the tribe to become one of its
-greatest warriors.</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>This story is based upon an incident in the life of Red Cloud, an
-Algonquin warrior, as told to the author by John Fitch, a farmer
-from Vermont.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_127">127</div>
-<h2 id="c23"><span class="h2line1">BROKEN TOOTH AND THE WAR BONNET</span></h2>
-<p>The Apache warriors had been waiting a long time for
-this revenge upon the maurauding Kiowas and now the
-time had come. The leader of the Apache band raised his
-hand and the attack was on. The Apache war party swept
-down the hillside into the midst of the Kiowa camp. The
-camp had been caught off guard and the raiding Apaches
-were making short work of the few Kiowa braves who
-would stand and fight.</p>
-<p>Broken Tooth, one of the most honored warriors of
-the Apache tribe, rode down to a Kiowa brave and
-touched him with his coup stick. Then he rode on a short
-ways, turned abruptly and sent an arrow into the Kiowa&rsquo;s
-chest.</p>
-<p>The battle was short and furious. The Apache raiders
-withdrew from the village and slowly returned home to
-count their coup and to sing of their victory at the great
-council. As they rode, Broken Tooth was thinking ahead
-to the great council that night. After this raid today a
-great event would take place in his tepee on the morrow.</p>
-<p>The party entered the camp and there was much
-rejoicing. Finally, the evening meal was eaten and the
-word was sent out that the council would meet to hear the
-deeds of the day.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_128">128</div>
-<p>When all the men of the tribe had gathered in the
-council lodge, they rose one by one to recount their deeds
-of the day. Finally, Broken Tooth rose and told of his
-riding down upon the Kiowa warrior and touching him
-with his coup stick. He then related his other exploits of
-the day. The great chief rose from his place and then he
-spoke, &ldquo;Broken Tooth, you have been a brave warrior and
-you have earned many honors. Today you have added
-even more honors for your brave deeds.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The council then broke up, but the following day word
-was passed that Broken Tooth was on that day going to
-make a new headdress. As was the custom, the men of
-the tribe gathered that afternoon in the tepee of Broken
-Tooth and all his feathers were spread upon the ground.
-They were then sorted according to size, and the making
-of the headdress began. As each feather was being prepared
-for the headdress, Broken Tooth recounted for the
-men the story of the deed that had won him that feather.
-The men would listen and smoke and grunt approval
-after each story. Finally, the bonnet was finished and
-there was no more beautiful piece of handiwork in the
-whole village.</p>
-<p>The following day there were reports from the scouts
-that the Arapaho were banding together and would be
-attacking in force. The Apaches gathered their warriors
-and rode forth to meet the enemy. A large plain between
-the two villages was picked as the place of battle and the
-tribes met in both hand-to-hand and long-range battle. It
-was a hard-fought battle and soon both tribes withdrew,
-bearing their dead and wounded.</p>
-<p>Among the dead was Broken Tooth. As his body was
-borne back to the Apache village many praised the beauty
-of the war bonnet which had been worn so proudly by
-its owner for a single day.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_129">129</div>
-<h2 id="c24"><span class="h2line1">GREY SQUIRREL HEARS HIS NAME</span></h2>
-<p>The Oneidas were a tribe of the Iroquois Nation which
-had swept north to invade the lands of the Algonquins,
-spreading death and destruction. After having beaten all
-the surrounding Algonquin tribes badly, the Iroquois
-tribes fell to fighting among themselves&mdash;the Onondagas,
-Mohawks, Cayugas, and Senecas, as well as the Oneidas.
-This constant bloodshed in the Mohawk valley in time
-weakened the tribes so that they were always in danger of
-attack from the revenge-seeking Algonquins.</p>
-<p>It was during this unhappy time that a young brave,
-Grey Squirrel, lived among the Oneida people. He was
-not an unusual Indian. He was of average build with
-average good looks and average abilities. He took part in
-only the things the average young man in his tribe enjoyed&mdash;hunting,
-fishing, trapping, and doing all the things they
-did. However, there was one difference that set Grey
-Squirrel aside from his brothers of the tribe: Grey Squirrel
-had never heard his name spoken by the chiefs of the
-tribe. All the other braves of his age had either heard the
-chiefs call their names while on the hunt, at a tribal ceremony,
-or while walking in the woods or swimming in the
-stream.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_130">130</div>
-<p>So Grey Squirrel began to wonder whether he had ever
-done anything which, in the eyes of the chiefs, made him
-unworthy. He had fought in great battles, but he had
-never been cowardly. So cowardice could not be the
-reason. He had never failed to hunt well, to keep his
-wigwam warm and sturdy, and to see that there was
-enough food for all the family. He could see no way in
-which he had been unworthy of the chiefs&rsquo; notice. Often
-Grey Squirrel would walk by the quiet stream and ponder
-the reason for his being a brave forgotten by the chiefs.</p>
-<p>As Grey Squirrel&rsquo;s heart grew troubled, he sought the
-wise advice of his father, Grey Owl. One evening, he
-approached his father&rsquo;s wigwam and asked if he might
-speak with him about something which tormented his
-mind. Grey Owl invited him into his home and they both
-sat cross-legged around the small fire in the center of the
-wigwam. There was a long period of silence and then
-Grey Owl spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What is it that troubles you so deeply, my son? I have
-often watched you wander from the village to the near-by
-stream and sit and ponder. I have watched you return
-with a downcast look from the hunt or battle when you
-should have been joyful that your bow had proven
-straight and true in whatever task you set for it.&rdquo; His
-father paused. &ldquo;Speak, my son, unburden your heart to
-your father who has loved you and guided you from
-babyhood to fine young manhood.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Grey Squirrel looked long at his father and as he
-watched his father&rsquo;s eyes, his face softened and he said,
-&ldquo;O wise and kind father, many years I walked the forest
-trails at your heels carefully watching every move, imitating
-all that you taught me to the best of my ability. Many,
-many hours we spent together beneath the sheltering
-branches of the towering oak trees, listening with our ears
-to the voices of the forest. You taught me how to listen
-and what to listen for, so that my ears have grown very
-keen. Today the deer may not tread the forest floor that
-I do not hear, nor the rabbit scurry for cover that I
-cannot uncover the entrance to his home, nor the bluebird
-set his wings for flight that I cannot immediately see his
-starting place. And yet, dear father, there is one sound I
-have listened for and have not heard.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_131">131</div>
-<p>Grey Owl had been listening calmly to all that his
-young son had to say. Surprise crossed his face with his
-son&rsquo;s last words, and then a gentle smile came upon his
-lips. &ldquo;Tell me, Grey Squirrel, what is this sound you
-listen so hard for but cannot hear?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;O father,&rdquo; Grey Squirrel said, &ldquo;I have listened for the
-voices of our great chiefs calling my name, but to this
-day I have not heard them. Am I not in favor with those
-who watch over our tribe and guide our feet along the
-safe paths? Tell me, father, why do I not hear my name
-spoken by them? I have listened along the forest trails
-or in the din of battle. I have lain awake in the quiet of
-my wigwam listening for just a whisper. All the other
-braves of our village are proud that they have heard their
-names repeated by the chiefs. I alone have not. What is
-wrong, father? I have come to you to seek your wise
-answer.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Grey Owl lowered his eyes to the ground as he
-searched his thoughts for the right reply. Then he lifted
-his head slowly and studied his son&rsquo;s face. He began to
-speak slowly and kindly. &ldquo;My son, you have made one
-very great mistake. Without having meant to do so, you
-have done the one thing which could have prevented you
-from hearing the chiefs call your name.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Tell me, father,&rdquo; Grey Squirrel said impatiently, &ldquo;tell
-me what it is!&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_132">132</div>
-<p>Grey Owl rose and walked behind his son. Placing his
-hands upon the young man&rsquo;s shoulders, he said, &ldquo;Because
-you have walked in search of their praise you have spent
-many hours expecting to hear them praise you. Do not
-listen so hard, my son. Live your life the best you know
-how. One day you shall be rewarded by hearing the
-voices of the chiefs who watch over our tribe. Do not be
-troubled any longer. Return to your wigwam and your
-family and continue to be a good husband and father. If
-you allow it to worry you greatly, it will soon hurt your
-whole life. You are young, my son. You have not been
-forgotten.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Grey Squirrel rose then, and faced his father. &ldquo;Father,&rdquo;
-he said, &ldquo;your words are of little comfort. But I will
-follow your advice, for it has been wise and good
-through the years of my youth.&rdquo; With that, Grey Squirrel
-turned and left his father&rsquo;s wigwam.</p>
-<p>He returned to his own home and was greeted warmly
-by his good wife, Morning Star, who had prepared a fine
-meal for him. All through his dinner, Grey Squirrel
-thought carefully about his father&rsquo;s words. But when he
-went to bed that evening, he decided that he should drive
-these troubled thoughts from his mind. The weeks that
-followed were very pleasant for Grey Squirrel. The hunting
-and fishing were good. Everything was going well.
-The people of the village saw the sudden change in Grey
-Squirrel and the fact that he no longer appeared worried.
-Grey Squirrel felt better, greeting each new day happily.</p>
-<p>One day Grey Squirrel shouldered his bow and chose
-his best arrows. Bidding his family good-bye, he started
-toward the forest to hunt for fresh meat for his family.
-He trotted easily along the forest trail, stopping now and
-then to study the ground and look for signs of moving
-game.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_133">133</div>
-<p>He had been on the trail for a while when he came to
-a narrow stream. Stooping to drink of the fresh, cool
-water, he stopped with his hand halfway to his mouth.
-He blinked his eyes and looked again into the stream, not
-moving a muscle. There, in a quiet pool next to his reflection
-was that of the head and antlers of a beautiful deer.
-Slowly the brave lifted his head until he was looking
-straight into the eyes of a magnificent buck standing
-directly across the stream, almost within reach. As Grey
-Squirrel straightened up slowly, the buck shied a little and
-backed off. Many thoughts passed through Grey Squirrel&rsquo;s
-head, but the one which puzzled him most was why
-the buck shied only a little and then stood and watched
-him without any sign of fear after that.</p>
-<p>Grey Squirrel lowered a hand slowly to reach for his
-bow which he had placed upon the ground as he was
-kneeling to drink. Grasping the bow firmly, he fitted an
-arrow onto the bow string and took careful aim. The
-great buck&rsquo;s eyes stayed his hand from releasing the
-arrow and made him lower the bow. His mind told Grey
-Squirrel that this buck would provide good food, but his
-heart told him to stop. Then he noticed that the deer was
-favoring his right hoof and realized that the buck had an
-injury. The leg just above the hoof was swollen to almost
-twice its normal size. Grey Squirrel dropped his bow and
-arrow to the ground, and with careful and even steps,
-waded across the stream toward the buck.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_134">134</div>
-<p>The animal suddenly turned as if to spring into the
-forest, but his leg collapsed under him and he fell to the
-ground. Grey Squirrel guessed that the deer must have
-already used up his strength in escaping from whatever
-had caused the injury, had come to the stream to bathe
-the injured leg, and could go no further. Now the buck
-was struggling to rise and Grey Squirrel jumped quickly
-to his side. Firmly but gently, the Indian placed one knee
-against the buck&rsquo;s side, one hand on the animal&rsquo;s chest,
-the other on the buck&rsquo;s neck to hold him steady. The animal
-was frightened and trembled. Grey Squirrel spoke
-softly to the buck and began to stroke its side, each time
-managing to bring his hand a little closer to the injured
-hoof. Finally the buck seemed to sigh and relaxed as
-though he understood that this man wanted to help him.</p>
-<p>Grey Squirrel leaned over to look at the injured leg
-more closely. The buck apparently had run into some
-heavy brambles and a large thorn had lodged in the soft
-part of the leg just above the hoof, which had become
-infected and had begun to fester. Grey Squirrel took his
-knife from his belt and pressed the point of the blade into
-the flesh beside the thorn. The buck&rsquo;s leg quivered
-slightly. Then the thorn and a misty fluid spurted from
-the wound. Grey Squirrel took wet leaves and mud from
-the bed of the stream and laid them over the wound. All
-through this operation the buck lay still, allowing Grey
-Squirrel to do as he pleased. The animal continued to lie
-there quietly as though waiting for any more help the
-Indian might gave him.</p>
-<p>Grey Squirrel went back to the stream and, cupping his
-hands, brought some cool water for the animal. The buck
-drank it eagerly. A long time passed while Grey Squirrel
-kept vigil over the resting buck. Occasionally as he moved
-to another position, the buck would follow him with his
-eyes; when Grey Squirrel settled down again, the buck
-would put his head back on the earth and he too would
-rest again. Finally, dusk drew near and it began to
-darken in the forest. As if by signal, the buck arose,
-tested his injured leg, glanced at Grey Squirrel, and
-started for the protection of the dense trees. Grey Squirrel
-called and the buck stopped at the edge of the woods and
-turned to look back. He cocked his head to one side as if
-to say &ldquo;thank you,&rdquo; and then moved into the thick woods
-and out of sight.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_135">135</div>
-<p>Grey Squirrel suddenly became angry with himself and
-shouted aloud, &ldquo;What a fool you are, Grey Squirrel!
-There, before you, was food for your family for a whole
-week. But you let the buck make you feel sorry for him.
-You cared for his injury, and now he has left you empty-handed
-after a whole day of hunting, with only the story
-of a deer who let you pet him&mdash;as if anyone would believe
-you! You are a fool, Grey Squirrel!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then there was a loud rustling near by. All of a sudden,
-Grey Squirrel heard a voice, calling his name.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Grey Squirrel!&rdquo; the voice boomed, echoing in the forest.
-&ldquo;Don&rsquo;t be angry with yourself. I witnessed what you
-did today. Your tribe will honor you. It takes courage to
-travel in the forests alone in search of food. But it takes
-greater courage to forget to be a hunter when his prey is
-so easy a target because of an injury. You sacrificed time
-and food for your family&rsquo;s table to help the injured buck.
-If you had killed the animal, you would have felt cowardly.
-Return to our village, hold your head high, and tell
-of your deed today. Do not worry if they do not believe
-you at first. Your heart is happy for your kindness. Go,
-Grey Squirrel, it grows late. I will ask the chiefs to hear
-your story at the council fire tonight.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>In quiet wonder, Grey Squirrel stood gazing at Strong
-Heart, the great war chief of the Oneidas, who stepped
-out of the woods only a few paces from the spot where
-the buck had stopped briefly to gaze back at him. Lifting
-his bow from the ground, Grey Squirrel started back to
-his family and his wigwam. In his heart were a warmth
-and peace that he had never felt before.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_137">137</div>
-<h2><span class="h2line1">4. HEROISM</span></h2>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_139">139</div>
-<h2 id="c25"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE FAWN AND THE WOLVES</span></h2>
-<p>It had been a very poor hunting year for the Choctaw
-Tribe. Little Fawn, daughter of Wolf&rsquo;s Tooth, sat in her
-wigwam, thinking about her hunger. Not just Little Fawn,
-but everyone in the village was beginning to feel the
-pangs of hunger. One month still remained before the ice
-would thaw in the lakes, and the fish would begin to swim
-again, and the young green sprouts of grass would burst
-through the earth and draw the game back to the hunting
-ground. A grave decision had to be made. When the
-Council had gathered, Wolf&rsquo;s Tooth rose up and spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We need food. If we are not to starve, we must organize
-a strong hunting party, and travel south to seek
-out the animals that have wandered from our hunting
-grounds.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>There were many grunts of approval. The decision was
-made that a great hunting party would leave the following
-day for the south. There was much dancing and
-preparation for the hunt. Tough hickory bows were tested
-again and again for weak spots. Sinew cords that were
-old or might have weak spots were cast aside, and new
-ones strung on the hickory bows. Knives and tomahawks
-were made ready. The tension mounted until dawn when
-the hunting party started from the village toward the
-south.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_140">140</div>
-<p>Little Fawn gazed slowly around the encampment and
-immediately noticed that all the strong young braves were
-gone. All that remained were the old men, the sick, the
-women and children. This bothered Little Fawn, until she
-thought to herself, &ldquo;What could happen? Nothing. We
-will be safe as long as we stay in our village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Before the men left on the trip, they had been so confident
-they would bring back home an ample supply of meat
-that they gave their families extra rations of meat and
-greens which they had been guarding well. Some of the
-families were careful and, though given plenty, still used
-the extra food sparingly; but many of the families could
-not resist the temptation to feast, and built up fires to
-cook the extra meat and greens. It was just this mistake
-that nearly cost many of the remaining Choctaw people
-their lives.</p>
-<p>Just as the families were sitting down to eat, a howl
-echoed from out of the forest and then another and another
-from different directions. The women became
-frightened and some of the children began to cry. Some
-of the men began to cry too, because they realized that
-they were old and sick and could give little help to the
-women and children against the danger that was now
-just outside their village.</p>
-<p>How well they knew the sounds which came from the
-forests on the edge of the camp! The wolves were hungry,
-for their hunting season had been a poor one too.
-These lean and starving savage beasts had been drawn to
-the outskirts of the village by the smell of the large quantities
-of meat cooking in the many vessels throughout the
-village. The howling continued, and it grew louder as
-many more voices joined the circle of wolves slowly closing
-in on the village.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_141">141</div>
-<p>Food and hunger were forgotten by the older squaws
-as they hurried to carry their children to the comparative
-safety of the wigwam. Suddenly, all were stricken with
-panic except Little Fawn. Though her little heart pounded
-in her breast, Little Fawn searched her mind for a solution
-to this threat of death to her people. She ran quickly
-to her home and there found her younger brother, Flying
-Squirrel, crouched in the corner of the wigwam, shaking
-with fear. Slowly she explained to him that he must stop
-shaking and listen carefully. Though only a young boy,
-she told him, he must now become a man. He must leave
-immediately upon the trail of the hunting party to bring
-help to the village while she, Little Fawn, stayed behind
-to do whatever she could to help her people.</p>
-<p>Flying Squirrel knew the job he must do. So he immediately
-set out upon the trail of the hunting party, helped
-by the bright moon and driven on by thoughts of his brave
-young sister who was staying behind to face this howling
-menace of a pack of wolves. Both fear and courage lent
-wings to his feet as he sped through the circle of wolves
-and down the trail in pursuit of the hunting party.</p>
-<p>Meanwhile, Little Fawn called two other young Indian
-girls to her and explained that the only reason the wolves
-were staying as far from the village was their fear of the
-many fires which still burned brightly in the village.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;So,&rdquo; Little Fawn said, &ldquo;it is our job to keep those fires
-burning all night, and to make torches and light them on
-the edge of the village to keep the wolves away.&rdquo; Reluctantly
-the girls agreed, and fires were built up. The three
-girls made torches of pine knots and placed them in a
-wide circle at the edge of the village.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_142">142</div>
-<p>All night they kept the fires burning, and all night the
-howling of the wolves kept up. With the coming of dawn,
-however, the wolves scurried back into the forest. Only
-then did the girls who had helped Little Fawn decide to
-take a much needed rest. But Little Fawn could not rest
-because she was so worried about her little brother,
-Flying Squirrel. At just about this time, he reached the
-hunting party and, after explaining what had happened,
-collapsed in the arms of his father.</p>
-<p>Wolf&rsquo;s Tooth chose a half dozen warriors and immediately
-started home for the village which was almost a
-full day&rsquo;s journey away.</p>
-<p>Back at the village, Little Fawn was busy gathering
-wood for the fires that coming evening. Soon many
-willing hands were helping in this task. As the day wore
-on, Little Fawn anxiously watched the south trail for
-signs of the returning warriors. As the sun began to set,
-Little Fawn began to wonder if Flying Squirrel had been
-able to reach Wolf&rsquo;s Tooth and his band. Little Fawn
-knew that the wolves would be back after the sun set.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_143">143</div>
-<p>It grew dark fast. Little Fawn went to look at the
-many torches around the village, lighting any that had
-gone out and preparing once again for the long wait. As
-she reached to set another torch ablaze, she heard a low,
-threatening growl almost beside her. Turning slowly
-around, Little Fawn found she was gazing into the sharp
-eyes of a hungry wolf who must have followed her right
-to this spot. Little Fawn drew back in fear until her back
-pressed against a hickory tree as the wolf crouched to
-spring. There was no escape and Little Fawn faced the
-wolf trembling. The wolf leaped. There was the sudden
-twang of a bowstring. A howl of agony came from the
-throat of the wolf as the arrow struck home. The rescue
-party had arrived just in time. Wolf&rsquo;s Tooth&rsquo;s arrow had
-found its mark. The rescue party killed most of the
-wolves and drove off the rest of the pack. All the next
-day Little Fawn and her brother, Flying Squirrel, were
-thanked and praised by her tribe.</p>
-<p>Wolf Tooth told them: &ldquo;I am very proud of my children.
-My son moves even more swiftly than a flying
-squirrel. My daughter may be as gentle as a little fawn,
-but she is braver than a pack of wolves.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_144">144</div>
-<h2 id="c26"><span class="h2line1">THE ISLAND</span></h2>
-<p>White Eagle was a young Iroquois boy. His favorite
-friend was Shining Star, a young Indian girl from his
-tribe. The small village in which they lived stood on the
-shore of a large and beautiful lake that could become very
-dangerous in a sudden storm.</p>
-<p>Scattered in the lake were many small islands. When
-parents were sure that their children could handle the
-tribe&rsquo;s canoes safely in the lake, they allowed them to
-explore these islands. A favorite sport of White Eagle and
-Shining Star was to paddle to one of these islands to
-search for berries and other wild fruit.</p>
-<p>One sunny summer day, White Eagle and Shining Star
-decided to take a canoe trip to one of the islands farthest
-from their village. As far as White Eagle knew, the island
-they planned to visit was at the other end of the long
-lake. Excitedly, the two children went down to the shore
-and set out on their adventure across the calm, blue lake.
-They enjoyed paddling in the sun because its beams
-seemed to warm them to their hearts.</p>
-<p>They had been paddling gaily and laughing a great
-deal for some time when Shining Star suddenly turned to
-White Eagle with an unhappy look on her pretty face.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;White Eagle,&rdquo; she said sadly, &ldquo;I am getting tired. I
-think we should visit one of the islands nearer home.
-I don&rsquo;t think I can help you paddle all the way across
-this great lake and back again.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_145">145</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Very well,&rdquo; said White Eagle kindly, &ldquo;there is an
-island over there that we have never visited before. We
-will go ashore there and hunt for berries.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Without saying any more, the children turned their
-canoe and headed for the island about one hundred
-paces away. Soon their canoe was scraping bottom on a
-sand bar that seemed to lead from the island into the
-water. Stepping from the canoe, White Eagle steadied it
-while Shining Star stepped ashore. Finally, he pulled the
-canoe up onto the shore so that it would not be carried
-away from the island into the lake and leave them
-stranded. Then, hand in hand, the children began to
-explore.</p>
-<p>Now these islands were not small and, if one were not
-careful, he could really get lost for a little while. So the
-children were careful to mark their trail with broken
-branches as they went. In their eagerness to explore this
-island they forgot what they had actually come for.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We have never been on this island before,&rdquo; said
-White Eagle. &ldquo;At least, I don&rsquo;t remember having been on
-it before now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; answered Shining Star. &ldquo;We have never been
-here before.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, the only thing to do is look around.&rdquo; Maybe
-White Eagle was thinking of himself as an Indian warrior
-when he added, &ldquo;Let&rsquo;s see if we can find any enemies.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, don&rsquo;t be silly, White Eagle! We won&rsquo;t find any
-enemies on this island,&rdquo; Shining Star said, laughing and
-forgetting how tired she had been.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Don&rsquo;t fool yourself, Shining Star. My father tells me
-that sometimes the enemy will set up camp on an island
-near a village to keep watch on the tribe. Then when
-they feel that the village is off guard, they attack.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_146">146</div>
-<p>White Eagle said this with such a serious face that
-Shining Star became frightened. &ldquo;Let&rsquo;s go home, White
-Eagle, I&rsquo;m afraid.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Don&rsquo;t be silly, little one, I was only fooling.&rdquo; (Now
-he played the part of a warrior again.) &ldquo;There is probably
-no living thing upon this island but ourselves. Come on!
-We&rsquo;re wasting time. Let&rsquo;s start exploring.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two children continued to investigate the island,
-always making sure that they were leaving a plain trail
-so that they could return to their canoe in safety. After
-several hours, they decided that there were no berries on
-this island so they might as well return home. They
-turned around and started back for the shore, trying to
-follow their trail carefully.</p>
-<p>Sooner than he had expected, White Eagle could see
-the lake waters, but when they reached the shore he
-realized that this was not where they had landed. And
-there was no canoe. Looking out across the water, White
-Eagle knew that they were on another side of the island.
-Perhaps they had followed a fresh trail someone else had
-left.</p>
-<p>Shining Star seated herself on a log about ten paces
-from the shore to rest and wait for White Eagle to make
-a decision.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, Shining Star,&rdquo; he said confidently, &ldquo;we will
-walk along the shore until we reach our canoe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So taking hands once again, the children started along
-the shore of the island. Suddenly, the sky became black,
-a strong wind came up, and dark storm clouds started
-moving in over the lake.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_147">147</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Hurry, Shining Star!&rdquo; he said with just a touch of fear
-in his voice. &ldquo;A storm is coming over the lake. We must
-hurry if we are to reach home before the waves get so
-high that we can&rsquo;t paddle our canoe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Shining Star started to run, but stumbled and fell,
-twisting her ankle. She cried out in pain and White Eagle
-knelt by her side.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, I&rsquo;ve hurt my ankle,&rdquo; Shining Star told him,
-holding back her tears.</p>
-<p>White Eagle lifted the young girl in his arms and
-started carrying her. Soon they reached the place where
-the canoe was beached. Placing her gently into the canoe,
-White Eagle shoved the canoe into the water and climbed
-inside.</p>
-<p>The sky had become very dark. They could hear thunder
-and see flashes of lightning across the lake. Rain was
-beginning to fall fast. Now even White Eagle was afraid,
-but he tried his best to hide his fear from Shining Star.
-Using all the strength he could muster, he paddled furiously
-toward home, but the winds now were pounding
-the light canoe and seemed to drive him further and
-further from their village. Shining Star lay quietly in the
-bow of the canoe. She was too brave an Indian girl to
-cry but her eyes, peering through the driving rain toward
-White Eagle&rsquo;s face, pleaded with him to get them safely
-home.</p>
-<p>And then, without warning, a great gust of wind
-caught the bow of the canoe and swung it hard. White
-Eagle leaned in the opposite direction to balance the
-canoe. Suddenly, the wind shifted. Before White Eagle
-had a chance to turn the bow into the wind, it caught the
-canoe again and, with a loud swish, turned it over into
-the lake.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_148">148</div>
-<p>Amidst his surprise and confusion White Eagle&rsquo;s first
-thought was for Shining Star. He heard the girl sputtering
-and coughing. He looked to see her head just appearing
-above the water beside the canoe. Reaching his hand out,
-he grasped her arm and pulled her to him. Then grasping
-the underside of the overturned canoe, he pulled Shining
-Star so that her arms rested on the canoe and she was
-able to grasp the keel.</p>
-<p>Thus the two children hung on for what seemed like
-hours but actually was only a few minutes. The water
-was cold. White Eagle began to shiver, not so much
-because the water was cold, but because the rain was
-colder and the biting wind made it even worse.</p>
-<p>And then as quickly as the storm had come, it was
-gone. White Eagle tried, but did not have the strength to
-hold on to Shining Star and turn the canoe. Just when
-he was giving up any chance of getting to shore, strong
-hands gripped his arms. It was then that White Eagle
-realized that he was losing consciousness. Everything
-went black.</p>
-<p>When he finally woke, he found that he was in his bed
-in his own wigwam. His mother was kneeling by him with
-a cup of hot broth. Slowly he sipped. And then he could
-hold back no longer.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My mother, what of Shining Star?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;She is all right, my son. You have done well this day.
-It was feared that you children would be caught in the
-storm, so your father and Shining Star&rsquo;s father set forth
-in their canoes and reached you both just as you were
-slipping from the canoe. You are a brave lad, White
-Eagle, and your father is proud as is the father of Shining
-Star. You saved her life and she was brave, as you were.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_149">149</div>
-<h2 id="c27"><span class="h2line1">A NEW BOW FOR TANI</span></h2>
-<p>Tani was a small Cherokee lad who lived during the
-great Hundred Years&rsquo; War between the Northern and
-Southern tribes. When he was twelve years old, Tani&rsquo;s
-only wish was to own a bow like his father&rsquo;s&mdash;a strong
-hickory bow with a stout hide thong and a quiver of
-straight strong arrows.</p>
-<p>Each time he would approach his father about owning
-such a bow, his father would laugh, and placing his hand
-on his son&rsquo;s head, tell him in a kindly voice that he was
-still a little too young to handle a man-sized hickory bow.
-This always made Tani feel a little sad because, being a
-boy of twelve, he thought he was man enough to own one.</p>
-<p>One day Tani&rsquo;s father called Tani to him and told him
-they would be going on a hunting trip and asked if he
-would like to go along. Tani was overjoyed and all he
-could think about for the next three days was the forthcoming
-trip with his father. When the time finally arrived,
-Tani prepared for the trip just as his father did and
-noticed his father place war paint on his face and chest
-and arms. Tani said good-bye to all, and when he said
-good-bye to his mother he noticed she was crying. He
-did not understand, for his father had not told him that
-the hunting trip they were going on was to seek out
-Talitanigska, one of the great Cherokee Chieftains, and
-report to him the movements of a large band of Seneca
-Indians. This was a very dangerous journey, for the
-Seneca Indians were deadly enemies of the Cherokee
-Tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_150">150</div>
-<p>As Tani and his father traveled swiftly along the back
-paths of the vast forests toward the encampment of
-Talitanigska, one thought kept rushing through the little
-brave&rsquo;s mind: What great adventure was his father leading
-him into? Tani soon learned the answer to this question.
-That evening, as Tani and his father were seated at
-a small guarded fire off to the side of the trail, Tani&rsquo;s
-father told him the nature of their task.</p>
-<p>The little brave&rsquo;s heart pounded as he learned the
-reason for their journey. That night as they rolled in
-their blankets and slept, Tani dreamed of many Seneca
-Indians attacking his father and himself and of his standing
-back to back with his father, beating off the attackers.</p>
-<p>When the dawn broke, Tani and his father were on
-their way. They were careful to avoid any soft earth that
-might leave signs for roving Senecas to find and follow.</p>
-<p>About midafternoon Tani&rsquo;s father turned into a shallow
-stream and started north against the current. Suddenly,
-his father slipped and fell heavily head first into the
-stream. Tani reached his father&rsquo;s side and found his father
-could not stand. He helped him ashore and seated him
-against the trunk of a tree on the bank. A gash was red
-with blood across the forehead of Tani&rsquo;s father. Tani saw
-that his father&rsquo;s ankle was badly twisted. Not a word was
-spoken, but Tani built a small fire and made his father as
-comfortable as possible.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_151">151</div>
-<p>For several hours as the sun slowly sank behind the
-hills, Tani&rsquo;s father worried about the situation he and
-his son were in. He was tired and he must have dozed,
-for he woke with a start as he felt his bow being lifted
-from his fingers. He watched in silence as Tani fitted an
-arrow to the bow, pulled back the string and let fly. The
-arrow buried itself in a near-by bush. There was a thud,
-followed by a terrifying scream. A Seneca sprang up and
-fell dead across the path. Tani rushed forward and,
-having made sure their enemy was dead, returned to his
-father&rsquo;s side. Without a word he continued his sleepless
-watch.</p>
-<p>The night passed without incident but as dawn approached,
-Tani heard a rustle in the near-by bush. He
-raised his bow ready to fire, but recognized the head
-feathers of his Cherokee brothers and let the bow drop
-to the ground. He leaped forward with a happy cry. The
-two braves were from Talitanigska&rsquo;s camp. They quickly
-made a sling hammock to carry Tani&rsquo;s father and soon
-the four of them set forth for the great Chieftain&rsquo;s camp.</p>
-<p>Once safely within the camp, Tani&rsquo;s father was well
-cared for and soon was able to stand once again on his
-injured foot. Two weeks after their arrival at Talitanigska&rsquo;s
-camp a great council fire was held to celebrate the
-victory of the Cherokees over their enemies, the Senecas.
-As the festivities came to a close, Talitanigska stepped
-to the center of the ring and asked that Tani step forward.
-Then, in front of the great Cherokee Chieftains, Talitanigska
-took his stout hickory bow from his shoulder and
-placed it in Tani&rsquo;s hands.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;This is for you, Tani,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;for you are a great
-brave and now a man among men. You stood full of
-courage in the face of great danger. Because of your
-quick thinking, you saved your father&rsquo;s life and made it
-possible for your father to bring me the valuable information.
-This information helped our fellow tribesmen to
-meet and defeat the Senecas, our enemies.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_152">152</div>
-<p>Tani did not know what to say; but the following
-morning, as he and his father prepared to leave, he
-stepped in front of Chief Talitanigska and thanked him
-for the gift. He said he would always cherish the great
-hickory bow and remember the great kindness shown him
-by one of the great Chiefs of the Cherokee nation. Tani
-had his bow, just like his father&rsquo;s. There was no happier
-brave alive as he tramped closely behind his father on the
-path home.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_153">153</div>
-<h2 id="c28"><span class="h2line1">SINGING WATERS AND THE MEDICINE WELL</span></h2>
-<p>Singing Waters&rsquo; work as an Indian maiden in the
-Teton-Dakota tribe was typical of the work of Indian
-maidens across the continent. Each year she would make
-new clothing for her family and each day of the year she
-would cook and do the many little things that were the
-duty of a good Indian squaw. The work was hard but
-Singing Waters did not mind, for she loved her husband
-and her children and was very happy and proud to be
-able to help them.</p>
-<p>When she found that she had some free time, Singing
-Waters would join the other women of the tribe to boast
-about her husband&rsquo;s great deeds on the hunt and in battle.
-This was a favorite pastime of all the squaws. They
-would spend many hours throughout the years to talk,
-over and over again about the adventures of their braves.
-Each time they would repeat the stories with even more
-enthusiasm.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_154">154</div>
-<p>One day, all the tribe&rsquo;s braves had left to hunt down
-a great buffalo herd for food and clothing for the tribe.
-Singing Waters was seated in front of her tepee, teaching
-her two daughters how to cook, when the morning sky
-grew suddenly very black. A great quiet fell upon the
-village. Even the dogs that seemed to spend their day
-barking for no good reason were silent. Singing Waters
-heard only the wind as it whispered through the village.</p>
-<p>Then from the distance, there came a rumble that
-seemed to come slowly nearer and nearer to the village.
-Singing Waters realized quickly that a dust storm was
-heading for her village. The other squaws had heard it,
-too, and were rushing to gather their children into their
-tepees and bind the skins across the entrances as tightly
-as they could. The dogs whimpered and scattered for
-whatever shelter they could find. The village did not have
-to wait long, for the winds were soon lashing against the
-tepees, straining their fastenings, and the dust was whipping
-through the village like a flood tide rushing over
-the rocks on the seashore.</p>
-<p>The dust reached into every opening in Singing
-Waters&rsquo; tepee. It wasn&rsquo;t long before a fine coating of it
-covered everything and everyone inside. Her two daughters
-huddled close to her, crying slightly because of their
-fear of the storm. But soon the wind blew out of the
-village, and the last dust clouds settled to the ground.
-One by one the flaps of the tepees swung back. Mothers,
-children and old men began to come out. They found
-that many things, left outside in the haste of escaping
-from the storm, were covered with coats of light brown
-dust. Everyone began cleaning up the village and sweeping
-away the dust which had piled up against the sides
-of the tepees.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_155">155</div>
-<p>While this was happening a young boy, named Fat
-Buffalo because he was short and very fat, came running
-through the village, crying that his mother was lost.
-Singing Waters halted him and shook him a little to
-make him stop his screaming. When he had quieted, she
-was able to learn that Brown Fawn, the boy&rsquo;s mother,
-had left the tepee early that morning to seek fresh water.
-She had been gone only a little while when the storm
-struck. Now she was not back in the tepee and Fat Buffalo
-was frightened.</p>
-<p>Singing Waters was worried, but did not tell Fat
-Buffalo. She knew that an Indian woman out in such a
-storm might easily fall under the stinging pelting of the
-sand, only to be smothered by it. She might never be
-found unless, years later, new storms should blow away
-the dust and reveal the dry bones of a skeleton and a few
-bits of her clothing. Though Singing Waters felt panic in
-her heart, she quieted herself and spoke calmly to Fat
-Buffalo.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Go back to your tepee, Fat Buffalo, and wait. Your
-mother probably found shelter from the storm. Now that
-it has stopped she will be home soon. If it will make you
-feel better, I will go and look for her. Return now to your
-tepee. I wouldn&rsquo;t be surprised if your mother were there
-already.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>How Singing Waters hoped that Brown Fawn was back
-in the village by now! It would be almost an impossible
-task to find her here on the plains if she were dead or
-even hurt. First, Singing Waters would not know in which
-direction to start. The water hole that she and most of
-the tribe used was to the south, but there were many
-water holes in many directions from the village. Singing
-Waters decided that she should go to Brown Fawn&rsquo;s tepee
-and find out if anyone else in the family knew in which
-direction she had gone.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_156">156</div>
-<p>After warning her two daughters to stay close to home,
-saying that she would be back shortly, Singing Waters
-ran swiftly through the village. Reaching Brown Fawn&rsquo;s
-tepee, she opened the tent flap and stepped inside. As her
-eyes grew used to the darkness, she saw Fat Buffalo
-kneeling in the far corner of the tepee, crying. Approaching
-slowly, Singing Waters saw that there was someone
-else in the tepee and that Fat Buffalo was kneeling next
-to that person. As she drew near, her heart was happy,
-for she thought that Brown Fawn had returned and was
-comforting Fat Buffalo. She was about to turn and leave
-when she suddenly realized that this woman was not
-Brown Fawn, but Fat Buffalo&rsquo;s grandmother, Little
-Otter, who held the boy&rsquo;s head on her lap.</p>
-<p>Singing Waters approached quietly and spoke softly
-to Little Otter. &ldquo;Has Brown Fawn returned yet with the
-water?&rdquo; she asked with slight hope in her voice.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; said Little Otter, &ldquo;and it was because of me
-that she went in search of water. We have some water
-here in the tepee. But I have not been feeling well, and
-Brown Fawn thought that herbs brewed in fresh spring
-water from the rocks on the near-by hills might make a
-tea which would help my sickness to leave.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But,&rdquo; said Singing Waters, &ldquo;the hills where the streams
-flow are many miles from here. If Brown Fawn left when
-the sun rose, then she might just have reached the spring
-when the storm came. She is probably on her way back to
-the village right now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The sad news about Brown Fawn soon reached everyone
-in the village. Many anxious eyes watched the trail
-that led from the hills. Each person hoped to be first to
-catch sight of Brown Fawn and bring happiness to Little
-Otter and Fat Buffalo.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_157">157</div>
-<p>Later that afternoon, Singing Waters came once again
-to Brown Fawn&rsquo;s tepee. She talked quietly with Little
-Otter and then hurried back to her tepee and placed a
-warm buffalo jacket across her shoulders. Then taking
-her two little daughters, she went to her sister&rsquo;s tepee and
-asked if she might leave the children there for supper
-while she went in search of Brown Fawn. Her sister
-looked at her and asked, &ldquo;Why do you not wait until the
-warriors return? They should be coming any time now,
-and they could go in search of Brown Fawn! You have
-two little children to think about.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; said Singing Waters, &ldquo;I have two little children
-to think about, but we do not know when the warriors
-will be back. If the hunting is good they may not return
-for another week. Brown Fawn may not be too far from
-the village.&rdquo; Nothing Singing Waters&rsquo; sister could say to
-her would change her mind. So she set out from the village
-toward the mountain spring known to the members
-of her tribe as the medicine well. It was getting late in
-the day, and Singing Waters knew that she must hurry
-if she were to reach the medicine well before sunset. She
-knew the trail well. As a girl she had followed it many
-times, for there always seemed to be some sickness in her
-village.</p>
-<p>Singing Waters finally came in sight of the ridge beyond
-which lay the medicine well, still having found no
-trace of Brown Fawn. Tirelessly, she trotted on until she
-had climbed the ridge and had worked her way to the
-place from which the water flowed into the medicine well.
-As Singing Waters approached the medicine well, she
-called Brown Fawn&rsquo;s name softly, but heard no answer.
-Then she began to call more loudly. Suddenly, from far
-ahead she heard a voice answer. Now Singing Waters
-began to run, for she feared that Brown Fawn was in
-serious trouble. She ran until she reached the side of the
-medicine well, but still did not see Brown Fawn. Then
-she called again and the voice answered. &ldquo;Help me, I
-am over here.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_158">158</div>
-<p>The voice was coming from beyond the medicine well.
-Singing Waters ran on further; then she stopped and
-called again. The voice replied again, and Singing Waters
-knew that she was closer. Brown Fawn&rsquo;s voice seemed to
-be coming from just behind a rise ahead of her. She ran
-swiftly to the top of the rise, and there she found a water
-bag. As she looked down the side of the rise through the
-gathering gloom she could make out Brown Fawn&rsquo;s figure
-down the side of the hill. She sat leaning against a boulder,
-and she called out to Singing Waters to help her.
-Singing Waters slipped and slid in her haste down the side
-of the hill until she was at the side of Brown Fawn.
-Brown Fawn was so glad to see her that she cried, great
-tears rolling down her now pale cheeks.</p>
-<p>Singing Waters could see that Brown Fawn had twisted
-her ankle. As she began to lift the injured woman, Singing
-Waters asked her how she had hurt herself and how she
-had escaped the storm. Brown Fawn told how she had
-reached the medicine well just as the dust storm had
-broken. After filling her water bag, she had turned quickly
-to go and had fallen, twisting her ankle. When she was
-once again able to rise, putting her weight on her other
-ankle, she found that she had lost all sense of direction
-and had started hobbling in the wrong direction.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why didn&rsquo;t you lie down among the rocks until the
-storm passed?&rdquo; Singing Waters asked.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I wanted to rest,&rdquo; Brown Fawn replied, &ldquo;but then I
-would think of my mother and son and I felt I must
-return to her and Fat Buffalo immediately with the
-medicine water.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_159">159</div>
-<p>&ldquo;But,&rdquo; said Singing Waters, &ldquo;you are safe now. Now
-we must return to the village while there is still a little
-light or we may become lost out here on the prairie far
-away from the warmth of our tepees. Come, Brown Fawn,
-lean upon me and I will help you to walk.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So Brown Fawn placed her arm across Singing Waters&rsquo;
-shoulders. Together they slowly started back to the village.
-It was dark by the time they had reached the fringe
-of the village, but bright fires had been lighted to show
-them the way home. There was much rejoicing as Singing
-Waters entered the village half carrying Brown Fawn.
-Gentle hands grasped Brown Fawn and placed her gently
-upon the buffalo robe in her tepee. Soon her eyelids
-flickered and she opened them wide, looking around for a
-face which meant much to her. But Singing Waters had
-returned to her own home and her children and was
-recounting for them the adventure she had just had. They
-smiled, knowing that their mother was a woman of great
-courage. They were very proud.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_160">160</div>
-<h2 id="c29"><span class="h2line1">THE WAR THAT SHOULD NOT HAVE HAPPENED</span></h2>
-<p>Little Turtle was a young Comanche who lived happily
-with his mother, father, and two older brothers on the
-great prairies. His father was well respected by the tribe,
-above all for having three sons who would grow to
-manhood and bring honor to the Comanche name.</p>
-<p>Each day was a new adventure for Little Turtle and
-he welcomed each dawn with great excitement. He never
-knew just what was planned for him or what the other
-children of the village would decide to do, but he was
-always ready to take part in whatever would happen.</p>
-<p>For some time now, Little Turtle, who had just turned
-ten, had been in the complete charge of his father. On
-certain days his father would take him far from the
-village to hunt and learn how to stalk wild game and
-find their signs. He learned his lessons well. At night in
-the tepee, he would sit next to his father because he was
-the youngest, and he would listen carefully while his
-father explained many things a young brave must know
-to become a strong and great Comanche warrior.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_161">161</div>
-<p>Because the Comanche village had been at peace for
-the last three years, Little Turtle had only love in his
-heart for everyone he knew or met. Sometimes his
-brothers and his father would speak to him of the hated
-Apache and Kiowa and the many reasons the Comanches
-had for hating them. But this meant very little to the lad.
-He never let such thoughts of war spoil his fun.</p>
-<p>One evening after the three boys were asleep, Little
-Turtle&rsquo;s father spoke with his mother.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Blue Star,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;for many days now I have talked
-to our youngest son of the Apaches and the Kiowas, but
-he does not seem to understand. I have told him of their
-many cruel ways and about our warriors who have fallen
-under the arrow and the tomahawk of the Apaches and
-the Kiowas. Still he refuses to speak harshly of such
-neighbors. Maybe Little Turtle is right. Maybe I am
-wrong in hating these neighbors to the north. You are
-wise, Blue Star. Your advice is often sought. Tell me now
-what I should teach our son. Shall I teach him to hate the
-horse stealers from the north? Or shall I not speak even
-their names in our daily talks?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Blue Star thought for a moment and then said, &ldquo;My
-husband and great warrior of the Comanches, hatred is
-a word which Little Turtle will learn soon enough. Now
-he is young and innocent. He enjoys the coming of each
-new day for the adventures that it will bring in his world
-of dreams. He is a happy child and to us a very wonderful
-boy. Do we want to change this wonderful boy to a
-grown warrior filled with hate? He knows nothing but
-love. Possibly peace will be a long time upon our village.
-We, his parents, would not want to spoil that happy
-world in which he lives.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_162">162</div>
-<p>Great Hawk thought long about his wife&rsquo;s words. Then
-he left the tepee to walk alone and solve this problem
-which lay so heavily upon his heart. Since his early days,
-Great Hawk had been taught to hate the Apaches and the
-Kiowas. His own father had lost his life in a battle with
-the Apaches. His brother&rsquo;s hair now hung from the tepee
-of Grey Wolf, the Kiowa chieftain who sat at the head of
-the council lodge. And Grey Wolf was a cruel leader of a
-tribe that always looked for enemies to kill.</p>
-<p>Great Hawk knew that he had strong personal reasons
-for hating the tribes to the north. But was it right for
-him to think of punishing his son for not hating them,
-too, in the way he did? Until he had talked with Blue
-Star, he had planned to question his son tomorrow about
-the Apaches and Kiowas, and if his son did not show a
-growing hatred toward them, then he would punish him.
-But now he was not sure. No, he would wait and be
-patient. After all, as Blue Star had said, there had been
-peace for three years now. Thoughts of war were kept
-alive only by the young bucks of the tribe who were eager
-for battle and glory. War was far from the minds of the
-older and wiser men of the tribe. They knew that peace
-had brought them prosperity and happiness, but war
-made them poor and brought them hunger and pain and
-the death of friends.</p>
-<p>Great Hawk began thinking about Crooked Leg, one
-of the chieftains. He was the only member of the council
-of Comanche chieftains who was not happy that war had
-not come again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_163">163</div>
-<p>Early in his youth Crooked Leg had fallen into the
-hands of the Kiowas and had been tortured badly. When
-his body was found being dragged by a Kiowa pony that
-had been turned loose, he had been beaten and twisted
-so badly that he lay close to death for many months. He
-had lived, but his leg had never healed straight. He
-always rose in pain and could never run again. Crooked
-Leg had stayed behind in the village during all later
-battles. His hate for the Kiowa had grown until he now
-thought about it all the time. At council meetings, he
-would always argue that the Comanches should once
-again take to the warpath against the Apaches and
-Kiowas. Each time he spoke, only a few council members
-would agree with him. So Crooked Leg was asked to be
-quiet while the council talked about tribal business. But
-the young bucks who thirsted for the taste of battle would
-carry his words through the village after each council
-meeting. For many days, the village would talk for war
-and against war. Soon the wise council members would
-win out, the bucks would quiet down, and Crooked Leg
-would be left to grumble in his tepee alone and forgotten
-for awhile.</p>
-<p>Crooked Leg&rsquo;s life had a lesson for Great Hawk. As
-he was returning to his tepee, he promised himself that
-he would not speak of hatred again to his son. He must
-not allow hatred to run his life as it had run Crooked
-Leg&rsquo;s. If he did, even his friends might forget him and he
-would be of little use to anyone.</p>
-<p>The following day promised little peace. Dawn brought
-a roaring storm that smashed at the Comanche village.
-The pounding rain had soon churned the ground into
-deep mud. Families remained indoors and fathers sat
-around their fires teaching sons how to make stout bows
-and straight arrows, knives, tomahawks, and other handmade
-tools a young brave needs to survive. Great Hawk
-used the time to talk to Little Turtle of the great powers
-of nature and peace and the Comanche people.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_164">164</div>
-<p>&ldquo;As you grow,&rdquo; he told Little Turtle, &ldquo;remember to
-stay straight and true and do all things that are right, and
-you shall live a rich and happy life in our tribe. The
-Comanches have been favored greatly. We have lived in
-peace for the past three years and though it has been
-very dry, we have never been without water. Now the
-sky has opened and allowed the rains to fall so that we
-have water for our families and our horses. We have not
-suffered from great thirst since the great drought visited
-our land when we were last at war. After two years the
-supply of water was so small that our people were dying
-more from the great thirst than from the arrows of the
-enemy. Before long our chiefs sat down in council with
-our enemies to smoke the peace pipe. Now peace reigns
-over our people and they have plenty of food and water.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Turtle had listened carefully while his father was
-speaking, then turned to his mother and said, &ldquo;Mother,
-I am a very lucky boy to be a Comanche and to have
-such a wonderful family. I have a strong, wise, and kind
-father. You have cared for me as a baby and given me
-good food so that my bones would grow strong and
-straight. And I have two brothers of whom I am very
-proud.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Blue Star smiled happily and began to make lunch.
-While the family was eating, the rain stopped. Soon the
-sun broke through the dark clouds and began to dry the
-earth. In the middle of the afternoon, Great Hawk rose
-and touched his son upon the shoulder.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, Little Turtle,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It is time you learned
-to ride a horse. We will go to my string of ponies and
-pick one that you may ride and call your own. If you are
-to go on the hunt and take part in the many other riding
-events in the village, you must learn to ride well.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_165">165</div>
-<p>Little Turtle&rsquo;s heart leaped excitedly. He had been
-looking forward to the day his father would teach him to
-ride. Slowly Great Hawk and his son walked to where
-the tribe&rsquo;s ponies were kept tied. Great Hawk began to
-look amongst the herd for a special pinto pony he had
-planned to give Little Turtle. It was small but strong and
-could run for a long time without getting winded. Great
-Hawk saw quickly that something was wrong. He began
-counting and discovered that three of his string, including
-the pinto, were gone. At first he thought that the storm
-had frightened them and they had broken loose from the
-main line which held the whole string. But as he reached
-the main line where the three ponies should have been
-tied, he saw the dangling ends of ropes that had been cut
-by a knife.</p>
-<p>The pony guard must have left the herd to seek shelter
-during the storm. So it was easy for someone to steal his
-three ponies. Without thinking of Little Turtle, Great
-Hawk knelt in the mud to look closely at the clear tracks
-that the thieves had left. He rose to his feet quickly.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The Apaches have stolen my ponies!&rdquo; he cried out
-defiantly. &ldquo;I shall ride after them and bring the ponies
-back even if blood must be shed!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then he remembered Little Turtle. &ldquo;Go, Little Turtle,&rdquo;
-he ordered. &ldquo;Return to the tepee and explain to your
-mother what I must do. The Apaches have stolen three
-of my best ponies. I must ride fast to catch up with them
-before they get too far into the hills. I shall not rest until
-the ponies are back in our village or the scalps of the
-Apache thieves hang in our tepee.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then Great Hawk jumped onto a pony and sped off
-toward the hills.</p>
-<p>Little Turtle ran home and told his mother and
-brothers what had happened.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_166">166</div>
-<p>Little Turtle&rsquo;s brothers had been two of the young
-bucks who had agreed with Crooked Leg&rsquo;s war talk. So
-they rushed out of the tepee, happy for this chance to
-fight. They stopped outside their tepee just long enough
-to pick up their weapons and shout the news to other
-young bucks of the tribe. Many of the young braves
-rallied quickly, grabbed their weapons, and dashed
-toward their ponies. This was just what Great Hawk had
-wanted to prevent. He thought that if he could overtake
-the thieves he would be able to bring them back as prisoners.
-Then the council of chieftains would decide how
-their stealing should be punished.</p>
-<p>Only three Indians&mdash;not a large Apache band&mdash;were
-fleeing with the ponies. Great Hawk saw this clearly from
-the tracks he was following. He thought it might be three
-young Apache bucks who wanted to start trouble and
-had turned to stealing horses as a way of making the
-Comanches angry enough to fight. He must hurry, for if
-he did not reach the thieves before they got to the safety
-of the hills, he would have to report their escape to the
-council. Even the older Comanche chieftains probably
-would decide that war was the only answer.</p>
-<p>When he reached the base of the hills, Great Hawk lost
-the trail of the thieves in the rocks. Slowly, he turned his
-mount and started for the village. This would now mean
-war. Great Hawk turned back toward the hills. Shaking
-his fist at the Apaches&rsquo; stronghold, he swore vengeance
-upon them. As he headed for home again, he met the
-war party of young Comanche bucks, led by his two sons.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait!&rdquo; he said, raising his hand. &ldquo;Why do you ride so
-hard?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We ride to avenge the theft of your horses,&rdquo; Great
-Hawk&rsquo;s oldest son replied. &ldquo;We will catch the Apache
-party and soak the foothills with their blood. No matter
-how many they are, we shall defeat them!&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_167">167</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait!&rdquo; Great Hawk pleaded. &ldquo;There were only three
-men. They are already in the hills. We will lose many men
-if we try to attack them here. We do not know this
-ground, but the Apaches know it well. We must take this
-problem to our council.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Just as Great Hawk spoke of the council, Crooked Leg
-rode out from amidst the young warriors. Great Hawk
-had not seen the old warrior who rode up close to Great
-Hawk.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Out of the way, old and weak one,&rdquo; Crooked Leg
-screamed. &ldquo;You are afraid of these thieving vultures who
-steal from us under cover of a great storm. We are not
-afraid and we will go on until we find them. We have sat
-back too long getting fat and lazy on the buffalo meat.
-We have closed our eyes to the Apaches&rsquo; great war plans
-against our village!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>There were many shouts of approval from the young
-bucks, who were starting to move about impatiently.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait!&rdquo; shouted Great Hawk above the yelling of the
-young Comanche braves. &ldquo;This long-planned war plan
-against our village was carried out by just three braves,
-as the trail will show you. They did not attack. They
-killed no one. They only stole three horses. This was no
-attack by the Apache tribe. It was probably the work of
-three young bucks, like many of you here, who could
-not be held back. They went off on their own to try to
-stir up trouble between our two tribes. They baited the
-trap and you are riding right into it. What has happened
-here must be settled by our council. Do not let Crooked
-Leg drive you into something you will regret the rest of
-your lives&mdash;if you live to regret it!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The young men grew quiet as Great Hawk was
-speaking.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_168">168</div>
-<p>&ldquo;And now I speak directly to my two sons,&rdquo; he continued.
-&ldquo;I, your father, order you to return with me to
-our tepee.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>But the fire that Crooked Leg had been building for
-so long burst into flame again as he urged the young
-bucks to go on. They surged forward toward the hills.
-Great Hawk was forced to rein his pony aside to avoid
-being run into. He knew that if Crooked Leg succeeded
-in clashing with the Apaches, he, Great Hawk, would
-lose importance in the tribe. But if Crooked Leg were
-defeated at the hands of the Apaches, the council would
-deliver fair judgment and punishment.</p>
-<p>The young Comanche men had never fought before
-and might be defeated easily. So for the sake of his sons,
-Great Hawk turned his pony and fell in with the young
-bucks. When they saw that he had joined them, they
-urged their ponies ahead at a faster pace.</p>
-<p>Soon they were deep in the hills of the Apaches. The
-party halted, and Great Hawk moved to the front. Grasping
-the bridle on Crooked Leg&rsquo;s pony he swung the animal
-around sharply.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You will ride no farther,&rdquo; he told the old warrior.
-&ldquo;I command you to go back to our village now. We have
-no idea where the horse thieves are. You are willing to
-gamble the lives of these brave young Comanches to
-satisfy a hate that burns deeply in your heart and mind.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>While Crooked Leg watched him angrily, Great Hawk
-spoke to the young men.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_169">169</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Your wish to see justice done is good,&rdquo; he began.
-&ldquo;But the Apache has great strength, even greater here in
-his own home. We are few and most of us have never
-fought. If we fight here, our scalps will hang in the tepee
-of the Apaches before nightfall. Do not follow Crooked
-Leg any longer. What he suggests can bring only death
-to yourselves and much sadness to your families. We must
-return to the council and seek the wise advice of our
-chieftains.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Great Hawk could see that his words were beginning
-to have an effect. He continued talking to the young
-bucks until their ranks began to break as a few turned
-their mounts toward home. Others followed, and
-Crooked Leg started screaming at them to come back
-and follow him to glory in the defeat of the Apaches.
-Then, just as the last few braves were heading back down
-the trail, the hills suddenly bristled with Apache warriors,
-each aiming an arrow at a young Comanche brave. As
-Great Hawk looked slowly around, he saw that there were
-twenty times more Apache than Comanche warriors.</p>
-<p>The Comanche party was stunned. No one moved.
-Then one brave made a grab for his tomahawk. Great
-Hawk slapped his arm, saying, &ldquo;Do not be a fool. You
-would be dead before your hand touched the tomahawk
-handle. Right now at least a dozen arrows are aimed at
-your body. Your tepee will be unhappy tonight if you
-are so foolish.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then Great Hawk rode out a little apart from the
-rest of the band. Raising his empty hands, he called to
-the Apaches.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Who among you is the leader, for it is with him that
-I wish to talk?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>A tall, strong brave stepped from behind a boulder and
-made his way to the circle of warriors.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I, Maskan, am leader here,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;Why do you
-ride into our lands in such haste and with such anger on
-your faces?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_170">170</div>
-<p>Then Great Hawk explained the events that had led up
-to this moment. When he finished, the Apache leader
-signaled, and three young Kiowa bucks were dragged
-from behind the boulders into plain sight of the Comanche
-party.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;These,&rdquo; said Maskan, &ldquo;are the three who stole your
-horses and ours. Their blood has run hot with the desire
-for adventure. So all alone, they set out last evening to
-invade your land and ours to steal horses. We have waited
-for them here among the rocks. We have watched you
-from the time they were taken by our warriors. You who
-seem to lead here have spoken wisely. The Kiowas will
-be punished as all Kiowa are in the Apache nation. We
-have your horses. They will be yours again. We ask you
-to go in peace from these hills. You have come in anger.
-Now you can leave in friendship. The older men of your
-tribe and ours know the trouble we are having with our
-young braves who want the glory of battle. One day war
-will come when the chieftains who want it are strong
-enough to convince the council. That day is not far away.
-But now return in peace to your village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Maskan turned and started for the boulder before
-Great Hawk could thank him. Maskan told his braves to
-bring out the stolen horses. At that moment Crooked Leg
-slipped his tomahawk from his belt and sent it sailing
-toward the Apache leader. It landed with a thud in the
-middle of Maskan&rsquo;s back. Maskan cried out and fell to
-the ground, rolling in the dust. Immediately, Crooked
-Leg&rsquo;s body was filled with arrows as shaft after shaft
-whined through the air. War whoops split the air as the
-Comanches rose to attack the Apaches who dodged behind
-the rocks that had sheltered them before.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_171">171</div>
-<p>Great Hawk realized that it would be useless to attempt
-any talk of peace now. With a sinking feeling in his heart
-he, too, joined the battle, struggling to reach his two
-sons. The great numbers of Apaches, well protected by
-large boulders, made the victory easy for them. The
-young Comanches fell under the hail of Apache arrows,
-and their war cries became screams of pain.</p>
-<p>Then Great Hawk yelled to the warriors to retreat.
-The riddled band rushed toward their village. Sixteen
-young Comanche braves lay dead on the ground and
-seven strong Indian ponies were dead or dying. It was a
-ragged, tired, and bloody war party that entered the
-Comanche village that night. Badly beaten, their spirit
-defeated, they understood now that war was not as glorious
-as they had thought. As Great Hawk entered his
-tepee alone, Blue Star greeted him warmly but with fright
-in her eyes.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Where are our two sons, Great Hawk?&rdquo; she asked.
-Great Hawk looked at his wife and then at Little Turtle.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Turtle, you have never learned to hate and
-you know nothing of war. Now both hatred and war
-must shatter your world of dreams. Your two brothers
-lie out there in the foothills, killed by sharp, well-aimed
-Apache arrows. They and fourteen others will no longer
-walk this earth with us. Among them lies Crooked Leg,
-who is to blame for these deaths today. Many Apaches
-and Comanches will yet die in a battle that never should
-have begun.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>From that day forward, Little Turtle left his dream
-world and walked in the real world of warring tribes,
-learning to hate his tribe&rsquo;s enemies, to fight and revenge
-the death of his brothers.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_172">172</div>
-<p>The war continued for some time. Many Apache and
-Comanche braves were killed and injured. The council of
-Comanche chieftains met to discuss better ways of fighting
-the Apaches. Great Hawk, who had led so many
-attacks against the Apaches, stood in the council to
-speak. As he spoke, Little Turtle listened from just outside
-the lodge where he lay hidden.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I, Great Hawk, have fought many battles with the
-Apaches. I am tired but I will fight as long as we must.
-Before this war started, I had great hate in my heart for
-the Apaches and Kiowas, as many of you know. I tried
-to teach this to my son. I know now how wrong I was.
-My son could not bring himself to hate someone or
-something he had not seen and who had done him no
-harm. On that unhappy day which could have ended
-peacefully, Crooked Leg sent a tomahawk into the back
-of Maskan, a brave and fair-minded warrior who tried to
-keep the peace. Then the war started. Two of my sons
-fell dead at my side, but still I fought on. When we who
-were left managed to escape with our lives and return
-to our village, I had to break the sad news to my family.
-Yet from that moment I held no hate for the Apaches.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My oldest boys had gone from our village to follow
-Crooked Leg, a man whose whole life has been one of
-hate. They died because of that hate, though they died
-bravely, fighting as Comanches should. But now my
-youngest son has learned to hate as his brothers did and
-I am worried deeply. War comes with hate and is worse
-than disease or drought. The Comanches have always
-fought honorably, but Crooked Leg&rsquo;s act will always
-dishonor our tribe. We cannot seek peace until we have
-cleansed our hearts of hate. We must do this for the
-happiness and well-being of our children and their
-children.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_173">173</div>
-<p>The council was silent for several moments after Great
-Hawk had spoken. Then one of the head chiefs rose
-slowly and looked directly at Great Hawk. &ldquo;You have
-spoken wisely, Great Hawk,&rdquo; he began. &ldquo;We must think
-this over carefully. If we want peace, it must be genuine
-and honorable. Let us go back to our tepees. Let us call
-the council to meet in two suns and make our decision
-then.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When Great Hawk returned to his tepee, his son was
-waiting for him, having run ahead.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not be troubled, father,&rdquo; Little Turtle said, &ldquo;for
-I have driven the hate from my heart. I hope this war
-will end soon and that there will be no room in anyone&rsquo;s
-heart for hate. For hate eats men&rsquo;s hearts and makes them
-like Crooked Leg, unhappy and selfish and cruel, bringing
-death and sorrow to those around them. These things
-are not for the Comanches.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_174">174</div>
-<h2 id="c30"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE HORSE AND THE PAINTED ARROW</span></h2>
-<p>Little Horse was a member of the proud and courageous
-Delaware tribe. He grew up in his tribe among a
-people who were peaceful. They hunted and fished and
-sang and danced and celebrated much as most tribes did
-in the very early days, but there was to come a time when
-all was not peace and contentment.</p>
-<p>Little Horse had been well trained by his father, Running
-Bear, and he had taken his lessons as a young boy
-very seriously. Though he had practiced very hard, he
-had never become very good with the bow and arrow or
-the tomahawk. But he had become very good at using
-and throwing the traditional hunting knife which was his
-proudest possession.</p>
-<p>It was spring in the valley of the Delawares and day
-followed day with the peaceful and warm sun shining
-down upon the village in which Little Horse lived. Occasionally
-the soft rains would descend on the forest and
-hillside making everything wet and a rich green color. All
-was happiness in the village until that fateful day when
-Little Horse decided to take his long trip.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_175">175</div>
-<p>Shouldering his stout bow and a quiver of arrows he
-started out along the forest trail. He desired to go to the
-upper end of the valley and search out some wild turkey
-which he had heard many of the returning hunters speak
-about. The fact that the place where these turkeys lived
-was almost a day&rsquo;s journey from his village did not seem
-to bother him, for he had placed in his food pouch
-enough dried venison and he would have berries and nuts
-along the way.</p>
-<p>As he walked along, he looked from side to side
-watching for signs of wild game, not wanting to kill any
-so close to home but wanting to test his senses of hearing
-and sight which had been trained by his father so
-patiently.</p>
-<p>Once in a while, Little Horse would stop in his journey
-to partake of some fresh water or just to rest on a moss
-patch under some large tree and think about the wonders
-of nature and the wonderful peace in his tribe.</p>
-<p>Then he would rise and continue his journey which
-took him further and further from home with each step.
-And not realizing it, he had soon crossed into the land
-of the Iroquois, for his particular tribe had their village
-close to the line which separated the lands of the Delawares
-from the hunting grounds of the Iroquois.</p>
-<p>This talk of tribal lands and borders did not mean
-much to Little Horse, although he had heard his father
-speak quite often of the Iroquois; and though he had
-been told never to wander too far from the village, he felt
-he was grown up enough by this time to take care of
-himself. One other thing which meant very little to Little
-Horse was the fact that in this period, neighboring tribes
-were often at war with each other, for war between tribes
-was rather common among the American Indians. Stealing
-and quarreling among individuals and trespassing
-upon hunting grounds were but a few reasons for this
-constant state of war and feuding. But to a young lad
-like Little Horse, who was so wrapped up in his desire to
-hunt the elusive turkey, war and fighting were the furthest
-things from his mind.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_176">176</div>
-<p>Meanwhile Running Bear, back at the village, was
-asking about for his son, for today he was to have taken
-him fishing in the great lake. No one seemed to know
-where the boy was until Running Bear asked a group of
-children playing on the edge of the village, and one of
-them replied that he had seen Little Horse with his food
-pouch at his belt and his bow over his shoulder trotting
-up the trail that led to the north and into the land of the
-Iroquois.</p>
-<p>Fear gripped Running Bear&rsquo;s heart. Just that morning
-one of the hunters had returned from the forest to tell of
-having found three Iroquois painted arrows stuck in the
-ground in a row, which was a sign of open warfare and
-he had the three arrows gripped in his hand which had
-been found close by to the village. This could mean but
-one thing. For some reason the Iroquois had been
-aroused, and now no Delaware would be safe alone any
-great distance from the home encampment. As long as
-this open warfare lasted, now they would have to travel
-in groups.</p>
-<p>Running Bear feared for his son. So Running Bear
-gathered a few of his friends, and in a group they started
-up the trail toward the land of the Iroquois, hoping that
-Little Horse had not gone too far after all.</p>
-<p>But they were to be sadly disappointed, for Little
-Horse at this moment was deep in Iroquois territory on
-the trail of wild turkey.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_177">177</div>
-<p>As Little Horse walked silently along the forest trails,
-he suddenly realized that it had become very quiet. He
-stopped to listen for the song of the birds but he heard
-none. He even found it so quiet that the breeze sounded
-like a windstorm. Someone or something else was near
-by, for only for that reason would all the forest creatures
-grow silent.</p>
-<p>Then he heard the call of one solitary bird ahead and
-off to the left. And then behind him to the right he heard
-a similar call and then Little Horse knew.</p>
-<p>It came upon him suddenly like a thundering in his
-ears. He realized that he was no longer in Delaware
-country, for this was the call of the Iroquois which his
-father had taught to him. But what had he to fear? The
-Delawares and the Iroquois were not at war, and so he
-boldly shouldered his bow and turned to start for home
-down the trail. But before he had taken two steps there
-was a loud whooping from many directions and before
-Little Horse could do anything, he was surrounded and
-his arms pinned by four husky Iroquois braves. One of
-them brandishing a shining knife was about to take the
-boy&rsquo;s life when another brave stepped from the brush and
-spoke, &ldquo;Put down your knife. This Delaware is tall, but
-he is only a boy.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But he is still a Delaware,&rdquo; cried the brave, holding
-the knife close to the heart of Little Horse.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No matter, he is young and strong. We will take him
-back to the village with us. We have not had much sport
-these days of late. This young one will make a fair game
-for us. We will have him run the gauntlet to see whether
-he will be permitted to live. I, Crooked Hand, have
-spoken.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_178">178</div>
-<p>Little Horse then realized that Crooked Hand must be
-some sort of leader in the tribe, for there was no more
-argument. The arms of Little Horse were then tightly
-bound behind him and he was roughly shoved along the
-trail toward the village from whence these warriors had
-come. His weapons had been gathered, and one of the
-braves carried these as the party trotted easily along the
-trail, pressing Little Horse before them.</p>
-<p>It was not too long after this that Running Bear and
-his rescue party arrived at the place where the struggle
-had taken place. It was soon evident to all the braves in
-the party that Little Horse had been taken prisoner, for
-once past the marks of the struggle, it was easy to pick
-out the markings of his moccasins in the soft earth of the
-trail and Little Horse had made sure to come down
-heavily on his feet in order to leave a trail plain enough
-for any who might follow to see.</p>
-<p>Running Bear and his party pressed forward, going
-more stealthily now, for they were deep in the territory
-of the Iroquois and from all signs quite close to the village.
-Suddenly Running Bear stopped and signaled the
-party to flatten themselves upon the ground. Through
-the trees he had seen the feather of an Iroquois and,
-hardly daring to breathe, they waited. Detection now
-would mean almost certain death, for they were tired
-from their long race through the forest and the Iroquois,
-being close to home and fresh, would have made easy
-victims of the Delawares.</p>
-<p>The lone Iroquois brave had stopped and looked
-around and then satisfying himself that nothing out of
-the ordinary was around had continued along the trail in
-pursuit of the rest of his party which had Little Horse
-captive.</p>
-<p>Running Bear, when he felt it was safe, gathered his
-friends about him and then spoke in a whisper.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_179">179</div>
-<p>&ldquo;We will wait until it is dark and then I will approach
-the village and see if it would be possible for us to rescue
-Little Horse and return to our village. It is very late and
-surely he will not be in danger tonight, for the thieving
-Iroquois will go into council to decide what to do with
-him. He is definitely a prisoner and most likely since he
-is young and strong but yet a boy they will make him
-run the gauntlet tomorrow as a test as to whether he will
-be permitted to live or must die.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When darkness fell, Running Bear slipped through the
-forest to the edge of the Iroquois village and there,
-hidden in the brush, he was able to view the happenings
-in the village. He noticed one particular wigwam being
-well guarded and this he presumed was where Little
-Horse was being held prisoner. Then as his eyes wandered
-about the village he noticed a number of older men
-entering the large council lodge.</p>
-<p>This was a fairly large village of the Iroquois, and
-Running Bear felt that it would be useless for his small
-band to attempt a rescue of Little Horse.</p>
-<p>Suddenly he heard a slight rustling to the side of the
-trail and peering into the darkness he saw the figure of a
-brave approaching the trail. He waited and when the
-brave was almost upon him he reached out and throwing
-his arms around the throat of the Iroquois he drove his
-knife into the brave&rsquo;s heart.</p>
-<p>Without a sound the Iroquois slipped to the ground.
-Running Bear turned and fled back through the forest.
-They must leave the land quickly, for as soon as the dead
-brave was discovered a large party would be sent to look
-for the killers. So as soon as Running Bear had returned
-to his friends they made a hasty retreat from the vicinity
-of the village and, running at a steady pace, returned to
-their village to report the findings. Running Bear planned
-to gather a large force and the following evening they
-would attack the Iroquois village and seek to rescue
-Little Horse.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_180">180</div>
-<p>Meanwhile Little Horse sat in the wigwam of the
-Iroquois village awaiting the decision of the council and
-it was not long in coming. Soon a rather tall Iroquois
-brave entered and standing in the doorway he informed
-Little Horse that the council had agreed to spare his life
-if tomorrow he could prove himself worthy of the gift of
-life by running the gauntlet.</p>
-<p>When the sun was directly overhead he would be
-placed at the head of two rows of Iroquois and at a given
-signal would run the gauntlet of war clubs prepared for
-him.</p>
-<p>It would be ridiculous to say that Little Horse was not
-frightened, for at this particular time Little Horse was a
-very scared little brave. He had known nothing but comfort
-and warmth and friendliness since the day he was
-born, and the loving care and kindness of his family and
-friends had been his only contact with Indian life. Here
-in the village of a tribe which he had not thought to be
-hostile, he suddenly found himself a prisoner and about
-to be forced to run the gauntlet of war clubs.</p>
-<p>He had heard a great deal about the gauntlet from his
-father who had witnessed the gauntlet and had told of
-his experience as one of the line of braves making up
-the gauntlet when they dealt with some of their prisoners.</p>
-<p>Little Horse was afraid, and his fear kept him from
-resting his body for the coming ordeal. Then in the midst
-of this fear which gripped his heart, Little Horse remembered
-the words of his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_181">181</div>
-<p>&ldquo;My son,&rdquo; Running Bear had said to him one day,
-&ldquo;if ever you should find yourself in trouble or in danger,
-remember that you are a Delaware and the Delawares
-are a strong and proud people. Rest as much as you can,
-force your body to relax so that you may be prepared for
-whatever ordeal you must face. You have been taught
-every skill possible except the skill of courage. This you
-must have in your heart and if courage abides in your
-heart as the beaver in the stream, then fear can be overcome
-and one can consider himself prepared for any
-hardship which may lie ahead.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Remembering those words was great comfort to Little
-Horse and again and again he kept repeating them to
-himself. Soon the chill that seemed to be in his body left
-him and the cold fear that gripped his heart released its
-hold and he was calm once again. When his body relaxed
-and his mind was at ease, Little Horse slept.</p>
-<p>No sense to worry over what tomorrow will bring, but
-remember the words of Running Bear. Twice more he
-repeated the words of his father to himself and with that
-he was asleep.</p>
-<p>He had not been asleep long when the door of the
-wigwam was darkened by two of the braves who had
-aided in his capture that afternoon. As they viewed the
-boy asleep on the floor, the taller of the two spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He sleeps. Look how calm his face is. Notice the
-slight smile upon his lips. This is the sign of a growing
-warrior. Courage burns deep in his heart. For even now,
-knowing that tomorrow he may have to die, he sleeps
-the peaceful sleep of a baby. This lad can be no more
-than fifteen and yet he is tall and strong and he had a
-good face. For many moons we have been at peace with
-our brothers the Delawares and now war and bloodshed.&rdquo;
-The other brave shook his head and, looking at the lad,
-he spoke.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_182">182</div>
-<p>&ldquo;If you had not been present when he was captured,
-his hair would now be hanging from the wigwam of the
-vicious one. He has the blood of several Delawares upon
-his hands now and one more would only have added to
-his greatness even if it were only the scalp of a boy.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Masi is a ruthless brave. Ever since he was beaten
-in battle by the brave Delaware, Running Bear, he has
-carried hatred in his heart for the Delawares. Their
-having sent hunting parties into the land of the Iroquois
-and taken game from our hunting grounds was all the
-excuse that was needed. And so our tribes are at war, and
-it will not cease until many are dead and there is much
-sadness in the wigwams of both tribes.&rdquo; With these words,
-the warriors withdrew from the door.</p>
-<p>Little Horse had heard all and pondered the words of
-the Iroquois. He had not known that any of their tribe
-had invaded the hunting grounds of the Iroquois unless
-it had been himself. This troubled him, but he pushed
-the thoughts from his mind and slept once again. Because
-of his training he slept soundly and as dawn broke
-through the greyness he awoke feeling quite hungry and
-thirsty.</p>
-<p>The guards at his door looked in, and soon food and
-drink were brought to him. He ate hungrily and drank
-long of the cool water and when he had finished, his
-guards stepped forward and once again bound his wrists.
-However, they took him outside the wigwam and allowed
-him to walk up and down for a short while to give his
-muscles exercise. The morning passed quickly and soon it
-was time.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_183">183</div>
-<p>Little Horse felt the old fear once again returning to
-his breast and now there was nothing he could do to
-force it back. As the guards approached they noticed
-Little Horse looking upward as if to speak with someone
-and it was true, for Little Horse was calling upon the
-powers of nature to give him strength at this hour of trial.</p>
-<p>His guards approached him and, grasping his arms,
-dragged him from the wigwam, for now fear had gripped
-the heart of Little Horse and he fought the hands of the
-Iroquois which held his arms in firm grip and he fought
-the tough thongs which bound his wrists. But twist and
-turn as he would, it did no good and soon he was standing
-before the elders of the tribe.</p>
-<p>Across the center of the village he saw the gauntlet of
-tall powerful braves begin to form and his legs trembled
-slightly. The elders talked among themselves, and then
-one old man stepped forward and spoke to Little Horse.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your tribe has invaded the lands of the Iroquois in
-seeking wild game and in doing so they have broken the
-law of the tribes. If they had stayed on their own ground
-there would have been no need for war. But for the
-Iroquois to do nothing when their neighbor invades the
-sacred hunting ground would be as if we shouted through
-the forest that we were weak and afraid of the Delawares.
-You have been captured on our land and as an example
-to all Delawares you will be made to run the gauntlet.
-If you do so successfully your life will be spared, but if
-not the war clubs my braves now hold shall beat your
-body till it blends with the dirt of the forest floor and you
-are no more. Are you ready for the ordeal?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Horse held his head high and looking straight
-into the eyes of the elder warrior, he said, &ldquo;I know not of
-any of our braves that invaded your hunting grounds
-unless it was myself. In pursuit of the wild turkey, I ran
-quickly along the trail and was in the land of the
-Iroquois before I realized. I did not think that the great
-Iroquois would miss one little wild turkey.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_184">184</div>
-<p>The old warrior looked stern and then he said, &ldquo;It is
-not you but other braves of your tribe who have entered
-our grounds, but you and I are not here to argue, for I
-will not even discuss it, the law has been broken and war
-has been declared. Already the blood of one of our warriors
-had been spilled on the very edge of our camp.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With this statement the heart of Little Horse beat just
-a little faster, for if one of the Iroquois had died close to
-the village then the Delawares must have followed and
-there was still hope that he would be rescued.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am ready for the gauntlet,&rdquo; Little Horse said.</p>
-<p>With that he was dragged to the head of the two
-lines. He looked down the two long rows of warriors
-standing like statues with war clubs raised, each one
-hoping that his blow would be the one that would deal
-death to this Delaware. Then the signal was given, and
-Little Horse took a deep breath and started running with
-top speed. As he ran he ducked from side to side and
-hesitated, forcing one blow to come down too soon or
-miss entirely. Halfway down the line he had not fared too
-badly, but as he came to the second half he was thrown
-a little off stride and could not duck so many of the
-blows. Several landed rather solidly upon his back and
-shoulders and arms and he began to feel weak, but with
-a last spurt of speed he reached the end of the line just
-as the club of Masi glanced off the side of his head. Instead
-of slumping to the ground between the two rows,
-Little Horse fell forward clear of the line and as Masi
-raised his club to strike again the elder stepped forward
-and raising his arms he said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Cease, Masi, for the boy is clear of the gauntlet. He
-has received quite a beating, but breath still stirs in his
-body. He is a brave lad and has earned the right to live.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_185">185</div>
-<p>Little Horse was then carried to a wigwam where his
-bruises were cared for. Food and water were brought and
-he was made comfortable. The tall warrior that had prevented
-his death upon the trail entered the wigwam and
-spoke with Little Horse.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;O my brave young man, you have proved to be quite
-courageous this day, and the Iroquois admire the courage
-of even their enemies. You will rest now and when you
-are well we will talk.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that he left the wigwam, and sudden darkness
-came once again to Little Horse as he fell unconscious.</p>
-<p>Meanwhile Running Bear had gathered quite a force
-of Delawares and was approaching the village from the
-south. Advance scouts who had been near the village of
-the Iroquois throughout the day reported the gauntlet and
-the exact location where they had placed the boy.</p>
-<p>Running Bear swiftly gave his orders and the band
-advanced at a quicker pace, spreading out so that by the
-late afternoon a strong semicircle of Delaware braves
-surrounded the Iroquois stronghold.</p>
-<p>At a given signal from Running Bear, the attack was
-on. The attack was such that the Iroquois were caught
-completely by surprise. Though the band of attacking
-Delawares was much smaller than the number of Iroquois
-in the village, they swooped into the village to surprise the
-guards surrounding the wigwam of Little Horse.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_186">186</div>
-<p>They rushed in and gathering the body of the still
-unconscious boy they rushed out again and into the forest,
-and were away before the Iroquois had gathered themselves
-together. By the time the Iroquois were ready to do
-battle, the Delawares had left, leaving the bodies of four
-Iroquois and two of their own attacking party dead upon
-the ground surrounding the wigwam where Little Horse
-had been held captive.</p>
-<p>Once the rescue had been accomplished the attacking
-Delawares did not wait to join in battle with the now
-furious Iroquois but sped swiftly toward the south and
-the safety and security of their own village. They traveled
-at a very fast pace and though it was growing dark it was
-not long before they had placed many miles between
-themselves and the village of the Iroquois.</p>
-<p>Onward through the night and into the next day they
-pressed until soon they could see the smoke of the Delaware
-village. They arrived in the middle of the village
-among the welcoming shouts of their friends and families
-who had awaited their return with growing anxiety.</p>
-<p>Without a moment&rsquo;s hesitation, Little Horse was placed
-in the warmth and seclusion of his father&rsquo;s wigwam and
-when his hurts had been attended to, his father knelt by
-his side to add what comfort he could, and to add his
-praise to the courage of the boy. He promised that he,
-Running Bear, would not rest until he had paid back the
-Iroquois for the injuries they had inflicted upon his son.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Now rest, my son,&rdquo; Running Bear said, &ldquo;and when
-you have rested and eaten we shall talk some more.&rdquo;
-Running Bear turned to leave but Little Horse placed his
-hand upon his arm and bade him stay.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, my father, for there is something I must tell
-you. While at the village of our neighbors the Iroquois I
-learned why it was that they had declared war upon the
-Delawares. It was reported to them that the Delawares
-had invaded their hunting ground and made off with
-many kills. This being a breach of the peace between the
-tribes, they had no choice but to declare that war existed
-between their own tribe and that of the Delawares.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_187">187</div>
-<p>&ldquo;This is a serious matter, my son,&rdquo; said Running Bear,
-&ldquo;for we have had plenty of food on our own land and I
-see no reason for any of our braves going into the land
-of the Iroquois to hunt. But this matter is of grave importance
-and we must hold a council immediately, for the
-Iroquois are probably at this very moment preparing a
-great dance, since tomorrow they will no doubt move to
-attack our village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that, Running Bear left his wigwam and calling
-the elder braves together, they immediately went into
-council. After telling the council all that his son had
-reported to him, Running Bear asked that the tribe be
-assembled and told of the situation that existed. The
-council agreed and very shortly the whole tribe was gathered
-in the center of the ring and one of the elders rose to
-speak.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The Iroquois have declared war, and Little Horse tells
-us that the reason for this is that some of our braves have
-invaded their hunting grounds to kill the swift deer. If
-this is true we have done the Iroquois a grave injustice.
-The forest and fields of our land have yielded us much
-food this past year and I see no reason for having left our
-lands to hunt elsewhere. Who among you has caused the
-wrath of the Iroquois to be brought down upon our
-heads?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>One at a time the leaders of the families stepped forward
-to deny that they had left the sacred hunting
-grounds of the Delawares until all had spoken. When no
-one had accepted the guilt, Running Bear rose and spoke.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_188">188</div>
-<p>&ldquo;If no one of our village has violated the sacred lands
-of the Iroquois, we have committed no crime. Of this I
-must speak further. For at this moment the Iroquois are
-probably on their way to our village to seek revenge for
-our attack last night. I will take with me two warriors and
-without weapons we shall go to speak of peace with our
-neighbors, the Iroquois.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Already seven brave young men are dead, and my
-own son lies hurt and bleeding in my wigwam. In order
-to prevent the shed of further blood, I must go to meet
-the oncoming Iroquois with only talk of peace. Somewhere,
-somehow, an injustice has been done, and we
-must right this wrong before peace can once more prevail
-over our land.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that, Running Bear selected two stout warriors
-and leaving their weapons behind they proceeded at a
-steady pace back up the path toward the Iroquois country.
-They traveled swiftly and many hours later Running
-Bear suggested they stop and rest.</p>
-<p>As the three warriors rested at the side of the trail,
-they were suddenly surrounded by many Iroquois braves.
-Their arms were tightly bound and menacing motions
-with tomahawk and knife were made. But the same warrior
-that had prevented the death of Little Horse stepped
-forward and, raising his arm for silence, he spoke to
-Running Bear.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You appear to be the leader of this small party and I
-ask you why you come to the land of the Iroquois without
-arms when open war exists?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Running Bear spoke loud and clear for the whole
-Iroquois war party to hear. &ldquo;I, Running Bear, with my
-two fellow warriors come in peace to speak with the
-council of the great Iroquois. As you can see, we carry
-no arms and we rested in the open along the trail, hoping
-that we would find our Iroquois neighbors before they and
-the Delawares shed each other&rsquo;s blood once again.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_189">189</div>
-<p>The Iroquois brave said nothing, but having the wrists
-of the three Delawares bound they were herded along
-the trail back to the camp of the Iroquois.</p>
-<p>As the party entered the camp they could hear much
-moaning and crying from the families of the Iroquois that
-had been slain and also they observed the menacing looks
-as the people of the village crowded around the party,
-pressing ever closer hoping for a reason to swing a club
-or a tomahawk or drive a knife deep into the head or
-hearts of these Delawares who so boldly approached the
-village without arms.</p>
-<p>But the tall leader of the war party guided them safely
-to a wigwam where they were placed under heavy guard
-until the council lodge had been prepared for the great
-council.</p>
-<p>When the elders and wise men of the tribe had gathered,
-the prisoners were led before them. Running Bear
-spoke briefly of their mission and then in a loud clear
-voice he said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The Delawares have sworn to their chiefs that none
-among our village have invaded the hunting grounds of
-the Iroquois and therefore there is no need for war
-between us.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>There was some hushed conversation and then one of
-the elders spoke to a guard at the door. &ldquo;Summon the
-warrior known as Masi.&rdquo; Masi was brought to the council
-and the elder who had summoned him spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Masi, it was you who reported to the council of the
-thievery of the Delaware and it was you who brought to
-our council the entrails of a deer to prove before the
-council your story of having seen the hunting party of
-Delawares invade our lands and kill much wild game.
-Now tell these warriors who come to us from the Delawares
-that you have seen this with your own eyes.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_190">190</div>
-<p>Masi spoke and told of having seen a hunting party
-of some fifteen braves of the Delawares stalk, kill, and
-strip the carcasses of several deer and take several wild
-turkey and other wild game. When he had finished, the
-council looked first at Masi and then at Running Bear.
-The elder was about to speak once more when the tall
-warrior who had saved the life of Little Horse stepped
-forward and spoke to the council.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not know why,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;but my heart tells me
-the Delaware speaks truth. For many weeks now Masi has
-brooded over the death of his sister, and his mind has not
-been quite right since she died of the great sickness. We
-know that Masi has been a great warrior, but ask him
-once again to repeat what he saw. For when he first told
-his story the hunting party of Delawares were six in
-number. Suddenly they have increased to number fifteen.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, yes,&rdquo; cried Masi, &ldquo;and there have been many,
-many more since that day. If we are not careful they will
-be in our village in one more sun and we shall all be
-murdered in our sleep.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that, Masi began to scream and he threw himself
-upon the ground, tearing at the ground and bemoaning
-the death of his young sister whom he had loved dearly.
-He was truly a grief-stricken brave gone mad.</p>
-<p>The elder who seemed to be a leader in the council
-stepped forward then and placing his hands upon the
-shoulders of Running Bear, he said, &ldquo;There has been a
-great wrong done here, and we must sit and smoke the
-peacepipe together. We ask forgiveness, for we have
-wronged each other greatly. Once again peace shall exist
-between the Iroquois and the Delawares and let us not
-allow anything to break that peace. Brothers we have
-been in the past, and brothers we will be again. Come sit
-with us and we shall smoke the pipe.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_191">191</div>
-<p>With that, the peacepipe was passed from hand to
-hand and when all had smoked, food and drink were
-brought. Then there was much rejoicing as the village
-was told of the results of the council meeting. Loaded
-down with gifts, Running Bear and his two warriors
-returned to their village with the word of peace.</p>
-<p>After telling of the good news, Running Bear went to
-his wigwam where he found Little Horse now able to sit
-up and partake of solid food. He seated himself next to
-his son and once again praised him for the courage he
-had showed and explained to him how important the
-information he had brought had been&mdash;how he, Running
-Bear, was able through talk with the council of Iroquois
-to bring about peace between the Delawares and the
-Iroquois.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_192">192</div>
-<h2 id="c31"><span class="h2line1">FALLING WATER EARNS A FEATHER</span></h2>
-<p>Falling Water came galloping into the Dakota-Sioux
-camp on his brand-new pony. The pony had been a
-present from his uncle, Walking Bear, one of the leaders
-of the tribe. Proudly Falling Water rode it up and down
-through the camp so all the other young braves could see
-what a beautiful pony he had. When he felt that everyone
-had seen the pony he rode swiftly back to the tepee of his
-father and dismounting ran to show his father the fine
-gift.</p>
-<p>One Horn, so named because he had lost an ear in a
-battle with a band of Shoshone braves a few years ago,
-stepped from the tepee and admired this fine gift.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It is a strong pony and a young one, my son. Treat
-it well, for a horse can be your best friend.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, father, I will take good care of the pony and I
-will ride him on the hunt. I am now a man and with my
-own weapons and my own horse, I can now go on the
-hunt.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my son. In fact tomorrow your uncle is leading a
-hunting party in search of the buffalo, for it is almost
-time for the big buffalo hunt. So see to your weapons and
-be sure you are ready for the great hunt.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_193">193</div>
-<p>Falling Water rushed into the tepee and the rest of the
-day he spent working on his weapons in preparation for
-the hunt. He was sixteen now and considered a man but
-until now he had not been on any of the big hunts, for
-he had been sick the season of the hunt last year and now
-he was well and strong and prepared to ride with the best
-of them.</p>
-<p>The following morning, Walking Bear gathered the
-warriors about him and made sure that all were prepared
-for the trip ahead.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We will divide into three groups and go in different
-directions. When the sun has crossed the great sky twice
-we will meet where the Whispering River flows. There
-we will compare what each group has found, and the
-largest herd shall become our target. Let me warn you
-each and every one that though we are hunting buffalo,
-we must be ever aware that our enemies the Shoshones
-are all about us and we must be on guard that these
-jackals do not add our scalps to their belts. Calling
-Hawk, you will lead one party, Speaks Like Thunder,
-you will lead the second party, and I will lead the third.
-Good hunting, and may we all meet with our hair still
-upon our heads, come the end of the second day.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So it was that Falling Water, in Calling Hawk&rsquo;s party,
-was off on an adventure that was to earn him his first
-feathers for bravery.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_194">194</div>
-<p>Calling Hawk led his party to the west, for scouts had
-reported a fine herd of buffalo moving in that direction.
-The party moved steadily along keeping their eyes alert
-for signs of dust clouds that would signify a moving herd
-or horsemen. One or two braves were sent ahead to
-sweep wide of the main party to see what they could
-possibly find. From time to time these scouts would ride
-back to the main party and two more would take their
-place.</p>
-<p>The first day ended with no sight of buffalo or of
-marauding Shoshones, and the group made camp in a
-small clump of trees.</p>
-<p>The following morning after a breakfast of pemmican
-they were on their way once again.</p>
-<p>It was late in the morning when a scout riding hard
-brought his pony to a halt in front of Calling Hawk. He
-reported that he had spotted a herd of buffalo about a
-quarter of a mile ahead of the group. And so the party
-quickened its pace and soon came to the top of a rise.
-There below it on the prairie was a fine large herd of
-buffalo. They were not moving and therefore no dust
-cloud had been seen.</p>
-<p>Calling Hawk asked two of the braves to remain and
-keep watch on the herd while the others continued to
-the Whispering River which was but a short distance
-ahead, there to join with Walking Bear and make their
-report.</p>
-<p>Unknown to Calling Hawk and his party, the herd had
-also been seen by a hunting party of Shoshones, slightly
-larger than the Dakota-Sioux party, and also at the same
-time they had seen the party of Calling Hawk. As the
-Sioux moved toward the river, the Shoshones moved
-parallel awaiting the best place to attack.</p>
-<p>And now it was Falling Water&rsquo;s turn to ride scout and
-he moved out from the party. He rode hard to get a long
-lead on the party and then began to move steadily to the
-side of the group and ever toward the river. Soon he felt
-it was time to return to the group.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_195">195</div>
-<p>It was getting late in the afternoon, and as he turned
-to return he saw to the north a small cloud of dust.
-Urging his horse to the top of a near-by rise he slid
-from his back and, crawling to the very edge, peered
-over into the valley below. There he saw a sight which
-made his blood run hot.</p>
-<p>A band of perhaps twenty Shoshones were riding hard
-toward the unsuspecting Sioux party which was about
-twelve in number. Quickly mounting his horse, Falling
-Water rode like the wind back toward his brothers.
-Finally coming over a slight hill he saw the party moving
-slowly forward. Then he began to shout his warning of
-Shoshones and Calling Hawk called his party to a halt.</p>
-<p>Falling Water galloped up and reported what he had
-seen. Quickly the Sioux formed a line and drawing their
-weapons they moved forward to meet the Shoshones.</p>
-<p>Soon the Sioux saw the oncoming enemy and urged
-their horses to even greater speed.</p>
-<p>The two groups clashed, and there was a mixture of
-rearing horses and screaming men. Knives flashed and
-arrows swished through the air, some flying harmlessly
-or some thudding into flesh.</p>
-<p>Falling Water, right in the middle, rode toward a large
-Shoshone buck. As he did, a knife thrust slashed his arm
-and he dropped his weapons, but now he was too close
-to the Shoshone to stop the forward move of his horse.
-Ducking under the slashing knife of the Shoshone warrior,
-he placed his hand upon the brave&rsquo;s shoulder and
-pushed. The brave was thrown off balance and almost lost
-his seat and, while he was trying to regain his seat, Falling
-Water dashed to the outer circle.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_196">196</div>
-<p>Soon the fight was over and twelve Shoshones and three
-Sioux lay dead upon the ground while a badly beaten
-group of Shoshones beat a hasty retreat into the distance.
-The felled warriors were placed across their horses&rsquo; backs,
-and the group continued to their meeting place.</p>
-<p>When Calling Hawk reported to Walking Bear their
-fight with the Shoshone, Walking Bear ordered a return
-to the village.</p>
-<p>When the party entered the village the people were
-immediately aware of what had happened because of the
-bodies and the Shoshone scalps hanging from the belts of
-several warriors.</p>
-<p>That evening a council was held, and Falling Water
-rose to report to the council of his great deed of courage.
-He had rushed in and touched an enemy while still alive.
-When he had finished, Walking Bear said,</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Are there any here that were witnesses to this event?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Calling Hawk stepped forward and in very descriptive
-words retold the event. The others told their stories of
-bravery and then Falling Water was called before the
-chief, his uncle.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am very proud of you, my brother&rsquo;s son. You have
-proven yourself a great warrior this day and for that you
-shall be privileged to wear two eagle feathers.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>There were many shouts of praise and approval, and
-Falling Water felt a warm glow as his father placed his
-hands across his shoulders and said, &ldquo;I am proud of you,
-my son.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Today Falling Water had earned his first feathers.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_197">197</div>
-<h2 id="c32"><span class="h2line1">THE RACE WITH DEATH</span></h2>
-<p>In the high range of mountains lived the great and
-powerful Apaches. For many, many years the war between
-the Long Knives and the Apaches had been waging
-back and forth.</p>
-<p>The Long Knives, as the white men&rsquo;s cavalry were
-known in those days, had at last worked out a treaty
-with the Apaches and all was peaceful for the time being.
-With the coming of peace to the Apaches, the return of
-normal family life was slowly but surely noticed by the
-younger of the warriors.</p>
-<p>There was more time now to teach the young braves
-their lessons, and the women were happier than they had
-been. For the past few years all the talk had been of war
-and killing, but now conversation turned to other topics.
-Of course there were a few young bucks who still chanted
-for war, but the wiser chiefs desired to stay at peace for
-as long as was possible.</p>
-<p>One evening some of the older chiefs were seated
-around the fire smoking and talking to pass the evening
-hours away when their attention was called to Chief
-Running Dog, one of the older chiefs of the tribe, who
-had been sitting quietly in the circle not saying much but
-gazing off into the night as if he were looking for something.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_198">198</div>
-<p>Twisted Wolf spoke. &ldquo;What do you look for, friend
-Running Dog? Do you see something in the distance with
-those old eyes that the rest of us should be looking for?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, Twisted Wolf, I do not look for anything in the
-present, but rather I am looking far into the past, to a
-time when I was just a small boy and there had been
-peace and happiness in our tribe for many years.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why should you think about the past now, old one?
-Is there something particular that you are trying to
-recall?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Running Dog laughed, &ldquo;Oh, I do not have to think
-too hard to recall what I want to think about. Something
-happened when I was a young boy that I shall long remember.
-Some of you should remember this one adventure
-too, for some of you were just about my age at the
-time.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Tell us,&rdquo; they cried, &ldquo;tell us what adventure you recall
-as a boy.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said Chief Running Dog, &ldquo;the story I remember
-is one which my father liked to call the Race of
-Death. But I do not want to bore you with tales of my
-childhood. They are only memories of an old man who
-lives in a world of dreams.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Now, Running Dog, do you want us to coax you?
-I have never known you to need prompting to tell a story.
-Why do you need coaxing at this time?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, it is not a funny story and to me at the time it
-was not a very nice experience to go through. Just recalling
-it brings back some of the fears which filled my
-heart at the time. But, if it is your desire, then I shall tell
-you the story. Fill your pipes and settle back, because
-it is quite a long story and we will be here at the fire for
-some time until I have finished. But remember that I
-warned you. If you get bored, it is your own fault, for
-you have asked for this story.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_199">199</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not ramble, Running Dog. Get on with the story.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So it was that Running Dog, old Apache warrior, told
-his story that evening on the plateau of Apache country
-around a blazing council fire with his friends there to
-relive the experience of his childhood once again.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It was many years ago,&rdquo; Running Dog began. &ldquo;The
-Apache village in which I lived had a very long and
-difficult time of sickness. Many of our number had died
-of the great coughing sickness which the Long Knives
-call pneumonia, but it seemed that at last the sickness was
-leaving us and our people were returning to a time of
-good health and prosperity. There was much mourning
-for loved ones, but our family had been very lucky. My
-father and mother had both survived the epidemic and I,
-their only son, had been well all through the siege of
-sickness.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The sick continued to get well and little by little the
-tribe returned to its normal activity. Once again the
-contests and games took place and there was much joy
-at the ceremonial dances and feasts.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It was just after one of these feasts that my friend
-White Cloud and I decided to take a hunting trip into
-the far hills. We sought the permission of our fathers,
-and packing some food and blankets we placed these
-upon a pack horse and started off for the distant high
-mountains.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What exactly we were going to hunt we did not know,
-but we were so excited about the prospect of living by
-ourselves for a few days that the problem of what to hunt
-did not seem to bother us too much at the time.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_200">200</div>
-<p>&ldquo;One thing my father had cautioned me about. &lsquo;My
-son, Running Dog,&rsquo; he said, &lsquo;on your trip be aware of
-any strangers. Not too far to the north is the land of the
-Kiowas and they have been seen recently in this area.
-Just a few scattered here and there, but you and your
-friend White Cloud are riding two very fine ponies; and
-the Kiowas, I am sure, would like nothing better than to
-return to their village in the possession of three more very
-fine Apache horses, for their very life is one of horse
-stealing. The pack horse you take is just as strong and
-fast as the other two, so be careful and do not get careless
-on your trip. You are old enough now to realize the
-dangers an Apache faces in this country.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;&lsquo;Besides the wandering Kiowas you had best be alert
-to the cats that roam the rock ledges. Keep your bow
-and arrow handy and make sure your hand is steady,
-for you will get but one chance to stop the wild leap of
-a mountain lion if he chooses to spring. Now I must bid
-you good-bye. I have asked the gods to protect you and
-your friend White Cloud. May they guide you safely to
-a successful hunt and a safe return to your homes and
-your families. I will ride part way and see you on your
-way. Come, I will get my horse.&rsquo;&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So the two boys, along with Running Dog&rsquo;s father,
-rode to the edge of the camp and a little way farther on,
-where Running Dog&rsquo;s father bade them a fond good-bye
-once again and turned to return to the village.</p>
-<p>The two boys waved until they were out of sight and
-then concentrated on the long trip they felt they must
-make before they would enter good hunting territory. As
-they rode they kept careful watch along the trail for
-signs of anyone having recently been there.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_201">201</div>
-<p>Occasionally they saw signs where Indian ponies had
-been but these were all many days old. They found evidence
-too of wild game, but at no time did they catch
-sight of anything more than a rabbit or two.</p>
-<p>After traveling most of the day and stopping only for
-lunch the two boys decided to halt and make camp for
-the night. They found a beautiful spot near a water hole
-and after staking their horses out they unrolled their
-blankets and prepared the evening meal. In the darkness
-they could hear the coyote baying at the moon and
-Running Dog remarked how sad and plaintive was the
-call of the coyote. White Cloud agreed, &ldquo;Yes, Running
-Dog, it is quite a sad sound, but after all the coyote is
-a very lonely animal. You too would not feel much like
-laughing if you had to spend all of your life alone without
-friends.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys laughed and then wrapping themselves
-in their blankets were soon fast asleep.</p>
-<p>The following morning the boys rose and after eating
-breakfast, packed their equipment once again and were
-soon on the trail, traveling ever northward. Soon they
-had entered land that was not at all familiar to them, but
-they began to notice plentiful signs of game and so they
-kept eagerly onward.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Look,&rdquo; cried Running Dog, &ldquo;pony tracks, and they
-are fresh. Not too long ago Indian ponies passed this way.
-In fact I would say they are not more than a day old.
-See, it has been damp here and the impression of the
-ponies&rsquo; hoofs has not had time to harden through. I
-wonder though, White Cloud, why our brothers would be
-this far north?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_202">202</div>
-<p>White Cloud thought for a moment and then he said,
-&ldquo;But, Running Dog, you do not think that we are the
-only ones off on a hunting party. These are probably the
-tracks of some of our men who are also seeking game
-and have come this far north in search of it.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That may be true, White Cloud; on the other hand,
-these may be the hoof prints of Kiowa ponies and if so
-then we are much further north than I figured and are
-now in Kiowa territory. That is not a healthy place to be.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What should we do, Running Dog?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not know. For if we are in the land of the Kiowas
-we should turn and return to our own land; but if we
-are not and these are the tracks of friendly Apaches we
-would be silly to turn back, for only now have the signs
-of game become plentiful. The problem is whether we
-should stay and take our chances or return empty-handed
-with our tails between our legs.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You are older, Running Dog, you make the decision.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;All right then, we shall stay and take our chances.
-I have seen many signs of deer and we shall find ourselves
-a large buck to kill before we return to our village. But
-come, it is getting late. Let us find a good place to
-camp.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two young braves traveled a little farther on, and
-then when they both agreed that an ideal place was not
-to be located, they settled for a small clump of trees
-nestled in a gully. There was water not too far distant,
-and about two hundred yards from where they camped,
-there was a large mass of rock ledges that rose up from
-the ground, eventually growing into a cliff. In among
-these boulders and rock ledges they were able to find a
-source of water, and so they decided to make this their
-base of operations.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_203">203</div>
-<p>To the west of where they camped they had seen a
-small woodland and swamp area which they figured
-would make a good hunting place for wild game. The
-boys went about setting up their camping ground and
-when they had completed the task at hand they settled
-down to going over their hunting equipment.</p>
-<p>The two boys having checked their bows and arrows
-went off to attempt to find some fresh meat for supper.
-White Cloud headed for the woodlands to the west and
-Running Dog started for the rock formation to the north.
-After about two hours of hunting and searching, Running
-Dog returned to the campsite empty-handed, but
-soon he saw his friend White Cloud riding like the wind
-toward the camp.</p>
-<p>Slung over his horse&rsquo;s neck was an object that flopped
-loosely back and forth as he rose. Soon he was in the
-camp and swinging down from his pony&rsquo;s back he placed
-a plump young rabbit on the ground in front of Running
-Dog and smiled, saying, &ldquo;Here, little friend, is our dinner
-for tonight.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Soon the fire was blazing, and the two boys settled
-down to a delicious meal of roast rabbit. When they had
-finished their dinner they rolled up in their blankets and
-were soon asleep. Tomorrow was going to be a long day,
-for they were determined to track down some large game
-and make their kill, for their supplies were running low
-and they must start the return trip to the village the
-following afternoon.</p>
-<p>The night passed without incident and when the dawn
-broke it was raining slightly. The two boys looked at the
-heavens frowning, but in about a half hour the sky had
-cleared and the sun shone through again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_204">204</div>
-<p>The boys started off for the woodland and their big
-game hunt. They had not gone very far when Running
-Dog glanced up toward the high rock formations. He did
-not know what caused him to look in that direction, but
-suddenly he stopped and called to White Cloud who had
-been riding a little ahead, anxious to reach the woods.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, White Cloud. Look, look to the north, beyond
-that formation of rocks.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>White Cloud turned and gazed in the direction Running
-Dog pointed. There rising above the rock formation
-were puffs of smoke. &ldquo;Maybe it is the campfire of another
-hunting party, Running Dog?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; said Running Dog, &ldquo;that is not campfire, those
-are Kiowa smoke signals. I will try to make them out.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Are you sure they are Kiowa smoke signals, Running
-Do?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh yes, White Cloud, many moons ago my father
-taught me of the Kiowa smoke signals. Though all tribes
-use this method the Kiowas have a definite series of signals
-before their message. Look, White Cloud. See that
-series of short puffs of smoke? That is peculiar only to
-the Kiowas. Let me see if I can make out what they are
-sending.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys sat astride their ponies watching the signals
-of smoke rise in the distance. Running Dog studied
-the signals as diligently as he could and seeking back into
-his memory for everything his father had taught him
-about smoke signals.</p>
-<p>Then he turned to White Cloud, &ldquo;Come, my friend, we
-must hurry. Those signals are to a band of Kiowas to the
-south that we are here in their hunting grounds and therefore
-have broken the law of the Kiowa and must die.
-They are calling to this band to bring our scalps on their
-war lances triumphantly to the village. We must hurry,
-White Cloud. There is no telling how long that message
-has been playing in the sky. We did not notice it until
-now but that does not mean that it has not been sent before
-just now. We must ride to camp and take our other
-horse and start for home.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_205">205</div>
-<p>The two boys wheeled their ponies about and sped
-back for the camp. They entered the camp and quickly
-gathering their possessions together they put them aboard
-the pack horse and climbing upon their own ponies they
-started swiftly southward. They rode steadily for about
-an hour, and then Running Dog pulled up his pony.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, White Cloud, we are doing just what they wish
-us to do. We are running and we have a long hard trip
-to make. Besides, that signal was evidently for a band to
-the south of our camp. If we are not careful we shall find
-that we have ridden right into a trap. Let us plan our trip
-more carefully. First we must stay away from the main
-trails. We must take to the foothills and work our way
-south that way. It will take us longer, but there will be
-less chance of being ambushed, I believe, if we stay away
-from the well-used main trails. The Kiowas are a very
-tricky people and we would be in a trap before we knew
-it. They will be sure to be covering the water holes for
-they know we must have water. As far as I know there
-are but three between here and our village. How much
-water do you have in your pouch?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My pouch is about empty, Running Dog, but surely
-we will find water elsewhere than at the three water
-holes.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;There is a good chance that we will, but I do not
-want to count on it. After all, our hunters are the ones
-that are familiar with this land. We are strangers here
-and not acquainted with the good and bad points. Come,
-our horses have rested. We will leave the main trail now
-and continue cross country. It is going to be a hard journey,
-White Cloud, but we are racing death.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_206">206</div>
-<p>With that the two boys steered their ponies from the
-main trail and began to travel in a southeasterly direction.
-Here there was no clear trail, and they had only the
-uncanny sense of a homing pigeon to guide them. They
-pushed their ponies easily for the first couple of hours, but
-finally the steady pace began to tell and they had to come
-to a stop.</p>
-<p>They had entered a green valley and as they rode they
-noticed an abundance of game. &ldquo;Too bad that we are in
-a race,&rdquo; remarked White Cloud, &ldquo;for here is a paradise
-of game.&rdquo; Running Dog said nothing, and the two boys
-brought their ponies to a stop. They stepped from their
-ponies and rested, allowing the horses to crop grass.</p>
-<p>As they lay there, White Cloud glanced back in the
-direction from which they had come. Again he could see
-the ominous puffs of smoke rising from behind the small
-hills that separated them from the main band of Kiowas.</p>
-<p>After resting a short while and allowing their ponies to
-blow, they mounted again and continued their gallop toward
-their village and security. Night was approaching
-now and the boys were glad for they knew that they
-could travel much more swiftly at night because it would
-be cooler. Besides, they knew that the Kiowas would not
-attack unless they were sure they could kill both the boys.</p>
-<p>They rode more swiftly now, and suddenly Running
-Dog&rsquo;s pony whinnied aloud and swerved to one side.
-Running Dog tried to pull him back but the pony galloped
-off in a slightly different direction from the one in
-which they had been traveling. Then Running Dog understood
-why, for suddenly he heard the hoofs of his
-horse splashing. The horse had found water. What a
-break! The boys threw themselves from their horses and
-lay flat in the water. Suddenly Running Dog lifted himself
-from the water and grasping White Cloud&rsquo;s arm he said:</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_207">207</div>
-<p>&ldquo;We are foolish. Suppose they are watching this water
-hole. We sit here like two fat frogs waiting for the hook.
-Come quickly, we must leave this place.&rdquo; The two boys
-mounted once again and rode on. Suddenly the pack
-horse stumbled and fell. The boys stopped their ponies
-and returned to the side of the pack horse. &ldquo;He will be
-all right,&rdquo; said White Cloud, &ldquo;he is just winded.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We must leave him,&rdquo; said Running Dog. &ldquo;We cannot
-wait for him to regain his breath and his strength. We
-must ride.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Now the two boys could travel a little faster without
-the pack horse to slow them down, although they hated
-the thought of leaving a pony for the blood-thirsty
-Kiowas. Finally they brought their ponies to a halt and
-dismounted.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We must rest several hours or our ponies will die
-underneath us. Try to sleep, White Cloud. I will stand
-guard. I will wake you in a short time and then I will
-sleep. Do not worry, I am tired, but my eyes and ears
-are sharp.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>White Cloud was exhausted and in a matter of seconds
-he was asleep. Running Dog kept careful watch and a
-short time later he wakened White Cloud. Then Running
-Dog slept and shortly just as dawn was breaking White
-Cloud shook his friend and the two thrust some dried
-venison into their mouths to chew and each one taking
-a long drink of water they mounted and were soon on
-their way once again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_208">208</div>
-<p>They had been riding for about an hour when Running
-Dog glanced back in the direction they had just come
-and there on a hillside a few miles back he saw a small
-band of Kiowas. They were evidently looking for something
-or someone.</p>
-<p>It was not a puzzle to Running Dog long, for he saw
-the band of Kiowas break from the hillside in their direction.
-&ldquo;They have seen us, White Cloud! Ride as you
-have never ridden before. We are near to our land, but it
-is still a hard ride and the worst is yet to come. I cannot
-be sure if that is a band that is pursuing us or whether it
-is the band from the south. In any case, we must keep
-going. Ride, White Cloud, ride for your life.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two ponies thundered on. Soon they had entered a
-series of hills. The second day was fast drawing to a close.
-Then it happened.</p>
-<p>White Cloud&rsquo;s pony caught his foot in a gopher hole,
-and down went pony and rider.</p>
-<p>Running Dog pulled his pony to a halt and rode back
-to where his friend had fallen. Both boy and pony were
-down. The pony had evidently a broken leg and White
-Cloud had hit his head upon a stone and was unconscious.
-Running Dog took his knife and put the horse out of his
-misery and then he dragged his friend to the shelter of a
-rock and poured some water on his face. Soon White
-Cloud shook his head.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What happened?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your horse stumbled. I have had to use my knife on
-him, his leg was broken. But how do you feel?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, I am a little dizzy and very tired. But go, Running
-Dog, you must ride to the village for help.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, White Cloud, I must do that, but I am lost. I do
-not know where we are and the sky is black tonight. We
-must stay here until dawn. My pony is all done in anyway.
-He would not get very far tonight. We will rest. I
-will stand guard first.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_209">209</div>
-<p>With that, Running Dog moved off to a small crevice
-of rock and settled down to keep watch. But the grind
-had been too much even for him, and before too long his
-head hung low upon his chest and both boys slept.</p>
-<p>Suddenly Running Dog woke with a start, hands of
-steel were holding his arms and legs, pinning him where
-he sat. He struggled and then he heard a familiar voice,
-&ldquo;Why do you struggle so hard, my son?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Father, it is you. Oh father, I am so glad to see you.
-But tell me, how did you find us?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said Running Dog&rsquo;s father, &ldquo;we too have eyes
-and saw the Kiowa signals while off gathering some
-horses that had strayed. We rode to meet the invader, for
-we knew that they would have come far into Apache territory
-to catch those that they pursued. So we rode to
-attack the band. We were able to defeat them and send
-them running for their homes, but before that we were
-able to learn from one of their dying braves that you,
-their quarry, had ridden in this direction.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am sorry we were holding you when you awoke but
-you are mighty fast with the knife and I did not want to
-take the chance of being killed by my own son.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>They laughed and then the party returned without
-further incident to the safety of their village.</p>
-<p class="center"><span class="gs">* * * * * * * *</span></p>
-<p>&ldquo;Here my story ends,&rdquo; said Running Dog, &ldquo;but I shall
-long remember the events of that Race with Death.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_210">210</div>
-<h2 id="c33"><span class="h2line1">THE STORM</span></h2>
-<p>In the Algonquin tribe, Masequah had grown to manhood
-through the many winters and summers that his
-tribe lived in peace. He was a very tall, strong and good-looking
-Indian brave. He was bravest of all in battle, a
-good hunter, and a good husband to his wife, Senan, and
-their son, Pyan. Masequah was very proud of his son. As
-the baby grew, his mother no longer had to carry him
-upon her back. Soon Masequah was able to walk hand in
-hand with Pyan through the forest.</p>
-<p>As his son grew older, Masequah began to train him
-for manhood. One day Masequah and Pyan stepped into
-a canoe and paddled across the wide lake to look for
-berries and nuts. Pyan was now seven years of age, and
-his training had begun in earnest. While they were on the
-other shore, a great storm arose, and the wind brought
-huge angry waves to the lake. Masequah feared that
-their light canoe would be broken by the waves. He told
-Pyan that it would be much safer to stay where they were
-until morning.</p>
-<p>They found a small cove that would give them some
-shelter. Then they started hunting for food, while the
-rain beat down on them. Pyan spotted two rabbits, and
-his father shot both of them. Then they went back to the
-cove, found dry wood, and built a fire to cook the rabbits.
-Masequah and Pyan settled themselves as comfortably
-as they could for the long night.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_211">211</div>
-<p>The winds began to blow even harder and the rain
-began to fall more heavily. Pyan snuggled closer to his
-father&rsquo;s side to keep warm. As the warrior looked at his
-son, he saw fear in his son&rsquo;s eyes. Masequah had taught
-his son that Indians were never afraid, but suddenly he
-realized that lessons were not enough. Even an Indian
-needed to understand the thing he feared in order to
-drive fear away.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Don&rsquo;t be afraid, Pyan,&rdquo; he said kindly. &ldquo;The rain that
-falls around us brings strength to food we have planted
-and to the trees in the forest. At the worst, it can only
-wet us. We are too wise to battle the wind on the lake.
-The bright bolts of lightning could not strike us here
-easily in this cove, and the thunder is only a loud noise
-like a war drum. There is nothing to fear.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As Masequah watched his son&rsquo;s face in the flickering
-light of the fire, he knew that his words had been of
-little comfort. &ldquo;I want to go home,&rdquo; said Pyan, &ldquo;I want
-my mother and the warmth of my bed. I am afraid.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Don&rsquo;t be afraid, Pyan,&rdquo; Masequah said, &ldquo;your father
-is with you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Can you stop the lightning?&rdquo; asked Pyan. &ldquo;Can you
-stop the rain? That will stop my fear. The wind that is
-blowing so strong frightens me.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_212">212</div>
-<p>Masequah picked up his son and carried him to the
-shelter of a cave and after placing his son in the cave he
-said, &ldquo;Wait, I shall return. I must get an answer to your
-questions.&rdquo; Masequah walked to the edge of the lake and,
-facing straight into the wind, shouted, &ldquo;O great storm,
-tell me what answers I should give my son! He is afraid
-and I have told him not to be afraid. The wind, the lightning,
-and the rain frighten him and he wants to return
-to his home. To try to paddle our light canoe across the
-rough waters of the lake could mean death for my son
-and me. I am not afraid to die, but my son is young and
-his whole life lies before him. Tell me what I can do to
-stop his fear. He has asked me to stop the rain and the
-wind. This I cannot do, but you, great storm, hear a
-father&rsquo;s plea and blow away from our land!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Masequah shivered, for the storm seemed to be getting
-worse. He turned from the lake and walked back to the
-cave. Taking his son&rsquo;s hand, he said, &ldquo;Pyan, come, follow
-your father. We are going home.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But, father,&rdquo; said Pyan, &ldquo;the winds and the rain and
-the lightning have not stopped. The water is rough and
-our canoe is light. We will be drowned.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Pyan held back as his father took his hand. His father
-spoke kindly and firmly: &ldquo;Come, Pyan, do not be afraid.
-Your father will protect you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As they reached the shore Pyan began to tremble and
-felt heartsick because he was cowardly while his father
-was so brave. Pyan stepped into the canoe and his father
-followed. Masequah pointed to the sky.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Look, Pyan, the sky is beginning to brighten. Now
-the storm will halt long enough for us to reach the safety
-of our village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>There was a blinding flash of lightning and a loud clap
-of thunder. The rain stopped suddenly, the winds died
-down, and the waves on the lake became calm. Masequah
-pushed the canoe from the shore and paddled
-swiftly across the lake.</p>
-<p>When they reached home, Pyan told his mother excitedly
-how the storm had stopped when his father ordered
-it to halt. Pyan&rsquo;s mother turned slowly to Masequah.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_213">213</div>
-<p>&ldquo;My husband,&rdquo; she said with wonder in her voice, &ldquo;until
-just now as you and Pyan arrived, the storm hasn&rsquo;t
-paused once tonight.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>For many years until Masequah&rsquo;s death, the members
-of his tribe looked upon Masequah as a brave gifted with
-mysterious powers. They would tell of a hunting party
-that had reached the lake at the same time that Masequah
-and Pyan had started for home; the hunters had
-been whipped by the raging storm while they stood on a
-hill top overlooking the lake; suddenly they had seen the
-storm stop and the lake below them grow calm; and then
-they had watched a small canoe, with a man and a boy
-in it, glide swiftly across the peaceful waters. To them it
-was a miracle, but Masequah knew better.</p>
-<p>Masequah would always deny that he had any mysterious
-powers. Over and over again, he would remind his
-friends that no storm covers all the earth, and that every
-storm has its edges just as the lake does, or like the
-shadow of a fleecy cloud on a sunny day.</p>
-<p>No matter how often he told them that the edge of the
-storm had moved away from the lake, most of his friends
-still insisted that it was a miracle. Even Pyan, who believed
-that his father was wise and truthful, sometimes
-wondered.</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>This story was told to the author by Barney Mason, a Canadian
-Scout, who had learned it from living descendants of the Algonquin
-Tribe.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_215">215</div>
-<h2><span class="h2line1">5. CHARACTER</span></h2>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_217">217</div>
-<h2 id="c34"><span class="h2line1">SLEEPING BEAR MAKES A MISTAKE</span></h2>
-<p>The Montagnais village of the great Northern forest
-was large with many fine wigwams. The village had been
-built in a meadow near a great lake, and the smell of
-woodfires was always in the air, as the smoke curled skyward
-from each wigwam. It was a busy time of year for
-the Montagnais because winter would soon be upon
-them. Families were repairing their homes and making
-new clothing for the winter months.</p>
-<p>It was on one of these busy days that Bald Eagle informed
-his family that he believed they should build a new
-wigwam. So the work was organized. First Bald Eagle selected
-a good place to build it. Then he scratched lines on
-the ground to show where the frame would be set. Having
-cut saplings and put them in place, bending the ends to
-make arches for the roof, he bound them together with
-withes made from a peeled basswood sapling about three
-fingers thick that bent very easily. The making of these
-withes had fallen to Sleeping Bear, Bald Eagle&rsquo;s son. It is
-about this job that our story is concerned.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_218">218</div>
-<p>When Sleeping Bear was asked to make the withes, he
-was proud. This was the first time his father had ever
-asked him to do such an important job. Dashing off into
-the forest, he came upon a young basswood sapling about
-three fingers thick. Taking his knife from its beaded
-sheath, he proceeded to cut the sapling. The flint blade
-of his knife did a very neat job and he soon had the young
-sapling down and trimmed.</p>
-<p>Then Sleeping Bear set to work to strip the bark from
-the sapling. When he had all the bark peeled away, he
-dashed home to show his father what good work he had
-done.</p>
-<p>Bald Eagle smiled. &ldquo;That is fine, my son, but now we
-must have the withes to tie the ends of the frame together.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Sleeping Bear squatted upon the ground and began to
-cut thin strips from the basswood. He worked very carefully
-until he had cut a very, very thin strip from the
-sapling. Then he cut another and another, until he had a
-good supply. Picking them all up, he walked to where his
-father was working and proudly he said:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Here, father, are the strips you can use for withes.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Without looking up, Bald Eagle said, &ldquo;That is fine, my
-son. How many have you cut for me?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have cut about thirty,&rdquo; said Sleeping Bear.</p>
-<p>Bald Eagle looked up. Reaching toward his son&rsquo;s outstretched
-hands, he grasped the basswood strips.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;These will make very fine fishing lines, my son, but
-they are much too thin for withes. You must make them
-thicker, so that they will hold the frame in the position
-we want.&rdquo; Handing the strips back to Sleeping Bear, Bald
-Eagle smiled and continued to work upon the frame of the
-wigwam.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_219">219</div>
-<p>Sadly, Sleeping Bear turned and headed back into the
-forest to find more basswood saplings. As he walked
-along, he was not thinking about the basswood, but about
-how foolish he had felt when his father told him that the
-strips he had cut were too thin. He kicked at the pebbles
-and was very angry with himself. He did not realize that
-he had walked quite a distance from the village, until
-suddenly it got very dark.</p>
-<p>Looking up, Sleeping Bear realized that he was close
-to the swamp area and that he must have come quite a
-distance. Slowly, he turned and started back along the
-trail looking to either side for basswood saplings. Finally,
-he saw two or three set back in the forest a short way.
-Leaving the trail, he reached the saplings and started to
-cut them down and trim them. He had out two when
-there was a low growl behind him. Turning, he saw a
-bear standing on his hind feet and testing the air for
-scent with his snout.</p>
-<p>Sleeping Bear was suddenly very frightened. Crouching
-low to the ground, he began to edge his way toward
-the path again. Soon he reached the path. Then he began
-to run until he was safe in the camp once again. Dashing
-up to his father he stood a minute catching his breath,
-and then he blurted out the story of the bear.</p>
-<p>Bald Eagle put his arm around his son&rsquo;s shoulders and
-said:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You see how much trouble can be brought on by one
-foolish mistake? If you had watched your father carefully,
-you would have known how to make a withe the
-right thickness. Because you were angry, you did not look
-for basswood saplings close to home, but wandered deep
-into the forest and almost became the dinner of brother
-bear. Rushing to escape the bear, you left your basswood
-saplings behind. So the task of making withes begins all
-over again. Be careful, my son, that when you do something,
-you do it right, or if you make a mistake, you do
-not waste time brooding over it. Better to accept it and
-go forth to do the job better.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And so Sleeping Bear learned a great lesson that day.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_220">220</div>
-<h2 id="c35"><span class="h2line1">THE LESSON OF THE ELM TREE</span></h2>
-<p>A small Cherokee lad by the name of White Eagle
-lived with his father and mother on the shores of a large
-lake in the Appalachian Mountains. He was a lad of
-about eleven years. His father, Great Eagle, was known
-in the tribe as one of the bravest of warriors. In this
-Cherokee tribe there was much talk of war with other
-tribes, and the tribe&rsquo;s highest honors and respect always
-went to the bravest and most daring warrior.</p>
-<p>Not many suns away lived another woodlands tribe,
-the Eries. This story concerns a young captive from this
-Erie tribe and White Eagle, the Cherokee boy.</p>
-<p>Very rarely did any tribe go so far afield in its hunting,
-but this one winter food was very scarce for the Cherokees
-and they traveled quite a distance north in search of
-additional game. They moved into the hunting grounds
-of the Iroquois, quickly made their kills, and started for
-home. On their way, they came upon an Erie boy whom
-Great Eagle decided to bring home to his tepee as a
-brother to his son.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_221">221</div>
-<p>The Cherokee tribe lived in a sentry-patrolled, fortified
-village. When Little Frog, as the Erie lad was called, first
-saw the village, he was frightened. He realized that he
-was near the entire tribe of fearful Cherokees whose wars
-his father had often recounted to him. Great Eagle sensed
-the boy&rsquo;s fear and laid his hand gently on his shoulder.
-Great Eagle took him to his home and introduced him to
-White Eagle. White Eagle was pleased to have a boy of
-his own age to play with in his own wigwam. That night
-there was much dancing and merry-making to celebrate
-the successful hunting raid into the Iroquois lands.</p>
-<p>The following morning Great Eagle roused the boys
-to tell them that today they would go in search of small
-game to improve their shooting ability. Each boy was
-given a small amount of food, and they started off for the
-forest with Great Eagle. Little Frog began to look upon
-Great Eagle as his father and felt happy. His own father
-had been killed in an early tribal raid.</p>
-<p>As they padded through the forest, they could hear the
-cry of wild birds and every now and then the snapping
-of a twig. Great Eagle signaled with his hand for the
-two youngsters to wait. Then he moved off to the side
-to investigate the noise; but once again he returned to
-the trail, indicating that the game they were after was not
-to be seen.</p>
-<p>When the sun had risen high in the heavens, Great
-Eagle decided they would sit and rest and eat some food.
-As they were eating, Little Frog asked White Eagle, &ldquo;Do
-you often travel with your father?&rdquo; White Eagle replied,
-&ldquo;Right now I am being trained by my father to become a
-great warrior.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_222">222</div>
-<p>The Erie boy was very much impressed with this and
-thought of himself how wonderful it would be if he had a
-father. White Eagle then asked Little Frog, &ldquo;Do you miss
-your village and your people?&rdquo; &ldquo;No,&rdquo; Little Frog replied,
-&ldquo;because in my village I was not wanted by anyone.
-My father had been killed in battle. My mother died of a
-great sickness and I was cast out of my father&rsquo;s wigwam
-by a new brave. I was made to work for myself to get
-food and to live as best I could.&rdquo; White Eagle realized
-then how lucky he was to have such a fine warrior father
-as Great Eagle.</p>
-<p>After drinking some water to wash down the dried deer
-meat, Great Eagle arose and the boys stood up quickly,
-and they started forward. The brave signaled the boys to
-follow him more softly now. Little Eagle noticed that
-they were approaching a stream where beaver had built
-their dams and homes. As they approached the stream,
-Great Eagle pointed to the brush where the boys should
-wait while he looked about for the beaver. Not having
-seen any, Great Eagle returned to where the boys were
-hidden and told them they would start back to the village
-and search for wild turkeys and rabbits. White Eagle felt
-a slight disappointment at not having been able to try out
-his new arrows on the beaver, but he trusted the wisdom
-of his father. So he and Little Frog returned along the
-trail with Great Eagle.</p>
-<p>When they had almost reached the edge of the forest,
-Great Eagle stopped and pointed into the brush at the
-side of the trail. There, crouching in hiding, was a small
-cotton-tail rabbit. Quickly, White Eagle raised his bow
-and let fly an arrow. The rabbit took one leap and fell
-dead. White Eagle was so excited that he danced up and
-down, shouting at the top of his lungs that he had made
-his kill. Great Eagle quieted his son and then looked
-slowly in Little Frog&rsquo;s direction. Approaching the rabbit,
-Great Eagle noticed that two arrows had struck it. He
-knew that Little Frog must have shot his arrow at the
-same time as White Eagle. White Eagle and Little Frog
-began to argue about whose arrow had really killed the
-rabbit. Naturally, each claimed that his arrow had made
-the kill.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_223">223</div>
-<p>Great Eagle was at a loss as to just what to do. He
-was always fair in his decisions and did not want to
-favor one boy over the other, especially because it involved
-his son. So Great Eagle said, &ldquo;Let us agree; say
-that each of your arrows shared in killing the rabbit, for
-I can see that you are both like stubborn elm trees&mdash;and
-you are both better with your bows than I had thought.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that, Great Eagle picked up the rabbit and put it
-in his pouch and the three of them started for home.
-Both boys seemed quite happy now that Great Eagle had
-made the decision. However, that night Little Frog
-leaned over in his bed and tapped White Eagle&rsquo;s shoulder.
-&ldquo;White Eagle,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;what does your father mean
-when he says we are like the stubborn elm?&rdquo; &ldquo;Tomorrow
-morning,&rdquo; said White Eagle, &ldquo;I will show you what my
-father meant.&rdquo; With that the boys went to sleep.</p>
-<p>The following morning when they arose, Little Frog
-was impatient to learn why Great Eagle had called them
-stubborn like the elm, and he quickly reminded White
-Eagle of his promise of the night before. Hand in hand,
-they started for the great forest. As they went along,
-White Eagle kept breaking branches of the different trees
-along the way. Little Frog was imitating White Eagle as
-they walked until they came upon a small young elm
-tree. White Eagle did his best to break the elm tree, but
-all it did was bend. Then Little Frog tried to help him
-break the tree; but despite their weight and strength, it
-still only bent.</p>
-<p>Just then they heard a voice behind them and Great
-Eagle stepped up and placed his hands on the shoulders
-of both boys.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_224">224</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Now,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;you have found the reason why I
-called you stubborn as the elm. Many, many of the trees
-of the forest can be broken and forced to the earth. But
-the elm tree will bend and not break unless the strength of
-several braves is put upon it. So it is with two proud
-young Indian boys who both believe they are right, putting
-their equal strength against each other in an argument.
-Neither gives way, just as the elm will not give
-away. If I attempted to add my strength on either side
-of the argument, the other might have bent to the earth
-like the elm if we all put our weight upon it. So remember
-this tree. As long as you believe honestly that you are
-right, you can be strong and straight like the elm tree; but
-once you leave the path of truth and wisdom you become
-weak and brittle, and your enemy can bow you to the
-ground in shame and defeat.&rdquo;</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>This story was told to the author by James Ariga, a boy of part
-Cherokee blood, at the Ten Mile River Scout Reservation in the year
-1947.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_225">225</div>
-<h2 id="c36"><span class="h2line1">THE RACE</span></h2>
-<p>Winter had come to the many Indian villages in the
-northeastern woodlands, and with it, the snow, the wind,
-and the cold. The winter was so severe that even the
-strongest braves hesitated to wander far from their villages,
-knowing that death could overtake an adventurous
-brave if a sudden blizzard should catch him far from
-familiar ground.</p>
-<p>This story is about two such adventurous young
-Oneida Indians that winter. Naltan and Ceysoda were
-outstanding young boys of their tribe. Time and time
-again before winter set in, they had taken part in the
-games and contests of the tribe, and one or the other had
-won each time. This had continued until the other young
-boys in the village decided that Naltan and Ceysoda were
-just too good for them, and that something must be done
-to prevent their running away with all the prizes.</p>
-<p>So one fall day, when they were sure that Ceysoda and
-Naltan were not around, all the youngsters gathered to
-discuss a plan. On the following day, there were to be
-foot races in the village. The group plotted that at the
-start of the foot race, two of the faster young braves
-would trip Naltan and Ceysoda so that they would fall
-and thus be put out of the race. The boys who had
-tripped them would be scored out of the race, too, but at
-least they would have the satisfaction of knowing that
-someone besides Naltan and Ceysoda would win the foot
-race for a change.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_226">226</div>
-<p>Just at that moment they saw Naltan coming around
-one of the wigwams, and they all started walking away
-in different directions. Naltan walked up to one of the
-leaders of the group and asked:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What have I missed, friend Beartooth? Ceysoda and I
-have been busy repairing and sharpening our hunting
-weapons. We did not know that there was to be a meeting
-of all the boys of the village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Beartooth was quick to recover from his surprise and
-then in a very calm voice said:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, Naltan, that was no meeting of all the boys. It
-was merely a few of us talking about the foot races tomorrow
-and the weather. It has been very cold, and soon
-winter will be here with her snow and winds and bitter
-cold. Tomorrow we are going to have the foot races. So
-we were talking about who we thought would be victorious.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do you think there are any among you who can defeat
-Ceysoda and me in the foot race, Beartooth? If you
-do, you had better forget about it,&rdquo; Naltan boasted.
-&ldquo;Ceysoda and I will win the race tomorrow, as we always
-do.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We shall see,&rdquo; said Beartooth with a note of warning
-in his voice. &ldquo;We shall see.&rdquo; Then he turned and walked
-away from Naltan toward his father&rsquo;s wigwam.</p>
-<p>Naltan shrugged his shoulders and, thinking no more
-about it, dashed off to find Ceysoda. He looked all
-around the camp and finally found him practicing with
-his bow and arrow a short distance from the village. Naltan
-told him what Beartooth had said. Ceysoda was silent
-for a few moments, thinking.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_227">227</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Naltan, my friend,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;I have a strange feeling
-that our brothers plot against us. I have no good reason
-for feeling this way, but I can&rsquo;t help it. For some reason
-our friends have planned a way to make us lose the race.
-What it is and how I know I cannot tell you, but the
-feeling is upon me.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You are foolish, Ceysoda. The fact that we have won
-many contests and games from our friends surely
-wouldn&rsquo;t give them a reason to plot any harm.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not say that they want to harm us; but in some
-way they will try to make sure we do not win the foot
-races tomorrow. Wait and see, Naltan.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys spoke no further and soon it was time to
-return to their wigwams for the evening meal. When Naltan
-and his father had finished eating, Naltan told his
-father that he would like to get his advice. So father and
-son sat down by the blazing coals of the fire in the middle
-of their wigwam.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Father,&rdquo; Naltan began, &ldquo;today Ceysoda told me that
-our friends were planning some trick to make us lose in
-the foot race tomorrow. He also said that he did not
-know why he had this feeling, but he did have it. Surely,
-father, our friends would not try to harm us?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, my son, I do not believe that your friends would
-want to harm you, but is there any reason that you would
-have to believe that what your friend Ceysoda tells you
-might be true?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_228">228</div>
-<p>&ldquo;No, father, there isn&rsquo;t anything&mdash;yes, wait a minute!
-There might be. Late this afternoon when Ceysoda and I
-had finished working on our bows, I went down to Beartooth&rsquo;s
-wigwam to borrow some thongs for my moccasins.
-Just as I reached the small clearing near Beartooth&rsquo;s
-home, I saw almost all of our friends gathered together
-talking; but when they saw me they scattered, each one
-heading for his own home. When I questioned Beartooth
-about it, he said that they had been talking about the
-coming winter and the foot races tomorrow, and had just
-finished when I arrived.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, do not worry about it, my son. Whoever is
-strongest and fastest will win tomorrow. It will soon be
-time for bed. Go out and play for a little while, but when
-your mother calls, come to bed, for you will need your
-rest for the foot races.&rdquo; With that Naltan&rsquo;s father rose to
-leave.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You know, father, my thoughts became so confused
-when I saw the crowd of boys that I forgot to ask Beartooth
-for the thongs. I will go down now before he goes
-to sleep so that I may work a little more on my bow tonight
-before I go to sleep.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Naltan left his home and walked quickly to Beartooth&rsquo;s
-home. As he neared Beartooth&rsquo;s wigwam he heard voices.
-Beartooth was talking to one of the other young braves.
-&ldquo;Yes, that&rsquo;s right,&rdquo; he was saying, &ldquo;make sure that you
-are next to Naltan at the start of the race tomorrow.
-When the signal is given, pretend to trip so that you will
-fall against Naltan and tumble him to the ground. I will
-do the same to Ceysoda. Then we can be sure that someone
-else will win the race.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Naltan decided that he did not need the extra thong
-that night, but hurried to see his friend, Ceysoda. Reaching
-the wigwam where he lived, he called until Ceysoda
-came to the entrance.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What do you want, Naltan? It is late and I am tired.
-I was just about to go to bed.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_229">229</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Ceysoda, I have discovered what our friends plan for
-us tomorrow.&rdquo; Naltan repeated what he had heard at
-Beartooth&rsquo;s wigwam. When he had finished, he waited to
-see how Ceysoda would take the news. He did not have to
-wait long, for suddenly Ceysoda&rsquo;s face took on an angry
-look. &ldquo;Those crawling mud worms,&rdquo; he cried. &ldquo;Have they
-become so jealous because they cannot win at the games
-and contests that they have to use trickery against us?
-I knew that the feeling I had was a true one. Now we
-know exactly what they are going to do. But how can we
-prevent this from happening tomorrow, Naltan?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have a plan,&rdquo; said Naltan. &ldquo;Tomorrow when we line
-up for the race we will ask that the others be given a slight
-lead over us because we have won so many races. We
-should be able to tell by what they say to that whether or
-not they would still try to carry out such a plan.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That is a very good idea, Naltan,&rdquo; said Ceysoda,
-yawning. &ldquo;Now I must say goodnight, for I am tired, and
-we have some hard running ahead of us tomorrow.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boys said goodnight. Ceysoda turned back into his
-wigwam and Naltan started to go home to his own bed.
-On the way, he wondered whether he should tell his
-father what had happened. He decided to handle this in
-his own way, without the help of any adults.</p>
-<p>The following day was very crisp and cool. Off to the
-northwest clouds warned that a snowstorm might be
-building up. But everyone was too excited to take much
-notice of anything besides the preparations going on all
-around for the big foot race. Fathers and sons together
-made the final inspection of the boys&rsquo; clothing for the big
-race. The boys&rsquo; moccasins especially were looked over
-carefully for any weak spots where the leather might
-break. A torn moccasin could mean lost time and a lost
-race.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_230">230</div>
-<p>At last, the call went up through the village for all
-who were entering the race to gather at the starting line
-just outside the village on the border of a great meadow.
-The young boys gathered, joined by their proud fathers,
-each of whom hoped that his son would cross the finish
-line first and win the beautiful bone-handled hunting
-knife which the tribe&rsquo;s medicine man had offered as the
-first prize.</p>
-<p>When all the contestants had gathered at the starting
-line, the warrior in charge of the race began to give instructions.
-He called for the attention of all the runners.
-At that moment, Ceysoda and Naltan stepped forward
-and asked that they be allowed to start ten paces behind
-the others so that this could be a more even race. There
-were many shouts from the other boys that Ceysoda and
-Naltan were only boasting. They said that they wanted
-the two boys to start with them. If Ceysoda and Naltan
-won the race, all well and good! But if they had to start
-back and lost the race then someone would always complain
-that it was not an even race. The warrior in charge
-then made his decision.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I believe,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;that Naltan and Ceysoda are being
-very fair. So far they have won all foot races by a
-great margin. Now they offer to start late in order to give
-every one of you a better chance to win. I have no doubt
-that many of you have been practicing hard for this
-event, but these two have been practicing just as hard.
-So it would be a very unfair race unless I did give them
-a handicap to even up the chances for you all.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Beartooth knew that if they argued against this ruling,
-suspicion might be aroused. So he bade his friends be
-quiet and line up again for the race.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_231">231</div>
-<p>The course for the race this year had been chosen very
-carefully. The boys were to run across the meadow and
-into the woods up the game trail until they reached the
-blaze marked on a fallen birch. Then they were to turn off
-the trail and head east until they came to the singing
-rock. That, Naltan knew, was the rock from which water
-trickled during and after a heavy rain, and made an unusual,
-almost tinkling sound. At the rock the boys would
-turn south, break from the forest, cross the meadow, and
-head for home. The first one to cross the finish line would
-be declared the winner and receive the coveted hunting
-knife.</p>
-<p>The instructions were clear. The boys waited eagerly.
-When the warrior had made sure that all were lined up
-correctly, he gave them the starting signal. Instead of
-leaping forward, the racers began to mill around. Then
-several boys broke from the group and started to run
-along the course. Five young Indian braves, including
-Beartooth, Naltan, and Ceysoda, could be seen lying on
-the ground. Naltan and Ceysoda leaped quickly to their
-feet and began running. They had already lost a great
-deal of valuable ground, but the desire to win this race
-now burned especially bright in their hearts. They ran
-swiftly across the meadow in pursuit of the fast-disappearing
-figures of the leading braves, while others
-trailed behind them.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_232">232</div>
-<p>As they reached the woods, they began to overtake the
-other boys one at a time, because the running became
-harder as they got deeper into the woods. There were
-rocks and branches to hinder their way, and the footing
-was often unsure. As the two boys reached the blazed
-birch tree they turned eastward and continued swiftly on
-their way. They soon passed more of the young braves.
-As they reached the singing rock and turned for home
-only two boys were still between them and the finish line.
-When they broke into the open and reached the meadow,
-the gap between the boys narrowed rapidly, and they
-were greeted by cheers. It was clear to all that Naltan and
-Ceysoda would overtake the two leaders. The cheering
-grew louder when, with a sudden burst of speed, Naltan
-and Ceysoda passed them and sped across the finish line
-at exactly the same moment. They were declared winners
-in a tied race, and each was given a beautiful knife.</p>
-<p>After the award was made, Naltan looked around for
-Beartooth, but could not find him. On the way home,
-Naltan asked his father if he had seen Beartooth.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why, my son,&rdquo; his father said, &ldquo;he was standing close
-to me as you and Ceysoda broke from the woods into the
-meadow on the last part of the race. Then he disappeared.
-Why are you so concerned. When you had picked yourself
-up from the ground and started after the other boys,
-the warrior in charge of the race spoke to Beartooth.
-Beartooth confessed his plan which, it seems, did not
-work out successfully. He will be punished for his plot.
-There is no need for you to be worried.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But I am worried, father, for there is no need to
-punish Beartooth. What he did was wrong, but I am sure
-he is sorry. And after all, no harm was done. I will go to
-him and speak with him and show him that I am not
-angry. Then I will talk to the warrior who started the
-race?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Naltan left his father and went to Beartooth&rsquo;s house.
-He called to his friend but there was no answer. When
-he called again, Beartooth&rsquo;s mother came out of the wigwam
-and told him that her son had not returned from the
-foot race.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_233">233</div>
-<p>&ldquo;But all the contestants have finished in the race and
-are home by now. Where could Beartooth have gone? I
-will look for him.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Naltan left to find Ceysoda, who was showing his beautiful
-knife proudly to his many friends.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Ceysoda,&rdquo; Naltan called as he drew near. &ldquo;Come, I
-must talk with you.&rdquo; When he finished telling Ceysoda
-about Beartooth&rsquo;s not returning home, the two boys went
-in search of him. They looked all through the village but
-could not find him anywhere. They asked all the children
-but they had not seen him. Finally, they found the boy to
-whom Beartooth had spoken about the plot and who was
-to have helped him. At first the boy denied knowing anything
-about where Beartooth might be; but finally after
-continued questioning from Naltan, the boy told them.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Beartooth was afraid when the warrior at the racing
-field told him that he would have to be punished. So
-while everyone was milling around and shouting at the
-end of the race, he stole off and ran into the wood. He
-feared not only the punishment of the warrior and council,
-but also the punishment that you and Ceysoda would
-bring down upon him for playing such a trick.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>While they were talking, a few snowflakes began to
-fall.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come,&rdquo; said Naltan, &ldquo;we must go after him quickly.
-From the looks of the sky and this snow, there will be a
-heavy storm. Beartooth has had little experience with
-snow. His days alone in the forest have been few. If we do
-not go after him, he may be lost in the storm and threatened
-by the wild animals of the forest.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I cannot go,&rdquo; the boy answered. &ldquo;My father would not
-allow it. Besides, how would we know where to look?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_234">234</div>
-<p>The boys stepped back and stared at the boy. &ldquo;You are
-a coward,&rdquo; Naltan said angrily. &ldquo;I cannot waste time
-arguing with you. Come, Ceysoda, we must leave immediately.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Without further words, the two friends turned and
-started for the forest. The snow was beginning to fall
-faster and thicker now. As they reached the forest, they
-stopped to choose the most likely trail that Beartooth
-would follow. The race had tired Ceysoda, and he was
-breathing heavily now.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Naltan,&rdquo; he pleaded. &ldquo;The boy was right. How
-would we know which direction Beartooth would take?
-Besides, at the rate this snow is falling any trace of him
-would be covered. Is it wise to go on?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wise or not, Ceysoda, we must go on. Beartooth must
-be found. Not knowing the forest too well, he would
-probably travel the main trail toward the north. We will
-go in that direction. If we hurry, we may be able to pick
-up a sign of his route before the snow has a chance to
-cover it completely, and reach him before he goes too
-far.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boys spoke no further but hurried up the trail to
-the north, keeping their eyes toward the ground to look
-for signs of the boy&rsquo;s having passed that way. Soon Naltan
-stopped and pointed to a place in the trail where the snow
-had been disturbed.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He must have fallen here. See the way the snow has
-been pushed aside. Come, quickly, Ceysoda, he cannot be
-too far ahead.&rdquo; The two boys continued swiftly on the
-trail. Soon they were able to make out signs of fresh moccasin
-prints in the snow. But just when they felt they were
-getting close, the wind began to blow harder, sweeping
-along the trail and covering any tracks or other signs
-that they might have found. The boys had been traveling
-at a fast pace for some time, when Ceysoda stopped suddenly.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_235">235</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Naltan, I must rest,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I am tired. I
-cannot go on without rest. Just for a moment let me
-catch my breath. Surely Beartooth will not continue without
-rest, too, and we will lose no ground by stopping for
-a short while.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;All right,&rdquo; said Naltan, &ldquo;but just for a moment. The
-day is growing late.&rdquo; The two boys squatted down by the
-side of the trail and breathed deeply to get their wind
-back again. Suddenly, Nathan gazed up through the
-trees and then, stretching his hands out in front of him,
-he said, &ldquo;Ceysoda, my friend, look! It has stopped snowing.
-We are in luck. But we must hurry even so, because
-the storm will no longer slow Beartooth&rsquo;s pace.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The two boys rose and sped on up the trail. Truly they
-were in luck, for soon they came upon a place in the
-snow where someone had stopped to rest at the side of the
-trail. The prints of small moccasins were plain in the
-snow and led straight up the trail. Now the boys increased
-their efforts, for they knew they must be close.
-Suddenly, the tracks stopped and turned off the trail into
-the thick woods. This puzzled Naltan, but he turned to
-follow them. The two boys began finding the going a
-little rougher. Suddenly, they found that they not only
-were following moccasin tracks, but another set of tracks
-now appeared not far behind the boy&rsquo;s. These were the
-tracks of a bear!</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_236">236</div>
-<p>The bear, Naltan thought, must have been late in going
-into hibernation for the winter because he had not
-found enough food. Now a delicious morsel of warm-blooded
-food was on the trail ahead of him. Now Naltan
-understood why Beartooth had left the trail; he must have
-seen the bear ahead on the trail and turned off to escape
-him. But the hear was not going to be avoided so easily.
-Naltan suddenly stopped and turned to Ceysoda.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What shall we do if we do come upon the bear and
-Beartooth?&rdquo; he asked. &ldquo;We are not armed with our bows
-and arrows. We could hardly defend ourselves against
-such a worthy opponent as a bear. Two young Indians
-such as we, no matter how brave, would be easy prey for
-a large bear. Yet we must go on and see if there is any
-help we can give. To turn back now would certainly mark
-us as cowards.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Ceysoda did not like the idea of fighting a full-grown
-bear; yet he liked less the thought of turning his back on
-danger and returning to the village to meet his friends&rsquo;
-ridicule and his father&rsquo;s anger for having been so cowardly.
-They would have trouble enough as it was, for
-having left the village without letting their parents or
-friends know where they had gone. Naltan&rsquo;s voice swung
-his thoughts back to his present plight.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I have an idea, Ceysoda. Between us we have two
-knives. Let us cut a couple of stout saplings to use as
-spears if we should need them. At least we will have
-some chance, even if it is not a very good one, against
-the bear.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_237">237</div>
-<p>So the two boys immediately began cutting stout saplings
-to hack into crude spears&mdash;poor weapons against an
-angry bear, but the best the boys could think of at the
-moment. When they sharpened the points on their spears,
-they continued following the very clear trail in the snow.
-They did not travel as fast now because they sensed a
-danger lurking ahead of them. They did not know just
-how far ahead the bear was, whether he was still following
-Beartooth, or whether he had discovered them. In
-fact, at this very moment, he might be awaiting them,
-hidden among the rocks up ahead, which they could
-plainly see now as they watched the forest in front of
-them cautiously while following the tracks carefully in
-the snow.</p>
-<p>They were continuing their anxious march in silence
-when they were startled by a sound that echoed through
-the forest, a sound all too familiar to them&mdash;the growl of
-an angry bear. It had come from in front and to the right
-of them. So the boys went on with even more caution.
-Suddenly, Naltan signaled to Ceysoda and the two boys
-crouched low to the ground. Ahead of them, about a
-hundred paces, the natural trail they had been following
-came to an end in a boxlike formation of rocks. The rocks
-reached almost straight up to the height of an elm tree.
-On top of this enclosure stood the bear and about ten
-feet below him on a ledge sticking out from the rocks was
-Beartooth. Behind the bear the boys noticed that the
-rocks continued to rise and they figured that they had
-come upon almost a dead end. Beartooth, Naltan figured,
-had reached the dead end and panic-stricken because of
-the bear, had either fallen or jumped to the ledge. For
-the moment he was safe, for the bear did not want to
-chance jumping to the ledge and there was no way that
-he could climb down. Suddenly he turned to the side and
-calmly walked around and down beside the wall until
-he was once again on the forest floor. He trotted to a spot
-directly beneath where the boy lay and studied the situation,
-trying to figure a way to get at this thing that had
-invaded the privacy of his forest at a time when he had
-been almost mad with hunger.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_238">238</div>
-<p>The wind was blowing into the faces of the boys so
-they knew for the time being they were safe because the
-bear could not smell them, but if the wind should shift
-they would then be in trouble, for the bear would turn
-his attention to them. This also gave them time to think
-and work out a plan. Suddenly Ceysoda touched Naltan&rsquo;s
-shoulder.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My brother,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;he moved. Beartooth moved;
-he is alive. We must do something.&rdquo; &ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; said Naltan,
-&ldquo;for in his present situation he might fall from the ledge
-and then it would be all over. If we can somehow drive
-the bear off, we could then rescue Beartooth and return to
-the village.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That is a good idea, Naltan, but tell me, friend, how
-do we get Beartooth off the ledge once we have chased
-the bear away, if we can chase him away?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>This was a serious problem, for the boys had nothing
-they could use as a rope and, besides, Naltan could for
-the moment think of no way to get rid of the bear.</p>
-<p>Just then the boys noticed Beartooth moving again,
-but this time he rolled even closer to the ledge. Without
-thinking, Ceysoda stood straight up and shouted at Beartooth.
-&ldquo;Look out, Beartooth, you are right at the edge of
-the ledge. Look out, you will fall.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_239">239</div>
-<p>Then Ceysoda realized what he had done, and he stood
-frozen as the bear turned and raising himself on his hind
-legs, emitting a terrible growl, started for the boys. Ceysoda&rsquo;s
-shouts had roused Beartooth and he worked his
-way back from the edge of the ledge close to the wall and
-safety. Meanwhile the bear was increasing his speed
-toward the two boys. The boys stood almost frozen with
-fear, but suddenly they were able to shake off the paralysis
-that had gripped them, and both boys drew their
-rustic spears in front of them to await the charge of the
-bear who was coming ever closer.</p>
-<p>Naltan stepped slightly in front of Ceysoda in order to
-take the brunt of the attack, but Ceysoda would have
-none of it and edged up right next to Naltan. By this
-time the bear was almost upon them and with a terrifying
-snarl came rushing the last few yards.</p>
-<p>Naltan and Ceysoda, with the ends of the spears
-jammed into the ground held fast as the bear rushed
-right into the sharp points. The bear stopped in his tracks
-as if suddenly he had forgotten something and then with
-an agonizing snarl fell over dead, the two spears protruding
-from his body. Immediately Naltan and Ceysoda ran
-forward to the base of the ledge. Climbing to the top
-above Beartooth, the boys cut a long stout staff and
-lowered the end to Beartooth who grasped it and was
-pulled to safety. Then swiftly the three boys started for
-the village. On the way, each in turn told their story.</p>
-<p>First Beartooth told of how he had run away and how
-he had been chased to the top of the rock formation by
-the bear and, in trying to avoid him, had fallen. The two
-boys told how they had followed Beartooth to bring him
-back and of their coming upon the bear and their narrow
-escape.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_240">240</div>
-<p>When they reached the warmth and security of their
-village again, Naltan and Ceysoda went with Beartooth
-to his wigwam and there assured him that they had no
-desire to punish him in any way for his trickery of that
-morning. &ldquo;What you did was wrong, but what has happened
-to you today we firmly believe is punishment
-enough. Let us forget the incidents of this day. We are
-still friends and friends we must remain, for only through
-unity and friendship will we grow into strong good
-Oneida warriors.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Beartooth smiled and thanked his two friends, and he
-continued to smile as Naltan and Ceysoda walked off
-arm in arm toward their homes and large suppers that
-awaited the returning heroes.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_241">241</div>
-<h2 id="c37"><span class="h2line1">LITTLE THUNDERBIRD TELLS THE TRUTH</span></h2>
-<p>The Blackfoot tribe was on the move. The buffalo had
-begun to search for new pasture. So the tribe had packed
-all its tepees on the travois and were moving to follow
-the herd. Their lives depended upon these prairie beasts,
-and they did not dare to be too far from them. For two
-days the herd moved until it found enough grass and
-water, and then it milled around and started to graze.
-How long or how short a time they would stay in this
-new place, no one knew; but here the tribe must make
-its camp until the buffalo forced them to move again.</p>
-<p>As soon as his family&rsquo;s tepee was set up, Little Thunderbird
-wandered off in search of some excitement. He
-was a Blackfoot lad who seemed to be able to get into
-trouble no matter where he was&mdash;like the day he cut the
-string on his father&rsquo;s bow, or the day he burned a hole
-in his mother&rsquo;s new dress. These are only samples of the
-kinds of mischief Thunderbird got himself into. So today
-he planned to stay far from his home until mealtime and
-in that way keep out of trouble.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_242">242</div>
-<p>Skipping through the village, he saw some of his friends
-throwing stones to see who could throw the farthest, and
-he ran up to them to ask if he could play. His friends told
-him to get in line and wait his turn. Soon he was throwing
-stones along with the other children. After they had
-played this game for a while, the children decided to play
-Follow the Leader. There was a great deal of talk about
-who would be leader for the game. Finally, one of the
-older boys was chosen, and he led off by dodging
-through a rack of drying buffalo meat.</p>
-<p>After everyone had run through the rack, the leader
-headed for the strings of ponies which were picketed
-out on the edge of the village. Here he ducked under the
-lines of many ponies that reared and whinnied from
-fright as the shouting youths leaped past them one after
-another. This kept on until one of the braves who was
-guarding the ponies chased the boys back into the village.
-The leader ran over boulders, danced between tepees,
-and did many other stunts which each boy repeated until
-finally the leader sat down, tired out. All the other boys
-admitted they were tired, too, and the group sat around
-talking about their fathers&rsquo; great deeds.</p>
-<p>Soon it was Little Thunderbird&rsquo;s turn and he stood and
-walked to the center of the circle, the way the big braves
-did in council. Then he raised his hands for silence from
-the group.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My father is the greatest of Blackfoot warriors,&rdquo;
-Thunderbird began. &ldquo;One day, while he was out on a
-hunt with some other braves of the tribe, he spotted a
-mountain lion. They were high in the hills and they had
-been looking for some ponies that had strayed from the
-herd. When my father saw the mountain lion, he spoke
-with the other braves and they decided to kill the beast.
-As you know, the mountain lion preys upon our pony
-herds. By killing this one, that would be one less lion to
-worry about. My father looked around the circle of
-braves and asked who would go with him to kill the lion.
-The braves talked a great deal and at last two of them
-stepped forward and said that they would go.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_243">243</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Slowly the three men began the climb into the hills.
-The lion had seen them coming and headed for higher
-ground. But finally he came to a solid wall and could
-climb no farther. My father stepped forward and drew
-his bow and shot an arrow toward the lion. He missed
-and the lion started toward him, snarling. The other
-braves turned and ran for their lives. There was no time
-to shoot another arrow, so my father drew his knife and
-waited for the lion&rsquo;s charge.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;The beast leaped, and my father caught the lion on
-his knife. Again and again, he plunged the knife into the
-lion. The fight ended quickly. The lion lay dead at my
-father&rsquo;s feet. My father had not even been scratched.
-Dancing around his victim, my father cut the lion&rsquo;s tail
-off and placed it in his pouch. Then he caught up with
-the other braves farther down the trail, and they continued
-on the hunt for the ponies.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;After they found the ponies and brought them back
-to the village, my father told the council of his brave
-fight and held the tail of the lion on high for all to see.
-For his courage, he was allowed to wear another feather
-in his headdress. Now he is really a brave worthy of
-honor from all. But the two who deserted him were cowards
-and do not deserve to be members of our tribe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When Little Thunderbird had finished, he seated himself
-in the circle once again. He was proud of the way the
-other boys listened to his story and the way they talked
-of his father as a great brave. Little Thunderbird enjoyed
-the attention he was getting, but in his heart he was
-troubled. He had made up the whole story. There was
-no truth at all in it. Then the test came.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_244">244</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Take us to see the lion&rsquo;s tail, Little Thunderbird,&rdquo;
-one of the boys said. &ldquo;We want to see the lion&rsquo;s tail.&rdquo;
-And the rest of the boys took up the cry.</p>
-<p>Now what was Little Thunderbird to do? But he decided
-to bluff it out anyway. He led the boys to his
-father&rsquo;s tepee. When they got there, he searched hurriedly
-for something that looked like a lion&rsquo;s tail. But he
-could not find anything. The boys began to get angry.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You lied to us, Little Thunderbird,&rdquo; one of them said.
-&ldquo;Your father never killed a lion, and he is not the greatest
-brave in the tribe!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The other boys agreed. They ran out, leaving Little
-Thunderbird standing at the entrance to his father&rsquo;s
-tepee. Suddenly, Little Thunderbird felt very much alone.
-In the next few days, he began to feel even more lonely
-because the other boys would not play with him or speak
-to him. This went on, until one day Little Thunderbird
-refused to leave the tepee. His mother asked him if he
-felt sick, and he told her he was &ldquo;just a little tired.&rdquo; But
-Little Thunderbird&rsquo;s mother knew that something must
-be wrong and so she talked with her husband about it.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I know what is wrong, my dear wife. My friends have
-told me of Little Thunderbird&rsquo;s tale to the other boys
-one day about the brave deed of his father, the greatest
-warrior the Blackfoot have ever known. When they asked
-Little Thunderbird to prove the story, he could not. He
-had lied to his friends and his conscience is punishing
-him.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But can&rsquo;t you help him?&rdquo; the boy&rsquo;s mother pleaded.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_245">245</div>
-<p>&ldquo;There is nothing I can do. Many moons ago I taught
-my son the strength of truth. He does not have to lie
-now. If he is not proud of his father, let him say so. I am
-not ashamed that I have not done something great and
-have not done something very brave. I have done no more
-and no less than most of the braves of the tribe. Surely I
-am not the greatest warrior in the tribe, and I have never
-given Little Thunderbird any reason to say that I am.
-The boys will not make fun of him if he tells the truth.
-They know that their fathers are like me. The boys will
-probably praise him if he admits that he lied.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Thunderbird lay just inside the tepee and had
-heard his father speaking with his mother. Rising from
-his bed, he ran out of the tepee and headed through the
-village to find his friends. His parents understood and
-did not try to call him back. Finally, he found them,
-once again seated in a council circle like the men of the
-tribe. When they saw him coming, the tallest arose from
-his place and stopped Little Thunderbird before he could
-reach the circle.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What is it you want here, teller of lies?&rdquo; he asked
-angrily. &ldquo;We do not want you for a friend. Go from this
-place. There is none here that you could call a friend.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, let me speak,&rdquo; Little Thunderbird begged. &ldquo;I
-have something important to say and I want to be heard.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;All right, speak,&rdquo; the tall lad said, &ldquo;but be brief&mdash;and
-none of your lies!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Thunderbird stepped to the center of the circle.
-He was about to raise his arms for silence as he had done
-before, but he thought better of it and waited until the
-boys were quiet once again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_246">246</div>
-<p>&ldquo;The last time I stood before you I told you of my
-father&rsquo;s brave deed in fighting a mountain lion.&rdquo; The boys
-began to laugh, but Little Thunderbird went on. &ldquo;I lied
-to you. My father is a brave man but he has never had
-to fight a mountain lion. My father taught me to tell
-the truth when I was very young. He trusted that I would,
-and I have broken that trust. But I have learned my
-lesson. Lies can bring nothing but hurt to the liar and
-to all who trust him. If we speak with a straight tongue,
-our friends will believe in us and trust us. I ask you now
-to trust me. I will never lie again. Your friendship means
-too much to me.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The tall boy rose from the circle. The other boys
-watched him closely to see what he would do. Everyone
-was very quiet.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Here truly is a brave Blackfoot,&rdquo; the tall boy said.
-&ldquo;It took real courage for Little Thunderbird to come
-before this council and admit he was wrong.&rdquo; He paused
-and looked at Little Thunderbird. &ldquo;I offer you my hand in
-friendship once again. Come, take your place in the
-council.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Thunderbird smiled and took his place. A short
-distance from the circle, a tall brave smiled, too. Little
-Thunderbird&rsquo;s father had been sure to speak loudly so
-that his voice would be heard by the young boy inside the
-tepee.</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>Based on an idea from a story told to the author by Mr. Walter
-Elliott.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_247">247</div>
-<h2 id="c38"><span class="h2line1">THE PRIZE NO ONE COULD SEE</span></h2>
-<p>The dawn came slowly as the sun tried to fight its way
-through the mist that hung in the valleys. The spring had
-been cool, and for nearly a moon rain had been drenching
-the ground. By midmorning, the sun had burned away the
-haze, and its rays beat down upon the little Kickapoo
-village, warming and drying everything that had been wet
-and cold for so long.</p>
-<p>When Little Snapping Turtle walked from his father&rsquo;s
-wigwam and saw the bright sun and the blue skies, he
-called to his father who was still inside.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Father, father, come here! See, the sun has won. The
-storm clouds have run from the battle with the sun. Once
-again we have light and warmth. Is this not a good reason
-for a celebration?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my son, it is reason enough for you and your
-friends to celebrate. But we should be glad for the rain
-we have had because it makes the forest green and gives
-the streams new strength and makes the lakes rise so that
-all the animals may drink. Of course, it has also kept the
-young braves in their houses, so now that the sun is out
-again we should have a celebration.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What shall we do, father? Can we go on a hunt or a
-fishing trip? Can we, father?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_248">248</div>
-<p>&ldquo;No, my son, there is not time for that yet. Now that
-the sun is with us again, there is much gardening to do
-right here in the village. But late this afternoon we shall
-have a race to see who has lost the most speed during this
-lazy vacation. Go to the other young braves in the tribe
-and tell them that I, Big Snapping Turtle, Medicine Man
-of the Kickapoo tribe, will give a fine belt and knife as a
-prize to the young brave who wins the race this afternoon.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What kind of a race will it be, father?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, it would not be fair to tell you, my young son,
-for then you would have an advantage over the other
-young braves. Just spread the news and this afternoon we
-will gather in the meadow for the race.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Eagerly Little Snapping Turtle ran to tell all the young
-boys to gather in the meadow north of the village late
-in the afternoon for a race. He also told them about the
-prize that any young brave would want. Most of the boys
-he talked to were working hard in the gardens to make
-up for time lost during the rain. But they stopped long
-enough to listen excitedly to the news Little Snapping
-Turtle brought. All of them said they would be there, and
-then went back to work. The rain had been good for the
-seed, but it had also been good for the weeds. When Little
-Snapping Turtle got back home, he went to work cheerfully
-with his father in their garden to clear out the weeds.</p>
-<p>Finally the time neared for the big contest, and the
-young boys began to gather in the meadow. Soon every
-boy in the village was present, and Big Snapping Turtle
-stepped to the front to explain the rules.</p>
-<p>He first gave each boy a small container made of birch
-bark. After this had been done, Big Snapping Turtle
-signaled for all to be quiet.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_249">249</div>
-<p>&ldquo;A quarter of a mile from here there are several small
-lakes,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;In one of those lakes, as you know,
-there are some very small fish. Each of you has a container.
-At the signal you will run to that lake and trap a
-small fish. Making sure to keep the fish in the container,
-you will run back to the meadow. The first boy to return
-with a fish still alive in the container will win the race.
-Then after the prize has been awarded, we will put all the
-fish you caught into the stream that runs through our
-village so that they can swim to the great lake to the
-south.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boys waited impatiently for the signal. When it
-was given, they shouted and laughed as they raced toward
-the lake that held the small fish. Little Snapping Turtle
-soon was far ahead of the other young boys. When he
-reached the lake shore, he waded knee deep into the lake
-and placed his container halfway under and then stood
-perfectly still, waiting for the curious little fish to swim
-into the trap.</p>
-<p>As he stood there quietly, peering at the sandy bottom,
-several of the others arrived and began to follow his lead.
-Soon there were fifteen or twenty of them spread out
-near the shore standing motionless waiting for the fish.
-Now and then a boy would shout that he had made a
-catch only to find that the fish had escaped.</p>
-<p>Finally patience rewarded Little Snapping Turtle. With
-a flick of his wrist, Little Snapping Turtle scooped his
-container into the water. When he looked into it, he
-discovered that he had trapped two fish instead of one.
-Quickly he waded toward shore and he saw that two boys
-had also trapped their fish and were on the way back to
-the meadow. He stopped only a moment to tear a large
-leaf from a plant that grew along the lake shore. Then
-he wrapped it tightly over the mouth of the container and
-started running again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_250">250</div>
-<p>The two boys were running swiftly ahead of him along
-the trail, each with a container in his hand. Suddenly,
-one of the boys slipped and fell and his container and
-fish went flying off into the brush. Now only one boy,
-Crying Hawk, stood between Little Snapping Turtle and
-victory. Using all the strength he had, he began to catch
-up with the young boy ahead of him.</p>
-<p>As he began to pass Crying Hawk, he noticed that the
-boy was limping. Looking at the boy&rsquo;s feet, he saw that
-Crying Hawk&rsquo;s moccasins were loose, and he guessed that
-a pebble must have fallen into one of them. The boy
-stopped to take the pebble out. As he did, Little Snapping
-Turtle sped by him. Turning to look at Crying Hawk,
-Little Snapping Turtle found that the boy had just sat
-down and was crying. He stopped and went back to him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What is the trouble, Crying Hawk?&rdquo; Little Snapping
-Turtle asked kindly.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I thought that for once I could win a game and own
-a new knife and belt. But a pebble has cut my foot, and
-I cannot hope to win now. I was lucky enough to catch
-my fish first and I thought that I had a good head start.
-But as it always has happened, an accident will make me
-lose the race. I will never be a winner. Don&rsquo;t wait for me,
-Little Snapping Turtle. If you stay with me any longer,
-the other boys will catch up with you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then Little Snapping Turtle remembered that Crying
-Hawk had never won any contest. He was a little slower
-than the other boys, and not so skilled as many of them.
-He, Little Snapping Turtle, had won many contests and
-many prizes. Quickly he took off his own new doeskin
-moccasins and slipped them onto Crying Hawk&rsquo;s feet.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;These will protect your feet,&rdquo; he told Crying Hawk.
-&ldquo;Run quickly now, for you still have a chance. Take my
-container, too. I have sealed a leaf tightly over the top
-and little water will spill. Today you will win the race.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_251">251</div>
-<p>Crying Hawk started to complain, but Little Snapping
-Turtle silenced him. He pulled the other boy to his feet
-and, shoving the container into his hand, sent him on
-his way. With the new moccasins, the boy ran more easily
-and soon was out of sight. Little Snapping Turtle picked
-up Crying Hawk&rsquo;s container and put his feet into the ill-fitting
-moccasins. He trotted slowly after Crying Hawk,
-keeping just far enough behind to make sure the boy
-would win.</p>
-<p>He heard several pairs of feet moving swiftly along the
-trail just in back of him. From here to the meadow, the
-trail narrowed and only one boy could use it at one time.
-So Little Snapping Turtle kept his slow pace and kept the
-others from passing Crying Hawk. Little Snapping Turtle
-could see the clearing now and he sped toward the
-meadow. There he saw Crying Hawk standing proudly
-next to Little Snapping Turtle&rsquo;s father. He ran up to
-Crying Hawk.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Say nothing of what happened on the trail,&rdquo; he
-whispered. &ldquo;You have run a good race, Crying Hawk.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Soon all the boys were back and the inspection of the
-containers began. When Big Snapping Turtle had seen all
-of them, he stepped to the front and declared Crying
-Hawk the winner. Everyone cheered as the boy received
-the knife and belt from the smiling Medicine Man. Then
-they all started back toward the village to place the fish
-in the stream and then go home.</p>
-<p>As Little Snapping Turtle and his father walked along
-the trail, the Medicine Man asked, &ldquo;Where did you get
-that container, my son?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_252">252</div>
-<p>Little Snapping Turtle blushed as he looked up at his
-father, but his father smiled. &ldquo;It is well, my son. I knew
-each container that I had given out and at the end of the
-race you did not have the one you had started with. I
-also noticed the beautiful moccasins that Crying Hawk
-was wearing. I discovered, too, how big my son&rsquo;s heart
-really is. Today you lost a race, but the happiness you
-won is the best possible prize.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_253">253</div>
-<h2 id="c39"><span class="h2line1">THE MYSTERIOUS PONY RAIDERS</span></h2>
-<p>Among the American Indians truth was respected as
-most sacred. Parents took great pains to teach their children
-that above all else, a good Indian was one who had
-honor and spoke nothing but the truth, or, as the Indians
-would say, spoke with a straight tongue. It is about the
-power of truth that this story is told.</p>
-<p>The Blackfoot Indians were a wandering tribe of the
-Western plains. Their very lives depended upon the great
-buffalo herds. From the buffalo meat and hides, the
-Blackfeet were able to get their food, skins for clothing,
-and their tepees; and from the head, horns, and tail,
-decorations for costume and headdress.</p>
-<p>Blackfoot villages were always moving, since they
-were set up near the grazing herds of buffalo. When the
-herd moved, the whole tribe would tie its belongings
-onto travois drawn by horses, and move with the buffalo
-until the animals stopped once again to graze where there
-was more prairie grass.</p>
-<p>Young Deerfoot, the son of a great warrior of the
-Blackfeet, Sleeping Bear, prided himself on being one of
-the strongest of the tribe&rsquo;s young braves. While growing
-into young manhood, he had won many honors in his
-tribe as a warrior and a great hunter. Blind Dog was
-another young brave about Deerfoot&rsquo;s age. The son of
-Black Dog, he also had become quite famous among the
-Blackfeet for his honors in war and hunting.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_254">254</div>
-<p>Both young braves were guarding the tribe&rsquo;s horses,
-one very warm summer evening as the chiefs of the Blackfeet
-were gathered in the center of the village around the
-blazing campfires. The chiefs had met to talk of tribal
-problems and to plan ahead for fall and winter. At this
-time, life had been unusually peaceful on the plains.
-There had been some horse stealing and a few occasional
-skirmishes among small parties of raiders from different
-tribes. Outside of that, there had not been much excitement.</p>
-<p>As the chiefs sat around the fire, Blind Dog and Deerfoot
-were taking their job of standing guard over the
-horses very seriously. The quiet was broken by a noise off
-to one side of the herd of horses. Deerfoot signaled
-silently to Blind Dog to draw near so that they might
-speak. When Blind Dog had reached Deerfoot&rsquo;s side the
-two crouched low behind the horses, and Deerfoot whispered
-that he had heard a noise slightly to the west of the
-herd.</p>
-<p>The two braves crept forward on their hands and
-knees, keeping the horses between themselves and whatever
-had made the noise. The horses began moving
-uneasily as the two young braves drew closer to the spot
-from which the noise had come.</p>
-<p>Deerfoot stopped abruptly. He slapped Blind Dog&rsquo;s
-shoulder and began to laugh. Not two paces from them
-was a small mongrel dog which had wandered down
-among the horses seeking a cool place in which to lie and
-rest for a while. When Blind Dog saw what had amused
-Deerfoot so much, he laughed too, because they had
-been so alarmed by a dog.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_255">255</div>
-<p>&ldquo;If it were not so quiet tonight,&rdquo; Deerfoot remarked,
-&ldquo;we would not have been so worried by anything so
-unimportant as a puppy.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; Blind Dog agreed, &ldquo;it has been much too quiet.
-We have not had much excitement. Things have been
-far too peaceful.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do you wish to have a war on your hands, Blind
-Dog?&rdquo; Deerfoot asked with a smile.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, it would be a very welcome change from horse
-herd duty at night, and repairing bridles and broken
-weapons in the daytime.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You are getting restless, my friend.&rdquo; Deerfoot spoke
-soberly now. &ldquo;That is not good. When one gets restless,
-one becomes careless. That can be dangerous.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>At first, Blind Dog refused to be serious. &ldquo;Oh, do not
-worry, Deerfoot. I may have become restless, but I will
-never become careless.&rdquo; Then he added gravely, &ldquo;To
-become careless even for a moment might mean death
-to a warrior like myself. There is many a brave in other
-tribes who would love to see my scalp hanging from his
-tepee pole. But I like the feel of my scalp right where it
-is. Anyway, nothing&mdash;not even a puppy&mdash;will ever catch
-me off guard.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not be so sure of yourself, Blind Dog. Being so
-sure can make any brave careless. You must always be
-alert. It may seem too peaceful to us here now, but even
-the quiet shadows of this very night could conceal our
-enemies. As we sit here talking noisily about not being
-careless, they could be stealing some of our best horses.
-Let us go back to our guard posts so that we can watch
-the herd as we should.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_256">256</div>
-<p>Deerfoot and Blind Dog mounted their horses and
-had started to circle the herd to see that nothing had
-disturbed the horses. When they had finished checking
-and had dismounted, Blind Dog complained that he felt
-ill.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Since we have just checked the herd and everything
-is all right,&rdquo; Deerfoot said, &ldquo;why don&rsquo;t you return to the
-village, Blind Dog, and go to your tepee? It is almost time
-for the other guards to take our places. I can stand guard
-alone for that short time.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Blind Dog said that he should not leave his friend,
-but with Deerfoot&rsquo;s urging, he finally agreed and walked
-slowly back toward the village. Arriving at his tepee, he
-found that his father must still be at the council meeting.
-The night air had become chilly and he wrapped himself
-in a warm buffalo robe and curled up in the corner of
-the tepee. Blind Dog was just about to fall off to sleep
-when he heard men shouting excitedly and horses snorting
-and pounding their hoofs. He struggled out of the
-robe and stepped outside of the tepee in time to see
-several chieftains break from the council ring and head
-toward the horses.</p>
-<p>As they reached the edge of the herd, they called out
-for the guard but there was no response. They called
-again and again, but their only answer was the stomping
-of horses and the frightened neighing of ponies. It was
-very dark and it was some time before the chieftains
-discovered that about six of their finest animals were
-missing. Where were the guards, they wondered, and
-how had the horses gotten loose? Then someone noticed
-Blind Dog and called to him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Blind Dog, were you not on watch with Deerfoot?
-What did you see? What happened? Who raided our
-herd?&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_257">257</div>
-<p>Blind Dog looked at Great Owl and his father, Black
-Dog, who stood waiting for his answer. Just then they
-heard the clopping of a single pony&rsquo;s hoofs. Peering into
-the darkness, they could make out the figure of a lone
-horseman riding wildly toward the standing group. As
-the rider came nearer, Blind Dog saw that it was his
-friend. Deerfoot jumped from his pony and stood, breathless
-and bleeding, before the chieftains, waiting for silence
-so that he could report what had happened. When everyone
-was quiet, Deerfoot began his story. For the moment,
-Blind Dog was forgotten.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Blind Dog and I were on guard here at the horse
-herd,&rdquo; Deerfoot said, &ldquo;when we heard a strange noise.
-We found that it was only a stray dog that had wandered
-down here to the horse herd. We went back to our guard
-posts and settled down again, keeping careful watch.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;After some time had passed, I heard another noise
-much like the dog had made so I did not pay any attention.
-Suddenly, the horses became uneasy. When I went
-to see what the trouble was, I was struck a blow on the
-side of my head. It was not too hard a blow and only
-made me a little dizzy. As I shook off the shadows from
-my brain, I spotted a small group of warriors who were
-cutting some of our best ponies loose from the herd. Then
-I called for Blind Dog and started after the raiders. By
-the time I had reached the place the raiders had been,
-they were already heading back into the night, driving
-several of our ponies before them. I quickly mounted a
-pony and started to chase the thieves, but I lost them in
-the darkness. Perhaps I was closer to them than I realized
-because they let some of the stolen ponies go. I have been
-able to round up some of the ponies, but I believe there
-are still a few missing. I will mount up again and start
-after them immediately.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_258">258</div>
-<p>But Chief Great Owl stopped Deerfoot with a wave
-of his hand and said, &ldquo;No, Deerfoot, let some of the other
-braves round them up. You are hurt and need rest. But
-first we must speak with Blind Dog. Who has seen Blind
-Dog?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Without any hesitation, Blind Dog stepped from the
-circle of braves and stood next to Deerfoot.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You summoned me, Chief Great Owl?&rdquo; he asked
-politely.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Blind Dog, were you on herd guard duty tonight with
-Deerfoot?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, Great Chief, I was.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;When Deerfoot called you to assist him, why did you
-not answer?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Because I was not where I could hear Deerfoot.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Where were you then?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;When Deerfoot called for help, I was in my tepee just
-about to go off to sleep.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Great Owl glared at Blind Dog. &ldquo;Do you mean that
-you had left your guard post to sleep in your tepee, leaving
-Deerfoot here alone to watch the herd?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Black Dog waited for his son to answer. &ldquo;Speak, my
-son,&rdquo; he pleaded. &ldquo;Tell Great Owl that you did not desert
-your friend and leave him alone on duty.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am sorry, father, but what he says is true. I was
-not at my guard post when the raiders came in the night.
-I did neglect my duty and for that I shall take proper
-punishment.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son,&rdquo; Black Dog said with great sorrow in his
-voice, &ldquo;do you know what you are saying? You are admitting
-that you have shirked your duty. Is guarding the herd
-not important to the whole tribe?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, father, it is very important. I am ashamed of
-what I have done.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_259">259</div>
-<p>Great Owl ordered Blind Dog to be held under guard
-until the council should decide his punishment.</p>
-<p>Quietly, Blind Dog went with the guards. He glanced
-back toward Deerfoot, but Deerfoot would not meet his
-gaze. Dropping his head upon his chest, Blind Dog was
-troubled that Deerfoot had avoided looking at him. He
-was worried, too, about why Deerfoot had not told the
-rest of the story&mdash;how Deerfoot had insisted that he go
-to his tepee when he had felt ill. Then he guessed that
-Deerfoot must have had a good reason, so Blind Dog
-would not change his friend&rsquo;s story unless he really had
-to. He vowed, however, that he would try to speak with
-Deerfoot and discover for himself just why Deerfoot had
-not told them the whole story.</p>
-<p>The tepee in which Blind Dog was held under guard
-was close to the center of the village where the council
-had met. Suddenly, he heard many voices talking excitedly
-and realized that the council had gathered again.
-What had been a calm council before had now become
-an angry group of men seeking revenge upon the horse
-stealers. He heard Deerfoot repeating his story and the
-chieftains questioning him closely. Above all they wanted
-to know of what tribe the raiders were members. Then he
-could hear Deerfoot reply vaguely, &ldquo;It was dark and I
-was still confused from the blow upon my head. I would
-not want to accuse any tribe unless I were sure. But who
-could be this close to us?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Many of the chiefs shook their heads in doubt, but
-Sleeping Bear rose to plead for war, repeating by his own
-son&rsquo;s account of the stealing of fine horses by a neighboring
-tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_260">260</div>
-<p>Crouched in the tepee, Blind Dog realized now why
-Deerfoot had not told the complete story. Rushing to the
-entrance of the tepee, he begged the guards to take him
-before Chief Great Owl and the council. One of the
-guards ran to the council and reported the prisoner&rsquo;s
-mysterious request. Chief Great Owl said that Blind Dog
-should be permitted to enter the council ring and speak
-to the council.</p>
-<p>With head held high, Blind Dog stepped to the center
-of the ring and gazed around at the unfriendly eyes which
-peered at him from faces of stone. Finally Blind Dog
-spoke.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Since I was but a tiny boy holding tightly to my
-father&rsquo;s hand so that I would not stumble, I have been
-taught to respect the property of others. I have
-been taught to honor my parents and the elders of our
-tribe. I have been taught to learn well the many things
-a good brave should learn. Above all, I have learned the
-power of truth.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My father has told me many times that I would never
-gain by telling a lie. I have seen the truth of this often.
-Now, more strongly than ever, I see the power that truth
-can have. I wondered a while ago why Deerfoot had not
-told the whole story, but now I know.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_261">261</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, we were on guard duty together, as he told you,
-and we did hear a noise after that of the dog. We circled
-the herd to see that all was well. Upon returning to our
-starting place, I told Deerfoot that I was not feeling well.
-I had suddenly become chilled and sick to my stomach.
-Deerfoot reminded me that it was almost time for us to
-be relieved, but that I should go immediately to my
-tepee to rest. He said that he would be glad to stand
-guard alone. I realized that what I did then was wrong,
-but I felt so sick that I followed Deerfoot&rsquo;s suggestion
-and went to my father&rsquo;s tepee. There I rolled myself in a
-buffalo blanket and lay in pain for some time until I, too,
-heard Deerfoot&rsquo;s shouts and the hoofbeats of the horses
-running away from our camp.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I, too, rushed to the herd and reached there a short
-time before most of you. I looked around quickly for
-signs that would show how many raiders there had been.
-But oh, Great Chieftain, there were no tracks of any
-ponies other than our own.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Deerfoot has used this story to try to arouse our tribe
-to a war. He thirsts for the excitement that fighting
-would bring him. Now I am sure that Deerfoot ran those
-ponies off himself in order to cause a war between our
-tribe and our nearest neighbors. If I am lying now,
-punish me doubly; but if I am right, let the punishment
-fall where it belongs, even upon my friend.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Great Owl rose and called upon Deerfoot to defend
-himself. All eyes were turned in his direction as Deerfoot
-rose to face Blind Dog.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh, Great Chief,&rdquo; said Deerfoot, &ldquo;all that Blind Dog
-has told you is true. I sent him from the herd and I ran
-the ponies off into the night. I made the wound that you
-see on my head. We had no raiders in our camp tonight.
-Blind Dog has just taught me the true meaning of loyalty
-to my tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_262">262</div>
-<p>&ldquo;The fact that he was placed under guard and was to
-be punished made little difference to him. But when he
-discovered that my plan was to hurt more than him and
-me, he spoke out for what he believed was the truth.
-Yes, I had hoped to force our tribe into war. I hoped
-that I might be honored for bravery in war, even though
-I would sacrifice the honor and friendship of my boyhood
-companion, Blind Dog, and many of our braves might
-be killed in useless fighting. To make myself once again
-a man in Blind Dog&rsquo;s sight, let me repeat his words.
-&lsquo;I am ashamed of what I have done.&rsquo; Let the council
-punish me so that I will not forget again the sacredness
-of truth and friendship and loyalty to my tribe.&rdquo;</p>
-<hr />
-<blockquote>
-<p>The incident around which this story is woven was told to the
-author by Sam Carpin, trapper, hunter, and former member of the
-Butte, Montana, Police Force.</p>
-</blockquote>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_263">263</div>
-<h2 id="c40"><span class="h2line1">THE CANOE RACE</span></h2>
-<p>Long Bow for many moons had been the champion of
-the canoe racers in the Ottawa village and had accepted
-every challenge that had ever come his way.</p>
-<p>From the time he was a young boy he had spent many
-hours upon the waters of the great lake practicing his
-canoeing until he felt there wasn&rsquo;t another boy in the
-tribe that could come at all close to beating him in a fair
-race.</p>
-<p>Soon the great hunt was upon them, and the warriors
-gathered their weapons and headed north to hunt the
-elusive deer. Whenever they went off on these hunts Black
-Rock, a short husky young warrior, always could be seen
-as the constant companion of Long Bow.</p>
-<p>As the hunting party trotted along the woodland trail
-getting farther and farther from the village, Black Rock
-and Long Bow would hold conversation in sentences with
-very few words.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I think we will have a good hunt, Long Bow.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, Black Rock, for the signs of deer in this area are
-many.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We have had a good year, and if the gods bless us we
-will have another good year.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Soon the winter will be upon us and we must wait a
-long time for the spring.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Long Bow, you speak of the winter when here it is
-just late spring.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_264">264</div>
-<p>&ldquo;It will be a long summer for me.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why so, friend Long Bow?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It used to be that during the summer when we held
-our games and contests there would be excitement and
-thrills.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Are there still not excitement and thrills for you?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Black Rock, my friend, I have become so skilled that
-there are none left in our tribe who give me any competition.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;That is not a wise way to talk, Long Bow. One must
-never set himself above all others; that can be said only
-by the council.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As they continued along the trail, Black Rock said no
-more to his friend, and Long Bow did not seem concerned
-that his friend offered no more conversation.</p>
-<p>Soon they both forgot about the talk, for the hunting
-party had begun to split up in search of the game. For
-the next few hours the party made many fine shots and
-then it was time to return to the village.</p>
-<p>Each of the two braves had a fine buck strung upon a
-pole between them as they walked easily along the trail
-homeward. Once again Black Rock and Long Bow were
-a team.</p>
-<p>Now the excitement of the hunt was over and the
-catch was good, and all the braves were feeling very good
-about their success. And so as a result there was much
-talk and laughing and joking about the misses and successful
-shots. Long Bow noticed that Black Rock was
-especially quiet as they walked along the trail.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Black Rock, my friend, what makes your tongue so
-still? You have made a fine kill this day and there will be
-much fresh meat for the village, yet you walk with a
-heavy step and your voice is still.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_265">265</div>
-<p>&ldquo;I am silent for a good reason, Long Bow my friend,
-for I fear that if I speak my heart will speak rather than
-my lips.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Long Bow said nothing for a long while, trying to
-figure out what Black Rock meant by such a statement.
-Finally the leader of the hunt called a halt and the warriors
-placed their heavy burdens upon the ground and
-seated themselves under the shade trees to rest and drink
-of the water pouches before the journey homeward.</p>
-<p>As Black Rock and Long Bow sat beneath a tree,
-Long Bow chanced a question of his friend.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What did you mean, friend Black Rock, that your
-heart would speak rather than your lips?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;As we approached the hunting grounds, my friend,
-you said that your summer would not be enjoyable because
-there was no competition for you. Would the fact
-that you are among your people not give you joy enough?
-Must there always be competition or contests to make
-your blood run fast?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Black Rock, you are one who can be contented with
-every-day living in our village. I cannot, and the yearly
-games and contests I have always looked forward to
-with great anticipation; but for the past three years there
-has been no competition among the braves, especially in
-the king of contests, the canoe race. Eagerly the young
-braves have met me on the lake, but I am so skilled that
-no one has been able to come even close to winning in
-the canoe race.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;This is not a good way to feel, friend Long Bow, so
-I guess it is time that someone told you so. I, Black
-Rock, will challenge you upon the lake and then we shall
-see if there is no competition left in the village.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_266">266</div>
-<p>Now Long Bow had never raced against his friend
-Black Rock, for Black Rock had never entered the canoe
-race, leaving the glory to his friend Long Bow. He also
-knew that Black Rock was considered a good man in a
-canoe but not good enough to defeat the great Long Bow.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Then this is a challenge, friend Black Rock?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, Long Bow, when the moon is full, on the following
-dawn we shall man our canoes on the great blue
-water. We shall race and see who best handles the canoe.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Long Bow laughed. &ldquo;Oh, Black Rock, are you serious?
-Do you really think that you can beat your friend Long
-Bow in a canoe race?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I do not know, Long Bow, but someone has to try.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The leader called, and the men picked up their burdens
-and continued on their way home.</p>
-<p>In the days that followed, whenever Long Bow had
-no work to do he could be found out on the lake paddling
-up and down the shore line practicing hard for the
-coming event. Black Rock on the other hand very rarely
-would be seen in a canoe unless he were fishing or
-trapping.</p>
-<p>Word had spread swiftly through the village about the
-canoe race, and the excitement was growing as each
-night the moon appeared more full. Finally the moon
-was full and that night there was a great celebration in
-the camp in preparation for the big event.</p>
-<p>Many of the braves were making wagers as to who
-would win, and there even were some hot words; but the
-men realized that this was to be a friendly challenge.
-Suddenly one of the braves realized that Black Rock was
-nowhere to be seen. This was unheard of the night
-before a great contest and they looked high and low but
-could find no trace of him. Finally one of the men
-thought to ask his wife who had been sitting quietly off
-to one side.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_267">267</div>
-<p>&ldquo;He has taken a walk before retiring. He said that he
-wished to be alone this night.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Black Rock was alone. He had walked to a small glen
-a short way from the camp, and there if one had come
-he would have seen a young warrior kneeling talking to
-someone although no other person could be seen.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;O, Great Manitou, who guides the lives of all red
-men, give me strength tomorrow to wield a strong and
-sure paddle. Carry my canoe swiftly across the waters
-and on to victory. Not for the glory that it will bring me
-but to wipe from the heart of my friend Long Bow his
-feeling that he is above the other men of the tribe. If he
-can be made to see right again, as a good Ottawa brave
-should, this is all that I ask.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When he had finished Black Rock rose and returned
-to his home. The celebrating was still going on, but
-quietly Black Rock said good-night to his wife and
-wrapped himself in his blanket and was soon asleep. He
-had been troubled, but his walk and his prayer had eased
-his mind, for now he knew that it rested with the great
-spirits.</p>
-<p>The following day dawned bright and clear, and before
-the sun had risen very far in the heavens the lake shore
-was crowded with eager spectators waiting for the start
-of the race.</p>
-<p>The rules were outlined to the two warriors and then
-each took his position along the shore, standing in their
-respective canoes. About a mile down the shore of the
-lake a warrior stood with a gayly colored coup stick. This
-was the point which would indicate the finish line. The
-signal was given, and the two men bent to the task.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_268">268</div>
-<p>The crowd cheered as the two canoes sped down the
-shore line, neither one getting far ahead before the other
-would pull alongside. As they neared the finish line, the
-watchers on the shore could see the muscles of the two
-men striving in their backs and shoulders.</p>
-<p>Finally the finish line was just a few yards away, and
-with a mighty surge, Black Rock drove his canoe across
-the finish line first.</p>
-<p>There was a mixed chorus of groans and cheers as the
-men returned to the starting point and beached their
-canoes. The crowd milled around Black Rock as he
-stepped ashore, but he raised his arms for silence.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Long Bow has lost the race this day, but let no man
-say that he is not a good man with the canoe; for there
-are none among us who to this day have been able to
-defeat him. I shake the hand of my brother Long Bow
-and to him I say, it was a great race and I have won, but
-it was a close race and if we raced again I might not be
-so lucky.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, Black Rock, it was not luck this day that won
-the race, but rather a strong back being helped by a true
-loyal heart. I know now why you challenged me and I
-could not have won if you had tied one hand behind your
-back. I have been selfish and ungrateful for the many
-friends and good things that have been showered upon
-me. I have lost this battle of the canoes, but it has helped
-me win a battle with myself. I thank you, Black Rock,
-for bringing a straying warrior once again into the camp
-of good Ottawas.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_269">269</div>
-<h2 id="c41"><span class="h2line1">STANDING FAWN MAKES A DOLL</span></h2>
-<p>When the excitement was over in Flying Arrow&rsquo;s wigwam
-and all the Shawnee had returned to their own
-homes to sit and talk of the birth of a new son to Flying
-Arrow, Standing Fawn, daughter to Flying Arrow, wandered
-off from the wickiup to think about this thing that
-had happened.</p>
-<p>Until this day, little Standing Fawn had been the
-center of attention in the home of her mother and father
-and also when they went to visit friends; but now a new
-baby boy had been born, and everyone was very excited.
-When Standing Fawn had come running to tell her
-mother how she had helped her grandmother to dry
-rabbit skins and to make furry ropes for blankets her
-mother had said how nice that was, but went right back
-to taking care of the little boy Indian that now held the
-place of honor in the home of Flying Arrow.</p>
-<p>This Standing Fawn could not understand, but for the
-time being she did not think about it any more but went
-to join the other girls that were gathering nuts. The girls
-had to hurry so that they gathered enough nuts for the
-tribal families before the squirrels got them all.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_270">270</div>
-<p>The walnut and butternut hulls were used for dyeing
-quills and so many, many nuts had to be gathered that
-soon the baskets were bulging with these and beechnuts,
-hazelnuts, and hickory nuts. When the task was over
-Standing Fawn returned home to her father and mother
-and her little brother.</p>
-<p>As she entered the wickiup she could hear her mother
-singing softly to the new baby. There against the wall
-was the carrying case for the baby which Standing Fawn
-had helped her mother to make. That was fun working
-with her mother, but now mother was busy with the new
-baby and so Standing Fawn felt that she was no longer
-loved.</p>
-<p>After supper, she crawled into her warm blankets and
-was soon asleep, but she awakened a short time later as
-the new baby cried for food. The crying continued until
-he was fed and then Standing Fawn was asleep once
-again.</p>
-<p>For many weeks there was a great deal of work to be
-done with the new baby in the house, and Standing Fawn
-found that more and more she was asked to carry on the
-duties that her mother had done before this time.</p>
-<p>When friends came to visit, they still had a smile and
-warm pat on the head for Standing Fawn, but most of
-the attention was given to her little brother, or so it
-seemed to Standing Fawn.</p>
-<p>One night the little baby was very restless and did a
-lot of crying. Standing Fawn did not sleep well that night
-and in the morning when she rose to stir the coals for
-the morning fire and prepare to cook the breakfast she
-was feeling very cross. Her mother called to her from the
-wickiup.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Standing Fawn, will you go to the stream and fetch
-some fresh water and heat it for me, please?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, mother, I will go, but I am so tired,&rdquo; Standing
-Fawn heard herself answer. &ldquo;Today I would like to go
-to grandmother&rsquo;s to help her with the quills if I may.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_271">271</div>
-<p>&ldquo;But, Standing Fawn, I need your help here today.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I want to go to grandmother&rsquo;s today.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;All right, Standing Fawn, you may go to grandmother&rsquo;s
-today. I will manage alone.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So after Standing Fawn had fetched the water she
-skipped merrily on her way to join her grandmother who
-was busy this winter in making fancy quill work upon
-moccasins and leggings, knife sheaths, and anything else
-that needed bright decoration.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Welcome, Standing Fawn, you have not been to see
-your grandmother for a long time. I was beginning to
-think that you had forgotten old Granny.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, grandmother, it is just that with the new baby I
-have been kept so busy that I have not been able to leave
-home for very long at all. I wish the new boy had never
-come to our home.&rdquo; With that Standing Fawn kicked her
-foot at some soft rabbit hides that lay on the floor of the
-wickiup, more angry at herself than anything else.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Now, now,&rdquo; said her grandmother. &ldquo;That is no way
-to feel, especially about a little boy who was not able to
-choose whether he would come to the house of your
-father or not. He is very small and he does not understand
-if you are angry with him, but he does understand love
-and attention.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, grandmother, and he is getting plenty of that
-from everyone who comes to our house. Since he has
-come I have been very unhappy, and I shouldn&rsquo;t be
-unhappy, should I, grandmother?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, Standing Fawn, that is not the right feeling to
-have in your heart. Let me explain something to you as
-best I can.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_272">272</div>
-<p>&ldquo;When you were born your father was disappointed,
-for you were a girl and he had hoped so for a warrior
-son, but he loved you as much as if you were a boy; for,
-as your mother said to him, your daughter will bear many
-sons. Your parents loved you and cherished you and did
-everything they could to make your life a happy and
-pleasant one. When your mother was heavy with child
-you were a great help to her around the wickiup. When
-your brother was born, there was much excitement in
-the village, for it was a boy and now your father had a
-warrior son and a beautiful daughter.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;For this he was very thankful and went to the hills
-to thank the great spirit for blessing his home so. When
-he returned there was great rejoicing once again just as
-there was when you were born, but then the work started
-just as when you were born, and your mother had no
-one to help her when you were a very small baby, but
-now she had you and she depends a great deal upon you
-to help her with your little brother. Soon he will be big
-and strong and you will be very proud to be called his
-sister. But now he is small and needs your love and
-attention.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I understand, grandmother, and I have been a very
-foolish girl. I will try to make up to my brother for this
-feeling I have had in my heart that is bad.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I am glad, granddaughter, to hear you say that. Now
-you had best run along, for your mother will be needing
-help this day.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_273">273</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my grandmother, but first I have something I
-must do.&rdquo; So Standing Fawn strolled off to a corner of
-her grandmother&rsquo;s wickiup and there she gathered some
-items into her lap and began working busily at something.
-Soon it was finished and she rose and saying good-bye to
-her grandmother, walked back to her own wickiup. Her
-mother was busy preparing supper, for the project Standing
-Fawn worked on had taken most of the day.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, my daughter, did you have a nice day with your
-grandmother?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh yes, mother, a very nice day.&rdquo; Standing Fawn was
-sure to keep her hands behind her back so that her
-mother could not see what she held.</p>
-<p>Finally she excused herself and ran into the wickiup.
-There where he usually hung was her baby brother in his
-cradleboard, warm and sleeping. To the large cradle loop
-above his head, Standing Fawn hung a dainty little doll,
-all dressed in buckskin, that she had been so busy making
-that day. Next to the doll she placed a very small bow
-and arrows and tiny moccasins. Just at that moment her
-father entered the wickiup.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;See, father, what I have made for my little brother,
-who will one day be a great warrior. When he sees this
-doll it will make him want to run fast and shoot straight
-and carry himself as a warrior should.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As Standing Fawn talked her mother had entered and
-was standing next to her father.</p>
-<p>Flying Arrow motioned for his daughter to come to
-him and then kneeling on the ground and placing his
-hands upon his daughter&rsquo;s shoulders he said:</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Surely, my daughter, if he were not destined to be a
-great warrior he would not be blessed with such a fine and
-beautiful sister. I am a very proud man to have such a
-wonderful family.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Standing Fawn looked at her mother, and her mother
-was smiling. And inside, Standing Fawn felt all warm and
-good.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_274">274</div>
-<h2 id="c42"><span class="h2line1">BLACK CLOUD REMEMBERS</span></h2>
-<p>It had been many weeks since the Seneca hunting party
-had seen the friendly smoke of their own village and as
-they lay among the pines, resting now, they were thinking
-of how it would be in their village when they returned
-the following day to speak of their success on the hunt.
-Their catch was large and there would be much dancing
-and celebration when they did return.</p>
-<p>Black Cloud, leader of the hunting party, lay stretched
-out beneath the boughs of a large pine and gazed up
-through the branches at the clear sky lighted this evening
-by a bright full moon. The heavens were filled with stars,
-and this would mean a good clear day for travel when
-dawn finally broke upon the forest.</p>
-<p>The party had traveled far in search of food but their
-labors were not in vain for they were returning loaded
-down with good fresh meat for their tribe.</p>
-<p>The trip had been an exciting one from the standpoint
-of the hunt, but now the excitement was over and the
-warriors were tired. A half day&rsquo;s journey lay between
-them and their homes, and they were eager to start the
-next morning.</p>
-<p>The canoes had been pulled up the side of the lake and
-rigged for shelter in case of rain but all the party were
-sleeping in the open. As Black Cloud lay gazing at the
-stars he remembered back to his days as a boy when he
-had made his first hunting trip with his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_275">275</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, father, hurry, we must get started!&rdquo; Little
-Black Cloud had called as he waited at the beach for his
-father to join him. His father finally arrived and, approving
-of the canoe which his son had chosen, he turned it
-upright and pushed it into the lake. They loaded their
-packs and hunting weapons and soon Black Cloud was
-seated in the middle of the canoe as his father pushed
-from shore.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Where are we going to hunt, father?&rdquo; asked Little
-Black Cloud.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well, my son, I thought that we would try Bear Lake;
-for many of our warriors have reported fine deer around
-Bear Lake, and you saw the two beauties that were
-brought to the camp last week.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, father, they were beautiful bucks, and I hope we
-are as fortunate.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We have a hard long journey ahead, my son, and so
-pull hard upon the paddle; for we must reach the upper
-end of the lake before nightfall. There we will make camp
-and tomorrow we shall carry our canoe to the upper lake
-known as Bear Lake. It is quite a distance and though it
-may seem close it will take us some time to reach our
-destination.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Father and son pulled upon the paddles, and soon the
-canoe was moving steadily forward toward the upper end
-of the lake. As the craft skimmed through the water,
-Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father pointed out the many signs
-of wild game that could be seen along the shore.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_276">276</div>
-<p>Here was evidence of where brother beaver had been
-at work cutting logs or here was a grey muddy hole near
-the lake&rsquo;s edge to which the forest animals came to
-drink. Always the canoe was kept near the shoreline, for
-this made the trip more interesting since there was much
-to see.</p>
-<p>As noon approached, Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father
-directed the canoe in to the shore and beached it in a
-small cove. Father and son stepped ashore and pulled the
-canoe up after them. Near by there were some fine berry
-bushes and, walking inland a short way, they came upon
-a clear swift flowing stream. They picked some berries
-and, seating themselves near the stream, they made a
-meal of some fried venison they had brought with them,
-berries, and water. After eating they relaxed for a few
-moments and then the two walked back to the lake edge
-and climbing aboard their canoe once again were soon
-continuing their journey up the lake shore.</p>
-<p>It was near dark when they reached the top of the
-lake. Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father guided the canoe into a
-small stream leading from the lake and, calling to his son
-to stop paddling, he guided the canoe softly against the
-shore of the stream. The two Indians stepped from their
-canoe and then, lifting the canoe from the water, set it
-upon the shore.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;We shall make camp here for the night, my son. You
-will gather some wood and I will see if I can catch us
-some fish for our supper. I shall not be gone long and
-there will still be plenty of daylight.&rdquo; Saying this, Little
-Black Cloud&rsquo;s father took up his fishing line and bone
-hook and a bright spinner and started back through the
-woods for the lake shore.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_277">277</div>
-<p>Little Black Cloud meanwhile started busily preparing
-camp and gathering wood for a fire. In an hour his father
-was back carrying a fine fish and soon they were having
-fresh fish steaks broiled on green sticks. These they flavored
-with some sugar, which they always carried, and
-washed it down with fresh water.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;And now, my son, we must sleep, for in the morning
-we have a long walk ahead to reach the Bear Lake.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Father and son rolled into their blankets and the night
-noises around them provided a lullaby.</p>
-<p>When dawn broke, Little Black Cloud found that his
-father had been up for some time and that breakfast was
-ready and waiting.</p>
-<p>Following a hearty breakfast, Little Black Cloud
-picked up his pack. His father strapped his own pack
-upon his back and, balancing the light birch bark canoe
-upon his head, led the way through the forest toward the
-lake. The woodland Indians often had to make portages
-like this in order to reach their final destination.</p>
-<p>After traveling for some time in this manner, Little
-Black Cloud noticed a clear space among the trees ahead.
-His father seemed to sense what he was thinking, for he
-called to his son, &ldquo;That is Bear Lake just ahead. It was
-given that name many moons ago by our people, for it
-used to be the home of many bears who lived and thrived
-here, but when our people discovered that many fine fish
-lived in these waters they had to drive the bears off in
-order to make the fishing grounds safe for our people.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Since the disappearance of the bears the deer have
-flocked to the shores of this fine lake, and now whenever
-fresh meat is needed a small party of us come to the lake
-and in a short time we have enough meat for the needs
-of our people.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_278">278</div>
-<p>Soon the two had reached the shores of Bear Lake
-and, looking out upon the calm waters, Little Black
-Cloud said, &ldquo;My, how peaceful the waters look, father.
-It seems as though nothing or no one had ever visited
-these shores before.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Then a short distance down the shore there was a
-rustling in the brush and a splash, and soon the head of a
-doe would be seen bending to drink, and then another
-and another; and then the eight-pointed head of a buck
-could be seen a short distance beyond the does.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Look, father, look. How many deer are there?&rdquo; Little
-Black Cloud was very excited, for never before had
-he seen such a large number of deer in one place at the
-same time.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come, my son, we must leave our gear here and go
-in pursuit of the fine deer. They abide all along these
-shores and back away from the lakes in the shaded glens
-and the open meadows. It may not be as easy to catch
-them as it is to see them.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Once again the canoe was placed in the water, and
-father and son set off to hunt the deer. They moved
-quietly down the shore, but no sooner had they reached
-a spot near enough to fire an arrow when the deer would
-turn and disappear into the woodlands. For several hours
-they paddled the shore but try as they might to approach
-the deer quietly the animals would turn as if warned and,
-with a flick of their tails, were deep in the woods by the
-time the canoe was within striking distance.</p>
-<p>Soon dusk was drawing nigh, and the two turned their
-canoe to return to where they had left their gear.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come,&rdquo; said Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father, &ldquo;we will
-have some supper and when it is dark we shall hunt
-again.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But, father, how can you hunt when it is dark? You
-cannot see the deer.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_279">279</div>
-<p>&ldquo;I will show you, my son. First we must gather some
-pine knots.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>And so the supper was prepared and two very hungry
-Indians feasted and then sat back to allow the food to
-settle. Finally the father rose and taking his boy by the
-hand they wandered into the woods to gather pine knots.
-Finally they had gathered about ten pine knots and these
-they placed in the bottom of the canoe.</p>
-<p>Then Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father made an attachment
-on the front of the canoe which would hold a burning
-pine knot. It was getting dark faster now, and so the two
-Indians loaded their weapons into the canoe and then
-strapping a piece of birch bark to the bow of the canoe
-to act as a reflector they pushed away from shore after
-lighting a pine knot and placing it in the holder which
-contained sand so the fire would not burn the canoe. It
-was then that Little Black Cloud was able to see why his
-father wanted the pine knots.</p>
-<p>As they skimmed along the shore, the deer would see
-the light and be attracted by it to the shore. This would
-then make them easy targets, for their bodies would then
-be outlined on the shore.</p>
-<p>Slowly the canoe moved along the shore until Little
-Black Cloud&rsquo;s father motioned for him to stop paddling.
-Placing his paddle in the bottom of the canoe, Little
-Black Cloud took his bow and arrow and stood waiting.
-Soon the flash of a pair of eyes was seen and then Little
-Black Cloud fired.</p>
-<p>There was a splash and all was still. They steered the
-canoe toward the place they had seen the deer and there
-lay a small buck. This was placed in the canoe and they
-moved on.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_280">280</div>
-<p>Little Black Cloud shot another deer that night, and
-then father and son returned to camp to skin and dress
-the two deer.</p>
-<p>The following day they returned to the lake where they
-had started and were soon paddling down the lake shore
-for home. Little Black Cloud&rsquo;s father decided not to stop
-that evening and so continued paddling swiftly until the
-friendly fires of the village were in sight. He beached the
-canoe, and a proud father and a very tired young Indian
-boy entered the village that night with two fine specimens
-of deer.</p>
-<p>Black Cloud sighed as he lay under the pine. Yes,
-these were fond memories he had of the days when he was
-a youth.</p>
-<p>But soon he would be doing the same thing his father
-had done twelve summers ago for when he returned to
-the village the next day, he did not know that his wife
-would be waiting for him with a new-born baby son, a
-boy who would some day paddle swiftly along the lake
-shore with his father.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_281">281</div>
-<h2 id="c43"><span class="h2line1">THE MIRACLE OF THE PINE GROVE</span></h2>
-<p>The drums beat slowly. A cloud of sadness hung over
-the Iroquois village. People moved slowly about their
-tasks. Even the pets of the village seemed to have lost
-their playfulness. The little children were playing quietly
-at sitting games, rather than the usual noisy running
-games that they liked so well.</p>
-<p>As Little Rock, a young Iroquois warrior, rode into the
-village with a dead buck slung across his pony, he became
-suddenly aware of the great feeling of sadness that
-was upon his village. Instead of hearing the usual gay
-greetings from the people of the tribe, Little Rock noticed
-that when he looked at them they would shake their
-heads and turn slowly away. Little Rock feared that great
-trouble had come and wanted to know what it was. So
-he dug his heels into his pony&rsquo;s sides and sped toward his
-father&rsquo;s wigwam. As he drew near, he saw a number of
-people gathered close to the entrance. The drums boomed
-slowly and sadly. As Little Rock came nearer his friend,
-Little Red Cloud, stopped him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Little Rock!&rdquo; his friend warned gently. &ldquo;Do not
-go to your father now. The Medicine Man is with him.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;What is the trouble with my father?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not worry, Little Rock. Great Rock is a great and
-strong Chief. He will be all right.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_282">282</div>
-<p>&ldquo;As my friend, Little Red Cloud, I ask you once again.
-What is the matter with my father? It cannot be so simple,
-when half the tribe gathers outside the entrance to my
-father&rsquo;s wigwam. They usually come to talk or seek advice,
-but now they are silent and their faces are sad. Tell
-me, Little Red Cloud, what is wrong?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Rock could not wait for an answer. He jumped
-from his pony and ran swiftly toward his father&rsquo;s wigwam.
-He was met at the entrance by his mother.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, Little Rock! Do not come in yet. Tall Spear is
-making medicine for your father. He is very ill.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I must go to him. He may need me.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Just then the Medicine Man joined Little Rock&rsquo;s
-mother.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your father is asking for you, Little Rock,&rdquo; the old
-man said. &ldquo;You can see him now.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Rock stepped inside the wigwam and found his
-father lying on the great buffalo robe, his head propped
-up. Great Rock&rsquo;s face looked drawn and tired and he
-breathed with great difficulty. As Little Rock knelt beside
-his father, the sick man&rsquo;s eyes opened wide.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, you have returned.&rdquo; Great Rock spoke slowly
-as though each word pained him greatly. &ldquo;Did you have
-a good hunt?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my father. There was much game and I was able
-to bring a really fine buck back to our village. He will
-give us much fine meat, and his skin will make you a fine
-shirt.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Great Rock closed his eyes for a few moments while
-Little Rock, his mother, and the Medicine Man waited
-anxiously in silence. Then Great Rock opened his eyes,
-wet his lips, and started speaking with great effort again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_283">283</div>
-<p>&ldquo;That is good, my son. You have learned the ways of
-the forest well. This was your first trip alone into the
-great forest, yet you have tracked down a fine buck.&rdquo; The
-old chief seemed more tired than before.</p>
-<p>Little Rock reached for a bowl of soup near by and
-spooned some of this to his father&rsquo;s lips. The old man
-started to sip the soup slowly. Then he raised his hand
-weakly.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, your father is old. Last night this sickness
-came upon me. I feel that the time is growing near when
-I shall journey to the Happy Hunting Grounds. I have
-raised you to be a warrior in our tribe. I have taught you
-the way of the bear and the way of the fox. You will
-have to be the man of the family now and provide for
-your mother.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But, my father,&rdquo; said Little Rock, &ldquo;you must not leave
-us now. Our tribe and all the Iroquois need you now
-more than ever before. There is trouble among the tribes.
-Soon the Great Council will meet. If your seat at the
-Council is taken by one who is not so wise, the trouble
-among our tribes will continue and become greater. You
-must get well, father, for much depends upon you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;There are others as wise, my son. My voice is but a
-small breeze in a big windstorm. The men who lead our
-tribes are wise in the ways of peace. They will make good
-decisions. Of that I am certain. But now leave me, my
-son, for I wish to be alone. I am tired and I must rest for
-the final journey.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my father, I will go now, but it is not to pine and
-weep, as the others do. I know you will get well. Tall
-Spear will make strong medicine. I have no fear.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_284">284</div>
-<p>Little Rock left the wigwam and, without saying a
-word to anyone, he mounted his pony and rode swiftly
-from the village. For many hours he rode until it was
-nearly dark. Then he stopped his pony in a pine grove.
-Leaving the pony to graze, he walked deep into the grove
-until he came to a place where an opening in the trees
-allowed the last rays of light to stream in.</p>
-<p>Under the spreading branches of a great pine tree,
-Little Rock knelt and started digging with his knife to
-root up some plants. When he had gathered a handful of
-roots, he arose. He walked toward a stream and near it
-he picked some berries from a bush. He dropped the
-roots and berries into a small leather pouch and rode
-back to the village. He thrust the pouch into his mother&rsquo;s
-hand and asked her to brew the roots quickly in some
-fresh water.</p>
-<p>When the broth had been bubbling for a short time,
-Little Rock grasped the gourd from the fire and carried it
-toward the wigwam where his father lay ill with fever.
-As he approached the wigwam, Tall Spear stopped him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Little Rock, what is it you carry in the gourd?&rdquo; the
-Medicine Man asked.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Many moons ago, my father and I traveled deep into
-the forest. Finally we came to a large pine grove. Deep
-within the pine grove, my father pointed out certain roots
-and berries that grew there and nowhere else near our
-village. He told me that those berries and roots would
-make strong medicine for anyone sick with hotness of the
-skin. When I spoke with my father, I remembered those
-roots and berries. I thought that a broth made from them
-might save his life. So I have brought them to his wigwam.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The Medicine Man grasped the gourd and was about
-to turn away when Little Rock seized his arm.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_285">285</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Make him drink, Tall Spear. Tell him this is broth
-made from the plants in the pine grove. He will understand
-and he will drink.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I will give him the medicine and I will tell him. You
-have done well, Little Rock. Your respect for your
-father&rsquo;s wisdom is very great.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With that the Medicine Man disappeared inside the
-wigwam, and Little Rock sat upon the ground to wait.
-Soon Tall Spear came out again.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your father has sipped the broth. He told me to clasp
-your hand as he would in thanks for bringing the roots.
-He is resting now. All we can do is wait.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>As time went by, Little Rock became drowsy and soon
-could keep his eyes open no longer. As he fell asleep, the
-old Medicine Man took his blanket and wrapped it
-around the young brave&rsquo;s shoulders.</p>
-<p>A new day was dawning as Little Rock awoke. He
-looked quickly toward the entrance of the wigwam. Suddenly
-Tall Spear appeared, his face looking cheerful.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your father is asking for you. He is weak but he will
-not die. He will sit at the Council soon to decide for
-peace. Go to him and go with your head held high, for
-you have much to be proud of this day.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Little Rock entered the wigwam and hurried to his
-father&rsquo;s side. At that moment his father reached out his
-hand and Little Rock bent down to take it. The eyes of
-father and son met in silence. No words were needed to
-tell how much more closely their lives were tied together.</p>
-<p>Tall Spear stepped quickly outside. It seemed only a
-moment to the men inside the wigwam when they heard
-the voices of their Oneida brothers speaking loudly and
-happily again.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_286">286</div>
-<h2 id="c44"><span class="h2line1">CROOKED ARROW FINDS A FRIEND</span></h2>
-<p>Black Hawk was a young Shawnee brave who lived in
-the earliest days of the American Indian. Black Hawk
-had been raised in his village by his father, Tall Hawk,
-who was very proud of him.</p>
-<p>Tall Hawk had very carefully taught Black Hawk all
-there was to know about hunting, fishing, stalking, and
-all the other necessary ways of forest and stream.</p>
-<p>Each year, Tall Hawk would look at his son growing
-and exclaim to his wife, Soft Bird, &ldquo;See how tall and
-strong he grows. Surely he is the most handsome brave in
-our village. Not only is he handsome but brave and
-strong as well; he will bring much honor and glory to his
-father.&rdquo; At this Soft Bird nodded, for she knew how
-much Tall Hawk thought of his son.</p>
-<p>It was late spring, and the Shawnee were preparing to
-take the trail of the wild fish and game. It was time they
-began thinking of new skins for clothing and housing and
-food for their families. Each father who had a son, carefully
-trained his son for just this day.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_287">287</div>
-<p>Finally all was in readiness and the great hunting party,
-after bidding good-bye to their friends and loved ones,
-took the trail to the north where scouts had earlier reported
-seeing herd of deer. Perhaps this would be easier
-than they had thought, but as they traveled onward, Tall
-Hawk began to realize that they were quite a long way
-from the village.</p>
-<p>He signaled for the party to stop and called two of the
-leader warriors to him. &ldquo;We have traveled far from our
-village. Do you think it wise that we go on? Surely along
-the way we have seen many single deer, but nowhere have
-we seen signs of a herd or a large number. This territory
-which we now enter is the home and hunting
-grounds of the Conestogas. We must leave here, for we
-are on land that does not belong to us.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Tall Hawk was turning to speak to the others of the
-party when one of the warriors interrupted him. &ldquo;Yes, this
-is Conestoga country, but we are to stop now because of a
-few woodland weasels that call this their land?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But it is their land and we shall do just that, turn
-around and go back. Such foolishness this day could
-bring the angry Conestogas down on our heads in a very
-short space of time and we would be badly outnumbered.
-Our party is not too strong, and any attack upon us here
-in unfamiliar territory would mean that many lives would
-be lost.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Are you afraid, Tall Hawk? Does your stomach swim
-and your heart flutter like a bird? Surely the Conestogas
-do not concern you?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;One Conestoga against one Shawnee, or even two
-Conestogas against one Shawnee, and I would not in the
-least be afraid, for the gods know that one good Shawnee
-brave could hold his own against any two Conestogas.
-But we are on their home grounds. Any attack by a large
-force of Conestogas and any one of us would be lucky to
-live. No, foolish one, we shall turn and go back in the
-direction we came. We shall search elsewhere for the
-elusive deer.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_288">288</div>
-<p>With that, Tall Hawk turned to the hunting party and
-repeated what had gone on between himself and the other
-two braves. There were some grunts from braves who disagreed
-with Tall Hawk, but for the most part they were
-willing to return.</p>
-<p>As the party turned to go back down the trail, one of
-the scouts who had been sent ahead came running into
-the circle to report that a large band of Conestogas were
-heading for just that place and they would be better off
-to start immediately for the home village. Tall Hawk gave
-the signal, and the hunting party turned quickly and
-trotted south toward the village.</p>
-<p>It was fully a day&rsquo;s journey and they had no rest. The
-long grind began to tell upon their numbers. When they
-would falter and were about to collapse, Tall Hawk could
-be heard to shout, &ldquo;Keep running, fools! Do you wish
-your hair to grace the home of one of our Conestoga
-neighbors?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>This threat served its purpose, and the braves who
-were tiring suddenly found fresh strength and would continue
-the grueling run.</p>
-<p>Soon they reached their own hunting grounds and were
-safe on the other side when the Conestogas broke from
-the cover of the forest and into the meadow which
-separated the hunting grounds of the two tribes.</p>
-<p>Suddenly the leader of the Conestogas raised his hand,
-and the band of braves with him stopped running and
-listened. The chief explained that they had reached the
-border and could go no further. And so the score was
-equal. Black Hawk was proud of his father, for once
-again he had proved to his fellow braves that he was a
-wise man.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_289">289</div>
-<p>The hunting party slowed down a bit now and, after
-traveling about two miles, they camped for the night.
-They were tired and after a hasty supper they fell off to
-sleep one by one until all but the guards were sound
-asleep. Black Hawk was soon sound asleep as well, but
-Tall Hawk lay awake thinking.</p>
-<p>Why did they not sight the deer before they reached the
-land of the Conestogas? Surely the scouts that had reported
-the deer herd to the village had not imagined seeing
-so many deer, or had they? And why had the chase
-taken them into Conestoga land? Over and over he
-asked himself these questions until he could not stay
-awake any longer and finally he was asleep with the rest
-of the party.</p>
-<p>The next morning after breakfast the party continued
-on its trek, this time turning westward. Soon they came
-to a large lake and Tall Hawk divided the party, requesting
-some of them to remain here and fish and the
-others to continue on around the lake in search of game.
-Black Hawk was among those chosen to stay and fish and
-he was very happy about it. He saw that he was the only
-young brave allowed to stay with the fishing party and he
-felt it was because he was such a good fisherman.</p>
-<p>When the hunting party had finally gone out of sight,
-Red Hand, the second in command, gathered the group
-and explained to them their mission. This lake should
-have plenty of fish, and so they would spend the next day
-and night here fishing and in the morning of the second
-day return to their village, as they hoped, with a successful
-catch of fish from the beautiful lake.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_290">290</div>
-<p>Red Hand led the way down the shore of the lake to
-where the last fishing party had hidden the canoes. Then,
-asking the party to team up in pairs, he slipped a pouch
-from his shoulder and gave out fishing equipment to each
-brave. When each one had received his equipment, Red
-Hand said, &ldquo;We shall fish the lake for one day and we
-shall rest on shore for one night. On the dawn of the
-second day the hunting party will return and we shall all
-leave for our homes together. Let us pray that the gods
-will smile favorably upon us this day and that our catch
-will be a large one. Good luck to all of you, and may
-your lines be heavy with fish when you return.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>With these words ringing in their ears the Indians
-rushed to the canoes and pushed off into the quiet blue
-waters of this great lake. Black Hawk had chosen as his
-partner an older brave of the tribe by the name of
-Crooked Arrow. Perhaps it seemed strange that Black
-Hawk should choose his partner because he was so
-young, but Crooked Arrow very rarely spoke and many
-of the Indians of the tribe did not like him. Why they
-did not like him, Black Hawk did not know. He did
-know that Crooked Arrow was not very good-looking
-and that he was a little fatter than most of the other men
-of the tribe. But, aside from that, Black Hawk could see
-no reason for not liking him and so had asked him if he
-would be Black Hawk&rsquo;s partner in the fishing trip.</p>
-<p>Crooked Arrow had shaken his head and without saying
-a word had followed Black Hawk to the canoes and
-helped him lift one into the lake. The other braves had
-laughed at Black Hawk when they saw him choose
-Crooked Arrow as his partner, but Red Hand had motioned
-them to be quiet and stop making fun of the boy.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_291">291</div>
-<p>When the instructions had been given out and the
-equipment distributed among the braves, Black Hawk
-and Crooked Arrow stepped into their canoe and pushed
-away from the shore. They dipped their paddles softly
-into the lake and the canoe glided quietly across the
-waters.</p>
-<p>Soon they had pulled away from the other canoe and
-Crooked Arrow who had taken the stern of the canoe,
-was steering the canoe for a point of land about a half a
-mile down the lake shore. Black Hawk turned to him and
-asked, &ldquo;Why do you steer for that part of the lake,
-Crooked Arrow? I should think that that section of lake
-over to the eastward would be better.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Crooked Arrow knows where the fish are, little Black
-Hawk.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>He said nothing more but pulled strongly with his paddle
-and the canoe fairly skimmed across the water. Black
-Hawk thought to himself that they would probably have
-gone even faster if he, Black Hawk, had removed his
-paddle from the water, for he could not keep up with
-Crooked Arrow&rsquo;s stroke and was causing a backwash
-with his paddle by dragging it through the water.</p>
-<p>Finally Crooked Arrow said, &ldquo;My little friend, dip your
-paddle deep and pull strongly back toward the stern of
-the canoe. When you have completed the stroke, draw
-your paddle completely from the water and reach it forward
-high in the air before placing it in the water again.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Black Hawk followed his instructions, and soon he
-found that the paddling was a lot easier by using that
-technique than the way he had been trying to paddle. He
-had been concentrating so hard on his paddling that he
-did not realize that they were soon to the place where
-Crooked Arrow said that they would be sure to catch
-some fish.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_292">292</div>
-<p>Crooked Arrow motioned for Black Hawk to throw his
-line overboard, which he did, and with that Crooked
-Arrow slowed down the canoe to an even, smooth pace
-which would take them just past the small jutting of
-land.</p>
-<p>Black Hawk could see his own lure shining in the
-water. As the lure came parallel with the jutting land
-there was a great swirl of water, and the fight was on.</p>
-<p>A very large fish had grasped the lure in his mouth and
-it was now a fight between the boy and the fish. It was a
-huge bass that was threshing around in the water and
-soon it was obvious that Black Hawk would be the victor.
-With some swift overhand strokes he had pulled the fish
-up to the side of the canoe. Then with a thrust of his arm,
-Crooked Arrow speared the fish with his fish spear and
-brought him safely aboard. He was a beautiful big bass
-and Black Hawk was so proud he nearly tipped over the
-canoe in his excitement to see the fish.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Be not so excited, my young friend. It is a nice-sized
-fish, but the day is young and we must catch many, many
-more.&rdquo; Black Hawk cast his lure in again, and soon the
-episode was repeated. Back and forth Crooked Arrow
-paddled near the jutting land and fish after fish fell victim
-to the line of Black Hawk and the spear of Crooked
-Arrow.</p>
-<p>Soon shadows began to gather and Crooked Arrow
-turned the bow of the canoe toward the place they had
-started from. Black Hawk paddled even harder now going
-home, for he was very proud. There in the bottom of
-the canoe, all nicely strung on an improvised leather
-loop, were twelve plump large fish.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_293">293</div>
-<p>When they reached the shore, Black Hawk with his
-fish in hand dashed ashore to report his success to Red
-Hand. Red Hand looked with pride upon the catch Black
-Hawk held up to show him and then he said, &ldquo;My, but
-that is a fine catch of fish. Did you catch them all by
-yourself?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh no,&rdquo; said Black Hawk, &ldquo;Crooked Arrow and I
-both caught them. They would strike at my line and when
-I pulled them to the side of the boat, Crooked Arrow
-would spear them and bring them on board. Oh, what an
-exciting trip we have had. How did the others make out,
-or are we the first to return?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, you are the first to return, but remember you
-were not too far from the landing place. The others will
-be here shortly. Sit down and we will smoke and rest
-while we wait for the others.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>They sat down and waited. Soon the other canoes,
-one by one, would slip up to the shore, and the braves
-would leap out and triumphantly tell Red Hand of their
-catch. Soon the last of the canoes had been beached and
-the last of the fish carefully packed away for the journey
-home the following morning.</p>
-<p>The braves had a supper of delicious fresh lake bass
-and after they had sat around the fire telling of their adventures
-on the lake they all turned in for the night.
-Soon the fire had burned to just ashes and all the braves
-slept peacefully in the quiet of the night.</p>
-<p>It had been a long day on the lake in the sun, and now
-the quiet spring breezes through the trees overhead sang
-a soft lullaby along the lake shore. When it had been
-quiet for a long time, Black Hawk sat up and noticed
-that Crooked Arrow was gone from where he lay down
-to sleep.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_294">294</div>
-<p>Black Hawk looked around and then suddenly he
-glanced toward the lake. There he saw Crooked Arrow
-standing quiet. Black Hawk rose and quietly slipped
-down toward the lake and to where Crooked Arrow was
-standing. Approaching the lakeside, Black Hawk respected
-the brave, Crooked Arrow, and when he had
-reached a point about five yards from the brave he
-stopped. He could barely hear Crooked Arrow and then
-he knew that Crooked Arrow was thanking someone.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Finally, O Great Spirit, I, Crooked Arrow, humbly
-thank you for sending to me a friend, this boy, Black
-Hawk, who asked me to go with him on the fishing trip.
-For this I am thankful and also I am thankful that you
-sent the fish of the lake to his hook so that his catch was
-a large one. You have been very kind to Crooked Arrow
-this day and I will not forget. I have never known my
-family, but from this day forth I shall look upon Black
-Hawk as if he were my son. I know he has a father, a
-good and wonderful man, but I am sure he will not mind
-if I remain close to him, for his kindness to me this day
-has brought great joy to my heart. Thank you once again,
-O Great Spirit.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Crooked Arrow turned and walked slowly back to
-where he had been sleeping and lay down once again.
-Either he did not look or did not particularly notice that
-Black Hawk was missing from his place upon the ground.</p>
-<p>For a long time Black Hawk sat by the side of the
-lake thinking about what Crooked Arrow had been saying.
-Suddenly he realized what had happened here. He
-had made a friend, a very close friend, and it made his
-heart warm. Slowly he too returned to where he had
-slept and, lying down once again, was soon fast asleep.</p>
-<p>Dawn broke bright and warm upon the lake and soon
-all the Indians were astir.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_295">295</div>
-<p>They all ate a hearty breakfast and as they were packing
-the remainder of the equipment and safely storing the
-canoes away once again, the first of the hunting party
-arrived.</p>
-<p>They too had a very successful hunt, and Black Hawk
-counted five very plump bucks being carried by the hunting
-party.</p>
-<p>Some of the braves were quick to point out to him
-that the largest buck had been brought down with an
-arrow from the bow of Tall Hawk and this made Black
-Hawk very proud of his father. The party started on the
-return trip to the village and it was a happy group which
-entered the circle of homes to be greeted warmly by
-friends and family who viewed the fine food supply with
-a great deal of laughter and joy. The party soon dispersed,
-each one returning to his own home.</p>
-<p>When Black Hawk and his father returned to their
-home there was a fine meal awaiting them; and the rest
-of the family, his mother and two sisters, greeted the two
-hunters with praise for their success which had preceded
-them to their home by the little braves&rsquo; spreading the
-word through the village of the success of the hunters,
-especially Tall Hawk and his son Black Hawk, the great
-fisherman.</p>
-<p>After supper, Black Hawk stepped out of his home and
-wandered through the village greeting his many friends
-and talking with them of the adventures he had just been
-through.</p>
-<p>Finally Black Hawk had been to almost all his friends
-when he noticed one rather shabby wigwam set off from
-the rest on the far side of the village. Slowly puzzling a
-little bit about this, he wandered toward the wigwam. He
-saw one of his playmates, Walking Bird, and he stopped
-to ask who lived in the wigwam in the distance.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_296">296</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh,&rdquo; said Walking Bird, &ldquo;that is the home of Crooked
-Arrow. He lives off by himself like that, for he seems to
-enjoy being by himself. He is a strange sort of man and
-he very rarely comes out of his wigwam to participate in
-the activities of the tribe, except when there is a hunting
-or a fishing party or a tribal celebration. Was not he on
-the same trip with you?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, he was, and I think I shall pay him a visit.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Quickly Black Hawk approached the wigwam of
-Crooked Arrow and when he had reached the flap that
-served as a door he called out and asked if he might
-enter.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come in, come in, my friend, Black Hawk,&rdquo; called
-Crooked Arrow.</p>
-<p>The boy entered and Crooked Arrow rose to greet him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;It is very kind of you to come and see me.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Is it not the thing to do for friends to visit one another?&rdquo;
-asked Black Hawk. &ldquo;Why do you live here by
-yourself? Have you no family?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, Black Hawk, Crooked Arrow has no family, and
-I have liked living here on the edge of the village. It is
-quiet and I get much time to work on my tools for fishing
-and hunting. I like it here.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Black Hawk stayed until it was quite late and he noticed
-that Crooked Arrow talked on and on about many,
-many things. Finally it was getting very late and Black
-Hawk rose to leave.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Come again, little Black Hawk. My wigwam is always
-open to my good friend. The next time you come we
-will have another fine talk.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Thank you, friend Crooked Arrow. I shall return
-often for you have been a good friend.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_297">297</div>
-<p>With that, Black Hawk turned and walked to his own
-wigwam. As he approached his home he noticed his
-father just leaving. When Tall Hawk saw his son, he
-stopped and called to him. &ldquo;Black Hawk, my son, where
-have you been? It is quite late and your mother was getting
-quite concerned.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I was visiting with a friend, my father, a very good
-friend.&rdquo; It was then that Black Hawk spoke with his
-father about the events on the fishing trip and about how
-Crooked Arrow had knelt at the lakeside and thanked the
-Great Spirit for his friend, Black Hawk.</p>
-<p>His father listened attentively and then when Black
-Hawk had finished he said, &ldquo;My son, I am very proud of
-you. You have done a great and generous thing. Crooked
-Arrow has been a lonely person. You have brought much
-joy to his life. To have a friend is a wonderful thing.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;But, my father, if this is such a wonderful thing, why
-has no one befriended him before? Why does he still live
-alone on the edge of the tribe? Why is he alone on the
-hunt though he is with many braves?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He is not an easy person to talk to, my son. You, a
-boy, have spoken to him as an equal; this has meant much
-to him. The rest of us should be ashamed. We have been
-so busy that we have not taken time out to look at what
-is around us. It has taken a young Indian boy to bring to
-our attention this lack of concern for a fellow member of
-the tribe. If he had been a worthless brave who had
-sought pity and help from others, the treatment he had
-been given would have been what he deserved.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>But in thinking back, Tall Hawk realized that Crooked
-Arrow had always carried his share of the responsibility
-in the tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_298">298</div>
-<p>When a hunting party was forming, he always volunteered;
-when a battle was in progress, Crooked Arrow
-was always found to be in the middle. When there was
-distasteful jobs to be done around the village or a new
-lodge to be built or some repairs needed or someone to
-stand night watch, Crooked Arrow would always be
-among the first to volunteer.</p>
-<p>Yes, thought Tall Hawk, here is a man who has been
-treated with scorn who should have been treated with
-honor by his fellow braves.</p>
-<p>The following day after giving much thought to the
-question, Tall Hawk went to consult with the leaders of
-the village.</p>
-<p>After many hours, a delegation was formed and they
-proceeded to the wigwam of Crooked Arrow. The fat
-ugly warrior stepped from his wigwam and suddenly his
-eyes grew a little wild until he saw in the delegation
-Black Hawk, his friend.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Why have you come to the humble wigwam of
-Crooked Arrow?&rdquo; he asked of the leaders. &ldquo;What have I
-done to cause you to come? If I have done wrong tell me
-and I shall do all in my power to make it right.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; said Tall Hawk, &ldquo;It is we who have done wrong.
-We come to invite you to rebuild your wigwam within
-the village circle. There is a fine place right next to mine,
-and I would consider it an honor if you would build there
-and become my neighbor. My son has told me quite a bit
-about you and I can see now where we have been very
-unfair in the way we have neglected making you a part
-of our tribe. Come, become a part of our family. Share
-our fires and our food and we shall talk together of the
-great hunts. This we ask you to do as a sign that you will
-forgive us for this wrong which has existed so long.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_299">299</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, I will come, but listen. You have done me no
-wrong. I have been happy living here on the edge of the
-village, watching the children play and taking part in the
-hunt. I have had a good life. I have never known what
-real friendship was from the time I was a little boy going
-from one to the other begging for food to keep me going.
-But Black Hawk has brought the meaning of friendship
-to my heart, and for that reason I have desired these last
-few days to live closer to my people. Yes, I will come.
-With gladness in my heart, I will come.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The group turned and started for the center of the
-village to proclaim what had just happened; and, as they
-walked, a small boy, Black Hawk, and a not so ugly, fat,
-young man could be seen walking hand in hand&mdash;a certain
-lightness in their step that had not been there before.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_300">300</div>
-<h2 id="c45"><span class="h2line1">THE BOY AND THE WARRIOR CHIEF</span></h2>
-<p>Flying Owl was a very happy little Seneca brave. He
-had all he could wish for. His father was a very brave and
-honored member of the tribe. His mother was kind and
-made the best-tasting dishes of food for him when he was
-hungry. His sister and he would quarrel now and then,
-but most of the time they played and lived together very
-happily.</p>
-<p>Their home was strong and warm in the winter and
-cool in the summer. There were always many nice clothes
-to wear and plenty to eat. Flying Owl was learning from
-his father every day about the ways of the forest and the
-stream. When anyone watched Flying Owl at play, he
-would think, &ldquo;Now there is a lucky and happy little boy.
-I wonder if he knows how fortunate he is.&rdquo; But Flying
-Owl was a rare little Indian brave, for he did realize how
-lucky he was. When he was still young, Flying Owl gladly
-shared his toys and other things with his friends. For this
-reason he was very much liked by both the braves and
-women and by the other boys and girls of the tribe.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_301">301</div>
-<p>One bright summer day, Flying Owl rose early from his
-bed and looked out at the bright warm sun shining down
-on the green forest and the blue-green lake at the edge of
-their village. He thought to himself, &ldquo;What a wonderful
-day this is to go fishing. Only a short way from our home
-is the beautiful little hidden lake which my father has
-shown me. Surely there must be big fish in that lake. If I
-could catch some of them all by myself, my father would
-be proud of me and we would have a delicious supper this
-evening.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So without any delay, Flying Owl gathered together his
-fishing tackle which he and his father had made with such
-care during the cold winter nights. Flying Owl was often
-allowed to go off by himself on short trips like this, so
-long as he did not go too far or stay away from his home
-after dark. He packed his fishing gear and some food and
-started out, waving good-bye to his mother and sister
-who stood at the entrance to their wigwam. His mother
-called to remind him to be back in time for supper. Flying
-Owl shouted that he not only would be back before
-supper but would bring their supper home with him.
-Then his mother and sister watched him trotting from the
-village until he was out of sight.</p>
-<p>Flying Owl ran gaily along the forest paths, thinking
-that the many wild creatures had been awake since dawn.
-Now they were scurrying through the brush and the tree
-tops, enjoying the warm sunshine and cool breezes which
-blew gently through the forest. Flying Owl&rsquo;s heart felt
-very happy. It was good to be alive, discovering new
-wonders of nature here in the forest instead of playing in
-the village that he knew too well. And he thought, &ldquo;Perhaps
-some great adventure is waiting for me here in the
-green forest!&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_302">302</div>
-<p>He hurried on, impatient to reach the secret lake and
-catch the many large fish that he was sure were there. At
-the pace he was keeping, it was not long before he saw,
-through an opening in the trees, the blue-green, shimmering
-waters of the lake. Running faster, he reached the lake
-shore quickly and stopped a moment to look out across
-the waters and wonder where he would find the best place
-to fish.</p>
-<p>He saw a tree that had fallen out into the lake, and
-decided to stand on the end of the log in the lake. He
-cast his line into the water and settled down to await the
-first nibble. He did not have to wait long. There was a
-sharp tug upon his line and he felt the line go taut in his
-hands. In fact, it had come so suddenly that Flying Owl
-was almost thrown off balance. Bracing the heels of his
-moccasins against the curve of the log, he started pulling
-at the line and brought in a fine fat fish. The catch now
-lay on the bank next to him and he was ready to cast
-again. In only a few moments, he felt another sharp tug
-and soon had landed another plump fish. &ldquo;This is really
-fun!&rdquo; Flying Owl said aloud.</p>
-<p>Just then he heard a movement behind him. Turning
-quickly, he saw a tall handsome Indian brave dressed in
-the costume of the Woodland Indians, wearing the headdress
-of a chieftain. Flying Owl was startled, but the tall
-brave reached out his hand in friendship.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Do not be afraid, Flying Owl,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I will not
-hurt you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Who are you?&rdquo; Flying Owl asked as he looked up at
-the brave. &ldquo;I do not recognize you as a member of our
-tribe. How do you know my name?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The brave smiled, stepped closer, and said, &ldquo;Oh, I
-know your name because I <i>am</i> of your tribe. I remember
-you as a baby who looked so much like his father whom I
-knew well.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_303">303</div>
-<p>&ldquo;But I do not ever remember seeing you and I thought
-I knew everyone. If you are one of our tribe, I should
-know you, and above all because you are wearing the
-headdress of our Chief. Surely all, even the children,
-know our great Chieftains.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The brave drew closer until he was no more than a
-pace from Flying Owl. Then he took a small deerskin
-jacket from his shoulders, laid it on the ground, and sat
-cross-legged upon it, facing the boy. &ldquo;My name is Bear
-Claw and I am truly your Chief. If you do not believe me,
-you may ask any question you wish about our tribe, and I
-will give you the answer.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Flying Owl accepted the challenge and began to question
-the tall brave carefully until he was sure that the man
-was telling the truth. Still he had never seen or heard of
-him.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Surely,&rdquo; the chieftain said, &ldquo;you must know now that
-I am one of your tribe. But let me ask you a few questions.
-You have been asking me many, and now it is my
-turn.&rdquo; He waited with a laughing sparkle in his eyes
-while Flying Owl watched his face closely. &ldquo;What reason
-would you have for questioning me, Bear Claw?&rdquo; Flying
-Owl asked.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I would merely like to ask why you came to the still
-lake on such a beautiful summer day,&rdquo; replied the brave,
-not taking his eyes from the boy for one moment.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Well,&rdquo; said Flying Owl, &ldquo;I thought it would be fun if
-I came here today and caught enough fish for my mother
-to cook for our supper.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh,&rdquo; said Bear Claw smiling, &ldquo;that is a very good
-reason. Please do not let me stop your fishing.&rdquo; Then
-Bear Claw stretched out on the bank of the lake and lay
-gazing up through the trees at the bright blue sky.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_304">304</div>
-<p>Flying Owl hesitated, thinking about this strong brave&rsquo;s
-strange behavior. Then he remembered the fish he must
-catch and how he must return home before dark. So he
-cast his line into the water again and almost immediately
-caught another large fish. This he placed with the other
-two and went on fishing until he soon had a good catch.
-Seeing the sun sinking lower in the afternoon sky, he
-knew that he must hurry to reach the village in time for
-his mother to cook the fish for supper.</p>
-<p>Taking a stout birch branch, he ran one end of the
-branch through the gills of the fish to carry his catch over
-his shoulder. As he turned to say good-bye to the brave
-who had kept him company at the lakeside, he was surprised
-to find him gone. Beneath the tree, he saw only the
-flattened fir needles where the brave had lain watching
-him. He looked all around and could find no further trace
-of him. Flying Owl moved even faster toward home, because
-now he certainly had a great deal to tell his friends.
-He reached home in plenty of time before supper and
-handed the fish to his mother, telling her that, like his
-father, he had brought their meal for the evening. His
-mother was very proud and told him so. Then she asked,
-&ldquo;Did you have any strange and wonderful adventures today,
-my little Flying Owl?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The boy was just about to blurt out that he had, when
-he decided that he should wait to tell his father first about
-everything that had happened. So all he said was, &ldquo;We
-will talk later, mother. I have much to tell you.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Impatient now to break the news to his father, he
-went outside to look for him. Flying Owl found him
-talking with another brave and waited respectfully until
-his father had finished and was starting home. Planting
-himself in front of his father, Flying Owl began to tell
-his story, but he was speaking so fast that his father could
-hardly understand him.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_305">305</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Wait, my son! You must speak more slowly. I want
-to hear about everything that happened to you today, but
-your words tumble out so swiftly that my brain can&rsquo;t
-make any sense of them. Now start from the beginning
-again.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Flying Owl took a deep breath and began slowly this
-time to tell his father all about his adventure at the great
-still lake in the deep forest. As he talked, his father&rsquo;s face
-looked more and more puzzled. When Flying Owl had
-finished, his father put one hand on his son&rsquo;s shoulder,
-and they started for the wigwam. Nothing more was said
-about the adventure until they reached home. While
-Flying Owl was washing, his father turned to his mother
-and asked her what she thought of their son&rsquo;s story.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;He has not told me about it yet. He wanted to wait
-until he found you and tell you first.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>When the family had begun eating the supper of fish
-Flying Owl had caught, the young brave told his story
-once again for his mother&rsquo;s benefit. When he had ended
-it, his parents looked at each other and smiled and said
-no more about it.</p>
-<p>When the children had gone to bed, Flying Owl&rsquo;s
-mother said to her husband, &ldquo;Surely you do not believe
-this story that Flying Owl has told us. It must be something
-he imagined. He probably had a dull day and
-believed that he had to think up some adventure to tell
-his father.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No,&rdquo; said her husband, &ldquo;that is not the reason, for
-the catching of many sweet fish would be enough of a
-story. There is something more behind this and I must
-find out what it is. How would he know Bear Claw&rsquo;s
-name? He was only a baby when the great chief vanished.
-Tomorrow I will go with the boy and see for myself this
-place where he says he met Bear Claw.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_306">306</div>
-<p>The next morning, Flying Owl&rsquo;s father remarked to
-his son that it was such a nice day that they ought to go
-fishing once again at the still lake. Surely if there were
-more fish like those they had eaten the night before, they
-should try to make another large catch and share them
-with other families in the village. Flying Owl was thrilled
-with the thought of going fishing with his father and
-gathered his gear together quickly. Father and son started
-off together into the forest, traveling at a slower pace than
-Flying Owl had gone the day before. It was almost mid-day
-when they reached the side of the lake. Flying Owl&rsquo;s
-father suggested that they eat lunch before they began
-fishing. When they were through eating, Flying Owl&rsquo;s
-father looked at the boy curiously.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, show me where you saw this Seneca Chief
-yesterday.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Certainly, father,&rdquo; Flying Owl said confidently.</p>
-<p>He took his father&rsquo;s hand and walked back to the fir
-tree under which the warrior had rested. They both
-looked carefully at the ground.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;I see no signs of where a person lay under this tree,
-my son,&rdquo; Flying Owl&rsquo;s father finally said. &ldquo;Are you sure
-that you saw a Seneca Chief when you were here yesterday?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Oh yes, father, I know I did. We can&rsquo;t find any trace
-of the spot he lay on because the fir needles have risen
-again like the grass on which a deer has lain. Surely you
-don&rsquo;t believe that I would lie to you, father?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, my son. I do not believe you would, but I know
-of no one by the name of Bear Claw who lives in our
-village. Perhaps one of our unfriendly neighbors was
-playing a trick on you, or maybe your imagination
-wanted a little adventure of its own.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_307">307</div>
-<p>Flying Owl paused for a moment, thinking seriously.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;No, father, you have taught me to be truthful at all
-times, and to tell you exactly what I have seen and heard.
-I did see a tall Seneca standing right there, wearing a
-Chief&rsquo;s headdress that was one of the most beautiful I
-have ever seen. It was not something in my imagination,
-and it was not one of our neighbors, for he wore no mask
-and no paint to hide behind. His costume was Seneca,
-and when I questioned him about our village, he knew
-every answer.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;All right, my son, we will speak no more about it.
-But come, we must cast our lines. It is growing late and
-we must hurry if we are to bring home another meal this
-evening.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>So they started to fish and waited a long time without
-getting even a nibble. They changed their bait and
-moved to a new position farther along the lake shore,
-but nothing did any good. When the sun had sunk very
-low, Flying Owl&rsquo;s father announced that it was time to
-start for home. As they trotted back through the forest,
-neither spoke to the other, because both were thinking
-busily about Flying Owl&rsquo;s story, his good catch of yesterday,
-and their poor luck today.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_308">308</div>
-<p>When Flying Owl&rsquo;s mother saw them returning empty-handed,
-she said nothing of the fact that there were no
-fish. When the children had finished their supper and
-gone to bed, their parents spoke of the boy&rsquo;s adventure.
-Now they were more puzzled than ever. Just at that
-moment there was a loud muttering of voices, followed
-by such shouting and laughter and cheers as had not
-been heard in the village for many moons. Flying Owl&rsquo;s
-father dashed from his home, grasping his bow as he
-went. Certainly something wonderful must be happening.
-As he reached the center of the village, the first thing he
-saw was a tall Seneca Chieftain standing amidst many
-warriors who were shouting and dancing. It was Bear
-Claw, a Seneca Chief who had disappeared after a great
-battle. His people had returned to their village defeated
-and heartsick, believing him dead, and there had been
-much sadness. It had happened so many moons ago that
-Chief Bear Claw had almost been forgotten. Now he
-had appeared in the village as if from nowhere. Finally
-Bear Claw raised his arms in the air, asking for silence.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Your Chief has returned. I have much to tell you,
-but I must wait because I am tired and need rest. Tomorrow
-we shall have feasting and dancing and a Great
-Council. Then I will speak.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>The great warrior turned and walked to his wigwam
-where his wife and young son, who had been leading the
-tribe, waited for him. Flying Owl&rsquo;s father walked slowly
-back to his home where the boy lay sleeping, unaware of
-the great event that had been taking place.</p>
-<p>The next day the sun rose and covered the small village
-with a warm glow, as though greeting Bear Claw&rsquo;s return.
-Flying Owl walked out into the sunshine and found
-everyone preparing for a great celebration. He ran to
-ask his father about the reason for all the excitement.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;My son, sit beside your father who doubted you.
-Today a miracle has come to pass, and together we will
-hear how that miracle happened.&rdquo;</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_309">309</div>
-<p>Although he was bubbling over with curiosity to learn
-what had happened, Flying Owl sat patiently and silently
-beside his father. Soon it was time for the special meeting.
-The whole village began to gather in front of the home
-of the great Chief who had returned to his people. Flying
-Owl and his father joined the others and sat watching the
-entrance of the wigwam. Soon a great warrior with a
-magnificent headdress stepped out. Flying Owl grasped
-his father&rsquo;s arm and whispered, &ldquo;That&rsquo;s the Seneca Chief
-I told you about, father!&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Yes, my son. That is Bear Claw, warrior Chief of our
-tribe, who has returned to us after we had believed him
-dead.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Bear Claw signaled for silence. Then he began speaking
-with great dignity.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Many moons ago, when we were at war with our
-enemies to the north, I fell, wounded by an enemy arrow.
-Before I could escape, the enemy fell upon me and took
-me prisoner. I was taken to their village where I was
-kept under close guard. They did not kill me but made
-me a slave&mdash;a far greater punishment for any Seneca.
-For many moons I worked in the enemy camp, often
-being whipped and beaten and spit upon by their warriors
-and their squaws, and even their children. Two moons
-ago I escaped and began my long trek homeward. But I
-moved slowly because the path was long and I was weary.
-They sent a war party after me to bring me back. So for
-many suns I hid in the deep forest. I led their war party
-in a chase, first toward our village, and then away from
-it. I did not want to come too close to our homes until I
-was sure they had lost my trail. I knew they would not
-dare to attack our village because they were a small band,
-but still big enough to take prisoner any of our people
-who might have wandered too far away.</p>
-<div class="pb" id="Page_310">310</div>
-<p>&ldquo;Yesterday I arrived at the secret lake with the only
-things that I had been able to find and bring with me
-from the enemy camp&mdash;my knife, my bow, and my headdress
-which they had taken from me when they captured
-me. Suddenly I saw a Seneca boy fishing. I approached
-and spoke with him. Last night I slept in the forest until
-it was late and dark enough to enter our village. The rest
-of the story you know. But first, before the celebration,
-I would like to see that young lad I spoke to at the lakeside,
-the young brave who is called Flying Owl.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Flying Owl rose and stepped forward to face the Chief.</p>
-<p>&ldquo;You were the first of my people to see me, young
-brave, and it was the sight of you, fishing in the lake,
-which first made me feel that I was really home. You are
-a good fisherman and a bright lad, and I am sure you
-will become a great warrior. Because you were the first
-and because you appeared so brave in the face of what
-might have been great danger, I wish to reward you. Here
-is the bow which I carried all through my homeward trip.
-Keep it and remember the Seneca Chief you spoke to
-the day the fish were biting so well and the sun was
-warm&mdash;the day that happiness once again filled that
-Chief&rsquo;s heart.&rdquo;</p>
-<p>&ldquo;Thank you, Bear Claw,&rdquo; the boy replied proudly.
-&ldquo;May I hope that some day my father and I may go
-fishing with you at the secret lake?&rdquo;</p>
-<p>Everyone laughed and, most of all, Bear Claw. There
-was joy in the village for their leader had returned, and
-a boy had made him welcome.</p>
-<h2>Transcriber&rsquo;s Notes</h2>
-<ul>
-<li>Copyright notice provided as in the original&mdash;this e-text is public domain in the country of publication.</li>
-<li>Silently corrected palpable typos; left non-standard (or amusing) spellings and dialect unchanged.</li>
-<li>In the text versions, delimited italics text in _underscores_ (the HTML version reproduces the font form of the printed book.)</li>
-</ul>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Treasury of American Indian Tales, by
-Theodore Whitson Ressler
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURY OF AMERICAN INDIAN TALES ***
-
-***** This file should be named 62855-h.htm or 62855-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/6/2/8/5/62855/
-
-Produced by Stephen Hutcheson and the Online Distributed
-Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/62855-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/62855-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 064c72a..0000000
--- a/old/62855-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/62855-h/images/p2.jpg b/old/62855-h/images/p2.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 5d6c00f..0000000
--- a/old/62855-h/images/p2.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/62855-h/images/spine.jpg b/old/62855-h/images/spine.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 2beb87f..0000000
--- a/old/62855-h/images/spine.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ